From: tomo Date: Thu, 6 Jan 2000 06:28:03 +0000 (+0000) Subject: XEmacs 21.2.22 "Mercedes". X-Git-Tag: r21-2-22~1 X-Git-Url: http://git.chise.org/gitweb/?a=commitdiff_plain;h=afa9772e3fcbb4e80e3e4cfd1a40b4fccc6d08b8;p=chise%2Fxemacs-chise.git XEmacs 21.2.22 "Mercedes". --- diff --git a/CHANGES-beta b/CHANGES-beta index c400359..6666b17 100644 --- a/CHANGES-beta +++ b/CHANGES-beta @@ -1,4 +1,16 @@ -*- indented-text -*- +to 21.2.22 "Mercedes" +-- ESD Sound support from Robert Bihlmeyer +-- 10% faster redisplay from Jan Vroonhof +-- Fixes from Jeff Miller, Alexandre Oliva and Yoshiki Hayashi +-- "If you've got problems, read PROBLEMS!" from Robert Pluim +-- Lstream code now uses size_t, ssize_t consistently, Martin Buchholz +-- Fix `make install' if prefix != exec_prefix, Martin Buchholz +-- Fix compile warnings and C++ compilation, Martin Buchholz +-- Fix detection of coding: cookie in -*- first line. +-- More xim-xlib work by Kazuyuki Ienaga +-- Fix crash in abbrev.c (abbrev_location), Eric Darve + to 21.2.20 "Yoko" -- UTF-8 & file-coding magic cookie fix from MORIOKA Tomohiko -- bug fixes from Adrian Aichner, Sean MacLennan, and Jeff Miller diff --git a/ChangeLog b/ChangeLog index 46a3797..bba1269 100644 --- a/ChangeLog +++ b/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,72 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + +1999-11-26 Martin Buchholz + + * configure.in: + Add configure support for Unix 98 type ssize_t. + +1999-11-27 Martin Buchholz + + * Makefile.in.in: + Make sure config.values.sh is up to date. + Use $(SHELL) instead of sh or /bin/sh consistently. + Delegate `depend' target to src/Makefile.in.in. + +1999-10-27 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * INSTALL: Update configure option. + +1999-10-12 Alexandre Oliva + + * configure.in (native_sound_lib, *-sgi-*): Check for audio.h. + (LIBS): Check for libCsup. + + * etc/sample.Xdefaults: adds a reference to beNiceToColrmap, + so that the user can guess what to do if xemacs' dialogs are + butt ugly. + +1999-10-24 Jan Vroonhof + + * config.h.in: define HAVE_ESD_SOUND + + * configure.in: Add support for esd sound. --with-sound + now accepts a list of options. + * configure.usage (--native-sound-lib): ditto. + +1999-11-17 Martin Buchholz + + * Makefile.in.in (install-arch-dep): + Fix `make install' if prefix != exec_prefix. + +1999-11-15 Martin Buchholz + + * configure.in: + - Accept --with-database=gdbm as an alias for + --with-database=gnudbm. + - rename with_database_gnudbm to with_database_gdbm. + + * aclocal.m4 (ld_dynamic_link_flags): Just use empty value for + ld_dynamic_link_flags on Solaris. Else CC gives us: + CC: Warning: Option -Wl,-Bdynamic passed to ld, if ld is invoked, ignored otherwise + /usr/ccs/bin/ld: illegal option -- W + + +1999-11-13 Jason R Mastaler + + * etc/FTP: Updated FTP mirrors list. Replaced GNU FTP document + with a URL. + +1999-11-13 Jason R Mastaler + + * etc/MAILINGLISTS: Updated mailing list subscription information. + Replaced GNU MAILINGLISTS document with a URL. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released diff --git a/INSTALL b/INSTALL index e795ec5..ce6d91f 100644 --- a/INSTALL +++ b/INSTALL @@ -310,12 +310,12 @@ inefficient. Generally, it's best to go with the default configuration for your system. You can tweak this based on how you use XEmacs, and the memory and cpu resources available on your system. -The `--use-system-malloc' option can be use to either enable or +The `--with-system-malloc' option can be use to either enable or disable use of the system malloc. Generally, it's best to go with the default configuration for your system. Note that on many systems using the system malloc disables the use of the relocating allocator. -The `--use-debug-malloc' option can be used to link a special debugging +The `--with-debug-malloc' option can be used to link a special debugging version of malloc. Debug Malloc is not included with XEmacs, is intended for use only by the developers and may be obtained from . diff --git a/Makefile.in.in b/Makefile.in.in index 95f1a21..3a29d39 100644 --- a/Makefile.in.in +++ b/Makefile.in.in @@ -63,6 +63,7 @@ SHELL = /bin/sh LANG = C LC_ALL = C RM = rm -f +MAKEPATH=./lib-src/make-path pwd = /bin/pwd ## ==================== Things `configure' Might Edit ==================== @@ -273,30 +274,31 @@ dist: all-elc info ## - src/depend from src/*.[ch] .PHONY: config configure depend config: configure depend -configure: ${srcdir}/configure -${srcdir}/configure: ${srcdir}/configure.in +configure: ${srcdir}/configure ${srcdir}/lib-src/config.values.in + +${srcdir}/configure : ${srcdir}/configure.in cd ${srcdir} && autoconf - cd ${srcdir} && /bin/sh lib-src/config.values.sh -depend ${srcdir}/src/depend: - cd ${srcdir}/src && \ - perl ./make-src-depend > depend.tmp && \ - $(RM) depend && mv depend.tmp depend +${srcdir}/lib-src/config.values.in : ${srcdir}/configure + cd ${srcdir} && $(SHELL) lib-src/config.values.sh + +depend ${srcdir}/src/depend : + cd ${srcdir}/src && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) depend ## Build XEmacs and recompile out-of-date and missing .elc files along ## the way. all-elc all-elcs: lib-src lwlib dump-elcs src - MAKE='$(MAKE)' EMACS='./src/$(PROGNAME)' sh ${srcdir}/lib-src/update-elc.sh + MAKE='$(MAKE)' EMACS='./src/$(PROGNAME)' $(SHELL) ${srcdir}/lib-src/update-elc.sh ## Sub-target for all-elc. dump-elc dump-elcs: ${GENERATED_HEADERS} FRC.dump-elcs cd ./src && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) dump-elcs autoloads: src - MAKE='$(MAKE)' EMACS='./src/$(PROGNAME)' sh ${srcdir}/lib-src/update-autoloads.sh + MAKE='$(MAKE)' EMACS='./src/$(PROGNAME)' $(SHELL) ${srcdir}/lib-src/update-autoloads.sh custom-loads: - MAKE='$(MAKE)' EMACS='./src/$(PROGNAME)' sh ${srcdir}/lib-src/update-custom.sh + MAKE='$(MAKE)' EMACS='./src/$(PROGNAME)' $(SHELL) ${srcdir}/lib-src/update-custom.sh finder: src @echo "Building finder database ..." @@ -323,7 +325,7 @@ src/Emacs.ad.h: ${srcdir}/etc/Emacs.ad @(echo "/* Do not edit this file!" ; \ echo " Automatically generated from ${srcdir}/etc/Emacs.ad" ; \ echo " */" ; \ - /bin/sh ${srcdir}/lib-src/ad2c ${srcdir}/etc/Emacs.ad ) > \ + $(SHELL) ${srcdir}/lib-src/ad2c ${srcdir}/etc/Emacs.ad ) > \ src/Emacs.ad.h src/sheap-adjust.h: @@ -428,6 +430,7 @@ install-arch-dep: mkdir # endif /* __CYGWIN32__ */ #endif /* WINDOWSNT */ if test "${prefix}" != "${exec_prefix}"; then \ + $(MAKEPATH) ${exec_prefix}/lib/${instvardir}; \ for dir in \ lib/${inststaticdir} \ lib/${instvardir}/etc \ @@ -487,9 +490,8 @@ install-arch-indep: mkdir info @echo "${lispdir}" gzip-el: - ${srcdir}/lib-src/gzip-el.sh ${lispdir} + $(SHELL) ${srcdir}/lib-src/gzip-el.sh ${lispdir} -MAKEPATH=./lib-src/make-path ## Build all the directories to install XEmacs in. ## Since we may be creating several layers of directories, ## (e.g. /usr/local/lib/${PROGNAME}-20.5/sparc-sun-solaris2.6), we use diff --git a/aclocal.m4 b/aclocal.m4 index ff5c7ae..5635441 100644 --- a/aclocal.m4 +++ b/aclocal.m4 @@ -569,7 +569,7 @@ if test -z "$ld_dynamic_link_flags"; then ;; solaris2* | solaris7*) - ld_dynamic_link_flags="${wl}-Bdynamic" + ld_dynamic_link_flags= ;; sco3.2v5* | unixware* | sysv5* | sysv4*) diff --git a/configure b/configure index e19107a..cf53d2e 100755 --- a/configure +++ b/configure @@ -424,22 +424,22 @@ echo " Use \`$progname --help' to show usage.") >&2 && exit 1 ;; "with_database" ) with_database_berkdb=no with_database_dbm=no - with_database_gnudbm=no + with_database_gdbm=no for x in `echo "$val" | sed -e 's/,/ /g'` ; do case "$x" in - no ) ;; - b | be | ber | berk | berkd | berkdb ) with_database_berkdb=yes ;; - d | db | dbm ) with_database_dbm=yes ;; - g | gn | gnu | gnud | gnudb | gnudbm ) with_database_gnudbm=yes ;; - * ) (echo "$progname: Usage error:" + no ) ;; + b | be | ber | berk | berkd | berkdb ) with_database_berkdb=yes ;; + d | db | dbm ) with_database_dbm=yes ;; + g | gn | gnu | gnud | gnudb | gnudbm | gdbm) with_database_gdbm=yes ;; + * ) (echo "$progname: Usage error:" echo " " "The \`--$optname' option value must be either \`no' or a comma-separated list of one or more of \`berkdb' and either \`dbm' or \`gnudbm'." echo " Use \`$progname --help' to show usage.") >&2 && exit 1 ;; esac done - if test "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" -a \ - "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes"; then + if test "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" -a \ + "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes"; then (echo "$progname: Usage error:" echo " " "Only one of \`dbm' and \`gnudbm' may be specified with the \`--$optname' option." @@ -448,18 +448,38 @@ echo " Use \`$progname --help' to show usage.") >&2 && exit 1 ;; "with_sound" ) - case "$val" in - y | ye | yes ) val=native ;; - n | no | non | none ) val=no;; - na | nat | nati | nativ | native ) val=native ;; - ne | net | neta | netau | netaud | netaudi | netaudio | nas ) val=nas ;; - b | bo | bot | both ) val=both;; - * ) (echo "$progname: Usage error:" -echo " " "The \`--$optname' option must have one of these values: - \`native', \`nas', \`both', or \`none'." -echo " Use \`$progname --help' to show usage.") >&2 && exit 1 ;; - esac - eval "$opt=\"$val\"" + for x in `echo "$val" | sed -e 's/,/ /g'` ; do + case "$x" in + n | no | non | none ) new_sdefault=no ;; + a | al | all | both ) new_sdefault=yes ;; + + native ) with_native_sound=yes ;; + nonative ) with_native_sound=no ;; + + nas ) with_nas_sound=yes ;; + nonas ) with_nas_sound=no ;; + + esd ) with_esd=yes ;; + noesd ) with_esh=no ;; + + * ) bogus_sound=yes ;; + esac + if test "$bogus_sound" -o \ + \( -n "$new_sdefault" -a -n "$sound_notfirst" \) ; then + types="\`all', \`none', \`(no)native', \`no(nas)', \`(no)esd'." + (echo "$progname: Usage error:" +echo " " "Valid types for the \`--$optname' option are: + $types. +The default is native,esd." +echo " Use \`$progname --help' to show usage.") >&2 && exit 1 + elif test -n "$new_sdefault" ; then + with_native_sound=$new_sdefault + with_nas_sound=$new_sdefault + with_esd=$new_sdefault + new_sdefault= # reset this + fi + sound_notfirst=true + done ;; "with_xim" ) @@ -796,7 +816,7 @@ echo " Use \`$progname --help' to show usage.") >&2 && exit 1 fi echo $ac_n "checking whether ln -s works""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:800: checking whether ln -s works" >&5 +echo "configure:820: checking whether ln -s works" >&5 rm -f conftestdata if ln -s X conftestdata 2>/dev/null @@ -1041,7 +1061,7 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking "host system type"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1045: checking "host system type"" >&5 +echo "configure:1065: checking "host system type"" >&5 internal_configuration=`echo $configuration | sed 's/-\(workshop\)//'` canonical=`${CONFIG_SHELL-/bin/sh} $srcdir/config.sub "$internal_configuration"` configuration=`echo "$configuration" | sed 's/^\([^-][^-]*-[^-][^-]*-[^-][^-]*\)-.*$/\1/'` @@ -1535,7 +1555,7 @@ xe_save_CFLAGS="$CFLAGS" # Extract the first word of "gcc", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy gcc; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1539: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:1559: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -1562,7 +1582,7 @@ if test -z "$CC"; then # Extract the first word of "cc", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy cc; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1566: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:1586: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -1610,7 +1630,7 @@ fi # Extract the first word of "cl", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy cl; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1614: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:1634: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -1639,7 +1659,7 @@ fi fi echo $ac_n "checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1643: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works" >&5 +echo "configure:1663: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works" >&5 ac_ext=c xe_cppflags='$CPPFLAGS $c_switch_site $c_switch_machine $c_switch_system $c_switch_x_site $X_CFLAGS' @@ -1652,12 +1672,12 @@ cross_compiling=no cat > conftest.$ac_ext << EOF -#line 1656 "configure" +#line 1676 "configure" #include "confdefs.h" main(){return(0);} EOF -if { (eval echo configure:1661: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:1681: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then ac_cv_prog_cc_works=yes # If we can't run a trivial program, we are probably using a cross compiler. if (./conftest; exit) 2>/dev/null; then @@ -1685,19 +1705,19 @@ if test $ac_cv_prog_cc_works = no; then { echo "configure: error: installation or configuration problem: C compiler cannot create executables." 1>&2; exit 1; } fi echo $ac_n "checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1689: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler" >&5 +echo "configure:1709: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler" >&5 echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_prog_cc_cross" 1>&6 cross_compiling=$ac_cv_prog_cc_cross echo $ac_n "checking whether we are using GNU C""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1694: checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 +echo "configure:1714: checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 cat > conftest.c <&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; }; } | egrep yes >/dev/null 2>&1; then +if { ac_try='${CC-cc} -E conftest.c'; { (eval echo configure:1721: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; }; } | egrep yes >/dev/null 2>&1; then ac_cv_prog_gcc=yes else ac_cv_prog_gcc=no @@ -1715,7 +1735,7 @@ ac_test_CFLAGS="${CFLAGS+set}" ac_save_CFLAGS="$CFLAGS" CFLAGS= echo $ac_n "checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1719: checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g" >&5 +echo "configure:1739: checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g" >&5 echo 'void f(){}' > conftest.c if test -z "`${CC-cc} -g -c conftest.c 2>&1`"; then @@ -1748,7 +1768,7 @@ if test "$with_gcc" = "no" -a "$GCC" = "yes"; then # Extract the first word of "gcc", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy gcc; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1752: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:1772: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -1775,7 +1795,7 @@ if test -z "$CC"; then # Extract the first word of "cc", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy cc; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1779: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:1799: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -1823,7 +1843,7 @@ fi # Extract the first word of "cl", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy cl; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1827: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:1847: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -1852,7 +1872,7 @@ fi fi echo $ac_n "checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1856: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works" >&5 +echo "configure:1876: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works" >&5 ac_ext=c xe_cppflags='$CPPFLAGS $c_switch_site $c_switch_machine $c_switch_system $c_switch_x_site $X_CFLAGS' @@ -1865,12 +1885,12 @@ cross_compiling=no cat > conftest.$ac_ext << EOF -#line 1869 "configure" +#line 1889 "configure" #include "confdefs.h" main(){return(0);} EOF -if { (eval echo configure:1874: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:1894: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then ac_cv_prog_cc_works=yes # If we can't run a trivial program, we are probably using a cross compiler. if (./conftest; exit) 2>/dev/null; then @@ -1898,19 +1918,19 @@ if test $ac_cv_prog_cc_works = no; then { echo "configure: error: installation or configuration problem: C compiler cannot create executables." 1>&2; exit 1; } fi echo $ac_n "checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1902: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler" >&5 +echo "configure:1922: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler" >&5 echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_prog_cc_cross" 1>&6 cross_compiling=$ac_cv_prog_cc_cross echo $ac_n "checking whether we are using GNU C""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1907: checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 +echo "configure:1927: checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 cat > conftest.c <&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; }; } | egrep yes >/dev/null 2>&1; then +if { ac_try='${CC-cc} -E conftest.c'; { (eval echo configure:1934: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; }; } | egrep yes >/dev/null 2>&1; then ac_cv_prog_gcc=yes else ac_cv_prog_gcc=no @@ -1928,7 +1948,7 @@ ac_test_CFLAGS="${CFLAGS+set}" ac_save_CFLAGS="$CFLAGS" CFLAGS= echo $ac_n "checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1932: checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g" >&5 +echo "configure:1952: checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g" >&5 echo 'void f(){}' > conftest.c if test -z "`${CC-cc} -g -c conftest.c 2>&1`"; then @@ -1961,7 +1981,7 @@ elif test "$with_gcc" = "yes" -a "$GCC" != "yes" ; then # Extract the first word of "gcc", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy gcc; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1965: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:1985: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -1988,7 +2008,7 @@ if test -z "$CC"; then # Extract the first word of "cc", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy cc; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:1992: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:2012: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -2036,7 +2056,7 @@ fi # Extract the first word of "cl", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy cl; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2040: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:2060: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$CC"; then ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -2065,7 +2085,7 @@ fi fi echo $ac_n "checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2069: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works" >&5 +echo "configure:2089: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) works" >&5 ac_ext=c xe_cppflags='$CPPFLAGS $c_switch_site $c_switch_machine $c_switch_system $c_switch_x_site $X_CFLAGS' @@ -2078,12 +2098,12 @@ cross_compiling=no cat > conftest.$ac_ext << EOF -#line 2082 "configure" +#line 2102 "configure" #include "confdefs.h" main(){return(0);} EOF -if { (eval echo configure:2087: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:2107: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then ac_cv_prog_cc_works=yes # If we can't run a trivial program, we are probably using a cross compiler. if (./conftest; exit) 2>/dev/null; then @@ -2111,19 +2131,19 @@ if test $ac_cv_prog_cc_works = no; then { echo "configure: error: installation or configuration problem: C compiler cannot create executables." 1>&2; exit 1; } fi echo $ac_n "checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2115: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler" >&5 +echo "configure:2135: checking whether the C compiler ($CC $CFLAGS $LDFLAGS) is a cross-compiler" >&5 echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_prog_cc_cross" 1>&6 cross_compiling=$ac_cv_prog_cc_cross echo $ac_n "checking whether we are using GNU C""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2120: checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 +echo "configure:2140: checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 cat > conftest.c <&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; }; } | egrep yes >/dev/null 2>&1; then +if { ac_try='${CC-cc} -E conftest.c'; { (eval echo configure:2147: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; }; } | egrep yes >/dev/null 2>&1; then ac_cv_prog_gcc=yes else ac_cv_prog_gcc=no @@ -2141,7 +2161,7 @@ ac_test_CFLAGS="${CFLAGS+set}" ac_save_CFLAGS="$CFLAGS" CFLAGS= echo $ac_n "checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2145: checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g" >&5 +echo "configure:2165: checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g" >&5 echo 'void f(){}' > conftest.c if test -z "`${CC-cc} -g -c conftest.c 2>&1`"; then @@ -2178,7 +2198,7 @@ test -n "$CPP" -a -d "$CPP" && CPP= test -n "$NON_GNU_CPP" -a "$GCC" != "yes" -a -z "$CPP" && CPP="$NON_GNU_CPP" echo $ac_n "checking how to run the C preprocessor""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2182: checking how to run the C preprocessor" >&5 +echo "configure:2202: checking how to run the C preprocessor" >&5 # On Suns, sometimes $CPP names a directory. if test -n "$CPP" && test -d "$CPP"; then CPP= @@ -2191,13 +2211,13 @@ if test -z "$CPP"; then # On the NeXT, cc -E runs the code through the compiler's parser, # not just through cpp. cat > conftest.$ac_ext < Syntax Error EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:2201: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:2221: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then : @@ -2208,13 +2228,13 @@ else rm -rf conftest* CPP="${CC-cc} -E -traditional-cpp" cat > conftest.$ac_ext < Syntax Error EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:2218: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:2238: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then : @@ -2225,13 +2245,13 @@ else rm -rf conftest* CPP="${CC-cc} -nologo -E" cat > conftest.$ac_ext < Syntax Error EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:2235: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:2255: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then : @@ -2256,9 +2276,9 @@ echo "$ac_t""$CPP" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for AIX""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2260: checking for AIX" >&5 +echo "configure:2280: checking for AIX" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&6 -echo "configure:2289: checking for GNU libc" >&5 +echo "configure:2309: checking for GNU libc" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main() { @@ -2299,7 +2319,7 @@ int main() { ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:2303: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:2323: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* have_glibc=yes else @@ -2321,7 +2341,7 @@ EOF cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:2357: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then : else @@ -2607,7 +2627,7 @@ test -n "$unexec" && extra_objs="$extra_objs $unexec" && if test "$ext fi echo $ac_n "checking for dynodump""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2611: checking for dynodump" >&5 +echo "configure:2631: checking for dynodump" >&5 if test "$unexec" != "unexsol2.o"; then echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 else @@ -2645,12 +2665,12 @@ if test "$unexec" = "unexaix.o"; then done echo $ac_n "checking for terminateAndUnload in -lC""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2649: checking for terminateAndUnload in -lC" >&5 +echo "configure:2669: checking for terminateAndUnload in -lC" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo C'_'terminateAndUnload | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lC " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:2685: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -2765,7 +2785,7 @@ fi if test "$add_runtime_path" = "yes"; then echo $ac_n "checking "for runtime libraries flag"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2769: checking "for runtime libraries flag"" >&5 +echo "configure:2789: checking "for runtime libraries flag"" >&5 case "$opsys" in sol2 ) dash_r="-R" ;; decosf* | linux* | irix*) dash_r="-rpath " ;; @@ -2787,14 +2807,14 @@ if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then done fi cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:2818: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* dash_r="$try_dash_r" else @@ -2896,10 +2916,10 @@ else fi after_morecore_hook_exists=yes echo $ac_n "checking for malloc_get_state""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2900: checking for malloc_get_state" >&5 +echo "configure:2920: checking for malloc_get_state" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:2946: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_malloc_get_state=yes" else @@ -2942,10 +2962,10 @@ doug_lea_malloc=no fi echo $ac_n "checking for malloc_set_state""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2946: checking for malloc_set_state" >&5 +echo "configure:2966: checking for malloc_set_state" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:2992: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_malloc_set_state=yes" else @@ -2988,16 +3008,16 @@ doug_lea_malloc=no fi echo $ac_n "checking whether __after_morecore_hook exists""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:2992: checking whether __after_morecore_hook exists" >&5 +echo "configure:3012: checking whether __after_morecore_hook exists" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:3021: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 else @@ -3056,7 +3076,7 @@ fi # Extract the first word of "ranlib", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy ranlib; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3060: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:3080: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$RANLIB"; then ac_cv_prog_RANLIB="$RANLIB" # Let the user override the test. @@ -3111,7 +3131,7 @@ ac_configure=$ac_aux_dir/configure # This should be Cygnus configure. # SVR4 /usr/ucb/install, which tries to use the nonexistent group "staff" # ./install, which can be erroneously created by make from ./install.sh. echo $ac_n "checking for a BSD compatible install""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3115: checking for a BSD compatible install" >&5 +echo "configure:3135: checking for a BSD compatible install" >&5 if test -z "$INSTALL"; then IFS="${IFS= }"; ac_save_IFS="$IFS"; IFS=":" @@ -3165,7 +3185,7 @@ do # Extract the first word of "$ac_prog", so it can be a program name with args. set dummy $ac_prog; ac_word=$2 echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3169: checking for $ac_word" >&5 +echo "configure:3189: checking for $ac_word" >&5 if test -n "$YACC"; then ac_cv_prog_YACC="$YACC" # Let the user override the test. @@ -3197,15 +3217,15 @@ for ac_hdr in mach/mach.h sys/stropts.h sys/timeb.h sys/time.h unistd.h do ac_safe=`echo "$ac_hdr" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_hdr""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3201: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 +echo "configure:3221: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:3209: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:3229: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -3238,15 +3258,15 @@ for ac_hdr in utime.h locale.h libgen.h fcntl.h ulimit.h cygwin/version.h do ac_safe=`echo "$ac_hdr" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_hdr""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3242: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 +echo "configure:3262: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:3250: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:3270: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -3279,15 +3299,15 @@ for ac_hdr in kstat.h sys/pstat.h inttypes.h sys/un.h a.out.h do ac_safe=`echo "$ac_hdr" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_hdr""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3283: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 +echo "configure:3303: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:3291: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:3311: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -3317,10 +3337,10 @@ fi done echo $ac_n "checking for sys/wait.h that is POSIX.1 compatible""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3321: checking for sys/wait.h that is POSIX.1 compatible" >&5 +echo "configure:3341: checking for sys/wait.h that is POSIX.1 compatible" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -3336,7 +3356,7 @@ wait (&s); s = WIFEXITED (s) ? WEXITSTATUS (s) : 1; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3340: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3360: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_header_sys_wait_h=yes else @@ -3360,10 +3380,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for ANSI C header files""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3364: checking for ANSI C header files" >&5 +echo "configure:3384: checking for ANSI C header files" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -3371,7 +3391,7 @@ cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:3375: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:3395: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -3388,7 +3408,7 @@ rm -f conftest* if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then # SunOS 4.x string.h does not declare mem*, contrary to ANSI. cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF @@ -3406,7 +3426,7 @@ fi if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then # ISC 2.0.2 stdlib.h does not declare free, contrary to ANSI. cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF @@ -3424,7 +3444,7 @@ fi if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then # /bin/cc in Irix-4.0.5 gets non-ANSI ctype macros unless using -ansi. cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #define ISLOWER(c) ('a' <= (c) && (c) <= 'z') @@ -3435,7 +3455,7 @@ if (XOR (islower (i), ISLOWER (i)) || toupper (i) != TOUPPER (i)) exit(2); exit (0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3439: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:3459: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then : else @@ -3461,10 +3481,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking whether time.h and sys/time.h may both be included""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3465: checking whether time.h and sys/time.h may both be included" >&5 +echo "configure:3485: checking whether time.h and sys/time.h may both be included" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -3473,7 +3493,7 @@ int main() { struct tm *tp; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3477: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3497: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_header_time=yes else @@ -3497,10 +3517,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for sys_siglist declaration in signal.h or unistd.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3501: checking for sys_siglist declaration in signal.h or unistd.h" >&5 +echo "configure:3521: checking for sys_siglist declaration in signal.h or unistd.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -3512,7 +3532,7 @@ int main() { char *msg = *(sys_siglist + 1); ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3516: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3536: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_decl_sys_siglist=yes else @@ -3537,9 +3557,9 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for struct utimbuf""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3541: checking for struct utimbuf" >&5 +echo "configure:3561: checking for struct utimbuf" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < @@ -3558,7 +3578,7 @@ int main() { static struct utimbuf x; x.actime = x.modtime; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3562: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3582: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF @@ -3578,10 +3598,10 @@ fi rm -f conftest* echo $ac_n "checking return type of signal handlers""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3582: checking return type of signal handlers" >&5 +echo "configure:3602: checking return type of signal handlers" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -3598,7 +3618,7 @@ int main() { int i; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3602: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3622: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_type_signal=void else @@ -3620,10 +3640,10 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking for size_t""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3624: checking for size_t" >&5 +echo "configure:3644: checking for size_t" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #if STDC_HEADERS @@ -3654,10 +3674,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for pid_t""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3658: checking for pid_t" >&5 +echo "configure:3678: checking for pid_t" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #if STDC_HEADERS @@ -3688,10 +3708,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for uid_t in sys/types.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3692: checking for uid_t in sys/types.h" >&5 +echo "configure:3712: checking for uid_t in sys/types.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF @@ -3727,10 +3747,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for mode_t""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3731: checking for mode_t" >&5 +echo "configure:3751: checking for mode_t" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #if STDC_HEADERS @@ -3761,10 +3781,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for off_t""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3765: checking for off_t" >&5 +echo "configure:3785: checking for off_t" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #if STDC_HEADERS @@ -3794,11 +3814,45 @@ EOF fi +echo $ac_n "checking for ssize_t""... $ac_c" 1>&6 +echo "configure:3819: checking for ssize_t" >&5 + +cat > conftest.$ac_ext < +#if STDC_HEADERS +#include +#include +#endif +EOF +if (eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext") 2>&5 | + egrep "(^|[^a-zA-Z_0-9])ssize_t[^a-zA-Z_0-9]" >/dev/null 2>&1; then + rm -rf conftest* + ac_cv_type_ssize_t=yes +else + rm -rf conftest* + ac_cv_type_ssize_t=no +fi +rm -f conftest* + +echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_type_ssize_t" 1>&6 +if test $ac_cv_type_ssize_t = no; then + { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF + Defining ssize_t = int +EOF +cat >> confdefs.h <<\EOF +#define ssize_t int +EOF +} + +fi + echo $ac_n "checking for struct timeval""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3800: checking for struct timeval" >&5 +echo "configure:3854: checking for struct timeval" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < @@ -3814,7 +3868,7 @@ int main() { static struct timeval x; x.tv_sec = x.tv_usec; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3818: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3872: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 HAVE_TIMEVAL=yes @@ -3836,10 +3890,10 @@ fi rm -f conftest* echo $ac_n "checking whether struct tm is in sys/time.h or time.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3840: checking whether struct tm is in sys/time.h or time.h" >&5 +echo "configure:3894: checking whether struct tm is in sys/time.h or time.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -3847,7 +3901,7 @@ int main() { struct tm *tp; tp->tm_sec; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3851: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3905: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_struct_tm=time.h else @@ -3871,10 +3925,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for tm_zone in struct tm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3875: checking for tm_zone in struct tm" >&5 +echo "configure:3929: checking for tm_zone in struct tm" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include <$ac_cv_struct_tm> @@ -3882,7 +3936,7 @@ int main() { struct tm tm; tm.tm_zone; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3886: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:3940: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_struct_tm_zone=yes else @@ -3905,10 +3959,10 @@ EOF else echo $ac_n "checking for tzname""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3909: checking for tzname" >&5 +echo "configure:3963: checking for tzname" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #ifndef tzname /* For SGI. */ @@ -3918,7 +3972,7 @@ int main() { atoi(*tzname); ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:3922: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:3976: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_var_tzname=yes else @@ -3944,10 +3998,10 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for working const""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:3948: checking for working const" >&5 +echo "configure:4002: checking for working const" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:4054: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_c_const=yes else @@ -4021,7 +4075,7 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking whether ${MAKE-make} sets \${MAKE}""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4025: checking whether ${MAKE-make} sets \${MAKE}" >&5 +echo "configure:4079: checking whether ${MAKE-make} sets \${MAKE}" >&5 set dummy ${MAKE-make}; ac_make=`echo "$2" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` cat > conftestmake <<\EOF @@ -4046,12 +4100,12 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking whether byte ordering is bigendian""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4050: checking whether byte ordering is bigendian" >&5 +echo "configure:4104: checking whether byte ordering is bigendian" >&5 ac_cv_c_bigendian=unknown # See if sys/param.h defines the BYTE_ORDER macro. cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -4062,11 +4116,11 @@ int main() { #endif ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4066: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:4120: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* # It does; now see whether it defined to BIG_ENDIAN or not. cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -4077,7 +4131,7 @@ int main() { #endif ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4081: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:4135: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_c_bigendian=yes else @@ -4094,7 +4148,7 @@ fi rm -f conftest* if test $ac_cv_c_bigendian = unknown; then cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:4165: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_c_bigendian=no else @@ -4134,10 +4188,10 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking size of short""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4138: checking size of short" >&5 +echo "configure:4192: checking size of short" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < main() @@ -4148,7 +4202,7 @@ main() exit(0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4152: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:4206: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_sizeof_short=`cat conftestval` else @@ -4176,10 +4230,10 @@ if test "$ac_cv_sizeof_short" = 0; then exit 1 fi echo $ac_n "checking size of int""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4180: checking size of int" >&5 +echo "configure:4234: checking size of int" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < main() @@ -4190,7 +4244,7 @@ main() exit(0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4194: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:4248: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_sizeof_int=`cat conftestval` else @@ -4212,10 +4266,10 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking size of long""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4216: checking size of long" >&5 +echo "configure:4270: checking size of long" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < main() @@ -4226,7 +4280,7 @@ main() exit(0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4230: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:4284: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_sizeof_long=`cat conftestval` else @@ -4248,10 +4302,10 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking size of long long""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4252: checking size of long long" >&5 +echo "configure:4306: checking size of long long" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < main() @@ -4262,7 +4316,7 @@ main() exit(0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4266: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:4320: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_sizeof_long_long=`cat conftestval` else @@ -4284,10 +4338,10 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking size of void *""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4288: checking size of void *" >&5 +echo "configure:4342: checking size of void *" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < main() @@ -4298,7 +4352,7 @@ main() exit(0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4302: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:4356: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_sizeof_void_p=`cat conftestval` else @@ -4321,7 +4375,7 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking for long file names""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4325: checking for long file names" >&5 +echo "configure:4379: checking for long file names" >&5 ac_cv_sys_long_file_names=yes # Test for long file names in all the places we know might matter: @@ -4367,10 +4421,10 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for sin""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4371: checking for sin" >&5 +echo "configure:4425: checking for sin" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:4451: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_sin=yes" else @@ -4411,12 +4465,12 @@ else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for sin in -lm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4415: checking for sin in -lm" >&5 +echo "configure:4469: checking for sin in -lm" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo m'_'sin | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lm " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:4485: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -4471,14 +4525,14 @@ EOF cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main() { return atanh(1.0) + asinh(1.0) + acosh(1.0); ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:4482: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:4536: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_INVERSE_HYPERBOLIC @@ -4495,7 +4549,7 @@ fi rm -f conftest* echo "checking type of mail spool file locking" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4499: checking type of mail spool file locking" >&5 +echo "configure:4553: checking type of mail spool file locking" >&5 test -z "$mail_locking" -a "$mail_use_flock" = "yes" && mail_locking=flock test -z "$mail_locking" -a "$mail_use_lockf" = "yes" && mail_locking=lockf if test "$mail_locking" = "lockf"; then { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF @@ -4520,12 +4574,12 @@ fi case "$opsys" in decosf*) echo $ac_n "checking for cma_open in -lpthreads""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4524: checking for cma_open in -lpthreads" >&5 +echo "configure:4578: checking for cma_open in -lpthreads" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo pthreads'_'cma_open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lpthreads " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:4594: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -4572,7 +4626,7 @@ fi esac echo $ac_n "checking whether the -xildoff compiler flag is required""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4576: checking whether the -xildoff compiler flag is required" >&5 +echo "configure:4630: checking whether the -xildoff compiler flag is required" >&5 if ${CC-cc} '-###' -xildon no_such_file.c 2>&1 | grep '^[^ ]*/ild ' > /dev/null ; then if ${CC-cc} '-###' -xildoff no_such_file.c 2>&1 | grep '^[^ ]*/ild ' > /dev/null ; then echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6; @@ -4583,7 +4637,7 @@ fi if test "$opsys" = "sol2" && test "$OS_RELEASE" -ge 56; then echo $ac_n "checking for \"-z ignore\" linker flag""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4587: checking for \"-z ignore\" linker flag" >&5 +echo "configure:4641: checking for \"-z ignore\" linker flag" >&5 case "`ld -h 2>&1`" in *-z\ ignore\|record* ) echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 ld_switch_site="-z ignore $ld_switch_site" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " Prepending \"-z ignore\" to \$ld_switch_site"; fi ;; @@ -4593,7 +4647,7 @@ fi echo "checking "for specified window system"" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4597: checking "for specified window system"" >&5 +echo "configure:4651: checking "for specified window system"" >&5 if test "$with_x11" != "no"; then test "$x_includes $x_libraries" != "NONE NONE" && \ @@ -4626,7 +4680,7 @@ if test "$with_x11" != "no"; then # Uses ac_ vars as temps to allow command line to override cache and checks. # --without-x overrides everything else, but does not touch the cache. echo $ac_n "checking for X""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4630: checking for X" >&5 +echo "configure:4684: checking for X" >&5 # Check whether --with-x or --without-x was given. if test "${with_x+set}" = set; then @@ -4686,12 +4740,12 @@ if test "$ac_x_includes" = NO; then # First, try using that file with no special directory specified. cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:4695: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:4749: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -4760,14 +4814,14 @@ if test "$ac_x_libraries" = NO; then ac_save_LIBS="$LIBS" LIBS="-l$x_direct_test_library $LIBS" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:4825: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* LIBS="$ac_save_LIBS" # We can link X programs with no special library path. @@ -4876,17 +4930,17 @@ else case "`(uname -sr) 2>/dev/null`" in "SunOS 5"*) echo $ac_n "checking whether -R must be followed by a space""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4880: checking whether -R must be followed by a space" >&5 +echo "configure:4934: checking whether -R must be followed by a space" >&5 ac_xsave_LIBS="$LIBS"; LIBS="$LIBS -R$x_libraries" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:4944: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* ac_R_nospace=yes else @@ -4902,14 +4956,14 @@ rm -f conftest* else LIBS="$ac_xsave_LIBS -R $x_libraries" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:4967: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* ac_R_space=yes else @@ -4945,12 +4999,12 @@ ac_cv_lib_dnet_dnet_ntoa=no else echo $ac_n "checking for dnet_ntoa in -ldnet""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4949: checking for dnet_ntoa in -ldnet" >&5 +echo "configure:5003: checking for dnet_ntoa in -ldnet" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo dnet'_'dnet_ntoa | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ldnet " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5019: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -4985,12 +5039,12 @@ fi if test $ac_cv_lib_dnet_dnet_ntoa = no; then echo $ac_n "checking for dnet_ntoa in -ldnet_stub""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:4989: checking for dnet_ntoa in -ldnet_stub" >&5 +echo "configure:5043: checking for dnet_ntoa in -ldnet_stub" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo dnet_stub'_'dnet_ntoa | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ldnet_stub " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5059: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5030,10 +5084,10 @@ fi # The nsl library prevents programs from opening the X display # on Irix 5.2, according to dickey@clark.net. echo $ac_n "checking for gethostbyname""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5034: checking for gethostbyname" >&5 +echo "configure:5088: checking for gethostbyname" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5114: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_gethostbyname=yes" else @@ -5077,12 +5131,12 @@ fi if test $ac_cv_func_gethostbyname = no; then echo $ac_n "checking for gethostbyname in -lnsl""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5081: checking for gethostbyname in -lnsl" >&5 +echo "configure:5135: checking for gethostbyname in -lnsl" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo nsl'_'gethostbyname | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lnsl " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5151: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5123,10 +5177,10 @@ fi # -lsocket must be given before -lnsl if both are needed. # We assume that if connect needs -lnsl, so does gethostbyname. echo $ac_n "checking for connect""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5127: checking for connect" >&5 +echo "configure:5181: checking for connect" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5207: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_connect=yes" else @@ -5172,12 +5226,12 @@ fi xe_msg_checking="for connect in -lsocket" test -n "$X_EXTRA_LIBS" && xe_msg_checking="$xe_msg_checking using extra libs $X_EXTRA_LIBS" echo $ac_n "checking "$xe_msg_checking"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5176: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 +echo "configure:5230: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo socket'_'connect | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lsocket $X_EXTRA_LIBS" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5246: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5212,10 +5266,10 @@ fi # gomez@mi.uni-erlangen.de says -lposix is necessary on A/UX. echo $ac_n "checking for remove""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5216: checking for remove" >&5 +echo "configure:5270: checking for remove" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5296: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_remove=yes" else @@ -5259,12 +5313,12 @@ fi if test $ac_cv_func_remove = no; then echo $ac_n "checking for remove in -lposix""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5263: checking for remove in -lposix" >&5 +echo "configure:5317: checking for remove in -lposix" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo posix'_'remove | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lposix " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5333: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5299,10 +5353,10 @@ fi # BSDI BSD/OS 2.1 needs -lipc for XOpenDisplay. echo $ac_n "checking for shmat""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5303: checking for shmat" >&5 +echo "configure:5357: checking for shmat" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5383: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_shmat=yes" else @@ -5346,12 +5400,12 @@ fi if test $ac_cv_func_shmat = no; then echo $ac_n "checking for shmat in -lipc""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5350: checking for shmat in -lipc" >&5 +echo "configure:5404: checking for shmat in -lipc" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo ipc'_'shmat | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lipc " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5420: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5398,12 +5452,12 @@ fi xe_msg_checking="for IceConnectionNumber in -lICE" test -n "$X_EXTRA_LIBS" && xe_msg_checking="$xe_msg_checking using extra libs $X_EXTRA_LIBS" echo $ac_n "checking "$xe_msg_checking"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5402: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 +echo "configure:5456: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo ICE'_'IceConnectionNumber | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lICE $X_EXTRA_LIBS" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5472: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5583,7 +5637,7 @@ EOF echo "checking for X defines extracted by xmkmf" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5587: checking for X defines extracted by xmkmf" >&5 +echo "configure:5641: checking for X defines extracted by xmkmf" >&5 rm -fr conftestdir if mkdir conftestdir; then cd conftestdir @@ -5615,15 +5669,15 @@ EOF ac_safe=`echo "X11/Intrinsic.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for X11/Intrinsic.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5619: checking for X11/Intrinsic.h" >&5 +echo "configure:5673: checking for X11/Intrinsic.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:5627: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:5681: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -5647,12 +5701,12 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for XOpenDisplay in -lX11""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5651: checking for XOpenDisplay in -lX11" >&5 +echo "configure:5705: checking for XOpenDisplay in -lX11" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo X11'_'XOpenDisplay | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lX11 " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5721: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5688,12 +5742,12 @@ fi xe_msg_checking="for XGetFontProperty in -lX11" test -n "-b i486-linuxaout" && xe_msg_checking="$xe_msg_checking using extra libs -b i486-linuxaout" echo $ac_n "checking "$xe_msg_checking"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5692: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 +echo "configure:5746: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo X11'_'XGetFontProperty | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lX11 -b i486-linuxaout" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5762: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5731,12 +5785,12 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for XShapeSelectInput in -lXext""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5735: checking for XShapeSelectInput in -lXext" >&5 +echo "configure:5789: checking for XShapeSelectInput in -lXext" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xext'_'XShapeSelectInput | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXext " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5805: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5770,12 +5824,12 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for XtOpenDisplay in -lXt""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5774: checking for XtOpenDisplay in -lXt" >&5 +echo "configure:5828: checking for XtOpenDisplay in -lXt" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xt'_'XtOpenDisplay | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXt " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5844: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5809,14 +5863,14 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking the version of X11 being used""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5813: checking the version of X11 being used" >&5 +echo "configure:5867: checking the version of X11 being used" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main(int c, char *v[]) { return c>1 ? XlibSpecificationRelease : 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:5820: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:5874: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ./conftest foobar; x11_release=$? else @@ -5841,15 +5895,15 @@ EOF do ac_safe=`echo "$ac_hdr" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_hdr""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5845: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 +echo "configure:5899: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:5853: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:5907: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -5880,7 +5934,7 @@ done echo $ac_n "checking for XFree86""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5884: checking for XFree86" >&5 +echo "configure:5938: checking for XFree86" >&5 if test -d "/usr/X386/include" -o \ -f "/etc/XF86Config" -o \ -f "/etc/X11/XF86Config" -o \ @@ -5900,12 +5954,12 @@ EOF test -z "$with_xmu" && { echo $ac_n "checking for XmuReadBitmapDataFromFile in -lXmu""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5904: checking for XmuReadBitmapDataFromFile in -lXmu" >&5 +echo "configure:5958: checking for XmuReadBitmapDataFromFile in -lXmu" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xmu'_'XmuReadBitmapDataFromFile | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXmu " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:5974: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -5955,19 +6009,19 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking for main in -lXbsd""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:5959: checking for main in -lXbsd" >&5 +echo "configure:6013: checking for main in -lXbsd" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xbsd'_'main | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXbsd " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6025: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6004,22 +6058,22 @@ fi fi if test "$with_msw" != "no"; then echo "checking for MS-Windows" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6008: checking for MS-Windows" >&5 +echo "configure:6062: checking for MS-Windows" >&5 echo $ac_n "checking for main in -lgdi32""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6011: checking for main in -lgdi32" >&5 +echo "configure:6065: checking for main in -lgdi32" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo gdi32'_'main | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lgdi32 " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6077: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6085,12 +6139,12 @@ EOF fi fi cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main() { return (open("/dev/windows", O_RDONLY, 0) > 0)? 0 : 1; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:6094: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:6148: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_MSG_SELECT @@ -6166,7 +6220,7 @@ case "$x_libraries" in *X11R4* ) esac echo "checking for WM_COMMAND option" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6170: checking for WM_COMMAND option" >&5; +echo "configure:6224: checking for WM_COMMAND option" >&5; if test "$with_wmcommand" != "no"; then { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_WMCOMMAND @@ -6181,15 +6235,15 @@ fi test -z "$with_xauth" && test "$window_system" = "none" && with_xauth=no test -z "$with_xauth" && { ac_safe=`echo "X11/Xauth.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for X11/Xauth.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6185: checking for X11/Xauth.h" >&5 +echo "configure:6239: checking for X11/Xauth.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:6193: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:6247: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -6212,12 +6266,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_xauth" && { echo $ac_n "checking for XauGetAuthByAddr in -lXau""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6216: checking for XauGetAuthByAddr in -lXau" >&5 +echo "configure:6270: checking for XauGetAuthByAddr in -lXau" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xau'_'XauGetAuthByAddr | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXau " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6286: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6273,15 +6327,15 @@ if test "$with_tooltalk" != "no" ; then for dir in "" "Tt/" "desktop/" ; do ac_safe=`echo "${dir}tt_c.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for ${dir}tt_c.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6277: checking for ${dir}tt_c.h" >&5 +echo "configure:6331: checking for ${dir}tt_c.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:6285: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:6339: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -6317,12 +6371,12 @@ if test "$with_tooltalk" != "no" ; then xe_msg_checking="for tt_message_create in -ltt" test -n "$extra_libs" && xe_msg_checking="$xe_msg_checking using extra libs $extra_libs" echo $ac_n "checking "$xe_msg_checking"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6321: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 +echo "configure:6375: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo tt'_'tt_message_create | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ltt $extra_libs" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6391: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6390,15 +6444,15 @@ fi test -z "$with_cde" && { ac_safe=`echo "Dt/Dt.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for Dt/Dt.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6394: checking for Dt/Dt.h" >&5 +echo "configure:6448: checking for Dt/Dt.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:6402: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:6456: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -6421,12 +6475,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_cde" && { echo $ac_n "checking for DtDndDragStart in -lDtSvc""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6425: checking for DtDndDragStart in -lDtSvc" >&5 +echo "configure:6479: checking for DtDndDragStart in -lDtSvc" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo DtSvc'_'DtDndDragStart | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lDtSvc " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6495: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6506,7 +6560,7 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking if drag and drop API is needed""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6510: checking if drag and drop API is needed" >&5 +echo "configure:6564: checking if drag and drop API is needed" >&5 if test "$with_dragndrop" != "no" ; then if test -n "$dragndrop_proto" ; then with_dragndrop=yes @@ -6527,18 +6581,18 @@ EOF fi echo "checking for LDAP" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6531: checking for LDAP" >&5 +echo "configure:6585: checking for LDAP" >&5 test -z "$with_ldap" && { ac_safe=`echo "ldap.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for ldap.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6534: checking for ldap.h" >&5 +echo "configure:6588: checking for ldap.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:6542: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:6596: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -6561,15 +6615,15 @@ fi } test -z "$with_ldap" && { ac_safe=`echo "lber.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for lber.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6565: checking for lber.h" >&5 +echo "configure:6619: checking for lber.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:6573: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:6627: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -6593,12 +6647,12 @@ fi if test "$with_ldap" != "no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for ldap_search in -lldap""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6597: checking for ldap_search in -lldap" >&5 +echo "configure:6651: checking for ldap_search in -lldap" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo ldap'_'ldap_search | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lldap " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6667: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6634,12 +6688,12 @@ fi xe_msg_checking="for ldap_open in -lldap" test -n "-llber" && xe_msg_checking="$xe_msg_checking using extra libs -llber" echo $ac_n "checking "$xe_msg_checking"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6638: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 +echo "configure:6692: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo ldap'_'ldap_open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lldap -llber" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6708: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6675,12 +6729,12 @@ fi xe_msg_checking="for ldap_open in -lldap" test -n "-llber -lkrb" && xe_msg_checking="$xe_msg_checking using extra libs -llber -lkrb" echo $ac_n "checking "$xe_msg_checking"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6679: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 +echo "configure:6733: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo ldap'_'ldap_open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lldap -llber -lkrb" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6749: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6716,12 +6770,12 @@ fi xe_msg_checking="for ldap_open in -lldap" test -n "-llber -lkrb -ldes" && xe_msg_checking="$xe_msg_checking using extra libs -llber -lkrb -ldes" echo $ac_n "checking "$xe_msg_checking"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6720: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 +echo "configure:6774: checking "$xe_msg_checking"" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo ldap'_'ldap_open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lldap -llber -lkrb -ldes" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6790: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -6783,10 +6837,10 @@ EOF for ac_func in ldap_set_option ldap_get_lderrno ldap_result2error ldap_parse_result do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6787: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:6841: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6867: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -6841,15 +6895,15 @@ fi if test "$window_system" != "none"; then echo "checking for graphics libraries" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6845: checking for graphics libraries" >&5 +echo "configure:6899: checking for graphics libraries" >&5 xpm_problem="" if test -z "$with_xpm"; then echo $ac_n "checking for Xpm - no older than 3.4f""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6850: checking for Xpm - no older than 3.4f" >&5 +echo "configure:6904: checking for Xpm - no older than 3.4f" >&5 xe_check_libs=-lXpm cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main(int c, char **v) { @@ -6857,7 +6911,7 @@ echo "configure:6850: checking for Xpm - no older than 3.4f" >&5 XpmIncludeVersion != XpmLibraryVersion() ? 1 : XpmIncludeVersion < 30406 ? 2 : 0 ;} EOF -if { (eval echo configure:6861: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:6915: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ./conftest dummy_arg; xpm_status=$?; if test "$xpm_status" = "0"; then @@ -6899,17 +6953,17 @@ EOF libs_x="-lXpm $libs_x" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " Prepending \"-lXpm\" to \$libs_x"; fi echo $ac_n "checking for \"FOR_MSW\" xpm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6903: checking for \"FOR_MSW\" xpm" >&5 +echo "configure:6957: checking for \"FOR_MSW\" xpm" >&5 xe_check_libs=-lXpm cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:6967: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* xpm_for_msw=no else @@ -6935,15 +6989,15 @@ EOF test -z "$with_xface" && { ac_safe=`echo "compface.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for compface.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6939: checking for compface.h" >&5 +echo "configure:6993: checking for compface.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:6947: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:7001: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -6966,12 +7020,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_xface" && { echo $ac_n "checking for UnGenFace in -lcompface""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:6970: checking for UnGenFace in -lcompface" >&5 +echo "configure:7024: checking for UnGenFace in -lcompface" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo compface'_'UnGenFace | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lcompface " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7040: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7034,12 +7088,12 @@ EOF if test "$with_png $with_tiff" != "no no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for inflate in -lc""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7038: checking for inflate in -lc" >&5 +echo "configure:7092: checking for inflate in -lc" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo c'_'inflate | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lc " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7108: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7069,12 +7123,12 @@ else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for inflate in -lz""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7073: checking for inflate in -lz" >&5 +echo "configure:7127: checking for inflate in -lz" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo z'_'inflate | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lz " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7143: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7104,12 +7158,12 @@ else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for inflate in -lgz""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7108: checking for inflate in -lgz" >&5 +echo "configure:7162: checking for inflate in -lgz" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo gz'_'inflate | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lgz " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7178: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7150,15 +7204,15 @@ fi test -z "$with_jpeg" && { ac_safe=`echo "jpeglib.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for jpeglib.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7154: checking for jpeglib.h" >&5 +echo "configure:7208: checking for jpeglib.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:7162: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:7216: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -7181,12 +7235,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_jpeg" && { echo $ac_n "checking for jpeg_destroy_decompress in -ljpeg""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7185: checking for jpeg_destroy_decompress in -ljpeg" >&5 +echo "configure:7239: checking for jpeg_destroy_decompress in -ljpeg" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo jpeg'_'jpeg_destroy_decompress | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ljpeg " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7255: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7233,10 +7287,10 @@ EOF png_problem="" test -z "$with_png" && { echo $ac_n "checking for pow""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7237: checking for pow" >&5 +echo "configure:7291: checking for pow" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7317: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_pow=yes" else @@ -7280,15 +7334,15 @@ fi } test -z "$with_png" && { ac_safe=`echo "png.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for png.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7284: checking for png.h" >&5 +echo "configure:7338: checking for png.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:7292: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:7346: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -7311,12 +7365,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_png" && { echo $ac_n "checking for png_read_image in -lpng""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7315: checking for png_read_image in -lpng" >&5 +echo "configure:7369: checking for png_read_image in -lpng" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo png'_'png_read_image | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lpng " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7385: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7350,10 +7404,10 @@ fi } if test -z "$with_png"; then echo $ac_n "checking for workable png version information""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7354: checking for workable png version information" >&5 +echo "configure:7408: checking for workable png version information" >&5 xe_check_libs="-lpng -lz" cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main(int c, char **v) { @@ -7361,7 +7415,7 @@ echo "configure:7354: checking for workable png version information" >&5 if (strcmp(png_libpng_ver, PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING) != 0) return 1; return (PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10002) ? 2 : 0 ;} EOF -if { (eval echo configure:7365: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:7419: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ./conftest dummy_arg; png_status=$?; if test "$png_status" = "0"; then @@ -7404,15 +7458,15 @@ EOF test -z "$with_tiff" && { ac_safe=`echo "tiffio.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for tiffio.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7408: checking for tiffio.h" >&5 +echo "configure:7462: checking for tiffio.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:7416: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:7470: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -7435,12 +7489,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_tiff" && { echo $ac_n "checking for TIFFClientOpen in -ltiff""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7439: checking for TIFFClientOpen in -ltiff" >&5 +echo "configure:7493: checking for TIFFClientOpen in -ltiff" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo tiff'_'TIFFClientOpen | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ltiff " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7509: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7490,16 +7544,16 @@ fi if test "$with_x11" = "yes"; then echo "checking for X11 graphics libraries" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7494: checking for X11 graphics libraries" >&5 +echo "configure:7548: checking for X11 graphics libraries" >&5 echo $ac_n "checking for XawScrollbarSetThumb in -lXaw""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7498: checking for XawScrollbarSetThumb in -lXaw" >&5 +echo "configure:7552: checking for XawScrollbarSetThumb in -lXaw" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xaw'_'XawScrollbarSetThumb | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXaw " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7568: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7534,12 +7588,12 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for XawScrollbarSetThumb in -lXaw3d""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7538: checking for XawScrollbarSetThumb in -lXaw3d" >&5 +echo "configure:7592: checking for XawScrollbarSetThumb in -lXaw3d" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xaw3d'_'XawScrollbarSetThumb | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXaw3d " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7608: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7574,15 +7628,15 @@ fi ac_safe=`echo "Xm/Xm.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for Xm/Xm.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7578: checking for Xm/Xm.h" >&5 +echo "configure:7632: checking for Xm/Xm.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:7586: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:7640: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -7599,12 +7653,12 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_header_'$ac_safe`\" = yes"; then echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for XmStringFree in -lXm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7603: checking for XmStringFree in -lXm" >&5 +echo "configure:7657: checking for XmStringFree in -lXm" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xm'_'XmStringFree | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXm " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:7673: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -7644,9 +7698,9 @@ fi if test "$have_motif" = "yes"; then echo $ac_n "checking for Lesstif""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7648: checking for Lesstif" >&5 +echo "configure:7702: checking for Lesstif" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #ifdef LESSTIF_VERSION @@ -7951,7 +8005,7 @@ if test "$with_x11" = "yes"; then echo " xemacs will be linked with \"gui-x.o\"" fi else - if test \( "$with_sound" = "nas" \) -o \( "$with_sound" = "both" \); then + if test "$with_nas_sound" = "nas"; then echo "Attempt to Build NAS sound without X" echo "Please remove NAS configuration or build with X" exit 1 @@ -7979,7 +8033,7 @@ fi if test "$with_mule" = "yes" ; then echo "checking for Mule-related features" 1>&6 -echo "configure:7983: checking for Mule-related features" >&5 +echo "configure:8037: checking for Mule-related features" >&5 { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining MULE EOF @@ -8004,15 +8058,15 @@ EOF do ac_safe=`echo "$ac_hdr" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_hdr""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8008: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 +echo "configure:8062: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:8016: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:8070: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -8043,12 +8097,12 @@ done echo $ac_n "checking for strerror in -lintl""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8047: checking for strerror in -lintl" >&5 +echo "configure:8101: checking for strerror in -lintl" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo intl'_'strerror | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lintl " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8117: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8092,18 +8146,18 @@ fi echo "checking for Mule input methods" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8096: checking for Mule input methods" >&5 +echo "configure:8150: checking for Mule input methods" >&5 case "$with_xim" in "" | "yes" ) echo "checking for XIM" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8099: checking for XIM" >&5 +echo "configure:8153: checking for XIM" >&5 echo $ac_n "checking for XOpenIM in -lX11""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8102: checking for XOpenIM in -lX11" >&5 +echo "configure:8156: checking for XOpenIM in -lX11" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo X11'_'XOpenIM | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lX11 " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8172: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8138,12 +8192,12 @@ fi if test "$have_motif $have_lesstif" = "yes no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for XmImMbLookupString in -lXm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8142: checking for XmImMbLookupString in -lXm" >&5 +echo "configure:8196: checking for XmImMbLookupString in -lXm" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Xm'_'XmImMbLookupString | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lXm " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8212: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8219,15 +8273,15 @@ EOF if test "$with_xfs" = "yes" ; then echo "checking for XFontSet" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8223: checking for XFontSet" >&5 +echo "configure:8277: checking for XFontSet" >&5 echo $ac_n "checking for XmbDrawString in -lX11""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8226: checking for XmbDrawString in -lX11" >&5 +echo "configure:8280: checking for XmbDrawString in -lX11" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo X11'_'XmbDrawString | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lX11 " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8296: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8278,15 +8332,15 @@ EOF test "$with_wnn6" = "yes" && with_wnn=yes # wnn6 implies wnn support test -z "$with_wnn" && { ac_safe=`echo "wnn/jllib.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for wnn/jllib.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8282: checking for wnn/jllib.h" >&5 +echo "configure:8336: checking for wnn/jllib.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:8290: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:8344: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -8311,10 +8365,10 @@ fi for ac_func in crypt do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8315: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:8369: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8395: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -8366,12 +8420,12 @@ done test "$ac_cv_func_crypt" != "yes" && { echo $ac_n "checking for crypt in -lcrypt""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8370: checking for crypt in -lcrypt" >&5 +echo "configure:8424: checking for crypt in -lcrypt" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo crypt'_'crypt | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lcrypt " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8440: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8417,12 +8471,12 @@ fi if test -z "$with_wnn" -o "$with_wnn" = "yes"; then echo $ac_n "checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8421: checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn" >&5 +echo "configure:8475: checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo wnn'_'jl_dic_list_e | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lwnn " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8491: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8451,12 +8505,12 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_lib_'$ac_lib_var`\" = yes" ; then else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn4""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8455: checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn4" >&5 +echo "configure:8509: checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn4" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo wnn4'_'jl_dic_list_e | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lwnn4 " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8525: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8485,12 +8539,12 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_lib_'$ac_lib_var`\" = yes" ; then else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn6""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8489: checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn6" >&5 +echo "configure:8543: checking for jl_dic_list_e in -lwnn6" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo wnn6'_'jl_dic_list_e | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lwnn6 " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8559: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8519,12 +8573,12 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_lib_'$ac_lib_var`\" = yes" ; then else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for dic_list_e in -lwnn6_fromsrc""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8523: checking for dic_list_e in -lwnn6_fromsrc" >&5 +echo "configure:8577: checking for dic_list_e in -lwnn6_fromsrc" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo wnn6_fromsrc'_'dic_list_e | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lwnn6_fromsrc " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8593: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8583,12 +8637,12 @@ EOF if test "$with_wnn6" != "no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for jl_fi_dic_list in -l$libwnn""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8587: checking for jl_fi_dic_list in -l$libwnn" >&5 +echo "configure:8641: checking for jl_fi_dic_list in -l$libwnn" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo $libwnn'_'jl_fi_dic_list | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -l$libwnn " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8657: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8634,15 +8688,15 @@ EOF if test "$with_canna" != "no"; then ac_safe=`echo "canna/jrkanji.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for canna/jrkanji.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8638: checking for canna/jrkanji.h" >&5 +echo "configure:8692: checking for canna/jrkanji.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:8646: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:8700: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -8669,15 +8723,15 @@ fi c_switch_site="$c_switch_site -I/usr/local/canna/include" ac_safe=`echo "canna/jrkanji.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for canna/jrkanji.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8673: checking for canna/jrkanji.h" >&5 +echo "configure:8727: checking for canna/jrkanji.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:8681: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:8735: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -8705,15 +8759,15 @@ fi test -z "$with_canna" && { ac_safe=`echo "canna/RK.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for canna/RK.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8709: checking for canna/RK.h" >&5 +echo "configure:8763: checking for canna/RK.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:8717: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:8771: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -8736,12 +8790,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_canna" && { echo $ac_n "checking for RkBgnBun in -lRKC""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8740: checking for RkBgnBun in -lRKC" >&5 +echo "configure:8794: checking for RkBgnBun in -lRKC" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo RKC'_'RkBgnBun | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lRKC " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8810: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8775,12 +8829,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_canna" && { echo $ac_n "checking for jrKanjiControl in -lcanna""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8779: checking for jrKanjiControl in -lcanna" >&5 +echo "configure:8833: checking for jrKanjiControl in -lcanna" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo canna'_'jrKanjiControl | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lcanna " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8849: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8840,12 +8894,12 @@ if test "$need_motif" = "yes" ; then libs_x="-lXm $libs_x" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " Prepending \"-lXm\" to \$libs_x"; fi echo $ac_n "checking for layout_object_getvalue in -li18n""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8844: checking for layout_object_getvalue in -li18n" >&5 +echo "configure:8898: checking for layout_object_getvalue in -li18n" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo i18n'_'layout_object_getvalue | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -li18n " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:8914: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -8942,10 +8996,10 @@ fi for ac_func in cbrt closedir dup2 eaccess fmod fpathconf frexp ftime gethostname getpagesize gettimeofday getcwd getpt getwd logb lrand48 matherr mkdir mktime perror poll random rename res_init rint rmdir select setitimer setpgid setlocale setsid sigblock sighold sigprocmask snprintf stpcpy strcasecmp strerror tzset ulimit usleep utimes waitpid vsnprintf do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:8946: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:9000: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9026: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -9009,10 +9063,10 @@ case "$opsys" in * ) for ac_func in realpath do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9013: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:9067: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9093: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -9071,10 +9125,10 @@ esac for ac_func in getloadavg do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9075: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:9129: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9155: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -9133,12 +9187,12 @@ then echo $ac_n "checking for kstat_open in -lkstat""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9137: checking for kstat_open in -lkstat" >&5 +echo "configure:9191: checking for kstat_open in -lkstat" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo kstat'_'kstat_open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lkstat " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9207: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -9183,12 +9237,12 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for kvm_read in -lkvm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9187: checking for kvm_read in -lkvm" >&5 +echo "configure:9241: checking for kvm_read in -lkvm" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo kvm'_'kvm_read | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lkvm " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9257: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -9233,16 +9287,16 @@ fi fi echo $ac_n "checking whether netdb declares h_errno""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9237: checking whether netdb declares h_errno" >&5 +echo "configure:9291: checking whether netdb declares h_errno" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main() { return h_errno; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:9246: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9300: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF @@ -9262,16 +9316,16 @@ fi rm -f conftest* echo $ac_n "checking for sigsetjmp""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9266: checking for sigsetjmp" >&5 +echo "configure:9320: checking for sigsetjmp" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main() { sigjmp_buf bar; sigsetjmp (bar, 0); ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:9275: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:9329: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF @@ -9291,11 +9345,11 @@ fi rm -f conftest* echo $ac_n "checking whether localtime caches TZ""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9295: checking whether localtime caches TZ" >&5 +echo "configure:9349: checking whether localtime caches TZ" >&5 if test "$ac_cv_func_tzset" = "yes"; then cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #if STDC_HEADERS @@ -9330,7 +9384,7 @@ main() exit (0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:9334: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:9388: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then emacs_cv_localtime_cache=no else @@ -9360,9 +9414,9 @@ fi if test "$HAVE_TIMEVAL" = "yes"; then echo $ac_n "checking whether gettimeofday accepts one or two arguments""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9364: checking whether gettimeofday accepts one or two arguments" >&5 +echo "configure:9418: checking whether gettimeofday accepts one or two arguments" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9442: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""two" 1>&6 else @@ -9406,19 +9460,19 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for inline""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9410: checking for inline" >&5 +echo "configure:9464: checking for inline" >&5 ac_cv_c_inline=no for ac_kw in inline __inline__ __inline; do cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:9476: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_c_inline=$ac_kw; break else @@ -9468,17 +9522,17 @@ fi # The Ultrix 4.2 mips builtin alloca declared by alloca.h only works # for constant arguments. Useless! echo $ac_n "checking for working alloca.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9472: checking for working alloca.h" >&5 +echo "configure:9526: checking for working alloca.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < int main() { char *p = alloca(2 * sizeof(int)); ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:9482: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9536: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_header_alloca_h=yes else @@ -9502,10 +9556,10 @@ EOF fi echo $ac_n "checking for alloca""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9506: checking for alloca" >&5 +echo "configure:9560: checking for alloca" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9591: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* ac_cv_func_alloca_works=yes else @@ -9572,10 +9626,10 @@ EOF echo $ac_n "checking whether alloca needs Cray hooks""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9576: checking whether alloca needs Cray hooks" >&5 +echo "configure:9630: checking whether alloca needs Cray hooks" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&6 if test $ac_cv_os_cray = yes; then for ac_func in _getb67 GETB67 getb67; do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9603: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:9657: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9683: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -9655,10 +9709,10 @@ done fi echo $ac_n "checking stack direction for C alloca""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9659: checking stack direction for C alloca" >&5 +echo "configure:9713: checking stack direction for C alloca" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:9735: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_c_stack_direction=1 else @@ -9706,15 +9760,15 @@ test -n "$ALLOCA" && extra_objs="$extra_objs $ALLOCA" && if test "$extra_verbos ac_safe=`echo "vfork.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for vfork.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9710: checking for vfork.h" >&5 +echo "configure:9764: checking for vfork.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:9718: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:9772: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -9742,10 +9796,10 @@ else fi echo $ac_n "checking for working vfork""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9746: checking for working vfork" >&5 +echo "configure:9800: checking for working vfork" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < @@ -9840,7 +9894,7 @@ main() { } } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:9844: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:9898: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_func_vfork_works=yes else @@ -9866,10 +9920,10 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for working strcoll""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9870: checking for working strcoll" >&5 +echo "configure:9924: checking for working strcoll" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < main () @@ -9879,7 +9933,7 @@ main () strcoll ("123", "456") >= 0); } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:9883: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:9937: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_func_strcoll_works=yes else @@ -9907,10 +9961,10 @@ fi for ac_func in getpgrp do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9911: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:9965: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:9991: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -9961,10 +10015,10 @@ fi done echo $ac_n "checking whether getpgrp takes no argument""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:9965: checking whether getpgrp takes no argument" >&5 +echo "configure:10019: checking whether getpgrp takes no argument" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:10077: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then ac_cv_func_getpgrp_void=yes else @@ -10046,10 +10100,10 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for working mmap""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10050: checking for working mmap" >&5 +echo "configure:10104: checking for working mmap" >&5 case "$opsys" in ultrix* ) have_mmap=no ;; *) cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #include @@ -10082,7 +10136,7 @@ int main (int argc, char *argv[]) return 1; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:10086: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:10140: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then have_mmap=yes else @@ -10117,15 +10171,15 @@ EOF ac_safe=`echo "termios.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for termios.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10121: checking for termios.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10175: checking for termios.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10129: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10183: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10168,15 +10222,15 @@ else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 ac_safe=`echo "termio.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for termio.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10172: checking for termio.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10226: checking for termio.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10180: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10234: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10208,10 +10262,10 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for socket""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10212: checking for socket" >&5 +echo "configure:10266: checking for socket" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:10292: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_socket=yes" else @@ -10249,15 +10303,15 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_func_'socket`\" = yes"; then echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 ac_safe=`echo "netinet/in.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for netinet/in.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10253: checking for netinet/in.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10307: checking for netinet/in.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10261: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10315: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10274,15 +10328,15 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_header_'$ac_safe`\" = yes"; then echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 ac_safe=`echo "arpa/inet.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for arpa/inet.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10278: checking for arpa/inet.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10332: checking for arpa/inet.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10286: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10340: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10307,9 +10361,9 @@ EOF } echo $ac_n "checking "for sun_len member in struct sockaddr_un"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10311: checking "for sun_len member in struct sockaddr_un"" >&5 +echo "configure:10365: checking "for sun_len member in struct sockaddr_un"" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < @@ -10320,7 +10374,7 @@ int main() { static struct sockaddr_un x; x.sun_len = 1; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:10324: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:10378: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6; { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_SOCKADDR_SUN_LEN @@ -10338,9 +10392,9 @@ else fi rm -f conftest* echo $ac_n "checking "for ip_mreq struct in netinet/in.h"""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10342: checking "for ip_mreq struct in netinet/in.h"" >&5 +echo "configure:10396: checking "for ip_mreq struct in netinet/in.h"" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < @@ -10350,7 +10404,7 @@ int main() { static struct ip_mreq x; ; return 0; } EOF -if { (eval echo configure:10354: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:10408: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6; { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_MULTICAST @@ -10381,10 +10435,10 @@ fi echo $ac_n "checking for msgget""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10385: checking for msgget" >&5 +echo "configure:10439: checking for msgget" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:10465: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_msgget=yes" else @@ -10422,15 +10476,15 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_func_'msgget`\" = yes"; then echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 ac_safe=`echo "sys/ipc.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for sys/ipc.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10426: checking for sys/ipc.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10480: checking for sys/ipc.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10434: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10488: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10447,15 +10501,15 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_header_'$ac_safe`\" = yes"; then echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 ac_safe=`echo "sys/msg.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for sys/msg.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10451: checking for sys/msg.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10505: checking for sys/msg.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10459: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10513: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10493,15 +10547,15 @@ fi ac_safe=`echo "dirent.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for dirent.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10497: checking for dirent.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10551: checking for dirent.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10505: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10559: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10528,15 +10582,15 @@ else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 ac_safe=`echo "sys/dir.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for sys/dir.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10532: checking for sys/dir.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10586: checking for sys/dir.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10540: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10594: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10569,15 +10623,15 @@ fi ac_safe=`echo "nlist.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for nlist.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10573: checking for nlist.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10627: checking for nlist.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10581: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10635: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10607,26 +10661,22 @@ fi echo "checking "for sound support"" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10611: checking "for sound support"" >&5 -case "$with_sound" in - native | both ) with_native_sound=yes;; - nas | no ) with_native_sound=no;; -esac +echo "configure:10665: checking "for sound support"" >&5 test -z "$with_native_sound" -a -n "$native_sound_lib" && with_native_sound=yes if test "$with_native_sound" != "no"; then if test -n "$native_sound_lib"; then ac_safe=`echo "multimedia/audio_device.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for multimedia/audio_device.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10622: checking for multimedia/audio_device.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10672: checking for multimedia/audio_device.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10630: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10680: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10674,12 +10724,12 @@ fi if test -z "$native_sound_lib"; then echo $ac_n "checking for ALopenport in -laudio""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10678: checking for ALopenport in -laudio" >&5 +echo "configure:10728: checking for ALopenport in -laudio" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo audio'_'ALopenport | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -laudio " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:10744: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -10721,12 +10771,12 @@ fi if test -z "$native_sound_lib"; then echo $ac_n "checking for AOpenAudio in -lAlib""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10725: checking for AOpenAudio in -lAlib" >&5 +echo "configure:10775: checking for AOpenAudio in -lAlib" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo Alib'_'AOpenAudio | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lAlib " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:10791: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -10775,15 +10825,15 @@ fi for dir in "machine" "sys" "linux"; do ac_safe=`echo "${dir}/soundcard.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for ${dir}/soundcard.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10779: checking for ${dir}/soundcard.h" >&5 +echo "configure:10829: checking for ${dir}/soundcard.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10787: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:10837: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10799,6 +10849,7 @@ rm -f conftest* if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_header_'$ac_safe`\" = yes"; then echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 sound_found=yes + need_miscplay=yes extra_objs="$extra_objs linuxplay.o" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " xemacs will be linked with \"linuxplay.o\"" fi @@ -10821,12 +10872,6 @@ fi test "$sound_found" = "yes" && with_native_sound=yes fi -if test -z "$with_sound"; then - if test "$with_native_sound" = "yes" -o -n "$native_sound_lib"; then - with_sound=native - fi -fi - if test "$with_native_sound" = "yes"; then { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_NATIVE_SOUND @@ -10839,7 +10884,7 @@ EOF test -n "$native_sound_lib" && LIBS="$native_sound_lib $LIBS" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " Prepending \"$native_sound_lib\" to \$LIBS"; fi fi -case "$with_sound" in both | nas ) +if test "$with_nas_sound" = "yes"; then { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_NAS_SOUND EOF @@ -10853,7 +10898,7 @@ EOF fi libs_x="-laudio $libs_x" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " Prepending \"-laudio\" to \$libs_x"; fi cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF @@ -10873,14 +10918,72 @@ EOF fi rm -f conftest* -esac +fi + +# Extract the first word of "esd-config", so it can be a program name with args. +set dummy esd-config; ac_word=$2 +echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6 +echo "configure:10927: checking for $ac_word" >&5 + +if test -n "$have_esd_config"; then + ac_cv_prog_have_esd_config="$have_esd_config" # Let the user override the test. +else + IFS="${IFS= }"; ac_save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS=":" + ac_dummy="$PATH" + for ac_dir in $ac_dummy; do + test -z "$ac_dir" && ac_dir=. + if test -f $ac_dir/$ac_word; then + ac_cv_prog_have_esd_config="yes" + break + fi + done + IFS="$ac_save_ifs" + test -z "$ac_cv_prog_have_esd_config" && ac_cv_prog_have_esd_config="no" +fi +have_esd_config="$ac_cv_prog_have_esd_config" +if test -n "$have_esd_config"; then + echo "$ac_t""$have_esd_config" 1>&6 +else + echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 +fi + +if test -z "$with_esd"; then + with_esd=$have_esd_config +fi + +if test "$with_esd" = "yes"; then + if test "$have_esd_config" = "no"; then + echo "*** esd-config was not found in your PATH. Disabling esd support." + with_esd=no + else + { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF + Defining HAVE_ESD_SOUND +EOF +cat >> confdefs.h <<\EOF +#define HAVE_ESD_SOUND 1 +EOF +} + + need_miscplay=yes + extra_objs="$extra_objs esd.o" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then + echo " xemacs will be linked with \"esd.o\"" + fi + libs_x="`esd-config --libs` $libs_x" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " Prepending \"`esd-config --libs`\" to \$libs_x"; fi + fi +fi + +if test "$need_miscplay" = "yes"; then + extra_objs="$extra_objs miscplay.o" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then + echo " xemacs will be linked with \"miscplay.o\"" + fi +fi test -z "$with_tty" && with_tty=yes if test "$with_tty" = "yes" ; then echo "checking for TTY-related features" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10884: checking for TTY-related features" >&5 +echo "configure:10987: checking for TTY-related features" >&5 { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_TTY EOF @@ -10896,12 +10999,12 @@ EOF if test -z "$with_ncurses"; then echo $ac_n "checking for tgetent in -lncurses""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10900: checking for tgetent in -lncurses" >&5 +echo "configure:11003: checking for tgetent in -lncurses" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo ncurses'_'tgetent | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lncurses " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11019: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -10945,15 +11048,15 @@ EOF ac_safe=`echo "ncurses/curses.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for ncurses/curses.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10949: checking for ncurses/curses.h" >&5 +echo "configure:11052: checking for ncurses/curses.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10957: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:11060: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -10975,15 +11078,15 @@ fi ac_safe=`echo "ncurses/term.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for ncurses/term.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:10979: checking for ncurses/term.h" >&5 +echo "configure:11082: checking for ncurses/term.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:10987: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:11090: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -11013,15 +11116,15 @@ fi c_switch_site="$c_switch_site -I/usr/include/ncurses" ac_safe=`echo "ncurses/curses.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for ncurses/curses.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11017: checking for ncurses/curses.h" >&5 +echo "configure:11120: checking for ncurses/curses.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:11025: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:11128: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -11056,12 +11159,12 @@ fi for lib in curses termlib termcap; do echo $ac_n "checking for tgetent in -l$lib""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11060: checking for tgetent in -l$lib" >&5 +echo "configure:11163: checking for tgetent in -l$lib" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo $lib'_'tgetent | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -l$lib " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11179: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11103,12 +11206,12 @@ fi else echo $ac_n "checking for tgetent in -lcurses""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11107: checking for tgetent in -lcurses" >&5 +echo "configure:11210: checking for tgetent in -lcurses" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo curses'_'tgetent | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lcurses " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11226: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11137,12 +11240,12 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_lib_'$ac_lib_var`\" = yes" ; then else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 echo $ac_n "checking for tgetent in -ltermcap""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11141: checking for tgetent in -ltermcap" >&5 +echo "configure:11244: checking for tgetent in -ltermcap" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo termcap'_'tgetent | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ltermcap " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11260: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11201,15 +11304,15 @@ EOF test -z "$with_gpm" && { ac_safe=`echo "gpm.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for gpm.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11205: checking for gpm.h" >&5 +echo "configure:11308: checking for gpm.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:11213: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:11316: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -11232,12 +11335,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_gpm" && { echo $ac_n "checking for Gpm_Open in -lgpm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11236: checking for Gpm_Open in -lgpm" >&5 +echo "configure:11339: checking for Gpm_Open in -lgpm" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo gpm'_'Gpm_Open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lgpm " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11355: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11296,22 +11399,22 @@ test "$with_x11" = "yes" -o "$with_tty" = "yes" && extra_objs="$extra_objs event fi -test "$with_database_gnudbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ +test "$with_database_gdbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ != "no no no" && echo "checking for database support" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11302: checking for database support" >&5 +echo "configure:11405: checking for database support" >&5 -if test "$with_database_gnudbm $with_database_dbm" != "no no"; then +if test "$with_database_gdbm $with_database_dbm" != "no no"; then ac_safe=`echo "ndbm.h" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for ndbm.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11307: checking for ndbm.h" >&5 +echo "configure:11410: checking for ndbm.h" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:11315: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:11418: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -11330,23 +11433,23 @@ if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_header_'$ac_safe`\" = yes"; then else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 - test "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes" -o \ - "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ + test "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes" -o \ + "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ { echo "Error:" "Required DBM support cannot be provided." >&2; exit 1; } - with_database_gnudbm=no with_database_dbm=no + with_database_gdbm=no with_database_dbm=no fi fi -if test "$with_database_gnudbm" != "no"; then +if test "$with_database_gdbm" != "no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for dbm_open in -lgdbm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11345: checking for dbm_open in -lgdbm" >&5 +echo "configure:11448: checking for dbm_open in -lgdbm" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo gdbm'_'dbm_open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lgdbm " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11464: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11371,13 +11474,13 @@ xe_check_libs="" if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_lib_'$ac_lib_var`\" = yes" ; then echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6 - with_database_gnudbm=yes with_database_dbm=no libdbm=-lgdbm + with_database_gdbm=yes with_database_dbm=no libdbm=-lgdbm else echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6 -if test "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes"; then +if test "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes"; then { echo "Error:" "Required GNU DBM support cannot be provided." >&2; exit 1; } fi - with_database_gnudbm=no + with_database_gdbm=no fi @@ -11385,10 +11488,10 @@ fi if test "$with_database_dbm" != "no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for dbm_open""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11389: checking for dbm_open" >&5 +echo "configure:11492: checking for dbm_open" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11518: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_dbm_open=yes" else @@ -11430,12 +11533,12 @@ else echo $ac_n "checking for dbm_open in -ldbm""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11434: checking for dbm_open in -ldbm" >&5 +echo "configure:11537: checking for dbm_open in -ldbm" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo dbm'_'dbm_open | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ldbm " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11553: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11474,8 +11577,8 @@ fi fi test -n "$libdbm" && LIBS=""$libdbm" $LIBS" && if test "$extra_verbose" = "yes"; then echo " Prepending \""$libdbm"\" to \$LIBS"; fi -test "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes" -o \ - "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ +test "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes" -o \ + "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_DBM EOF @@ -11487,10 +11590,10 @@ EOF if test "$with_database_berkdb" != "no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for Berkeley db.h""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11491: checking for Berkeley db.h" >&5 +echo "configure:11594: checking for Berkeley db.h" >&5 for path in "db/db.h" "db.h"; do cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:11615: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* db_h_path="$path"; break else @@ -11524,9 +11627,9 @@ rm -f conftest* if test "$with_database_berkdb" != "no"; then echo $ac_n "checking for Berkeley DB version""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11528: checking for Berkeley DB version" >&5 +echo "configure:11631: checking for Berkeley DB version" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < #if DB_VERSION_MAJOR > 1 @@ -11545,10 +11648,10 @@ fi rm -f conftest* echo $ac_n "checking for $dbfunc""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11549: checking for $dbfunc" >&5 +echo "configure:11652: checking for $dbfunc" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11678: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$dbfunc=yes" else @@ -11590,12 +11693,12 @@ else echo $ac_n "checking for $dbfunc in -ldb""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11594: checking for $dbfunc in -ldb" >&5 +echo "configure:11697: checking for $dbfunc in -ldb" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo db'_'$dbfunc | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ldb " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11713: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11652,7 +11755,7 @@ EOF fi fi -if test "$with_database_gnudbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ +if test "$with_database_gdbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ != "no no no"; then { test "$extra_verbose" = "yes" && cat << \EOF Defining HAVE_DATABASE @@ -11670,12 +11773,12 @@ fi if test "$with_socks" = "yes"; then echo $ac_n "checking for SOCKSinit in -lsocks""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11674: checking for SOCKSinit in -lsocks" >&5 +echo "configure:11777: checking for SOCKSinit in -lsocks" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo socks'_'SOCKSinit | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lsocks " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11793: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11743,15 +11846,15 @@ for ac_hdr in dlfcn.h do ac_safe=`echo "$ac_hdr" | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_hdr""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11747: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 +echo "configure:11850: checking for $ac_hdr" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext < EOF ac_try="$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out" -{ (eval echo configure:11755: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } +{ (eval echo configure:11858: \"$ac_try\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_try) 2>&5; } ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out | grep -v "^conftest.${ac_ext}\$"` if test -z "$ac_err"; then rm -rf conftest* @@ -11790,12 +11893,12 @@ done test -z "$with_modules" && test ! -z "$have_dlfcn" && { echo $ac_n "checking for dlopen in -ldl""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11794: checking for dlopen in -ldl" >&5 +echo "configure:11897: checking for dlopen in -ldl" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo dl'_'dlopen | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ldl " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11913: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11835,12 +11938,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_modules" && test ! -z "$have_dlfcn" && { echo $ac_n "checking for _dlopen in -lc""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11839: checking for _dlopen in -lc" >&5 +echo "configure:11942: checking for _dlopen in -lc" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo c'_'_dlopen | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lc " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:11958: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11880,12 +11983,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_modules" && test ! -z "$have_dlfcn" && { echo $ac_n "checking for dlopen in -lc""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11884: checking for dlopen in -lc" >&5 +echo "configure:11987: checking for dlopen in -lc" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo c'_'dlopen | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -lc " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:12003: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11925,12 +12028,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_modules" && { echo $ac_n "checking for shl_load in -ldld""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11929: checking for shl_load in -ldld" >&5 +echo "configure:12032: checking for shl_load in -ldld" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo dld'_'shl_load | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ldld " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:12048: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -11970,12 +12073,12 @@ fi } test -z "$with_modules" && { echo $ac_n "checking for dld_init in -ldld""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:11974: checking for dld_init in -ldld" >&5 +echo "configure:12077: checking for dld_init in -ldld" >&5 ac_lib_var=`echo dld'_'dld_init | sed 'y%./+-%__p_%'` xe_check_libs=" -ldld " cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:12093: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_lib_$ac_lib_var=yes" else @@ -12025,7 +12128,7 @@ xehost=$canonical xealias=$internal_configuration echo "checking how to build dynamic libraries for ${xehost}" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12029: checking how to build dynamic libraries for ${xehost}" >&5 +echo "configure:12132: checking how to build dynamic libraries for ${xehost}" >&5 # Transform *-*-linux* to *-*-linux-gnu*, to support old configure scripts. case "$xehost" in *-*-linux-gnu*) ;; @@ -12053,9 +12156,9 @@ if test "$GCC" = "yes"; then XEGCC=yes else echo $ac_n "checking checking whether we are using GNU C""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12057: checking checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 +echo "configure:12160: checking checking whether we are using GNU C" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&6 -echo "configure:12081: checking how to produce PIC code" >&5 +echo "configure:12184: checking how to produce PIC code" >&5 wl= can_build_shared=yes @@ -12170,18 +12273,18 @@ if test -n "$dll_cflags"; then # Check to make sure the dll_cflags actually works. echo $ac_n "checking if PIC flag ${dll_cflags} really works""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12174: checking if PIC flag ${dll_cflags} really works" >&5 +echo "configure:12277: checking if PIC flag ${dll_cflags} really works" >&5 save_CFLAGS="$CFLAGS" CFLAGS="$CFLAGS $dll_cflags -DPIC" cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then +if { (eval echo configure:12288: \"$ac_compile\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_compile) 2>&5; }; then rm -rf conftest* # On HP-UX, the stripped-down bundled CC doesn't accept +Z, but also @@ -12212,7 +12315,7 @@ cc_produces_so=no xldf= xcldf= echo $ac_n "checking if C compiler can produce shared libraries""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12216: checking if C compiler can produce shared libraries" >&5 +echo "configure:12319: checking if C compiler can produce shared libraries" >&5 if test "$XEGCC" = yes; then xcldf="-shared" xldf="-shared" @@ -12263,14 +12366,14 @@ if test -n "$xcldf"; then xe_libs= ac_link='${CC-cc} -o conftest $CFLAGS '"$xe_cppflags $xe_ldflags"' conftest.$ac_ext '"$xe_libs"' 1>&5' cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:12377: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* cc_produces_so=yes else @@ -12295,7 +12398,7 @@ if test -z "$LTLD"; then if test "$XEGCC" = yes; then # Check if gcc -print-prog-name=ld gives a path. echo $ac_n "checking for ld used by GCC""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12299: checking for ld used by GCC" >&5 +echo "configure:12402: checking for ld used by GCC" >&5 ac_prog=`($CC -print-prog-name=ld) 2>&5` case "$ac_prog" in # Accept absolute paths. @@ -12320,7 +12423,7 @@ echo "configure:12299: checking for ld used by GCC" >&5 esac else echo $ac_n "checking for GNU ld""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12324: checking for GNU ld" >&5 +echo "configure:12427: checking for GNU ld" >&5 fi if test -z "$LTLD"; then @@ -12358,7 +12461,7 @@ ld_dynamic_link_flags= # Check to see if it really is or isn't GNU ld. echo $ac_n "checking if the linker is GNU ld""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12362: checking if the linker is GNU ld" >&5 +echo "configure:12465: checking if the linker is GNU ld" >&5 # I'd rather use --version here, but apparently some GNU ld's only accept -v. if $LTLD -v 2>&1 &5; then xe_gnu_ld=yes @@ -12385,7 +12488,7 @@ else # OK - only NOW do we futz about with ld. # See if the linker supports building shared libraries. echo $ac_n "checking whether the linker supports shared libraries""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12389: checking whether the linker supports shared libraries" >&5 +echo "configure:12492: checking whether the linker supports shared libraries" >&5 dll_ld=$CC dll_ldflags=$LDFLAGS ld_shlibs=yes @@ -12551,7 +12654,7 @@ if test -z "$ld_dynamic_link_flags"; then ;; solaris2* | solaris7*) - ld_dynamic_link_flags="${wl}-Bdynamic" + ld_dynamic_link_flags= ;; sco3.2v5* | unixware* | sysv5* | sysv4*) @@ -12601,10 +12704,10 @@ EOF for ac_func in dlerror _dlerror do echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_func""... $ac_c" 1>&6 -echo "configure:12605: checking for $ac_func" >&5 +echo "configure:12708: checking for $ac_func" >&5 cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then +if { (eval echo configure:12734: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest${ac_exeext}; then rm -rf conftest* eval "ac_cv_func_$ac_func=yes" else @@ -12661,11 +12764,11 @@ done fi cat > conftest.$ac_ext <&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 +if { (eval echo configure:12772: \"$ac_link\") 1>&5; (eval $ac_link) 2>&5; } && test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit $?) 2>&5 then : else @@ -13331,16 +13434,14 @@ test "$with_gif" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for (builtin) GIF image test "$with_jpeg" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for JPEG image handling." test "$with_tiff" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for TIFF image handling." test "$with_xface" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for X-Face message headers." -case "$with_sound" in - nas ) echo " Compiling in network sound (NAS) support." ;; - native ) echo " Compiling in native sound support." ;; - both ) echo " Compiling in both network and native sound support." ;; -esac +test "$with_native_sound" = yes && echo " Compiling in native sound support." +test "$with_nas_sound" = yes && echo " Compiling in network sound (NAS) support." test "$old_nas" = yes && echo " nas library lacks error trapping, will play synchronously." +test "$with_esd" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for Enlightened Sound Daemon." test "$with_database_berkdb" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for Berkeley DB." test "$with_database_dbm" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for DBM." -test "$with_database_gnudbm" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for GNU DBM." +test "$with_database_gdbm" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for GNU DBM." test "$with_ldap" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for LDAP." @@ -13553,6 +13654,7 @@ s%@libs_xauth@%$libs_xauth%g s%@dnd_objs@%$dnd_objs%g s%@lwlib_objs@%$lwlib_objs%g s%@ALLOCA@%$ALLOCA%g +s%@have_esd_config@%$have_esd_config%g s%@dll_ld@%$dll_ld%g s%@dll_cflags@%$dll_cflags%g s%@dll_ldflags@%$dll_ldflags%g diff --git a/configure.in b/configure.in index 9ae8f22..2962071 100644 --- a/configure.in +++ b/configure.in @@ -582,20 +582,20 @@ while test $# != 0; do "with_database" ) with_database_berkdb=no with_database_dbm=no - with_database_gnudbm=no + with_database_gdbm=no for x in `echo "$val" | sed -e 's/,/ /g'` ; do case "$x" in - no ) ;; - b | be | ber | berk | berkd | berkdb ) with_database_berkdb=yes ;; - d | db | dbm ) with_database_dbm=yes ;; - g | gn | gnu | gnud | gnudb | gnudbm ) with_database_gnudbm=yes ;; - * ) USAGE_ERROR(["The \`--$optname' option value + no ) ;; + b | be | ber | berk | berkd | berkdb ) with_database_berkdb=yes ;; + d | db | dbm ) with_database_dbm=yes ;; + g | gn | gnu | gnud | gnudb | gnudbm | gdbm) with_database_gdbm=yes ;; + * ) USAGE_ERROR(["The \`--$optname' option value must be either \`no' or a comma-separated list of one or more of \`berkdb' and either \`dbm' or \`gnudbm'."]) ;; esac done - if test "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" -a \ - "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes"; then + if test "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" -a \ + "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes"; then USAGE_ERROR("Only one of \`dbm' and \`gnudbm' may be specified with the \`--$optname' option.") fi @@ -603,18 +603,39 @@ while test $# != 0; do dnl Has the user requested sound support? "with_sound" ) - dnl value can be native, nas or both. yes is allowed - dnl as a backwards compatible synonym for native - case "$val" in - y | ye | yes ) val=native ;; - n | no | non | none ) val=no;; - na | nat | nati | nativ | native ) val=native ;; - ne | net | neta | netau | netaud | netaudi | netaudio | nas ) val=nas ;; - b | bo | bot | both ) val=both;; - * ) USAGE_ERROR(["The \`--$optname' option must have one of these values: - \`native', \`nas', \`both', or \`none'."]) ;; - esac - eval "$opt=\"$val\"" + dnl values is a subset of all,native,nas,esd + dnl or their negatives: none,nonative,nonas,noesd + for x in `echo "$val" | sed -e 's/,/ /g'` ; do + case "$x" in + dnl all and none are only permitted as the first in the list. + n | no | non | none ) new_sdefault=no ;; + a | al | all | both ) new_sdefault=yes ;; + + native ) with_native_sound=yes ;; + nonative ) with_native_sound=no ;; + + nas ) with_nas_sound=yes ;; + nonas ) with_nas_sound=no ;; + + esd ) with_esd=yes ;; + noesd ) with_esh=no ;; + + * ) bogus_sound=yes ;; + esac + if test "$bogus_sound" -o \ + \( -n "$new_sdefault" -a -n "$sound_notfirst" \) ; then + types="\`all', \`none', \`(no)native', \`no(nas)', \`(no)esd'." + USAGE_ERROR(["Valid types for the \`--$optname' option are: + $types. +The default is native,esd."]) + elif test -n "$new_sdefault" ; then + with_native_sound=$new_sdefault + with_nas_sound=$new_sdefault + with_esd=$new_sdefault + new_sdefault= # reset this + fi + sound_notfirst=true + done ;; dnl Has the user requested XIM support? @@ -2158,6 +2179,7 @@ AC_TYPE_PID_T AC_TYPE_UID_T AC_TYPE_MODE_T AC_TYPE_OFF_T +AC_CHECK_TYPE(ssize_t, int) AC_MSG_CHECKING(for struct timeval) AC_TRY_COMPILE([#ifdef TIME_WITH_SYS_TIME @@ -2987,7 +3009,7 @@ if test "$with_x11" = "yes"; then test "$with_toolbars" != "no" && XE_ADD_OBJS(toolbar-x.o) test "$all_widgets" != "no no no no no" && XE_ADD_OBJS(gui-x.o) else - if test \( "$with_sound" = "nas" \) -o \( "$with_sound" = "both" \); then + if test "$with_nas_sound" = "nas"; then echo "Attempt to Build NAS sound without X" echo "Please remove NAS configuration or build with X" exit 1 @@ -3376,10 +3398,6 @@ dnl Check for sound of various sorts. dnl Autodetect native sound AC_CHECKING("for sound support") -case "$with_sound" in - native | both ) with_native_sound=yes;; - nas | no ) with_native_sound=no;; -esac test -z "$with_native_sound" -a -n "$native_sound_lib" && with_native_sound=yes if test "$with_native_sound" != "no"; then @@ -3437,6 +3455,7 @@ if test "$with_native_sound" != "no"; then for dir in "machine" "sys" "linux"; do AC_CHECK_HEADER(${dir}/soundcard.h, sound_found=yes + need_miscplay=yes XE_ADD_OBJS(linuxplay.o) [AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(SOUNDCARD_H_PATH, "${dir}/soundcard.h")] break) @@ -3446,25 +3465,40 @@ if test "$with_native_sound" != "no"; then test "$sound_found" = "yes" && with_native_sound=yes fi -if test -z "$with_sound"; then - if test "$with_native_sound" = "yes" -o -n "$native_sound_lib"; then - with_sound=native - fi -fi - if test "$with_native_sound" = "yes"; then AC_DEFINE(HAVE_NATIVE_SOUND) test -n "$native_sound_lib" && XE_PREPEND($native_sound_lib, LIBS) fi -case "$with_sound" in both | nas ) +if test "$with_nas_sound" = "yes"; then AC_DEFINE(HAVE_NAS_SOUND) XE_ADD_OBJS(nas.o) XE_PREPEND(-laudio, libs_x) dnl If the nas library does not contain the error jump point, dnl then we force safer behavior. AC_EGREP_HEADER(AuXtErrorJump,audio/Xtutil.h,,[AC_DEFINE(NAS_NO_ERROR_JUMP)]) -esac +fi + +AC_CHECK_PROG(have_esd_config, esd-config, yes, no) +if test -z "$with_esd"; then + with_esd=$have_esd_config +fi + +if test "$with_esd" = "yes"; then + if test "$have_esd_config" = "no"; then + echo "*** esd-config was not found in your PATH. Disabling esd support." + with_esd=no + else + AC_DEFINE(HAVE_ESD_SOUND) + need_miscplay=yes + XE_ADD_OBJS(esd.o) + XE_PREPEND(`esd-config --libs`, libs_x) + fi +fi + +if test "$need_miscplay" = "yes"; then + XE_ADD_OBJS(miscplay.o) +fi dnl --------------------- dnl TTY-dependent options @@ -3555,26 +3589,26 @@ dnl We do not necessarily have to have libdb/lib(g)dbm for DB/(G)DBM support. dnl On FreeBSD, both DB and DBM are part of libc. dnl By default, we check for DBM support in libgdbm, then libc, then libdbm. -test "$with_database_gnudbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ +test "$with_database_gdbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ != "no no no" && AC_CHECKING(for database support) dnl Check for ndbm.h, required for either kind of DBM support. -if test "$with_database_gnudbm $with_database_dbm" != "no no"; then +if test "$with_database_gdbm $with_database_dbm" != "no no"; then AC_CHECK_HEADER(ndbm.h, [:], [ - test "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes" -o \ - "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ + test "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes" -o \ + "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ XE_DIE("Required DBM support cannot be provided.") - with_database_gnudbm=no with_database_dbm=no]) + with_database_gdbm=no with_database_dbm=no]) fi dnl Check for DBM support in libgdbm. -if test "$with_database_gnudbm" != "no"; then +if test "$with_database_gdbm" != "no"; then AC_CHECK_LIB(gdbm, dbm_open, [ - with_database_gnudbm=yes with_database_dbm=no libdbm=-lgdbm], [ - if test "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes"; then + with_database_gdbm=yes with_database_dbm=no libdbm=-lgdbm], [ + if test "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes"; then XE_DIE("Required GNU DBM support cannot be provided.") fi - with_database_gnudbm=no]) + with_database_gdbm=no]) fi dnl Check for DBM support in libc and libdbm. @@ -3588,8 +3622,8 @@ fi dnl Tell make about the DBM support we detected. test -n "$libdbm" && XE_PREPEND("$libdbm", LIBS) -test "$with_database_gnudbm" = "yes" -o \ - "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ +test "$with_database_gdbm" = "yes" -o \ + "$with_database_dbm" = "yes" && \ AC_DEFINE(HAVE_DBM) dnl Check for Berkeley DB. @@ -3634,7 +3668,7 @@ yes fi fi -if test "$with_database_gnudbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ +if test "$with_database_gdbm $with_database_dbm $with_database_berkdb" \ != "no no no"; then AC_DEFINE(HAVE_DATABASE) XE_ADD_OBJS(database.o) @@ -4123,16 +4157,14 @@ test "$with_gif" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for (builtin) GIF image test "$with_jpeg" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for JPEG image handling." test "$with_tiff" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for TIFF image handling." test "$with_xface" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for X-Face message headers." -case "$with_sound" in - nas ) echo " Compiling in network sound (NAS) support." ;; - native ) echo " Compiling in native sound support." ;; - both ) echo " Compiling in both network and native sound support." ;; -esac +test "$with_native_sound" = yes && echo " Compiling in native sound support." +test "$with_nas_sound" = yes && echo " Compiling in network sound (NAS) support." test "$old_nas" = yes && echo " nas library lacks error trapping, will play synchronously." +test "$with_esd" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for Enlightened Sound Daemon." test "$with_database_berkdb" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for Berkeley DB." test "$with_database_dbm" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for DBM." -test "$with_database_gnudbm" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for GNU DBM." +test "$with_database_gdbm" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for GNU DBM." test "$with_ldap" = yes && echo " Compiling in support for LDAP." diff --git a/configure.usage b/configure.usage index 6cbfcc6..1f1b77e 100644 --- a/configure.usage +++ b/configure.usage @@ -121,9 +121,11 @@ Additional features: --with-database=TYPE (*) Compile with database support. Valid types are `no' or a comma-separated list of one or more of `berkdb' and either `dbm' or `gnudbm'. ---with-sound=native (*) Compile with native sound support. ---with-sound=nas Compile with network sound support. ---with-sound=both Compile with native and network sound support. +--with-sound=TYPE,[TYPE],... Compile with native sound support. + Valid types are `native', `nas' and `esd'. + Prefix a type with 'no' to disable. + The first option can be `none' or `all' to change + the default which is: native,esd --native-sound-lib=LIB Native sound support library. Needed on Suns with --with-sound=both because both sound libraries are called libaudio. diff --git a/etc/FTP b/etc/FTP index 965f0b9..2074ec4 100644 --- a/etc/FTP +++ b/etc/FTP @@ -1,282 +1,103 @@ - -*- text -*- - XEmacs availability information. Last Modified: 9-Jul-1998. + XEmacs availability information. Last Modified: 1999-11-08 XEmacs is available via anonymous FTP from ftp.xemacs.org (207.96.122.8) in the directory /pub/xemacs/. ftp.xemacs.org is the primary distribution point, but you may find copies of it at other sites as well. Some sites to try include: - - ftp://ftp.jaist.ac.jp/pub/GNU/xemacs/ - ftp://ring.aist.go.jp/pub/text/xemacs/ - ftp://ring.asahi-net.or.jp/pub/text/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.uu.net/systems/gnu/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.sunet.se/pub/gnu/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.cenatls.cena.dgac.fr/pub/Emacs/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.th-darmstadt.de/pub/editors/xemacs/ - ftp://sunsite.doc.ic.ac.uk/gnu/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.lip6.fr/pub/emacs/xemacs/ - ftp://uiarchive.cso.uiuc.edu/pub/packages/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.technion.ac.il/pub/unsupported/gnu/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.linux.hr/pub/xemacs/ - ftp://sunsite.cnlab-switch.ch/mirror/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.unicamp.br/pub/xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.usyd.edu.au/pub/Xemacs/ - ftp://ftp.lab.kdd.co.jp/xemacs/ - ftp://SunSITE.sut.ac.jp/pub/archives/xemacs/ - ftp://sunsite.icm.edu.pl/pub/unix/xemacs + +* North America + + o Canada + + ftp://ftp.crc.ca/pub/packages/editors/xemacs/ + + ftp://sunsite.ualberta.ca/pub/Mirror/xemacs/ + o United States + + ftp://uiarchive.uiuc.edu/pub/packages/xemacs/ + + ftp://metalab.unc.edu/pub/packages/editors/xemacs/ + + ftp://ftp.sunsite.utk.edu/pub/xemacs/ + +* South America + + o Brazil + + ftp://ftp.unicamp.br/pub/xemacs/ + +* Europe + + o Austria + + ftp://gd.tuwien.ac.at/editors/xemacs/ + o Denmark + + ftp://sunsite.auc.dk/pub/emacs/xemacs/ + o England + + ftp://sunsite.doc.ic.ac.uk/packages/xemacs/ + o Finland + + ftp://ftp.funet.fi/pub/mirrors/ftp.xemacs.org/pub/tux/xemacs/ + o France + + ftp://ftp.pasteur.fr/pub/computing/xemacs/ + + ftp://ftp.cenatls.cena.dgac.fr/Emacs/xemacs/ + o Germany + + ftp://ftp.tu-darmstadt.de/pub/editors/xemacs/ + o Hungary + + ftp://ftp.kfki.hu/pub/packages/xemacs/ + o Ireland + + ftp://ftp.eunet.ie/mirrors/ftp.xemacs.org/pub/xemacs/ + o Italy + + ftp://ftp.uniroma2.it/unix/misc/dist/XEMACS/ + o Norway + + ftp://sunsite.uio.no/pub/xemacs + o Poland + + ftp://ftp.icm.edu.pl/pub/unix/editors/xemacs/ + o Russia + + ftp://ftp.srcc.msu.su/mirror/ftp.xemacs.org/ + o Sweden + + ftp://ftp.sunet.se/pub/gnu/xemacs/ + o Switzerland + + ftp://sunsite.cnlab-switch.ch/mirror/xemacs/ + +* Asia + + o Japan + + ftp://ftp.netlab.is.tsukuba.ac.jp/pub/GNU/xemacs/ + + ftp://ftp.jaist.ac.jp/pub/GNU/xemacs/ + + ftp://ring.aist.go.jp/pub/text/xemacs/ + + ftp://ring.asahi-net.or.jp/pub/text/xemacs/ + + ftp://sunsite.sut.ac.jp/pub/archives/packages/xemacs/ + + ftp://ftp.dti.ad.jp/pub/unix/editor/xemacs/ + + ftp://mirror.nucba.ac.jp/mirror/xemacs/ + o Korea + + ftp://ftp.kreonet.re.kr/pub/tools/emacs/xemacs/ + o Taiwan + + ftp://coda.nctu.edu.tw/Editors/xemacs/ + +* Africa + + o South Africa + + ftp://ftp.sun.ac.za/xemacs/ + +* Middle East + + o Saudi Arabia + + ftp://ftp.isu.net.sa/pub/mirrors/ftp.xemacs.org/ + +* Australia + + o ftp://mirror.aarnet.edu.au/pub/xemacs The most up-to-date list of distribution sites can always be found on -the XEmacs WWW page, http://www.xemacs.org/. Try to pick a site -that is networkologically close to you. If you know of other mirrors -of the XEmacs archives, please send us mail and we will list them here -as well. +the XEmacs WWW page, http://www.xemacs.org/. Try to pick a site that +is networkologically close to you. If you know of other mirrors of +the XEmacs archives, please send us mail and we will list them here as +well. There are mailing lists and newsgroups specifically for discussing and reporting bugs in XEmacs; see the file MAILINGLISTS in this directory. -The FTP and ordering information in the remainder of this file applies -to the versions of GNU Emacs distributed by the Free Software Foundation, -not to XEmacs. - ----------------------------------------------------------------------- -How to get GNU Software by Internet FTP or by UUCP. Last updated 11 June 95. - -* Please send improvements to this file to gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu. - -* No Warranties - -We distribute software in the hope that it will be useful, but without -any warranty. No author or distributor of this software accepts -responsibility to anyone for the consequences of using it or for -whether it serves any particular purpose or works at all, unless he -says so in writing. - -* Updates - -If you find this file in the Emacs distribution, there is a chance it -is out of date. If you plan to FTP files from a GNU FTP host, you -might as well start by FTPing the current version of this file, which -is `/pub/gnu/GNUinfo/FTP'. - -* How to FTP - -Use the ftp program on your system (ask locally if you can't find it) -to connect to the host you are ftping from. Unless indicated -otherwise, login in as user "anonymous", with password: "your e-mail -address" and set "binary" mode (to transfer all eight bits in each -byte). - -* FTPing GNU Software - -** How to FTP GNU Emacs - -If you are on the Internet (see also "** Alternative Internet FTP -Sources" below), you can at present copy the latest distribution -version of GNU Emacs from the file /pub/gnu/emacs-M.N.tar on host -prep.ai.mit.edu (or the file /pub/gnu/emacs-M.N.tar.gz which has been -run through gzip after tar). M and N stand for version numbers; look -at a listing of the directory through ftp to see what version is -available. These files are about 11 and 4 megabytes long, -respectively. After you unpack the distribution, be sure to look at -the files README and INSTALL. - -Because of difficulties in transferring large files, sometimes a split -version of the tar file is created. This would be in a directory -named /pub/gnu/emacs-M.N.tar-split or perhaps -/pub/gnu/emacs-M.N.tar.gz-split, containing files of 100000 characters -each. There is generally no trouble in ftping files of this size. -They can be combined with cat to make a tar file or compressed tar -file. If you can't find such files on prep.ai.mit.edu, have a look at -archive.cis.ohio-state.edu. - -ALWAYS USE BINARY/IMAGE MODE TO TRANSFER THESE FILES! -Text mode does not work for tar files or compressed files. - -Some ftp'ers have found it necessary for successful file transfer: - - to explicitly use prep.ai.mit.edu internet address: -18.159.0.42 (as of 18 June 95) - -Files of differences from previous widely distributed GNU Emacs -versions to the present version are also available on prep.ai.mit.edu -under names of the form emacs.diff-OO.OO-NN.NN in directory /pub/gnu. -These are made with diff -rc2. Sometimes there are versions -compressed with gzip of these difference files as well; their names -have .gz appended. - -The Emacs manual in source form is included in the distribution. The -dvi file produced by TeX is not included, but a copy may be available -for ftp under the name /pub/gnu/emacs.dvi. - -The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is in a separate file: - /pub/gnu/elisp-manual-NN.tar.gz - -** VMS FTP sites with GNU Software -You can anonymously ftp a VMS version of GNU emacs from: - - ftp.stacken.kth.se:[.GNU-VMS] - GNU Emacs and some other VMS -ports (and some VMS binaries) of GNU software - - mango.rsmas.miami.edu has a VMS version of the GCC/G++ compiler. -Contact angel@flipper.miami.edu (angel li) for details. - - addvax.llnl.gov - GNU Emacs - - VMSD.OAC.UCI.EDU - GNU Emacs - - RIGEL.EFD.LTH.SE [130.235.48.3] - GNU Emacs - - ctrsci.cc.utah.edu - GNU Emacs - The 00readme.txt file gives details - - cc.utah.edu [128.110.8.24] - misc. GNU software - user -anonymous, pass guest. The 00README.txt file gives details. - -** Other GNU Software and How To FTP It - -Other GNU software is available on prep.ai.mit.edu under directory -/pub/gnu. diff files to convert between versions (like those used for -GNU Emacs), exist for some of these programs. Some programs have misc -support files as well. Have a look on prep to see which ones. -Compressed versions of the tar or diff files are often available -(indicated by a .gz suffix and made with the `gzip' program). Some of -this software is in beta test (probably still buggy), and is being -made available for use by hackers who like to test software. - -The file /pub/gnu/DESCRIPTIONS has a list of the packages distributed -on prep.ai.mit.edu with a brief description explaining what -each one can be used for. - -More information about these programs can typically be found in the -GNU Bulletin. To receive a copy, write to gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu. - -** Scheme and How to FTP It - -The latest distribution version of C Scheme is available via anonymous FTP -from altdorf.ai.mit.edu in /archive/scheme-X.XX/ (where X.XX is some version -number). - -Read the files INSTALL and README in the top level C Scheme directory. - -** TeX and How to Obtain It - -We don't distribute TeX now, but it is free software. - -TeX is a document formatter that is used, among other things, by the FSF -for all its documentation. You will need it if you want to make printed -manuals. - -TeX is freely redistributable. You can get it by ftp, tape, or CD/ROM. - -*** For FTP instructions, retrieve the file -ftp.cs.umb.edu:pub/tex/unixtex.ftp. (We don't include it here because it -changes relatively frequently. Sorry.) - -*** For TeX on a single tape (4mm DAT or QIC-24), ordering information is -available from unixtex@u.washington.edu. A distribution fee in the area -of US$210.00 covers administrative costs. Tapes will be available at -least through summer of 1994. - -*** The FSF hopes soon to distribute tapes of TeX itself, after the -University of Washington distribution service goes away. - -*** A minimal TeX collection (enough to process Texinfo files, anyway) -is included on the GNU source CD/ROM. See the file ORDERS in this -directory for more information. - -** Alternative Internet FTP Sources - -Please do NOT use a site outside your country, until you have checked -all sites inside your country, and then your continent. Trans-ocean -TCP/IP links are very expensive and usually very low speed. - -The administrators of louie.udel.edu maintains copies of GNU Emacs. -The files are available via anonymous ftp under directory ~ftp/gnu. - -Emacs and other GNU programs may be available via anonymous ftp from -these US sites: ftp.kpc.com:/pub/mirror/gnu (Silicon Valley, CA) -ftp.hawaii.edu:/mirrors/gnu, f.ms.uky.edu:/pub3/gnu, -ftp.digex.net:/pub/gnu (Internet address 164.109.10.23, nightly full -mirror, ran by mcguire@digex.net), wuarchive.wustl.edu:/systems/gnu, -col.hp.com:/mirrors/gnu, ftp.cs.columbia.edu:/archives/gnu/prep, -uiarchive.cso.uiuc.edu:/pub/gnu (Internet address 128.174.5.14, -nightly full mirror, ran by ftpadmin@uiuc.edu), -jaguar.utah.edu:/gnustuff, gatekeeper.dec.com:/pub/GNU, -labrea.stanford.edu, archive.cis.ohio-state.edu, and -ftp.uu.net:/archive/systems/gnu. - -And these foreign sites: ftp.cs.ubc.ca:/mirror2/gnu (Western Canada, -daily full mirror, ran by ftp-admin@cs.ubc.ca), -ftp.inf.utfsm.cl:/pub/gnu (Chile 146.83.198.3 nightly full mirror, ran -by ftp@inf.utfsm.cl), ftp.unicamp.br:/pub/gnu (Brazil manual mirror, -ran by oliva@dcc.unicamp.br), archie.au:/gnu (Australia (archie.oz or -archie.oz.au for ACSnet)), ftp.technion.ac.il:/pub/unsupported/gnu -(Israel, daily full mirror, ran by ftp-admin), ftp.sun.ac.za:/pub/gnu -(South Africa), ftp.etsimo.uniovi.es:/pub/gnu (Spain), -ftp.mcc.ac.uk:/pub/gnu (130.88.203.12 daily full mirror, ran by -root@ftp.mcc.ac.uk), unix.hensa.ac.uk:/mirrors/uunet/systems/gnu, -ftp.warwick.ac.uk (137.205.192.14 daily full mirror, ran by -unixhelp@warwick.ac.uk), ftp.informatik.tu-muenchen.de, -ftp.informatik.rwth-aachen.de, or germany.eu.net (mirror ran by -archive-admin@germany.eu.net) (Germany), isy.liu.se (Sweden), -ftp.stacken.kth.se or ftp.luth.se:/pub/unix/gnu (Sweden), -ftp.sunet.se:/pub/gnu (Sweden 130.238.127.3 daily mirror, ran by -archive@ftp.sunet.se (also mirrors the Mailing List Archives) -ftp.nl.net (Netherlands), ftp.win.tue.nl:/pub/gnu (Netherlands -131.155.70.100 daily mirror, ran by ftp@win.tue.nl), -ftp.funet.fi:/pub/gnu (Finland 128.214.6.100, ran by gnu-adm), -ftp.denet.dk (Denmark), ugle.unit.no (Norway 129.241.1.97), -ftp.eunet.ch or nic.switch.ch:/mirror/gnu (Switzerland), -irisa.irisa.fr:/pub/gnu or ftp.univ-lyon1.fr:pub/gnu (ran by -ftpmaint@ftp.univ-lyon1.fr) (France), ftp.ieunet.ie:pub/gnu (Ireland -192.111.39.1 weekly mirror, ran by archive@ieunet.ie), archive.eu.net -(Europe 192.16.202.1), cair-archive.kaist.ac.kr:/pub/gnu (Korea -143.248.11.171, ran by ftpkeeper@cair-archive.kaist.ac.kr), -ftp.nectec.or.th:/pub/mirrors/gnu (Thailand 192.150.251.32 daily -mirror, ran by ftp@nwg.nectec.or.th), -utsun.s.u-tokyo.ac.jp:/ftpsync/prep or ftp.cs.titech.ac.jp (Japan, -nemacs, the japanese port of GNU Emacs, is under ~ftp/JAPAN). - -* Getting GNU software in Great Britain - -jpo@cs.nott.ac.uk is willing to distribute those GNU sources he has -available. The smaller items are available from the info-server (send -to info-server@cs.nott.ac.uk) the larger items by negotiation. Due to -communication costs this service is only available within the UK. - -BattenIG@computer-science.birmingham.ac.uk (aka -I.G.Batten@fulcrum.bt.co.uk) is also willing to distribute those GNU -sources he has. He can also write tapes in qic-21 and qic-24 formats. - -lmjm@doc.ic.ac.uk is willing to distribute those GNU sources he has -along with comp.sources.unix, comp.sources.x, X windows et al. The -archive, on src.doc.ic.ac.uk in directory /gnu, is available via ftp -over the Internet (on 146.169.3.7), ftam over IXI, HTTP, FSP, Gopher, -ftpmail, NFS, Lanmanger over IP, telnet, and uucp. Due to -communication costs this service is only available within the UK. -Mail to info-server@doc.ic.ac.uk for details. He can also write sun -cartridge or exabyte tapes. - -UK sites with just anonymous FTP access are in the above list. - -* Getting GNU software via UUCP - -OSU is distributing via UUCP: most GNU software, MIT C Scheme, -Compress, News, RN, NNTP, Patch, some Appletalk stuff, some of the -Internet Requests For Comment (RFC) et al.. See their periodic -postings on the Usenet newsgroup comp.sources.d for informational -updates. Current details from or -<...!osu-cis!staff>. - -Information on how to uucp some GNU programs is available via -electronic mail from: uunet!hutch!barber, hqda-ai!merlin, acornrc!bob, -hao!scicom!qetzal!upba!ugn!nepa!denny, ncar!noao!asuvax!hrc!dan, -bigtex!james (aka james@bigtex.cactus.org), oli-stl!root, -src@contrib.de (Germany), toku@dit.co.jp (Japan) and info@ftp.uu.net. -* If You Like The Software + How to get GNU Software by Internet FTP or by UUCP: -If you like the software developed and distributed by the Free -Software Foundation, please express your satisfaction with a donation. -Your donations will help to support the Foundation and make our future -efforts successful, including a complete development and operating -system, called GNU (Gnu's Not Un*x), which will run Un*x user -programs. For more information on GNU and the Foundation, contact us -at the above address. +The XEmacs project is separate from and not managed by the GNU +project. The latest GNU project FTP and UUCP availability information +can be found at ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/GNUinfo/FTP -Ordering a distribution tape from the Foundation is often a good -way to bring your company or university to make a donation. diff --git a/etc/MAILINGLISTS b/etc/MAILINGLISTS index 2bab54a..d175754 100644 --- a/etc/MAILINGLISTS +++ b/etc/MAILINGLISTS @@ -1,1206 +1,112 @@ - XEmacs Electronic Mailing Lists. Last Modified: 1997-01-13 + XEmacs Electronic Mailing Lists. Last Modified: 1999-11-08 -XEmacs has its own mailing list and newsgroup which are distinct from -the FSF GNU Emacs mailing lists and newsgroups. The mailing list is: +XEmacs has its own mailing lists and newsgroup which are distinct from +the FSF GNU Emacs mailing lists and newsgroups. The mailing lists are: - xemacs@xemacs.org For reporting all bugs in XEmacs, including bugs - in the compilation and installation procedures. - Also for all random questions and conversation - about XEmacs. +xemacs@xemacs.org comp.emacs.xemacs bi-directional gateway. + + xemacs is an open list for discussion and bug reporting for + XEmacs. This mailing list is bi-directionally gatewayed with the + USENET newsgroup comp.emacs.xemacs. -This mailing list is bidirectionally gatewayed into the USENET newsgroup -comp.emacs.xemacs. +xemacs-announce@xemacs.org XEmacs Announcements. -To be added or removed from this mailing list, send mail to -xemacs-request@xemacs.org (If it is possible for you to read the -messages via the newsgroup, we would prefer that; the fewer people there -are on the mailing list, the less trouble it is to maintain.) + xemacs-announce is a read-only, low volume list for announcements + concerning the XEmacs project and new releases of the XEmacs + software. -Please do NOT send messages about problems with XEmacs to the FSF GNU -Emacs newsgroups and mailing lists (listed below) unless you are sure -that the problem you are reporting is a problem with both versions of -GNU Emacs. People who aren't subscribed to the XEmacs mailing list most -likely are not interested in hearing about problems with it. - -The XEmacs mailing list is archived at ftp://ftp.xemacs.org/pub/xemacs/mlists/. - -See the file etc/BETA for more information about mailing lists for use -by beta testers and XEmacs developers. - -IMPORTANT IMPORTANT IMPORTANT: - -Aside from the names of the mailing lists and newsgroups corresponding -to this version of Emacs, the guidelines enumerated below still apply. -Please read them before sending a message. - ------------------------------------------------------------------------ - GNU Project Electronic Mailing Lists and gnUSENET Newsgroups - Last Updated 1 July 97 - - Please report improvements to: gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu - -* GNU mailing lists are also distributed as USENET news groups - -The mailing lists are gated both ways with the gnu.all newsgroups at -ohio-state.edu. The one-to-one correspondence is indicated below. If -you don't know if your site is on USENET, ask your system administrator. -If you are a USENET site and don't get the gnu.all newsgroups, please -ask your USENET administrator to get them. If he has your feeds ask -their feeds, you should win. And everyone else wins: newsgroups make -better use of the limited bandwidth of the computer networks and your -home machine than mailing list traffic; and staying off the mailing -lists make better use of the people who maintain the lists and the -machines that the GNU people working with rms use (i.e. we have more -time to produce code!!). Thanx. - -* Getting the mailing lists directly - -If several users at your site or local network want to read a list and -you aren't a USENET site, Project GNU would prefer that you would set up -one address that redistributes locally. This reduces overhead on our -people and machines, your gateway machine, and the network(s) used to -transport the mail from us to you. - -* How to subscribe to and report bugs in mailing lists - -Send messages ABOUT these lists, such as reports of mail problems, or -requests to be added or removed, to help-gnu-emacs-request (or -info-gnu-request, bug-gdb-request, etc.), NOT to info-gnu-emacs (or -info-gnu, etc.). These -request addresses go only to the -people who can do something about your requests or problems, and thus -avoids disturbing everyone else. - -Note that all GNU mailing lists are maintained by volunteers. They get -behind occasionally. Wait at least 3 or 4 days before asking again. -Thanks! - -Many of the GNU mailing lists are very large and are received by many -people. Please don't send them anything that is not seriously important -to all their readers. All GNU mailing lists are unmoderated, mail -reflectors, except info-gnu, info-gnu-emacs, info-gcc, info-g++, -info-gnu-fortran. - -All addresses below are in internet format. Consult the mail guru for -your computer to figure out address syntaxes from other networks. From -UUCP machines: - ..!ucbvax!prep.ai.mit.edu!ADDRESS - ..!uunet!prep.ai.mit.edu!ADDRESS - -If a message you mail to a list is returned from a MAILER-DAEMON (often -with the line: - ----- Transcript of session follows ----- - don't resend the message to the list. All this return means is that -your original message failed to reach a few addresses on the list. Such -messages are NEVER a reason to resend a piece of mail a 2nd time. This -just bothers all (less the few delivery failures (which will probably -just fail again!)) of the readers of the list with a message they have -already seen. It also wastes computer and network resources. - -It is appropriate to send these to the -request address for a list, and -ask them to check the problem out. - -* Send Specific Requests for Information to: gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu - -Specific requests for information about obtaining GNU software, or GNU -activities in Cambridge and elsewhere can be directed to: - gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu - -* General Information about all lists - -Please keep each message under 25,000 characters. Some mailers bounce -messages that are longer than this. If your message is long, it is -generally better to send a message offering to make the large file -available to only those people who want it (e.g. mailing it to people -who ask, or putting it up for FTP). In the case of gnu.emacs.sources, -somewhat larger postings (up to 10 parts of no more than 25,000 -characters each) are acceptable (assuming they are likely to be of -interest to a reasonable number of people); if it is larger than that -have it added to archive.cis.ohio-state.edu (the GNU Emacs Lisp ftp and -uucp archive on and announce) its location there. Good bug reports are -short. See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and ...' -for further details. - -Most of the time, when you reply to a message sent to a list, the reply -should not go to the list. But most mail reading programs supply, by -default, all the recipients of the original as recipients of the reply. -Make a point of deleting the list address from the header when it does -not belong. This prevents bothering all readers of a list, and reduces -network congestion. - -The GNU mailing lists and newsgroups, like the GNU project itself, exist -to promote the freedom to share software. So don't use these lists to -promote or recommend non-free software. (Using them to post ordering -information is the ultimate faux pas.) If there is no free program to -do a certain task, then somebody should write one! - -* General Information about info-* lists - -These lists and their newsgroups are meant for important announcements. -Since the GNU project uses software development as a means for social -change, the announcements may be technical or political. - -Most GNU projects info-* lists (and their corresponding gnu.*.announce -newsgroups) are moderated to keep their content significant and -relevant. If you have a bug to report, send it to the bug-* list. If -you need help on something else and the help-* list exists, ask it. - -See section '* General Information about all lists'. - -* General Information about help-* lists - -These lists (and their newsgroups) exist for anyone to ask questions -about the GNU software that the list deals with. The lists are read by -people who are willing to take the time to help other users. - -When you answer the questions that people ask on the help-* lists, keep -in mind that you shouldn't answer by promoting a proprietary program as -a solution. The only real solutions are the ones all the readers can -share. - -If a program crashes, or if you build it following the standard -procedure on a system on which it is supposed to work and it does not -work at all, or if an command does not behave as it is documented to -behave, this is a bug. Don't send bug reports to a help-* list; mail -them to the bug-* list instead. - -See section '* General Information about all lists'. - -* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting program bugs - -If you think something is a bug in a program, it might be one; or, it -might be a misunderstanding or even a feature. Before beginning to -report bugs, please read the section ``Reporting Emacs Bugs'' toward the -end of the GNU Emacs reference manual (or node Emacs/Bugs in Emacs's -built-in Info system) for a discussion of how and when to send in bug -reports. For GNU programs other than GNU Emacs, also consult their -documentation for their bug reporting procedures. Always include the -version number of the GNU program, as well as the operating system and -machine the program was ran on (if the program doesn't have a version -number, send the date of the latest entry in the file ChangeLog). For -GNU Emacs bugs, type "M-x emacs-version". A debugger backtrace of any -core dump, can also be useful. Be careful to separate out hypothesis -from fact! For bugs in GNU Emacs lisp, set variable debug-on-error to -t, and re-enter the command(s) that cause the error message; Emacs will -pop up a debug buffer if something is wrong; please include a copy of -the buffer in your bug report. Please also try to make your bug report -as short as possible; distill the problem to as few lines of code and/or -input as possible. GNU maintainers give priority to the shortest, high -quality bug reports. - -Please don't send in a patch without a test case to illustrate the -problem the patch is supposed to fix. Sometimes the patches aren't -correct or aren't the best way to do the job, and without a test case -there is no way to debug an alternate fix. - -The purpose of reporting a bug is to enable the bug to be fixed for the -sake of the whole community of users. You may or may not receive a -response; the maintainers will send one if that helps them find or -verify a fix. Most GNU maintainers are volunteers and all are -overworked; they don't have time to help individuals and still fix the -bugs and make the improvements that everyone wants. If you want help -for yourself in particular, you may have to hire someone. The GNU -project maintains a list of people providing such services. It is -distributed with GNU Emacs in file etc/SERVICE, and can be requested -from gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu. - -Anything addressed to the implementors and maintainers of a GNU program -via a bug-* list, should NOT be sent to the corresponding info-* or -help-* list. - -Please DON'T post your bug reports on the gnu.*.bug newsgroups! Mail -them to bug-*@prep instead! At first sight, it seems to make no -difference: anything sent to one will be propagated to the other; but: - - if you post on the newsgroup, the information about how to -reach you is lost in the message that goes on the mailing list. It -can be very important to know how to reach you, if there is anything -in the bug report that we don't understand; - - bug reports reach the GNU maintainers quickest when they are -sent to the bug-* mailing list submittal address; - - mail is much more reliable then netnews; and - - if the internet mailers can't get your bug report delivered, -they almost always send you an error message, so you can find another -way to get the bug report in. When netnews fails to get your message -delivered to the maintainers, you'll never know about it and the -maintainers will never see the bug report. - -And please DON'T post your GNU bug reports to comp.* or other gnu.* -newsgroups, they never make it to the GNU maintainers at all. Please -mail them to bug-*@prep instead! - -See section '* General Information about all lists'. - -* info-gnu-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-gnu -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.announce -** Send announcements to: info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes progress reports on the GNU Project. It is also -used by the GNU Project to ask people for various kinds of help. It is -NOT for general discussion. - -The list is filtered to remove items meant for info-gnu-request, that -can be answered by the moderator without bothering the list, or should -have been sent to another list. - -See section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -* gnu-misc-discuss-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to gnu-misc-discuss -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.misc.discuss -** Send contributions to: gnu-misc-discuss@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is for serious discussion of freed software, the GNU Project, -the GNU Manifesto, and their implications. It's THE place for -discussion that is not appropriate in the other GNU mailing lists and -gnUSENET newsgroups. - -Flaming is out of place. Tit-for-tat is not welcome. Repetition -should not occur. - -Good READING and writing are expected. Before posting, wait a while, -cool off, and think. - -Don't use this group for complaints and bug reports about GNU software! -The maintainers don't read this group; they won't see your complaint. -Use the appropriate bug-reporting mailing list instead, so that people -who can do something about the problem will see it. - -Don't trust pronouncements made on gnu-misc-discuss about what GNU is, -what FSF position is, what the GNU General Public License is, etc., -unless they are made by someone you know is well connected with GNU and -are sure the message is not forged. - -USENET and gnUSENET readers are expected to have read ALL the articles -in news.announce.newusers before posting. If news.announce.newusers is -empty at your site, wait (the articles are posted monthly), your posting -isn't that urgent! Readers on the Internet can anonymous FTP these -articles from host ftp.uu.net under directory ?? - -Someone from the Free Software Foundation will attempt to follow this -group as time and volume permits. - -Remember, "GNUs Not Unix" and "gnUSENET is Not USENET". We have -higher standards! - -Note that sending technical questions about specific GNU software to -gnu-misc-discuss is likely to be less useful than sending them to the -appropriate mailing list or gnUSENET newsgroup, since more technical -people read those. - -* bug-gnu-sql-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gnu-sql -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** GNU-SQL BUG reports to: bug-gnu-sql@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of GNU's SQL (GNU's SQL -full scale database server), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions -for improvements to GNU's SQL. User discussion of GNU's SQL also occurs -here. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for GNU's SQL. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-guile-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-guile -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** GUILE BUG reports to: bug-guile@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of GUILE (GNU's -Ubiquitous Extension Language), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions for -improvements to GUILE. User discussion of GUILE also occurs here. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for GUILE . - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* guile-sources-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to guile-sources -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Guile source code to: guile-sources@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list will be for the posting, by their authors, of GUILE, Scheme, -and C sources and patches that improve Guile. Its contents will be -reviewed by the FSF for inclusion in future releases of GUILE. - -Please do NOT discuss or request source code here. Use bug-guile for -those purposes. This allows the automatic archiving of sources posted -to this list. - -Please do NOT post such sources to any other GNU mailing list (e.g -bug-guile) or gnUSENET newsgroups. It's up to each poster to decide -whether to cross-post to any non-gnUSENET newsgroup. - -Please do NOT announce that you have posted source code to guile.sources -to any other GNU mailing list (e.g. bug-guile) or gnUSENET newsgroups. -People who want to keep up with sources will read this list. It's up to -each poster to decide whether to announce a guile.sources article in any -non-gnUSENET newsgroup (e.g. comp.emacs or comp.sources.d). - -If source or patches that were previously posted or a simple fix is -requested in bug-guile, please mail it to the requester. Do NOT -repost it. If you also want something that is requested, send mail to -the requester asking him to forward it to you. This kind of traffic is -best handled by e-mail, not by a broadcast medium that reaches millions -of sites. - -If the requested source is very long (>10k bytes) send mail offering to -send it. This prevents the requester from getting many redundant copies -and saves network bandwidth. - -* bug-gnustep-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gnustep -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gnustep.bug -** Gnustep bug reports to: bug-gnustep@prep.ai.mit.edu -** FAQ-URL: none known -** FAQ-Archive-name: none known -** FAQ-Posting-frequency: none known - -This list distributes bug reports for, fixes for bugs in, and -suggestions for improvements in GNUstep to its active developers. - -Subscribers to bug-gnustep get all info-gnustep messages. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* help-gnustep-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to help-gnustep -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gnustep.help -** Send contributions to: help-gnustep@prep.ai.mit.edu -** FAQ-URL: none known -** FAQ-Archive-name: none known -** FAQ-Posting-frequency: none known - -This list is the place for users and installers of the GNUstep to ask -for help. Please send bug reports to bug-gnustep@prep.ai.mit.edu -instead of posting them here. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. - -* discuss-gnustep-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to discuss-gnustep -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gnustep.discuss -** Send contributions to: discuss-gnustep@prep.ai.mit.edu -** FAQ-URL: none known -** FAQ-Archive-name: none known -** FAQ-Posting-frequency: none known - -This list is the place for GNUstep users and developers to discuss -GNUstep. Please send bug reports to bug-gnustep@prep.ai.mit.edu -instead of posting them here. - -See section '* General Information about discuss-* lists'. - -* info-gnustep-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-gnustep -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gnustep.announce -** Send announcements to: info-gnustep@prep.ai.mit.edu -** FAQ-URL: none known -** FAQ-Archive-name: none known -** FAQ-Posting-frequency: none known - -This list distributes announcements and progress reports on GNUstep. -It is NOT for general discussion; please use discuss-gnustep for that. - -The list is filtered to remove items meant for info-gnustep-request, that -can be answered by the moderator without bothering the list, or should -have been sent to another list. - -Do not report GNUstep bugs to info-gnustep, help-gnustep, or -discuss-gnustep, mail them to bug-gnustep@prep.ai.mit.edu instead. - -See section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -* bug-hurd-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-hurd -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.hurd.bug -** Hurd bug reports to: bug-hurd@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes bug reports for, fixes for bugs in, and -suggestions for improvements in the GNU Hurd to its active developers. - -No info-gnu-hurd list is planned. Announcements about the GNU Hurd will -be made to the list info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu (see above). - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* help-hurd-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to help-hurd -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.hurd.help -** Send contributions to: help-hurd@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is the place for users and installers of the GNU Hurd to ask -for help. - -No info-gnu-hurd list is planned. Announcements about the GNU Hurd will -be made to the list info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu (see above). - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. - -* hurd-ann-request@prep.ai.mit.edu IS NOW DEFUNCT -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NEVER EXISTED -** DEAD address: hurd-ann@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is dead. Announcements about the GNU Hurd will be made to the -list info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu (see above). - -* bug-gnu-emacs-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gnu-emacs -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.bug -** Gnu Emacs bug reports to: bug-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of GNU Emacs, bug -reports and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements in GNU Emacs. - -Send bugs in the GNU Emacs Lisp reference manual to: - lisp-manual-bugs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -lisp-manual-bugs is neither a mailing list nor a gnUSENET newsgroup. -It's just a bug-reporting address. - -Subscribers to bug-gnu-emacs get all info-gnu-emacs messages. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* gnu-emacs-sources-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to gnu-emacs-sources -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.sources -** Gnu Emacs source code to: gnu-emacs-sources@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list/newsgroup will be for the posting, by their authors, of Emacs -Lisp and C sources and patches that improve GNU Emacs. Its contents -will be reviewed by the FSF for inclusion in future releases of GNU -Emacs. - -Please do NOT discuss or request source code here. Use -help-gnu-emacs/gnu.emacs.help for those purposes. This allows the -automatic archiving of sources posted to this list/newsgroup. - -Please do NOT post such sources to any other GNU mailing list (e.g -help-gnu-emacs) or gnUSENET newsgroups (e.g. gnu.emacs.help). It's up -to each poster to decide whether to cross-post to any non-gnUSENET -newsgroup (e.g. comp.emacs or vmsnet.sources). - -Please do NOT announce that you have posted source code to -gnu.emacs.sources to any other GNU mailing list (e.g. help-gnu-emacs) or -gnUSENET newsgroups (e.g. gnu.emacs.help). People who want to keep up -with sources will read this list/newsgroup. It's up to each poster to -decide whether to announce a gnu.emacs.sources article in any -non-gnUSENET newsgroup (e.g. comp.emacs or comp.sources.d). - -If source or patches that were previously posted or a simple fix is -requested in help-gnu-emacs, please mail it to the requester. Do NOT -repost it. If you also want something that is requested, send mail to -the requester asking him to forward it to you. This kind of traffic is -best handled by e-mail, not by a broadcast medium that reaches millions -of sites. - -If the requested source is very long (>10k bytes) send mail offering to -send it. This prevents the requester from getting many redundant copies -and saves network bandwidth. - -* help-gnu-emacs-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to help-gnu-emacs -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.help (and one-way into comp.emacs) -** Send contributions to: help-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is the place for users and installers of GNU Emacs to ask for -help. Please send bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs instead of posting them -here. - -Since help-gnu-emacs is a very large list, send it only those items that -are seriously important to many people. - -If source or patches that were previously posted or a simple fix is -requested in help-gnu-emacs, please mail it to the requester. Do NOT -repost it. If you also want something that is requested, send mail to -the requester asking him to forward it to you. This kind of traffic is -best handled by e-mail, not a broadcast medium that reaches millions of -sites. - -This list is also gated one way to USENET's newsgroup comp.emacs (once -known as net.emacs). This one-way gating is done for users whose sites -get comp.emacs, but not gnu.emacs.help. Users at non-USENET sites may -receive all articles from comp.emacs by making their request to: -unix-emacs-request@bbn.com - -If Emacs crashes, or if you build Emacs following the standard procedure -on a system which Emacs is supposed to work on (see etc/MACHINES) and it -does not work at all, or if an editing command does not behave as it is -documented to behave, this is a bug. Don't send bug reports to -help-gnu-emacs (gnu.emacs.help) or post them to comp.emacs; mail them to -bug-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu instead. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. - -* info-gnu-emacs-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-gnu-emacs -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.announce (and one-way into comp.emacs) -** Send announcements to: info-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes announcements and progress reports on GNU Emacs. -It is NOT for general discussion; please use help-gnu-emacs for that. - -The list is filtered to remove items meant for info-gnu-emacs-request, -that can be answered by the moderator without bothering the list, or -should have been sent to another list. - -info-gnu-emacs is also gated one way to USENET's newsgroup comp.emacs -(once known as net.emacs). This one-way gating is done for users whose -sites get comp.emacs, but not gnu.emacs.announce. Users at non-USENET -sites may receive all articles from comp.emacs by making their request -to: unix-emacs-request@bbn.com - -Do not report GNU Emacs bugs to info-gnu-emacs or comp.emacs, instead -mail them to bug-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu. - -See section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -* vms-gnu-emacs-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.vms -** Send contributions to: vms-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list was a working group who did the initial port of GNU Emacs to -the VMS operating system. It still discusses problems and solutions to -the VMS port and the distribution of it. - -* bug-bash-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-bash -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.bash.bug -** BASH bug reports to: bug-bash@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of BASH (the Bourne -Again SHell), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions for -improvements in BASH. User discussion of BASH also occurs here. - -Always report the version number of the operating system, hardware, and -bash (flag -version on startup or check the variable $BASH_VERSION in a -running bash). - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for BASH. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-gdb-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gdb -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gdb.bug -** GDB bug reports to: bug-gdb@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of GDB (Gnu's -DeBugger), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements -in GDB. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for GDB. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-octave-request@che.utexas.edu to subscribe to bug-octave -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Octave bug reports to: bug-octave@che.utexas.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of Octave (a system -for numerical computations), bug reports and fixes for, and -suggestions for improvements to Octave. - -The help-octave mailing list is for user discussion of Octave. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - - -* help-octave-request@che.utexas.edu to subscribe to help-octave -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Send contributions to: help-octave@che.utexas.edu - -This list is the place for users and installers of Octave to ask for -help. Please send bug reports to bug-octave instead of posting them -here. - -If Octave crashes, or if you build Octave following the standard -procedure on a system on which Octave is supposed to work on and it -does not work at all, or if a command does not behave as it is -documented to behave, this is a bug. Don't send bug reports to -help-octave; mail them to bug-octave@che.utexas.edu instead. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. +xemacs-beta@xemacs.org XEmacs Beta Testers. -* bug-gcc-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gcc -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gcc.bug -** GCC bug reports to: bug-gcc@prep.ai.mit.edu + xemacs-beta is an open list for bug reports and general + communication about beta versions of XEmacs. -This list distributes bug reports for, fixes for bugs in, and -suggestions for improvements in the GNU C Compiler to its active -developers. +xemacs-build-reports@xemacs.org XEmacs Build Report Submissions. + + xemacs-build-reports is an open list for submission of build-reports + on beta versions of XEmacs. For information on what the + build-reports should contain, please see the `etc/BETA' file which + is included in each beta distribution. -Please don't send in a patch without a test case to illustrate the -problem the patch is supposed to fix. Sometimes the patches aren't -correct or aren't the best way to do the job, and without a test case -there is no way to debug an alternate fix. +xemacs-cvs@xemacs.org XEmacs CVS Commit Notices. -The most convenient form of test case is a piece of cpp output that can -be passed directly to cc1. Preferably written in C, not C++ or -Objective C. + xemacs-cvs is a read-only list for notices and information on what + has been committed to the XEmacs CVS trees, by whom, and for + what. (For more information on the XEmacs CVS Archive: + http://cvs.xemacs.org/.) -Subscribers to bug-gcc get all info-gcc messages. +xemacs-mule@xemacs.org XEmacs International Extensions. -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. + xemacs-mule is an open mailing list for discussion of International + extensions to XEmacs including Mule, XIM, I18n issues, etc, and is + not confined to developmental issues. This list is not restricted + to English, postings in all languages are welcome. -* help-gcc-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to help-gcc -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gcc.help -** Send contributions to: help-gcc@prep.ai.mit.edu +xemacs-nt@xemacs.org XEmacs on Windows NT/98/95. -This list is the place for users and installers of the GNU C Compiler to -ask for help. + xemacs-nt is a developer's only mailing list and is intended for + people who wish to work actively on the porting of XEmacs to + Microsoft Windows NT and Microsoft Windows 98/95. -If gcc crashes, or if you build gcc following the standard procedure on -a system which gcc is supposed to work on (see config.sub) and it does -not work at all, or if an command line option does not behave as it is -documented to behave, this is a bug. Don't send bug reports to help-gcc -(gnu.gcc.help); mail them to bug-gcc@prep.ai.mit.edu instead. +xemacs-patches@xemacs.org XEmacs Patch Submissions. -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. + xemacs-patches is an open, moderated list for submission of patches + to the XEmacs distribution and its packages. Anyone may subscribe or + submit to xemacs-patches, but all submissions are reviewed by the + list moderator before they are distributed to the list. Discussion + is not appropriate on xemacs-patches. -* info-gcc-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-gcc -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gcc.announce -** Send announcements to: info-gcc@prep.ai.mit.edu +xemacs-users-ja@xemacs.org XEmacs (Japanese). -This list distributes announcements and progress reports on the GNU C -Compiler. It is NOT for general discussion; please use help-gcc for -that. + xemacs-users-ja is an open list for discussion and bug reporting for + XEmacs. Japanese is the preferred language of discussion. It is not + gated to comp.emacs.xemacs or the xemacs list. For fastest + response, bugs not specifically related to Japanese or Mule features + should be reported on xemacs (in English). -The list is filtered to remove items meant for info-gcc-request, that -can be answered by the moderator without bothering the list, or should -have been sent to another list. +xemacs-beta-ja@xemacs.org XEmacs Beta (Japanese). -See section '* General Information about info-* lists'. + xemacs-beta-ja is an open list for bug reports and general + communication about beta versions of XEmacs, especially features + related to Mule and Japanese-handling. Japanese is the preferred + language of discussion. Bugs not specifically related to Japanese or + Mule features should be reported on xemacs-beta (in English). Please + consider sending bug reports on Mule to xemacs-mule, in English. -* bug-gnu960-request@ichips.intel.com to subscribe to bug-gnu960 -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Intel 960 Port bug reports to: bug-gnu960@ichips.intel.com +The most up to date information on the mailing lists can always be +found at http://www.xemacs.org/. -This list distributes bug reports for, fixes for bugs in, and -suggestions for improvements in Intel's port of GNU software to the -Intel 960 microprocessor. +Subscriptions: -You can also fax to: GNU/960 - 1-503-696-4930. +Subscription to all the lists is accomplished by sending an e-mail +message to LISTNAME-request@xemacs.org with `subscribe' (without the +quotes) as the BODY of the message. -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for Intel's -port of GNU software to the Intel 960 microprocessor. +To unsubscribe, send an e-mail to LISTNAME-request@xemacs.org with +`unsubscribe' (without the quotes) as the BODY of the message. -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. +List Archives: -* bug-glibc-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-glibc -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.glibc.bug -** GNU C Library bug reports to: bug-glibc@prep.ai.mit.edu +A browsable and searchable archive of these lists is available at +http://www.xemacs.org/list-archives/. -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of glibc (GNU's C -library), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements in -glibc. User discussion of glibc also occurs here. +Problems: -Announcements of new releases of glibc are made on both info-gcc and -bug-glibc. +Any comments, questions, or complaints about the lists should be +brought to the attention of the XEmacs Mailing List Manager +. -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for the GNU -C Library. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-g++-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-g++ -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.g++.bug -** G++ bug reports to: bug-g++@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes bug reports for, fixes for bugs in, and -suggestions for improvements in the GNU C++ Compiler to its active -developers. - -G++ uses the GNU C-Compiler back end. Active developers may wish to -subscribe to bug-gcc@prep.ai.mit.edu as well. - -Subscribers to bug-g++ get all info-g++ messages. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* help-g++-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to help-g++ -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.g++.help (and one-way into comp.lang.c++) -** Send contributions to: help-g++@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is the place for users and installers of the GNU C++ Compiler -to ask for help. Please send bug reports to bug-g++@prep.ai.mit.edu -instead of posting them here. - -help-g++ is also gated one way to USENET's newsgroup comp.lang.c++. -This one-way gating is done for users whose sites get comp.lang.c++, but -not gnu.g++.help. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. - -* info-g++-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-g++ -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.g++.announce (and one-way into comp.lang.c++) -** Send announcements to: info-g++@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes announcements and progress reports on the GNU C++ -Compiler. It is NOT for general discussion; please use help-g++ for -that. - -The list is filtered to remove items meant for info-g++-request, that -can be answered by the moderator without bothering the list, or should -have been sent to another list. - -It is also gated one way to USENET's newsgroup comp.lang.c++. This -one-way gating is done for users whose sites get comp.lang.c++, but not -gnu.g++.announce. - -Do not report g++ bugs to info-g++ or comp.lang.c++, mail them to -bug-g++@prep.ai.mit.edu instead. - -See section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -* bug-lib-g++-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-lib-g++ -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.g++.lib.bug -** lib-g++ bug reports to: bug-lib-g++@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of libg++ (GNU's -library for C++), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions for -improvements in lib-g++. User discussion of libg++ also occurs here. - -Announcements of new releases of libg++ are made on both info-g++ and -bug-lib-g++. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for GNU's -G++ Library. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* info-gnu-fortran-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-gnu-fortran -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE YET -** Send announcements to: info-gnu-fortran@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is for progress reports about the GNU Fortran compiler. In -the future it will also be used for release notices. - -The list is filtered to remove items meant for info-gnu-fortran-request, -that can be answered by the moderator without bothering the list, or -should have been sent to another list. - -People on the Internet can get a current status report by fingering the -address fortran@gnu.ai.mit.edu. - -See section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for GNU -Fortran (yet). - -* bug-oleo-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-oleo -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Oleo bug reports to: bug-oleo@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of Oleo (the GNU -spreadsheet), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions for -improvements to Oleo. User discussion of Oleo also occurs here. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for Oleo . - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-gmp-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gmp -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** gmp bug reports to: bug-gmp@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of gmp (the GNU -Multiple Precision Library), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions -for improvements to gmp. User discussion of gmp also occurs here. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for gmp . - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-pine-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-pine -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** pine bug reports to: bug-pine@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of pine (the GNU -version of the pine mail reader), bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions -for improvements to pine. User discussion of pine also occurs here. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for pine . - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-cfengine-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-cfengine -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.cfengine.bug -** cfengine bug reports to: bug-cfengine@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of cfengine (configure -BSD and System-5-like operating systems attached to a TCP/IP network), -bug reports and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements to cfengine. -User discussion of cfengine also occurs here. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* help-cfengine-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to help-cfengine -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.cfengine.help -** Send contributions to: help-cfengine@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is the place for users and installers of cfengine to ask for -help. Please send bug reports to bug-cfengine instead of posting them -here. - -This list is also used for announcements about cfengine and related -programs, and small but important patches. Announcements of cfengine -releases are also made to info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu (see above) - -Since help-cfengine is a large list, send it only those items that -are seriously important to many people. - -If source or patches that were previously posted or a simple fix is -requested in help-cfengine, please mail it to the requester. Do NOT -repost it. If you also want something that is requested, send mail to -the requester asking him to forward it to you. This kind of traffic is -best handled by e-mail, not a broadcast medium that reaches millions of -sites. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. -Also see section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -* bug-gnu-smalltalk-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gnu-smalltalk -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.smalltalk.bug -** GNU Smalltalk bug reports to: bug-gnu-smalltalk@prep.ai.mit.edu - -GNU Smalltalk is the GNU project implementation of the Smalltalk language. - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of GNU Smalltalk, bug -reports and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements to GNU -Smalltalk. User discussion of GNU Smalltalk also occurs here. - -For now, new releases of GNU Smalltalk will also be announced on this list. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for GNU -Smalltalk. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* st-next-request@laplace.eng.sun.com to subscribe to st-next -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Send contributions to: st-next@laplace.eng.sun.com - -For people interested in working on GNU Smalltalk on the NeXT. - -* bug-groff-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-groff -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.groff.bug -** GNU groff bug reports to: bug-groff@prep.ai.mit.edu - -groff is the GNU project implementation, in C++, of the traditional Unix -document formatting tools. - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of groff, bug reports -and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements to groff (and it -component programs). User discussion of groff also occurs here. - -For now, new releases of groff will also be announced on this list. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for groff. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-ghostscript-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-ghostscript -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.ghostscript.bug -** Ghostscript bug reports to: bug-ghostscript@prep.ai.mit.edu - -Ghostscript is the GNU project implementation of a language and graphics -library with a remarkable similarity to PostScript. - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of Ghostscript, bug -reports and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements in Ghostscript. - -For now, new releases of Ghostscript will also be announced on this list. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for -Ghostscript. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-gnu-utils-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gnu-utils -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.utils.bug -** GNU Utilities bug reports to: bug-gnu-utils@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes, to the active maintainers of these programs, bug -reports and fixes for, and suggestions for improvements in GNU programs -not covered by other bug-* mailing lists/gnu.*.bug newsgroups. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* help-gnu-utils-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to help-gnu-utils -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.utils.help -** Send contributions to: help-gnu-utils@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is the place for users and installers of GNU programs not -covered by other GNU mailing lists/gnu.* newsgroups to ask for help. - -Don't send bug reports to help-gnu-utils (gnu.utils.help); mail them to -bug-gnu-utils@prep.ai.mit.edu instead. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. - -* info-gnu-utils-request@prep.ai.mit.edu IS NOW DEFUNCT -** a gnUSENET newsgroup bever existed -** DEAD address: info-gnu-utils@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is dead. Announcements about GNU Utilities will be made to the -list info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu (see above). - -* info-cvs-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-cvs. -** USENET newsgroup: (none) -** CVS discussions/questions to: info-cvs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is for discussion and dissemination of information about -CVS. Please check the FAQ before posting questions, however. - -* bug-cvs-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-cvs. -** USENET newsgroup: (none) -** CVS bug reports to: bug-cvs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list distributes bug reports, fixes, and suggestions for -improvements to the maintainers of CVS. - -* bug-fortran-mode-request@erl.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-fortran-mode -** USENET newsgroup: (none) -** Fortran mode bug reports to: bug-fortran-mode@erl.mit.edu - -This list collects bug reports, fixes for bugs, and suggestions for -improvements in GNU Emacs's Fortran mode (a major mode to support -editing Fortran source code). - -It is the place to report Fortran mode bugs by all users of Fortran -mode. - -Always report the version number Fortran mode reports on startup as well -as the version of Emacs. - -There is no info-fortran-mode list. There are no USENET gateways to -bug-fortran-mode at this time. - -* info-gnus-request@flab.fujitsu.co.jp to subscribe -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE YET -** Send contributions to: info-gnus@flab.fujitsu.co.jp - -The list is intended to exchange useful information about GNUS, such as -bug reports, useful hooks, and extensions of GNUS. GNUS is an NNTP-base -network news reader for GNU Emacs (which also works with a news spool). -English and Japanese are the official languages of the list. GNUS is -quite different than gnews. - -* info-gnus-english-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.gnus -** Send contributions to: info-gnus-english@prep.ai.mit.edu - -The list has the same charter as info-gnus. The difference is that -English is the only official language of the list. - -info-gnus-english/gnu.emacs.gnus is forward to info-gnus, but NOT -vice-versa. - -* info-gnews-request@ics.uci.edu to subscribe to info-gnews -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.gnews -** Send contributions to: info-gnews@ics.uci.edu - -This newsgroup is intended to exchange useful information about gnews, -such as bug reports, useful hooks, and extensions of gnews. gnews is an -NNTP-base network news reader for GNU Emacs (which also works a news -spool). It is quite different than GNUS. - -* gnu-emacs-ada-request@grebyn.com to subscribe to gnu-emacs-ada -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Gnu Emacs Ada support bug reports to: gnu-emacs-ada@grebyn.com - -This list distributes bug reports for, fixes for bugs in, and -suggestions for improvements in GNU Emacs' editing support of the Ada -programming language. - -There are no other GNU mailing lists or gnUSENET newsgroups for GNU -Emacs' editing support of Ada. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* bug-vm-request@uunet.uu.net to subscribe to bug-vm -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.vm.bug -** VM mail reader bug reports to: bug-vm@uunet.uu.net - -This list discusses bugs in View Mail mode for GNU Emacs, with an -emphasis on beta and prerelease versions. - -Always report the version number of VM you are using, as well as the -version of Emacs you're running. If you believe it is significant, -report the operating system used and the hardware. - -Subscribers to bug-vm get all info-vm messages. - -* info-vm-request@uunet.uu.net to subscribe to info-vm -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.emacs.vm.info -** Send contributions to: info-vm@uunet.uu.net - -This list discusses the View Mail mode for GNU Emacs, an alternative to -rmail mode. - -* supercite-request@warsaw.nlm.nih.gov to subscribe to supercite -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Send articles to: supercite@warsaw.nlm.nih.gov -*** UUCP: ..!uunet!warsaw.nlm.nih.gov!supercite-request - -The supercite mailing list covers issues related to the advanced -mail/news citation package called Supercite for GNU Emacs. - -* auc-tex-request@iesd.auc.dk to subscribe -** USENET newsgroup: NONE YET -** Send contributions to: auc-tex@iesd.auc.dk - -The list is intended to exchange information about AUC TeX, such as -bug reports, request for help, and information on current -developments. AUC TeX is a much enhanced LaTeX mode for GNU Emacs. - -The list is unmoderated. - -* bug-gnu-chess-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gnu-chess -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.chess.bug -** GNU Chess bug reports to: bug-gnu-chess@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list directly accesses the GNU Chess developer's group. If you -have a *BUG* to report about the program, which can also include a -feature enhancement request, please send it to this list. - -Subscribers to bug-gnu-chess get all info-gnu-chess messages. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -* help-gnu-chess-request@prep.ai.mit.edu IS NOW DEFUNCT -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** DEAD address: help-gnu-chess@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is dead. Use info-gnu-chess@prep.ai.mit.edu/gnu.chess instead. - -* info-gnu-chess-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-gnu-chess -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.chess -** Send contributions to: info-gnu-chess@prep.ai.mit.edu -** FAQ-URL: http://www.research.digital.com/SRC/personal/Tim_Mann/chess.html -** FAQ-Archive-name: games/chess/gnu-faq -** FAQ-Posting-frequency: monthly - -This list is the place for users and installers of GNU Chess to ask for -help. This list is also used for games played by people or other -entities against the program, and other generalized non-bug, -non-enhancement data. Please send bug reports to bug-gnu-chess instead -of posting them here. - -This list is also used for announcements about GNU Chess and related -programs, and small but important patches. Announcements of GNU Chess -releases are also made to info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu (see above) - -Since info-gnu-chess is a large list, send it only those items that -are seriously important to many people. - -If source or patches that were previously posted or a simple fix is -requested in info-gnu-chess, please mail it to the requester. Do NOT -repost it. If you also want something that is requested, send mail to -the requester asking him to forward it to you. This kind of traffic is -best handled by e-mail, not a broadcast medium that reaches millions of -sites. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. -Also see section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -* bug-gnu-shogi-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to bug-gnu-shogi -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** GNU Shogi bug reports to: bug-gnu-shogi@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list directly accesses the GNU Shogi developer's group. If you -have a *BUG* to report about the program, which can also include a -feature enhancement request, please send it to this list. - -Subscribers to bug-gnu-shogi get all info-gnu-shogi messages. - -See section '* General Information about bug-* lists and reporting -program bugs'. - -Shogi is a game something like chess. There are several different types -of pieces, a board that is 9 by 9 squares, and the modification that a -captured piece can be reintroduced on the board by the capturing player -(and used). Due to this last difference from Western chess, a Shogi -game never simplifies. - -* help-gnu-shogi-request@prep.ai.mit.edu IS NOW DEFUNCT -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** DEAD address: help-gnu-shogi@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is dead. - -* info-gnu-shogi-request@prep.ai.mit.edu to subscribe to info-gnu-shogi -** gnUSENET newsgroup: NONE PLANNED -** Send contributions to: info-gnu-shogi@prep.ai.mit.edu - -This list is the place for users and installers of GNU Shogi to ask for -help. This list is also used for games played by people or other -entities against the program, and other generalized non-bug, -non-enhancement data. Please send bug reports to bug-gnu-shogi instead -of posting them here. - -This list is also used for announcements about GNU Shogi and related -programs, and small but important patches. Announcements of GNU Shogi -releases are also made to info-gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu (see above) - -Since info-gnu-shogi is a large list, send it only those items that -are seriously important to many people. - -If source or patches that were previously posted or a simple fix is -requested in info-gnu-shogi, please mail it to the requester. Do NOT -repost it. If you also want something that is requested, send mail to -the requester asking him to forward it to you. This kind of traffic is -best handled by e-mail, not a broadcast medium that reaches millions of -sites. - -See section '* General Information about help-* lists'. -Also see section '* General Information about info-* lists'. - -* gnu-manual-request@a.cs.uiuc.edu IS NOW DEFUNCT -** DEAD: Gnusenet newsgroup: gnu.emacs.lisp.manual -** DEAD address: gnu-manual@a.cs.uiuc.edu -*** DEAD UUCP address: ..!uunet!uiucdcs!gnu-manual-request - -This list and newsgroup is dead. It was a working group whose -volunteers wrote, proofread and commented on the developing GNU Emacs -Lisp programmers manual. - -Send bugs in the GNU Emacs Lisp reference manual to: - lisp-manual-bugs@prep.ai.mit.edu - -lisp-manual-bugs is neither a mailing list nor a gnUSENET newsgroup. -It's just a bug-reporting address. - -* no mailing list request -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gnusenet.config -** no mailing list - -This newsgroup has nothing to do with GNU software, especially its -configuration. It exists to distribute information about the -administration and configuration of gnUSENET: the gnu.all alternative -USENET hierarchy that carry the GNU mailing lists. +----------------------------------------------------------------------- -Administrators of gnUSENET hosts receiving the gnu.all newsgroups are -welcome to ask questions here or via e-mail of gnu@prep.ai.mit.edu. + GNU Project Electronic Mailing Lists and gnUSENET Newsgroups: -* no mailing list request -** gnUSENET newsgroup: gnu.gnusenet.test -** no mailing list +The XEmacs project is separate from and not managed by the GNU +project. The latest information about the GNU project mailing lists +can be found at ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/GNUinfo/MAILINGLISTS -This newsgroup has nothing to do with GNU software, especially its -testing. It exists to allow test messages to be made in gnUSENET: the -gnu.all alternative USENET hierarchy that carry the GNU mailing lists. +Please do NOT send messages about problems with XEmacs to the FSF GNU +Emacs newsgroups and mailing lists unless you are sure that the +problem you are reporting is a problem with both versions of GNU +Emacs. People who aren't subscribed to the XEmacs mailing list most +likely are not interested in hearing about problems with it. -Local variables: -mode: outline -fill-column: 72 -End: diff --git a/etc/NEWS b/etc/NEWS index 0e7ab45..7267c67 100644 --- a/etc/NEWS +++ b/etc/NEWS @@ -124,6 +124,9 @@ buffer. As a side effect subwindow support now works once again. This support is currently only available under MS-Windows. +** XEmacs can now play sound using Enlightenment Sound Daemon (ESD). +It will try NAS first, then ESD, then playing native sound directly. + ** X-Face support is now available under MS-Windows. If an X-Face libary built under MS-Windows is available then XEmacs will use this at build time. @@ -150,6 +153,40 @@ Moreover, -user (which used to only work in unpredictable ways) is now equivalent to -user-init-file ~/.emacs -user-init-directory ~/.xemacs. +** Etags changes. + +*** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c. + +*** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now +possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with +{lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out. +This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains +a regular expression. The manual contains details. + +*** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function +declarations when given the --declarations option. + +*** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form +"operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator. + +*** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and +types. + +*** In Fortran, procedure is no more tagged. + +*** In Java, tags are created for "interface". + +*** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs +are now tagged. + +*** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local +variables are tagged. + +*** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags. + +*** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is +for PSWrap. + * Lisp and internal changes in XEmacs 21.2 ========================================== @@ -236,15 +273,21 @@ Except that SUFFIXES are now a list of strings instead of a single, colon-separated string. MODE is now a symbol or a list of symbols (symbols `exists', `executable', `writable', and `readable' are supported) instead of an integer code. See the documentation for -details. +details. Of course, the old form is still accepted for backward +compatibility. -Of course, the old form is still accepted for backward compatibility. +Several bugs in locate-file have been fixed, most notably its failure +to call expand-file-name on elements of PATH-LIST. Because of that +elements of load-path of the form "~/..." used to not work. +locate-file is now guaranteed to expand files during its course of +operation. ** `translate-region' has been improved in several ways. Its TABLE argument used to be a 256-character string. In addition to this, it -can now also be a vector or a char-table (which is useful for Mule.) -If TABLE a vector or a generic char-table, you can map characters to -strings instead of to other characters. For instance: +can now also be a vector or a char-table, which makes the function +useful for Mule, which it wasn't. If TABLE a vector or a generic +char-table, you can map characters to strings instead of to other +characters. For instance: (let ((table (make-char-table 'generic))) (put-char-table ?a "the letter a" table) diff --git a/etc/OONEWS b/etc/OONEWS index 56e72d7..57b3174 100644 --- a/etc/OONEWS +++ b/etc/OONEWS @@ -2403,7 +2403,7 @@ source; if you're going to use this, you'd better be able to. *** utils/bench.el Commentary: -Adapted from Shane Holder's bench.el by steve@altair.xemacs.org. +Adapted from Shane Holder's bench.el by steve@xemacs.org. To run Extract the shar file in /tmp, or modify bench-lisp-file to diff --git a/etc/README.HYPERBOLE b/etc/README.HYPERBOLE index b1e8e63..5b0fd2e 100644 --- a/etc/README.HYPERBOLE +++ b/etc/README.HYPERBOLE @@ -2,5 +2,5 @@ Hyperbole is a suite of tools for enhancing productivity. The latest working version of this package with major enhancements is available together with professional support exclusively from their -developer, Altrasoft Inc. See http://www.altrasoft.com for product +developer, BeOpen Inc. See http://www.beopen.com for product and service details. diff --git a/etc/README.OO-BROWSER b/etc/README.OO-BROWSER index f572fab..f480ee4 100644 --- a/etc/README.OO-BROWSER +++ b/etc/README.OO-BROWSER @@ -2,5 +2,5 @@ The OO-Browser is a tool for examining object oriented code. The latest working version of this package with major enhancements is available together with professional support exclusively from their -developer, Altrasoft Inc. See http://www.altrasoft.com for product +developer, BeOpen Inc. See http://www.beopen.com for product and service details. diff --git a/etc/SERVICE b/etc/SERVICE index 9219b24..b54b83f 100644 --- a/etc/SERVICE +++ b/etc/SERVICE @@ -40,13 +40,13 @@ For a current copy of this directory, or to have yourself listed, ask: ** Please keep the entries in this file alphabetical **  -Altrasoft +BeOpen 4880 Stevens Creek Blvd., Suite 205 San Jose, CA 95129-1034 +1 408 243 3300 -http://www.altrasoft.com +http://www.beopen.com -Altrasoft provides corporate-quality support, development and user +BeOpen provides corporate-quality support, development and user documentation for GNU Emacs, XEmacs and InfoDock. (InfoDock is a turnkey information management and software development toolset built atop emacs, written by one of our associates.) Emacs distributions for a variety of diff --git a/etc/aliases.ksh b/etc/aliases.ksh index 90c0e70..a45d60d 100755 --- a/etc/aliases.ksh +++ b/etc/aliases.ksh @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ # Shortcuts for sh-derived Unix shells (ksh, zsh, bash) -# From Steve Baur +# From Steve Baur # Run temacs as XEmacs function runtemacs { diff --git a/etc/editclient.sh b/etc/editclient.sh index 8e1c9b7..99152dd 100644 --- a/etc/editclient.sh +++ b/etc/editclient.sh @@ -1,6 +1,5 @@ #!/bin/sh -if gnuclient -batch -eval t >/dev/null 2>&1 -then +if gnuclient -batch -eval t >/dev/null 2>&1; then exec gnuclient ${1+"$@"} else xemacs -unmapped -f gnuserv-start & diff --git a/etc/etags.1 b/etc/etags.1 index 2a6c375..735b187 100644 --- a/etc/etags.1 +++ b/etc/etags.1 @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ .\" Copyright (c) 1992 Free Software Foundation .\" See section COPYING for conditions for redistribution -.TH etags 1 "19apr1994" "GNU Tools" "GNU Tools" +.TH etags 1 "02nov1999" "GNU Tools" "GNU Tools" .de BP .sp .ti -.2i @@ -12,24 +12,33 @@ etags, ctags \- generate tag file for Emacs, vi .SH SYNOPSIS .hy 0 .na -.B etags [\|\-aCDRSVh\|] [\|\-i \fIfile\fP\|] [\|\-l \fIlanguage\fP\|] [\|\-i \fIregexp\fP\|] [\|\-o \fItagfile\fP\|] +.B etags [\|\-aCDGImRVh\|] [\|\-i \fIfile\fP\|] [\|\-l \fIlanguage\fP\|] +.if n .br +.B [\|\-o \fItagfile\fP\|] [\|\-r \fIregexp\fP\|] .br -[\|\-\-c++\|] [\|\-\-no\-defines\|] [\|\-\-ignore\-indentation\|] -[\|\-\-language=\fIlanguage\fP\|] [\|\-\-regex=\fIregexp\fP\|] -[\|\-\-no\-regexp\|] [\|\-\-help\|] [\|\-\-version\|] -[\|\-\-include=\fIfile\fP\|] [\|\-\-output=\fItagfile\fP\|] -[\|\-\-append\|] \fIfile\fP .\|.\|. +[\|\-\-append\|] [\|\-\-c++\|] [\|\-\-no\-defines\|] +[\|\-\-no\-globals\|] [\|\-\-include=\fIfile\fP\|] +[\|\-\-ignore\-indentation\|] [\|\-\-language=\fIlanguage\fP\|] +[\|\-\-members\|] [\|\-\-output=\fItagfile\fP\|] +[\|\-\-regex=\fIregexp\fP\|] [\|\-\-no\-regex\|] +[\|\-\-ignore\-case\-regex=\fIregexp\fP\|] +[\|\-\-help\|] [\|\-\-version\|] +\fIfile\fP .\|.\|. -.B ctags [\|\-aCdRSVh\|] [\|\-BtTuvwx\|] [\|\-l \fIlanguage\fP\|] +.B ctags [\|\-aCdgImRVh\|] [\|\-BtTuvwx\|] [\|\-l \fIlanguage\fP\|] +.if n .br +.B [\|\-o \fItagfile\fP\|] [\|\-r \fIregexp\fP\|] .br -[\|\-i \fIregexp\fP\|] [\|\-o \fItagfile\fP\|] -[\|\-\-c++\|] [\|\-\-defines\|] [\|\-\-ignore\-indentation\|] -[\|\-\-no\-warn\|] [\|\-\-cxref\|] [\|\-\-backward\-search\|] -[\|\-\-forward\-search\|] [\|\-\-typedefs\|] [\|\-\-typedefs\-and\-c++\|] -[\|\-\-language=\fIlanguage\fP\|] [\|\-\-regex=\fIregexp\fP\|] +[\|\-\-append\|] [\|\-\-backward\-search\|] [\|\-\-c++\|] +[\|\-\-cxref\|] [\|\-\-defines\|] [\|\-\-forward\-search\|] +[\|\-\-globals\|] [\|\-\-ignore\-indentation\|] +[\|\-\-language=\fIlanguage\fP\|] [\|\-\-members\|] +[\|\-\-output=\fItagfile\fP\|] [\|\-\-regex=\fIregexp\fP\|] +[\|\-\-ignore\-case\-regex=\fIregexp\fP\|] +[\|\-\-typedefs\|] [\|\-\-typedefs\-and\-c++\|] +[\|\-\-update\|] [\|\-\-no\-warn\|] [\|\-\-help\|] [\|\-\-version\|] -.br -[\|\-\-output=\fItagfile\fP\|] [\|\-\-append\|] [\|\-\-update\|] \fIfile\fP .\|.\|. +\fIfile\fP .\|.\|. .ad b .hy 1 .SH DESCRIPTION @@ -40,8 +49,8 @@ understood by format understood by .BR vi ( 1 )\c \&. Both forms of the program understand -the syntax of C, Objective C, C++, Java, Fortran, Pascal, Cobol, -LaTeX, Scheme, Emacs Lisp/Common Lisp, Postscript, Erlang, Prolog and +the syntax of C, Objective C, C++, Java, Fortran, Pascal, Cobol, Ada, Perl, +LaTeX, Scheme, Emacs Lisp/Common Lisp, Postscript, Erlang, Python, Prolog and most assembler\-like syntaxes. Both forms read the files specified on the command line, and write a tag table (defaults: `\|TAGS\|' for \fBetags\fP, `\|tags\|' for @@ -77,18 +86,39 @@ Treat files with `\|.c\|' and `\|.h\|' extensions as C++ code, not C code. Files with `\|.C\|', `\|.H\|', `\|.cxx\|', `\|.hxx\|', or `\|.cc\|' extensions are always assumed to be C++ code. .TP +.B \-\-declarations +In C and derived languages, create tags for function declarations, +and create tags for extern variables unless \-\-no\-globals is used. +.TP .B \-d, \-\-defines -Create tag entries for C preprocessor constant definitions +Create tag entries for C preprocessor constant definitions and enum constants, too. This is the -default behavior for \fBetags\fP, so this option is only accepted -by \fBctags\fP. +default behavior for \fBetags\fP. .TP .B \-D, \-\-no\-defines Do not create tag entries for C preprocessor constant definitions and enum constants. This may make the tags file much smaller if many header files are tagged. -This is the default behavior for \fBctags\fP, so this option is only -accepted by \fBetags\fP. +This is the default behavior for \fBctags\fP. +.TP +.B \-g, \-\-globals +Create tag entries for global variables in C, C++, Objective C, Java, +and Perl. +This is the default behavior for \fBetags\fP. +.TP +.B \-G, \-\-no\-globals +Do not tag global variables. Typically this reduces the file size by +one fourth. This is the default behavior for \fBctags\fP. +.TP +\fB\-i\fP \fIfile\fP, \fB\-\-include=\fIfile\fP +Include a note in the tag file indicating that, when searching for a +tag, one should also consult the tags file \fIfile\fP after checking the +current file. This options is only accepted by \fBetags\fP. +.TP +.B \-I, \-\-ignore\-indentation +Don't rely on indentation as much as we normally do. Currently, this +means not to assume that a closing brace in the first column is the +final brace of a function or structure definition in C and C++. .TP \fB\-l\fP \fIlanguage\fP, \fB\-\-language=\fIlanguage\fP Parse the following files according to the given language. More than @@ -99,27 +129,30 @@ detection of language based on filename extension. The `none' language may be used to disable language parsing altogether; only regexp matching is done in this case (see the \fB\-\-regex\fP option). .TP -\fB\-\-no_globals\fP -Do not tag global variables in C, C++, Objective C, Java. Typically -this reduces the file size by one fourth. +.B \-m, \-\-members +Create tag entries for variables that are members of structure-like +constructs in C++, Objective C, Java. .TP -\fB\-\-members\fP -Tag variables that are members of strucure-like constructs in C++, -Objective C, Java. +.B \-M, \-\-no\-members +Do not tag member variables. This is the default behavior. +.TP +.B \-\-packages\-only +Only tag packages in Ada files. .TP \fB\-o\fP \fItagfile\fP, \fB\-\-output=\fItagfile\fP Explicit name of file for tag table; overrides default `\|TAGS\|' or `\|tags\|'. (But ignored with \fB\-v\fP or \fB\-x\fP.) .TP \fB\-r\fP \fIregexp\fP, \fB\-\-regex=\fIregexp\fP -Make tags based on regexp matching for each line of the files -following this option, in addition to the tags made with the standard -parsing based on language. May be freely intermixed with filenames -and the \fB\-R\fP option. The regexps are cumulative, i.e. each -option will add to the previous ones. The regexps are of the form: +\fB\-\-ignore\-case\-regex=\fIregexp\fP\ +Make tags based on regexp matching for each line of the files following +this option, in addition to the tags made with the standard parsing based +on language. When using \-\-regex, case is significant, while it is not +with \-\-ignore\-case\-regex. May be freely intermixed with filenames and +the \fB\-R\fP option. The regexps are cumulative, i.e. each option will +add to the previous ones. The regexps are of the form: .br - - \fB/\fP\fItagregexp\fP[\fB/\fP\fInameregexp\fP]\fB/\fP + \fB/\fP\fItagregexp\fP[\fB/\fP\fInameregexp\fP]\fB/\fP .br where \fItagregexp\fP is used to match the lines that must be tagged. @@ -127,8 +160,8 @@ It should not match useless characters. If the match is such that more characters than needed are unavoidably matched by \fItagregexp\fP, it may be useful to add a \fInameregexp\fP, to narrow down the tag scope. \fBctags\fP ignores regexps without a -\fInameregexp\fP. The syntax of regexps is the same as in emacs, -augmented with intervals of the form \\{m,n\\}, as id ed or grep. +\fInameregexp\fP. The syntax of regexps is the same as in emacs, +augmented with intervals of the form \\{m,n\\}, as in ed or grep. .br Here are some examples. All the regexps are quoted to protect them from shell interpretation. @@ -152,16 +185,25 @@ Tag TCL files (this last example shows the usage of a \fItagregexp\fP): .br \fI\-\-lang\=none \-\-regex\='/proc[\ \\t]+\\([^\ \\t]+\\)/\\1/'\fP +.br +A regexp can be preceded by {lang}, thus restriciting it to match lines of +files of the specified language. Use \fBetags --help\bP to obtain a list +of the recognised languages. This feature is particularly useful inside +\fBregex files\fB. A regex file contains one regex per line. Empty lines, +and those lines beginning with space or tab are ignored. Lines beginning +with @ are references to regex files whose name follows the @ sign. Other +lines are considered regular expressions like those following \-\-regex. +.br +For example, the command +.br +etags \-\-regex=@regex.file *.c +.br +reads the regexes contained in the file regex.file. .TP .B \-R, \-\-no\-regex Don't do any more regexp matching on the following files. May be freely intermixed with filenames and the \fB\-\-regex\fP option. .TP -.B \-S, \-\-ignore\-indentation -Don't rely on indentation as much as we normally do. Currently, this -means not to assume that a closing brace in the first column is the -final brace of a function or structure definition in C and C++. -.TP .B \-t, \-\-typedefs Record typedefs in C code as tags. Since this is the default behaviour of \fBetags\fP, only \fBctags\fP accepts this option. @@ -192,7 +234,7 @@ allowed with it. Instead of generating a tag file, write a cross reference (in \fBcxref\fP format) to standard output. Only \fBctags\fP accepts this option. .TP -.B \-H, \-\-help +.B \-h, \-H, \-\-help Print usage information. .TP .B \-V, \-\-version @@ -209,7 +251,7 @@ Stallman. .BR vi ( 1 ). .SH COPYING -Copyright (c) 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +Copyright (c) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. .PP Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice diff --git a/etc/gnuserv.1 b/etc/gnuserv.1 index f87359f..781d24e 100644 --- a/etc/gnuserv.1 +++ b/etc/gnuserv.1 @@ -291,4 +291,4 @@ Andy Norman (ange@hplb.hpl.hp.com), based heavily upon etc/emacsclient.c, etc/server.c and lisp/server.el from the GNU Emacs 18.52 distribution. Various modifications from Bob Weiner (weiner@mot.com), Darrell Kindred (dkindred@cmu.edu), Arup Mukherjee (arup@cmu.edu), Ben -Wing (ben@xemacs.org) and Hrvoje Niksic (hniksic@srce.hr). +Wing (ben@xemacs.org) and Hrvoje Niksic (hniksic@xemacs.org). diff --git a/etc/package-index.LATEST.pgp b/etc/package-index.LATEST.pgp index 6feef5a..3464c72 100644 --- a/etc/package-index.LATEST.pgp +++ b/etc/package-index.LATEST.pgp @@ -120,7 +120,7 @@ Hash: SHA1 author-version "10.38" date "1999-05-18" build-date "1999-07-30" - maintainer "SL Baur " + maintainer "SL Baur " distribution mule priority medium category "mule" @@ -230,7 +230,7 @@ Hash: SHA1 author-version "21.1" date "1999-06-30" build-date "1999-07-30" - maintainer "SL Baur " + maintainer "SL Baur " distribution mule priority high category "mule" diff --git a/etc/sample.Xdefaults b/etc/sample.Xdefaults index 52199e8..71151aa 100644 --- a/etc/sample.Xdefaults +++ b/etc/sample.Xdefaults @@ -75,6 +75,13 @@ Emacs*dialog*XmList*Background: WhiteSmoke ! While this one is for Athena dialog boxes. Emacs*dialog*Command*Background: WhiteSmoke +! Athena dialog boxes are sometimes built with the Xaw3d +! variant of the Athena toolkit. +! XEmacs being nice to 8bit displays, it defaults to: +Emacs*dialog*Command*beNiceToColormap: true +! If you are shocked by the ugliness of the 3d rendition, +! you may want to set (even on 8bit displays) the above to false. + ! Xlw Scrollbar colors Emacs*XlwScrollBar.Foreground: Gray30 Emacs*XlwScrollBar.Background: Gray75 diff --git a/etc/xemacs.1 b/etc/xemacs.1 index e86dce2..c912a1c 100644 --- a/etc/xemacs.1 +++ b/etc/xemacs.1 @@ -742,10 +742,10 @@ was written by Steve Baur , Martin Buchholz , Richard Mlynarik , -Hrvoje Niksic , +Hrvoje Niksic , Chuck Thompson , -Ben Wing , -Jamie Zawinski , +Ben Wing , +Jamie Zawinski , and many others. It was based on an early version of .I GNU Emacs Version diff --git a/info/cl.info b/info/cl.info index 06f1c56..fdd0642 100644 --- a/info/cl.info +++ b/info/cl.info @@ -1,5 +1,4 @@ -This is Info file ../info/cl.info, produced by Makeinfo version 1.68 -from the input file cl.texi. +This is ../info/cl.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from cl.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -29,79 +28,79 @@ the original English.  Indirect: -cl.info-1: 1190 -cl.info-2: 46365 -cl.info-3: 89150 -cl.info-4: 138909 -cl.info-5: 176907 -cl.info-6: 219515 +cl.info-1: 1164 +cl.info-2: 46335 +cl.info-3: 89116 +cl.info-4: 138874 +cl.info-5: 176870 +cl.info-6: 219475  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top1190 -Node: Overview2742 -Node: Usage5021 -Node: Organization5671 -Node: Installation7494 -Node: Naming Conventions8647 -Node: Program Structure10786 -Node: Argument Lists11254 -Node: Time of Evaluation21039 -Node: Function Aliases27019 -Node: Predicates27603 -Node: Type Predicates27923 -Node: Equality Predicates32966 -Node: Control Structure35742 -Node: Assignment36546 -Node: Generalized Variables37788 -Node: Basic Setf39095 -Node: Modify Macros46365 -Node: Customizing Setf53575 -Node: Variable Bindings60865 -Node: Dynamic Bindings61446 -Node: Lexical Bindings62336 -Node: Function Bindings66440 -Node: Macro Bindings68827 -Node: Conditionals71751 -Node: Blocks and Exits74834 -Node: Iteration77890 -Node: Loop Facility83364 -Node: Loop Basics84291 -Node: Loop Examples86891 -Node: For Clauses89150 -Node: Iteration Clauses101028 -Node: Accumulation Clauses102869 -Node: Other Clauses105213 -Node: Multiple Values111282 -Node: Macros113175 -Node: Declarations116393 -Node: Symbols124885 -Node: Property Lists125185 -Node: Creating Symbols128386 -Node: Numbers130464 -Node: Predicates on Numbers130944 -Node: Numerical Functions131973 -Node: Random Numbers136200 -Node: Implementation Parameters138909 -Node: Sequences142481 -Node: Sequence Basics143154 -Node: Mapping over Sequences146733 -Node: Sequence Functions152587 -Node: Searching Sequences158762 -Node: Sorting Sequences161800 -Node: Lists164348 -Node: List Functions164773 -Node: Substitution of Expressions169036 -Node: Lists as Sets170922 -Node: Association Lists174984 -Node: Hash Tables176687 -Node: Structures176907 -Node: Assertions191690 -Node: Efficiency Concerns194633 -Node: Common Lisp Compatibility200960 -Node: Old CL Compatibility204118 -Node: Porting Common Lisp208501 -Node: Function Index219515 -Node: Variable Index230778 +Node: Top1164 +Node: Overview2716 +Node: Usage4995 +Node: Organization5645 +Node: Installation7468 +Node: Naming Conventions8621 +Node: Program Structure10760 +Node: Argument Lists11228 +Node: Time of Evaluation21011 +Node: Function Aliases26991 +Node: Predicates27575 +Node: Type Predicates27895 +Node: Equality Predicates32937 +Node: Control Structure35713 +Node: Assignment36517 +Node: Generalized Variables37758 +Node: Basic Setf39065 +Node: Modify Macros46335 +Node: Customizing Setf53544 +Node: Variable Bindings60833 +Node: Dynamic Bindings61414 +Node: Lexical Bindings62304 +Node: Function Bindings66408 +Node: Macro Bindings68795 +Node: Conditionals71718 +Node: Blocks and Exits74801 +Node: Iteration77857 +Node: Loop Facility83330 +Node: Loop Basics84257 +Node: Loop Examples86857 +Node: For Clauses89116 +Node: Iteration Clauses100993 +Node: Accumulation Clauses102834 +Node: Other Clauses105178 +Node: Multiple Values111247 +Node: Macros113140 +Node: Declarations116358 +Node: Symbols124850 +Node: Property Lists125150 +Node: Creating Symbols128351 +Node: Numbers130429 +Node: Predicates on Numbers130909 +Node: Numerical Functions131938 +Node: Random Numbers136165 +Node: Implementation Parameters138874 +Node: Sequences142446 +Node: Sequence Basics143119 +Node: Mapping over Sequences146697 +Node: Sequence Functions152551 +Node: Searching Sequences158726 +Node: Sorting Sequences161763 +Node: Lists164311 +Node: List Functions164736 +Node: Substitution of Expressions168999 +Node: Lists as Sets170885 +Node: Association Lists174947 +Node: Hash Tables176650 +Node: Structures176870 +Node: Assertions191653 +Node: Efficiency Concerns194596 +Node: Common Lisp Compatibility200923 +Node: Old CL Compatibility204079 +Node: Porting Common Lisp208462 +Node: Function Index219475 +Node: Variable Index230738  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/custom.info b/info/custom.info index ccf40ba..0a0b284 100644 --- a/info/custom.info +++ b/info/custom.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/custom.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file custom.texi. +This is ../info/custom.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +custom.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -58,7 +58,7 @@ Declaring Groups Use `defgroup' to declare new customization groups. - - Function: defgroup SYMBOL MEMBERS DOC [KEYWORD VALUE]... + - Function: defgroup symbol members doc [keyword value]... Declare SYMBOL as a customization group containing MEMBERS. SYMBOL does not need to be quoted. @@ -89,7 +89,7 @@ Declaring Variables Use `defcustom' to declare user editable variables. - - Function: defcustom SYMBOL VALUE DOC [KEYWORD VALUE]... + - Function: defcustom symbol value doc [keyword value]... Declare SYMBOL as a customizable variable that defaults to VALUE. Neither SYMBOL nor VALUE needs to be quoted. If SYMBOL is not already bound, initialize it to VALUE. @@ -156,7 +156,7 @@ default value, `saved-value' for a value saved by the user, and Use `custom-add-option' to specify that a specific function is useful as an member of a hook. - - Function: custom-add-option SYMBOL OPTION + - Function: custom-add-option symbol option To the variable SYMBOL add OPTION. If SYMBOL is a hook variable, OPTION should be a hook member. For @@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ Declaring Faces Faces are declared with `defface'. - - Function: defface FACE SPEC DOC [KEYWORD VALUE]... + - Function: defface face spec doc [keyword value]... Declare FACE as a customizable face that defaults to SPEC. FACE does not need to be quoted. @@ -225,7 +225,7 @@ subgroups, with each subgroup being member of the top level group. The top level group for the package should itself be member of one or more of the standard customization groups. There exists a group for -each *finder* keyword. Press `C-h p' to see a list of finder keywords, +each _finder_ keyword. Press `C-h p' to see a list of finder keywords, and add you group to each of them, using the `:group' keyword.  @@ -240,18 +240,18 @@ Utilities Widget type for specifying the info manual entry for a customization option. It takes one argument, an info address. - - Function: custom-add-to-group GROUP MEMBER WIDGET + - Function: custom-add-to-group group member widget To existing GROUP add a new MEMBER of type WIDGET, If there already is an entry for that member, overwrite it. - - Function: custom-add-link SYMBOL WIDGET + - Function: custom-add-link symbol widget To the custom option SYMBOL add the link WIDGET. - - Function: custom-add-load SYMBOL LOAD + - Function: custom-add-load symbol load To the custom option SYMBOL add the dependency LOAD. LOAD should be either a library file name, or a feature name. - - Function: customize-menu-create SYMBOL &optional NAME + - Function: customize-menu-create symbol &optional name Create menu for customization group SYMBOL. If optional NAME is given, use that as the name of the menu. Otherwise the menu will be named `Customize'. The menu is in a format applicable to @@ -378,15 +378,16 @@ Wishlist Add colors. +  Tag Table: -Node: Top230 -Node: Declaring Groups1651 -Node: Declaring Variables2752 -Node: Declaring Faces5843 -Node: Usage for Package Authors7541 -Node: Utilities8320 -Node: The Init File9404 -Node: Wishlist9856 +Node: Top204 +Node: Declaring Groups1625 +Node: Declaring Variables2726 +Node: Declaring Faces5817 +Node: Usage for Package Authors7515 +Node: Utilities8294 +Node: The Init File9378 +Node: Wishlist9830  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/emodules.info b/info/emodules.info index f81e90f..b04e884 100644 --- a/info/emodules.info +++ b/info/emodules.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/emodules.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file emodules.texi. +This is ../info/emodules.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +emodules.texi. This file documents the module loading technology of XEmacs. @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ support documentation. * Defining Variables:: Creating new Lisp variables * Index:: Concept Index - -- The Detailed Node Listing -- + --- The Detailed Node Listing --- Annatomy of a Module @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ place-holder, not an actual function name. `syms_of_module' This required function is responsible for introducing to the Lisp reader all functions that you have defined in your module using - `DEFUN()'. Note that *only* functions are declared here, using + `DEFUN()'. Note that _only_ functions are declared here, using the `DEFSUBR()' macro. No variables are declared. `vars_of_module' @@ -276,7 +276,7 @@ Required Variables Not only does a module need to declare the initialization functions mentioned above, it is also required to provide certain variables which the module loading code searches for in order to determine the viability -of a module. You are *not* required to provide these variables in your +of a module. You are _not_ required to provide these variables in your source files. They are automatically set up in the module initialization file by the `ellcc' compiler. These variables are discussed here simply for the sake of completeness. @@ -820,7 +820,7 @@ initialization function using special XEmacs macros such as how to use these macros is to look at existing source code, or read the internals manual. - One *very* important difference between XEmacs variables and module + One _very_ important difference between XEmacs variables and module variables is how you use pure space. Simply put, you *never* use pure space in XEmacs modules. The pure space storage is of a limited size, and is initialized propperly during the dumping of XEmacs. Because @@ -930,23 +930,23 @@ Index  Tag Table: -Node: Top1562 -Node: Introduction2908 -Node: Annatomy of a Module7417 -Node: Required Header File8233 -Node: Required Functions10154 -Node: Required Variables12403 -Node: Loading other Modules15090 -Node: Using ellcc17148 -Node: Compile Mode18943 -Node: Initialization Mode20311 -Node: Link Mode25343 -Node: Other ellcc options26490 -Node: Environment Variables29070 -Node: Defining Functions30761 -Node: Using DEFUN32772 -Node: Declaring Functions34483 -Node: Defining Variables35826 -Node: Index38071 +Node: Top1536 +Node: Introduction2884 +Node: Annatomy of a Module7393 +Node: Required Header File8209 +Node: Required Functions10130 +Node: Required Variables12379 +Node: Loading other Modules15066 +Node: Using ellcc17124 +Node: Compile Mode18919 +Node: Initialization Mode20287 +Node: Link Mode25319 +Node: Other ellcc options26466 +Node: Environment Variables29046 +Node: Defining Functions30737 +Node: Using DEFUN32748 +Node: Declaring Functions34459 +Node: Defining Variables35802 +Node: Index38047  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/external-widget.info b/info/external-widget.info index def4c1b..e7ebc60 100644 --- a/info/external-widget.info +++ b/info/external-widget.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/external-widget.info, produced by Makeinfo -version 1.68 from the input file external-widget.texi. +This is ../info/external-widget.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 +from external-widget.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -129,9 +129,9 @@ are not seen by Emacs.  Tag Table: -Node: Top258 -Node: Using an External Client Widget688 -Node: External Client Widget Resource Settings2403 -Node: Motif-Specific Info About the External Client Widget5146 +Node: Top232 +Node: Using an External Client Widget662 +Node: External Client Widget Resource Settings2377 +Node: Motif-Specific Info About the External Client Widget5120  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/info.info b/info/info.info index ff9d60e..17280e2 100644 --- a/info/info.info +++ b/info/info.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/info.info, produced by Makeinfo version 1.68 -from the input file info.texi. +This is ../info/info.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +info.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION Texinfo documentation system START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -9,7 +9,7 @@ END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY This file describes how to use Info, the on-line, menu-driven GNU documentation system. - Copyright (C) 1989, 92, 96, 97 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Copyright (C) 1989, 92, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are @@ -36,15 +36,11 @@ Info: An Introduction To learn how to use Info, type the command `h'. It brings you to a programmed instruction sequence. - To learn advanced Info commands, type `n' twice. This brings you to -`Info for Experts', skipping over the `Getting Started' chapter. - * Menu: * Getting Started:: Getting started using an Info reader. * Advanced Info:: Advanced commands within Info. -* Create an Info File:: How to make your own Info file. -* The Standalone Info Program: (info-stnd.info). +* Creating an Info File:: How to make your own Info file.  File: info.info, Node: Getting Started, Next: Advanced Info, Prev: Top, Up: Top @@ -172,7 +168,7 @@ Another `n' command now would take you to the next node, `Help-^L'. you to the `Previous' node. When you get there, you can do an `n' again to return here. - This all probably seems insultingly simple so far, but *do not* be + This all probably seems insultingly simple so far, but _do not_ be led into skimming. Things will get more complicated soon. Also, do not try a new command until you are told it is time to. Otherwise, you may make Info skip past an important warning that was coming up. @@ -204,7 +200,7 @@ not anything above the top until you have typed some spaces). When you type the space, the two lines that were at the bottom of the screen appear at the top, followed by more lines. Delete takes the -two lines from the top and moves them to the bottom, *usually*, but if +two lines from the top and moves them to the bottom, _usually_, but if there are not a full screen's worth of lines above them they may not make it all the way to the bottom. @@ -298,8 +294,8 @@ actually visible in its node. If you cannot find a menu in a node by looking at it, then the node does not have a menu and the `m' command is not available. - The command to go to one of the subnodes is `m'--but *do not do it -yet!* Before you use `m', you must understand the difference between + The command to go to one of the subnodes is `m'--but _do not do it +yet!_ Before you use `m', you must understand the difference between commands and arguments. So far, you have learned several commands that do not need arguments. When you type one, Info processes it and is instantly ready for another command. The `m' command is different: it @@ -338,16 +334,16 @@ what you have entered. not need to type the argument: you just type a Return, and it stands for the subtopic of the line you are on. - Here is a menu to give you a chance to practice. - - * Menu: The menu starts here. + Here is a menu to give you a chance to practice. This menu gives you +three ways of going to one place, Help-FOO: - This menu gives you three ways of going to one place, Help-FOO. +* Menu: - * Foo: Help-FOO. A node you can visit for fun. +* Foo: Help-FOO. A node you can visit for fun. * Bar: Help-FOO. Strange! two ways to get to the same place. * Help-FOO:: And yet another! ->> Now type just an `m' and see what happens: + + >> Now type just an `m' and see what happens: Now you are "inside" an `m' command. Commands cannot be used now; the next thing you will type must be the name of a subtopic. @@ -393,7 +389,7 @@ Menus move Down in the tree, and `Up' moves Up. `Previous', on the other hand, is usually used to "stay on the same level but go backwards" You can go back to the node `Help-M' by typing the command `u' for -"Up". That puts you at the *front* of the node--to get back to where +"Up". That puts you at the _front_ of the node--to get back to where you were reading you have to type some s. >> Now type `u' to move back up to `Help-M'. @@ -423,7 +419,7 @@ back to `Help-M'. Then follow directions again and you will end up back here. - Note the difference between `l' and `p': `l' moves to where *you* + Note the difference between `l' and `p': `l' moves to where _you_ last were, whereas `p' always moves to the node which the header says is the `Previous' node (from this node, to `Help-M'). @@ -432,7 +428,7 @@ node, which is the first one you saw when you entered Info, has a menu which leads (directly, or indirectly through other menus), to all the nodes that exist. - >> Try doing a `d', then do an `l' to return here (yes, *do* + >> Try doing a `d', then do an `l' to return here (yes, _do_ return). Sometimes, in Info documentation, you will see a cross reference. @@ -499,14 +495,14 @@ and Return, to get to the node about Info and see what other help is available.  -File: info.info, Node: Advanced Info, Next: Create an Info File, Prev: Getting Started, Up: Top +File: info.info, Node: Advanced Info, Next: Creating an Info File, Prev: Getting Started, Up: Top Info for Experts **************** This chapter describes various advanced Info commands, and how to write an Info as distinct from a Texinfo file. (However, in most -cases, writing a Texinfo file is better, since you can use it *both* to +cases, writing a Texinfo file is better, since you can use it _both_ to generate an Info file and to make a printed manual. *Note Overview of Texinfo: (texinfo)Top.) @@ -562,10 +558,10 @@ short for the `m' command together with an argument. `1' goes through the first item in the current node's menu; `2' goes through the second item, etc. - If you display supports multiple fonts, and you are using Emacs' Info -mode to read Info files, the `*' for the fifth menu item is underlines, -and so is the `*' for the ninth item; these underlines make it easy to -see at a glance which number to use for an item. + If your display supports multiple fonts, and you are using Emacs' +Info mode to read Info files, the `*' for the fifth menu item is +underlined, and so is the `*' for the ninth item; these underlines make +it easy to see at a glance which number to use for an item. On ordinary terminals, you won't have underlining. If you need to actually count items, it is better to use `m' instead, and specify the @@ -587,7 +583,7 @@ Adding a new node to Info 2. Put that topic in the menu in the directory. *Note Menu: Menus. - Usually, the way to create the nodes is with Texinfo *note Overview + Usually, the way to create the nodes is with Texinfo (*note Overview of Texinfo: (texinfo)Top.); this has the advantage that you can also make a printed manual from them. However, if you want to edit an Info file, here is how. @@ -597,8 +593,8 @@ one. It must have a <^_> character before it (invisible to the user; this node has one but you cannot see it), and it ends with either a <^_>, a <^L>, or the end of file. Note: If you put in a <^L> to end a new node, be sure that there is a <^_> after it to start the next one, -since <^L> cannot *start* a node. Also, a nicer way to make a node -boundary be a page boundary as well is to put a <^L> *right after* the +since <^L> cannot _start_ a node. Also, a nicer way to make a node +boundary be a page boundary as well is to put a <^L> _right after_ the <^_>. The <^_> starting a node must be followed by a newline or a <^L> @@ -634,10 +630,10 @@ make it possible to make old-fashioned, unstructured files into nodes of the tree. The `Node:' name, in which a node states its own name, must not -contain a filename, since Info when searching for a node does not -expect one to be there. The `Next', `Previous' and `Up' names may -contain them. In this node, since the `Up' node is in the same file, -it was not necessary to use one. +contain a filename, since Info when searching for a node does not expect +one to be there. The `Next', `Previous' and `Up' names may contain +them. In this node, since the `Up' node is in the same file, it was +not necessary to use one. Note that the nodes in this file have a file name in the header line. The file names are ignored by Info, but they serve as comments @@ -682,13 +678,13 @@ to see them all need not keep revisiting the Menu. The Info Directory is simply the menu of the node `(dir)Top'--that is, node `Top' in file `.../info/dir'. You can put new entries in that -menu just like any other menu. The Info Directory is *not* the same as +menu just like any other menu. The Info Directory is _not_ the same as the file directory called `info'. It happens that many of Info's files live on that file directory, but they do not have to; and files on that directory are not automatically listed in the Info Directory node. Also, although the Info node graph is claimed to be a "hierarchy", -in fact it can be *any* directed graph. Shared structures and pointer +in fact it can be _any_ directed graph. Shared structures and pointer cycles are perfectly possible, and can be used if they are appropriate to the meaning to be expressed. There is no need for all the nodes in a file to form a connected structure. In fact, this file has two @@ -707,7 +703,7 @@ Creating Cross References A cross reference can be placed anywhere in the text, unlike a menu item which must go at the front of a line. A cross reference looks like a menu item except that it has `*note' instead of `*'. It -*cannot* be terminated by a `)', because `)''s are so often part of +_cannot_ be terminated by a `)', because `)''s are so often part of node names. If you wish to enclose a cross reference in parentheses, terminate it with a period first. Here are two examples of cross references pointers: @@ -802,43 +798,42 @@ Setting Variables: (emacs)Examining. when the function `Info-directory' is called.  -File: info.info, Node: Create an Info File, Prev: Advanced Info, Up: Top - -Creating an Info File from a Makeinfo file -****************************************** +File: info.info, Node: Creating an Info File, Prev: Advanced Info, Up: Top - `makeinfo' is a utility that converts a Texinfo file into an Info -file; `texinfo-format-region' and `texinfo-format-buffer' are GNU Emacs -functions that do the same. - - *Note Creating an Info File: (texinfo)Create an Info File, to learn -how to create an Info file from a Texinfo file. +Creating an Info File +********************* *Note Overview of Texinfo: (texinfo)Top, to learn how to write a Texinfo file. + *Note Creating an Info File: (texinfo)Creating an Info File, to +learn how to create an Info file from a Texinfo file. + + *Note Installing an Info File: (texinfo)Installing an Info File, to +learn how to install an Info file after you have created one. +  Tag Table: -Node: Top1085 -Node: Getting Started1770 -Node: Help-Small-Screen2518 -Node: Help4267 -Node: Help-P5297 -Node: Help-^L6159 -Node: Help-M9037 -Node: Help-FOO15047 -Node: Help-Adv15785 -Node: Help-Cross18460 -Node: Help-Q19106 -Node: Advanced Info19733 -Node: Expert20709 -Node: Add23222 -Node: Menus26581 -Node: Cross-refs29455 -Node: Tags30157 -Node: Checking31459 -Node: Emacs Info Variables32412 -Node: Create an Info File33401 +Node: Top1067 +Node: Getting Started1565 +Node: Help-Small-Screen2313 +Node: Help4062 +Node: Help-P5092 +Node: Help-^L5954 +Node: Help-M8832 +Node: Help-FOO14812 +Node: Help-Adv15550 +Node: Help-Cross18225 +Node: Help-Q18871 +Node: Advanced Info19498 +Node: Expert20476 +Node: Add22990 +Node: Menus26350 +Node: Cross-refs29224 +Node: Tags29926 +Node: Checking31228 +Node: Emacs Info Variables32181 +Node: Creating an Info File33170  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/internals.info b/info/internals.info index c7464dc..0674c50 100644 --- a/info/internals.info +++ b/info/internals.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/internals.info, produced by Makeinfo -version 1.68 from the input file internals.texi. +This is ../info/internals.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +internals/internals.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -39,141 +39,141 @@ Foundation instead of in the original English.  Indirect: -internals.info-1: 1789 -internals.info-2: 45943 -internals.info-3: 93017 -internals.info-4: 141389 -internals.info-5: 183420 -internals.info-6: 232841 -internals.info-7: 281571 -internals.info-8: 330967 +internals.info-1: 1770 +internals.info-2: 45926 +internals.info-3: 92999 +internals.info-4: 141365 +internals.info-5: 183396 +internals.info-6: 232817 +internals.info-7: 281547 +internals.info-8: 331004  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top1789 -Node: A History of Emacs6369 -Node: Through Version 187894 -Node: Lucid Emacs11315 -Node: GNU Emacs 1914333 -Node: GNU Emacs 2016516 -Node: XEmacs16943 -Node: XEmacs From the Outside20122 -Node: The Lisp Language21890 -Node: XEmacs From the Perspective of Building31435 -Node: XEmacs From the Inside37560 -Node: The XEmacs Object System (Abstractly Speaking)45943 -Node: How Lisp Objects Are Represented in C60031 -Node: Rules When Writing New C Code68593 -Node: General Coding Rules69397 -Node: Writing Lisp Primitives74557 -Node: Adding Global Lisp Variables85727 -Node: Coding for Mule89365 -Node: Character-Related Data Types90344 -Node: Working With Character and Byte Positions93017 -Node: Conversion to and from External Data96767 -Node: General Guidelines for Writing Mule-Aware Code101648 -Node: An Example of Mule-Aware Code103679 -Node: Techniques for XEmacs Developers105666 -Node: A Summary of the Various XEmacs Modules109437 -Node: Low-Level Modules110257 -Node: Basic Lisp Modules117779 -Node: Modules for Standard Editing Operations126103 -Node: Editor-Level Control Flow Modules131991 -Node: Modules for the Basic Displayable Lisp Objects135438 -Node: Modules for other Display-Related Lisp Objects137960 -Node: Modules for the Redisplay Mechanism139038 -Node: Modules for Interfacing with the File System141389 -Node: Modules for Other Aspects of the Lisp Interpreter and Object System145087 -Node: Modules for Interfacing with the Operating System150541 -Node: Modules for Interfacing with X Windows158202 -Node: Modules for Internationalization161638 -Node: Allocation of Objects in XEmacs Lisp164275 -Node: Introduction to Allocation164829 -Node: Garbage Collection170292 -Node: GCPROing173245 -Node: Garbage Collection - Step by Step180056 -Node: Invocation180448 -Node: garbage_collect_1183420 -Node: mark_object192900 -Node: gc_sweep194712 -Node: sweep_lcrecords_1199775 -Node: compact_string_chars200770 -Node: sweep_strings202950 -Node: sweep_bit_vectors_1203915 -Node: Integers and Characters204591 -Node: Allocation from Frob Blocks205343 -Node: lrecords206947 -Node: Low-level allocation219409 -Node: Pure Space223577 -Node: Cons223752 -Node: Vector224468 -Node: Bit Vector225045 -Node: Symbol225538 -Node: Marker226107 -Node: String226662 -Node: Compiled Function230277 -Node: Events and the Event Loop230446 -Node: Introduction to Events230925 -Node: Main Loop232841 -Node: Specifics of the Event Gathering Mechanism236417 -Node: Specifics About the Emacs Event248870 -Node: The Event Stream Callback Routines249125 -Node: Other Event Loop Functions249370 -Node: Converting Events250510 -Node: Dispatching Events; The Command Builder251119 -Node: Evaluation; Stack Frames; Bindings251354 -Node: Evaluation251696 -Node: Dynamic Binding; The specbinding Stack; Unwind-Protects258236 -Node: Simple Special Forms260620 -Node: Catch and Throw261402 -Node: Symbols and Variables263977 -Node: Introduction to Symbols264241 -Node: Obarrays265279 -Node: Symbol Values268812 -Node: Buffers and Textual Representation271100 -Node: Introduction to Buffers271758 -Node: The Text in a Buffer274421 -Node: Buffer Lists281571 -Node: Markers and Extents283522 -Node: Bufbytes and Emchars285787 -Node: The Buffer Object286002 -Node: MULE Character Sets and Encodings289482 -Node: Character Sets290544 -Node: Encodings293987 -Node: Japanese EUC (Extended Unix Code)295054 -Node: JIS7295868 -Node: Internal Mule Encodings297218 -Node: Internal String Encoding299048 -Node: Internal Character Encoding301161 -Node: CCL302885 -Node: The Lisp Reader and Compiler309637 -Node: Lstreams309850 -Node: Creating an Lstream310881 -Node: Lstream Types312091 -Node: Lstream Functions312343 -Node: Lstream Methods315865 -Node: Consoles; Devices; Frames; Windows318994 -Node: Introduction to Consoles; Devices; Frames; Windows319309 -Node: Point321801 -Node: Window Hierarchy323080 -Node: The Window Object327530 -Node: The Redisplay Mechanism330967 -Node: Critical Redisplay Sections331759 -Node: Line Start Cache332714 -Node: Redisplay Piece by Piece335951 -Node: Extents337987 -Node: Introduction to Extents338525 -Node: Extent Ordering339651 -Node: Format of the Extent Info340892 -Node: Zero-Length Extents342780 -Node: Mathematics of Extent Ordering344178 -Node: Extent Fragments348935 -Node: Faces350022 -Node: Glyphs350138 -Node: Specifiers353156 -Node: Menus353285 -Node: Subprocesses355543 -Node: Interface to X Windows357519 -Node: Index357690 +Node: Top1770 +Node: A History of Emacs6352 +Node: Through Version 187877 +Node: Lucid Emacs11298 +Node: GNU Emacs 1914316 +Node: GNU Emacs 2016499 +Node: XEmacs16926 +Node: XEmacs From the Outside20105 +Node: The Lisp Language21873 +Node: XEmacs From the Perspective of Building31418 +Node: XEmacs From the Inside37543 +Node: The XEmacs Object System (Abstractly Speaking)45926 +Node: How Lisp Objects Are Represented in C60014 +Node: Rules When Writing New C Code68576 +Node: General Coding Rules69380 +Node: Writing Lisp Primitives74540 +Node: Adding Global Lisp Variables85709 +Node: Coding for Mule89347 +Node: Character-Related Data Types90326 +Node: Working With Character and Byte Positions92999 +Node: Conversion to and from External Data96749 +Node: General Guidelines for Writing Mule-Aware Code101630 +Node: An Example of Mule-Aware Code103661 +Node: Techniques for XEmacs Developers105648 +Node: A Summary of the Various XEmacs Modules109413 +Node: Low-Level Modules110233 +Node: Basic Lisp Modules117755 +Node: Modules for Standard Editing Operations126079 +Node: Editor-Level Control Flow Modules131967 +Node: Modules for the Basic Displayable Lisp Objects135414 +Node: Modules for other Display-Related Lisp Objects137936 +Node: Modules for the Redisplay Mechanism139014 +Node: Modules for Interfacing with the File System141365 +Node: Modules for Other Aspects of the Lisp Interpreter and Object System145063 +Node: Modules for Interfacing with the Operating System150517 +Node: Modules for Interfacing with X Windows158178 +Node: Modules for Internationalization161614 +Node: Allocation of Objects in XEmacs Lisp164251 +Node: Introduction to Allocation164805 +Node: Garbage Collection170268 +Node: GCPROing173221 +Node: Garbage Collection - Step by Step180032 +Node: Invocation180424 +Node: garbage_collect_1183396 +Node: mark_object192876 +Node: gc_sweep194688 +Node: sweep_lcrecords_1199751 +Node: compact_string_chars200746 +Node: sweep_strings202926 +Node: sweep_bit_vectors_1203891 +Node: Integers and Characters204567 +Node: Allocation from Frob Blocks205319 +Node: lrecords206923 +Node: Low-level allocation219385 +Node: Pure Space223553 +Node: Cons223728 +Node: Vector224444 +Node: Bit Vector225021 +Node: Symbol225514 +Node: Marker226083 +Node: String226638 +Node: Compiled Function230253 +Node: Events and the Event Loop230422 +Node: Introduction to Events230901 +Node: Main Loop232817 +Node: Specifics of the Event Gathering Mechanism236393 +Node: Specifics About the Emacs Event248846 +Node: The Event Stream Callback Routines249101 +Node: Other Event Loop Functions249346 +Node: Converting Events250486 +Node: Dispatching Events; The Command Builder251095 +Node: Evaluation; Stack Frames; Bindings251330 +Node: Evaluation251672 +Node: Dynamic Binding; The specbinding Stack; Unwind-Protects258212 +Node: Simple Special Forms260596 +Node: Catch and Throw261378 +Node: Symbols and Variables263953 +Node: Introduction to Symbols264217 +Node: Obarrays265255 +Node: Symbol Values268788 +Node: Buffers and Textual Representation271076 +Node: Introduction to Buffers271734 +Node: The Text in a Buffer274397 +Node: Buffer Lists281547 +Node: Markers and Extents283498 +Node: Bufbytes and Emchars285763 +Node: The Buffer Object285978 +Node: MULE Character Sets and Encodings289458 +Node: Character Sets290520 +Node: Encodings293963 +Node: Japanese EUC (Extended Unix Code)295030 +Node: JIS7295844 +Node: Internal Mule Encodings297194 +Node: Internal String Encoding299024 +Node: Internal Character Encoding301137 +Node: CCL302861 +Node: The Lisp Reader and Compiler309613 +Node: Lstreams309826 +Node: Creating an Lstream310857 +Node: Lstream Types312067 +Node: Lstream Functions312319 +Node: Lstream Methods315888 +Node: Consoles; Devices; Frames; Windows319031 +Node: Introduction to Consoles; Devices; Frames; Windows319346 +Node: Point321838 +Node: Window Hierarchy323117 +Node: The Window Object327567 +Node: The Redisplay Mechanism331004 +Node: Critical Redisplay Sections331796 +Node: Line Start Cache332751 +Node: Redisplay Piece by Piece335988 +Node: Extents338024 +Node: Introduction to Extents338562 +Node: Extent Ordering339688 +Node: Format of the Extent Info340929 +Node: Zero-Length Extents342817 +Node: Mathematics of Extent Ordering344215 +Node: Extent Fragments348972 +Node: Faces350059 +Node: Glyphs350175 +Node: Specifiers353193 +Node: Menus353322 +Node: Subprocesses355580 +Node: Interface to X Windows357556 +Node: Index357727  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/internals.info-1 b/info/internals.info-1 index c43d904..5768b91 100644 --- a/info/internals.info-1 +++ b/info/internals.info-1 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/internals.info, produced by Makeinfo -version 1.68 from the input file internals.texi. +This is ../info/internals.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +internals/internals.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ File: internals.info, Node: Top, Next: A History of Emacs, Prev: (dir), Up: * Index:: Index including concepts, functions, variables, and other terms. - -- The Detailed Node Listing -- + --- The Detailed Node Listing --- Here are other nodes that are inferiors of those already listed, mentioned here so you can get to them in one step: @@ -886,7 +886,7 @@ for easy upgrading of parts of a system without upgrading the rest. It would be impossible to pre-determine and pre-specify the information for all possible configurations. - In fact, the `s/' and `m/' files are basically *evil*, since they + In fact, the `s/' and `m/' files are basically _evil_, since they contain unmaintainable platform-specific hard-coded information. XEmacs has been moving in the direction of having all system-specific information be determined dynamically by `configure'. Perhaps someday @@ -897,7 +897,7 @@ we can `rm -rf src/s src/m'. features of your system) from template files. You then run `make', which compiles the auxiliary code and programs in `lib-src/' and `lwlib/' and the main XEmacs executable in `src/'. The result of -compiling and linking is an executable called `temacs', which is *not* +compiling and linking is an executable called `temacs', which is _not_ the final XEmacs executable. `temacs' by itself is not intended to function as an editor or even display any windows on the screen, and if you simply run it, it will exit immediately. The `Makefile' runs diff --git a/info/internals.info-2 b/info/internals.info-2 index 8d78cb4..0ae8e55 100644 --- a/info/internals.info-2 +++ b/info/internals.info-2 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/internals.info, produced by Makeinfo -version 1.68 from the input file internals.texi. +This is ../info/internals.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +internals/internals.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -286,7 +286,7 @@ but detached extents (extents not referring to any text, as happens to some extents when the text they are referring to is deleted) are temporary. Note that some permanent objects, such as faces and coding systems, cannot be deleted. Note also that windows are unique in that -they can be *undeleted* after having previously been deleted. (This +they can be _undeleted_ after having previously been deleted. (This happens as a result of restoring a window configuration.) Note that many types of objects have a "read syntax", i.e. a way of @@ -493,7 +493,7 @@ advantages: 1. 31 bits can be used for Lisp Integers. - 2. *Any* pointer can be represented directly, and no bit masking + 2. _Any_ pointer can be represented directly, and no bit masking operations are necessary. The disadvantages are: @@ -535,7 +535,7 @@ have to be a statement rather than just used in an expression. The reason for this is that standard C doesn't let you "construct" a structure (but GCC does). Granted, this sometimes isn't too convenient; for the case of integers, at least, you can use the function -`make_int()', which constructs and *returns* an integer Lisp object. +`make_int()', which constructs and _returns_ an integer Lisp object. Note that the `XSETTYPE()' macros are also affected by `ERROR_CHECK_TYPECHECK' and make sure that the structure is of the right type in the case of record types, where the type is contained in @@ -870,7 +870,7 @@ call the C function. Defining the C function is not enough to make a Lisp primitive available; you must also create the Lisp symbol for the primitive (the -symbol is "interned"; *note Obarrays::.) and store a suitable subr +symbol is "interned"; *note Obarrays::) and store a suitable subr object in its function cell. (If you don't do this, the primitive won't be seen by Lisp code.) The code looks like this: @@ -956,7 +956,7 @@ variable gets changed. Whether or not you `DEFVAR_LISP()' a variable, you need to initialize it in the `vars_of_*()' function; otherwise it will end up -as all zeroes, which is the integer 0 (*not* `nil'), and this is +as all zeroes, which is the integer 0 (_not_ `nil'), and this is probably not what you want. Also, if the variable is not `DEFVAR_LISP()'ed, *you must call* `staticpro()' on the C variable in the `vars_of_*()' function. Otherwise, the garbage-collection diff --git a/info/lispref.info b/info/lispref.info index b7c31a9..360182b 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info +++ b/info/lispref.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -51,836 +51,838 @@ Foundation instead of in the original English.  Indirect: -lispref.info-1: 2387 -lispref.info-2: 48394 -lispref.info-3: 96933 -lispref.info-4: 146792 -lispref.info-5: 195517 -lispref.info-6: 243211 -lispref.info-7: 291472 -lispref.info-8: 340630 -lispref.info-9: 387982 -lispref.info-10: 436629 -lispref.info-11: 484512 -lispref.info-12: 531109 -lispref.info-13: 579014 -lispref.info-14: 627229 -lispref.info-15: 675480 -lispref.info-16: 724640 -lispref.info-17: 771866 -lispref.info-18: 818656 -lispref.info-19: 865712 -lispref.info-20: 914446 -lispref.info-21: 963810 -lispref.info-22: 1010651 -lispref.info-23: 1057664 -lispref.info-24: 1107066 -lispref.info-25: 1156744 -lispref.info-26: 1206642 -lispref.info-27: 1255865 -lispref.info-28: 1304640 -lispref.info-29: 1353618 -lispref.info-30: 1394929 -lispref.info-31: 1444081 -lispref.info-32: 1493295 -lispref.info-33: 1542879 -lispref.info-34: 1591063 -lispref.info-35: 1636699 -lispref.info-36: 1678018 -lispref.info-37: 1722965 -lispref.info-38: 1772661 -lispref.info-39: 1821723 -lispref.info-40: 1871108 -lispref.info-41: 1921004 -lispref.info-42: 1969995 -lispref.info-43: 2014504 -lispref.info-44: 2052883 +lispref.info-1: 2366 +lispref.info-2: 48385 +lispref.info-3: 96924 +lispref.info-4: 146766 +lispref.info-5: 195600 +lispref.info-6: 243285 +lispref.info-7: 291568 +lispref.info-8: 340704 +lispref.info-9: 388026 +lispref.info-10: 436665 +lispref.info-11: 484608 +lispref.info-12: 531220 +lispref.info-13: 579119 +lispref.info-14: 627342 +lispref.info-15: 675596 +lispref.info-16: 724798 +lispref.info-17: 772038 +lispref.info-18: 818888 +lispref.info-19: 865939 +lispref.info-20: 914669 +lispref.info-21: 964091 +lispref.info-22: 1011010 +lispref.info-23: 1058037 +lispref.info-24: 1107436 +lispref.info-25: 1157118 +lispref.info-26: 1207028 +lispref.info-27: 1256251 +lispref.info-28: 1305018 +lispref.info-29: 1353990 +lispref.info-30: 1395325 +lispref.info-31: 1444468 +lispref.info-32: 1493681 +lispref.info-33: 1543255 +lispref.info-34: 1591432 +lispref.info-35: 1637064 +lispref.info-36: 1678380 +lispref.info-37: 1723321 +lispref.info-38: 1773008 +lispref.info-39: 1822112 +lispref.info-40: 1871516 +lispref.info-41: 1921400 +lispref.info-42: 1970391 +lispref.info-43: 2014283 +lispref.info-44: 2052619  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top2387 -Node: Copying48394 -Node: Introduction67552 -Node: Caveats69143 -Node: Lisp History70872 -Node: Conventions72128 -Node: Some Terms72943 -Node: nil and t73664 -Node: Evaluation Notation75341 -Node: Printing Notation76254 -Node: Error Messages77128 -Node: Buffer Text Notation77569 -Node: Format of Descriptions78444 -Node: A Sample Function Description79298 -Node: A Sample Variable Description83284 -Node: Acknowledgements84192 -Node: Lisp Data Types86170 -Node: Printed Representation88725 -Node: Comments90768 -Node: Primitive Types91666 -Node: Programming Types93325 -Node: Integer Type95277 -Node: Floating Point Type96314 -Node: Character Type96933 -Node: Symbol Type104839 -Node: Sequence Type107534 -Node: Cons Cell Type109055 -Node: Dotted Pair Notation113538 -Node: Association List Type115659 -Node: Array Type116542 -Node: String Type118008 -Node: Vector Type120689 -Node: Bit Vector Type121461 -Node: Function Type122323 -Node: Macro Type123439 -Node: Primitive Function Type124136 -Node: Compiled-Function Type125663 -Node: Autoload Type126217 -Node: Char Table Type127231 -Node: Hash Table Type127405 -Node: Range Table Type128560 -Node: Weak List Type129413 -Node: Editing Types129563 -Node: Buffer Type131190 -Node: Marker Type133226 -Node: Extent Type133950 -Node: Window Type135218 -Node: Frame Type136629 -Node: Device Type137424 -Node: Console Type138250 -Node: Window Configuration Type139451 -Node: Event Type140149 -Node: Process Type140313 -Node: Stream Type141348 -Node: Keymap Type142473 -Node: Syntax Table Type143011 -Node: Display Table Type144035 -Node: Database Type144474 -Node: Charset Type144640 -Node: Coding System Type144804 -Node: ToolTalk Message Type144988 -Node: ToolTalk Pattern Type145187 -Node: Window-System Types145359 -Node: Face Type146505 -Node: Glyph Type146636 -Node: Specifier Type146792 -Node: Font Instance Type146965 -Node: Color Instance Type147155 -Node: Image Instance Type147352 -Node: Toolbar Button Type147550 -Node: Subwindow Type147743 -Node: X Resource Type147922 -Node: Type Predicates148075 -Node: Equality Predicates157205 -Node: Numbers162010 -Node: Integer Basics163465 -Node: Float Basics165815 -Node: Predicates on Numbers167557 -Node: Comparison of Numbers169190 -Node: Numeric Conversions173011 -Node: Arithmetic Operations174477 -Node: Rounding Operations179942 -Node: Bitwise Operations181047 -Node: Math Functions189982 -Node: Random Numbers192298 -Node: Strings and Characters194064 -Node: String Basics195517 -Node: Predicates for Strings197939 -Node: Creating Strings198702 -Node: Predicates for Characters204030 -Node: Character Codes205101 -Node: Text Comparison206514 -Node: String Conversion209876 -Node: Modifying Strings213554 -Node: String Properties214195 -Node: Formatting Strings214838 -Node: Character Case224446 -Node: Case Tables227593 -Node: Char Tables231492 -Node: Char Table Types232884 -Node: Working With Char Tables234459 -Node: Lists236408 -Node: Cons Cells237531 -Node: Lists as Boxes238867 -Node: List-related Predicates241509 -Node: List Elements243211 -Node: Building Lists248240 -Node: Modifying Lists254235 -Node: Setcar255047 -Node: Setcdr257468 -Node: Rearrangement259978 -Node: Sets And Lists265537 -Node: Association Lists269766 -Node: Property Lists279267 -Node: Working With Normal Plists280815 -Node: Working With Lax Plists283083 -Node: Converting Plists To/From Alists285323 -Node: Weak Lists286671 -Node: Sequences Arrays Vectors288836 -Node: Sequence Functions291472 -Node: Arrays295133 -Node: Array Functions298198 -Node: Vectors300731 -Node: Vector Functions302229 -Node: Bit Vectors304803 -Node: Bit Vector Functions305648 -Node: Symbols307899 -Node: Symbol Components308948 -Node: Definitions313127 -Node: Creating Symbols315352 -Node: Symbol Properties322390 -Node: Plists and Alists323906 -Node: Symbol Plists325656 -Node: Other Plists327466 -Node: Evaluation329244 -Node: Intro Eval330049 -Node: Eval333540 -Node: Forms337960 -Node: Self-Evaluating Forms339117 -Node: Symbol Forms340630 -Node: Classifying Lists341547 -Node: Function Indirection342303 -Node: Function Forms345418 -Node: Macro Forms346417 -Node: Special Forms348017 -Node: Autoloading350351 -Node: Quoting350849 -Node: Control Structures352212 -Node: Sequencing353834 -Node: Conditionals356699 -Node: Combining Conditions360122 -Node: Iteration363392 -Node: Nonlocal Exits365177 -Node: Catch and Throw365879 -Node: Examples of Catch369723 -Node: Errors371742 -Node: Signaling Errors373231 -Node: Processing of Errors376299 -Node: Handling Errors377629 -Node: Error Symbols384535 -Node: Cleanups387982 -Node: Variables391762 -Node: Global Variables393531 -Node: Constant Variables394607 -Node: Local Variables395233 -Node: Void Variables400177 -Node: Defining Variables403688 -Node: Accessing Variables410853 -Node: Setting Variables412279 -Node: Variable Scoping416798 -Node: Scope418397 -Node: Extent419922 -Node: Impl of Scope421401 -Node: Using Scoping423364 -Node: Buffer-Local Variables424886 -Node: Intro to Buffer-Local425722 -Node: Creating Buffer-Local428265 -Node: Default Value433485 -Node: Variable Aliases436629 -Node: Functions438415 -Node: What Is a Function439509 -Node: Lambda Expressions443556 -Node: Lambda Components444466 -Node: Simple Lambda446298 -Node: Argument List447957 -Node: Function Documentation451685 -Node: Function Names453627 -Node: Defining Functions456201 -Node: Calling Functions459243 -Node: Mapping Functions463092 -Node: Anonymous Functions465445 -Node: Function Cells468690 -Node: Inline Functions473500 -Node: Related Topics475310 -Node: Macros476363 -Node: Simple Macro477647 -Node: Expansion478382 -Node: Compiling Macros481356 -Node: Defining Macros483194 -Node: Backquote484512 -Node: Problems with Macros486910 -Node: Argument Evaluation487605 -Node: Surprising Local Vars490506 -Node: Eval During Expansion492574 -Node: Repeated Expansion494268 -Node: Customization496179 -Node: Common Keywords496648 -Node: Group Definitions499493 -Node: Variable Definitions501686 -Node: Customization Types506669 -Node: Simple Types508105 -Node: Composite Types510262 -Node: Splicing into Lists514952 -Node: Type Keywords516787 -Node: Loading520307 -Node: How Programs Do Loading521980 -Node: Autoload531109 -Node: Repeated Loading537189 -Node: Named Features539303 -Node: Unloading545736 -Node: Hooks for Loading547892 -Node: Byte Compilation548609 -Node: Speed of Byte-Code550526 -Node: Compilation Functions551733 -Node: Docs and Compilation558122 -Node: Dynamic Loading560775 -Node: Eval During Compile563139 -Node: Compiled-Function Objects564404 -Node: Disassembly569203 -Node: Debugging576457 -Node: Debugger577869 -Node: Error Debugging579014 -Node: Infinite Loops581767 -Node: Function Debugging583011 -Node: Explicit Debug585801 -Node: Using Debugger586573 -Node: Debugger Commands588437 -Node: Invoking the Debugger592754 -Node: Internals of Debugger596669 -Node: Syntax Errors601546 -Node: Excess Open602794 -Node: Excess Close604669 -Node: Compilation Errors606090 -Node: Edebug607378 -Node: Using Edebug609485 -Node: Instrumenting612182 -Node: Edebug Execution Modes615671 -Node: Jumping618781 -Node: Edebug Misc621124 -Node: Breakpoints622513 -Node: Global Break Condition625319 -Node: Embedded Breakpoints626274 -Node: Trapping Errors627229 -Node: Edebug Views629305 -Node: Edebug Eval631270 -Node: Eval List632447 -Node: Reading in Edebug635832 -Node: Printing in Edebug636631 -Node: Tracing638346 -Node: Coverage Testing640232 -Node: The Outside Context642273 -Node: Checking Whether to Stop643222 -Node: Edebug Display Update643868 -Node: Edebug Recursive Edit645890 -Node: Instrumenting Macro Calls647544 -Node: Specification List650026 -Node: Backtracking659437 -Node: Debugging Backquote661375 -Node: Specification Examples665081 -Node: Edebug Options667148 -Node: Read and Print672485 -Node: Streams Intro673462 -Node: Input Streams675480 -Node: Input Functions680381 -Node: Output Streams682441 -Node: Output Functions686493 -Node: Output Variables690793 -Node: Minibuffers695592 -Node: Intro to Minibuffers696677 -Node: Text from Minibuffer699005 -Node: Object from Minibuffer703668 -Node: Minibuffer History706865 -Node: Completion709775 -Node: Basic Completion711750 -Node: Minibuffer Completion716757 -Node: Completion Commands719992 -Node: High-Level Completion724640 -Node: Reading File Names728664 -Node: Programmed Completion732353 -Node: Yes-or-No Queries734563 -Node: Multiple Queries740259 -Node: Minibuffer Misc744324 -Node: Command Loop749193 -Node: Command Overview750539 -Node: Defining Commands753823 -Node: Using Interactive754571 -Node: Interactive Codes759345 -Node: Interactive Examples765149 -Node: Interactive Call766463 -Node: Command Loop Info771866 -Node: Events776845 -Node: Event Types778305 -Node: Event Contents780228 -Node: Event Predicates784704 -Node: Accessing Mouse Event Positions786029 -Node: Frame-Level Event Position Info786728 -Node: Window-Level Event Position Info787768 -Node: Event Text Position Info789532 -Node: Event Glyph Position Info792024 -Node: Event Toolbar Position Info793347 -Node: Other Event Position Info794018 -Node: Accessing Other Event Info794427 -Node: Working With Events796047 -Node: Converting Events801975 -Node: Reading Input804928 -Node: Key Sequence Input805930 -Node: Reading One Event807884 -Node: Dispatching an Event810645 -Node: Quoted Character Input811096 -Node: Peeking and Discarding812444 -Node: Waiting816348 -Node: Quitting818656 -Node: Prefix Command Arguments823064 -Node: Recursive Editing828151 -Node: Disabling Commands832948 -Node: Command History835016 -Node: Keyboard Macros836755 -Node: Keymaps838973 -Node: Keymap Terminology840550 -Node: Format of Keymaps843480 -Node: Creating Keymaps843891 -Node: Inheritance and Keymaps845970 -Node: Key Sequences848342 -Node: Prefix Keys852912 -Node: Active Keymaps856497 -Node: Key Lookup865712 -Node: Functions for Key Lookup870876 -Node: Changing Key Bindings876579 -Node: Key Binding Commands883466 -Node: Scanning Keymaps885532 -Node: Other Keymap Functions894044 -Node: Menus894666 -Node: Menu Format895208 -Node: Menubar Format903793 -Node: Menubar904418 -Node: Modifying Menus907532 -Node: Menu Filters912550 -Node: Pop-Up Menus914446 -Node: Menu Accelerators916652 -Node: Creating Menu Accelerators917374 -Node: Keyboard Menu Traversal918692 -Node: Menu Accelerator Functions919419 -Node: Buffers Menu922454 -Node: Dialog Boxes923748 -Node: Dialog Box Format923915 -Node: Dialog Box Functions925285 -Node: Toolbar925683 -Node: Toolbar Intro926008 -Node: Toolbar Descriptor Format928419 -Node: Specifying the Toolbar932913 -Node: Other Toolbar Variables936521 -Node: Scrollbars940948 -Node: Drag and Drop941084 -Node: Supported Protocols942160 -Node: OffiX DND942663 -Node: CDE dt943670 -Node: MSWindows OLE944261 -Node: Loose ends944432 -Node: Drop Interface944824 -Node: Drag Interface945846 -Node: Modes946020 -Node: Major Modes946971 -Node: Major Mode Conventions949887 -Node: Example Major Modes955842 -Node: Auto Major Mode963810 -Node: Mode Help971260 -Node: Derived Modes972361 -Node: Minor Modes974552 -Node: Minor Mode Conventions975854 -Node: Keymaps and Minor Modes978718 -Node: Modeline Format979553 -Node: Modeline Data981322 -Node: Modeline Variables985594 -Node: %-Constructs990310 -Node: Hooks993221 -Node: Documentation999985 -Node: Documentation Basics1001408 -Node: Accessing Documentation1004460 -Node: Keys in Documentation1010651 -Node: Describing Characters1014114 -Node: Help Functions1016468 -Node: Obsoleteness1022911 -Node: Files1025905 -Node: Visiting Files1027830 -Node: Visiting Functions1029335 -Node: Subroutines of Visiting1034383 -Node: Saving Buffers1036459 -Node: Reading from Files1042552 -Node: Writing to Files1044709 -Node: File Locks1047426 -Node: Information about Files1050479 -Node: Testing Accessibility1051240 -Node: Kinds of Files1054980 -Node: Truenames1056661 -Node: File Attributes1057664 -Node: Changing File Attributes1062804 -Node: File Names1068210 -Node: File Name Components1069819 -Node: Directory Names1072920 -Node: Relative File Names1076373 -Node: File Name Expansion1077451 -Node: Unique File Names1081358 -Node: File Name Completion1082973 -Node: User Name Completion1085634 -Node: Contents of Directories1086974 -Node: Create/Delete Dirs1090287 -Node: Magic File Names1091393 -Node: Partial Files1097023 -Node: Intro to Partial Files1097251 -Node: Creating a Partial File1098491 -Node: Detached Partial Files1099426 -Node: Format Conversion1100548 -Node: Files and MS-DOS1107066 -Node: Backups and Auto-Saving1109130 -Node: Backup Files1109805 -Node: Making Backups1111202 -Node: Rename or Copy1113951 -Node: Numbered Backups1116444 -Node: Backup Names1118689 -Node: Auto-Saving1121972 -Node: Reverting1130114 -Node: Buffers1133272 -Node: Buffer Basics1134687 -Node: Current Buffer1136740 -Node: Buffer Names1141430 -Node: Buffer File Name1144635 -Node: Buffer Modification1148755 -Node: Modification Time1150951 -Node: Read Only Buffers1154326 -Node: The Buffer List1156744 -Node: Creating Buffers1161574 -Node: Killing Buffers1163723 -Node: Indirect Buffers1167454 -Node: Windows1170026 -Node: Basic Windows1171504 -Node: Splitting Windows1174602 -Node: Deleting Windows1181473 -Node: Selecting Windows1184154 -Node: Cyclic Window Ordering1187283 -Node: Buffers and Windows1191907 -Node: Displaying Buffers1193748 -Node: Choosing Window1198926 -Node: Window Point1206642 -Node: Window Start1208688 -Node: Vertical Scrolling1213178 -Node: Horizontal Scrolling1219315 -Node: Size of Window1222824 -Node: Position of Window1227542 -Node: Resizing Windows1229782 -Node: Window Configurations1235211 -Node: Frames1238636 -Node: Creating Frames1240405 -Node: Frame Properties1241746 -Node: Property Access1242562 -Node: Initial Properties1243411 -Node: X Frame Properties1245897 -Node: Size and Position1250531 -Node: Frame Name1252527 -Node: Frame Titles1253441 -Node: Deleting Frames1255265 -Node: Finding All Frames1255865 -Node: Frames and Windows1257859 -Node: Minibuffers and Frames1259564 -Node: Input Focus1260483 -Node: Visibility of Frames1263561 -Node: Raising and Lowering1265480 -Node: Frame Configurations1267857 -Node: Frame Hooks1268451 -Node: Consoles and Devices1270258 -Node: Basic Console Functions1273002 -Node: Basic Device Functions1273425 -Node: Console Types and Device Classes1274141 -Node: Connecting to a Console or Device1276338 -Node: The Selected Console and Device1278501 -Node: Console and Device I/O1279527 -Node: Positions1280291 -Node: Point1281260 -Node: Motion1284353 -Node: Character Motion1285120 -Node: Word Motion1287357 -Node: Buffer End Motion1288858 -Node: Text Lines1290355 -Node: Screen Lines1294950 -Node: List Motion1299013 -Node: Skipping Characters1302421 -Node: Excursions1304640 -Node: Narrowing1307675 -Node: Markers1313002 -Node: Overview of Markers1313904 -Node: Predicates on Markers1318597 -Node: Creating Markers1319843 -Node: Information from Markers1323880 -Node: Changing Markers1324978 -Node: The Mark1326356 -Node: The Region1334850 -Node: Text1340537 -Node: Near Point1343239 -Node: Buffer Contents1346961 -Node: Comparing Text1348367 -Node: Insertion1349775 -Node: Commands for Insertion1353618 -Node: Deletion1356576 -Node: User-Level Deletion1360173 -Node: The Kill Ring1364303 -Node: Kill Ring Concepts1366477 -Node: Kill Functions1367531 -Node: Yank Commands1369436 -Node: Low-Level Kill Ring1371307 -Node: Internals of Kill Ring1374093 -Node: Undo1376873 -Node: Maintaining Undo1381202 -Node: Filling1383822 -Node: Margins1389818 -Node: Auto Filling1393748 -Node: Sorting1394929 -Node: Columns1404230 -Node: Indentation1406746 -Node: Primitive Indent1407525 -Node: Mode-Specific Indent1408769 -Node: Region Indent1411280 -Node: Relative Indent1414228 -Node: Indent Tabs1416610 -Node: Motion by Indent1417932 -Node: Case Changes1418711 -Node: Text Properties1421962 -Node: Examining Properties1423777 -Node: Changing Properties1425644 -Node: Property Search1429239 -Node: Special Properties1433950 -Node: Saving Properties1434231 -Node: Substitution1437373 -Node: Registers1440644 -Node: Transposition1443187 -Node: Change Hooks1444081 -Node: Transformations1446121 -Node: Searching and Matching1450506 -Node: String Search1451637 -Node: Regular Expressions1456361 -Node: Syntax of Regexps1457728 -Node: Regexp Example1472108 -Node: Regexp Search1474278 -Node: POSIX Regexps1480366 -Node: Search and Replace1482201 -Node: Match Data1485566 -Node: Simple Match Data1486696 -Node: Replacing Match1490961 -Node: Entire Match Data1493295 -Node: Saving Match Data1495286 -Node: Searching and Case1496669 -Node: Standard Regexps1498703 -Node: Syntax Tables1500901 -Node: Syntax Basics1502017 -Node: Syntax Descriptors1504992 -Node: Syntax Class Table1506842 -Node: Syntax Flags1512880 -Node: Syntax Table Functions1516097 -Node: Motion and Syntax1519961 -Node: Parsing Expressions1521413 -Node: Standard Syntax Tables1527482 -Node: Syntax Table Internals1528326 -Node: Abbrevs1529353 -Node: Abbrev Mode1531157 -Node: Abbrev Tables1531877 -Node: Defining Abbrevs1533410 -Node: Abbrev Files1535315 -Node: Abbrev Expansion1537089 -Node: Standard Abbrev Tables1541720 -Node: Extents1542879 -Node: Intro to Extents1544122 -Node: Creating and Modifying Extents1548116 -Node: Extent Endpoints1549625 -Node: Finding Extents1552890 -Node: Mapping Over Extents1556641 -Node: Extent Properties1562759 -Node: Detached Extents1572903 -Node: Extent Parents1574762 -Node: Duplicable Extents1576457 -Node: Extents and Events1579680 -Node: Atomic Extents1581588 -Node: Specifiers1582035 -Node: Introduction to Specifiers1583838 -Node: Specifiers In-Depth1586148 -Node: Specifier Instancing1591063 -Node: Specifier Types1594325 -Node: Adding Specifications1599399 -Node: Retrieving Specifications1608762 -Node: Specifier Tag Functions1612497 -Node: Specifier Instancing Functions1615731 -Node: Specifier Example1619138 -Node: Creating Specifiers1622244 -Node: Specifier Validation Functions1624493 -Node: Other Specification Functions1626877 -Node: Faces and Window-System Objects1630696 -Node: Faces1631020 -Node: Merging Faces1632639 -Node: Basic Face Functions1634600 -Node: Face Properties1636699 -Node: Face Convenience Functions1646258 -Node: Other Face Display Functions1649391 -Node: Fonts1650204 -Node: Font Specifiers1650905 -Node: Font Instances1651146 -Node: Font Instance Names1652113 -Node: Font Instance Size1652954 -Node: Font Instance Characteristics1654240 -Node: Font Convenience Functions1655409 -Node: Colors1656699 -Node: Color Specifiers1657139 -Node: Color Instances1657366 -Node: Color Instance Properties1658110 -Node: Color Convenience Functions1658736 -Node: Glyphs1659789 -Node: Glyph Functions1661381 -Node: Creating Glyphs1661788 -Node: Glyph Properties1663375 -Node: Glyph Convenience Functions1672542 -Node: Glyph Dimensions1676489 -Node: Images1677569 -Node: Image Specifiers1678018 -Node: Image Instantiator Conversion1689442 -Node: Image Instances1690807 -Node: Image Instance Types1691558 -Node: Image Instance Functions1694213 -Node: Glyph Types1698783 -Node: Mouse Pointer1700555 -Node: Redisplay Glyphs1703558 -Node: Subwindows1704591 -Node: Annotations1704834 -Node: Annotation Basics1705851 -Node: Annotation Primitives1709789 -Node: Annotation Properties1711118 -Node: Locating Annotations1714158 -Node: Margin Primitives1714995 -Node: Annotation Hooks1716889 -Node: Display1717549 -Node: Refresh Screen1718527 -Node: Truncation1720438 -Node: The Echo Area1722965 -Node: Warnings1729401 -Node: Invisible Text1733837 -Node: Selective Display1736417 -Node: Overlay Arrow1740544 -Node: Temporary Displays1741898 -Node: Blinking1746019 -Node: Usual Display1748203 -Node: Display Tables1750753 -Node: Display Table Format1751557 -Node: Active Display Table1753001 -Node: Character Descriptors1754193 -Node: Beeping1754951 -Node: Hash Tables1759717 -Node: Introduction to Hash Tables1760325 -Node: Working With Hash Tables1766350 -Node: Weak Hash Tables1767467 -Node: Range Tables1769266 -Node: Introduction to Range Tables1769955 -Node: Working With Range Tables1770386 -Node: Databases1771271 -Node: Connecting to a Database1771570 -Node: Working With a Database1772661 -Node: Other Database Functions1773519 -Node: Processes1774093 -Node: Subprocess Creation1776317 -Node: Synchronous Processes1779610 -Node: MS-DOS Subprocesses1786308 -Node: Asynchronous Processes1787382 -Node: Deleting Processes1791086 -Node: Process Information1792957 -Node: Input to Processes1796885 -Node: Signals to Processes1799154 -Node: Output from Processes1803574 -Node: Process Buffers1804386 -Node: Filter Functions1807255 -Node: Accepting Output1812822 -Node: Sentinels1814349 -Node: Process Window Size1817842 -Node: Transaction Queues1818191 -Node: Network1819889 -Node: System Interface1821723 -Node: Starting Up1822993 -Node: Start-up Summary1823587 -Node: Init File1827141 -Node: Terminal-Specific1829525 -Node: Command Line Arguments1832684 -Node: Getting Out1836173 -Node: Killing XEmacs1836742 -Node: Suspending XEmacs1838411 -Node: System Environment1841727 -Node: User Identification1848392 -Node: Time of Day1851922 -Node: Time Conversion1854711 -Node: Timers1859753 -Node: Terminal Input1861926 -Node: Input Modes1862429 -Node: Translating Input1864842 -Node: Recording Input1869007 -Node: Terminal Output1871108 -Node: Flow Control1874731 -Node: Batch Mode1878524 -Node: X-Windows1879906 -Node: X Selections1880718 -Node: X Server1882928 -Node: Resources1883329 -Node: Server Data1888470 -Node: Grabs1889677 -Node: X Miscellaneous1891258 -Node: ToolTalk Support1893643 -Node: XEmacs ToolTalk API Summary1893860 -Node: Sending Messages1895160 -Node: Example of Sending Messages1895411 -Node: Elisp Interface for Sending Messages1896473 -Node: Receiving Messages1902866 -Node: Example of Receiving Messages1903089 -Node: Elisp Interface for Receiving Messages1903925 -Node: LDAP Support1907750 -Node: Building XEmacs with LDAP support1908246 -Node: XEmacs LDAP API1909224 -Node: LDAP Variables1909954 -Node: The High-Level LDAP API1912431 -Node: The Low-Level LDAP API1913544 -Node: The LDAP Lisp Object1913818 -Node: Opening and Closing a LDAP Connection1914371 -Node: Searching on a LDAP Server (Low-level)1916154 -Node: Syntax of Search Filters1917549 -Node: Internationalization1918847 -Node: I18N Levels 1 and 21919184 -Node: I18N Level 31919890 -Node: Level 3 Basics1920171 -Node: Level 3 Primitives1921004 -Node: Dynamic Messaging1922610 -Node: Domain Specification1923073 -Node: Documentation String Extraction1924976 -Node: I18N Level 41925894 -Node: MULE1926086 -Node: Internationalization Terminology1927197 -Node: Charsets1935736 -Node: Charset Properties1936432 -Node: Basic Charset Functions1941118 -Node: Charset Property Functions1943299 -Node: Predefined Charsets1945342 -Node: MULE Characters1948262 -Node: Composite Characters1949109 -Node: ISO 20221950363 -Node: Coding Systems1956085 -Node: Coding System Types1958007 -Node: EOL Conversion1959826 -Node: Coding System Properties1961009 -Node: Basic Coding System Functions1964861 -Node: Coding System Property Functions1966765 -Node: Encoding and Decoding Text1967323 -Node: Detection of Textual Encoding1968459 -Node: Big5 and Shift-JIS Functions1969995 -Node: CCL1971083 -Node: CCL Syntax1974187 -Node: CCL Statements1975775 -Node: CCL Expressions1980423 -Node: Calling CCL1983575 -Node: CCL Examples1986565 -Node: Category Tables1986702 -Node: Tips1989061 -Node: Style Tips1989702 -Node: Compilation Tips1999222 -Node: Documentation Tips2001138 -Node: Comment Tips2006647 -Node: Library Headers2009649 -Node: Building XEmacs and Object Allocation2013621 -Node: Building XEmacs2014504 -Node: Pure Storage2020839 -Node: Garbage Collection2023627 -Node: Standard Errors2034766 -Node: Standard Buffer-Local Variables2038975 -Node: Standard Keymaps2041651 -Node: Standard Hooks2045383 -Node: Index2052883 +Node: Top2366 +Node: Copying48385 +Node: Introduction67543 +Node: Caveats69134 +Node: Lisp History70865 +Node: Conventions72121 +Node: Some Terms72936 +Node: nil and t73657 +Node: Evaluation Notation75334 +Node: Printing Notation76247 +Node: Error Messages77121 +Node: Buffer Text Notation77562 +Node: Format of Descriptions78437 +Node: A Sample Function Description79291 +Node: A Sample Variable Description83277 +Node: Acknowledgements84185 +Node: Lisp Data Types86163 +Node: Printed Representation88718 +Node: Comments90760 +Node: Primitive Types91657 +Node: Programming Types93316 +Node: Integer Type95268 +Node: Floating Point Type96305 +Node: Character Type96924 +Node: Symbol Type104830 +Node: Sequence Type107525 +Node: Cons Cell Type109044 +Node: Dotted Pair Notation113528 +Node: Association List Type115649 +Node: Array Type116532 +Node: String Type117998 +Node: Vector Type120679 +Node: Bit Vector Type121451 +Node: Function Type122313 +Node: Macro Type123426 +Node: Primitive Function Type124123 +Node: Compiled-Function Type125649 +Node: Autoload Type126203 +Node: Char Table Type127217 +Node: Hash Table Type127391 +Node: Range Table Type128546 +Node: Weak List Type129399 +Node: Editing Types129549 +Node: Buffer Type131176 +Node: Marker Type133203 +Node: Extent Type133927 +Node: Window Type135195 +Node: Frame Type136606 +Node: Device Type137401 +Node: Console Type138227 +Node: Window Configuration Type139428 +Node: Event Type140126 +Node: Process Type140290 +Node: Stream Type141325 +Node: Keymap Type142448 +Node: Syntax Table Type142986 +Node: Display Table Type144009 +Node: Database Type144448 +Node: Charset Type144614 +Node: Coding System Type144778 +Node: ToolTalk Message Type144962 +Node: ToolTalk Pattern Type145161 +Node: Window-System Types145333 +Node: Face Type146479 +Node: Glyph Type146610 +Node: Specifier Type146766 +Node: Font Instance Type146939 +Node: Color Instance Type147129 +Node: Image Instance Type147326 +Node: Toolbar Button Type147524 +Node: Subwindow Type147717 +Node: X Resource Type147896 +Node: Type Predicates148049 +Node: Equality Predicates157178 +Node: Numbers161983 +Node: Integer Basics163438 +Node: Float Basics165787 +Node: Predicates on Numbers167529 +Node: Comparison of Numbers169162 +Node: Numeric Conversions172983 +Node: Arithmetic Operations174449 +Node: Rounding Operations179914 +Node: Bitwise Operations181019 +Node: Math Functions190065 +Node: Random Numbers192381 +Node: Strings and Characters194147 +Node: String Basics195600 +Node: Predicates for Strings198018 +Node: Creating Strings198781 +Node: Predicates for Characters204098 +Node: Character Codes205169 +Node: Text Comparison206582 +Node: String Conversion209944 +Node: Modifying Strings213620 +Node: String Properties214261 +Node: Formatting Strings214904 +Node: Character Case224522 +Node: Case Tables227668 +Node: Char Tables231566 +Node: Char Table Types232958 +Node: Working With Char Tables234533 +Node: Lists236482 +Node: Cons Cells237605 +Node: Lists as Boxes238941 +Node: List-related Predicates241583 +Node: List Elements243285 +Node: Building Lists248314 +Node: Modifying Lists254306 +Node: Setcar255118 +Node: Setcdr257539 +Node: Rearrangement260050 +Node: Sets And Lists265636 +Node: Association Lists269864 +Ref: Association Lists-Footnote-1279159 +Node: Property Lists279364 +Node: Working With Normal Plists280912 +Node: Working With Lax Plists283180 +Node: Converting Plists To/From Alists285420 +Node: Weak Lists286768 +Node: Sequences Arrays Vectors288932 +Node: Sequence Functions291568 +Node: Arrays295227 +Node: Array Functions298291 +Node: Vectors300824 +Node: Vector Functions302322 +Node: Bit Vectors304893 +Node: Bit Vector Functions305738 +Node: Symbols307988 +Node: Symbol Components309037 +Node: Definitions313210 +Node: Creating Symbols315435 +Node: Symbol Properties322469 +Node: Plists and Alists323985 +Node: Symbol Plists325734 +Node: Other Plists327543 +Node: Evaluation329321 +Node: Intro Eval330126 +Ref: Intro Eval-Footnote-1333479 +Node: Eval333614 +Node: Forms338032 +Node: Self-Evaluating Forms339191 +Node: Symbol Forms340704 +Node: Classifying Lists341621 +Node: Function Indirection342377 +Node: Function Forms345488 +Node: Macro Forms346485 +Node: Special Forms348085 +Node: Autoloading350394 +Node: Quoting350892 +Node: Control Structures352253 +Node: Sequencing353873 +Node: Conditionals356738 +Node: Combining Conditions360161 +Node: Iteration363431 +Node: Nonlocal Exits365210 +Node: Catch and Throw365912 +Node: Examples of Catch369751 +Node: Errors371770 +Node: Signaling Errors373259 +Node: Processing of Errors376335 +Node: Handling Errors377664 +Node: Error Symbols384580 +Node: Cleanups388026 +Node: Variables391804 +Node: Global Variables393573 +Node: Constant Variables394649 +Node: Local Variables395275 +Node: Void Variables400212 +Node: Defining Variables403728 +Node: Accessing Variables410892 +Node: Setting Variables412317 +Node: Variable Scoping416836 +Node: Scope418435 +Node: Extent419960 +Node: Impl of Scope421439 +Node: Using Scoping423402 +Node: Buffer-Local Variables424924 +Node: Intro to Buffer-Local425760 +Node: Creating Buffer-Local428303 +Node: Default Value433522 +Node: Variable Aliases436665 +Node: Functions438450 +Node: What Is a Function439544 +Node: Lambda Expressions443590 +Node: Lambda Components444500 +Node: Simple Lambda446332 +Node: Argument List447989 +Node: Function Documentation451717 +Node: Function Names453659 +Node: Defining Functions456232 +Node: Calling Functions459272 +Node: Mapping Functions463121 +Node: Anonymous Functions465514 +Node: Function Cells468759 +Node: Inline Functions473569 +Node: Related Topics475379 +Node: Macros476432 +Node: Simple Macro477716 +Node: Expansion478451 +Node: Compiling Macros481455 +Node: Defining Macros483291 +Node: Backquote484608 +Node: Problems with Macros487005 +Node: Argument Evaluation487700 +Node: Surprising Local Vars490615 +Node: Eval During Expansion492683 +Node: Repeated Expansion494376 +Node: Customization496292 +Node: Common Keywords496761 +Node: Group Definitions499606 +Node: Variable Definitions501798 +Node: Customization Types506781 +Node: Simple Types508216 +Node: Composite Types510373 +Node: Splicing into Lists515063 +Node: Type Keywords516898 +Node: Loading520418 +Node: How Programs Do Loading522093 +Node: Autoload531220 +Node: Repeated Loading537299 +Node: Named Features539412 +Node: Unloading545844 +Node: Hooks for Loading548000 +Node: Byte Compilation548717 +Node: Speed of Byte-Code550634 +Node: Compilation Functions551841 +Node: Docs and Compilation558228 +Node: Dynamic Loading560881 +Node: Eval During Compile563245 +Node: Compiled-Function Objects564510 +Node: Disassembly569308 +Node: Debugging576562 +Node: Debugger577974 +Node: Error Debugging579119 +Node: Infinite Loops581872 +Node: Function Debugging583116 +Node: Explicit Debug585906 +Node: Using Debugger586677 +Node: Debugger Commands588539 +Node: Invoking the Debugger592856 +Node: Internals of Debugger596771 +Node: Syntax Errors601658 +Node: Excess Open602906 +Node: Excess Close604781 +Node: Compilation Errors606202 +Node: Edebug607490 +Node: Using Edebug609598 +Node: Instrumenting612295 +Node: Edebug Execution Modes615784 +Node: Jumping618894 +Node: Edebug Misc621237 +Node: Breakpoints622626 +Node: Global Break Condition625432 +Node: Embedded Breakpoints626387 +Node: Trapping Errors627342 +Node: Edebug Views629418 +Node: Edebug Eval631383 +Node: Eval List632560 +Node: Reading in Edebug635945 +Node: Printing in Edebug636744 +Node: Tracing638459 +Node: Coverage Testing640345 +Node: The Outside Context642386 +Node: Checking Whether to Stop643335 +Node: Edebug Display Update643982 +Node: Edebug Recursive Edit646005 +Node: Instrumenting Macro Calls647660 +Node: Specification List650142 +Node: Backtracking659553 +Node: Debugging Backquote661491 +Node: Specification Examples665197 +Node: Edebug Options667264 +Node: Read and Print672601 +Node: Streams Intro673578 +Node: Input Streams675596 +Node: Input Functions680497 +Node: Output Streams682557 +Node: Output Functions686608 +Node: Output Variables690908 +Node: Minibuffers695707 +Node: Intro to Minibuffers696792 +Node: Text from Minibuffer699118 +Node: Object from Minibuffer703780 +Node: Minibuffer History706997 +Node: Completion709907 +Node: Basic Completion711882 +Node: Minibuffer Completion716906 +Node: Completion Commands720151 +Node: High-Level Completion724798 +Node: Reading File Names728822 +Node: Programmed Completion732511 +Node: Yes-or-No Queries734721 +Node: Multiple Queries740458 +Node: Minibuffer Misc744522 +Node: Command Loop749388 +Node: Command Overview750732 +Node: Defining Commands754010 +Node: Using Interactive754758 +Node: Interactive Codes759531 +Node: Interactive Examples765323 +Node: Interactive Call766637 +Node: Command Loop Info772038 +Node: Events777017 +Node: Event Types778477 +Node: Event Contents780400 +Node: Event Predicates784876 +Node: Accessing Mouse Event Positions786201 +Node: Frame-Level Event Position Info786900 +Node: Window-Level Event Position Info787940 +Node: Event Text Position Info789704 +Node: Event Glyph Position Info792196 +Node: Event Toolbar Position Info793519 +Node: Other Event Position Info794190 +Node: Accessing Other Event Info794599 +Node: Working With Events796219 +Node: Converting Events802207 +Node: Reading Input805160 +Node: Key Sequence Input806162 +Node: Reading One Event808116 +Node: Dispatching an Event810877 +Node: Quoted Character Input811328 +Node: Peeking and Discarding812676 +Node: Waiting816580 +Node: Quitting818888 +Node: Prefix Command Arguments823296 +Node: Recursive Editing828383 +Node: Disabling Commands833179 +Node: Command History835247 +Node: Keyboard Macros836984 +Node: Keymaps839201 +Node: Keymap Terminology840778 +Node: Format of Keymaps843707 +Node: Creating Keymaps844118 +Node: Inheritance and Keymaps846197 +Node: Key Sequences848569 +Node: Prefix Keys853139 +Node: Active Keymaps856724 +Node: Key Lookup865939 +Node: Functions for Key Lookup871102 +Node: Changing Key Bindings876799 +Node: Key Binding Commands883696 +Node: Scanning Keymaps885761 +Node: Other Keymap Functions894272 +Node: Menus894894 +Node: Menu Format895436 +Node: Menubar Format904021 +Node: Menubar904646 +Node: Modifying Menus907759 +Node: Menu Filters912773 +Node: Pop-Up Menus914669 +Node: Menu Accelerators916874 +Node: Creating Menu Accelerators917596 +Node: Keyboard Menu Traversal918914 +Node: Menu Accelerator Functions919641 +Node: Buffers Menu922676 +Node: Dialog Boxes923970 +Node: Dialog Box Format924137 +Node: Dialog Box Functions925507 +Node: Toolbar925904 +Node: Toolbar Intro926229 +Node: Toolbar Descriptor Format928639 +Node: Specifying the Toolbar933133 +Node: Other Toolbar Variables936738 +Node: Scrollbars941165 +Node: Drag and Drop941301 +Node: Supported Protocols942377 +Node: OffiX DND942880 +Node: CDE dt943887 +Node: MSWindows OLE944478 +Node: Loose ends944649 +Node: Drop Interface945041 +Node: Drag Interface946063 +Node: Modes946237 +Node: Major Modes947188 +Node: Major Mode Conventions950103 +Node: Example Major Modes956058 +Node: Auto Major Mode964091 +Node: Mode Help971539 +Node: Derived Modes972640 +Node: Minor Modes974831 +Node: Minor Mode Conventions976133 +Node: Keymaps and Minor Modes978996 +Node: Modeline Format979831 +Node: Modeline Data981599 +Node: Modeline Variables985869 +Node: %-Constructs990585 +Node: Hooks993496 +Node: Documentation1000258 +Node: Documentation Basics1001681 +Node: Accessing Documentation1004731 +Node: Keys in Documentation1011010 +Node: Describing Characters1014489 +Node: Help Functions1016838 +Node: Obsoleteness1023289 +Node: Files1026283 +Node: Visiting Files1028208 +Node: Visiting Functions1029713 +Node: Subroutines of Visiting1034760 +Node: Saving Buffers1036833 +Node: Reading from Files1042926 +Node: Writing to Files1045083 +Node: File Locks1047800 +Node: Information about Files1050853 +Node: Testing Accessibility1051614 +Node: Kinds of Files1055354 +Node: Truenames1057035 +Node: File Attributes1058037 +Node: Changing File Attributes1063176 +Node: File Names1068582 +Node: File Name Components1070191 +Node: Directory Names1073292 +Node: Relative File Names1076745 +Node: File Name Expansion1077823 +Node: Unique File Names1081730 +Node: File Name Completion1083345 +Node: User Name Completion1086006 +Node: Contents of Directories1087346 +Node: Create/Delete Dirs1090659 +Node: Magic File Names1091765 +Node: Partial Files1097395 +Node: Intro to Partial Files1097623 +Node: Creating a Partial File1098863 +Node: Detached Partial Files1099798 +Node: Format Conversion1100920 +Node: Files and MS-DOS1107436 +Node: Backups and Auto-Saving1109500 +Node: Backup Files1110175 +Node: Making Backups1111572 +Node: Rename or Copy1114321 +Node: Numbered Backups1116814 +Node: Backup Names1119058 +Node: Auto-Saving1122350 +Node: Reverting1130492 +Node: Buffers1133650 +Node: Buffer Basics1135067 +Node: Current Buffer1137120 +Node: Buffer Names1141808 +Node: Buffer File Name1145013 +Node: Buffer Modification1149132 +Node: Modification Time1151325 +Node: Read Only Buffers1154700 +Node: The Buffer List1157118 +Node: Creating Buffers1161948 +Node: Killing Buffers1164094 +Node: Indirect Buffers1167825 +Node: Windows1170397 +Node: Basic Windows1171875 +Node: Splitting Windows1174973 +Node: Deleting Windows1181862 +Node: Selecting Windows1184542 +Node: Cyclic Window Ordering1187671 +Node: Buffers and Windows1192295 +Node: Displaying Buffers1194136 +Node: Choosing Window1199312 +Node: Window Point1207028 +Node: Window Start1209074 +Node: Vertical Scrolling1213564 +Node: Horizontal Scrolling1219701 +Node: Size of Window1223210 +Node: Position of Window1227928 +Node: Resizing Windows1230168 +Node: Window Configurations1235597 +Node: Frames1239022 +Node: Creating Frames1240791 +Node: Frame Properties1242132 +Node: Property Access1242948 +Node: Initial Properties1243797 +Node: X Frame Properties1246283 +Node: Size and Position1250917 +Node: Frame Name1252913 +Node: Frame Titles1253827 +Node: Deleting Frames1255651 +Node: Finding All Frames1256251 +Node: Frames and Windows1258245 +Node: Minibuffers and Frames1259950 +Node: Input Focus1260868 +Node: Visibility of Frames1263945 +Node: Raising and Lowering1265864 +Node: Frame Configurations1268240 +Node: Frame Hooks1268834 +Node: Consoles and Devices1270639 +Node: Basic Console Functions1273383 +Node: Basic Device Functions1273806 +Node: Console Types and Device Classes1274522 +Node: Connecting to a Console or Device1276719 +Node: The Selected Console and Device1278882 +Node: Console and Device I/O1279908 +Node: Positions1280672 +Node: Point1281641 +Node: Motion1284731 +Node: Character Motion1285498 +Node: Word Motion1287735 +Node: Buffer End Motion1289236 +Node: Text Lines1290733 +Node: Screen Lines1295328 +Node: List Motion1299391 +Node: Skipping Characters1302799 +Node: Excursions1305018 +Node: Narrowing1308050 +Node: Markers1313375 +Node: Overview of Markers1314281 +Node: Predicates on Markers1318973 +Node: Creating Markers1320219 +Node: Information from Markers1324256 +Node: Changing Markers1325354 +Node: The Mark1326732 +Node: The Region1335226 +Node: Text1340913 +Node: Near Point1343612 +Node: Buffer Contents1347334 +Node: Comparing Text1348740 +Node: Insertion1350148 +Node: Commands for Insertion1353990 +Node: Deletion1356946 +Node: User-Level Deletion1360541 +Node: The Kill Ring1364702 +Node: Kill Ring Concepts1366876 +Node: Kill Functions1367930 +Node: Yank Commands1369835 +Node: Low-Level Kill Ring1371706 +Node: Internals of Kill Ring1374492 +Node: Undo1377272 +Node: Maintaining Undo1381601 +Node: Filling1384221 +Node: Margins1390215 +Node: Auto Filling1394144 +Node: Sorting1395325 +Node: Columns1404625 +Node: Indentation1407141 +Node: Primitive Indent1407920 +Node: Mode-Specific Indent1409164 +Node: Region Indent1411675 +Node: Relative Indent1414623 +Node: Indent Tabs1417005 +Node: Motion by Indent1418326 +Node: Case Changes1419105 +Node: Text Properties1422356 +Node: Examining Properties1424169 +Node: Changing Properties1426036 +Node: Property Search1429627 +Node: Special Properties1434338 +Node: Saving Properties1434619 +Node: Substitution1437761 +Node: Registers1441031 +Node: Transposition1443574 +Node: Change Hooks1444468 +Node: Transformations1446508 +Node: Searching and Matching1450893 +Node: String Search1452024 +Node: Regular Expressions1456748 +Node: Syntax of Regexps1458115 +Node: Regexp Example1472494 +Node: Regexp Search1474664 +Node: POSIX Regexps1480752 +Node: Search and Replace1482587 +Node: Match Data1485952 +Node: Simple Match Data1487082 +Node: Replacing Match1491347 +Node: Entire Match Data1493681 +Node: Saving Match Data1495672 +Node: Searching and Case1497053 +Node: Standard Regexps1499087 +Node: Syntax Tables1501285 +Node: Syntax Basics1502399 +Node: Syntax Descriptors1505371 +Node: Syntax Class Table1507221 +Node: Syntax Flags1513259 +Node: Syntax Table Functions1516476 +Node: Motion and Syntax1520340 +Node: Parsing Expressions1521792 +Node: Standard Syntax Tables1527861 +Node: Syntax Table Internals1528705 +Node: Abbrevs1529731 +Node: Abbrev Mode1531534 +Node: Abbrev Tables1532254 +Node: Defining Abbrevs1533787 +Node: Abbrev Files1535692 +Node: Abbrev Expansion1537465 +Node: Standard Abbrev Tables1542096 +Node: Extents1543255 +Node: Intro to Extents1544498 +Node: Creating and Modifying Extents1548492 +Node: Extent Endpoints1549999 +Node: Finding Extents1553262 +Node: Mapping Over Extents1557011 +Node: Extent Properties1563128 +Node: Detached Extents1573272 +Node: Extent Parents1575131 +Node: Duplicable Extents1576826 +Node: Extents and Events1580047 +Node: Atomic Extents1581954 +Node: Specifiers1582401 +Node: Introduction to Specifiers1584208 +Node: Specifiers In-Depth1586518 +Node: Specifier Instancing1591432 +Node: Specifier Types1594694 +Node: Adding Specifications1599768 +Node: Retrieving Specifications1609130 +Node: Specifier Tag Functions1612865 +Node: Specifier Instancing Functions1616099 +Node: Specifier Example1619506 +Node: Creating Specifiers1622612 +Node: Specifier Validation Functions1624861 +Node: Other Specification Functions1627245 +Node: Faces and Window-System Objects1631064 +Node: Faces1631388 +Node: Merging Faces1633005 +Node: Basic Face Functions1634966 +Node: Face Properties1637064 +Node: Face Convenience Functions1646623 +Node: Other Face Display Functions1649753 +Node: Fonts1650566 +Node: Font Specifiers1651267 +Node: Font Instances1651508 +Node: Font Instance Names1652475 +Node: Font Instance Size1653316 +Node: Font Instance Characteristics1654602 +Node: Font Convenience Functions1655771 +Node: Colors1657061 +Node: Color Specifiers1657501 +Node: Color Instances1657728 +Node: Color Instance Properties1658472 +Node: Color Convenience Functions1659098 +Node: Glyphs1660151 +Node: Glyph Functions1661743 +Node: Creating Glyphs1662150 +Node: Glyph Properties1663737 +Node: Glyph Convenience Functions1672904 +Node: Glyph Dimensions1676851 +Node: Images1677931 +Node: Image Specifiers1678380 +Node: Image Instantiator Conversion1689802 +Node: Image Instances1691167 +Node: Image Instance Types1691918 +Node: Image Instance Functions1694573 +Node: Glyph Types1699142 +Node: Mouse Pointer1700914 +Node: Redisplay Glyphs1703917 +Node: Subwindows1704950 +Node: Annotations1705193 +Node: Annotation Basics1706209 +Node: Annotation Primitives1710147 +Node: Annotation Properties1711476 +Node: Locating Annotations1714516 +Node: Margin Primitives1715353 +Node: Annotation Hooks1717247 +Node: Display1717907 +Node: Refresh Screen1718885 +Node: Truncation1720796 +Node: The Echo Area1723321 +Node: Warnings1729756 +Node: Invisible Text1734192 +Node: Selective Display1736771 +Node: Overlay Arrow1740897 +Node: Temporary Displays1742250 +Node: Blinking1746371 +Node: Usual Display1748556 +Node: Display Tables1751105 +Node: Display Table Format1751909 +Node: Active Display Table1753351 +Node: Character Descriptors1754543 +Node: Beeping1755300 +Node: Hash Tables1760066 +Node: Introduction to Hash Tables1760674 +Node: Working With Hash Tables1766697 +Node: Weak Hash Tables1767814 +Node: Range Tables1769613 +Node: Introduction to Range Tables1770302 +Node: Working With Range Tables1770733 +Node: Databases1771618 +Node: Connecting to a Database1771917 +Node: Working With a Database1773008 +Node: Other Database Functions1773866 +Node: Processes1774440 +Node: Subprocess Creation1776664 +Node: Synchronous Processes1779953 +Node: MS-DOS Subprocesses1786671 +Node: Asynchronous Processes1787745 +Node: Deleting Processes1791458 +Node: Process Information1793329 +Node: Input to Processes1797255 +Node: Signals to Processes1799545 +Node: Output from Processes1803965 +Node: Process Buffers1804777 +Node: Filter Functions1807644 +Node: Accepting Output1813214 +Node: Sentinels1814741 +Node: Process Window Size1818231 +Node: Transaction Queues1818580 +Node: Network1820278 +Node: System Interface1822112 +Node: Starting Up1823382 +Node: Start-up Summary1823976 +Node: Init File1827530 +Node: Terminal-Specific1829911 +Node: Command Line Arguments1833070 +Node: Getting Out1836559 +Node: Killing XEmacs1837128 +Node: Suspending XEmacs1838797 +Node: System Environment1842139 +Node: User Identification1848806 +Node: Time of Day1852335 +Node: Time Conversion1855122 +Node: Timers1860162 +Node: Terminal Input1862335 +Node: Input Modes1862838 +Node: Translating Input1865251 +Node: Recording Input1869416 +Node: Terminal Output1871516 +Node: Flow Control1875139 +Node: Batch Mode1878931 +Node: X-Windows1880313 +Node: X Selections1881125 +Node: X Server1883335 +Node: Resources1883736 +Node: Server Data1888877 +Node: Grabs1890084 +Node: X Miscellaneous1891665 +Node: ToolTalk Support1894050 +Node: XEmacs ToolTalk API Summary1894267 +Node: Sending Messages1895567 +Node: Example of Sending Messages1895818 +Node: Elisp Interface for Sending Messages1896880 +Node: Receiving Messages1903273 +Node: Example of Receiving Messages1903496 +Node: Elisp Interface for Receiving Messages1904332 +Node: LDAP Support1908157 +Node: Building XEmacs with LDAP support1908653 +Node: XEmacs LDAP API1909631 +Node: LDAP Variables1910361 +Node: The High-Level LDAP API1912837 +Node: The Low-Level LDAP API1913942 +Node: The LDAP Lisp Object1914216 +Node: Opening and Closing a LDAP Connection1914769 +Node: Searching on a LDAP Server (Low-level)1916552 +Node: Syntax of Search Filters1917945 +Node: Internationalization1919243 +Node: I18N Levels 1 and 21919580 +Node: I18N Level 31920286 +Node: Level 3 Basics1920567 +Node: Level 3 Primitives1921400 +Node: Dynamic Messaging1923006 +Node: Domain Specification1923469 +Node: Documentation String Extraction1925372 +Node: I18N Level 41926290 +Node: MULE1926482 +Node: Internationalization Terminology1927593 +Node: Charsets1936132 +Node: Charset Properties1936828 +Node: Basic Charset Functions1941514 +Node: Charset Property Functions1943695 +Node: Predefined Charsets1945738 +Node: MULE Characters1948658 +Node: Composite Characters1949505 +Node: ISO 20221950759 +Node: Coding Systems1956481 +Node: Coding System Types1958403 +Node: EOL Conversion1960222 +Node: Coding System Properties1961405 +Node: Basic Coding System Functions1965257 +Node: Coding System Property Functions1967161 +Node: Encoding and Decoding Text1967719 +Node: Detection of Textual Encoding1968855 +Node: Big5 and Shift-JIS Functions1970391 +Node: CCL1971479 +Node: CCL Syntax1974583 +Node: CCL Statements1976171 +Node: CCL Expressions1980819 +Node: Calling CCL1983358 +Node: CCL Examples1986347 +Node: Category Tables1986484 +Node: Tips1988843 +Node: Style Tips1989484 +Node: Compilation Tips1999003 +Node: Documentation Tips2000917 +Node: Comment Tips2006426 +Node: Library Headers2009428 +Node: Building XEmacs and Object Allocation2013400 +Node: Building XEmacs2014283 +Node: Pure Storage2020618 +Node: Garbage Collection2023406 +Node: Standard Errors2034545 +Node: Standard Buffer-Local Variables2038754 +Node: Standard Keymaps2041387 +Node: Standard Hooks2045119 +Node: Index2052619  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/lispref.info-1 b/info/lispref.info-1 index 097bf97..dfc2f71 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-1 +++ b/info/lispref.info-1 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -151,7 +151,7 @@ Appendices * Index:: Index including concepts, functions, variables, and other terms. - -- The Detailed Node Listing -- + --- The Detailed Node Listing --- Here are other nodes that are inferiors of those already listed, mentioned here so you can get to them in one step: @@ -303,7 +303,7 @@ Kinds of Forms * Classifying Lists:: How to distinguish various sorts of list forms. * Function Forms:: Forms that call functions. * Macro Forms:: Forms that call macros. -* Special Forms:: "Special forms" are idiosyncratic primitives, +* Special Forms:: ``Special forms'' are idiosyncratic primitives, most of them extremely important. * Autoloading:: Functions set up to load files containing their real definitions. @@ -466,7 +466,7 @@ Command Loop * Events:: What input looks like when you read it. * Reading Input:: How to read input events from the keyboard or mouse. * Waiting:: Waiting for user input or elapsed time. -* Quitting:: How `C-g' works. How to catch or defer quitting. +* Quitting:: How C-g works. How to catch or defer quitting. * Prefix Command Arguments:: How the commands to set prefix args work. * Recursive Editing:: Entering a recursive edit, and why you usually shouldn't. @@ -651,7 +651,7 @@ Buffers is visited. * Buffer Modification:: A buffer is "modified" if it needs to be saved. * Modification Time:: Determining whether the visited file was changed - "behind XEmacs's back". + ``behind XEmacs's back''. * Read Only Buffers:: Modifying text is not allowed in a read-only buffer. * The Buffer List:: How to look at all the existing buffers. @@ -720,8 +720,8 @@ Markers * Information from Markers:: Finding the marker's buffer or character position. * Changing Markers:: Moving the marker to a new buffer or position. -* The Mark:: How "the mark" is implemented with a marker. -* The Region:: How to access "the region". +* The Mark:: How ``the mark'' is implemented with a marker. +* The Region:: How to access ``the region''. Text @@ -828,10 +828,10 @@ Specifiers (under user control) in a wide variety of contexts. * Specifiers In-Depth:: Gory details about specifier innards. -* Specifier Instancing:: Instancing means obtaining the "value" of +* Specifier Instancing:: Instancing means obtaining the ``value'' of a specifier in a particular context. * Specifier Types:: Specifiers come in different flavors. -* Adding Specifications:: Specifications control a specifier's "value" +* Adding Specifications:: Specifications control a specifier's ``value'' by giving conditions under which a particular value is valid. * Retrieving Specifications:: Querying a specifier's specifications. diff --git a/info/lispref.info-2 b/info/lispref.info-2 index 291dd3e..e2a39c4 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-2 +++ b/info/lispref.info-2 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -477,7 +477,7 @@ function or variable name, as appropriate. Also state the number of the edition which you are criticizing. This manual was originally written for FSF Emacs 19 and was updated -by Ben Wing (wing@666.com) for Lucid Emacs 19.10 and later for XEmacs +by Ben Wing (ben@xemacs.org) for Lucid Emacs 19.10 and later for XEmacs 19.12, 19.13, 19.14, and 20.0. It was further updated by the XEmacs Development Team for 19.15 and 20.1. Please send comments and corrections relating to XEmacs-specific portions of this manual to @@ -667,7 +667,7 @@ and "after" versions of the text. These examples show the contents of the buffer in question between two lines of dashes containing the buffer name. In addition, `-!-' indicates the location of point. (The symbol for point, of course, is not part of the text in the buffer; it -indicates the place *between* two characters where point is located.) +indicates the place _between_ two characters where point is located.) ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- This is the -!-contents of foo. @@ -723,7 +723,7 @@ Do not write `&rest' when you call the function. Here is a description of an imaginary function `foo': - - Function: foo INTEGER1 &optional INTEGER2 &rest INTEGERS + - Function: foo integer1 &optional integer2 &rest integers The function `foo' subtracts INTEGER1 from INTEGER2, then adds all the rest of the arguments to the result. If INTEGER2 is not supplied, then the number 19 is used by default. @@ -939,7 +939,7 @@ signals the error `invalid-read-syntax' whenever it encounters `#<'. When you evaluate an expression interactively, the Lisp interpreter first reads the textual representation of it, producing a Lisp object, -and then evaluates that object (*note Evaluation::.). However, +and then evaluates that object (*note Evaluation::). However, evaluation and reading are separate activities. Reading returns the Lisp object represented by the text that is read; the object may or may not be evaluated later. *Note Input Functions::, for a description of @@ -962,7 +962,7 @@ system. The `#@COUNT' construct, which skips the next COUNT characters, is useful for program-generated comments containing binary data. The XEmacs Lisp byte compiler uses this in its output files (*note Byte -Compilation::.). It isn't meant for source files, however. +Compilation::). It isn't meant for source files, however. *Note Comment Tips::, for conventions for formatting comments. @@ -1138,7 +1138,7 @@ Integer Type machines, in particular 64-bit machines such as the DEC Alpha, may provide a wider range.) It is important to note that the XEmacs Lisp arithmetic functions do not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' -is -134217728 on most machines. (However, you *will* get an error if +is -134217728 on most machines. (However, you _will_ get an error if you attempt to read an out-of-range number using the Lisp reader.) The read syntax for integers is a sequence of (base ten) digits with diff --git a/info/lispref.info-3 b/info/lispref.info-3 index d59669d..bb82c59 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-3 +++ b/info/lispref.info-3 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ integer 65, following the standard ASCII representation of characters. If XEmacs was not compiled with MULE support, the range of this integer will always be 0 to 255 - eight bits, or one byte. (Integers outside this range are accepted but silently truncated; however, you should -most decidedly *not* rely on this, because it will not work under +most decidedly _not_ rely on this, because it will not work under XEmacs with MULE support.) When MULE support is present, the range of character codes is much larger. (Currently, 19 bits are used.) @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ that does not distinguish between ASCII keys and other keys), so you will never find character codes above 255 in a non-MULE XEmacs. Individual characters are not often used in programs. It is far more -common to work with *strings*, which are sequences composed of +common to work with _strings_, which are sequences composed of characters. *Note String Type::. The read syntax for characters begins with a question mark, followed @@ -104,7 +104,7 @@ print representation. In XEmacs 19, however, where characters are really integers, the printed representation of a character is a decimal number. This is also a possible read syntax for a character, but writing characters that way in Lisp programs is a very bad idea. You -should *always* use the special read syntax formats that XEmacs Lisp +should _always_ use the special read syntax formats that XEmacs Lisp provides for characters. The usual read syntax for alphanumeric characters is a question mark @@ -122,7 +122,7 @@ the character `B', and `?a' for the character `a'. You can use the same syntax for punctuation characters, but it is often a good idea to add a `\' so that the Emacs commands for editing Lisp code don't get confused. For example, `?\ ' is the way to write -the space character. If the character is `\', you *must* use a second +the space character. If the character is `\', you _must_ use a second `\' to quote it: `?\\'. XEmacs 20 always prints punctuation characters with a `\' in front of them, to avoid confusion. @@ -177,7 +177,7 @@ example, both `?\^I' and `?\^i' are valid read syntax for the character There is also a character read syntax beginning with `\M-'. This sets the high bit of the character code (same as adding 128 to the character code). For example, `?\M-A' stands for the character with -character code 193, or 128 plus 65. You should *not* use this syntax +character code 193, or 128 plus 65. You should _not_ use this syntax in your programs. It is a holdover of yet another confoundance disease from earlier Emacsen. (This was used to represent keyboard input with the key set, thus the `M'; however, it conflicts with the @@ -276,8 +276,8 @@ considered a sequence. Arrays are further subdivided into strings, vectors, and bit vectors. Vectors can hold elements of any type, but string elements must be characters, and bit vector elements must be either 0 or 1. However, the -characters in a string can have extents (*note Extents::.) and text -properties (*note Text Properties::.) like characters in a buffer; +characters in a string can have extents (*note Extents::) and text +properties (*note Text Properties::) like characters in a buffer; vectors do not support extents or text properties even when their elements happen to be characters. @@ -357,7 +357,7 @@ cell refers to `nil'. Here is another diagram of the same list, `(rose violet buttercup)', sketched in a different manner: - --------------- ---------------- ------------------- + --------------- ---------------- ------------------- | car | cdr | | car | cdr | | car | cdr | | rose | o-------->| violet | o-------->| buttercup | nil | | | | | | | | | | @@ -614,13 +614,13 @@ Function Type functions in Lisp are primarily Lisp objects, and only secondarily the text which represents them. These Lisp objects are lambda expressions: lists whose first element is the symbol `lambda' (*note Lambda -Expressions::.). +Expressions::). In most programming languages, it is impossible to have a function without a name. In Lisp, a function has no intrinsic name. A lambda expression is also called an "anonymous function" (*note Anonymous -Functions::.). A named function in Lisp is actually a symbol with a -valid function in its function cell (*note Defining Functions::.). +Functions::). A named function in Lisp is actually a symbol with a +valid function in its function cell (*note Defining Functions::). Most of the time, functions are called when their names are written in Lisp expressions in Lisp programs. However, you can construct or @@ -655,7 +655,7 @@ in the C programming language. Primitive functions are also called "subrs" or "built-in functions". (The word "subr" is derived from "subroutine".) Most primitive functions evaluate all their arguments when they are called. A primitive function that does not evaluate all -its arguments is called a "special form" (*note Special Forms::.). +its arguments is called a "special form" (*note Special Forms::). It does not matter to the caller of a function whether the function is primitive. However, this does matter if you try to substitute a @@ -825,10 +825,10 @@ Buffer Type ----------- A "buffer" is an object that holds text that can be edited (*note -Buffers::.). Most buffers hold the contents of a disk file (*note -Files::.) so they can be edited, but some are used for other purposes. +Buffers::). Most buffers hold the contents of a disk file (*note +Files::) so they can be edited, but some are used for other purposes. Most buffers are also meant to be seen by the user, and therefore -displayed, at some time, in a window (*note Windows::.). But a buffer +displayed, at some time, in a window (*note Windows::). But a buffer need not be displayed in any window. The contents of a buffer are much like a string, but buffers are not @@ -839,21 +839,21 @@ concatenating substrings, and the result is an entirely new string object. Each buffer has a designated position called "point" (*note -Positions::.). At any time, one buffer is the "current buffer". Most +Positions::). At any time, one buffer is the "current buffer". Most editing commands act on the contents of the current buffer in the neighborhood of point. Many of the standard Emacs functions manipulate or test the characters in the current buffer; a whole chapter in this -manual is devoted to describing these functions (*note Text::.). +manual is devoted to describing these functions (*note Text::). Several other data structures are associated with each buffer: - * a local syntax table (*note Syntax Tables::.); + * a local syntax table (*note Syntax Tables::); - * a local keymap (*note Keymaps::.); + * a local keymap (*note Keymaps::); - * a local variable binding list (*note Buffer-Local Variables::.); + * a local variable binding list (*note Buffer-Local Variables::); - * a list of extents (*note Extents::.); + * a list of extents (*note Extents::); * and various other related properties. @@ -1104,8 +1104,8 @@ streams (character sinks) send characters to a buffer, such as a The object `nil', in addition to its other meanings, may be used as a stream. It stands for the value of the variable `standard-input' or `standard-output'. Also, the object `t' as a stream specifies input -using the minibuffer (*note Minibuffers::.) or output in the echo area -(*note The Echo Area::.). +using the minibuffer (*note Minibuffers::) or output in the echo area +(*note The Echo Area::). Streams have no special printed representation or read syntax, and print as whatever primitive type they are. @@ -1137,7 +1137,7 @@ Syntax Table Type Under XEmacs 20, a "syntax table" is a particular type of char table. Under XEmacs 19, a syntax table a vector of 256 integers. In both cases, each element defines how one character is interpreted when -it appears in a buffer. For example, in C mode (*note Major Modes::.), +it appears in a buffer. For example, in C mode (*note Major Modes::), the `+' character is punctuation, but in Lisp mode it is a valid character in a symbol. These modes specify different interpretations by changing the syntax table entry for `+'. diff --git a/info/lispref.info-4 b/info/lispref.info-4 index 096f2d3..6f65791 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-4 +++ b/info/lispref.info-4 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -445,10 +445,10 @@ with references to further information. The most general way to check the type of an object is to call the function `type-of'. Recall that each object belongs to one and only one primitive type; `type-of' tells you which one (*note Lisp Data -Types::.). But `type-of' knows nothing about non-primitive types. In +Types::). But `type-of' knows nothing about non-primitive types. In most cases, it is more convenient to use type predicates than `type-of'. - - Function: type-of OBJECT + - Function: type-of object This function returns a symbol naming the primitive type of OBJECT. The value is one of `bit-vector', `buffer', `char-table', `character', `charset', `coding-system', `cons', `color-instance', @@ -480,7 +480,7 @@ objects. Other functions test equality between objects of specific types, e.g., strings. For these predicates, see the appropriate chapter describing the data type. - - Function: eq OBJECT1 OBJECT2 + - Function: eq object1 object2 This function returns `t' if OBJECT1 and OBJECT2 are the same object, `nil' otherwise. The "same object" means that a change in one will be reflected by the same change in the other. @@ -530,12 +530,12 @@ describing the data type. => nil - - Function: old-eq OBJ1 OBJ2 + - Function: old-eq obj1 obj2 This function exists under XEmacs 20 and is exactly like `eq' except that it suffers from the char-int confoundance disease. In other words, it returns `t' if given a character and the equivalent integer, even though the objects are of different types! - You should *not* ever call this function explicitly in your code. + You should _not_ ever call this function explicitly in your code. However, be aware that all calls to `eq' in byte code compiled under version 19 map to `old-eq' in XEmacs 20. (Likewise for `old-equal', `old-memq', `old-member', `old-assq' and @@ -551,7 +551,7 @@ describing the data type. (eq ?A 65) => nil ; We are still healthy. - - Function: equal OBJECT1 OBJECT2 + - Function: equal object1 object2 This function returns `t' if OBJECT1 and OBJECT2 have equal components, `nil' otherwise. Whereas `eq' tests if its arguments are the same object, `equal' looks inside nonidentical arguments @@ -655,7 +655,7 @@ optional initial sign and optional final period. -0 ; The integer 0. To understand how various functions work on integers, especially the -bitwise operators (*note Bitwise Operations::.), it is often helpful to +bitwise operators (*note Bitwise Operations::), it is often helpful to view the numbers in their binary form. In 28-bit binary, the decimal integer 5 looks like this: @@ -727,7 +727,7 @@ NaNs or infinities; perhaps we should create a syntax in the future. You can use `logb' to extract the binary exponent of a floating point number (or estimate the logarithm of an integer): - - Function: logb NUMBER + - Function: logb number This function returns the binary exponent of NUMBER. More precisely, the value is the logarithm of NUMBER base 2, rounded down to an integer. @@ -746,27 +746,27 @@ predicate requires a number as its argument. See also `integer-or-marker-p', `integer-char-or-marker-p', `number-or-marker-p' and `number-char-or-marker-p', in *Note Predicates on Markers::. - - Function: floatp OBJECT + - Function: floatp object This predicate tests whether its argument is a floating point number and returns `t' if so, `nil' otherwise. `floatp' does not exist in Emacs versions 18 and earlier. - - Function: integerp OBJECT + - Function: integerp object This predicate tests whether its argument is an integer, and returns `t' if so, `nil' otherwise. - - Function: numberp OBJECT + - Function: numberp object This predicate tests whether its argument is a number (either integer or floating point), and returns `t' if so, `nil' otherwise. - - Function: natnump OBJECT + - Function: natnump object The `natnump' predicate (whose name comes from the phrase "natural-number-p") tests to see whether its argument is a nonnegative integer, and returns `t' if so, `nil' otherwise. 0 is considered non-negative. - - Function: zerop NUMBER + - Function: zerop number This predicate tests whether its argument is zero, and returns `t' if so, `nil' otherwise. The argument must be a number. @@ -781,7 +781,7 @@ Comparison of Numbers To test numbers for numerical equality, you should normally use `=', not `eq'. There can be many distinct floating point number objects with the same numeric value. If you use `eq' to compare them, then you -test whether two values are the same *object*. By contrast, `=' +test whether two values are the same _object_. By contrast, `=' compares only the numeric values of the objects. At present, each integer value has a unique Lisp object in XEmacs @@ -816,7 +816,7 @@ Here's a function to do this: characters and markers as arguments, and treat them as their number equivalents. - - Function: = NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: = number &rest more-numbers This function returns `t' if all of its arguments are numerically equal, `nil' otherwise. @@ -829,7 +829,7 @@ equivalents. (= 5 5 6) => nil - - Function: /= NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: /= number &rest more-numbers This function returns `t' if no two arguments are numerically equal, `nil' otherwise. @@ -840,7 +840,7 @@ equivalents. (/= 5 6 1) => t - - Function: < NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: < number &rest more-numbers This function returns `t' if the sequence of its arguments is monotonically increasing, `nil' otherwise. @@ -851,7 +851,7 @@ equivalents. (< 5 6 7) => t - - Function: <= NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: <= number &rest more-numbers This function returns `t' if the sequence of its arguments is monotonically nondecreasing, `nil' otherwise. @@ -862,15 +862,15 @@ equivalents. (<= 5 6 5) => nil - - Function: > NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: > number &rest more-numbers This function returns `t' if the sequence of its arguments is monotonically decreasing, `nil' otherwise. - - Function: >= NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: >= number &rest more-numbers This function returns `t' if the sequence of its arguments is monotonically nonincreasing, `nil' otherwise. - - Function: max NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: max number &rest more-numbers This function returns the largest of its arguments. (max 20) @@ -880,7 +880,7 @@ equivalents. (max 1 3 2.5) => 3 - - Function: min NUMBER &rest MORE-NUMBERS + - Function: min number &rest more-numbers This function returns the smallest of its arguments. (min -4 1) @@ -894,7 +894,7 @@ Numeric Conversions To convert an integer to floating point, use the function `float'. - - Function: float NUMBER + - Function: float number This returns NUMBER converted to floating point. If NUMBER is already a floating point number, `float' returns it unchanged. @@ -902,11 +902,11 @@ Numeric Conversions integers; they differ in how they round. These functions accept integer arguments also, and return such arguments unchanged. - - Function: truncate NUMBER + - Function: truncate number This returns NUMBER, converted to an integer by rounding towards zero. - - Function: floor NUMBER &optional DIVISOR + - Function: floor number &optional divisor This returns NUMBER, converted to an integer by rounding downward (towards negative infinity). @@ -914,11 +914,11 @@ integer arguments also, and return such arguments unchanged. floor is taken; this is the division operation that corresponds to `mod'. An `arith-error' results if DIVISOR is 0. - - Function: ceiling NUMBER + - Function: ceiling number This returns NUMBER, converted to an integer by rounding upward (towards positive infinity). - - Function: round NUMBER + - Function: round number This returns NUMBER, converted to an integer by rounding towards the nearest integer. Rounding a value equidistant between two integers may choose the integer closer to zero, or it may prefer @@ -943,7 +943,7 @@ any argument is floating. not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' may evaluate to -134217728, depending on your hardware. - - Function: 1+ NUMBER-OR-MARKER + - Function: 1+ number-or-marker This function returns NUMBER-OR-MARKER plus 1. For example, (setq foo 4) @@ -968,13 +968,13 @@ not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' may evaluate to more convenient and natural way to increment a variable is `(incf foo)'. - - Function: 1- NUMBER-OR-MARKER + - Function: 1- number-or-marker This function returns NUMBER-OR-MARKER minus 1. - - Function: abs NUMBER + - Function: abs number This returns the absolute value of NUMBER. - - Function: + &rest NUMBERS-OR-MARKERS + - Function: + &rest numbers-or-markers This function adds its arguments together. When given no arguments, `+' returns 0. @@ -985,7 +985,7 @@ not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' may evaluate to (+ 1 2 3 4) => 10 - - Function: - &optional NUMBER-OR-MARKER &rest OTHER-NUMBERS-OR-MARKERS + - Function: - &optional number-or-marker &rest other-numbers-or-markers The `-' function serves two purposes: negation and subtraction. When `-' has a single argument, the value is the negative of the argument. When there are multiple arguments, `-' subtracts each of @@ -999,7 +999,7 @@ not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' may evaluate to (-) => 0 - - Function: * &rest NUMBERS-OR-MARKERS + - Function: * &rest numbers-or-markers This function multiplies its arguments together, and returns the product. When given no arguments, `*' returns 1. @@ -1010,7 +1010,7 @@ not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' may evaluate to (* 1 2 3 4) => 24 - - Function: / DIVIDEND DIVISOR &rest DIVISORS + - Function: / dividend divisor &rest divisors This function divides DIVIDEND by DIVISOR and returns the quotient. If there are additional arguments DIVISORS, then it divides DIVIDEND by each divisor in turn. Each argument may be a @@ -1039,7 +1039,7 @@ not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' may evaluate to The result of `(/ -17 6)' could in principle be -3 on some machines. - - Function: % DIVIDEND DIVISOR + - Function: % dividend divisor This function returns the integer remainder after division of DIVIDEND by DIVISOR. The arguments must be integers or markers. @@ -1065,7 +1065,7 @@ not check for overflow. Thus `(1+ 134217727)' may evaluate to always equals DIVIDEND. - - Function: mod DIVIDEND DIVISOR + - Function: mod dividend divisor This function returns the value of DIVIDEND modulo DIVISOR; in other words, the remainder after division of DIVIDEND by DIVISOR, but with the same sign as DIVISOR. The arguments must be numbers @@ -1110,19 +1110,19 @@ is a nearby integer. `ffloor' returns the nearest integer below; `fceiling', the nearest integer above; `ftruncate', the nearest integer in the direction towards zero; `fround', the nearest integer. - - Function: ffloor FLOAT + - Function: ffloor float This function rounds FLOAT to the next lower integral value, and returns that value as a floating point number. - - Function: fceiling FLOAT + - Function: fceiling float This function rounds FLOAT to the next higher integral value, and returns that value as a floating point number. - - Function: ftruncate FLOAT + - Function: ftruncate float This function rounds FLOAT towards zero to an integral value, and returns that value as a floating point number. - - Function: fround FLOAT + - Function: fround float This function rounds FLOAT to the nearest integral value, and returns that value as a floating point number. @@ -1140,7 +1140,7 @@ reproducing the same pattern "moved over". The bitwise operations in XEmacs Lisp apply only to integers. - - Function: lsh INTEGER1 COUNT + - Function: lsh integer1 count `lsh', which is an abbreviation for "logical shift", shifts the bits in INTEGER1 to the left COUNT places, or to the right if COUNT is negative, bringing zeros into the vacated bits. If COUNT @@ -1208,7 +1208,7 @@ reproducing the same pattern "moved over". ;; Decimal -2 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1110 - - Function: ash INTEGER1 COUNT + - Function: ash integer1 count `ash' ("arithmetic shift") shifts the bits in INTEGER1 to the left COUNT places, or to the right if COUNT is negative. @@ -1237,31 +1237,26 @@ reproducing the same pattern "moved over". Here are other examples: - ; 28-bit binary values + ; 28-bit binary values (lsh 5 2) ; 5 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0101 => 20 ; = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 0100 - (ash 5 2) => 20 (lsh -5 2) ; -5 = 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1011 => -20 ; = 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1110 1100 (ash -5 2) => -20 - (lsh 5 -2) ; 5 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0101 => 1 ; = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 - (ash 5 -2) => 1 - (lsh -5 -2) ; -5 = 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1011 => 4194302 ; = 0011 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1110 - (ash -5 -2) ; -5 = 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1011 => -2 ; = 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1110 - - Function: logand &rest INTS-OR-MARKERS + - Function: logand &rest ints-or-markers This function returns the "logical and" of the arguments: the Nth bit is set in the result if, and only if, the Nth bit is set in all the arguments. ("Set" means that the value of the bit is 1 @@ -1285,57 +1280,57 @@ reproducing the same pattern "moved over". representation consists entirely of ones. If `logand' is passed just one argument, it returns that argument. - ; 28-bit binary values + ; 28-bit binary values (logand 14 13) ; 14 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1110 ; 13 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1101 => 12 ; 12 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1100 - + (logand 14 13 4) ; 14 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1110 ; 13 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1101 ; 4 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0100 => 4 ; 4 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0100 - + (logand) => -1 ; -1 = 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 - - Function: logior &rest INTS-OR-MARKERS + - Function: logior &rest ints-or-markers This function returns the "inclusive or" of its arguments: the Nth bit is set in the result if, and only if, the Nth bit is set in at least one of the arguments. If there are no arguments, the result is zero, which is an identity element for this operation. If `logior' is passed just one argument, it returns that argument. - ; 28-bit binary values + ; 28-bit binary values (logior 12 5) ; 12 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1100 ; 5 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0101 => 13 ; 13 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1101 - + (logior 12 5 7) ; 12 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1100 ; 5 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0101 ; 7 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0111 => 15 ; 15 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1111 - - Function: logxor &rest INTS-OR-MARKERS + - Function: logxor &rest ints-or-markers This function returns the "exclusive or" of its arguments: the Nth bit is set in the result if, and only if, the Nth bit is set in an odd number of the arguments. If there are no arguments, the result is 0, which is an identity element for this operation. If `logxor' is passed just one argument, it returns that argument. - ; 28-bit binary values + ; 28-bit binary values (logxor 12 5) ; 12 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1100 ; 5 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0101 => 9 ; 9 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1001 - + (logxor 12 5 7) ; 12 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1100 ; 5 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0101 ; 7 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0111 => 14 ; 14 = 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1110 - - Function: lognot INTEGER + - Function: lognot integer This function returns the logical complement of its argument: the Nth bit is one in the result if, and only if, the Nth bit is zero in INTEGER, and vice-versa. @@ -1356,61 +1351,61 @@ Standard Mathematical Functions supported (which is the normal state of affairs). They allow integers as well as floating point numbers as arguments. - - Function: sin ARG - - Function: cos ARG - - Function: tan ARG + - Function: sin arg + - Function: cos arg + - Function: tan arg These are the ordinary trigonometric functions, with argument measured in radians. - - Function: asin ARG + - Function: asin arg The value of `(asin ARG)' is a number between -pi/2 and pi/2 (inclusive) whose sine is ARG; if, however, ARG is out of range (outside [-1, 1]), then the result is a NaN. - - Function: acos ARG + - Function: acos arg The value of `(acos ARG)' is a number between 0 and pi (inclusive) whose cosine is ARG; if, however, ARG is out of range (outside [-1, 1]), then the result is a NaN. - - Function: atan ARG + - Function: atan arg The value of `(atan ARG)' is a number between -pi/2 and pi/2 (exclusive) whose tangent is ARG. - - Function: sinh ARG - - Function: cosh ARG - - Function: tanh ARG + - Function: sinh arg + - Function: cosh arg + - Function: tanh arg These are the ordinary hyperbolic trigonometric functions. - - Function: asinh ARG - - Function: acosh ARG - - Function: atanh ARG + - Function: asinh arg + - Function: acosh arg + - Function: atanh arg These are the inverse hyperbolic trigonometric functions. - - Function: exp ARG + - Function: exp arg This is the exponential function; it returns e to the power ARG. e is a fundamental mathematical constant also called the base of natural logarithms. - - Function: log ARG &optional BASE + - Function: log arg &optional base This function returns the logarithm of ARG, with base BASE. If you don't specify BASE, the base E is used. If ARG is negative, the result is a NaN. - - Function: log10 ARG + - Function: log10 arg This function returns the logarithm of ARG, with base 10. If ARG is negative, the result is a NaN. `(log10 X)' == `(log X 10)', at least approximately. - - Function: expt X Y + - Function: expt x y This function returns X raised to power Y. If both arguments are integers and Y is positive, the result is an integer; in this case, it is truncated to fit the range of possible integer values. - - Function: sqrt ARG + - Function: sqrt arg This returns the square root of ARG. If ARG is negative, the value is a NaN. - - Function: cube-root ARG + - Function: cube-root arg This returns the cube root of ARG.  @@ -1439,7 +1434,7 @@ debugging. t)'. This chooses a new seed based on the current time of day and on XEmacs's process ID number. - - Function: random &optional LIMIT + - Function: random &optional limit This function returns a pseudo-random integer. Repeated calls return a series of pseudo-random integers. diff --git a/info/lispref.info-5 b/info/lispref.info-5 index cadf18b..9b6e82b 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-5 +++ b/info/lispref.info-5 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ integers; whether an integer was intended as a character or not is determined only by how it is used. *Note Character Type::. The length of a string (like any array) is fixed and independent of -the string contents, and cannot be altered. Strings in Lisp are *not* +the string contents, and cannot be altered. Strings in Lisp are _not_ terminated by a distinguished character code. (By contrast, strings in C are terminated by a character with ASCII code 0.) This means that any character, including the null character (ASCII code 0), is a valid @@ -71,22 +71,22 @@ element of a string. Since strings are considered arrays, you can operate on them with the general array functions. (*Note Sequences Arrays Vectors::.) For example, you can access or change individual characters in a string -using the functions `aref' and `aset' (*note Array Functions::.). +using the functions `aref' and `aset' (*note Array Functions::). Strings use an efficient representation for storing the characters in them, and thus take up much less memory than a vector of the same length. Sometimes you will see strings used to hold key sequences. This -exists for backward compatibility with Emacs 18, but should *not* be +exists for backward compatibility with Emacs 18, but should _not_ be used in new code, since many key chords can't be represented at all and others (in particular meta key chords) are confused with accented characters. Strings are useful for holding regular expressions. You can also -match regular expressions against strings (*note Regexp Search::.). The -functions `match-string' (*note Simple Match Data::.) and -`replace-match' (*note Replacing Match::.) are useful for decomposing +match regular expressions against strings (*note Regexp Search::). The +functions `match-string' (*note Simple Match Data::) and +`replace-match' (*note Replacing Match::) are useful for decomposing and modifying strings based on regular expression matching. Like a buffer, a string can contain extents in it. These extents are @@ -108,10 +108,10 @@ The Predicates for Strings For more information about general sequence and array predicates, see *Note Sequences Arrays Vectors::, and *Note Arrays::. - - Function: stringp OBJECT + - Function: stringp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a string, `nil' otherwise. - - Function: char-or-string-p OBJECT + - Function: char-or-string-p object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a string or a character, `nil' otherwise. @@ -129,7 +129,7 @@ Creating Strings The following functions create strings, either from scratch, or by putting strings together, or by taking them apart. - - Function: string &rest CHARACTERS + - Function: string &rest characters This function returns a new string made up of CHARACTERS. (string ?X ?E ?m ?a ?c ?s) @@ -138,11 +138,11 @@ putting strings together, or by taking them apart. => "" Analogous functions operating on other data types include `list', - `cons' (*note Building Lists::.), `vector' (*note Vectors::.) and - `bit-vector' (*note Bit Vectors::.). This function has not been + `cons' (*note Building Lists::), `vector' (*note Vectors::) and + `bit-vector' (*note Bit Vectors::). This function has not been available in XEmacs prior to 21.0 and FSF Emacs prior to 20.3. - - Function: make-string COUNT CHARACTER + - Function: make-string count character This function returns a string made up of COUNT repetitions of CHARACTER. If COUNT is negative, an error is signaled. @@ -152,10 +152,10 @@ putting strings together, or by taking them apart. => "" Other functions to compare with this one include `char-to-string' - (*note String Conversion::.), `make-vector' (*note Vectors::.), and - `make-list' (*note Building Lists::.). + (*note String Conversion::), `make-vector' (*note Vectors::), and + `make-list' (*note Building Lists::). - - Function: substring STRING START &optional END + - Function: substring string start &optional end This function returns a new string which consists of those characters from STRING in the range from (and including) the character at the index START up to (but excluding) the character @@ -195,7 +195,7 @@ putting strings together, or by taking them apart. => "abcdefg" But we recommend `copy-sequence' for this purpose (*note Sequence - Functions::.). + Functions::). If the characters copied from STRING have duplicable extents or text properties, those are copied into the new string also. *Note @@ -207,11 +207,11 @@ putting strings together, or by taking them apart. either integer is out of range for STRING. Contrast this function with `buffer-substring' (*note Buffer - Contents::.), which returns a string containing a portion of the + Contents::), which returns a string containing a portion of the text in the current buffer. The beginning of a string is at index 0, but the beginning of a buffer is at index 1. - - Function: concat &rest SEQUENCES + - Function: concat &rest sequences This function returns a new string consisting of the characters in the arguments passed to it (along with their text properties, if any). The arguments may be strings, lists of numbers, or vectors @@ -242,8 +242,8 @@ putting strings together, or by taking them apart. representation of the integer. *Don't use this feature; we plan to eliminate it. If you already use this feature, change your programs now!* The proper way to convert an integer to a decimal - number in this way is with `format' (*note Formatting Strings::.) - or `number-to-string' (*note String Conversion::.). + number in this way is with `format' (*note Formatting Strings::) or + `number-to-string' (*note String Conversion::). (concat 137) => "137" @@ -261,7 +261,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Predicates for Characters, Next: Character Codes, P The Predicates for Characters ============================= - - Function: characterp OBJECT + - Function: characterp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a character. Some functions that work on integers (e.g. the comparison functions @@ -275,7 +275,7 @@ The Predicates for Characters in the future; therefore, do not rely on them. Instead, convert the characters explicitly using `char-int'. - - Function: integer-or-char-p OBJECT + - Function: integer-or-char-p object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is an integer or character.  @@ -284,7 +284,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Character Codes, Next: Text Comparison, Prev: Predi Character Codes =============== - - Function: char-int CH + - Function: char-int ch This function converts a character into an equivalent integer. The resulting integer will always be non-negative. The integers in the range 0 - 255 map to characters as follows: @@ -307,17 +307,17 @@ Character Codes XEmacs, the order in which character sets were loaded, etc., and you should not depend on them. - - Function: int-char INTEGER + - Function: int-char integer This function converts an integer into the equivalent character. Not all integers correspond to valid characters; use `char-int-p' to determine whether this is the case. If the integer cannot be converted, `nil' is returned. - - Function: char-int-p OBJECT + - Function: char-int-p object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is an integer that can be converted into a character. - - Function: char-or-char-int-p OBJECT + - Function: char-or-char-int-p object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a character or an integer that can be converted into one. @@ -327,7 +327,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Text Comparison, Next: String Conversion, Prev: Cha Comparison of Characters and Strings ==================================== - - Function: char-equal CHARACTER1 CHARACTER2 + - Function: char-equal character1 character2 This function returns `t' if the arguments represent the same character, `nil' otherwise. This function ignores differences in case if `case-fold-search' is non-`nil'. @@ -341,7 +341,7 @@ Comparison of Characters and Strings (char-equal ?x ?X)) => nil - - Function: char= CHARACTER1 CHARACTER2 + - Function: char= character1 character2 This function returns `t' if the arguments represent the same character, `nil' otherwise. Case is significant. @@ -356,7 +356,7 @@ Comparison of Characters and Strings (char-equal ?x ?X)) => nil - - Function: string= STRING1 STRING2 + - Function: string= string1 string2 This function returns `t' if the characters of the two strings match exactly; case is significant. @@ -368,10 +368,10 @@ Comparison of Characters and Strings => nil - - Function: string-equal STRING1 STRING2 + - Function: string-equal string1 string2 `string-equal' is another name for `string='. - - Function: string< STRING1 STRING2 + - Function: string< string1 string2 This function compares two strings a character at a time. First it scans both the strings at once to find the first pair of corresponding characters that do not match. If the lesser @@ -410,7 +410,7 @@ Comparison of Characters and Strings (string< "" "") => nil - - Function: string-lessp STRING1 STRING2 + - Function: string-lessp string1 string2 `string-lessp' is another name for `string<'. See also `compare-buffer-substrings' in *Note Comparing Text::, for @@ -426,8 +426,8 @@ Conversion of Characters and Strings This section describes functions for conversions between characters, strings and integers. `format' and `prin1-to-string' (*note Output -Functions::.) can also convert Lisp objects into strings. -`read-from-string' (*note Input Functions::.) can "convert" a string +Functions::) can also convert Lisp objects into strings. +`read-from-string' (*note Input Functions::) can "convert" a string representation of a Lisp object into an object. *Note Documentation::, for functions that produce textual @@ -435,7 +435,7 @@ descriptions of text characters and general input events (`single-key-description' and `text-char-description'). These functions are used primarily for making help messages. - - Function: char-to-string CHARACTER + - Function: char-to-string character This function returns a new string with a length of one character. The value of CHARACTER, modulo 256, is used to initialize the element of the string. @@ -452,7 +452,7 @@ functions are used primarily for making help messages. (make-string 1 ?x) => "x" - - Function: string-to-char STRING + - Function: string-to-char string This function returns the first character in STRING. If the string is empty, the function returns 0. (Under XEmacs 19, the value is also 0 when the first character of STRING is the null @@ -473,7 +473,7 @@ functions are used primarily for making help messages. This function may be eliminated in the future if it does not seem useful enough to retain. - - Function: number-to-string NUMBER + - Function: number-to-string number This function returns a string consisting of the printed representation of NUMBER, which may be an integer or a floating point number. The value starts with a sign if the argument is @@ -490,7 +490,7 @@ functions are used primarily for making help messages. See also the function `format' in *Note Formatting Strings::. - - Function: string-to-number STRING &optional BASE + - Function: string-to-number string &optional base This function returns the numeric value of the characters in STRING, read in BASE. It skips spaces and tabs at the beginning of STRING, then reads as much of STRING as it can interpret as a @@ -530,7 +530,7 @@ character. string is created) and is incremented each time a change is made to that string. - - Function: string-modified-tick STRING + - Function: string-modified-tick string This function returns the tick counter for `string'.  @@ -565,7 +565,7 @@ In fact, the functions `message' and `error' provide the same formatting feature described here; they differ from `format' only in how they use the result of formatting. - - Function: format STRING &rest OBJECTS + - Function: format string &rest objects This function returns a new string that is made by copying STRING and then replacing any format specification in the copy with encodings of the corresponding OBJECTS. The arguments OBJECTS are @@ -747,11 +747,11 @@ truncated. In the third case, the padding is on the right. (format "The word `%7s' actually has %d letters in it." "foo" (length "foo")) => "The word ` foo' actually has 3 letters in it." - + (format "The word `%7s' actually has %d letters in it." "specification" (length "specification")) => "The word `specification' actually has 13 letters in it." - + (format "The word `%-7s' actually has %d letters in it." "foo" (length "foo")) => "The word `foo ' actually has 3 letters in it." @@ -793,7 +793,7 @@ that are passed to them as arguments. The examples below use the characters `X' and `x' which have ASCII codes 88 and 120 respectively. - - Function: downcase STRING-OR-CHAR + - Function: downcase string-or-char This function converts a character or a string to lower case. When the argument to `downcase' is a string, the function creates @@ -811,7 +811,7 @@ codes 88 and 120 respectively. => ?x ;; Under XEmacs 20. => 120 ;; Under XEmacs 19. - - Function: upcase STRING-OR-CHAR + - Function: upcase string-or-char This function converts a character or a string to upper case. When the argument to `upcase' is a string, the function creates @@ -831,7 +831,7 @@ codes 88 and 120 respectively. => ?X ;; Under XEmacs 20. => 88 ;; Under XEmacs 19. - - Function: capitalize STRING-OR-CHAR + - Function: capitalize string-or-char This function capitalizes strings or characters. If STRING-OR-CHAR is a string, the function creates and returns a new string, whose contents are a copy of STRING-OR-CHAR in which each @@ -841,7 +841,7 @@ codes 88 and 120 respectively. The definition of a word is any sequence of consecutive characters that are assigned to the word constituent syntax class in the - current syntax table (*note Syntax Class Table::.). + current syntax table (*note Syntax Class Table::). When the argument to `capitalize' is a character, `capitalize' has the same result as `upcase'. @@ -866,8 +866,8 @@ The Case Table table". A case table specifies the mapping between upper case and lower case letters. It affects both the string and character case conversion functions (see the previous section) and those that apply to text in the -buffer (*note Case Changes::.). You need a case table if you are using -a language which has letters other than the standard ASCII letters. +buffer (*note Case Changes::). You need a case table if you are using a +language which has letters other than the standard ASCII letters. A case table is a list of this form: @@ -907,10 +907,10 @@ Changing the standard case table doesn't affect any existing buffers. Here are the functions for working with case tables: - - Function: case-table-p OBJECT + - Function: case-table-p object This predicate returns non-`nil' if OBJECT is a valid case table. - - Function: set-standard-case-table TABLE + - Function: set-standard-case-table table This function makes TABLE the standard case table, so that it will apply to any buffers created subsequently. @@ -920,7 +920,7 @@ Changing the standard case table doesn't affect any existing buffers. - Function: current-case-table This function returns the current buffer's case table. - - Function: set-case-table TABLE + - Function: set-case-table table This sets the current buffer's case table to TABLE. The following three functions are convenient subroutines for packages @@ -929,15 +929,15 @@ DOWNCASE-TABLE provided as an argument; this should be a string to be used as the DOWNCASE part of a case table. They also modify the standard syntax table. *Note Syntax Tables::. - - Function: set-case-syntax-pair UC LC DOWNCASE-TABLE + - Function: set-case-syntax-pair uc lc downcase-table This function specifies a pair of corresponding letters, one upper case and one lower case. - - Function: set-case-syntax-delims L R DOWNCASE-TABLE + - Function: set-case-syntax-delims l r downcase-table This function makes characters L and R a matching pair of case-invariant delimiters. - - Function: set-case-syntax CHAR SYNTAX DOWNCASE-TABLE + - Function: set-case-syntax char syntax downcase-table This function makes CHAR case-invariant, with syntax SYNTAX. - Command: describe-buffer-case-table @@ -984,7 +984,7 @@ assigned values are * a single character - - Function: char-table-p OBJECT + - Function: char-table-p object This function returns non-`nil' if OBJECT is a char table. * Menu: @@ -1026,13 +1026,13 @@ different sorts of values. The different char table types are character. Higher-level Lisp functions are provided for working with syntax tables. The valid values are integers. - - Function: char-table-type TABLE + - Function: char-table-type table This function returns the type of char table TABLE. - Function: char-table-type-list This function returns a list of the recognized char table types. - - Function: valid-char-table-type-p TYPE + - Function: valid-char-table-type-p type This function returns `t' if TYPE if a recognized char table type.  @@ -1041,12 +1041,12 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Working With Char Tables, Prev: Char Table Types, U Working With Char Tables ------------------------ - - Function: make-char-table TYPE + - Function: make-char-table type This function makes a new, empty char table of type TYPE. TYPE should be a symbol, one of `char', `category', `display', `generic', or `syntax'. - - Function: put-char-table RANGE VAL TABLE + - Function: put-char-table range val table This function sets the value for chars in RANGE to be VAL in TABLE. RANGE specifies one or more characters to be affected and should be @@ -1063,17 +1063,17 @@ Working With Char Tables VAL must be a value appropriate for the type of TABLE. - - Function: get-char-table CH TABLE + - Function: get-char-table ch table This function finds the value for char CH in TABLE. - - Function: get-range-char-table RANGE TABLE &optional MULTI + - Function: get-range-char-table range table &optional multi This function finds the value for a range in TABLE. If there is more than one value, MULTI is returned (defaults to `nil'). - - Function: reset-char-table TABLE + - Function: reset-char-table table This function resets a char table to its default state. - - Function: map-char-table FUNCTION TABLE &optional RANGE + - Function: map-char-table function table &optional range This function maps FUNCTION over entries in TABLE, calling it with two args, each key and value in the table. @@ -1081,11 +1081,11 @@ Working With Char Tables as the RANGE argument to `put-range-table'. If omitted or `t', it defaults to the entire table. - - Function: valid-char-table-value-p VALUE CHAR-TABLE-TYPE + - Function: valid-char-table-value-p value char-table-type This function returns non-`nil' if VALUE is a valid value for CHAR-TABLE-TYPE. - - Function: check-valid-char-table-value VALUE CHAR-TABLE-TYPE + - Function: check-valid-char-table-value value char-table-type This function signals an error if VALUE is not a valid value for CHAR-TABLE-TYPE. @@ -1222,18 +1222,18 @@ cons cell or is a list, or whether it is the distinguished object `nil'. (Many of these predicates can be defined in terms of the others, but they are used so often that it is worth having all of them.) - - Function: consp OBJECT + - Function: consp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a cons cell, `nil' - otherwise. `nil' is not a cons cell, although it *is* a list. + otherwise. `nil' is not a cons cell, although it _is_ a list. - - Function: atom OBJECT + - Function: atom object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is an atom, `nil' otherwise. All objects except cons cells are atoms. The symbol `nil' is an atom and is also a list; it is the only Lisp object that is both. (atom OBJECT) == (not (consp OBJECT)) - - Function: listp OBJECT + - Function: listp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a cons cell or `nil'. Otherwise, it returns `nil'. @@ -1242,13 +1242,13 @@ others, but they are used so often that it is worth having all of them.) (listp '()) => t - - Function: nlistp OBJECT + - Function: nlistp object This function is the opposite of `listp': it returns `t' if OBJECT is not a list. Otherwise, it returns `nil'. (listp OBJECT) == (not (nlistp OBJECT)) - - Function: null OBJECT + - Function: null object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is `nil', and returns `nil' otherwise. This function is identical to `not', but as a matter of clarity we use `null' when OBJECT is considered a list and diff --git a/info/lispref.info-6 b/info/lispref.info-6 index ce764e8..f65d3dc 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-6 +++ b/info/lispref.info-6 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: List Elements, Next: Building Lists, Prev: List-rel Accessing Elements of Lists =========================== - - Function: car CONS-CELL + - Function: car cons-cell This function returns the value pointed to by the first pointer of the cons cell CONS-CELL. Expressed another way, this function returns the CAR of CONS-CELL. @@ -69,7 +69,7 @@ Accessing Elements of Lists (car '()) => nil - - Function: cdr CONS-CELL + - Function: cdr cons-cell This function returns the value pointed to by the second pointer of the cons cell CONS-CELL. Expressed another way, this function returns the CDR of CONS-CELL. @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ Accessing Elements of Lists (cdr '()) => nil - - Function: car-safe OBJECT + - Function: car-safe object This function lets you take the CAR of a cons cell while avoiding errors for other data types. It returns the CAR of OBJECT if OBJECT is a cons cell, `nil' otherwise. This is in contrast to @@ -96,7 +96,7 @@ Accessing Elements of Lists (car x) nil)) - - Function: cdr-safe OBJECT + - Function: cdr-safe object This function lets you take the CDR of a cons cell while avoiding errors for other data types. It returns the CDR of OBJECT if OBJECT is a cons cell, `nil' otherwise. This is in contrast to @@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ Accessing Elements of Lists (cdr x) nil)) - - Function: nth N LIST + - Function: nth n list This function returns the Nth element of LIST. Elements are numbered starting with zero, so the CAR of LIST is element number zero. If the length of LIST is N or less, the value is `nil'. @@ -125,7 +125,7 @@ Accessing Elements of Lists (nth n x) == (car (nthcdr n x)) - - Function: nthcdr N LIST + - Function: nthcdr n list This function returns the Nth CDR of LIST. In other words, it removes the first N links of LIST and returns what follows. @@ -143,34 +143,34 @@ Accessing Elements of Lists access particular elements in a nested list. All of these can be rewritten in terms of the functions just described. - - Function: caar CONS-CELL - - Function: cadr CONS-CELL - - Function: cdar CONS-CELL - - Function: cddr CONS-CELL - - Function: caaar CONS-CELL - - Function: caadr CONS-CELL - - Function: cadar CONS-CELL - - Function: caddr CONS-CELL - - Function: cdaar CONS-CELL - - Function: cdadr CONS-CELL - - Function: cddar CONS-CELL - - Function: cdddr CONS-CELL - - Function: caaaar CONS-CELL - - Function: caaadr CONS-CELL - - Function: caadar CONS-CELL - - Function: caaddr CONS-CELL - - Function: cadaar CONS-CELL - - Function: cadadr CONS-CELL - - Function: caddar CONS-CELL - - Function: cadddr CONS-CELL - - Function: cdaaar CONS-CELL - - Function: cdaadr CONS-CELL - - Function: cdadar CONS-CELL - - Function: cdaddr CONS-CELL - - Function: cddaar CONS-CELL - - Function: cddadr CONS-CELL - - Function: cdddar CONS-CELL - - Function: cddddr CONS-CELL + - Function: caar cons-cell + - Function: cadr cons-cell + - Function: cdar cons-cell + - Function: cddr cons-cell + - Function: caaar cons-cell + - Function: caadr cons-cell + - Function: cadar cons-cell + - Function: caddr cons-cell + - Function: cdaar cons-cell + - Function: cdadr cons-cell + - Function: cddar cons-cell + - Function: cdddr cons-cell + - Function: caaaar cons-cell + - Function: caaadr cons-cell + - Function: caadar cons-cell + - Function: caaddr cons-cell + - Function: cadaar cons-cell + - Function: cadadr cons-cell + - Function: caddar cons-cell + - Function: cadddr cons-cell + - Function: cdaaar cons-cell + - Function: cdaadr cons-cell + - Function: cdadar cons-cell + - Function: cdaddr cons-cell + - Function: cddaar cons-cell + - Function: cddadr cons-cell + - Function: cdddar cons-cell + - Function: cddddr cons-cell Each of these functions is equivalent to one or more applications of `car' and/or `cdr'. For example, @@ -191,22 +191,22 @@ rewritten in terms of the functions just described. That is to say, read the a's and d's from right to left and apply a `car' or `cdr' for each a or d found, respectively. - - Function: first LIST + - Function: first list This is equivalent to `(nth 0 LIST)', i.e. the first element of LIST. (Note that this is also equivalent to `car'.) - - Function: second LIST + - Function: second list This is equivalent to `(nth 1 LIST)', i.e. the second element of LIST. - - Function: third LIST - - Function: fourth LIST - - Function: fifth LIST - - Function: sixth LIST - - Function: seventh LIST - - Function: eighth LIST - - Function: ninth LIST - - Function: tenth LIST + - Function: third list + - Function: fourth list + - Function: fifth list + - Function: sixth list + - Function: seventh list + - Function: eighth list + - Function: ninth list + - Function: tenth list These are equivalent to `(nth 2 LIST)' through `(nth 9 LIST)' respectively, i.e. the third through tenth elements of LIST. @@ -221,7 +221,7 @@ Lisp. `cons' is the fundamental list-building function; however, it is interesting to note that `list' is used more times in the source code for Emacs than `cons'. - - Function: cons OBJECT1 OBJECT2 + - Function: cons object1 object2 This function is the fundamental function used to build new list structure. It creates a new cons cell, making OBJECT1 the CAR, and OBJECT2 the CDR. It then returns the new cons cell. The @@ -245,7 +245,7 @@ for Emacs than `cons'. used in this example and the function named `list' described below; any symbol can serve both purposes. - - Function: list &rest OBJECTS + - Function: list &rest objects This function creates a list with OBJECTS as its elements. The resulting list is always `nil'-terminated. If no OBJECTS are given, the empty list is returned. @@ -257,17 +257,17 @@ for Emacs than `cons'. (list) => nil - - Function: make-list LENGTH OBJECT + - Function: make-list length object This function creates a list of length LENGTH, in which all the elements have the identical value OBJECT. Compare `make-list' - with `make-string' (*note Creating Strings::.). + with `make-string' (*note Creating Strings::). (make-list 3 'pigs) => (pigs pigs pigs) (make-list 0 'pigs) => nil - - Function: append &rest SEQUENCES + - Function: append &rest sequences This function returns a list containing all the elements of SEQUENCES. The SEQUENCES may be lists, vectors, or strings, but the last one should be a list. All arguments except the last one @@ -357,12 +357,12 @@ for Emacs than `cons'. of the original integers. *Don't use this feature; we plan to eliminate it. If you already use this feature, change your programs now!* The proper way to convert an integer to a decimal - number in this way is with `format' (*note Formatting Strings::.) - or `number-to-string' (*note String Conversion::.). + number in this way is with `format' (*note Formatting Strings::) + or `number-to-string' (*note String Conversion::). - - Function: reverse LIST + - Function: reverse list This function creates a new list whose elements are the elements of - LIST, but in reverse order. The original argument LIST is *not* + LIST, but in reverse order. The original argument LIST is _not_ altered. (setq x '(1 2 3 4)) @@ -403,7 +403,7 @@ Altering List Elements with `setcar' a list, `setcar' replaces one element of a list with a different element. - - Function: setcar CONS OBJECT + - Function: setcar cons object This function stores OBJECT as the new CAR of CONS, replacing its previous CAR. It returns the value OBJECT. For example: @@ -481,7 +481,7 @@ Altering the CDR of a List The lowest-level primitive for modifying a CDR is `setcdr': - - Function: setcdr CONS OBJECT + - Function: setcdr cons object This function stores OBJECT as the new CDR of CONS, replacing its previous CDR. It returns the value OBJECT. @@ -535,7 +535,7 @@ list. Here is this result in box notation: - -------------- ------------- ------------- + -------------- ------------- ------------- | car | cdr | | car | cdr | | car | cdr | | a | o | -->| b | o------->| c | nil | | | | | | | | | | | | @@ -563,9 +563,9 @@ to them as arguments, to produce a new list that is the returned value. See `delq', in *Note Sets And Lists::, for another function that modifies cons cells. - - Function: nconc &rest LISTS + - Function: nconc &rest lists This function returns a list containing all the elements of LISTS. - Unlike `append' (*note Building Lists::.), the LISTS are *not* + Unlike `append' (*note Building Lists::), the LISTS are _not_ copied. Instead, the last CDR of each of the LISTS is changed to refer to the following list. The last of the LISTS is not altered. For example: @@ -595,23 +595,21 @@ modifies cons cells. (defun add-foo (x) ; We want this function to add (nconc '(foo) x)) ; `foo' to the front of its arg. - + (symbol-function 'add-foo) => (lambda (x) (nconc (quote (foo)) x)) - + (setq xx (add-foo '(1 2))) ; It seems to work. => (foo 1 2) - (setq xy (add-foo '(3 4))) ; What happened? => (foo 1 2 3 4) - (eq xx xy) => t - + (symbol-function 'add-foo) => (lambda (x) (nconc (quote (foo 1 2 3 4) x))) - - Function: nreverse LIST + - Function: nreverse list This function reverses the order of the elements of LIST. Unlike `reverse', `nreverse' alters its argument by reversing the CDRs in the cons cells forming the list. The cons cell that used to be @@ -646,7 +644,7 @@ modifies cons cells. | | | | ------------- ------------ - - Function: sort LIST PREDICATE + - Function: sort list predicate This function sorts LIST stably, though destructively, and returns the sorted list. It compares elements using PREDICATE. A stable sort is one in which elements with equal sort keys maintain their @@ -710,7 +708,7 @@ versions, `member' and `delete'. XEmacs Lisp does not have them. You can write them in Lisp if you wish. - - Function: memq OBJECT LIST + - Function: memq object list This function tests to see whether OBJECT is a member of LIST. If it is, `memq' returns a list starting with the first occurrence of OBJECT. Otherwise, it returns `nil'. The letter `q' in `memq' @@ -722,7 +720,7 @@ versions, `member' and `delete'. (memq '(2) '((1) (2))) ; `(2)' and `(2)' are not `eq'. => nil - - Function: delq OBJECT LIST + - Function: delq object list This function destructively removes all elements `eq' to OBJECT from LIST. The letter `q' in `delq' says that it uses `eq' to compare OBJECT against the elements of the list, like `memq'. @@ -734,7 +732,7 @@ after those elements: (delq 'a '(a b c)) == (cdr '(a b c)) When an element to be deleted appears in the middle of the list, -removing it involves changing the CDRs (*note Setcdr::.). +removing it involves changing the CDRs (*note Setcdr::). (setq sample-list '(a b c (4))) => (a b c (4)) @@ -766,7 +764,7 @@ and the `(4)' in the `sample-list' are not `eq': The following two functions are like `memq' and `delq' but use `equal' rather than `eq' to compare elements. They are new in Emacs 19. - - Function: member OBJECT LIST + - Function: member object list The function `member' tests to see whether OBJECT is a member of LIST, comparing members with OBJECT using `equal'. If OBJECT is a member, `member' returns a list starting with its first occurrence @@ -782,7 +780,7 @@ and the `(4)' in the `sample-list' are not `eq': (member "foo" '("foo" "bar")) => ("foo" "bar") - - Function: delete OBJECT LIST + - Function: delete object list This function destructively removes all elements `equal' to OBJECT from LIST. It is to `delq' as `member' is to `memq': it uses `equal' to compare elements with OBJECT, like `member'; when it @@ -820,7 +818,7 @@ key `maple' is associated with `seeds'. The associated values in an alist may be any Lisp objects; so may the keys. For example, in the following alist, the symbol `a' is associated with the number `1', and the string `"b"' is associated with -the *list* `(2 3)', which is the CDR of the alist element: +the _list_ `(2 3)', which is the CDR of the alist element: ((a . 1) ("b" 2 3)) @@ -847,7 +845,7 @@ the front of the list. When searching an association list for an association with a given key, the first one found is returned, if there is more than one. - In XEmacs Lisp, it is *not* an error if an element of an association + In XEmacs Lisp, it is _not_ an error if an element of an association list is not a cons cell. The alist search functions simply ignore such elements. Many other versions of Lisp signal errors in such cases. @@ -856,10 +854,10 @@ respects. A property list behaves like an association list in which each key can occur only once. *Note Property Lists::, for a comparison of property lists and association lists. - - Function: assoc KEY ALIST + - Function: assoc key alist This function returns the first association for KEY in ALIST. It compares KEY against the alist elements using `equal' (*note - Equality Predicates::.). It returns `nil' if no association in + Equality Predicates::). It returns `nil' if no association in ALIST has a CAR `equal' to KEY. For example: (setq trees '((pine . cones) (oak . acorns) (maple . seeds))) @@ -884,7 +882,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. (cdr (assoc 2 needles-per-cluster)) => ("Austrian Pine" "Red Pine") - - Function: rassoc VALUE ALIST + - Function: rassoc value alist This function returns the first association with value VALUE in ALIST. It returns `nil' if no association in ALIST has a CDR `equal' to VALUE. @@ -893,7 +891,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. ALIST association instead of the CAR. You can think of this as "reverse `assoc'", finding the key for a given value. - - Function: assq KEY ALIST + - Function: assq key alist This function is like `assoc' in that it returns the first association for KEY in ALIST, but it makes the comparison using `eq' instead of `equal'. `assq' returns `nil' if no association @@ -918,7 +916,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. (assoc "simple leaves" leaves) => ("simple leaves" . oak) - - Function: rassq VALUE ALIST + - Function: rassq value alist This function returns the first association with value VALUE in ALIST. It returns `nil' if no association in ALIST has a CDR `eq' to VALUE. @@ -950,7 +948,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. (lily white) == (lily . (white)) - - Function: remassoc KEY ALIST + - Function: remassoc key alist This function deletes by side effect any associations with key KEY in ALIST - i.e. it removes any elements from ALIST whose `car' is `equal' to KEY. The modified ALIST is returned. @@ -960,7 +958,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. `(setq foo (remassoc key foo))' to be sure of changing the value of `foo'. - - Function: remassq KEY ALIST + - Function: remassq key alist This function deletes by side effect any associations with key KEY in ALIST - i.e. it removes any elements from ALIST whose `car' is `eq' to KEY. The modified ALIST is returned. @@ -968,7 +966,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. This function is exactly like `remassoc', but comparisons between KEY and keys in ALIST are done using `eq' instead of `equal'. - - Function: remrassoc VALUE ALIST + - Function: remrassoc value alist This function deletes by side effect any associations with value VALUE in ALIST - i.e. it removes any elements from ALIST whose `cdr' is `equal' to VALUE. The modified ALIST is returned. @@ -983,7 +981,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. as "reverse `remassoc'", removing an association based on its value instead of its key. - - Function: remrassq VALUE ALIST + - Function: remrassq value alist This function deletes by side effect any associations with value VALUE in ALIST - i.e. it removes any elements from ALIST whose `cdr' is `eq' to VALUE. The modified ALIST is returned. @@ -991,7 +989,7 @@ of property lists and association lists. This function is exactly like `remrassoc', but comparisons between VALUE and values in ALIST are done using `eq' instead of `equal'. - - Function: copy-alist ALIST + - Function: copy-alist alist This function returns a two-level deep copy of ALIST: it creates a new copy of each association, so that you can alter the associations of the new alist without changing the old one. @@ -1062,13 +1060,13 @@ association lists generally are not. compared with `eq', and "lax" plists, whose keys are compared with `equal', - - Function: valid-plist-p PLIST + - Function: valid-plist-p plist Given a plist, this function returns non-`nil' if its format is correct. If it returns `nil', `check-valid-plist' will signal an error when given the plist; that means it's a malformed or circular plist or has non-symbols as keywords. - - Function: check-valid-plist PLIST + - Function: check-valid-plist plist Given a plist, this function signals an error if there is anything wrong with it. This means that it's a malformed or circular plist. @@ -1084,25 +1082,25 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Working With Normal Plists, Next: Working With Lax P Working With Normal Plists -------------------------- - - Function: plist-get PLIST PROP &optional DEFAULT + - Function: plist-get plist prop &optional default This function extracts a value from a property list. The function returns the value corresponding to the given PROP, or DEFAULT if PROP is not one of the properties on the list. - - Function: plist-put PLIST PROP VAL + - Function: plist-put plist prop val This function changes the value in PLIST of PROP to VAL. If PROP is already a property on the list, its value is set to VAL, otherwise the new PROP VAL pair is added. The new plist is returned; use `(setq x (plist-put x prop val))' to be sure to use the new value. The PLIST is modified by side effects. - - Function: plist-remprop PLIST PROP + - Function: plist-remprop plist prop This function removes from PLIST the property PROP and its value. The new plist is returned; use `(setq x (plist-remprop x prop val))' to be sure to use the new value. The PLIST is modified by side effects. - - Function: plist-member PLIST PROP + - Function: plist-member plist prop This function returns `t' if PROP has a value specified in PLIST. In the following functions, if optional arg NIL-MEANS-NOT-PRESENT is @@ -1111,16 +1109,16 @@ This feature is a virus that has infected old Lisp implementations (and thus E-Lisp, due to RMS's enamorment with old Lisps), but should not be used except for backward compatibility. - - Function: plists-eq A B &optional NIL-MEANS-NOT-PRESENT + - Function: plists-eq a b &optional nil-means-not-present This function returns non-`nil' if property lists A and B are `eq' (i.e. their values are `eq'). - - Function: plists-equal A B &optional NIL-MEANS-NOT-PRESENT + - Function: plists-equal a b &optional nil-means-not-present This function returns non-`nil' if property lists A and B are `equal' (i.e. their values are `equal'; their keys are still compared using `eq'). - - Function: canonicalize-plist PLIST &optional NIL-MEANS-NOT-PRESENT + - Function: canonicalize-plist plist &optional nil-means-not-present This function destructively removes any duplicate entries from a plist. In such cases, the first entry applies. @@ -1137,21 +1135,21 @@ Working With Lax Plists Recall that a "lax plist" is a property list whose keys are compared using `equal' instead of `eq'. - - Function: lax-plist-get LAX-PLIST PROP &optional DEFAULT + - Function: lax-plist-get lax-plist prop &optional default This function extracts a value from a lax property list. The function returns the value corresponding to the given PROP, or DEFAULT if PROP is not one of the properties on the list. - - Function: lax-plist-put LAX-PLIST PROP VAL + - Function: lax-plist-put lax-plist prop val This function changes the value in LAX-PLIST of PROP to VAL. - - Function: lax-plist-remprop LAX-PLIST PROP + - Function: lax-plist-remprop lax-plist prop This function removes from LAX-PLIST the property PROP and its value. The new plist is returned; use `(setq x (lax-plist-remprop x prop val))' to be sure to use the new value. The LAX-PLIST is modified by side effects. - - Function: lax-plist-member LAX-PLIST PROP + - Function: lax-plist-member lax-plist prop This function returns `t' if PROP has a value specified in LAX-PLIST. @@ -1161,17 +1159,17 @@ This feature is a virus that has infected old Lisp implementations (and thus E-Lisp, due to RMS's enamorment with old Lisps), but should not be used except for backward compatibility. - - Function: lax-plists-eq A B &optional NIL-MEANS-NOT-PRESENT + - Function: lax-plists-eq a b &optional nil-means-not-present This function returns non-`nil' if lax property lists A and B are `eq' (i.e. their values are `eq'; their keys are still compared using `equal'). - - Function: lax-plists-equal A B &optional NIL-MEANS-NOT-PRESENT + - Function: lax-plists-equal a b &optional nil-means-not-present This function returns non-`nil' if lax property lists A and B are `equal' (i.e. their values are `equal'). - - Function: canonicalize-lax-plist LAX-PLIST &optional - NIL-MEANS-NOT-PRESENT + - Function: canonicalize-lax-plist lax-plist &optional + nil-means-not-present This function destructively removes any duplicate entries from a lax plist. In such cases, the first entry applies. @@ -1185,7 +1183,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Converting Plists To/From Alists, Prev: Working With Converting Plists To/From Alists -------------------------------- - - Function: alist-to-plist ALIST + - Function: alist-to-plist alist This function converts association list ALIST into the equivalent property-list form. The plist is returned. This converts from @@ -1197,7 +1195,7 @@ Converting Plists To/From Alists The original alist is not modified. - - Function: plist-to-alist PLIST + - Function: plist-to-alist plist This function converts property list PLIST into the equivalent association-list form. The alist is returned. This converts from @@ -1214,11 +1212,11 @@ except that they destructively modify their arguments, using cons cells from the original list to form the new list rather than allocating new cons cells. - - Function: destructive-alist-to-plist ALIST + - Function: destructive-alist-to-plist alist This function destructively converts association list ALIST into the equivalent property-list form. The plist is returned. - - Function: destructive-plist-to-alist PLIST + - Function: destructive-plist-to-alist plist This function destructively converts property list PLIST into the equivalent association-list form. The alist is returned. @@ -1243,9 +1241,9 @@ parent will still be reclaimed, and will automatically be removed from its parent's list of children. Weak lists are similar to weak hash tables (*note Weak Hash -Tables::.). +Tables::). - - Function: weak-list-p OBJECT + - Function: weak-list-p object This function returns non-`nil' if OBJECT is a weak list. Weak lists come in one of four types: @@ -1266,18 +1264,18 @@ Tables::.). Objects in the list disappear if they are conses and the cdr is not referenced outside of the list. - - Function: make-weak-list &optional TYPE + - Function: make-weak-list &optional type This function creates a new weak list of type TYPE. TYPE is a symbol (one of `simple', `assoc', `key-assoc', or `value-assoc', as described above) and defaults to `simple'. - - Function: weak-list-type WEAK + - Function: weak-list-type weak This function returns the type of the given weak-list object. - - Function: weak-list-list WEAK + - Function: weak-list-list weak This function returns the list contained in a weak-list object. - - Function: set-weak-list-list WEAK NEW-LIST + - Function: set-weak-list-list weak new-list This function changes the list contained in a weak-list object.  diff --git a/info/lispref.info-7 b/info/lispref.info-7 index 780fd80..b24b1a9 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-7 +++ b/info/lispref.info-7 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -60,11 +60,11 @@ vector, or a string. The common property that all sequences have is that each is an ordered collection of elements. This section describes functions that accept any kind of sequence. - - Function: sequencep OBJECT + - Function: sequencep object Returns `t' if OBJECT is a list, vector, bit vector, or string, `nil' otherwise. - - Function: copy-sequence SEQUENCE + - Function: copy-sequence sequence Returns a copy of SEQUENCE. The copy is the same type of object as the original sequence, and it has the same elements in the same order. @@ -115,7 +115,7 @@ functions that accept any kind of sequence. (bit-vector 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 0) => #*10110100 - - Function: length SEQUENCE + - Function: length sequence Returns the number of elements in SEQUENCE. If SEQUENCE is a cons cell that is not a list (because the final CDR is not `nil'), a `wrong-type-argument' error is signaled. @@ -131,7 +131,7 @@ functions that accept any kind of sequence. (length #*01101) => 5 - - Function: elt SEQUENCE INDEX + - Function: elt sequence index This function returns the element of SEQUENCE indexed by INDEX. Legitimate values of INDEX are integers ranging from 0 up to one less than the length of SEQUENCE. If SEQUENCE is a list, then @@ -151,8 +151,8 @@ functions that accept any kind of sequence. (elt [1 2 3 4] -1) error-->Args out of range: [1 2 3 4], -1 - This function generalizes `aref' (*note Array Functions::.) and - `nth' (*note List Elements::.). + This function generalizes `aref' (*note Array Functions::) and + `nth' (*note List Elements::).  File: lispref.info, Node: Arrays, Next: Array Functions, Prev: Sequence Functions, Up: Sequences Arrays Vectors @@ -188,7 +188,7 @@ Type::, *Note Vector Type::, and *Note Bit Vector Type::. * The elements of an array may be referenced or changed with the functions `aref' and `aset', respectively (*note Array - Functions::.). + Functions::). In principle, if you wish to have an array of text characters, you could use either a string or a vector. In practice, we always choose @@ -233,7 +233,7 @@ Functions that Operate on Arrays In this section, we describe the functions that accept strings, vectors, and bit vectors. - - Function: arrayp OBJECT + - Function: arrayp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is an array (i.e., a string, vector, or bit vector). @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ vectors, and bit vectors. (arrayp #*101) => t - - Function: aref ARRAY INDEX + - Function: aref array index This function returns the INDEXth element of ARRAY. The first element is at index zero. @@ -263,7 +263,7 @@ vectors, and bit vectors. See also the function `elt', in *Note Sequence Functions::. - - Function: aset ARRAY INDEX OBJECT + - Function: aset array index object This function sets the INDEXth element of ARRAY to be OBJECT. It returns OBJECT. @@ -291,7 +291,7 @@ vectors, and bit vectors. If ARRAY is a string and OBJECT is not a character, a `wrong-type-argument' error results. - - Function: fillarray ARRAY OBJECT + - Function: fillarray array object This function fills the array ARRAY with OBJECT, so that each element of ARRAY is OBJECT. It returns ARRAY. @@ -364,7 +364,7 @@ Functions That Operate on Vectors Here are some functions that relate to vectors: - - Function: vectorp OBJECT + - Function: vectorp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a vector. (vectorp [a]) @@ -372,7 +372,7 @@ Functions That Operate on Vectors (vectorp "asdf") => nil - - Function: vector &rest OBJECTS + - Function: vector &rest objects This function creates and returns a vector whose elements are the arguments, OBJECTS. @@ -381,14 +381,14 @@ Functions That Operate on Vectors (vector) => [] - - Function: make-vector LENGTH OBJECT + - Function: make-vector length object This function returns a new vector consisting of LENGTH elements, each initialized to OBJECT. (setq sleepy (make-vector 9 'Z)) => [Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z] - - Function: vconcat &rest SEQUENCES + - Function: vconcat &rest sequences This function returns a new vector containing all the elements of the SEQUENCES. The arguments SEQUENCES may be lists, vectors, or strings. If no SEQUENCES are given, an empty vector is returned. @@ -411,8 +411,8 @@ Functions That Operate on Vectors of the original integers. *Don't use this feature; we plan to eliminate it. If you already use this feature, change your programs now!* The proper way to convert an integer to a decimal - number in this way is with `format' (*note Formatting Strings::.) - or `number-to-string' (*note String Conversion::.). + number in this way is with `format' (*note Formatting Strings::) + or `number-to-string' (*note String Conversion::). For other concatenation functions, see `mapconcat' in *Note Mapping Functions::, `concat' in *Note Creating Strings::, `append' @@ -420,7 +420,7 @@ Functions That Operate on Vectors Functions::. The `append' function provides a way to convert a vector into a list -with the same elements (*note Building Lists::.): +with the same elements (*note Building Lists::): (setq avector [1 two (quote (three)) "four" [five]]) => [1 two (quote (three)) "four" [five]] @@ -458,7 +458,7 @@ Functions That Operate on Bit Vectors Here are some functions that relate to bit vectors: - - Function: bit-vector-p OBJECT + - Function: bit-vector-p object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a bit vector. (bit-vector-p #*01) @@ -468,10 +468,10 @@ Functions That Operate on Bit Vectors (bit-vector-p "01") => nil - - Function: bitp OBJECT + - Function: bitp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is either 0 or 1. - - Function: bit-vector &rest OBJECTS + - Function: bit-vector &rest objects This function creates and returns a bit vector whose elements are the arguments OBJECTS. The elements must be either of the two integers 0 or 1. @@ -481,14 +481,14 @@ Functions That Operate on Bit Vectors (bit-vector) => #* - - Function: make-bit-vector LENGTH OBJECT + - Function: make-bit-vector length object This function creates and returns a bit vector consisting of LENGTH elements, each initialized to OBJECT. (setq picket-fence (make-bit-vector 9 1)) => #*111111111 - - Function: bvconcat &rest SEQUENCES + - Function: bvconcat &rest sequences This function returns a new bit vector containing all the elements of the SEQUENCES. The arguments SEQUENCES may be lists, vectors, or bit vectors, all of whose elements are the integers 0 or 1. If @@ -512,7 +512,7 @@ Functions That Operate on Bit Vectors Building Lists::. The `append' function provides a way to convert a bit vector into a -list with the same elements (*note Building Lists::.): +list with the same elements (*note Building Lists::): (setq bv #*00001110) => #*00001110 @@ -535,7 +535,7 @@ Type::. You can test whether an arbitrary Lisp object is a symbol with `symbolp': - - Function: symbolp OBJECT + - Function: symbolp object This function returns `t' if OBJECT is a symbol, `nil' otherwise. * Menu: @@ -594,15 +594,15 @@ Symbols::.) In normal usage, the function cell usually contains a function or macro, as that is what the Lisp interpreter expects to see there (*note -Evaluation::.). Keyboard macros (*note Keyboard Macros::.), keymaps -(*note Keymaps::.) and autoload objects (*note Autoloading::.) are also +Evaluation::). Keyboard macros (*note Keyboard Macros::), keymaps +(*note Keymaps::) and autoload objects (*note Autoloading::) are also sometimes stored in the function cell of symbols. We often refer to "the function `foo'" when we really mean the function stored in the function cell of the symbol `foo'. We make the distinction only when necessary. The property list cell normally should hold a correctly formatted -property list (*note Property Lists::.), as a number of functions expect +property list (*note Property Lists::), as a number of functions expect to see a property list there. The function cell or the value cell may be "void", which means that @@ -635,9 +635,9 @@ file. (29529 is the offset from the beginning of the `DOC' file to where that documentation string begins.) The function cell contains the function for returning the name of the file. `buffer-file-name' names a primitive function, which has no read syntax and prints in hash -notation (*note Primitive Function Type::.). A symbol naming a -function written in Lisp would have a lambda expression (or a byte-code -object) in this cell. +notation (*note Primitive Function Type::). A symbol naming a function +written in Lisp would have a lambda expression (or a byte-code object) +in this cell.  File: lispref.info, Node: Definitions, Next: Creating Symbols, Prev: Symbol Components, Up: Symbols @@ -679,7 +679,7 @@ as a variable or function. Thus, you can make a symbol a global variable with `setq', whether you define it first or not. The real purpose of definitions is to guide programmers and programming tools. They inform programmers who read the code that certain symbols are -*intended* to be used as variables, or as functions. In addition, +_intended_ to be used as variables, or as functions. In addition, utilities such as `etags' and `make-docfile' recognize definitions, and add appropriate information to tag tables and the `DOC' file. *Note Accessing Documentation::. @@ -744,7 +744,7 @@ symbol in the obarray bucket. The results would be unpredictable. It is possible for two different symbols to have the same name in different obarrays; these symbols are not `eq' or `equal'. However, this normally happens only as part of the abbrev mechanism (*note -Abbrevs::.). +Abbrevs::). Common Lisp note: In Common Lisp, a single symbol may be interned in several obarrays. @@ -753,7 +753,7 @@ Abbrevs::.). arguments. A `wrong-type-argument' error is signaled if the name is not a string, or if the obarray is not a vector. - - Function: symbol-name SYMBOL + - Function: symbol-name symbol This function returns the string that is SYMBOL's name. For example: @@ -764,7 +764,7 @@ not a string, or if the obarray is not a vector. the name of the symbol, but fails to update the obarray, so don't do it! - - Function: make-symbol NAME + - Function: make-symbol name This function returns a newly-allocated, uninterned symbol whose name is NAME (which must be a string). Its value and function definition are void, and its property list is `nil'. In the @@ -776,7 +776,7 @@ not a string, or if the obarray is not a vector. (eq sym 'foo) => nil - - Function: intern NAME &optional OBARRAY + - Function: intern name &optional obarray This function returns the interned symbol whose name is NAME. If there is no such symbol in the obarray OBARRAY, `intern' creates a new one, adds it to the obarray, and returns it. If OBARRAY is @@ -792,7 +792,7 @@ not a string, or if the obarray is not a vector. (eq sym 'foo) => nil - - Function: intern-soft NAME &optional OBARRAY + - Function: intern-soft name &optional obarray This function returns the symbol in OBARRAY whose name is NAME, or `nil' if OBARRAY has no symbol with that name. Therefore, you can use `intern-soft' to test whether a symbol with a given name is @@ -805,13 +805,10 @@ not a string, or if the obarray is not a vector. => frazzle (intern-soft "frazzle") ; That one cannot be found. => nil - (setq sym (intern "frazzle")) ; Create an interned one. => frazzle - (intern-soft "frazzle") ; That one can be found! => frazzle - (eq sym 'frazzle) ; And it is the same one. => t @@ -819,7 +816,7 @@ not a string, or if the obarray is not a vector. This variable is the standard obarray for use by `intern' and `read'. - - Function: mapatoms FUNCTION &optional OBARRAY + - Function: mapatoms function &optional obarray This function calls FUNCTION for each symbol in the obarray OBARRAY. It returns `nil'. If OBARRAY is omitted, it defaults to the value of `obarray', the standard obarray for ordinary symbols. @@ -837,7 +834,7 @@ not a string, or if the obarray is not a vector. See `documentation' in *Note Accessing Documentation::, for another example using `mapatoms'. - - Function: unintern SYMBOL &optional OBARRAY + - Function: unintern symbol &optional obarray This function deletes SYMBOL from the obarray OBARRAY. If `symbol' is not actually in the obarray, `unintern' does nothing. If OBARRAY is `nil', the current obarray is used. @@ -891,7 +888,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Plists and Alists, Next: Symbol Plists, Up: Symbol Property Lists and Association Lists ------------------------------------ - Association lists (*note Association Lists::.) are very similar to + Association lists (*note Association Lists::) are very similar to property lists. In contrast to association lists, the order of the pairs in the property list is not significant since the property names must be distinct. @@ -924,10 +921,10 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Symbol Plists, Next: Other Plists, Prev: Plists and Property List Functions for Symbols ----------------------------------- - - Function: symbol-plist SYMBOL + - Function: symbol-plist symbol This function returns the property list of SYMBOL. - - Function: setplist SYMBOL PLIST + - Function: setplist symbol plist This function sets SYMBOL's property list to PLIST. Normally, PLIST should be a well-formed property list, but this is not enforced. @@ -940,9 +937,9 @@ Property List Functions for Symbols For symbols in special obarrays, which are not used for ordinary purposes, it may make sense to use the property list cell in a nonstandard fashion; in fact, the abbrev mechanism does so (*note - Abbrevs::.). + Abbrevs::). - - Function: get SYMBOL PROPERTY + - Function: get symbol property This function finds the value of the property named PROPERTY in SYMBOL's property list. If there is no such property, `nil' is returned. Thus, there is no distinction between a value of `nil' @@ -953,7 +950,7 @@ Property List Functions for Symbols See `put' for an example. - - Function: put SYMBOL PROPERTY VALUE + - Function: put symbol property value This function puts VALUE onto SYMBOL's property list under the property name PROPERTY, replacing any previous property value. The `put' function returns VALUE. @@ -976,14 +973,14 @@ Property Lists Outside Symbols These functions are useful for manipulating property lists that are stored in places other than symbols: - - Function: getf PLIST PROPERTY &optional DEFAULT + - Function: getf plist property &optional default This returns the value of the PROPERTY property stored in the property list PLIST. For example, (getf '(foo 4) 'foo) => 4 - - Function: putf PLIST PROPERTY VALUE + - Function: putf plist property value This stores VALUE as the value of the PROPERTY property in the property list PLIST. It may modify PLIST destructively, or it may construct a new list structure without altering the old. The @@ -997,13 +994,13 @@ stored in places other than symbols: (setq my-plist (putf my-plist 'quux '(a))) => (quux (a) bar t foo 5) - - Function: plists-eq A B + - Function: plists-eq a b This function returns non-`nil' if property lists A and B are `eq'. This means that the property lists have the same values for all the same properties, where comparison between values is done using `eq'. - - Function: plists-equal A B + - Function: plists-equal a b This function returns non-`nil' if property lists A and B are `equal'. @@ -1087,7 +1084,7 @@ function `car'. in it. *Note Functions::. The execution of the function may itself work by evaluating the function definition; or the function may be a Lisp primitive implemented in C, or it may be a byte-compiled function -(*note Byte Compilation::.). +(*note Byte Compilation::). The evaluation of forms takes place in a context called the "environment", which consists of the current values and bindings of all @@ -1096,14 +1093,14 @@ creating a new binding for it, the value of the binding in the current environment is used. *Note Variables::. Evaluation of a form may create new environments for recursive -evaluation by binding variables (*note Local Variables::.). These +evaluation by binding variables (*note Local Variables::). These environments are temporary and vanish by the time evaluation of the form is complete. The form may also make changes that persist; these changes are called "side effects". An example of a form that produces side effects is `(setq foo 1)'. The details of what evaluation means for each kind of form are -described below (*note Forms::.). +described below (*note Forms::). ---------- Footnotes ---------- @@ -1129,13 +1126,13 @@ ability to pass information to them as arguments. The functions and variables described in this section evaluate forms, specify limits to the evaluation process, or record recently returned -values. Loading a file also does evaluation (*note Loading::.). +values. Loading a file also does evaluation (*note Loading::). - - Function: eval FORM + - Function: eval form This is the basic function for performing evaluation. It evaluates FORM in the current environment and returns the result. How the evaluation proceeds depends on the type of the object (*note - Forms::.). + Forms::). Since `eval' is a function, the argument expression that appears in a call to `eval' is evaluated twice: once as preparation before @@ -1155,7 +1152,7 @@ values. Loading a file also does evaluation (*note Loading::.). The number of currently active calls to `eval' is limited to `max-lisp-eval-depth' (see below). - - Command: eval-region START END &optional STREAM + - Command: eval-region start end &optional stream This function evaluates the forms in the current buffer in the region defined by the positions START and END. It reads forms from the region and calls `eval' on them until the end of the region is @@ -1170,7 +1167,7 @@ values. Loading a file also does evaluation (*note Loading::.). `eval-region' always returns `nil'. - - Command: eval-buffer BUFFER &optional STREAM + - Command: eval-buffer buffer &optional stream This is like `eval-region' except that it operates on the whole contents of BUFFER. @@ -1243,7 +1240,7 @@ starting with "all other types" which are self-evaluating forms. we find the real function via the symbol. * Function Forms:: Forms that call functions. * Macro Forms:: Forms that call macros. -* Special Forms:: "Special forms" are idiosyncratic primitives, +* Special Forms:: ``Special forms'' are idiosyncratic primitives, most of them extremely important. * Autoloading:: Functions set up to load files containing their real definitions. diff --git a/info/lispref.info-8 b/info/lispref.info-8 index 379f384..c2d71fb 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-8 +++ b/info/lispref.info-8 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -91,7 +91,7 @@ macro, or special form. The first step in evaluating a nonempty list is to examine its first element. This element alone determines what kind of form the list is and how the rest of the list is to be processed. The first element is -*not* evaluated, as it would be in some Lisp dialects such as Scheme. +_not_ evaluated, as it would be in some Lisp dialects such as Scheme.  File: lispref.info, Node: Function Indirection, Next: Function Forms, Prev: Classifying Lists, Up: Forms @@ -122,7 +122,7 @@ these types, the error `invalid-function' is signaled. The following example illustrates the symbol indirection process. We use `fset' to set the function cell of a symbol and `symbol-function' -to get the function cell contents (*note Function Cells::.). +to get the function cell contents (*note Function Cells::). Specifically, we store the symbol `car' into the function cell of `first', and the symbol `first' into the function cell of `erste'. @@ -133,13 +133,10 @@ Specifically, we store the symbol `car' into the function cell of (symbol-function 'car) => # - (fset 'first 'car) => car - (fset 'erste 'first) => first - (erste '(1 2 3)) ; Call the function referenced by `erste'. => 1 @@ -157,7 +154,7 @@ symbol function indirection when calling `erste'. The built-in function `indirect-function' provides an easy way to perform symbol function indirection explicitly. - - Function: indirect-function FUNCTION + - Function: indirect-function function This function returns the meaning of FUNCTION as a function. If FUNCTION is a symbol, then it finds FUNCTION's function definition and starts over with that value. If FUNCTION is not a symbol, @@ -186,9 +183,9 @@ a "function call". For example, here is a call to the function `+': remaining elements of the list from left to right. The results are the actual argument values, one value for each list element. The next step is to call the function with this list of arguments, effectively using -the function `apply' (*note Calling Functions::.). If the function is +the function `apply' (*note Calling Functions::). If the function is written in Lisp, the arguments are used to bind the argument variables -of the function (*note Lambda Expressions::.); then the forms in the +of the function (*note Lambda Expressions::); then the forms in the function body are evaluated in order, and the value of the last body form becomes the value of the function call. @@ -200,7 +197,7 @@ Lisp Macro Evaluation If the first element of a list being evaluated is a macro object, then the list is a "macro call". When a macro call is evaluated, the -elements of the rest of the list are *not* initially evaluated. +elements of the rest of the list are _not_ initially evaluated. Instead, these elements themselves are used as the arguments of the macro. The macro definition computes a replacement form, called the "expansion" of the macro, to be evaluated in place of the original @@ -250,82 +247,82 @@ evaluated may depend on the results of evaluating other arguments. XEmacs Lisp with a reference to where each is described. `and' - *note Combining Conditions::. + *note Combining Conditions:: `catch' - *note Catch and Throw::. + *note Catch and Throw:: `cond' - *note Conditionals::. + *note Conditionals:: `condition-case' - *note Handling Errors::. + *note Handling Errors:: `defconst' - *note Defining Variables::. + *note Defining Variables:: `defmacro' - *note Defining Macros::. + *note Defining Macros:: `defun' - *note Defining Functions::. + *note Defining Functions:: `defvar' - *note Defining Variables::. + *note Defining Variables:: `function' - *note Anonymous Functions::. + *note Anonymous Functions:: `if' - *note Conditionals::. + *note Conditionals:: `interactive' - *note Interactive Call::. + *note Interactive Call:: `let' `let*' - *note Local Variables::. + *note Local Variables:: `or' - *note Combining Conditions::. + *note Combining Conditions:: `prog1' `prog2' `progn' - *note Sequencing::. + *note Sequencing:: `quote' - *note Quoting::. + *note Quoting:: `save-current-buffer' - *note Excursions::. + *note Excursions:: `save-excursion' - *note Excursions::. + *note Excursions:: `save-restriction' - *note Narrowing::. + *note Narrowing:: `save-selected-window' - *note Excursions::. + *note Excursions:: `save-window-excursion' - *note Window Configurations::. + *note Window Configurations:: `setq' - *note Setting Variables::. + *note Setting Variables:: `setq-default' - *note Creating Buffer-Local::. + *note Creating Buffer-Local:: `unwind-protect' - *note Nonlocal Exits::. + *note Nonlocal Exits:: `while' - *note Iteration::. + *note Iteration:: `with-output-to-temp-buffer' - *note Temporary Displays::. + *note Temporary Displays:: Common Lisp note: here are some comparisons of special forms in XEmacs Lisp and Common Lisp. `setq', `if', and `catch' are @@ -361,7 +358,7 @@ and lists, which are not self-evaluating objects, in a program. (It is not necessary to quote self-evaluating objects such as numbers, strings, and vectors.) - - Special Form: quote OBJECT + - Special Form: quote object This special form returns OBJECT, without evaluating it. Because `quote' is used so often in programs, Lisp provides a @@ -386,9 +383,9 @@ syntax `'x' is an abbreviation for `(quote x)'. => [(quote foo)] Other quoting constructs include `function' (*note Anonymous -Functions::.), which causes an anonymous lambda expression written in -Lisp to be compiled, and ``' (*note Backquote::.), which is used to -quote only part of a list, while computing and substituting other parts. +Functions::), which causes an anonymous lambda expression written in +Lisp to be compiled, and ``' (*note Backquote::), which is used to quote +only part of a list, while computing and substituting other parts.  File: lispref.info, Node: Control Structures, Next: Variables, Prev: Evaluation, Up: Top @@ -396,7 +393,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Control Structures, Next: Variables, Prev: Evaluati Control Structures ****************** - A Lisp program consists of expressions or "forms" (*note Forms::.). + A Lisp program consists of expressions or "forms" (*note Forms::). We control the order of execution of the forms by enclosing them in "control structures". Control structures are special forms which control when, whether, or how many times to execute the forms they @@ -418,7 +415,7 @@ other varieties of sequencing, conditionals, iteration, and (controlled) jumps--all discussed below. The built-in control structures are special forms since their subforms are not necessarily evaluated or not evaluated sequentially. You can use macros to define your own control -structure constructs (*note Macros::.). +structure constructs (*note Macros::). * Menu: @@ -458,7 +455,7 @@ structures likewise contain an implicit `progn'. As a result, `progn' is not used as often as it used to be. It is needed now most often inside an `unwind-protect', `and', `or', or in the THEN-part of an `if'. - - Special Form: progn FORMS... + - Special Form: progn forms... This special form evaluates all of the FORMS, in textual order, returning the result of the final form. @@ -473,7 +470,7 @@ inside an `unwind-protect', `and', `or', or in the THEN-part of an `if'. Two other control constructs likewise evaluate a series of forms but return a different value: - - Special Form: prog1 FORM1 FORMS... + - Special Form: prog1 form1 forms... This special form evaluates FORM1 and all of the FORMS, in textual order, returning the result of FORM1. @@ -490,7 +487,7 @@ return a different value: (prog1 (car x) (setq x (cdr x))) - - Special Form: prog2 FORM1 FORM2 FORMS... + - Special Form: prog2 form1 form2 forms... This special form evaluates FORM1, FORM2, and all of the following FORMS, in textual order, returning the result of FORM2. @@ -512,7 +509,7 @@ Conditionals Lisp has two conditional forms: `if', which is much the same as in other languages, and `cond', which is a generalized case statement. - - Special Form: if CONDITION THEN-FORM ELSE-FORMS... + - Special Form: if condition then-form else-forms... `if' chooses between the THEN-FORM and the ELSE-FORMS based on the value of CONDITION. If the evaluated CONDITION is non-`nil', THEN-FORM is evaluated and the result returned. Otherwise, the @@ -532,7 +529,7 @@ languages, and `cond', which is a generalized case statement. 'very-false) => very-false - - Special Form: cond CLAUSE... + - Special Form: cond clause... `cond' chooses among an arbitrary number of alternatives. Each CLAUSE in the `cond' must be a list. The CAR of this list is the CONDITION; the remaining elements, if any, the BODY-FORMS. Thus, @@ -603,13 +600,13 @@ with `if' and `cond' to express complicated conditions. The constructs `and' and `or' can also be used individually as kinds of multiple conditional constructs. - - Function: not CONDITION + - Function: not condition This function tests for the falsehood of CONDITION. It returns `t' if CONDITION is `nil', and `nil' otherwise. The function `not' is identical to `null', and we recommend using the name `null' if you are testing for an empty list. - - Special Form: and CONDITIONS... + - Special Form: and conditions... The `and' special form tests whether all the CONDITIONS are true. It works by evaluating the CONDITIONS one by one in the order written. @@ -648,7 +645,7 @@ conditional constructs. == (cond (ARG1 (cond (ARG2 ARG3)))) - - Special Form: or CONDITIONS... + - Special Form: or conditions... The `or' special form tests whether at least one of the CONDITIONS is true. It works by evaluating all the CONDITIONS one by one in the order written. @@ -696,7 +693,7 @@ example, you might want to repeat some computation once for each element of a list, or once for each integer from 0 to N. You can do this in XEmacs Lisp with the special form `while': - - Special Form: while CONDITION FORMS... + - Special Form: while condition forms... `while' first evaluates CONDITION. If the result is non-`nil', it evaluates FORMS in textual order. Then it reevaluates CONDITION, and if the result is non-`nil', it evaluates FORMS again. This @@ -704,8 +701,7 @@ XEmacs Lisp with the special form `while': There is no limit on the number of iterations that may occur. The loop will continue until either CONDITION evaluates to `nil' or - until an error or `throw' jumps out of it (*note Nonlocal - Exits::.). + until an error or `throw' jumps out of it (*note Nonlocal Exits::). The value of a `while' form is always `nil'. @@ -786,12 +782,12 @@ innermost one takes precedence. `catch', including function calls. When binding constructs such as `let' or function calls are exited in this way, the bindings are unbound, just as they are when these constructs exit normally (*note -Local Variables::.). Likewise, `throw' restores the buffer and -position saved by `save-excursion' (*note Excursions::.), and the -narrowing status saved by `save-restriction' and the window selection -saved by `save-window-excursion' (*note Window Configurations::.). It -also runs any cleanups established with the `unwind-protect' special -form when it exits that form (*note Cleanups::.). +Local Variables::). Likewise, `throw' restores the buffer and position +saved by `save-excursion' (*note Excursions::), and the narrowing +status saved by `save-restriction' and the window selection saved by +`save-window-excursion' (*note Window Configurations::). It also runs +any cleanups established with the `unwind-protect' special form when it +exits that form (*note Cleanups::). The `throw' need not appear lexically within the `catch' that it jumps to. It can equally well be called from another function called @@ -799,14 +795,14 @@ within the `catch'. As long as the `throw' takes place chronologically after entry to the `catch', and chronologically before exit from it, it has access to that `catch'. This is why `throw' can be used in commands such as `exit-recursive-edit' that throw back to the editor -command loop (*note Recursive Editing::.). +command loop (*note Recursive Editing::). Common Lisp note: Most other versions of Lisp, including Common Lisp, have several ways of transferring control nonsequentially: `return', `return-from', and `go', for example. XEmacs Lisp has only `throw'. - - Special Form: catch TAG BODY... + - Special Form: catch tag body... `catch' establishes a return point for the `throw' function. The return point is distinguished from other such return points by TAG, which may be any Lisp object. The argument TAG is evaluated @@ -821,7 +817,7 @@ command loop (*note Recursive Editing::.). the `catch' exits immediately; the value it returns is whatever was specified as the second argument of `throw'. - - Function: throw TAG VALUE + - Function: throw tag value The purpose of `throw' is to return from a return point previously established with `catch'. The argument TAG is used to choose among the various existing return points; it must be `eq' to the @@ -947,10 +943,10 @@ can also signal errors explicitly with the functions `error' and Quitting, which happens when the user types `C-g', is not considered an error, but it is handled almost like an error. *Note Quitting::. - - Function: error FORMAT-STRING &rest ARGS + - Function: error format-string &rest args This function signals an error with an error message constructed by - applying `format' (*note String Conversion::.) to FORMAT-STRING - and ARGS. + applying `format' (*note String Conversion::) to FORMAT-STRING and + ARGS. These examples show typical uses of `error': @@ -971,7 +967,7 @@ an error, but it is handled almost like an error. *Note Quitting::. will be interpreted as a format specifier, with undesirable results. Instead, use `(error "%s" STRING)'. - - Function: signal ERROR-SYMBOL DATA + - Function: signal error-symbol data This function signals an error named by ERROR-SYMBOL. The argument DATA is a list of additional Lisp objects relevant to the circumstances of the error. @@ -990,15 +986,15 @@ an error, but it is handled almost like an error. *Note Quitting::. Both ERROR-SYMBOL and DATA are available to any error handlers that handle the error: `condition-case' binds a local variable to a list of the form `(ERROR-SYMBOL . DATA)' (*note Handling - Errors::.). If the error is not handled, these two values are - used in printing the error message. + Errors::). If the error is not handled, these two values are used + in printing the error message. The function `signal' never returns (though in older Emacs versions it could sometimes return). (signal 'wrong-number-of-arguments '(x y)) error--> Wrong number of arguments: x, y - + (signal 'no-such-error '("My unknown error condition.")) error--> peculiar error: "My unknown error condition." @@ -1028,8 +1024,8 @@ print an error message. An error that has no explicit handler may call the Lisp debugger. The debugger is enabled if the variable `debug-on-error' (*note Error -Debugging::.) is non-`nil'. Unlike error handlers, the debugger runs -in the environment of the error, so that you can examine values of +Debugging::) is non-`nil'. Unlike error handlers, the debugger runs in +the environment of the error, so that you can examine values of variables precisely as they were at the time of the error.  @@ -1099,7 +1095,7 @@ caught by a `catch', and a `throw' cannot be handled by an error handler (though using `throw' when there is no suitable `catch' signals an error that can be handled). - - Special Form: condition-case VAR PROTECTED-FORM HANDLERS... + - Special Form: condition-case var protected-form handlers... This special form establishes the error handlers HANDLERS around the execution of PROTECTED-FORM. If PROTECTED-FORM executes without error, the value it returns becomes the value of the @@ -1123,9 +1119,9 @@ an error that can be handled). Each error that occurs has an "error symbol" that describes what kind of error it is. The `error-conditions' property of this - symbol is a list of condition names (*note Error Symbols::.). - Emacs searches all the active `condition-case' forms for a handler - that specifies one or more of these condition names; the innermost + symbol is a list of condition names (*note Error Symbols::). Emacs + searches all the active `condition-case' forms for a handler that + specifies one or more of these condition names; the innermost matching `condition-case' handles the error. Within this `condition-case', the first applicable handler handles the error. @@ -1157,7 +1153,7 @@ message and returns a very large number. (princ (format "Arithmetic error: %s" err)) 1000000))) => safe-divide - + (safe-divide 5 0) -| Arithmetic error: (arith-error) => 1000000 @@ -1174,7 +1170,7 @@ including those signaled with `error': (setq baz 34) => 34 - + (condition-case err (if (eq baz 35) t @@ -1236,7 +1232,7 @@ classification; and `error', which is the widest of all. not end with a period. This is for consistency with the rest of Emacs. Naturally, XEmacs will never signal `new-error' on its own; only an -explicit call to `signal' (*note Signaling Errors::.) in your code can +explicit call to `signal' (*note Signaling Errors::) in your code can do this: (signal 'new-error '(x y)) diff --git a/info/lispref.info-9 b/info/lispref.info-9 index 579cb35..5b59644 100644 --- a/info/lispref.info-9 +++ b/info/lispref.info-9 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/lispref.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file lispref.texi. +This is ../info/lispref.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +lispref/lispref.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -59,7 +59,7 @@ Cleaning Up from Nonlocal Exits put a data structure in an inconsistent state; it permits you to ensure the data are consistent in the event of an error or throw. - - Special Form: unwind-protect BODY CLEANUP-FORMS... + - Special Form: unwind-protect body cleanup-forms... `unwind-protect' executes the BODY with a guarantee that the CLEANUP-FORMS will be evaluated if control leaves BODY, no matter how that happens. The BODY may complete normally, or execute a @@ -73,14 +73,14 @@ the data are consistent in the event of an error or throw. Only the BODY is actually protected by the `unwind-protect'. If any of the CLEANUP-FORMS themselves exits nonlocally (e.g., via a - `throw' or an error), `unwind-protect' is *not* guaranteed to + `throw' or an error), `unwind-protect' is _not_ guaranteed to evaluate the rest of them. If the failure of one of the CLEANUP-FORMS has the potential to cause trouble, then protect it with another `unwind-protect' around that form. The number of currently active `unwind-protect' forms counts, together with the number of local variable bindings, against the - limit `max-specpdl-size' (*note Local Variables::.). + limit `max-specpdl-size' (*note Local Variables::). For example, here we make an invisible buffer for temporary use, and make sure to kill it before finishing: @@ -100,7 +100,7 @@ another `save-excursion' around the body, to ensure that the temporary buffer becomes current in time to kill it.) Here is an actual example taken from the file `ftp.el'. It creates -a process (*note Processes::.) to try to establish a connection to a +a process (*note Processes::) to try to establish a connection to a remote machine. As the function `ftp-login' is highly susceptible to numerous problems that the writer of the function cannot anticipate, it is protected with a form that guarantees deletion of the process in the @@ -247,7 +247,7 @@ variables; these last until exit from the `let' form. one) of the variable. When the life span of the local value is over, the previous value is restored. In the mean time, we say that the previous value is "shadowed" and "not visible". Both global and local -values may be shadowed (*note Scope::.). +values may be shadowed (*note Scope::). If you set a variable (such as with `setq') while it is local, this replaces the local value; it does not alter the global value, or @@ -277,7 +277,7 @@ binding. The special forms `let' and `let*' exist to create local bindings. - - Special Form: let (BINDINGS...) FORMS... + - Special Form: let (bindings...) forms... This special form binds variables according to BINDINGS and then evaluates all of the FORMS in textual order. The `let'-form returns the value of the last form in FORMS. @@ -288,7 +288,7 @@ binding. evaluating VALUE-FORM. If VALUE-FORM is omitted, `nil' is used. All of the VALUE-FORMs in BINDINGS are evaluated in the order they - appear and *before* any of the symbols are bound. Here is an + appear and _before_ any of the symbols are bound. Here is an example of this: `Z' is bound to the old value of `Y', which is 2, not the new value, 1. @@ -299,7 +299,7 @@ binding. (list Y Z)) => (1 2) - - Special Form: let* (BINDINGS...) FORMS... + - Special Form: let* (bindings...) forms... This special form is like `let', but it binds each variable right after computing its local value, before computing the local value for the next variable. Therefore, an expression in BINDINGS can @@ -317,21 +317,21 @@ binding. Here is a complete list of the other facilities that create local bindings: - * Function calls (*note Functions::.). + * Function calls (*note Functions::). - * Macro calls (*note Macros::.). + * Macro calls (*note Macros::). - * `condition-case' (*note Errors::.). + * `condition-case' (*note Errors::). Variables can also have buffer-local bindings (*note Buffer-Local -Variables::.). These kinds of bindings work somewhat like ordinary -local bindings, but they are localized depending on "where" you are in -Emacs, rather than localized in time. +Variables::). These kinds of bindings work somewhat like ordinary local +bindings, but they are localized depending on "where" you are in Emacs, +rather than localized in time. - Variable: max-specpdl-size This variable defines the limit on the total number of local variable bindings and `unwind-protect' cleanups (*note Nonlocal - Exits::.) that are allowed before signaling an error (with data + Exits::) that are allowed before signaling an error (with data `"Variable binding depth exceeds max-specpdl-size"'). This limit, with the associated error when it is exceeded, is one @@ -356,13 +356,13 @@ value. Note that a value of `nil' is not the same as void. The symbol `nil' is a Lisp object and can be the value of a variable just as any -other object can be; but it is *a value*. A void variable does not +other object can be; but it is _a value_. A void variable does not have any value. After you have given a variable a value, you can make it void once more using `makunbound'. - - Function: makunbound SYMBOL + - Function: makunbound symbol This function makes the current binding of SYMBOL void. Subsequent attempts to use this symbol's value as a variable will signal the error `void-variable', unless or until you set it again. @@ -390,7 +390,6 @@ more using `makunbound'. (makunbound 'x) ; Void the local binding. x) error--> Symbol's value as variable is void: x - x ; The global binding is unchanged. => 1 @@ -399,7 +398,7 @@ more using `makunbound'. (makunbound 'x) ; Void the innermost-local binding. x)) ; And refer: it's void. error--> Symbol's value as variable is void: x - + (let ((x 2)) (let ((x 3)) (makunbound 'x)) ; Void inner binding, then remove it. @@ -413,24 +412,20 @@ always been void. You can use the function `boundp' to test whether a variable is currently void. - - Function: boundp VARIABLE + - Function: boundp variable `boundp' returns `t' if VARIABLE (a symbol) is not void; more precisely, if its current binding is not void. It returns `nil' otherwise. (boundp 'abracadabra) ; Starts out void. => nil - (let ((abracadabra 5)) ; Locally bind it. (boundp 'abracadabra)) => t - (boundp 'abracadabra) ; Still globally void. => nil - (setq abracadabra 5) ; Make it globally nonvoid. => 5 - (boundp 'abracadabra) => t @@ -445,7 +440,7 @@ with a "variable definition": a special form, either `defconst' or `defvar'. In XEmacs Lisp, definitions serve three purposes. First, they inform -people who read the code that certain symbols are *intended* to be used +people who read the code that certain symbols are _intended_ to be used a certain way (as variables). Second, they inform the Lisp system of these things, supplying a value and documentation. Third, they provide information to utilities such as `etags' and `make-docfile', which @@ -467,7 +462,7 @@ Users would like to be able to set user options in their init files, and override the default values given in the definitions. For this reason, user options must be defined with `defvar'. - - Special Form: defvar SYMBOL [VALUE [DOC-STRING]] + - Special Form: defvar symbol [value [doc-string]] This special form defines SYMBOL as a value and initializes it. The definition informs a person reading your code that SYMBOL is used as a variable that programs are likely to set or change. It @@ -495,7 +490,7 @@ reason, user options must be defined with `defvar'. for the variable. (This opportunity to specify documentation is one of the main benefits of defining the variable.) The documentation is stored in the symbol's `variable-documentation' - property. The XEmacs help functions (*note Documentation::.) look + property. The XEmacs help functions (*note Documentation::) look for this property. If the first character of DOC-STRING is `*', it means that this @@ -539,7 +534,7 @@ reason, user options must be defined with `defvar'. The `defvar' form returns SYMBOL, but it is normally used at top level in a file where its value does not matter. - - Special Form: defconst SYMBOL [VALUE [DOC-STRING]] + - Special Form: defconst symbol [value [doc-string]] This special form defines SYMBOL as a value and initializes it. It informs a person reading your code that SYMBOL has a global value, established here, that will not normally be changed or @@ -570,7 +565,7 @@ reason, user options must be defined with `defvar'. pi => 3 - - Function: user-variable-p VARIABLE + - Function: user-variable-p variable This function returns `t' if VARIABLE is a user option--a variable intended to be set by the user for customization--and `nil' otherwise. (Variables other than user options exist for the @@ -601,12 +596,12 @@ Accessing Variable Values ========================= The usual way to reference a variable is to write the symbol which -names it (*note Symbol Forms::.). This requires you to specify the +names it (*note Symbol Forms::). This requires you to specify the variable name when you write the program. Usually that is exactly what you want to do. Occasionally you need to choose at run time which variable to reference; then you can use `symbol-value'. - - Function: symbol-value SYMBOL + - Function: symbol-value symbol This function returns the value of SYMBOL. This is the value in the innermost local binding of the symbol, or its global value if it has no local bindings. @@ -645,7 +640,7 @@ How to Alter a Variable Value form `setq'. When you need to compute the choice of variable at run time, use the function `set'. - - Special Form: setq [SYMBOL FORM]... + - Special Form: setq [symbol form]... This special form is the most common method of changing a variable's value. Each SYMBOL is given a new value, which is the result of evaluating the corresponding FORM. The most-local @@ -676,7 +671,7 @@ time, use the function `set'. y (1+ x)) ; the value of `y' is computed. => 11 - - Function: set SYMBOL VALUE + - Function: set symbol value This function sets SYMBOL's value to VALUE, then returns VALUE. Since `set' is a function, the expression written for SYMBOL is evaluated to obtain the symbol to set. @@ -725,7 +720,7 @@ time, use the function `set'. One other function for setting a variable is designed to add an element to a list if it is not already present in the list. - - Function: add-to-list SYMBOL ELEMENT + - Function: add-to-list symbol element This function sets the variable SYMBOL by consing ELEMENT onto the old value, if ELEMENT is not already a member of that value. It returns the resulting list, whether updated or not. The value of @@ -766,10 +761,10 @@ binding. The most recently established binding takes precedence over the others. Local bindings in XEmacs Lisp have "indefinite scope" and "dynamic -extent". "Scope" refers to *where* textually in the source code the +extent". "Scope" refers to _where_ textually in the source code the binding can be accessed. Indefinite scope means that any part of the program can potentially access the variable binding. "Extent" refers -to *when*, as the program is executing, the binding exists. Dynamic +to _when_, as the program is executing, the binding exists. Dynamic extent means that the binding lasts as long as the activation of the construct that established it. @@ -822,7 +817,7 @@ established in `binder', depending on circumstances: (user)) * If we define `foo' as follows and call `binder', then the binding - made in `binder' *will not* be seen in `user': + made in `binder' _will not_ be seen in `user': (defun foo (x) (user)) @@ -1017,7 +1012,7 @@ File: lispref.info, Node: Creating Buffer-Local, Next: Default Value, Prev: I Creating and Deleting Buffer-Local Bindings ------------------------------------------- - - Command: make-local-variable VARIABLE + - Command: make-local-variable variable This function creates a buffer-local binding in the current buffer for VARIABLE (a symbol). Other buffers are not affected. The value returned is VARIABLE. @@ -1051,21 +1046,21 @@ Creating and Deleting Buffer-Local Bindings *Please note:* do not use `make-local-variable' for a hook variable. Instead, use `make-local-hook'. *Note Hooks::. - - Command: make-variable-buffer-local VARIABLE + - Command: make-variable-buffer-local variable This function marks VARIABLE (a symbol) automatically buffer-local, so that any subsequent attempt to set it will make it local to the current buffer at the time. The value returned is VARIABLE. - - Function: local-variable-p VARIABLE &optional BUFFER + - Function: local-variable-p variable &optional buffer This returns `t' if VARIABLE is buffer-local in buffer BUFFER (which defaults to the current buffer); otherwise, `nil'. - - Function: buffer-local-variables &optional BUFFER + - Function: buffer-local-variables &optional buffer This function returns a list describing the buffer-local variables in buffer BUFFER. It returns an association list (*note - Association Lists::.) in which each association contains one + Association Lists::) in which each association contains one buffer-local variable and its value. When a buffer-local variable is void in BUFFER, then it appears directly in the resulting list. If BUFFER is omitted, the current buffer is used. @@ -1087,9 +1082,9 @@ Creating and Deleting Buffer-Local Bindings (bind-me . 69)) Note that storing new values into the CDRs of cons cells in this - list does *not* change the local values of the variables. + list does _not_ change the local values of the variables. - - Command: kill-local-variable VARIABLE + - Command: kill-local-variable variable This function deletes the buffer-local binding (if any) for VARIABLE (a symbol) in the current buffer. As a result, the global (default) binding of VARIABLE becomes visible in this @@ -1151,13 +1146,13 @@ buffer-local value for this variable. The special forms `defvar' and `defconst' also set the default value (if they set the variable at all), rather than any local value. - - Function: default-value SYMBOL + - Function: default-value symbol This function returns SYMBOL's default value. This is the value that is seen in buffers that do not have their own values for this variable. If SYMBOL is not buffer-local, this is equivalent to - `symbol-value' (*note Accessing Variables::.). + `symbol-value' (*note Accessing Variables::). - - Function: default-boundp SYMBOL + - Function: default-boundp symbol The function `default-boundp' tells you whether SYMBOL's default value is nonvoid. If `(default-boundp 'foo)' returns `nil', then `(default-value 'foo)' would get an error. @@ -1165,7 +1160,7 @@ buffer-local value for this variable. `default-boundp' is to `default-value' as `boundp' is to `symbol-value'. - - Special Form: setq-default SYMBOL VALUE + - Special Form: setq-default symbol value This sets the default value of SYMBOL to VALUE. It does not evaluate SYMBOL, but does evaluate VALUE. The value of the `setq-default' form is VALUE. @@ -1205,7 +1200,7 @@ buffer-local value for this variable. (default-value 'local) => another-default - - Function: set-default SYMBOL VALUE + - Function: set-default symbol value This function is like `setq-default', except that SYMBOL is evaluated. diff --git a/info/new-users-guide.info b/info/new-users-guide.info index ced6a25..32e78d1 100644 --- a/info/new-users-guide.info +++ b/info/new-users-guide.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/new-users-guide.info, produced by Makeinfo -version 1.68 from the input file new-users-guide.texi. +This is ../info/new-users-guide.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 +from new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -18,59 +18,59 @@ preserved on all copies.  Indirect: -new-users-guide.info-1: 648 -new-users-guide.info-2: 50484 -new-users-guide.info-3: 99987 +new-users-guide.info-1: 635 +new-users-guide.info-2: 50471 +new-users-guide.info-3: 99973  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top648 -Node: Intro4626 -Node: Entering7209 -Node: Enter8723 -Node: Frame9405 -Node: Exiting11074 -Node: Mode Line12274 -Node: Echo Area14421 -Node: Windows and Menus15776 -Node: XEmacs Window16229 -Node: Pull-down Menus19850 -Node: File menu20729 -Node: Edit menu23988 -Node: Options Menu26515 -Node: Buffers Menu31297 -Node: Help menu31683 -Node: Edit32181 -Node: Insert33775 -Node: Cursor Position35103 -Node: Erase37174 -Node: Numeric Argument38328 -Node: Undo39512 -Node: Customization Basics40275 -Node: Customizing key Bindings41504 -Node: Customizing Menus44994 -Node: Help50484 -Node: The Help Menu51172 -Node: Modes56097 -Node: Major Modes57013 -Node: Minor Modes60962 -Node: Files65048 -Node: File Names65770 -Node: Visiting67573 -Node: Saving Files69697 -Node: Other Customizations73075 -Node: Setting Variables75544 -Node: Init File78753 -Node: Select and Move84222 -Node: Selecting Text85176 -Node: Mouse86689 -Node: Region Operation88014 -Node: Moving Text89274 -Node: Accumulating text90514 -Node: Search and Replace92834 -Node: Key Index96698 -Node: Command Index99987 -Node: Variable Index104089 -Node: Concept Index104666 +Node: Top635 +Node: Intro4615 +Node: Entering7198 +Node: Enter8712 +Node: Frame9394 +Node: Exiting11063 +Node: Mode Line12263 +Node: Echo Area14410 +Node: Windows and Menus15765 +Node: XEmacs Window16218 +Node: Pull-down Menus19839 +Node: File menu20718 +Node: Edit menu23977 +Node: Options Menu26503 +Node: Buffers Menu31285 +Node: Help menu31671 +Node: Edit32169 +Node: Insert33763 +Node: Cursor Position35091 +Node: Erase37162 +Node: Numeric Argument38316 +Node: Undo39500 +Node: Customization Basics40263 +Node: Customizing key Bindings41492 +Node: Customizing Menus44982 +Node: Help50471 +Node: The Help Menu51159 +Node: Modes56084 +Node: Major Modes57000 +Node: Minor Modes60949 +Node: Files65035 +Node: File Names65757 +Node: Visiting67560 +Node: Saving Files69684 +Node: Other Customizations73061 +Node: Setting Variables75529 +Node: Init File78738 +Node: Select and Move84208 +Node: Selecting Text85162 +Node: Mouse86675 +Node: Region Operation88000 +Node: Moving Text89260 +Node: Accumulating text90500 +Node: Search and Replace92820 +Node: Key Index96684 +Node: Command Index99973 +Node: Variable Index104075 +Node: Concept Index104652  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/standards.info b/info/standards.info index edaa2b5..6ecf2d6 100644 --- a/info/standards.info +++ b/info/standards.info @@ -1,12 +1,12 @@ -This is Info file ../info/standards.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file standards.texi. +This is ../info/standards.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +standards.texi. START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY * Standards: (standards). GNU coding standards. END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY - GNU Coding Standards Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996 Free -Software Foundation, Inc. + GNU Coding Standards Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, +1997, 1998, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are @@ -24,52 +24,62 @@ translation approved by the Free Software Foundation.  Indirect: -standards.info-1: 982 -standards.info-2: 49841 -standards.info-3: 95838 +standards.info-1: 974 +standards.info-2: 48769 +standards.info-3: 97946  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top982 -Node: Preface1491 -Node: Intellectual Property2529 -Node: Reading Non-Free Code2885 -Node: Contributions4617 -Node: Design Advice6215 -Node: Compatibility6698 -Node: Using Extensions8342 -Node: ANSI C9844 -Node: Source Language11080 -Node: Program Behavior12214 -Node: Semantics12806 -Node: Libraries16560 -Node: Errors17795 -Node: User Interfaces19018 -Node: Memory Usage36043 -Node: Writing C37040 -Node: Formatting37750 -Node: Comments41022 -Node: Syntactic Conventions43815 -Node: Names46753 -Node: System Portability48065 -Node: CPU Portability49841 -Node: System Functions52002 -Node: Internationalization56903 -Node: Documentation59104 -Node: GNU Manuals59648 -Node: Manual Structure Details61690 -Node: NEWS File63095 -Node: Change Logs63776 -Node: Man Pages67978 -Node: Reading other Manuals69597 -Node: Managing Releases70381 -Node: Configuration71087 -Node: Makefile Conventions78027 -Node: Makefile Basics78551 -Node: Utilities in Makefiles81022 -Node: Command Variables82896 -Node: Directory Variables85732 -Node: Standard Targets95838 -Node: Releases105580 +Node: Top974 +Node: Preface1565 +Node: Legal Issues2582 +Node: Reading Non-Free Code2948 +Node: Contributions4671 +Node: Design Advice6801 +Node: Compatibility7309 +Node: Using Extensions8820 +Node: ANSI C10322 +Node: Source Language12445 +Node: Program Behavior13938 +Node: Semantics14647 +Node: Libraries18964 +Node: Errors20199 +Node: User Interfaces21975 +Node: Option Table28852 +Node: Memory Usage43662 +Node: Writing C44656 +Node: Formatting45497 +Node: Comments48769 +Node: Syntactic Conventions52067 +Node: Names55005 +Node: System Portability56939 +Node: CPU Portability58536 +Node: System Functions60793 +Node: Internationalization65897 +Node: Mmap69045 +Node: Documentation69750 +Node: GNU Manuals70385 +Node: Manual Structure Details74633 +Node: License for Manuals75966 +Node: NEWS File76550 +Node: Change Logs77226 +Node: Change Log Concepts77943 +Node: Style of Change Logs79798 +Node: Simple Changes81352 +Node: Conditional Changes82543 +Node: Man Pages83920 +Node: Reading other Manuals85539 +Node: Managing Releases86323 +Node: Configuration87078 +Node: Makefile Conventions94018 +Node: Makefile Basics94777 +Node: Utilities in Makefiles97946 +Node: Command Variables100082 +Node: Directory Variables103583 +Node: Standard Targets114460 +Ref: Standard Targets-Footnote-1124899 +Node: Install Command Categories124999 +Node: Releases129572 +Node: References133655  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/term.info b/info/term.info index e81567a..1f84f9e 100644 --- a/info/term.info +++ b/info/term.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/term.info, produced by Makeinfo version 1.68 -from the input file term.texi. +This is ../info/term.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +term.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -142,7 +142,7 @@ screen state to what it was before the program started. Many people are used to this behavior from `xterm', and its also offered by the `term' emulator. - - Function: term-switch-to-alternate-sub-buffer SET + - Function: term-switch-to-alternate-sub-buffer set If SET is true, and we're not already using the alternate sub-buffer, switch to it. What this means is that the `term-home-marker' is saved (in the variable @@ -238,7 +238,7 @@ of output (since the last input sent to the inferior). It will enter "pager" mode, which feels a lot like the "more" program: Typing a space requests another screenful of output. Other commands request more or less output, or scroll backwards in the `term' buffer. In -pager mode, type `h' or `?' to display a help message listing all the +pager mode, type `h' or `?' to display a help message listing all the available pager mode commands. In either character or line mode, type `C-c p' to enable paging, and @@ -421,21 +421,21 @@ Miscellaneous escapes  Tag Table: -Node: Top227 -Node: term mode393 -Node: Overview1216 -Node: Output from the inferior1966 -Node: subbuffer3546 -Node: altsubbuffer4869 -Node: Input to the inferior5894 -Node: Connecting to remote computers7414 -Node: Paging9319 -Node: Terminal escapes9989 -Node: Cursor motion10857 -Node: Erasing11517 -Node: Inserting and deleting12312 -Node: Scrolling12702 -Node: Command hook13148 -Node: Miscellaneous escapes14184 +Node: Top201 +Node: term mode367 +Node: Overview1190 +Node: Output from the inferior1940 +Node: subbuffer3520 +Node: altsubbuffer4843 +Node: Input to the inferior5868 +Node: Connecting to remote computers7388 +Node: Paging9293 +Node: Terminal escapes9962 +Node: Cursor motion10830 +Node: Erasing11490 +Node: Inserting and deleting12285 +Node: Scrolling12675 +Node: Command hook13121 +Node: Miscellaneous escapes14157  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/termcap.info b/info/termcap.info index fefb70c..5bbede1 100644 --- a/info/termcap.info +++ b/info/termcap.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/termcap.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file termcap.texi. +This is ../info/termcap.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +termcap.texi. START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY * Termcap: (termcap). Termcap library of the GNU system. @@ -25,57 +25,57 @@ translation approved by the Foundation.  Indirect: -termcap.info-1: 985 -termcap.info-2: 49255 -termcap.info-3: 92578 +termcap.info-1: 959 +termcap.info-2: 49216 +termcap.info-3: 92525  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top985 -Node: Introduction1630 -Node: Library3357 -Node: Preparation4374 -Node: Find5573 -Node: Interrogate9121 -Node: Initialize14429 -Node: Padding16069 -Node: Why Pad16730 -Node: Describe Padding18374 -Node: Output Padding19849 -Node: Parameters23464 -Node: Encode Parameters25123 -Node: Using Parameters31228 -Node: tparam31817 -Node: tgoto33882 -Node: Data Base36437 -Node: Format37315 -Node: Capability Format39406 -Node: Naming42459 -Node: Inheriting47028 -Node: Capabilities49255 -Node: Basic52097 -Node: Screen Size55941 -Node: Cursor Motion57681 -Node: Wrapping67338 -Node: Scrolling70163 -Node: Windows75183 -Node: Clearing75917 -Node: Insdel Line77681 -Node: Insdel Char82593 -Node: Standout92578 -Node: Underlining101637 -Node: Cursor Visibility104056 -Node: Bell104804 -Node: Keypad105353 -Node: Meta Key110074 -Node: Initialization111028 -Node: Pad Specs113392 -Node: Status Line115445 -Node: Half-Line117329 -Node: Printer118131 -Node: Summary119810 -Node: Var Index130016 -Node: Cap Index130740 -Node: Index137931 +Node: Top959 +Node: Introduction1604 +Node: Library3331 +Node: Preparation4348 +Node: Find5547 +Node: Interrogate9094 +Node: Initialize14401 +Node: Padding16039 +Node: Why Pad16700 +Node: Describe Padding18344 +Node: Output Padding19819 +Node: Parameters23432 +Node: Encode Parameters25090 +Node: Using Parameters31195 +Node: tparam31784 +Node: tgoto33849 +Node: Data Base36404 +Node: Format37281 +Node: Capability Format39372 +Node: Naming42422 +Node: Inheriting46990 +Node: Capabilities49216 +Node: Basic52059 +Node: Screen Size55903 +Node: Cursor Motion57643 +Node: Wrapping67293 +Node: Scrolling70117 +Node: Windows75137 +Node: Clearing75871 +Node: Insdel Line77635 +Node: Insdel Char82541 +Node: Standout92525 +Node: Underlining101582 +Node: Cursor Visibility104001 +Node: Bell104749 +Node: Keypad105298 +Node: Meta Key110019 +Node: Initialization110973 +Node: Pad Specs113337 +Node: Status Line115390 +Node: Half-Line117274 +Node: Printer118076 +Node: Summary119755 +Node: Var Index129960 +Node: Cap Index130684 +Node: Index137875  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/texinfo.info b/info/texinfo.info index 2986f92..76cc769 100644 --- a/info/texinfo.info +++ b/info/texinfo.info @@ -1,22 +1,22 @@ -This is Info file ../info/texinfo.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file texinfo.texi. +This is ../info/texinfo.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +texinfo.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION Texinfo documentation system START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY * Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format. -* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Updating info/dir entries. -* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Printing Texinfo documentation. -* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sorting Texinfo index files. +* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Update info/dir entries. +* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Print Texinfo documents. +* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sort Texinfo index files. * makeinfo: (texinfo)makeinfo Preferred. Translate Texinfo source. END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY This file documents Texinfo, a documentation system that can produce -both on-line information and a printed manual from a single source file. +both online information and a printed manual from a single source file. - Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98 Free Software + Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - This edition is for Texinfo version 3.12. + This edition is for Texinfo version 4.0, 28 September 1999. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are @@ -34,306 +34,339 @@ translation approved by the Free Software Foundation.  Indirect: -texinfo.info-1: 1510 -texinfo.info-2: 48723 -texinfo.info-3: 96698 -texinfo.info-4: 146082 -texinfo.info-5: 196057 -texinfo.info-6: 245140 -texinfo.info-7: 294058 -texinfo.info-8: 343872 -texinfo.info-9: 393199 -texinfo.info-10: 435577 -texinfo.info-11: 481692 -texinfo.info-12: 519851 +texinfo.info-1: 1493 +texinfo.info-2: 49439 +texinfo.info-3: 98206 +texinfo.info-4: 148178 +texinfo.info-5: 197140 +texinfo.info-6: 246982 +texinfo.info-7: 296539 +texinfo.info-8: 346362 +texinfo.info-9: 395696 +texinfo.info-10: 438701 +texinfo.info-11: 479038 +texinfo.info-12: 525104 +texinfo.info-13: 564169  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top1510 -Node: Copying23823 -Node: Overview25828 -Node: Overview-Footnotes27256 -Node: Using Texinfo27792 -Node: Info Files30275 -Node: Info Files-Footnotes34310 -Node: Printed Books34557 -Node: Printed Books-Footnotes37228 -Node: Formatting Commands37512 -Node: Formatting Commands-Footnotes40338 -Node: Conventions41040 -Node: Comments43602 -Node: Minimum45025 -Node: Six Parts47211 -Node: Short Sample48723 -Node: Acknowledgements52858 -Node: Texinfo Mode53693 -Node: Texinfo Mode Overview55065 -Node: Emacs Editing55841 -Node: Inserting57971 -Node: Showing the Structure62252 -Node: Updating Nodes and Menus64779 -Node: Updating Commands65852 -Node: Updating Requirements71913 -Node: Other Updating Commands74210 -Node: Info Formatting77478 -Node: Printing78736 -Node: Texinfo Mode Summary81082 -Node: Beginning a File85836 -Node: Four Parts86727 -Node: Sample Beginning88197 -Node: Header89817 -Node: First Line91169 -Node: Start of Header92158 -Node: setfilename92872 -Node: settitle94808 -Node: setchapternewpage96698 -Node: paragraphindent99459 -Node: End of Header100941 -Node: Info Summary and Permissions101780 -Node: Titlepage & Copyright Page102799 -Node: titlepage104405 -Node: titlepage-Footnotes106686 -Node: titlefont center sp107026 -Node: title subtitle author108252 -Node: Copyright & Permissions110524 -Node: end titlepage112525 -Node: headings on off114231 -Node: The Top Node116276 -Node: Title of Top Node117431 -Node: Master Menu Parts118684 -Node: Software Copying Permissions120921 -Node: Ending a File122089 -Node: Printing Indices & Menus122937 -Node: Contents125239 -Node: File End127579 -Node: Structuring128252 -Node: Tree Structuring129910 -Node: Structuring Command Types131353 -Node: makeinfo top133679 -Node: chapter134212 -Node: unnumbered & appendix135236 -Node: majorheading & chapheading136075 -Node: section136896 -Node: unnumberedsec appendixsec heading137660 -Node: subsection138649 -Node: unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading139221 -Node: subsubsection140174 -Node: Raise/lower sections141724 -Node: Nodes143859 -Node: Two Paths144796 -Node: Node Menu Illustration146082 -Node: node149777 -Node: Node Names152473 -Node: Writing a Node153549 -Node: Node Line Tips155567 -Node: Node Line Requirements156361 -Node: First Node157962 -Node: makeinfo top command159408 -Node: Top Node Summary160587 -Node: makeinfo Pointer Creation162037 -Node: Menus163284 -Node: Menus-Footnotes164222 -Node: Menu Location164573 -Node: Writing a Menu166250 -Node: Menu Parts167216 -Node: Less Cluttered Menu Entry168374 -Node: Menu Example168999 -Node: Other Info Files170520 -Node: Cross References172376 -Node: References173333 -Node: Cross Reference Commands175080 -Node: Cross Reference Parts176139 -Node: xref178975 -Node: Reference Syntax179774 -Node: One Argument181429 -Node: Two Arguments182441 -Node: Three Arguments183556 -Node: Four and Five Arguments185947 -Node: Top Node Naming188359 -Node: ref189369 -Node: pxref190759 -Node: inforef193141 -Node: uref194434 -Node: Marking Text195433 -Node: Indicating196057 -Node: Useful Highlighting197962 -Node: code199351 -Node: kbd202389 -Node: key204259 -Node: samp205592 -Node: var207179 -Node: file208972 -Node: dfn209579 -Node: cite210489 -Node: url210943 -Node: email211507 -Node: Emphasis212319 -Node: emph & strong213219 -Node: Smallcaps214205 -Node: Fonts215532 -Node: Customized Highlighting216620 -Node: Customized Highlighting-Footnotes219434 -Node: Quotations and Examples219654 -Node: Block Enclosing Commands221276 -Node: quotation223301 -Node: example224391 -Node: noindent226446 -Node: Lisp Example227911 -Node: Lisp Example-Footnotes228612 -Node: smallexample & smalllisp228802 -Node: display230827 -Node: format231459 -Node: exdent231920 -Node: flushleft & flushright233000 -Node: cartouche234266 -Node: Lists and Tables235033 -Node: Introducing Lists235709 -Node: itemize237371 -Node: enumerate239518 -Node: Two-column Tables242017 -Node: table242706 -Node: ftable vtable245140 -Node: itemx246241 -Node: Multi-column Tables247252 -Node: Multitable Column Widths247923 -Node: Multitable Rows249377 -Node: Indices251250 -Node: Index Entries252401 -Node: Predefined Indices253534 -Node: Indexing Commands254531 -Node: Combining Indices259072 -Node: syncodeindex260435 -Node: synindex262097 -Node: New Indices262622 -Node: Insertions264448 -Node: Braces Atsigns265632 -Node: Inserting An Atsign266184 -Node: Inserting Braces266458 -Node: Inserting Space266821 -Node: Not Ending a Sentence267325 -Node: Ending a Sentence268679 -Node: Multiple Spaces269808 -Node: dmn271028 -Node: Inserting Accents272236 -Node: Dots Bullets274212 -Node: dots275035 -Node: bullet275559 -Node: TeX and copyright275956 -Node: tex276523 -Node: copyright symbol276939 -Node: pounds277199 -Node: minus277563 -Node: math278485 -Node: Glyphs279214 -Node: Glyphs Summary280327 -Node: result280955 -Node: expansion281440 -Node: Print Glyph282396 -Node: Error Glyph283273 -Node: Equivalence284106 -Node: Point Glyph284794 -Node: Images286351 -Node: Breaks288018 -Node: Break Commands289449 -Node: Line Breaks290290 -Node: - and hyphenation291308 -Node: w292559 -Node: sp293272 -Node: page293681 -Node: group294058 -Node: need295801 -Node: Definition Commands296531 -Node: Def Cmd Template298102 -Node: Optional Arguments301099 -Node: deffnx302687 -Node: Def Cmds in Detail303642 -Node: Functions Commands304752 -Node: Variables Commands307757 -Node: Typed Functions309843 -Node: Typed Variables313385 -Node: Abstract Objects315368 -Node: Data Types320593 -Node: Def Cmd Conventions321848 -Node: Sample Function Definition322411 -Node: Footnotes325295 -Node: Footnotes-Footnotes325682 -Node: Footnote Commands326028 -Node: Footnote Commands-Footnotes327524 -Node: Footnote Styles327642 -Node: Conditionals330228 -Node: Conditional Commands331039 -Node: Conditional Not Commands332532 -Node: Raw Formatter Commands333277 -Node: set clear value335107 -Node: ifset ifclear335908 -Node: value339087 -Node: value Example340499 -Node: Macros342077 -Node: Defining Macros342783 -Node: Invoking Macros343872 -Node: Format/Print Hardcopy344978 -Node: Use TeX346815 -Node: Format with tex/texindex347443 -Node: Format with texi2dvi351086 -Node: Print with lpr351677 -Node: Within Emacs352531 -Node: Texinfo Mode Printing353450 -Node: Compile-Command356860 -Node: Requirements Summary357748 -Node: Preparing for TeX359061 -Node: Overfull hboxes361850 -Node: smallbook363409 -Node: A4 Paper364929 -Node: Cropmarks and Magnification366155 -Node: Create an Info File368097 -Node: makeinfo advantages369400 -Node: Invoking makeinfo370316 -Node: makeinfo options371004 -Node: Pointer Validation376493 -Node: makeinfo in Emacs377837 -Node: texinfo-format commands380395 -Node: Batch Formatting381667 -Node: Tag and Split Files382883 -Node: Install an Info File386237 -Node: Directory file387055 -Node: New Info File388923 -Node: Other Info Directories389984 -Node: Installing Dir Entries393199 -Node: Invoking install-info395192 -Node: Command List397607 -Node: Tips435577 -Node: Sample Texinfo File446987 -Node: Sample Permissions449105 -Node: Inserting Permissions450148 -Node: ifinfo Permissions452454 -Node: Titlepage Permissions454075 -Node: Include Files455337 -Node: Using Include Files456424 -Node: texinfo-multiple-files-update458379 -Node: Include File Requirements460740 -Node: Sample Include File461985 -Node: Include Files Evolution463504 -Node: Headings465475 -Node: Headings Introduced466112 -Node: Heading Format468000 -Node: Heading Choice470452 -Node: Custom Headings471824 -Node: Catching Mistakes476152 -Node: makeinfo Preferred477441 -Node: Debugging with Info478346 -Node: Debugging with TeX481692 -Node: Using texinfo-show-structure485973 -Node: Using occur489072 -Node: Running Info-Validate490609 -Node: Using Info-validate491670 -Node: Unsplit493512 -Node: Tagifying494558 -Node: Splitting495410 -Node: Refilling Paragraphs497026 -Node: Refilling Paragraphs-Footnotes498679 -Node: Command Syntax498930 -Node: Obtaining TeX501887 -Node: Command and Variable Index503999 -Node: Concept Index519851 +Node: Top1493 +Node: Copying24618 +Node: Overview26623 +Node: Overview-Footnotes27894 +Ref: Overview-Footnote-127958 +Node: Reporting Bugs28415 +Node: Using Texinfo29914 +Node: Info Files33728 +Node: Info Files-Footnotes38125 +Ref: Info Files-Footnote-138193 +Node: Printed Books38372 +Node: Printed Books-Footnotes41154 +Ref: Printed Books-Footnote-141228 +Node: Formatting Commands41562 +Node: Formatting Commands-Footnotes44559 +Ref: Formatting Commands-Footnote-144645 +Node: Conventions45253 +Node: Comments48014 +Node: Minimum49439 +Node: Six Parts51633 +Node: Short Sample53145 +Node: Acknowledgements and History57226 +Node: Texinfo Mode59241 +Node: Texinfo Mode Overview60613 +Node: Emacs Editing61398 +Node: Inserting63536 +Node: Showing the Structure67817 +Node: Updating Nodes and Menus70132 +Node: Updating Commands71205 +Node: Updating Requirements77249 +Node: Other Updating Commands79530 +Node: Info Formatting82786 +Node: Printing84046 +Node: Texinfo Mode Summary86378 +Node: Beginning a File91134 +Node: Four Parts92025 +Node: Sample Beginning93495 +Node: Header95115 +Node: First Line96519 +Node: Start of Header97493 +Node: setfilename98206 +Node: settitle100557 +Node: setchapternewpage102447 +Node: paragraphindent105299 +Node: exampleindent106606 +Node: End of Header107671 +Node: Info Summary and Permissions108508 +Node: Titlepage & Copyright Page109527 +Node: titlepage111380 +Node: titlepage-Footnotes113916 +Ref: titlepage-Footnote-1113982 +Node: titlefont center sp114256 +Node: title subtitle author115559 +Node: Copyright & Permissions118254 +Node: end titlepage120245 +Node: headings on off121951 +Node: The Top Node124011 +Node: Title of Top Node125166 +Node: Master Menu Parts126402 +Node: Software Copying Permissions128639 +Node: Ending a File129807 +Node: Printing Indices & Menus130662 +Node: Contents133010 +Node: File End136308 +Node: Structuring136981 +Node: Tree Structuring138638 +Node: Structuring Command Types140061 +Node: makeinfo top142383 +Node: chapter143163 +Node: unnumbered & appendix144187 +Node: majorheading & chapheading145032 +Node: section145853 +Node: unnumberedsec appendixsec heading146617 +Node: subsection147606 +Node: unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading148178 +Node: subsubsection149131 +Node: Raise/lower sections150681 +Node: Nodes152816 +Node: Two Paths153824 +Node: Node Menu Illustration155154 +Node: node158966 +Node: Node Names161787 +Node: Writing a Node163154 +Node: Node Line Tips165190 +Node: Node Line Requirements165984 +Node: First Node167765 +Node: makeinfo top command169209 +Node: Top Node Summary170388 +Node: makeinfo Pointer Creation171838 +Node: anchor172947 +Node: Menus174417 +Node: Menus-Footnotes175570 +Ref: Menus-Footnote-1175628 +Node: Menu Location175921 +Node: Writing a Menu177281 +Node: Menu Parts178344 +Node: Less Cluttered Menu Entry179502 +Node: Menu Example180127 +Node: Other Info Files181648 +Node: Cross References183494 +Node: References184463 +Node: Cross Reference Commands186254 +Node: Cross Reference Parts187313 +Node: xref190163 +Node: Reference Syntax190962 +Node: One Argument192616 +Node: Two Arguments193633 +Node: Three Arguments194748 +Node: Four and Five Arguments197140 +Node: Top Node Naming199552 +Node: ref200562 +Node: pxref201978 +Node: inforef204360 +Node: uref205653 +Node: Marking Text207875 +Node: Indicating208526 +Node: Useful Highlighting210622 +Node: code212245 +Node: kbd215477 +Node: key217348 +Node: samp218681 +Node: var220151 +Node: env222115 +Node: file222678 +Node: command223289 +Node: option223983 +Node: dfn224491 +Node: cite225403 +Node: acronym225859 +Node: url226412 +Node: email227058 +Node: Emphasis227872 +Node: emph & strong228703 +Node: Smallcaps229702 +Node: Fonts231326 +Node: Quotations and Examples232382 +Node: Block Enclosing Commands233993 +Node: quotation235893 +Node: example236983 +Node: noindent238982 +Node: lisp240438 +Node: lisp-Footnotes241105 +Ref: lisp-Footnote-1241161 +Node: small241279 +Node: display243204 +Node: format243998 +Node: exdent244636 +Node: flushleft & flushright245716 +Node: cartouche246982 +Node: Lists and Tables247742 +Node: Introducing Lists248418 +Node: itemize250095 +Node: enumerate252370 +Node: Two-column Tables254903 +Node: table255592 +Node: ftable vtable258049 +Node: itemx259134 +Node: Multi-column Tables260145 +Node: Multitable Column Widths260816 +Node: Multitable Rows262283 +Node: Indices264059 +Node: Index Entries265191 +Node: Predefined Indices266324 +Node: Indexing Commands267321 +Node: Combining Indices271116 +Node: syncodeindex272479 +Node: synindex274141 +Node: New Indices274666 +Node: Insertions276491 +Node: Braces Atsigns277733 +Node: Inserting An Atsign278285 +Node: Inserting Braces278559 +Node: Inserting Space278922 +Node: Not Ending a Sentence279426 +Node: Ending a Sentence280742 +Node: Multiple Spaces281762 +Node: dmn282981 +Node: Inserting Accents284194 +Node: Dots Bullets285971 +Node: dots286779 +Node: bullet287330 +Node: TeX and copyright287727 +Node: tex288294 +Node: copyright symbol288684 +Node: pounds288944 +Node: minus289308 +Node: math290230 +Node: Glyphs290956 +Node: Glyphs Summary292072 +Node: result292700 +Node: expansion293185 +Node: Print Glyph294141 +Node: Error Glyph295018 +Node: Equivalence295851 +Node: Point Glyph296539 +Node: Footnotes298104 +Node: Footnotes-Footnotes298480 +Ref: Footnotes-Footnote-1298546 +Node: Footnote Commands298826 +Node: Footnote Commands-Footnotes300441 +Ref: Footnote Commands-Footnote-1300523 +Node: Footnote Styles300559 +Node: Images303129 +Node: Breaks305394 +Node: Break Commands306825 +Node: Line Breaks307658 +Node: - and hyphenation308676 +Node: w309926 +Node: sp310539 +Node: page310948 +Node: group311325 +Node: need313068 +Node: Definition Commands313798 +Node: Def Cmd Template315372 +Node: Optional Arguments318369 +Node: deffnx319957 +Node: Def Cmds in Detail320898 +Node: Functions Commands322008 +Node: Variables Commands325011 +Node: Typed Functions327094 +Node: Typed Variables330636 +Node: Abstract Objects332619 +Node: Data Types338447 +Node: Def Cmd Conventions339702 +Node: Sample Function Definition340265 +Node: Conditionals343134 +Node: Conditional Commands344239 +Node: Conditional Not Commands345584 +Node: Raw Formatter Commands346362 +Node: set clear value348195 +Node: ifset ifclear349002 +Node: set value352223 +Node: value Example353881 +Node: Internationalization355603 +Node: documentlanguage356135 +Node: documentencoding360438 +Node: Defining New Texinfo Commands361051 +Node: Defining Macros362220 +Node: Invoking Macros364355 +Node: Macro Details366056 +Node: alias367101 +Node: definfoenclose368300 +Node: Hardcopy371050 +Node: Use TeX373074 +Node: Format with tex/texindex373662 +Node: Format with texi2dvi378036 +Node: Print with lpr379477 +Node: Within Emacs381694 +Node: Texinfo Mode Printing382587 +Node: Compile-Command386345 +Node: Requirements Summary387219 +Node: Preparing for TeX388544 +Node: Preparing for TeX-Footnotes392166 +Ref: Preparing for TeX-Footnote-1392248 +Node: Overfull hboxes392347 +Node: smallbook394500 +Node: A4 Paper395696 +Node: pagesizes396588 +Node: Cropmarks and Magnification397773 +Node: PDF Output399832 +Node: Creating and Installing Info Files401043 +Node: Creating an Info File401427 +Node: makeinfo advantages402700 +Node: Invoking makeinfo403624 +Node: makeinfo options404298 +Node: Pointer Validation411542 +Node: makeinfo in Emacs414682 +Node: texinfo-format commands417234 +Node: Batch Formatting418507 +Node: Tag and Split Files419724 +Node: makeinfo html423134 +Node: Install an Info File425154 +Node: Directory File425984 +Node: New Info File427768 +Node: New Info File-Footnotes428867 +Ref: New Info File-Footnote-1428941 +Node: Other Info Directories429022 +Node: Other Info Directories-Footnotes433343 +Ref: Other Info Directories-Footnote-1433435 +Ref: Other Info Directories-Footnote-2433562 +Node: Installing Dir Entries433623 +Node: Invoking install-info435842 +Node: Command List438701 +Node: Tips479038 +Node: Sample Texinfo File490447 +Node: Sample Permissions492566 +Node: Inserting Permissions493608 +Node: ifinfo Permissions495904 +Node: Titlepage Permissions497525 +Node: Include Files498787 +Node: Using Include Files499874 +Node: texinfo-multiple-files-update501829 +Node: Include File Requirements504190 +Node: Sample Include File505435 +Node: Include Files Evolution506942 +Node: Headings508916 +Node: Headings Introduced509553 +Node: Heading Format511441 +Node: Heading Choice513893 +Node: Custom Headings515265 +Node: Catching Mistakes519564 +Node: makeinfo Preferred520853 +Node: Debugging with Info521758 +Node: Debugging with TeX525104 +Node: Using texinfo-show-structure529367 +Node: Using occur532463 +Node: Running Info-Validate533998 +Node: Using Info-validate535059 +Node: Unsplit536889 +Node: Tagifying537935 +Node: Splitting538787 +Node: Refilling Paragraphs540405 +Node: Refilling Paragraphs-Footnotes542059 +Ref: Refilling Paragraphs-Footnote-1542147 +Node: Command Syntax542310 +Node: Obtaining TeX545267 +Node: Command and Variable Index546309 +Node: Concept Index564169  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/texinfo.info-1 b/info/texinfo.info-1 index bc542dc..0d1e560 100644 --- a/info/texinfo.info-1 +++ b/info/texinfo.info-1 @@ -1,22 +1,22 @@ -This is Info file ../info/texinfo.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file texinfo.texi. +This is ../info/texinfo.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +texinfo.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION Texinfo documentation system START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY * Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format. -* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Updating info/dir entries. -* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Printing Texinfo documentation. -* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sorting Texinfo index files. +* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Update info/dir entries. +* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Print Texinfo documents. +* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sort Texinfo index files. * makeinfo: (texinfo)makeinfo Preferred. Translate Texinfo source. END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY This file documents Texinfo, a documentation system that can produce -both on-line information and a printed manual from a single source file. +both online information and a printed manual from a single source file. - Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98 Free Software + Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - This edition is for Texinfo version 3.12. + This edition is for Texinfo version 4.0, 28 September 1999. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are @@ -33,19 +33,19 @@ versions, except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved by the Free Software Foundation.  -File: texinfo.info, Node: Top, Next: Copying, Prev: (dir), Up: (dir) +File: texinfo.info, Node: Top, Next: Copying, Up: (dir) Texinfo ******* Texinfo is a documentation system that uses a single source file to -produce both on-line information and printed output. +produce both online information and printed output. The first part of this master menu lists the major nodes in this Info document, including the @-command and concept indices. The rest of the menu lists all the lower level nodes in the document. - This is Edition 3.12 of the Texinfo documentation, 27 February 1998. + This is Edition 4.0 of the Texinfo manual, updated 28 September 1999. * Menu: @@ -69,13 +69,12 @@ menu lists all the lower level nodes in the document. * Breaks:: How to force and prevent line and page breaks. * Definition Commands:: How to describe functions and the like in a uniform manner. -* Footnotes:: How to write footnotes. * Conditionals:: How to specify text for either TeX or Info. -* Macros:: Defining new Texinfo commands. -* Format/Print Hardcopy:: How to convert a Texinfo file to a file +* Internationalization:: +* Defining New Texinfo Commands:: +* Hardcopy:: How to convert a Texinfo file to a file for printing and how to print that file. -* Create an Info File:: Convert a Texinfo file into an Info file. -* Install an Info File:: Make an Info file accessible to users. +* Creating and Installing Info Files:: * Command List:: All the Texinfo @-commands. * Tips:: Hints on how to write a Texinfo document. * Sample Texinfo File:: A sample Texinfo file to look at. @@ -91,22 +90,21 @@ menu lists all the lower level nodes in the document. * Concept Index:: A menu covering many topics. - -- The Detailed Node Listing -- + --- The Detailed Node Listing --- Overview of Texinfo -* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book - or an Info file. +* Reporting Bugs:: Submitting effective bug reports. +* Using Texinfo:: Create printed or online output. * Info Files:: What is an Info file? * Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual. * Formatting Commands:: @-commands are used for formatting. * Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file. -* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that - the formatting commands will ignore. +* Comments:: Writing comments and ignored text in general. * Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have. * Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts. * Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file. -* Acknowledgements:: +* Acknowledgements and History:: Contributors and genesis. Using Texinfo Mode @@ -147,7 +145,8 @@ The Texinfo File Header * setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file. * settitle:: Create a title for the printed work. * setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages. -* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation. +* paragraphindent:: Specify paragraph indentation. +* exampleindent:: Specify environment indentation. * End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this. The Title and Copyright Pages @@ -196,8 +195,9 @@ Nodes * Two Paths:: Different commands to structure Info output and printed output. * Node Menu Illustration:: A diagram, and sample nodes and menus. -* node:: How to write a node, in detail. -* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: How to create node pointers with `makeinfo'. +* node:: Creating nodes, in detail. +* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: Letting makeinfo determine node pointers. +* anchor:: Defining arbitrary cross-reference targets. The `@node' Command @@ -246,23 +246,26 @@ Marking Words and Phrases Indicating Definitions, Commands, etc. * Useful Highlighting:: Highlighting provides useful information. -* code:: How to indicate code. -* kbd:: How to show keyboard input. -* key:: How to specify keys. -* samp:: How to show a literal sequence of characters. -* var:: How to indicate a metasyntactic variable. -* file:: How to indicate the name of a file. -* dfn:: How to specify a definition. -* cite:: How to refer to a book that is not in Info. -* url:: How to indicate a world wide web reference. -* email:: How to indicate an electronic mail address. +* code:: Indicating program code. +* kbd:: Showing keyboard input. +* key:: Specifying keys. +* samp:: Showing a literal sequence of characters. +* var:: Indicating metasyntactic variables. +* env:: Indicating environment variables. +* file:: Indicating file names. +* command:: Indicating command names. +* option:: Indicating option names. +* dfn:: Specifying definitions. +* cite:: Referring to books not in the Info system. +* acronym:: Indicating acronyms. +* url:: Indicating a World Wide Web reference. +* email:: Indicating an electronic mail address. Emphasizing Text * emph & strong:: How to emphasize text in Texinfo. * Smallcaps:: How to use the small caps font. * Fonts:: Various font commands for printed output. -* Customized Highlighting:: How to define highlighting commands. Quotations and Examples @@ -271,8 +274,8 @@ Quotations and Examples * quotation:: How to write a quotation. * example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font. * noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation. -* Lisp Example:: How to illustrate Lisp code. -* smallexample & smalllisp:: Forms for the `@smallbook' option. +* lisp:: How to illustrate Lisp code. +* small:: Forms for `@smallbook'. * display:: How to write an example in the current font. * format:: How to write an example that does not narrow the margins. @@ -299,7 +302,7 @@ Multi-column Tables * Multitable Column Widths:: Defining multitable column widths. * Multitable Rows:: Defining multitable rows, with examples. -Creating Indices +Indices * Index Entries:: Choose different words for index entries. * Predefined Indices:: Use different indices for different kinds @@ -329,6 +332,7 @@ Special Insertions * math:: How to format a mathematical expression. * Glyphs:: How to indicate results of evaluation, expansion of macros, errors, etc. +* Footnotes:: How to include footnotes. * Images:: How to include graphics. Inserting @ and Braces @@ -372,6 +376,11 @@ Glyphs Summary * Equivalence:: * Point Glyph:: +Footnotes + +* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. +* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. + Making and Preventing Breaks * Break Commands:: Cause and prevent splits. @@ -402,11 +411,6 @@ The Definition Commands * Abstract Objects:: Commands for object-oriented programming. * Data Types:: The definition command for data types. -Footnotes - -* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. -* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. - Conditionally Visible Text * Conditional Commands:: Specifying text for HTML, Info, or TeX. @@ -419,30 +423,45 @@ Conditionally Visible Text `@set', `@clear', and `@value' * ifset ifclear:: Format a region if a flag is set. -* value:: Replace a flag with a string. +* set value:: Expand a flag variable to a string. * value Example:: An easy way to update edition information. -Macros: Defining New Texinfo Commands +Internationalization -* Defining Macros:: Both defining and undefining new commands. +* documentlanguage:: Declaring the current language. +* documentencoding:: Declaring the input encoding. + +Defining New Texinfo Commands + +* Defining Macros:: Defining and undefining new commands. * Invoking Macros:: Using a macro, once you've defined it. +* Macro Details:: Beyond basic macro usage. +* alias:: Command aliases. +* definfoenclose:: Customized highlighting. -Format and Print Hardcopy +Formatting and Printing Hardcopy * Use TeX:: Use TeX to format for hardcopy. -* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format in a shell. -* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to use the shell. +* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format with explicit shell commands. +* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to format. * Print with lpr:: How to print. * Within Emacs:: How to format and print from an Emacs shell. * Texinfo Mode Printing:: How to format and print in Texinfo mode. * Compile-Command:: How to print using Emacs's compile command. * Requirements Summary:: TeX formatting requirements summary. -* Preparing for TeX:: What you need to do to use TeX. +* Preparing for TeX:: What to do before you use TeX. * Overfull hboxes:: What are and what to do with overfull hboxes. * smallbook:: How to print small format books and manuals. * A4 Paper:: How to print on European A4 paper. +* pagesizes:: How to print with customized page sizes. * Cropmarks and Magnification:: How to print marks to indicate the size of pages and how to print scaled up output. +* PDF Output:: Portable Document Format output. + +Creating and Installing Info Files + +* Creating an Info File:: +* Install an Info File:: Creating an Info File @@ -457,10 +476,11 @@ Creating an Info File * Batch Formatting:: How to format for Info in Emacs Batch mode. * Tag and Split Files:: How tagged and split files help Info to run better. +* makeinfo html:: Generating HTML output. Installing an Info File -* Directory file:: The top level menu for all Info files. +* Directory File:: The top level menu for all Info files. * New Info File:: Listing a new info file. * Other Info Directories:: How to specify Info files that are located in other directories. @@ -508,7 +528,8 @@ Finding Badly Referenced Nodes * Tagifying:: How to tagify a file. * Splitting:: How to split a file manually. -How to Obtain TeX + Documentation is like sex: when it is good, it is very, very good; + and when it is bad, it is better than nothing. --Dick Brandon  File: texinfo.info, Node: Copying, Next: Overview, Prev: Top, Up: Top @@ -556,43 +577,80 @@ File: texinfo.info, Node: Overview, Next: Texinfo Mode, Prev: Copying, Up: T Overview of Texinfo ******************* - "Texinfo"(1) (*note Overview-Footnotes::) is a documentation system -that uses a single source file to produce both on-line information and + "Texinfo"(1) (*note Overview-Footnote-1::) is a documentation system +that uses a single source file to produce both online information and printed output. This means that instead of writing two different -documents, one for the on-line help or other on-line information and -the other for a typeset manual or other printed work, you need write -only one document. When the work is revised, you need revise only one -document. (You can read the on-line information, known as an "Info -file", with an Info documentation-reading program.) +documents, one for the online information and the other for a printed +work, you need write only one document. Therefore, when the work is +revised, you need revise only that one document. * Menu: -* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book - or an Info file. +* Reporting Bugs:: Submitting effective bug reports. +* Using Texinfo:: Create printed or online output. * Info Files:: What is an Info file? * Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual. * Formatting Commands:: @-commands are used for formatting. * Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file. -* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that - the formatting commands will ignore. +* Comments:: Writing comments and ignored text in general. * Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have. * Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts. * Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file. -* Acknowledgements:: +* Acknowledgements and History:: Contributors and genesis.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Overview-Footnotes, Up: Overview - (1) Note that the first syllable of "Texinfo" is pronounced like -"speck", not "hex". This odd pronunciation is derived from, but is not -the same as, the pronunciation of TeX. In the word TeX, the `X' is -actually the Greek letter "chi" rather than the English letter "ex". -Pronounce TeX as if the `X' were the last sound in the name `Bach'; but -pronounce Texinfo as if the `x' were a `k'. Spell "Texinfo" with a -capital "T" and write the other letters in lower case. + (1) The first syllable of "Texinfo" is pronounced like "speck", not +"hex". This odd pronunciation is derived from, but is not the same as, +the pronunciation of TeX. In the word TeX, the `X' is actually the +Greek letter "chi" rather than the English letter "ex". Pronounce TeX +as if the `X' were the last sound in the name `Bach'; but pronounce +Texinfo as if the `x' were a `k'. Spell "Texinfo" with a capital "T" +and the other letters in lower case. + + +File: texinfo.info, Node: Reporting Bugs, Next: Using Texinfo, Up: Overview + +Reporting Bugs +============== + + We welcome bug reports or suggestions for the Texinfo system, both +programs and documentation. Please email them to +. You can get the latest version of Texinfo from +`ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/' and its mirrors worldwide. + + For bug reports, please include enough information for the maintainers +to reproduce the problem. Generally speaking, that means: + + * the version number of Texinfo and the program(s) or manual(s) + involved. + + * hardware, operating system, and compiler versions. + + * any unusual options you gave to `configure'. + + * the contents of any input files necessary to reproduce the bug. + + * a description of the problem and samples of any erroneous output. + + * anything else that you think would be helpful. + + When in doubt whether something is needed or not, include it. It's +better to include too much than to leave out something important. + + Patches are most welcome; if possible, please make them with +`diff -c' (*note Overview: (diffutils)Top.) and include `ChangeLog' +entries (*note Change Log: (emacs)Change Log.). + + When sending email, please do not encode or split the messages in any +way if possible; it's much easier to deal with one plain text message, +however large, than many small ones. GNU shar +(ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/sharutils/) is a convenient way of packaging +multiple and/or binary files for email.  -File: texinfo.info, Node: Using Texinfo, Next: Info Files, Prev: Overview, Up: Overview +File: texinfo.info, Node: Using Texinfo, Next: Info Files, Prev: Reporting Bugs, Up: Overview Using Texinfo ============= @@ -600,47 +658,71 @@ Using Texinfo Using Texinfo, you can create a printed document with the normal features of a book, including chapters, sections, cross references, and indices. From the same Texinfo source file, you can create a -menu-driven, on-line Info file with nodes, menus, cross references, and -indices. You can, if you wish, make the chapters and sections of the -printed document correspond to the nodes of the on-line information; -and you use the same cross references and indices for both the Info -file and the printed work. `The GNU Emacs Manual' is a good example of -a Texinfo file, as is this manual. +menu-driven, online Info file with nodes, menus, cross references, and +indices. You can also create from that same source file an HTML output +file suitable for use with a web browser. `The GNU Emacs Manual' is a +good example of a Texinfo file, as is this manual. To make a printed document, you process a Texinfo source file with the -TeX typesetting program. This creates a DVI file that you can typeset -and print as a book or report. (Note that the Texinfo language is -completely different from TeX's usual language, plain TeX.) If you do -not have TeX, but do have `troff' or `nroff', you can use the -`texi2roff' program instead. - - To make an Info file, you process a Texinfo source file with the -`makeinfo' utility or Emacs's `texinfo-format-buffer' command; this -creates an Info file that you can install on-line. - - TeX and `texi2roff' work with many types of printers; similarly, Info -works with almost every type of computer terminal. This power makes -Texinfo a general purpose system, but brings with it a constraint, -which is that a Texinfo file may contain only the customary -"typewriter" characters (letters, numbers, spaces, and punctuation -marks) but no special graphics. - - A Texinfo file is a plain ASCII file containing text and "@-commands" -(words preceded by an `@') that tell the typesetting and formatting -programs what to do. You may edit a Texinfo file with any text editor; -but it is especially convenient to use GNU Emacs since that editor has -a special mode, called Texinfo mode, that provides various -Texinfo-related features. (*Note Texinfo Mode::.) - - Before writing a Texinfo source file, you should become familiar with -the Info documentation reading program and learn about nodes, menus, -cross references, and the rest. (*note info: (info)Top, for more -information.) - - You can use Texinfo to create both on-line help and printed manuals; +TeX typesetting program (but the Texinfo language is very different +from TeX's usual language, plain TeX). This creates a DVI file that +you can typeset and print as a book or report (*note Hardcopy::). + + To output an Info file, process your Texinfo source with the +`makeinfo' utility or Emacs's `texinfo-format-buffer' command. You can +install the result in your Info tree (*note Install an Info File::). + + To output an HTML file, process your Texinfo source with `makeinfo' +using the `--html' option. You can (for example) install the result on +your web site. + + If you are a programmer and would like to contribute to the GNU +project by implementing additional output formats for Texinfo, that +would be excellent. But please do not write a separate translator +texi2foo for your favorite format foo! That is the hard way to do the +job, and makes extra work in subsequent maintenance, since the Texinfo +language is continually being enhanced and updated. Instead, the best +approach is modify `makeinfo' to generate the new format, as it does +now for Info and HTML. + + TeX works with virtually all printers; Info works with virtually all +computer terminals; the HTML output works with virtually all web +browsers. Thus Texinfo can be used by almost any computer user. + + A Texinfo source file is a plain ASCII file containing text and +"@-commands" (words preceded by an `@') that tell the typesetting and +formatting programs what to do. You may edit a Texinfo file with any +text editor; but it is especially convenient to use GNU Emacs since +that editor has a special mode, called Texinfo mode, that provides +various Texinfo-related features. (*Note Texinfo Mode::.) + + Before writing a Texinfo source file, you should learn about nodes, +menus, cross references, and the rest, for example by reading this +manual. + + You can use Texinfo to create both online help and printed manuals; moreover, Texinfo is freely redistributable. For these reasons, Texinfo -is the format in which documentation for GNU utilities and libraries is -written. +is the official documentation format of the GNU project. More +information is available at the GNU documentation web page +(http://www.gnu.org/doc/). + + From time to time, proposals are made to generate traditional Unix man +pages from Texinfo source. This is not likely to ever be supported, +because man pages have a very strict conventional format. Merely +enhancing `makeinfo' to output troff format would be insufficient. +Generating a good man page therefore requires a completely different +source than the typical Texinfo applications of generating a good user +manual or a good reference manual. This makes generating man pages +incompatible with the Texinfo design goal of not having to document the +same information in different ways for different output formats. You +might as well just write the man page directly. + + If you wish to support man pages, the program `help2man' may be +useful; it generates a traditional man page from the `--help' output of +a program. In fact, this is currently used to generate man pages for +the Texinfo programs themselves. It is free software written by +Brendan O'Dea, available from +`http://www.ozemail.com.au/~bod/help2man.tar.gz'.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Info Files, Next: Printed Books, Prev: Using Texinfo, Up: Overview @@ -679,7 +761,7 @@ Normally the order in this chain is the same as the order of the children in the parent's menu. Each child node records the parent node name as its `Up' pointer. The last child has no `Next' pointer, and the first child has the parent both as its `Previous' and as its `Up' -pointer.(1) (*note Info Files-Footnotes::) +pointer.(1) (*note Info Files-Footnote-1::) The book-like structuring of an Info file into nodes that correspond to chapters, sections, and the like is a matter of convention, not a @@ -720,6 +802,15 @@ with the advanced Info command `g *'. (*note Advanced Info commands: for the whole Info system. From it, you can reach the `Top' nodes of each of the documents in a complete Info system. + If you wish to refer to an Info file in a URI, you can use the +(unofficial) syntax exemplified in the following. This works with +Emacs/W3, for example: + info:///usr/info/emacs#Dissociated%20Press + info:emacs#Dissociated%20Press + info://localhost/usr/info/emacs#Dissociated%20Press + + The `info' program itself does not follow URI's of any kind. +  File: texinfo.info, Node: Info Files-Footnotes, Up: Info Files @@ -735,7 +826,7 @@ Printed Books A Texinfo file can be formatted and typeset as a printed book or manual. To do this, you need TeX, a powerful, sophisticated typesetting -program written by Donald Knuth.(1) (*note Printed Books-Footnotes::) +program written by Donald Knuth.(1) (*note Printed Books-Footnote-1::) A Texinfo-based book is similar to any other typeset, printed work: it can have a title page, copyright page, table of contents, and preface, @@ -743,17 +834,19 @@ as well as chapters, numbered or unnumbered sections and subsections, page headers, cross references, footnotes, and indices. You can use Texinfo to write a book without ever having the intention -of converting it into on-line information. You can use Texinfo for +of converting it into online information. You can use Texinfo for writing a printed novel, and even to write a printed memo, although this latter application is not recommended since electronic mail is so much easier. TeX is a general purpose typesetting program. Texinfo provides a -file called `texinfo.tex' that contains information (definitions or -"macros") that TeX uses when it typesets a Texinfo file. -(`texinfo.tex' tells TeX how to convert the Texinfo @-commands to TeX -commands, which TeX can then process to create the typeset document.) -`texinfo.tex' contains the specifications for printing a document. +file `texinfo.tex' that contains information (definitions or "macros") +that TeX uses when it typesets a Texinfo file. (`texinfo.tex' tells +TeX how to convert the Texinfo @-commands to TeX commands, which TeX +can then process to create the typeset document.) `texinfo.tex' +contains the specifications for printing a document. You can get the +latest version of `texinfo.tex' from +`ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo.tex'. Most often, documents are printed on 8.5 inch by 11 inch pages (216mm by 280mm; this is the default size), but you can also print for 7 inch @@ -772,22 +865,23 @@ light-hearted, young and cheery. TeX is freely distributable. It is written in a superset of Pascal called WEB and can be compiled either in Pascal or (by using a conversion program that comes with the TeX distribution) in C. (*Note -TeX Mode: (xemacs)TeX Mode, for information about TeX.) +TeX Mode: (emacs)TeX Mode, for information about TeX.) TeX is very powerful and has a great many features. Because a Texinfo file must be able to present information both on a character-only terminal in Info form and in a typeset book, the formatting commands that Texinfo supports are necessarily limited. - *Note How to Obtain TeX: Obtaining TeX. + To get a copy of TeX, see *Note How to Obtain TeX: Obtaining TeX.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Printed Books-Footnotes, Up: Printed Books - (1) You can also use the `texi2roff' program if you do not have TeX; -since Texinfo is designed for use with TeX, `texi2roff' is not -described here. `texi2roff' is not part of the standard GNU -distribution. + (1) You can also use the `texi2roff' (ftp://tug.org/texi2roff.tar.gz) +program if you do not have TeX; since Texinfo is designed for use with +TeX, `texi2roff' is not described here. `texi2roff' is not part of the +standard GNU distribution and is not maintained or up-to-date with all +the Texinfo features described in this manual.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Formatting Commands, Next: Conventions, Prev: Printed Books, Up: Overview @@ -812,7 +906,7 @@ characters. Similarly, you can print the output generated by TeX on a wide variety of printers. Depending on what they do or what arguments(1) (*note Formatting -Commands-Footnotes::) they take, you need to write @-commands on lines +Commands-Footnote-1::) they take, you need to write @-commands on lines of their own or as part of sentences: * Write a command such as `@noindent' at the beginning of a line as @@ -832,11 +926,14 @@ of their own or as part of sentences: this example, between the braces. (`@code' marks text as being code.) - * Write a command such as `@example' at the beginning of a line of - its own; write the body-text on following lines; and write the - matching `@end' command, `@end example' in this case, at the - beginning of a line of its own after the body-text. (`@example' - ... `@end example' indents and typesets body-text as an example.) + * Write a command such as `@example' on a line of its own; write the + body-text on following lines; and write the matching `@end' + command, `@end example' in this case, at the on a line of its own + after the body-text. (`@example' ... `@end example' indents and + typesets body-text as an example.) It's usually ok to indent + environment commands like this, but in complicated and + hard-to-define circumstances the extra spaces cause extra space to + appear in the output, so beware. As a general rule, a command requires braces if it mingles among other text; but it does not need braces if it starts a line of its own. The @@ -853,14 +950,14 @@ exactly the same syntax. (For details about @-command syntax, see File: texinfo.info, Node: Formatting Commands-Footnotes, Up: Formatting Commands (1) The word "argument" comes from the way it is used in mathematics -and does not refer to a disputation between two people; it refers to the +and does not refer to a dispute between two people; it refers to the information presented to the command. According to the `Oxford English Dictionary', the word derives from the Latin for "to make clear, prove"; thus it came to mean `the evidence offered as proof', which is to say, `the information offered', which led to its mathematical meaning. In its other thread of derivation, the word came to mean `to assert in a manner against which others may make counter assertions', -which led to the meaning of `argument' as a disputation. +which led to the meaning of `argument' as a dispute.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Conventions, Next: Comments, Prev: Formatting Commands, Up: Overview @@ -868,37 +965,43 @@ File: texinfo.info, Node: Conventions, Next: Comments, Prev: Formatting Comma General Syntactic Conventions ============================= - All printable ASCII characters except `@', `{' and `}' can appear in -a Texinfo file and stand for themselves. `@' is the escape character -which introduces commands. `{' and `}' should be used only to surround -arguments to certain commands. To put one of these special characters -into the document, put an `@' character in front of it, like this: -`@@', `@{', and `@}'. - - It is customary in TeX to use doubled single-quote characters to -begin and end quotations: ` ` and ' ' (but without a space between the -two single-quote characters). This convention should be followed in -Texinfo files. TeX converts doubled single-quote characters to left- -and right-hand doubled quotation marks and Info converts doubled -single-quote characters to ASCII double-quotes: ` ` and ' ' to " . - - Use three hyphens in a row, `---', for a dash--like this. In TeX, a -single or double hyphen produces a printed dash that is shorter than -the usual typeset dash. Info reduces three hyphens to two for display -on the screen. - - To prevent a paragraph from being indented in the printed manual, put -the command `@noindent' on a line by itself before the paragraph. - - If you mark off a region of the Texinfo file with the `@iftex' and -`@end iftex' commands, that region will appear only in the printed -copy; in that region, you can use certain commands borrowed from plain -TeX that you cannot use in Info. Likewise, if you mark off a region -with the `@ifinfo' and `@end ifinfo' commands, that region will appear -only in the Info file; in that region, you can use Info commands that -you cannot use in TeX. Similarly for `@ifhtml ... @end ifhtml', -`@ifnothtml ... @end ifnothtml', `@ifnotinfo ... @end ifnotinfo', -`@ifnottex ... @end ifnottex', *Note Conditionals::. + This section describes the general conventions used in all Texinfo +documents. + + * All printable ASCII characters except `@', `{' and `}' can appear + in a Texinfo file and stand for themselves. `@' is the escape + character which introduces commands. `{' and `}' should be used + only to surround arguments to certain commands. To put one of + these special characters into the document, put an `@' character + in front of it, like this: `@@', `@{', and `@}'. + + * It is customary in TeX to use doubled single-quote characters to + begin and end quotations: ` ` and ' ' (but without a space between + the two single-quote characters). This convention should be + followed in Texinfo files. TeX converts doubled single-quote + characters to left- and right-hand doubled quotation marks and + Info converts doubled single-quote characters to ASCII + double-quotes: ` ` and ' ' to " . + + * Use three hyphens in a row, `---', for a dash--like this. In TeX, + a single or double hyphen produces a printed dash that is shorter + than the usual typeset dash. Info reduces three hyphens to two for + display on the screen. + + * To prevent a paragraph from being indented in the printed manual, + put the command `@noindent' on a line by itself before the + paragraph. + + * If you mark off a region of the Texinfo file with the `@iftex' and + `@end iftex' commands, that region will appear only in the printed + copy; in that region, you can use certain commands borrowed from + plain TeX that you cannot use in Info. Likewise, if you mark off + a region with the `@ifinfo' and `@end ifinfo' commands, that + region will appear only in the Info file; in that region, you can + use Info commands that you cannot use in TeX. Similarly for + `@ifhtml ... @end ifhtml', `@ifnothtml ... @end ifnothtml', + `@ifnotinfo ... @end ifnotinfo', `@ifnottex ... @end ifnottex'. + *Note Conditionals::. *Caution:* Do not use tabs in a Texinfo file! TeX uses variable-width fonts, which means that it cannot predefine a tab @@ -913,8 +1016,6 @@ you cannot use in TeX. Similarly for `@ifhtml ... @end ifhtml', Also, you can run `untabify' in Emacs to convert tabs in a region to multiple spaces. - Don't use tabs. -  File: texinfo.info, Node: Comments, Next: Minimum, Prev: Conventions, Up: Overview @@ -924,14 +1025,14 @@ Comments You can write comments in a Texinfo file that will not appear in either the Info file or the printed manual by using the `@comment' command (which may be abbreviated to `@c'). Such comments are for the -person who reads the Texinfo file. All the text on a line that follows -either `@comment' or `@c' is a comment; the rest of the line does not -appear in either the Info file or the printed manual. (Often, you can -write the `@comment' or `@c' in the middle of a line, and only the text -that follows after the `@comment' or `@c' command does not appear; but -some commands, such as `@settitle' and `@setfilename', work on a whole -line. You cannot use `@comment' or `@c' in a line beginning with such -a command.) +person who revises the Texinfo file. All the text on a line that +follows either `@comment' or `@c' is a comment; the rest of the line +does not appear in either the Info file or the printed manual. (Often, +you can write the `@comment' or `@c' in the middle of a line, and only +the text that follows after the `@comment' or `@c' command does not +appear; but some commands, such as `@settitle' and `@setfilename', work +on a whole line. You cannot use `@comment' or `@c' in a line beginning +with such a command.) You can write long stretches of text that will not appear in either the Info file or the printed manual by using the `@ignore' and `@end @@ -943,100 +1044,3 @@ two commands does not appear in the processed output. You can use applies to the Texinfo source file of a document, but not to the Info or printed version of the document. - -File: texinfo.info, Node: Minimum, Next: Six Parts, Prev: Comments, Up: Overview - -What a Texinfo File Must Have -============================= - - By convention, the names of Texinfo files end with one of the -extensions `.texinfo', `.texi', or `.tex'. The longer extension is -preferred since it describes more clearly to a human reader the nature -of the file. The shorter extensions are for operating systems that -cannot handle long file names. - - In order to be made into a printed manual and an Info file, a Texinfo -file *must* begin with lines like this: - - \input texinfo - @setfilename INFO-FILE-NAME - @settitle NAME-OF-MANUAL - -The contents of the file follow this beginning, and then you *must* end -a Texinfo file with a line like this: - - @bye - -The `\input texinfo' line tells TeX to use the `texinfo.tex' file, -which tells TeX how to translate the Texinfo @-commands into TeX -typesetting commands. (Note the use of the backslash, `\'; this is -correct for TeX.) The `@setfilename' line provides a name for the Info -file and tells TeX to open auxiliary files. The `@settitle' line -specifies a title for the page headers (or footers) of the printed -manual. - - The `@bye' line at the end of the file on a line of its own tells the -formatters that the file is ended and to stop formatting. - - Usually, you will not use quite such a spare format, but will include -mode setting and start-of-header and end-of-header lines at the -beginning of a Texinfo file, like this: - - \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- - @c %**start of header - @setfilename INFO-FILE-NAME - @settitle NAME-OF-MANUAL - @c %**end of header - -In the first line, `-*-texinfo-*-' causes Emacs to switch into Texinfo -mode when you edit the file. - - The `@c' lines which surround the `@setfilename' and `@settitle' -lines are optional, but you need them in order to run TeX or Info on -just part of the file. (*Note Start of Header::, for more information.) - - Furthermore, you will usually provide a Texinfo file with a title -page, indices, and the like. But the minimum, which can be useful for -short documents, is just the three lines at the beginning and the one -line at the end. - - -File: texinfo.info, Node: Six Parts, Next: Short Sample, Prev: Minimum, Up: Overview - -Six Parts of a Texinfo File -=========================== - - Generally, a Texinfo file contains more than the minimal beginning -and end--it usually contains six parts: - -1. Header - The "Header" names the file, tells TeX which definitions' file to - use, and performs other "housekeeping" tasks. - -2. Summary Description and Copyright - The "Summary Description and Copyright" segment describes the - document and contains the copyright notice and copying permissions - for the Info file. The segment must be enclosed between `@ifinfo' - and `@end ifinfo' commands so that the formatters place it only in - the Info file. - -3. Title and Copyright - The "Title and Copyright" segment contains the title and copyright - pages and copying permissions for the printed manual. The segment - must be enclosed between `@titlepage' and `@end titlepage' - commands. The title and copyright page appear only in the printed - manual. - -4. `Top' Node and Master Menu - The "Master Menu" contains a complete menu of all the nodes in the - whole Info file. It appears only in the Info file, in the `Top' - node. - -5. Body - The "Body" of the document may be structured like a traditional - book or encyclopedia or it may be free form. - -6. End - The "End" contains commands for printing indices and generating - the table of contents, and the `@bye' command on a line of its own. - diff --git a/info/texinfo.info-2 b/info/texinfo.info-2 index 1697d67..b309e1a 100644 --- a/info/texinfo.info-2 +++ b/info/texinfo.info-2 @@ -1,22 +1,22 @@ -This is Info file ../info/texinfo.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file texinfo.texi. +This is ../info/texinfo.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +texinfo.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION Texinfo documentation system START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY * Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format. -* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Updating info/dir entries. -* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Printing Texinfo documentation. -* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sorting Texinfo index files. +* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Update info/dir entries. +* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Print Texinfo documents. +* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sort Texinfo index files. * makeinfo: (texinfo)makeinfo Preferred. Translate Texinfo source. END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY This file documents Texinfo, a documentation system that can produce -both on-line information and a printed manual from a single source file. +both online information and a printed manual from a single source file. - Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98 Free Software + Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - This edition is for Texinfo version 3.12. + This edition is for Texinfo version 4.0, 28 September 1999. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are @@ -33,7 +33,104 @@ versions, except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved by the Free Software Foundation.  -File: texinfo.info, Node: Short Sample, Next: Acknowledgements, Prev: Six Parts, Up: Overview +File: texinfo.info, Node: Minimum, Next: Six Parts, Prev: Comments, Up: Overview + +What a Texinfo File Must Have +============================= + + By convention, the names of Texinfo files end with one of the +extensions `.texinfo', `.texi', `.txi', or `.tex'. The longer +extension is preferred since it describes more clearly to a human +reader the nature of the file. The shorter extensions are for +operating systems that cannot handle long file names. + + In order to be made into a printed manual and an Info file, a Texinfo +file *must* begin with lines like this: + + \input texinfo + @setfilename INFO-FILE-NAME + @settitle NAME-OF-MANUAL + +The contents of the file follow this beginning, and then you *must* end +a Texinfo file with a line like this: + + @bye + +The `\input texinfo' line tells TeX to use the `texinfo.tex' file, +which tells TeX how to translate the Texinfo @-commands into TeX +typesetting commands. (Note the use of the backslash, `\'; this is +correct for TeX.) The `@setfilename' line provides a name for the Info +file and tells TeX to open auxiliary files. The `@settitle' line +specifies a title for the page headers (or footers) of the printed +manual. + + The `@bye' line at the end of the file on a line of its own tells the +formatters that the file is ended and to stop formatting. + + Usually, you will not use quite such a spare format, but will include +mode setting and start-of-header and end-of-header lines at the +beginning of a Texinfo file, like this: + + \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- + @c %**start of header + @setfilename INFO-FILE-NAME + @settitle NAME-OF-MANUAL + @c %**end of header + +In the first line, `-*-texinfo-*-' causes Emacs to switch into Texinfo +mode when you edit the file. + + The `@c' lines which surround the `@setfilename' and `@settitle' +lines are optional, but you need them in order to run TeX or Info on +just part of the file. (*Note Start of Header::, for more information.) + + Furthermore, you will usually provide a Texinfo file with a title +page, indices, and the like. But the minimum, which can be useful for +short documents, is just the three lines at the beginning and the one +line at the end. + + +File: texinfo.info, Node: Six Parts, Next: Short Sample, Prev: Minimum, Up: Overview + +Six Parts of a Texinfo File +=========================== + + Generally, a Texinfo file contains more than the minimal beginning +and end--it usually contains six parts: + +1. Header + The "Header" names the file, tells TeX which definitions' file to + use, and performs other "housekeeping" tasks. + +2. Summary Description and Copyright + The "Summary Description and Copyright" segment describes the + document and contains the copyright notice and copying permissions + for the Info file. The segment must be enclosed between `@ifinfo' + and `@end ifinfo' commands so that the formatters place it only in + the Info file. + +3. Title and Copyright + The "Title and Copyright" segment contains the title and copyright + pages and copying permissions for the printed manual. The segment + must be enclosed between `@titlepage' and `@end titlepage' + commands. The title and copyright page appear only in the printed + manual. + +4. `Top' Node and Master Menu + The "Master Menu" contains a complete menu of all the nodes in the + whole Info file. It appears only in the Info file, in the `Top' + node. + +5. Body + The "Body" of the document may be structured like a traditional + book or encyclopedia or it may be free form. + +6. End + The "End" contains commands for printing indices and generating + the table of contents, and the `@bye' command on a line of its own. + + +File: texinfo.info, Node: Short Sample, Next: Acknowledgements and History, Prev: Six Parts, Up: Overview A Short Sample Texinfo File =========================== @@ -44,7 +141,7 @@ titlepage', look more intimidating than they are. Most of the material is standard boilerplate; when you write a manual, simply insert the names for your own manual in this segment. (*Note Beginning a File::.) -In the following, the sample text is *indented*; comments on it are + In the following, the sample text is _indented_; comments on it are not. The complete file, without any comments, is shown in *Note Sample Texinfo File::. @@ -59,9 +156,8 @@ file and the title used in the header. @c %**start of header @setfilename sample.info @settitle Sample Document - @c %**end of header - @setchapternewpage odd + @c %**end of header Part 2: Summary Description and Copyright ----------------------------------------- @@ -140,13 +236,11 @@ chapter containing an enumerated list. Part 6: The End of the Document ------------------------------- -The end segment contains commands both for generating an index in a node -and unnumbered chapter of its own and for generating the table of -contents; and it contains the `@bye' command that marks the end of the -document. +The end segment contains commands for generating an index in a node and +unnumbered chapter of its own, (usually) for generating the table of +contents, and the `@bye' command that marks the end of the document. @node Concept Index, , First Chapter, Top - @comment node-name, next, previous, up @unnumbered Concept Index @printindex cp @@ -160,6 +254,7 @@ The Results Here is what the contents of the first chapter of the sample look like: + This is the contents of the first chapter. Here is a numbered list. @@ -173,29 +268,44 @@ like: for a printed manual.  -File: texinfo.info, Node: Acknowledgements, Prev: Short Sample, Up: Overview +File: texinfo.info, Node: Acknowledgements and History, Prev: Short Sample, Up: Overview -Acknowledgements -================ +Acknowledgements and History +============================ - Richard M. Stallman wrote Edition 1.0 of this manual. -Robert J. Chassell revised and extended it, starting with Edition 1.1. -Karl Berry made updates for the Texinfo 3.8 and subsequent releases, -starting with Edition 2.22. + Richard M. Stallman invented the Texinfo format, wrote the initial +processors, and created Edition 1.0 of this manual. Robert J. Chassell +greatly revised and extended the manual, starting with Edition 1.1. +Brian Fox was responsible for the standalone Texinfo distribution until +version 3.8, and wrote the standalone `makeinfo' and `info'. Karl +Berry has made the updates since Texinfo 3.8 and subsequent releases, +starting with Edition 2.22 of the manual. Our thanks go out to all who helped improve this work, particularly to Franc,ois Pinard and David D. Zuhn, who tirelessly recorded and reported mistakes and obscurities; our special thanks go to Melissa Weisshaus for her frequent and often tedious reviews of nearly similar -editions. Our mistakes are our own. - - Please send suggestions and corrections to: - - Internet address: - bug-texinfo@gnu.org - -Please include the manual's edition number and update date in your -messages. +editions. The indefatigable Eli Zaretskii and Andreas Schwab have +provided patches beyond counting. Zack Weinberg did the impossible by +implementing the macro syntax in `texinfo.tex'. Dozens of others have +contributed patches and suggestions, they are gratefully acknowledged +in the `ChangeLog' file. Our mistakes are our own. + + A bit of history: in the 1970's at CMU, Brian Reid developed a program +and format named Scribe to mark up documents for printing. It used the +`@' character to introduce commands as Texinfo does and strived to +describe document contents rather than formatting. + + Meanwhile, people at MIT developed another, not too dissimilar format +called Bolio. This then was converted to using TeX as its typesetting +language: BoTeX. + + BoTeX could only be used as a markup language for documents to be +printed, not for online documents. Richard Stallman (RMS) worked on +both Bolio and BoTeX. He also developed a nifty on-line help format +called Info, and then combined BoTeX and Info to create Texinfo, a mark +up language for text that is intended to be read both on line and as +printed hard copy.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Texinfo Mode, Next: Beginning a File, Prev: Overview, Up: Top @@ -232,7 +342,8 @@ File: texinfo.info, Node: Texinfo Mode Overview, Next: Emacs Editing, Prev: T Texinfo Mode Overview ===================== - Texinfo mode provides special features for working with Texinfo files: + Texinfo mode provides special features for working with Texinfo files. +You can: * Insert frequently used @-commands. @@ -277,17 +388,18 @@ such as appendices. With this value for the page delimiter, you can jump from chapter title to chapter title with the `C-x ]' (`forward-page') and `C-x [' (`backward-page') commands and narrow to a chapter with the `C-x p' (`narrow-to-page') command. (*Note Pages: -(xemacs)Pages, for details about the page commands.) +(emacs)Pages, for details about the page commands.) You may name a Texinfo file however you wish, but the convention is to -end a Texinfo file name with one of the three extensions `.texinfo', -`.texi', or `.tex'. A longer extension is preferred, since it is +end a Texinfo file name with one of the extensions `.texinfo', `.texi', +`.txi', or `.tex'. A longer extension is preferred, since it is explicit, but a shorter extension may be necessary for operating systems that limit the length of file names. GNU Emacs automatically -enters Texinfo mode when you visit a file with a `.texinfo' or `.texi' -extension. Also, Emacs switches to Texinfo mode when you visit a file -that has `-*-texinfo-*-' in its first line. If ever you are in another -mode and wish to switch to Texinfo mode, type `M-x texinfo-mode'. +enters Texinfo mode when you visit a file with a `.texinfo', `.texi' or +`.txi' extension. Also, Emacs switches to Texinfo mode when you visit a +file that has `-*-texinfo-*-' in its first line. If ever you are in +another mode and wish to switch to Texinfo mode, type `M-x +texinfo-mode'. Like all other Emacs features, you can customize or enhance Texinfo mode as you wish. In particular, the keybindings are very easy to @@ -371,7 +483,7 @@ first letter of the @-command: however, more mnemonic; hence the two keybindings. (Also, you can move out from between braces by typing `C-f'.) - To put a command such as `@code{...}' around an *existing* word, + To put a command such as `@code{...}' around an _existing_ word, position the cursor in front of the word and type `C-u 1 C-c C-c c'. This makes it easy to edit existing plain text. The value of the prefix argument tells Emacs how many words following point to include @@ -436,19 +548,16 @@ corresponding spot in the Texinfo file. If you call `texinfo-show-structure' with a prefix argument by typing `C-u C-c C-s', it will list not only those lines with the @-commands for `@chapter', `@section', and the like, but also the `@node' lines. -(This is how the `texinfo-show-structure' command worked without an -argument in the first version of Texinfo. It was changed because -`@node' lines clutter up the `*Occur*' buffer and are usually not -needed.) You can use `texinfo-show-structure' with a prefix argument -to check whether the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of an -`@node' line are correct. +You can use `texinfo-show-structure' with a prefix argument to check +whether the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of an `@node' line +are correct. Often, when you are working on a manual, you will be interested only in the structure of the current chapter. In this case, you can mark off the region of the buffer that you are interested in by using the `C-x n n' (`narrow-to-region') command and `texinfo-show-structure' will work on only that region. To see the whole buffer again, use -`C-x n w' (`widen'). (*Note Narrowing: (xemacs)Narrowing, for more +`C-x n w' (`widen'). (*Note Narrowing: (emacs)Narrowing, for more information about the narrowing commands.) In addition to providing the `texinfo-show-structure' command, @@ -456,7 +565,7 @@ Texinfo mode sets the value of the page delimiter variable to match the chapter-level @-commands. This enables you to use the `C-x ]' (`forward-page') and `C-x [' (`backward-page') commands to move forward and backward by chapter, and to use the `C-x p' (`narrow-to-page') -command to narrow to a chapter. *Note Pages: (xemacs)Pages, for more +command to narrow to a chapter. *Note Pages: (emacs)Pages, for more information about the page commands.  @@ -490,14 +599,14 @@ File: texinfo.info, Node: Updating Commands, Next: Updating Requirements, Pre The Updating Commands --------------------- - You can use the updating commands + You can use the updating commands to: - * to insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of a + * insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of a node, - * to insert or update the menu for a section, and + * insert or update the menu for a section, and - * to create a master menu for a Texinfo source file. + * create a master menu for a Texinfo source file. You can also use the commands to update all the nodes and menus in a region or in a whole Texinfo file. @@ -516,11 +625,11 @@ structuring command line; and you may interpose only an `@comment' line or an `@ifinfo' line. Commands which work on a whole buffer require that the `Top' node be -followed by a node with an `@chapter' or equivalent-level command. -Note that the menu updating commands will not create a main or master -menu for a Texinfo file that has only `@chapter'-level nodes! The menu -updating commands only create menus *within* nodes for lower level -nodes. To create a menu of chapters, you must provide a `Top' node. +followed by a node with an `@chapter' or equivalent-level command. The +menu updating commands will not create a main or master menu for a +Texinfo file that has only `@chapter'-level nodes! The menu updating +commands only create menus _within_ nodes for lower level nodes. To +create a menu of chapters, you must provide a `Top' node. The menu updating commands remove menu entries that refer to other Info files since they do not refer to nodes within the current buffer. @@ -560,7 +669,7 @@ menu in the whole Texinfo file. This updates all the nodes and menus completely and all at once. The other major updating commands do smaller jobs and are designed for -the person who updates nodes and menus as he or she writes a Texinfo +the person who updates nodes and menus as he or she writes a Texinfo file. The commands are: @@ -618,8 +727,8 @@ file. which menu descriptions are indented. By default, the value is 32 although it is often useful to reduce it to as low as 24. You can set the variable with the `M-x edit-options' command (*note Editing -Variable Values: (xemacs)Edit Options.) or with the `M-x set-variable' -command (*note Examining and Setting Variables: (xemacs)Examining.). +Variable Values: (emacs)Edit Options.) or with the `M-x set-variable' +command (*note Examining and Setting Variables: (emacs)Examining.). Also, the `texinfo-indent-menu-description' command may be used to indent existing menu descriptions to a specified column. Finally, if @@ -661,7 +770,7 @@ In this example, `Comments' is the name of both the node and the section. The next node is called `Minimum' and the previous node is called `Conventions'. The `Comments' section is within the `Overview' node, which is specified by the `Up' pointer. (Instead of an -`@comment' line, you can write an `@ifinfo' line.) +`@comment' line, you may also write an `@ifinfo' line.) If a file has a `Top' node, it must be called `top' or `Top' and be the first node in the file. @@ -673,10 +782,10 @@ must have a `Top' node if you want a menu of chapters. Incidentally, the `makeinfo' command will create an Info file for a hierarchically organized Texinfo file that lacks `Next', `Previous' and `Up' pointers. Thus, if you can be sure that your Texinfo file will be -formatted with `makeinfo', you have no need for the `update node' -commands. (*Note Creating an Info File: Create an Info File, for more -information about `makeinfo'.) However, both `makeinfo' and the -`texinfo-format-...' commands require that you insert menus in the file. +formatted with `makeinfo', you have no need for the update node +commands. (*Note Creating an Info File::, for more information about +`makeinfo'.) However, both `makeinfo' and the `texinfo-format-...' +commands require that you insert menus in the file.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Other Updating Commands, Prev: Updating Requirements, Up: Updating Nodes and Menus @@ -705,11 +814,11 @@ possesses several less frequently used updating commands: C-x h C-u M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines - (Note that this command inserts titles as node names in `@node' - lines; the `texinfo-start-menu-description' command (*note - Inserting Frequently Used Commands: Inserting.) inserts titles as - descriptions in menu entries, a different action. However, in both - cases, you need to edit the inserted text.) + This command inserts titles as node names in `@node' lines; the + `texinfo-start-menu-description' command (*note Inserting + Frequently Used Commands: Inserting.) inserts titles as + descriptions in menu entries, a different action. However, in + both cases, you need to edit the inserted text. `M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update' Update nodes and menus in a document built from several separate @@ -785,10 +894,10 @@ an Info file: or M-x makeinfo-buffer - For TeX or the Info formatting commands to work, the file *must* + For TeX or the Info formatting commands to work, the file _must_ include a line that has `@setfilename' in its header. - *Note Create an Info File::, for details about Info formatting. + *Note Creating an Info File::, for details about Info formatting.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Printing, Next: Texinfo Mode Summary, Prev: Info Formatting, Up: Texinfo Mode @@ -802,7 +911,7 @@ print the file. Optionally, you may also create indices. To do this, you must run the `texindex' command after first running the `tex' typesetting command; and then you must run the `tex' command again. Or else run the `texi2dvi' command which automatically creates indices as -needed (*note Format with texi2dvi::.). +needed (*note Format with texi2dvi::). Often, when you are writing a document, you want to typeset and print only part of a file to see what it will look like. You can use the @@ -836,13 +945,13 @@ only part of a file to see what it will look like. You can use the `texinfo-tex-buffer' or `texinfo-tex-region'. For `texinfo-tex-region' or `texinfo-tex-buffer' to work, the file -*must* start with a `\input texinfo' line and must include an +_must_ start with a `\input texinfo' line and must include an `@settitle' line. The file must end with `@bye' on a line by itself. (When you use `texinfo-tex-region', you must surround the `@settitle' line with start-of-header and end-of-header lines.) - *Note Format/Print Hardcopy::, for a description of the other TeX -related commands, such as `tex-show-print-queue'. + *Note Hardcopy::, for a description of the other TeX related +commands, such as `tex-show-print-queue'.  File: texinfo.info, Node: Texinfo Mode Summary, Prev: Printing, Up: Texinfo Mode @@ -969,8 +1078,8 @@ C-t' and then another control command: `C-r' for `texinfo-tex-region', Other Updating Commands ----------------------- - The `other updating commands' do not have standard keybindings because -they are rarely used. + The remaining updating commands do not have standard keybindings +because they are rarely used. M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines Insert missing `@node' lines in region. @@ -1143,11 +1252,12 @@ or else like this: * setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file. * settitle:: Create a title for the printed work. * setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages. -* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation. +* paragraphindent:: Specify paragraph indentation. +* exampleindent:: Specify environment indentation. * End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this.  -File: texinfo.info, Node: First Line, Next: Start of Header, Prev: Header, Up: Header +File: texinfo.info, Node: First Line, Next: Start of Header, Up: Header The First Line of a Texinfo File -------------------------------- @@ -1181,7 +1291,7 @@ Start of Header Follow the start-of-header line with `@setfilename' and `@settitle' lines and, optionally, with other command lines, such as `@smallbook' or `@footnotestyle'; and then by an end-of-header line (*note End of -Header::.). +Header::). With these lines, you can format part of a Texinfo file for Info or typeset part for printing. @@ -1193,91 +1303,3 @@ typeset part for printing. The odd string of characters, `%**', is to ensure that no other comment is accidentally taken for a start-of-header line. - -File: texinfo.info, Node: setfilename, Next: settitle, Prev: Start of Header, Up: Header - -`@setfilename' --------------- - - In order to serve as the primary input file for either `makeinfo' or -TeX, a Texinfo file must contain a line that looks like this: - - @setfilename INFO-FILE-NAME - - Write the `@setfilename' command at the beginning of a line and -follow it on the same line by the Info file name. Do not write anything -else on the line; anything on the line after the command is considered -part of the file name, including what would otherwise be a comment. - - The `@setfilename' line specifies the name of the Info file to be -generated. This name should be different from the name of the Texinfo -file. There are two conventions for choosing the name: you can either -remove the `.texi' extension from the input file name, or replace it -with the `.info' extension. - - Some operating systems cannot handle long file names. You can run -into a problem even when the file name you specify is itself short -enough. This occurs because the Info formatters split a long Info file -into short indirect subfiles, and name them by appending `-1', `-2', -..., `-10', `-11', and so on, to the original file name. (*Note Tag -Files and Split Files: Tag and Split Files.) The subfile name -`texinfo.info-10', for example, is too long for some systems; so the -Info file name for this document is `texinfo' rather than -`texinfo.info'. - - The Info formatting commands ignore everything written before the -`@setfilename' line, which is why the very first line of the file (the -`\input' line) does not show up in the output. - - The `@setfilename' line produces no output when you typeset a manual -with TeX, but it nevertheless is essential: it opens the index, -cross-reference, and other auxiliary files used by Texinfo, and also -reads `texinfo.cnf' if that file is present on your system (*note -Preparing to Use TeX: Preparing for TeX.). - - -File: texinfo.info, Node: settitle, Next: setchapternewpage, Prev: setfilename, Up: Header - -`@settitle' ------------ - - In order to be made into a printed manual, a Texinfo file must contain -a line that looks like this: - - @settitle TITLE - - Write the `@settitle' command at the beginning of a line and follow -it on the same line by the title. This tells TeX the title to use in a -header or footer. Do not write anything else on the line; anything on -the line after the command is considered part of the title, including a -comment. - - Conventionally, when TeX formats a Texinfo file for double-sided -output, the title is printed in the left-hand (even-numbered) page -headings and the current chapter title is printed in the right-hand -(odd-numbered) page headings. (TeX learns the title of each chapter -from each `@chapter' command.) Page footers are not printed. - - Even if you are printing in a single-sided style, TeX looks for an -`@settitle' command line, in case you include the manual title in the -heading. - - The `@settitle' command should precede everything that generates -actual output in TeX. - - Although the title in the `@settitle' command is usually the same as -the title on the title page, it does not affect the title as it appears -on the title page. Thus, the two do not need not match exactly; and -the title in the `@settitle' command can be a shortened or expanded -version of the title as it appears on the title page. (*Note -`@titlepage': titlepage.) - - TeX prints page headings only for that text that comes after the -`@end titlepage' command in the Texinfo file, or that comes after an -`@headings' command that turns on headings. (*Note The `@headings' -Command: headings on off, for more information.) - - You may, if you wish, create your own, customized headings and -footings. *Note Page Headings: Headings, for a detailed discussion of -this process. - diff --git a/info/widget.info b/info/widget.info index 7e2da86..75b5ce0 100644 --- a/info/widget.info +++ b/info/widget.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/widget.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file widget.texi. +This is ../info/widget.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +widget.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -212,34 +212,34 @@ called "buttons". The default commands for activating a button are: There are several different kind of buttons, all of which are present in the example: -*The Option Field Tags.* +_The Option Field Tags._ When you invoke one of these buttons, you will be asked to choose between a number of different options. This is how you edit an option field. Option fields are created by the `menu-choice' widget. In the example, `Choose' is an option field tag. -*The `[INS]' and `[DEL]' buttons.* +_The `[INS]' and `[DEL]' buttons._ Activating these will insert or delete elements from a editable list. The list is created by the `editable-list' widget. -*Embedded Buttons.* +_Embedded Buttons._ The `_other work_' is an example of an embedded button. Embedded buttons are not associated with a fields, but can serve any purpose, such as implementing hypertext references. They are usually created by the `link' widget. -*The `[ ]' and `[X]' buttons.* +_The `[ ]' and `[X]' buttons._ Activating one of these will convert it to the other. This is useful for implementing multiple-choice fields. You can create it wit -*The `( )' and `(*)' buttons.* +_The `( )' and `(*)' buttons._ Only one radio button in a `radio-button-choice' widget can be selected at any time. When you invoke one of the unselected radio buttons, it will be selected and the previous selected radio button will become unselected. -*The `[Apply Form]' `[Reset Form]' buttons.* +_The `[Apply Form]' `[Reset Form]' buttons._ These are explicit buttons made with the `push-button' widget. The main difference from the `link' widget is that the buttons are will be displayed as GUI buttons when possible. enough. @@ -259,11 +259,11 @@ Navigation buffer, plus you will have these additional commands: `' - - Command: widget-forward &optional COUNT + - Command: widget-forward &optional count Move point COUNT buttons or editing fields forward. `' - - Command: widget-backward &optional COUNT + - Command: widget-backward &optional count Move point COUNT buttons or editing fields backward.  @@ -369,14 +369,14 @@ object. This object can be queried and manipulated by other widget functions, until it is deleted with `widget-delete'. After the widgets have been created, `widget-setup' must be called to enable them. - - Function: widget-create TYPE [ KEYWORD ARGUMENT ]... + - Function: widget-create type [ keyword argument ]... Create and return a widget of type TYPE. The syntax for the TYPE argument is described in *Note Basic Types::. The keyword arguments can be used to overwrite the keyword arguments that are part of TYPE. - - Function: widget-delete WIDGET + - Function: widget-delete widget Delete WIDGET and remove it from the buffer. - Function: widget-setup @@ -480,13 +480,13 @@ widget specific way. Text around %[ %] in the format. These can be - *nil* + _nil_ No text is inserted. - *a string* + _a string_ The string is inserted literally. - *a symbol* + _a symbol_ The value of the symbol is expanded according to this table. `:doc' @@ -545,7 +545,7 @@ widget specific way. The following predefined function can be used: - - Function: widget-children-validate WIDGET + - Function: widget-children-validate widget All the `:children' of WIDGET must be valid. `:tab-order' @@ -800,7 +800,7 @@ arguments. widget after it has been created with the function `widget-radio-add-item'. - - Function: widget-radio-add-item WIDGET TYPE + - Function: widget-radio-add-item widget type Add to `radio-button-choice' widget WIDGET a new radio button item of type TYPE. @@ -1198,15 +1198,15 @@ Properties You can examine or set the value of a widget by using the widget object that was returned by `widget-create'. - - Function: widget-value WIDGET + - Function: widget-value widget Return the current value contained in WIDGET. It is an error to call this function on an uninitialized widget. - - Function: widget-value-set WIDGET VALUE + - Function: widget-value-set widget value Set the value contained in WIDGET to VALUE. It is an error to call this function with an invalid VALUE. - *Important:* You *must* call `widget-setup' after modifying the + *Important:* You _must_ call `widget-setup' after modifying the value of a widget before the user is allowed to edit the widget again. It is enough to call `widget-setup' once if you modify multiple widgets. This is currently only necessary if the widget contains an @@ -1217,22 +1217,22 @@ widget objects, for example a reference to the item being edited, it can be done with `widget-put' and `widget-get'. The property names must begin with a `:'. - - Function: widget-put WIDGET PROPERTY VALUE + - Function: widget-put widget property value In WIDGET set PROPERTY to VALUE. PROPERTY should be a symbol, while VALUE can be anything. - - Function: widget-get WIDGET PROPERTY + - Function: widget-get widget property In WIDGET return the value for PROPERTY. PROPERTY should be a symbol, the value is what was last set by `widget-put' for PROPERTY. - - Function: widget-member WIDGET PROPERTY + - Function: widget-member widget property Non-nil if WIDGET has a value (even nil) for property PROPERTY. Occasionally it can be useful to know which kind of widget you have, i.e. the name of the widget type you gave when the widget was created. - - Function: widget-type WIDGET + - Function: widget-type widget Return the name of WIDGET, a symbol. Widgets can be in two states: active, which means they are @@ -1278,7 +1278,7 @@ you to create a shorthand for more complex widgets, including specifying component widgets and default new default values for the keyword arguments. - - Function: widget-define NAME CLASS DOC &rest ARGS + - Function: widget-define name class doc &rest args Define a new widget type named NAME from `class'. NAME and class should both be symbols, `class' should be one of @@ -1312,10 +1312,10 @@ new widgets: The following predefined functions can be used here: - - Function: widget-types-convert-widget WIDGET + - Function: widget-types-convert-widget widget Convert `:args' as widget types in WIDGET. - - Function: widget-value-convert-widget WIDGET + - Function: widget-value-convert-widget widget Initialize `:value' from `:args' in WIDGET. `:value-to-internal' @@ -1354,7 +1354,7 @@ new widgets: The following predefined function can be used here: - - Function: widget-children-value-delete WIDGET + - Function: widget-children-value-delete widget Delete all `:children' and `:buttons' in WIDGET. `:value-get' @@ -1363,7 +1363,7 @@ new widgets: The following predefined function can be used here: - - Function: widget-value-value-get WIDGET + - Function: widget-value-value-get widget Return the `:value' property of WIDGET. `:format-handler' @@ -1382,7 +1382,7 @@ new widgets: The following predefined function can be used here: - - Function: widget-parent-action WIDGET &optional EVENT + - Function: widget-parent-action widget &optional event Tell `:parent' of WIDGET to handle the `:action'. Optional EVENT is the event that triggered the action. @@ -1450,12 +1450,12 @@ File: widget.info, Node: Utilities, Next: Widget Wishlist, Prev: Widget Minor Utilities. ========== - - Function: widget-prompt-value WIDGET PROMPT [ VALUE UNBOUND ] + - Function: widget-prompt-value widget prompt [ value unbound ] Prompt for a value matching WIDGET, using PROMPT. The current value is assumed to be VALUE, unless UNBOUND is non-nil. - - Function: widget-get-sibling WIDGET + - Function: widget-get-sibling widget Get the item WIDGET is assumed to toggle. This is only meaningful for radio buttons or checkboxes in a list. @@ -1514,39 +1514,40 @@ Wishlist symbol, it should pop up a menu. +  Tag Table: -Node: Top227 -Node: Introduction607 -Node: User Interface4090 -Node: Programming Example8985 -Node: Setting Up the Buffer12302 -Node: Basic Types14019 -Node: link20064 -Node: url-link20578 -Node: info-link20890 -Node: push-button21181 -Node: editable-field21754 -Node: text23093 -Node: menu-choice23391 -Node: radio-button-choice24256 -Node: item25835 -Node: choice-item26223 -Node: toggle26721 -Node: checkbox27446 -Node: checklist27752 -Node: editable-list29196 -Node: group30378 -Node: Sexp Types30665 -Node: constants30978 -Node: generic32057 -Node: atoms32590 -Node: composite34537 -Node: Widget Properties37003 -Node: Defining New Widgets40066 -Node: Widget Browser45366 -Node: Widget Minor Mode46224 -Node: Utilities46781 -Node: Widget Wishlist47262 +Node: Top201 +Node: Introduction581 +Node: User Interface4064 +Node: Programming Example8959 +Node: Setting Up the Buffer12276 +Node: Basic Types13993 +Node: link20038 +Node: url-link20552 +Node: info-link20864 +Node: push-button21155 +Node: editable-field21728 +Node: text23067 +Node: menu-choice23365 +Node: radio-button-choice24230 +Node: item25809 +Node: choice-item26197 +Node: toggle26695 +Node: checkbox27420 +Node: checklist27726 +Node: editable-list29170 +Node: group30352 +Node: Sexp Types30639 +Node: constants30952 +Node: generic32031 +Node: atoms32564 +Node: composite34511 +Node: Widget Properties36977 +Node: Defining New Widgets40040 +Node: Widget Browser45340 +Node: Widget Minor Mode46198 +Node: Utilities46755 +Node: Widget Wishlist47236  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/xemacs-faq.info b/info/xemacs-faq.info index cf12847..981e994 100644 --- a/info/xemacs-faq.info +++ b/info/xemacs-faq.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/xemacs-faq.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs-faq.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs-faq.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs-faq.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -8,241 +8,242 @@ END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY  Indirect: -xemacs-faq.info-1: 221 -xemacs-faq.info-2: 48809 -xemacs-faq.info-3: 95901 -xemacs-faq.info-4: 145739 -xemacs-faq.info-5: 195532 +xemacs-faq.info-1: 195 +xemacs-faq.info-2: 48836 +xemacs-faq.info-3: 95929 +xemacs-faq.info-4: 145764 +xemacs-faq.info-5: 195594  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top221 -Node: Introduction15614 -Node: Q1.0.119134 -Node: Q1.0.219670 -Node: Q1.0.320106 -Node: Q1.0.420364 -Node: Q1.0.521796 -Node: Q1.0.622485 -Node: Q1.0.723616 -Node: Q1.0.824015 -Node: Q1.0.924211 -Node: Q1.0.1024489 -Node: Q1.0.1125938 -Node: Q1.0.1226395 -Node: Q1.0.1326763 -Node: Q1.0.1426998 -Node: Q1.1.127542 -Node: Q1.1.228737 -Node: Q1.1.329112 -Node: Q1.2.130060 -Node: Q1.2.231120 -Node: Q1.2.331550 -Node: Q1.3.132501 -Node: Q1.3.236419 -Node: Q1.3.337128 -Node: Q1.3.437370 -Node: Q1.3.538134 -Node: Q1.3.640549 -Node: Q1.3.742044 -Node: Q1.4.142979 -Node: Q1.4.243849 -Node: Q1.4.344190 -Node: Q1.4.444832 -Node: Q1.4.546372 -Node: Q1.4.646676 -Node: Q1.4.747684 -Node: Installation48809 -Node: Q2.0.151217 -Node: Q2.0.252090 -Node: Q2.0.359300 -Node: Q2.0.460598 -Node: Q2.0.561187 -Node: Q2.0.661555 -Node: Q2.0.761936 -Node: Q2.0.862317 -Node: Q2.0.963892 -Node: Q2.0.1065330 -Node: Q2.0.1166174 -Node: Q2.0.1267115 -Node: Q2.0.1368638 -Node: Q2.0.1469296 -Node: Q2.1.169864 -Node: Q2.1.272606 -Node: Q2.1.373783 -Node: Q2.1.475076 -Node: Q2.1.575875 -Node: Q2.1.676237 -Node: Q2.1.776714 -Node: Q2.1.877067 -Node: Q2.1.978583 -Node: Q2.1.1079005 -Node: Q2.1.1179762 -Node: Q2.1.1280627 -Node: Q2.1.1381582 -Node: Q2.1.1482613 -Node: Q2.1.1583721 -Node: Q2.1.1689678 -Node: Q2.1.1790356 -Node: Q2.1.1890953 -Node: Q2.1.1992750 -Node: Q2.1.2093280 -Node: Q2.1.2193662 -Node: Q2.1.2293952 -Node: Q2.1.2395249 -Node: Customization95901 -Node: Q3.0.1100795 -Node: Q3.0.2101501 -Node: Q3.0.3102065 -Node: Q3.0.4102482 -Node: Q3.0.5103315 -Node: Q3.0.6104096 -Node: Q3.0.7104676 -Node: Q3.0.8105340 -Node: Q3.0.9106186 -Node: Q3.1.1106747 -Node: Q3.1.2107484 -Node: Q3.1.3107915 -Node: Q3.1.4108500 -Node: Q3.1.5109036 -Node: Q3.1.6109420 -Node: Q3.1.7110101 -Node: Q3.1.8112325 -Node: Q3.2.1112864 -Node: Q3.2.2114272 -Node: Q3.2.3115071 -Node: Q3.2.4115673 -Node: Q3.2.5116707 -Node: Q3.2.6117174 -Node: Q3.3.1118136 -Node: Q3.3.2118529 -Node: Q3.3.3119160 -Node: Q3.3.4119541 -Node: Q3.3.5120635 -Node: Q3.4.1122129 -Node: Q3.4.2122772 -Node: Q3.5.1123284 -Node: Q3.5.2124739 -Node: Q3.5.3125157 -Node: Q3.5.4125998 -Node: Q3.5.5126830 -Node: Q3.5.6127970 -Node: Q3.5.7128960 -Node: Q3.5.8130312 -Node: Q3.5.9131059 -Node: Q3.5.10131839 -Node: Q3.5.11132472 -Node: Q3.6.1133025 -Node: Q3.6.2133765 -Node: Q3.6.3134193 -Node: Q3.7.1134693 -Node: Q3.7.2135581 -Node: Q3.7.3136240 -Node: Q3.7.4136662 -Node: Q3.7.5137005 -Node: Q3.7.6137473 -Node: Q3.7.7138188 -Node: Q3.7.8139208 -Node: Q3.8.1139627 -Node: Q3.8.2140087 -Node: Q3.8.3140550 -Node: Q3.8.4141156 -Node: Q3.8.5141875 -Node: Q3.9.1142660 -Node: Q3.9.2143600 -Node: Q3.9.3144198 -Node: Q3.9.4144860 -Node: Q3.10.1145739 -Node: Q3.10.2146557 -Node: Q3.10.3147338 -Node: Q3.10.4148066 -Node: Q3.10.5148449 -Node: Subsystems149459 -Node: Q4.0.1151874 -Node: Q4.0.2152399 -Node: Q4.0.3152957 -Node: Q4.0.4153278 -Node: Q4.0.5153520 -Node: Q4.0.6153751 -Node: Q4.0.7154329 -Node: Q4.0.8154654 -Node: Q4.0.9155881 -Node: Q4.0.10157919 -Node: Q4.0.11158373 -Node: Q4.0.12159223 -Node: Q4.1.1160196 -Node: Q4.1.2160599 -Node: Q4.1.3160926 -Node: Q4.2.1161235 -Node: Q4.2.2161865 -Node: Q4.2.3162105 -Node: Q4.2.4162649 -Node: Q4.3.1163302 -Node: Q4.3.2163886 -Node: Q4.3.3165602 -Node: Q4.3.4165871 -Node: Q4.3.5166560 -Node: Q4.4.1167188 -Node: Q4.5.1168695 -Node: Q4.6.1169464 -Node: Q4.7.1174724 -Node: Q4.7.2175679 -Node: Q4.7.3175976 -Node: Q4.7.4176322 -Node: Q4.7.5177206 -Node: Q4.7.6178848 -Node: Miscellaneous179397 -Node: Q5.0.1182823 -Node: Q5.0.2183557 -Node: Q5.0.3184411 -Node: Q5.0.4185113 -Node: Q5.0.5186053 -Node: Q5.0.6188033 -Node: Q5.0.7188690 -Node: Q5.0.8189295 -Node: Q5.0.9189814 -Node: Q5.0.10190328 -Node: Q5.0.11190576 -Node: Q5.0.12191137 -Node: Q5.0.13192054 -Node: Q5.0.14192738 -Node: Q5.0.15193503 -Node: Q5.0.16193804 -Node: Q5.0.17194316 -Node: Q5.0.18194581 -Node: Q5.0.19195107 -Node: Q5.0.20195532 -Node: Q5.1.1196447 -Node: Q5.1.2198516 -Node: Q5.1.3199252 -Node: Q5.1.4202646 -Node: Q5.1.5203181 -Node: Q5.1.6205275 -Node: Q5.1.7206664 -Node: Q5.1.8208265 -Node: Q5.1.9208817 -Node: Q5.1.10209702 -Node: Q5.1.11210833 -Node: Q5.2.1211379 -Node: Q5.2.2211950 -Node: Q5.2.3212367 -Node: Q5.2.4212602 -Node: Q5.3.1213512 -Node: Q5.3.2214733 -Node: Q5.3.3215509 -Node: Q5.3.4215993 -Node: Q5.3.5216660 -Node: Q5.3.6217529 -Node: Q5.3.7217774 -Node: Q5.3.8219964 -Node: Q5.3.9220211 -Node: Q5.3.10221164 -Node: Q5.3.11223359 -Node: Q5.3.12224908 -Node: Current Events226182 -Node: Q6.0.1226839 -Node: Q6.0.2227478 -Node: Q6.0.3228552 -Node: Q6.0.4228780 +Node: Top195 +Node: Introduction15648 +Node: Q1.0.119167 +Node: Q1.0.219703 +Node: Q1.0.320139 +Node: Q1.0.420397 +Node: Q1.0.521829 +Node: Q1.0.622518 +Node: Q1.0.723649 +Node: Q1.0.824048 +Node: Q1.0.924244 +Node: Q1.0.1024522 +Node: Q1.0.1125971 +Node: Q1.0.1226428 +Node: Q1.0.1326796 +Node: Q1.0.1427031 +Node: Q1.1.127575 +Node: Q1.1.228770 +Node: Q1.1.329145 +Node: Q1.2.130096 +Node: Q1.2.231152 +Node: Q1.2.331586 +Node: Q1.3.132537 +Node: Q1.3.236455 +Node: Q1.3.337164 +Node: Q1.3.437405 +Node: Q1.3.538169 +Node: Q1.3.640584 +Node: Q1.3.742079 +Node: Q1.4.143014 +Node: Q1.4.243876 +Node: Q1.4.344217 +Node: Q1.4.444859 +Node: Q1.4.546399 +Node: Q1.4.646703 +Node: Q1.4.747711 +Node: Installation48836 +Node: Q2.0.151242 +Node: Q2.0.252115 +Node: Q2.0.359318 +Node: Q2.0.460616 +Node: Q2.0.561208 +Node: Q2.0.661576 +Node: Q2.0.761957 +Node: Q2.0.862338 +Node: Q2.0.963916 +Node: Q2.0.1065354 +Node: Q2.0.1166198 +Node: Q2.0.1267139 +Node: Q2.0.1368662 +Node: Q2.0.1469320 +Node: Q2.1.169888 +Node: Q2.1.272630 +Node: Q2.1.373807 +Node: Q2.1.475100 +Node: Q2.1.575899 +Node: Q2.1.676261 +Node: Q2.1.776738 +Node: Q2.1.877091 +Node: Q2.1.978607 +Node: Q2.1.1079029 +Node: Q2.1.1179786 +Node: Q2.1.1280651 +Node: Q2.1.1381606 +Node: Q2.1.1482637 +Node: Q2.1.1583748 +Node: Q2.1.1689706 +Node: Q2.1.1790384 +Node: Q2.1.1890981 +Node: Q2.1.1992778 +Node: Q2.1.2093308 +Node: Q2.1.2193690 +Node: Q2.1.2293980 +Node: Q2.1.2395277 +Node: Customization95929 +Node: Q3.0.1100816 +Node: Q3.0.2101522 +Node: Q3.0.3102086 +Node: Q3.0.4102503 +Node: Q3.0.5103336 +Node: Q3.0.6104117 +Node: Q3.0.7104697 +Node: Q3.0.8105361 +Node: Q3.0.9106207 +Node: Q3.1.1106768 +Node: Q3.1.2107505 +Node: Q3.1.3107936 +Node: Q3.1.4108521 +Node: Q3.1.5109057 +Node: Q3.1.6109441 +Node: Q3.1.7110122 +Node: Q3.1.8112346 +Node: Q3.2.1112888 +Node: Q3.2.2114296 +Node: Q3.2.3115095 +Node: Q3.2.4115697 +Node: Q3.2.5116731 +Node: Q3.2.6117198 +Node: Q3.3.1118160 +Node: Q3.3.2118553 +Node: Q3.3.3119184 +Node: Q3.3.4119565 +Node: Q3.3.5120659 +Node: Q3.4.1122153 +Node: Q3.4.2122796 +Node: Q3.5.1123308 +Node: Q3.5.2124762 +Node: Q3.5.3125180 +Node: Q3.5.4126020 +Node: Q3.5.5126852 +Node: Q3.5.6127992 +Node: Q3.5.7128982 +Node: Q3.5.8130334 +Node: Q3.5.9131081 +Node: Q3.5.10131861 +Node: Q3.5.11132497 +Node: Q3.6.1133050 +Node: Q3.6.2133790 +Node: Q3.6.3134218 +Node: Q3.7.1134718 +Node: Q3.7.2135606 +Node: Q3.7.3136265 +Node: Q3.7.4136687 +Node: Q3.7.5137030 +Node: Q3.7.6137498 +Node: Q3.7.7138213 +Node: Q3.7.8139233 +Node: Q3.8.1139652 +Node: Q3.8.2140112 +Node: Q3.8.3140575 +Node: Q3.8.4141181 +Node: Q3.8.5141900 +Node: Q3.9.1142685 +Node: Q3.9.2143625 +Node: Q3.9.3144223 +Node: Q3.9.4144885 +Node: Q3.10.1145764 +Node: Q3.10.2146582 +Node: Q3.10.3147363 +Node: Q3.10.4148091 +Node: Q3.10.5148474 +Node: Subsystems149484 +Node: Q4.0.1151969 +Node: Q4.0.2152494 +Node: Q4.0.3153052 +Node: Q4.0.4153373 +Node: Q4.0.5153615 +Node: Q4.0.6153846 +Node: Q4.0.7154427 +Node: Q4.0.8154752 +Node: Q4.0.9155979 +Node: Q4.0.10158017 +Node: Q4.0.11158471 +Node: Q4.0.12159321 +Node: Q4.1.1160294 +Node: Q4.1.2160697 +Node: Q4.1.3161024 +Node: Q4.2.1161333 +Node: Q4.2.2161963 +Node: Q4.2.3162203 +Node: Q4.2.4162747 +Node: Q4.3.1163400 +Node: Q4.3.2163984 +Node: Q4.3.3165700 +Node: Q4.3.4165972 +Node: Q4.3.5166649 +Node: Q4.4.1167277 +Node: Q4.4.2168777 +Node: Q4.5.1169981 +Node: Q4.6.1170750 +Node: Q4.7.1176010 +Node: Q4.7.2176965 +Node: Q4.7.3177262 +Node: Q4.7.4177608 +Node: Q4.7.5178492 +Node: Q4.7.6180134 +Node: Miscellaneous180678 +Node: Q5.0.1184102 +Node: Q5.0.2184836 +Node: Q5.0.3185690 +Node: Q5.0.4186392 +Node: Q5.0.5187331 +Node: Q5.0.6189311 +Node: Q5.0.7189968 +Node: Q5.0.8190573 +Node: Q5.0.9191092 +Node: Q5.0.10191606 +Node: Q5.0.11191854 +Node: Q5.0.12192415 +Node: Q5.0.13193332 +Node: Q5.0.14194016 +Node: Q5.0.15194781 +Node: Q5.0.16195082 +Node: Q5.0.17195594 +Node: Q5.0.18195859 +Node: Q5.0.19196385 +Node: Q5.0.20196809 +Node: Q5.1.1197724 +Node: Q5.1.2199793 +Node: Q5.1.3200529 +Node: Q5.1.4203923 +Node: Q5.1.5204458 +Node: Q5.1.6206552 +Node: Q5.1.7207941 +Node: Q5.1.8209542 +Node: Q5.1.9210094 +Node: Q5.1.10210979 +Node: Q5.1.11212110 +Node: Q5.2.1212659 +Node: Q5.2.2213230 +Node: Q5.2.3213647 +Node: Q5.2.4213882 +Node: Q5.3.1214792 +Node: Q5.3.2216013 +Node: Q5.3.3216789 +Node: Q5.3.4217273 +Node: Q5.3.5217940 +Node: Q5.3.6218809 +Node: Q5.3.7219054 +Node: Q5.3.8221244 +Node: Q5.3.9221491 +Node: Q5.3.10222444 +Node: Q5.3.11224639 +Node: Q5.3.12226188 +Node: Current Events227462 +Node: Q6.0.1228119 +Node: Q6.0.2228758 +Node: Q6.0.3229832 +Node: Q6.0.4230060  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/xemacs-faq.info-1 b/info/xemacs-faq.info-1 index 4b06ab8..4102ba3 100644 --- a/info/xemacs-faq.info-1 +++ b/info/xemacs-faq.info-1 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/xemacs-faq.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs-faq.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs-faq.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs-faq.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ archives. * Current Events:: What the Future Holds. - -- The Detailed Node Listing -- + --- The Detailed Node Listing --- Introduction, Policy, Credits @@ -120,7 +120,7 @@ Trouble Shooting: * Q2.1.11:: Can't instantiate image error... in toolbar * Q2.1.12:: Regular Expression Problems on DEC OSF1. * Q2.1.13:: HP/UX 10.10 and `create_process' failure -* Q2.1.14:: `C-g' doesn't work for me. Is it broken? +* Q2.1.14:: C-g doesn't work for me. Is it broken? * Q2.1.15:: How to debug an XEmacs problem with a debugger. * Q2.1.16:: XEmacs crashes in `strcat' on HP/UX 10. * Q2.1.17:: `Marker does not point anywhere'. @@ -176,9 +176,9 @@ The Keyboard: * Q3.5.1:: How can I bind complex functions (or macros) to keys? * Q3.5.2:: How can I stop down-arrow from adding empty lines to the bottom of my buffers? * Q3.5.3:: How do I bind C-. and C-; to scroll one line up and down? -* Q3.5.4:: Globally binding `Delete'? +* Q3.5.4:: Globally binding Delete? * Q3.5.5:: Scrolling one line at a time. -* Q3.5.6:: How to map `Help' key alone on Sun type4 keyboard? +* Q3.5.6:: How to map Help key alone on Sun type4 keyboard? * Q3.5.7:: How can you type in special characters in XEmacs? * Q3.5.8:: Why does `(global-set-key [delete-forward] 'delete-char)' complain? * Q3.5.9:: How do I make the Delete key delete forward? @@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ The Mouse and Highlighting: * Q3.7.5:: Why does cut-and-paste not work between XEmacs and a cmdtool? * Q3.7.6:: How I can set XEmacs up so that it pastes where the text cursor is? * Q3.7.7:: How do I select a rectangular region? -* Q3.7.8:: Why does `M-w' take so long? +* Q3.7.8:: Why does M-w take so long? The Menubar and Toolbar: * Q3.8.1:: How do I get rid of the menu (or menubar)? @@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ Text Selections: * Q3.10.1:: How can I turn off or change highlighted selections? * Q3.10.2:: How do I get that typing on an active region removes it? * Q3.10.3:: Can I turn off the highlight during isearch? -* Q3.10.4:: How do I turn off highlighting after `C-x C-p' (mark-page)? +* Q3.10.4:: How do I turn off highlighting after C-x C-p (mark-page)? * Q3.10.5:: The region disappears when I hit the end of buffer while scrolling. Major Subsystems @@ -255,6 +255,7 @@ Other Mail & News: Sparcworks, EOS, and WorkShop: * Q4.4.1:: What is SPARCworks, EOS, and WorkShop +* Q4.4.2:: How do I start the Sun Workshop support in XEmacs 21? Energize: * Q4.5.1:: What is/was Energize? @@ -316,7 +317,7 @@ Miscellaneous: * Q5.3.1:: How do you make XEmacs indent CL if-clauses correctly? * Q5.3.2:: Fontifying hangs when editing a postscript file. * Q5.3.3:: How can I print WYSIWYG a font-locked buffer? -* Q5.3.4:: Getting `M-x lpr' to work with postscript printer. +* Q5.3.4:: Getting M-x lpr to work with postscript printer. * Q5.3.5:: How do I specify the paths that XEmacs uses for finding files? * Q5.3.6:: [This question intentionally left blank] * Q5.3.7:: Can I have the end of the buffer delimited in some way? @@ -346,24 +347,25 @@ considering XEmacs for their own use, or has just obtained it and is wondering what to do next. It is also useful as a reference to available resources. - The previous maintainer of the FAQ was Anthony Rossini , who started it, after getting tired of hearing JWZ complain -about repeatedly having to answer questions. Ben Wing -and Chuck Thompson , the principal authors of -XEmacs, then took over and Ben did a massive update reorganizing the -whole thing. At which point Anthony took back over, but then had to -give it up again. Some of the other contributors to this FAQ are -listed later in this document. + The previous maintainer of the FAQ was Anthony Rossini +, who started it, after getting tired of hearing +JWZ complain about repeatedly having to answer questions. Ben Wing + and Chuck Thompson , the principal +authors of XEmacs, then took over and Ben did a massive update +reorganizing the whole thing. At which point Anthony took back over, +but then had to give it up again. Some of the other contributors to +this FAQ are listed later in this document. The previous version was converted to hypertext format, and edited by -Steven L. Baur . It was converted back to -texinfo by Hrvoje Niksic . +Steven L. Baur . It was converted back to texinfo by +Hrvoje Niksic . The FAQ was then maintained by Andreas Kaempf , -who passed it on to Christian Nybo/ , the current FAQ +who passed it on to Christian Nyb/o , the current FAQ maintainer. If you notice any errors or items which should be added or amended to -this FAQ please send email to Christian Nybo/ . Include +this FAQ please send email to Christian Nyb/o . Include `XEmacs FAQ' on the Subject: line. * Menu: @@ -584,7 +586,8 @@ File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q1.0.10, Next: Q1.0.11, Prev: Q1.0.9, Up: Intro Q1.0.10: Is there a port of XEmacs to Microsoft ('95 or NT)? ------------------------------------------------------------ - Thanks to efforts of many people, coordinated by David Hobley and Marc Paquette , beta versions of + Thanks to efforts of many people, coordinated by David Hobley + and Marc Paquette , beta versions of XEmacs now run on 32-bit Windows platforms (NT and 95). The current betas require having an X server to run XEmacs; however, a native NT/95 port is in alpha, thanks to Jonathan Harris . @@ -601,7 +604,9 @@ mail to to subscribe. Furthermore, Altrasoft is seeking corporate and government sponsors to help fund a fully native port of XEmacs to Windows 95 and NT using full-time, senior-level staff working under a professionally managed -project structure. See the Altrasoft web site (http://www.altrasoft.com/) for more details or contact Altrasoft directly at 1-888-ALTSOFT. +project structure. See the Altrasoft web site +(http://www.altrasoft.com/) for more details or contact Altrasoft +directly at 1-888-ALTSOFT. The closest existing port is "Win-Emacs", which is based on Lucid Emacs 19.6. Available from `http://www.pearlsoft.com/'. @@ -619,8 +624,8 @@ Q1.0.11: Is there a port of XEmacs to the Macintosh? but no patches have been submitted to the maintainers to get this in the mainstream distribution. - For the MacOS, there is a port of -Emacs 18.59 (ftp://ftp.cs.cornell.edu/pub/parmet/). + For the MacOS, there is a port of Emacs 18.59 +(ftp://ftp.cs.cornell.edu/pub/parmet/).  File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q1.0.12, Next: Q1.0.13, Prev: Q1.0.11, Up: Introduction @@ -671,7 +676,8 @@ purpose are defined as the 5th of the month through the 5th of the month. Preexisting questions that have been changed are marked as such. Brand new questions are tagged. - All submissions are welcome. E-mail submissions to Christian Nybo/ . + All submissions are welcome. E-mail submissions to Christian Nyb/o +. Please make sure that `XEmacs FAQ' appears on the Subject: line. If you think you have a better way of answering a question, or think a @@ -701,7 +707,7 @@ File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q1.1.3, Next: Q1.2.1, Prev: Q1.1.2, Up: Introdu Q1.1.3: How do I contribute to XEmacs itself? --------------------------------------------- - Ben Wing writes: + Ben Wing writes: BTW if you have a wish list of things that you want added, you have to speak up about it! More specifically, you can do the @@ -738,9 +744,10 @@ developers responsible for the 19.16/20.x releases are: * Martin Buchholz - * Steve Baur + * Steve Baur + + * Hrvoje Niksic - * Hrvoje Niksic The developers responsible for the 19.14 release are: @@ -749,9 +756,10 @@ developers responsible for the 19.16/20.x releases are: Chuck was Mr. XEmacs from 19.11 through 19.14, and is responsible for XEmacs becoming a widely distributed program over the Internet. - * Ben Wing + * Ben Wing + - * Jamie Zawinski + * Jamie Zawinski Jamie Zawinski was Mr. Lucid Emacs from 19.0 through 19.10, the last release actually named Lucid Emacs. Richard Mlynarik was @@ -773,10 +781,11 @@ this version of the FAQ (listed in alphabetical order): * SL Baur - * Hrvoje Niksic + * Hrvoje Niksic * Aki Vehtari +  File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q1.2.3, Next: Q1.3.1, Prev: Q1.2.2, Up: Introduction @@ -834,7 +843,7 @@ in February 1998. When compiled without MULE support, 20.4 is approximately as stable as 19.16, and probably faster (due to additional optimization work.) - As of XEmacs 20.3, version 20 is *the* supported version of XEmacs. + As of XEmacs 20.3, version 20 is _the_ supported version of XEmacs. This means that 19.16 will optionally receive stability fixes (if any), but that all the real development work will be done on the v20 tree. @@ -879,7 +888,7 @@ for your convenience. characters. If XEmacs was not compiled with MULE support, the range of this integer will always be 0 to 255 - eight bits, or one byte. (Integers outside this range are accepted but silently - truncated; however, you should most decidedly *not* rely on this, + truncated; however, you should most decidedly _not_ rely on this, because it will not work under XEmacs with MULE support.) When MULE support is present, the range of character codes is much larger. (Currently, 19 bits are used.) @@ -892,7 +901,7 @@ for your convenience. XEmacs. Individual characters are not often used in programs. It is far - more common to work with *strings*, which are sequences composed of + more common to work with _strings_, which are sequences composed of characters.  @@ -919,7 +928,7 @@ File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q1.3.3, Next: Q1.3.4, Prev: Q1.3.2, Up: Introdu Q1.3.3: How do I type non-ASCII characters? ------------------------------------------- - See question 3.5.7 (*note Q3.5.7::.) in part 3 of this FAQ. + See question 3.5.7 (*note Q3.5.7::) in part 3 of this FAQ.  File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q1.3.4, Next: Q1.3.5, Prev: Q1.3.3, Up: Introduction @@ -928,8 +937,8 @@ Q1.3.4: Can XEmacs messages come out in a different language? ------------------------------------------------------------- The message-catalog support has mostly been written but doesn't -currently work. The first release of XEmacs 20 will *not* support it. -However, menubar localization *does* work, even in 19.14. To enable +currently work. The first release of XEmacs 20 will _not_ support it. +However, menubar localization _does_ work, even in 19.14. To enable it, add to your `Emacs' file entries like this: Emacs*XlwMenu.resourceLabels: True @@ -1075,9 +1084,9 @@ directory called `sample.emacs'. Copy this file from there to your home directory and rename it `.emacs'. Then edit it to suit. Starting with 19.14, you may bring the `sample.emacs' into an XEmacs -buffer by selecting `Help->Samples->Sample .emacs' from the menubar. -To determine the location of the `etc' directory type the command `C-h -v data-directory '. +buffer by selecting `Help->Sample .emacs' from the menubar. To +determine the location of the `etc' directory type the command `C-h v +data-directory '.  File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q1.4.2, Next: Q1.4.3, Prev: Q1.4.1, Up: Introduction diff --git a/info/xemacs-faq.info-2 b/info/xemacs-faq.info-2 index 5f5d1e5..08629dc 100644 --- a/info/xemacs-faq.info-2 +++ b/info/xemacs-faq.info-2 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../info/xemacs-faq.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs-faq.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs-faq.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs-faq.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ Trouble Shooting: * Q2.1.11:: Can't instantiate image error... in toolbar * Q2.1.12:: Regular Expression Problems on DEC OSF1. * Q2.1.13:: HP/UX 10.10 and `create_process' failure -* Q2.1.14:: `C-g' doesn't work for me. Is it broken? +* Q2.1.14:: C-g doesn't work for me. Is it broken? * Q2.1.15:: How to debug an XEmacs problem with a debugger. * Q2.1.16:: XEmacs crashes in `strcat' on HP/UX 10. * Q2.1.17:: `Marker does not point anywhere'. @@ -93,7 +93,7 @@ Q2.0.2: XEmacs is too big Although this entry has been written for XEmacs 19.13, most of it still stands true. - Steve Baur writes: + Steve Baur writes: The 45MB of space required by the installation directories can be reduced dramatically if desired. Gzip all the .el files. Remove @@ -180,15 +180,15 @@ still stands true. These are all Emacs Lisp source code and bytecompiled object code. You may safely gzip everything named *.el here. You may remove - any package you don't use. *Nothing bad will happen if you delete - a package that you do not use*. You must be sure you do not use + any package you don't use. _Nothing bad will happen if you delete + a package that you do not use_. You must be sure you do not use it though, so be conservative at first. Possible candidates for deletion include w3 (newer versions exist, or you may just use Lynx or Netscape for web browsing), games, hyperbole, mh-e, hm-html-menus (better packages exist), vm, viper, - oobr, gnus (new versions exist), etc. Ask yourself, *Do I ever - want to use this package?* If the answer is no, then it is a + oobr, gnus (new versions exist), etc. Ask yourself, _Do I ever + want to use this package?_ If the answer is no, then it is a candidate for removal. First, gzip all the .el files. Then go about package by package @@ -295,7 +295,7 @@ libc 5.2.18, XEmacs 20.0b20 is unable to open a tty device: Initialization error: Terminal type `xterm' undefined (or can't access database?) - Ben Wing writes: + Ben Wing writes: Your ncurses configuration is messed up. Your /usr/lib/terminfo is a bad pointer, perhaps to a CD-ROM that is not inserted. @@ -351,14 +351,14 @@ ELF libraries are out of date. You have the following options: 3. Rebuild XEmacs yourself - any working ELF version of libc should be O.K. - Hrvoje Niksic writes: + Hrvoje Niksic writes: Why not use a Perl one-liner for No. 2? perl -pi -e 's/_h_errno\0/h_errno\0\0/g' \ /usr/local/bin/xemacs-19.14 - NB: You *must* patch `/usr/local/bin/xemacs-19.14', and not + NB: You _must_ patch `/usr/local/bin/xemacs-19.14', and not `xemacs' because `xemacs' is a link to `xemacs-19.14'; the Perl `-i' option will cause unwanted side-effects if applied to a symbolic link. @@ -409,8 +409,8 @@ PNG Compface `ftp://ftp.cs.indiana.edu/pub/faces/compface/'. This library has been frozen for about 6 years, and is distributed without version - numbers. *It should be compiled with the same options that X11 was - compiled with on your system*. The version of this library at + numbers. _It should be compiled with the same options that X11 was + compiled with on your system_. The version of this library at XEmacs.org includes the `xbm2xface.pl' script, written by , which may be useful when generating your own xface. @@ -889,7 +889,7 @@ File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q2.1.14, Next: Q2.1.15, Prev: Q2.1.13, Up: Inst Q2.1.14: `C-g' doesn't work for me. Is it broken? -------------------------------------------------- - Ben Wing writes: + Ben Wing writes: `C-g' does work for most people in most circumstances. If it doesn't, there are only two explanations: @@ -905,7 +905,7 @@ Q2.1.14: `C-g' doesn't work for me. Is it broken? Morten Welinder writes: - On some (but *not* all) machines a hung XEmacs can be revived by + On some (but _not_ all) machines a hung XEmacs can be revived by `kill -FPE '. This is a hack, of course, not a solution. This technique works on a Sun4 running 4.1.3_U1. To see if it works for you, start another XEmacs and test with that first. If @@ -1033,6 +1033,7 @@ debugger. Here are some hints: `gdbinit' files provided in the `src' directory. Use the one corresponding to the configure options used when building XEmacs. +  File: xemacs-faq.info, Node: Q2.1.16, Next: Q2.1.17, Prev: Q2.1.15, Up: Installation @@ -1100,12 +1101,12 @@ Q2.1.18: 19.14 hangs on HP/UX 10.10. Apparently somebody has found the reason why there is this `poll: interrupted...' message for each event. For some reason, libcurses reimplements a `select()' system call, in a highly broken fashion. - The fix is to add a -lc to the link line *before* the -lxcurses. + The fix is to add a -lc to the link line _before_ the -lxcurses. XEmacs will then use the right version of `select()'. Alain Fauconnet writes: - The *real* solution is to *not* link -lcurses in! I just changed + The _real_ solution is to _not_ link -lcurses in! I just changed -lcurses to -ltermcap in the Makefile and it fixed: 1. The `poll: interrupted system call' message. @@ -1113,7 +1114,7 @@ Q2.1.18: 19.14 hangs on HP/UX 10.10. 2. A more serious problem I had discovered in the meantime, that is the fact that subprocess handling was seriously broken: subprocesses e.g. started by AUC TeX for TeX compilation of a - buffer would *hang*. Actually they would wait forever for + buffer would _hang_. Actually they would wait forever for emacs to read the socket which connects stdout...  diff --git a/info/xemacs.info b/info/xemacs.info index bb32bf7..5854c42 100644 --- a/info/xemacs.info +++ b/info/xemacs.info @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/xemacs.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs/xemacs.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -31,367 +31,368 @@ translation approved by the author instead of in the original English.  Indirect: -xemacs.info-1: 1372 -xemacs.info-2: 47958 -xemacs.info-3: 95918 -xemacs.info-4: 144030 -xemacs.info-5: 192248 -xemacs.info-6: 241615 -xemacs.info-7: 290442 -xemacs.info-8: 339995 -xemacs.info-9: 385290 -xemacs.info-10: 433122 -xemacs.info-11: 482303 -xemacs.info-12: 528200 -xemacs.info-13: 577026 -xemacs.info-14: 625173 -xemacs.info-15: 673936 -xemacs.info-16: 723464 -xemacs.info-17: 772031 -xemacs.info-18: 815954 -xemacs.info-19: 857130 -xemacs.info-20: 905126 -xemacs.info-21: 945846 +xemacs.info-1: 1350 +xemacs.info-2: 47938 +xemacs.info-3: 95895 +xemacs.info-4: 143994 +xemacs.info-5: 192193 +xemacs.info-6: 241558 +xemacs.info-7: 290374 +xemacs.info-8: 339917 +xemacs.info-9: 385196 +xemacs.info-10: 433020 +xemacs.info-11: 482190 +xemacs.info-12: 531339 +xemacs.info-13: 580163 +xemacs.info-14: 628304 +xemacs.info-15: 677058 +xemacs.info-16: 726583 +xemacs.info-17: 775144 +xemacs.info-18: 819062 +xemacs.info-19: 860225 +xemacs.info-20: 908221 +xemacs.info-21: 948941  Tag Table: (Indirect) -Node: Top1372 -Node: License22524 -Node: Distrib35806 -Node: Intro37470 -Node: Frame40341 -Node: Point43613 -Node: Echo Area45580 -Node: Mode Line47958 -Node: XEmacs under X52389 -Node: Keystrokes55567 -Node: Intro to Keystrokes56411 -Node: Representing Keystrokes58514 -Node: Key Sequences59871 -Node: String Key Sequences63211 -Node: Meta Key63594 -Node: Super and Hyper Keys65067 -Node: Character Representation71291 -Node: Commands72311 -Node: Pull-down Menus75160 -Node: File Menu78509 -Node: Edit Menu82331 -Node: Apps Menu84716 -Node: Options Menu85206 -Node: Buffers Menu89186 -Node: Tools Menu89493 -Node: Help Menu89984 -Node: Menu Customization90385 -Node: Entering Emacs94615 -Node: Exiting95918 -Node: Command Switches99010 -Node: Startup Paths108199 -Node: Basic115775 -Node: Blank Lines125258 -Node: Continuation Lines126684 -Node: Position Info128118 -Node: Arguments131252 -Node: Undo134389 -Node: Minibuffer137336 -Node: Minibuffer File139820 -Node: Minibuffer Edit141457 -Node: Completion144030 -Node: Repetition150905 -Node: M-x153697 -Node: Help158791 -Node: Mark168713 -Node: Setting Mark170567 -Node: Using Region173689 -Node: Marking Objects174434 -Node: Mark Ring176275 -Node: Mouse Selection177991 -Node: Additional Mouse Operations179999 -Node: Killing184203 -Node: Yanking189843 -Node: Kill Ring190646 -Node: Appending Kills192248 -Node: Earlier Kills194285 -Node: Using X Selections196898 -Node: X Clipboard Selection198148 -Node: X Selection Commands200325 -Node: X Cut Buffers201411 -Node: Active Regions202770 -Node: Accumulating Text207350 -Node: Rectangles210423 -Node: Registers213942 -Node: RegPos214977 -Node: RegText215880 -Node: RegRect216964 -Node: Display217704 -Node: Scrolling219199 -Node: Horizontal Scrolling223342 -Node: Selective Display224538 -Node: Display Vars225757 -Node: Search228435 -Node: Incremental Search229628 -Node: Non-Incremental Search238555 -Node: Word Search239997 -Node: Regexp Search241615 -Node: Regexps243151 -Node: Search Case253452 -Node: Replace254233 -Node: Unconditional Replace255181 -Node: Regexp Replace256317 -Node: Replacement and Case257252 -Node: Query Replace258232 -Node: Other Repeating Search261465 -Node: Fixit262720 -Node: Kill Errors263300 -Node: Transpose264633 -Node: Fixing Case267038 -Node: Spelling267684 -Node: Files269145 -Node: File Names270453 -Node: Visiting274791 -Node: Saving281481 -Node: Backup286404 -Node: Backup Names287800 -Node: Backup Deletion289283 -Node: Backup Copying290442 -Node: Interlocking292149 -Node: Reverting296277 -Node: Auto Save298190 -Node: Auto Save Files299157 -Node: Auto Save Control300998 -Node: Recover302837 -Node: Version Control303992 -Node: Concepts of VC306030 -Node: Editing with VC307640 -Node: Variables for Check-in/out312896 -Node: Log Entries314795 -Node: Change Logs and VC315975 -Node: Old Versions319243 -Node: VC Status321247 -Node: Renaming and VC322961 -Node: Snapshots323642 -Node: Making Snapshots324143 -Node: Snapshot Caveats325437 -Node: Version Headers327246 -Node: ListDir329945 -Node: Comparing Files331994 -Node: Dired333527 -Node: Dired Enter334198 -Node: Dired Edit335023 -Node: Dired Deletion336770 -Node: Dired Immed339995 -Node: Misc File Ops341271 -Node: Buffers343760 -Node: Select Buffer345920 -Node: List Buffers347717 -Node: Misc Buffer349463 -Node: Kill Buffer351107 -Node: Several Buffers352237 -Node: Windows356103 -Node: Basic Window356814 -Node: Split Window358533 -Node: Other Window360666 -Node: Pop Up Window363096 -Node: Change Window364603 -Node: Mule367511 -Node: Mule Intro368774 -Node: Language Environments369790 -Node: Input Methods371898 -Node: Select Input Method375618 -Node: Coding Systems377773 -Node: Recognize Coding381961 -Node: Specify Coding385290 -Node: Major Modes390221 -Node: Choosing Modes392443 -Node: Indentation394833 -Node: Indentation Commands396928 -Node: Tab Stops399657 -Node: Just Spaces401506 -Node: Text402321 -Node: Text Mode404304 -Node: Nroff Mode406385 -Node: TeX Mode408029 -Node: TeX Editing410281 -Node: TeX Print413716 -Node: Outline Mode416936 -Node: Outline Format418417 -Node: Outline Motion421217 -Node: Outline Visibility422770 -Node: Words425691 -Node: Sentences428638 -Node: Paragraphs430834 -Node: Pages433122 -Node: Filling435722 -Node: Auto Fill436293 -Node: Fill Commands438441 -Node: Fill Prefix440607 -Node: Case442795 -Node: Programs444823 -Node: Program Modes447381 -Node: Lists449613 -Node: Defuns455453 -Node: Grinding458106 -Node: Basic Indent458734 -Node: Multi-line Indent460755 -Node: Lisp Indent462371 -Node: C Indent465821 -Node: Matching471061 -Node: Comments472583 -Node: Balanced Editing479035 -Node: Lisp Completion480049 -Node: Documentation481064 -Node: Change Log482303 -Node: Tags484881 -Node: Tag Syntax486458 -Node: Create Tags Table489832 -Node: Select Tags Table495930 -Node: Find Tag499672 -Node: Tags Search502636 -Node: List Tags506093 -Node: Fortran507122 -Node: Fortran Motion508198 -Node: Fortran Indent509018 -Node: ForIndent Commands509703 -Node: ForIndent Num510848 -Node: ForIndent Conv512122 -Node: ForIndent Vars512898 -Node: Fortran Comments514066 -Node: Fortran Columns517665 -Node: Fortran Abbrev519088 -Node: Asm Mode519998 -Node: Running520550 -Node: Compilation521520 -Node: Lisp Modes526371 -Node: Lisp Libraries527645 -Node: Loading528200 -Node: Compiling Libraries532660 -Node: Mocklisp535551 -Node: Lisp Eval536228 -Node: Lisp Debug539868 -Node: Lisp Interaction545294 -Node: External Lisp546649 -Node: Packages548724 -Node: Package Terminology549465 -Node: Using Packages550823 -Node: Building Packages559612 -Node: Abbrevs562134 -Node: Defining Abbrevs564334 -Node: Expanding Abbrevs566781 -Node: Editing Abbrevs569483 -Node: Saving Abbrevs571351 -Node: Dynamic Abbrevs573291 -Node: Picture574593 -Node: Basic Picture577026 -Node: Insert in Picture579313 -Node: Tabs in Picture580735 -Node: Rectangles in Picture582256 -Node: Sending Mail584165 -Node: Mail Format585876 -Node: Mail Headers587226 -Node: Mail Mode593636 -Node: Reading Mail597249 -Node: Calendar/Diary598824 -Node: Calendar Motion600496 -Node: Calendar Unit Motion601379 -Node: Move to Beginning or End603702 -Node: Specified Dates604835 -Node: Scroll Calendar605724 -Node: Mark and Region607515 -Node: General Calendar609422 -Node: LaTeX Calendar611030 -Node: Holidays613044 -Node: Sunrise/Sunset616147 -Node: Lunar Phases619190 -Node: Other Calendars620575 -Node: Calendar Systems622062 -Node: To Other Calendar625173 -Node: From Other Calendar627164 -Node: Mayan Calendar629470 -Node: Diary632666 -Node: Diary Commands634416 -Node: Format of Diary File637725 -Node: Date Formats640595 -Node: Adding to Diary643169 -Node: Special Diary Entries644800 -Node: Calendar Customization650140 -Node: Calendar Customizing651002 -Node: Holiday Customizing654222 -Node: Date Display Format660690 -Node: Time Display Format661648 -Node: Daylight Savings662786 -Node: Diary Customizing665974 -Node: Hebrew/Islamic Entries670596 -Node: Fancy Diary Display673936 -Node: Included Diary Files675833 -Node: Sexp Diary Entries676814 -Node: Appt Customizing681904 -Node: Sorting682950 -Node: Shell687756 -Node: Single Shell689049 -Node: Interactive Shell690648 -Node: Shell Mode694413 -Node: Terminal emulator696904 -Node: Term Mode699214 -Node: Paging in Term700128 -Node: Narrowing700926 -Node: Hardcopy702876 -Node: Recursive Edit703848 -Node: Dissociated Press706835 -Node: CONX709398 -Node: Amusements710422 -Node: Emulation710902 -Node: Customization712746 -Node: Minor Modes714470 -Node: Variables716102 -Node: Examining718060 -Node: Easy Customization719521 -Node: Customization Groups720535 -Node: Changing an Option723464 -Node: Face Customization729720 -Node: Specific Customization731485 -Node: Edit Options734092 -Node: Locals735676 -Node: File Variables738855 -Node: Keyboard Macros743382 -Node: Basic Kbd Macro745553 -Node: Save Kbd Macro747485 -Node: Kbd Macro Query749157 -Node: Key Bindings751099 -Node: Keymaps751973 -Node: Rebinding755823 -Node: Interactive Rebinding756519 -Node: Programmatic Rebinding758711 -Node: Key Bindings Using Strings761518 -Node: Disabling763124 -Node: Syntax764896 -Node: Syntax Entry765777 -Node: Syntax Change769861 -Node: Init File772031 -Node: Init Syntax773539 -Node: Init Examples775892 -Node: Terminal Init780083 -Node: Audible Bell781793 -Node: Faces785224 -Node: X Resources790061 -Node: Geometry Resources791682 -Node: Iconic Resources794130 -Node: Resource List794602 -Node: Face Resources801109 -Node: Widgets804786 -Node: Menubar Resources805725 -Node: Quitting806658 -Node: Lossage809637 -Node: Stuck Recursive810280 -Node: Screen Garbled810986 -Node: Text Garbled812120 -Node: Unasked-for Search812759 -Node: Emergency Escape813544 -Node: Total Frustration815323 -Node: Bugs815954 -Node: Glossary825489 -Node: Manifesto857130 -Node: Key Index880606 -Node: Command Index905126 -Node: Variable Index945846 -Node: Concept Index961797 +Node: Top1350 +Node: License22509 +Node: Distrib35791 +Node: Intro37455 +Node: Frame40326 +Node: Point43594 +Node: Echo Area45561 +Node: Mode Line47938 +Node: XEmacs under X52369 +Node: Keystrokes55546 +Node: Intro to Keystrokes56390 +Node: Representing Keystrokes58493 +Node: Key Sequences59850 +Node: String Key Sequences63190 +Node: Meta Key63573 +Node: Super and Hyper Keys65046 +Node: Character Representation71270 +Node: Commands72290 +Node: Pull-down Menus75139 +Node: File Menu78488 +Node: Edit Menu82310 +Node: Apps Menu84693 +Node: Options Menu85183 +Node: Buffers Menu89163 +Node: Tools Menu89470 +Node: Help Menu89961 +Node: Menu Customization90362 +Node: Entering Emacs94592 +Node: Exiting95895 +Node: Command Switches98986 +Node: Startup Paths108173 +Node: Basic115748 +Node: Blank Lines125226 +Node: Continuation Lines126652 +Node: Position Info128084 +Node: Arguments131217 +Node: Undo134354 +Node: Minibuffer137301 +Node: Minibuffer File139785 +Node: Minibuffer Edit141421 +Node: Completion143994 +Node: Repetition150869 +Node: M-x153661 +Node: Help158755 +Node: Mark168674 +Node: Setting Mark170528 +Node: Using Region173650 +Node: Marking Objects174387 +Node: Mark Ring176225 +Node: Mouse Selection177941 +Node: Additional Mouse Operations179948 +Node: Killing184152 +Node: Yanking189788 +Node: Kill Ring190591 +Node: Appending Kills192193 +Node: Earlier Kills194230 +Node: Using X Selections196843 +Node: X Clipboard Selection198093 +Node: X Selection Commands200270 +Node: X Cut Buffers201356 +Node: Active Regions202715 +Node: Accumulating Text207295 +Node: Rectangles210368 +Node: Registers213887 +Node: RegPos214921 +Node: RegText215824 +Node: RegRect216908 +Node: Display217648 +Node: Scrolling219143 +Node: Horizontal Scrolling223286 +Node: Selective Display224481 +Node: Display Vars225700 +Node: Search228378 +Node: Incremental Search229571 +Node: Non-Incremental Search238498 +Node: Word Search239940 +Node: Regexp Search241558 +Node: Regexps243094 +Node: Search Case253395 +Node: Replace254176 +Node: Unconditional Replace255124 +Node: Regexp Replace256259 +Node: Replacement and Case257194 +Node: Query Replace258174 +Node: Other Repeating Search261401 +Node: Fixit262656 +Node: Kill Errors263236 +Node: Transpose264569 +Node: Fixing Case266973 +Node: Spelling267619 +Node: Files269080 +Node: File Names270390 +Node: Visiting274727 +Node: Saving281413 +Node: Backup286336 +Node: Backup Names287732 +Node: Backup Deletion289215 +Node: Backup Copying290374 +Node: Interlocking292080 +Node: Reverting296208 +Node: Auto Save298120 +Node: Auto Save Files299087 +Node: Auto Save Control300928 +Node: Recover302766 +Node: Version Control303921 +Node: Concepts of VC305959 +Node: Editing with VC307569 +Node: Variables for Check-in/out312825 +Node: Log Entries314724 +Node: Change Logs and VC315904 +Node: Old Versions319171 +Node: VC Status321174 +Node: Renaming and VC322888 +Node: Snapshots323567 +Node: Making Snapshots324068 +Node: Snapshot Caveats325361 +Node: Version Headers327170 +Node: ListDir329869 +Node: Comparing Files331918 +Node: Dired333451 +Node: Dired Enter334122 +Node: Dired Edit334947 +Node: Dired Deletion336694 +Node: Dired Immed339917 +Node: Misc File Ops341193 +Node: Buffers343681 +Node: Select Buffer345839 +Node: List Buffers347634 +Node: Misc Buffer349379 +Node: Kill Buffer351022 +Node: Several Buffers352152 +Node: Windows356018 +Node: Basic Window356729 +Node: Split Window358448 +Node: Other Window360581 +Node: Pop Up Window363010 +Node: Change Window364515 +Node: Mule367423 +Node: Mule Intro368686 +Node: Language Environments369702 +Node: Input Methods371809 +Node: Select Input Method375529 +Node: Coding Systems377684 +Node: Recognize Coding381870 +Node: Specify Coding385196 +Node: Major Modes390127 +Node: Choosing Modes392346 +Node: Indentation394736 +Node: Indentation Commands396831 +Node: Tab Stops399560 +Node: Just Spaces401409 +Node: Text402224 +Node: Text Mode404207 +Node: Nroff Mode406286 +Node: TeX Mode407929 +Node: TeX Editing410181 +Node: TeX Print413615 +Node: Outline Mode416834 +Node: Outline Format418315 +Node: Outline Motion421115 +Node: Outline Visibility422668 +Node: Words425589 +Node: Sentences428536 +Node: Paragraphs430732 +Node: Pages433020 +Node: Filling435620 +Node: Auto Fill436191 +Node: Fill Commands438338 +Node: Fill Prefix440503 +Node: Case442691 +Node: Programs444719 +Node: Program Modes447268 +Node: Lists449500 +Node: Defuns455340 +Node: Grinding457993 +Node: Basic Indent458621 +Node: Multi-line Indent460642 +Node: Lisp Indent462258 +Node: C Indent465708 +Node: Matching470948 +Node: Comments472470 +Node: Balanced Editing478922 +Node: Lisp Completion479936 +Node: Documentation480951 +Node: Change Log482190 +Node: Tags484768 +Node: Tag Syntax486417 +Node: Create Tags Table490361 +Node: Etags Regexps494421 +Node: Select Tags Table499079 +Node: Find Tag502817 +Node: Tags Search505781 +Node: List Tags509237 +Node: Fortran510266 +Node: Fortran Motion511342 +Node: Fortran Indent512162 +Node: ForIndent Commands512847 +Node: ForIndent Num513992 +Node: ForIndent Conv515266 +Node: ForIndent Vars516042 +Node: Fortran Comments517210 +Node: Fortran Columns520808 +Node: Fortran Abbrev522231 +Node: Asm Mode523140 +Node: Running523692 +Node: Compilation524662 +Node: Lisp Modes529512 +Node: Lisp Libraries530785 +Node: Loading531339 +Node: Compiling Libraries535799 +Node: Mocklisp538690 +Node: Lisp Eval539367 +Node: Lisp Debug543007 +Node: Lisp Interaction548432 +Node: External Lisp549787 +Node: Packages551861 +Node: Package Terminology552602 +Node: Using Packages553960 +Node: Building Packages562749 +Node: Abbrevs565271 +Node: Defining Abbrevs567471 +Node: Expanding Abbrevs569918 +Node: Editing Abbrevs572620 +Node: Saving Abbrevs574488 +Node: Dynamic Abbrevs576428 +Node: Picture577730 +Node: Basic Picture580163 +Node: Insert in Picture582448 +Node: Tabs in Picture583870 +Node: Rectangles in Picture585391 +Node: Sending Mail587299 +Node: Mail Format589010 +Node: Mail Headers590360 +Node: Mail Mode596770 +Node: Reading Mail600383 +Node: Calendar/Diary601958 +Node: Calendar Motion603630 +Node: Calendar Unit Motion604513 +Node: Move to Beginning or End606836 +Node: Specified Dates607969 +Node: Scroll Calendar608857 +Node: Mark and Region610648 +Node: General Calendar612554 +Node: LaTeX Calendar614162 +Node: Holidays616176 +Node: Sunrise/Sunset619278 +Node: Lunar Phases622321 +Node: Other Calendars623706 +Node: Calendar Systems625193 +Node: To Other Calendar628304 +Node: From Other Calendar630295 +Node: Mayan Calendar632600 +Node: Diary635795 +Node: Diary Commands637544 +Node: Format of Diary File640850 +Node: Date Formats643720 +Node: Adding to Diary646294 +Node: Special Diary Entries647925 +Node: Calendar Customization653264 +Node: Calendar Customizing654126 +Node: Holiday Customizing657345 +Node: Date Display Format663813 +Node: Time Display Format664771 +Node: Daylight Savings665909 +Node: Diary Customizing669097 +Node: Hebrew/Islamic Entries673718 +Node: Fancy Diary Display677058 +Node: Included Diary Files678955 +Node: Sexp Diary Entries679936 +Node: Appt Customizing685026 +Node: Sorting686072 +Node: Shell690878 +Node: Single Shell692171 +Node: Interactive Shell693770 +Node: Shell Mode697535 +Node: Terminal emulator700026 +Node: Term Mode702335 +Node: Paging in Term703249 +Node: Narrowing704047 +Node: Hardcopy705997 +Node: Recursive Edit706969 +Node: Dissociated Press709956 +Node: CONX712519 +Node: Amusements713543 +Node: Emulation714023 +Node: Customization715867 +Node: Minor Modes717591 +Node: Variables719223 +Node: Examining721179 +Node: Easy Customization722640 +Node: Customization Groups723654 +Node: Changing an Option726583 +Node: Face Customization732839 +Node: Specific Customization734603 +Node: Edit Options737210 +Node: Locals738794 +Node: File Variables741973 +Node: Keyboard Macros746499 +Node: Basic Kbd Macro748670 +Node: Save Kbd Macro750602 +Node: Kbd Macro Query752271 +Node: Key Bindings754213 +Node: Keymaps755087 +Node: Rebinding758937 +Node: Interactive Rebinding759633 +Node: Programmatic Rebinding761825 +Node: Key Bindings Using Strings764632 +Node: Disabling766238 +Node: Syntax768010 +Node: Syntax Entry768891 +Node: Syntax Change772975 +Node: Init File775144 +Node: Init Syntax776649 +Node: Init Examples779001 +Node: Terminal Init783191 +Node: Audible Bell784901 +Node: Faces788332 +Node: X Resources793169 +Node: Geometry Resources794790 +Node: Iconic Resources797238 +Node: Resource List797710 +Node: Face Resources804217 +Node: Widgets807894 +Node: Menubar Resources808833 +Node: Quitting809766 +Node: Lossage812744 +Node: Stuck Recursive813388 +Node: Screen Garbled814094 +Node: Text Garbled815228 +Node: Unasked-for Search815867 +Node: Emergency Escape816652 +Node: Total Frustration818431 +Node: Bugs819062 +Node: Glossary828596 +Node: Manifesto860225 +Node: Key Index883701 +Node: Command Index908221 +Node: Variable Index948941 +Node: Concept Index964892  End Tag Table diff --git a/info/xemacs.info-1 b/info/xemacs.info-1 index e3b1285..0055d09 100644 --- a/info/xemacs.info-1 +++ b/info/xemacs.info-1 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/xemacs.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs/xemacs.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ Fundamental Editing Commands * Help:: Commands for asking XEmacs about its commands. Important Text-Changing Commands -* Mark:: The mark: how to delimit a "region" of text. +* Mark:: The mark: how to delimit a ``region'' of text. * Mouse Selection:: Selecting text with the mouse. * Additional Mouse Operations:: @@ -139,7 +139,7 @@ Recovery from Problems. Here are some other nodes which are really inferiors of the ones already listed, mentioned here so you can get to them in one step: - -- The Detailed Node Listing -- + --- The Detailed Node Listing --- The Organization of the Frame @@ -257,7 +257,7 @@ File Handling * Version Control:: Version control systems (RCS and SCCS). * ListDir:: Listing the contents of a file directory. * Comparing Files:: Finding where two files differ. -* Dired:: "Editing" a directory to delete, rename, etc. +* Dired:: ``Editing'' a directory to delete, rename, etc. the files in it. * Misc File Ops:: Other things you can do on files. @@ -534,7 +534,7 @@ Dealing with XEmacs Trouble * Screen Garbled:: Garbage on the screen. * Text Garbled:: Garbage in the text. * Unasked-for Search:: Spontaneous entry to incremental search. -* Emergency Escape:: Emergency escape-- +* Emergency Escape:: Emergency escape--- What to do if XEmacs stops responding. * Total Frustration:: When you are at your wits' end. @@ -880,9 +880,9 @@ commands relevant to a topic. *Note Help::. "Customizable" means you can change the definitions of XEmacs commands. For example, if you use a programming language in which comments start with `<**' and end with `**>', you can tell the XEmacs -comment manipulation commands to use those strings (*note Comments::.). -Another sort of customization is rearrangement of the command set. -For example, you can set up the four basic cursor motion commands (up, +comment manipulation commands to use those strings (*note Comments::). +Another sort of customization is rearrangement of the command set. For +example, you can set up the four basic cursor motion commands (up, down, left and right) on keys in a diamond pattern on the keyboard if you prefer. *Note Customization::. @@ -927,24 +927,24 @@ Window look at two buffers a the same time. * Below each text window's last line is a "mode line" (*note Mode - Line::.), which describes what is going on in that window. The + Line::), which describes what is going on in that window. The mode line is in inverse video if the terminal supports that. If there are several XEmacs windows in one frame, each window has its own mode line. * At the bottom of each XEmacs frame is the "echo area" or - "minibuffer window"(*note Echo Area::.). It is used by XEmacs to + "minibuffer window"(*note Echo Area::). It is used by XEmacs to exchange information with the user. There is only one echo area per XEmacs frame. * If you are running XEmacs under the X Window System, a menu bar at the top of the frame makes shortcuts to several of the commands - available (*note Pull-down Menus::.). + available (*note Pull-down Menus::). You can subdivide the XEmacs frame into multiple text windows, and -use each window for a different file (*note Windows::.). Multiple -XEmacs windows are tiled vertically on the XEmacs frame. The upper -XEmacs window is separated from the lower window by its mode line. +use each window for a different file (*note Windows::). Multiple XEmacs +windows are tiled vertically on the XEmacs frame. The upper XEmacs +window is separated from the lower window by its mode line. When there are multiple, tiled XEmacs windows on a single XEmacs frame, the XEmacs window receiving input from the keyboard has the @@ -1028,7 +1028,7 @@ The Echo Area as you type it. This behavior is designed to give confident users fast response, while giving hesitant users maximum feedback. You can change this behavior by setting a variable (*note Display - Vars::.). + Vars::). * If you issue a command that cannot be executed, XEmacs may print an "error message" in the echo area. Error messages are diff --git a/info/xemacs.info-2 b/info/xemacs.info-2 index 81da987..40909ac 100644 --- a/info/xemacs.info-2 +++ b/info/xemacs.info-2 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/xemacs.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs/xemacs.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -135,7 +135,7 @@ manual for information on manipulating X windows. When you are working under X, each X window (that is, each XEmacs frame) has a menu bar for mouse-controlled operations (*note Pull-down -Menus::.). +Menus::). XEmacs under X is also a multi-frame XEmacs. You can use the New Frame menu item from the File menu to create a new XEmacs frame in a @@ -826,7 +826,7 @@ Clear menu items. When you select a menu item, Emacs executes the equivalent command. Most commands on the Edit menu work on a block of text, the X selection. They appear faded until you select a block of text (activate a region) with the mouse. *Note Using X Selections::, -*note Killing::., and *note Yanking::. for more information. +*note Killing::, and *note Yanking:: for more information. Undo Undoes the previous command. Undo is equivalent to the Emacs @@ -1021,12 +1021,12 @@ Customizing XEmacs Menus menu items and disabling or enabling existing menu items. The following functions are available: -`add-menu: (MENU-PATH MENU-NAME MENU-ITEMS &OPTIONAL BEFORE)' +`add-menu: (MENU-PATH MENU-NAME MENU-ITEMS &optional BEFORE)' Add a menu to the menu bar or one of its submenus. -`add-menu-item: (MENU-PATH ITEM-NAME FUNCTION ENABLED-P - &optional before)' Add a menu item to a menu, creating the menu - first if necessary. +`add-menu-item: (MENU-PATH ITEM-NAME FUNCTION' + ENABLED-P &optional BEFORE) Add a menu item to a menu, creating + the menu first if necessary. `delete-menu-item: (PATH)' Remove the menu item defined by PATH from the menu hierarchy. diff --git a/info/xemacs.info-3 b/info/xemacs.info-3 index e663385..af47a05 100644 --- a/info/xemacs.info-3 +++ b/info/xemacs.info-3 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/xemacs.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs/xemacs.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -91,7 +91,7 @@ normally `C-z' and `C-c'.) This Unix feature is turned off while you are in Emacs. The meanings of `C-z' and `C-x C-c' as keys in Emacs were inspired by the standard Berkeley Unix meanings of `C-z' and `C-c', but that is their only relationship with Unix. You could customize these -keys to do anything (*note Keymaps::.). +keys to do anything (*note Keymaps::).  File: xemacs.info, Node: Command Switches, Next: Startup Paths, Prev: Exiting, Up: Top @@ -221,7 +221,7 @@ order in which they appear in this table. `-debug-paths' Displays information on how XEmacs constructs the various paths - into its hierarchy on startup. (See also *note Startup Paths::..) + into its hierarchy on startup. (See also *note Startup Paths::.) `-unmapped' Do not map the initial frame. This is useful if you want to start @@ -269,7 +269,7 @@ normal processing of the other arguments by setting this variable. xemacs *.c passes each `.c' file as a separate argument to Emacs, so that Emacs -visits each file (*note Visiting::.). +visits each file (*note Visiting::). Here is an advanced example that assumes you have a Lisp program file called `hack-c-program.el' which, when loaded, performs some useful @@ -478,7 +478,7 @@ directly under `', because that is where they are in the XEmacs tarball. If XEmacs runs with the `-debug-paths' option (*note Command -Switches::.), it will print the values of these variables, hopefully +Switches::), it will print the values of these variables, hopefully aiding in debugging any problems which come up. `lisp-directory' @@ -546,7 +546,7 @@ Inserting Text To insert printing characters into the text you are editing, just type them. This inserts the characters into the buffer at the cursor -(that is, at "point"; *note Point::.). The cursor moves forward. Any +(that is, at "point"; *note Point::). The cursor moves forward. Any characters after the cursor move forward too. If the text in the buffer is `FOOBAR', with the cursor before the `B', and you type `XX', the result is `FOOXXBAR', with the cursor still before the `B'. @@ -586,7 +586,7 @@ above 200 octal, you must "quote" it by typing the character with the specified character code. A numeric argument to `C-q' specifies how many copies of the quoted -character should be inserted (*note Arguments::.). +character should be inserted (*note Arguments::). If you prefer to have text characters replace (overwrite) existing text instead of moving it to the right, you can enable Overwrite mode, a @@ -596,7 +596,7 @@ Changing the Location of Point ============================== To do more than insert characters, you have to know how to move point -(*note Point::.). Here are a few of the available commands. +(*note Point::). Here are a few of the available commands. NOTE: Many of the following commands have two versions, one that uses the function keys (e.g. or ) and one that doesn't. The @@ -744,7 +744,7 @@ from Emacs, type: The file name is given as an "argument" to the command `C-x C-f' (`find-file'). The command uses the "minibuffer" to read the argument. -You have to type to terminate the argument (*note Minibuffer::.). +You have to type to terminate the argument (*note Minibuffer::). You can also use the Open... menu item from the File menu, then type the name of the file to the prompt. @@ -765,7 +765,7 @@ which you can insert the text you want to put in the file. When you save the buffer with `C-x C-s', or by choosing Save Buffer from the File menu, the file is created. - To learn more about using files, *note Files::.. + To learn more about using files, *note Files::. Help ==== @@ -832,8 +832,8 @@ Continuation Lines curved arrow at the extreme right margin of all but the last line. The curved arrow indicates that the following screen line is not really a distinct line in the text, but just the "continuation" of a line too -long to fit the frame. You can use Auto Fill mode (*note Filling::.) -to have Emacs insert newlines automatically when a line gets too long. +long to fit the frame. You can use Auto Fill mode (*note Filling::) to +have Emacs insert newlines automatically when a line gets too long. Instead of continuation, long lines can be displayed by "truncation". This means that all the characters that do not fit in the width of the @@ -844,7 +844,7 @@ of the curved arrow inform you that truncation is in effect. To turn off continuation for a particular buffer, set the variable `truncate-lines' to non-`nil' in that buffer. Truncation instead of continuation also happens whenever horizontal scrolling is in use, and -optionally whenever side-by-side windows are in use (*note Windows::.). +optionally whenever side-by-side windows are in use (*note Windows::). Altering the value of `truncate-lines' makes it local to the current buffer; until that time, the default value is in effect. The default is initially `nil'. *Note Locals::. @@ -888,7 +888,7 @@ information, it is not displayed all the time. current page. * `M-=' (`count-lines-region') prints the number of lines in the - region (*note Mark::.). + region (*note Mark::). The command `C-x =' (`what-cursor-position') provides information about point and about the column the cursor is in. It prints a line in @@ -1127,7 +1127,7 @@ where `Find File: ' is the prompt. Typing `buffer.c' specifies the file `..'; thus, if you type `../lisp/simple.el', the file that you visit will be the one named `/u2/emacs/lisp/simple.el'. Alternatively, you can use `M-' to -kill directory names you don't want (*note Words::.). +kill directory names you don't want (*note Words::). You can also type an absolute file name, one starting with a slash or a tilde, ignoring the default directory. For example, to find the diff --git a/info/xemacs.info-4 b/info/xemacs.info-4 index 32d87d6..66ed5a7 100644 --- a/info/xemacs.info-4 +++ b/info/xemacs.info-4 @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -This is Info file ../../info/xemacs.info, produced by Makeinfo version -1.68 from the input file xemacs.texi. +This is ../info/xemacs.info, produced by makeinfo version 4.0 from +xemacs/xemacs.texi. INFO-DIR-SECTION XEmacs Editor START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @@ -570,7 +570,7 @@ you are looking for commands for killing backwards and `C-h a kill-backwards ' doesn't reveal any commands, don't give up. Try just `kill', or just `backwards', or just `back'. Be persistent. Pretend you are playing Adventure. Also note that you can use a -regular expression as the argument (*note Regexps::.). +regular expression as the argument (*note Regexps::). Here is a set of arguments to give to `C-h a' that covers many classes of Emacs commands, since there are strong conventions for naming @@ -611,9 +611,9 @@ normally describes all the commands that are changed in this mode. present information about the current Emacs mode that is not covered by `C-h m'. `C-h b' displays a list of all key bindings currently in effect, with the local bindings of the current major mode first, -followed by the global bindings (*note Key Bindings::.). `C-h s' +followed by the global bindings (*note Key Bindings::). `C-h s' displays the contents of the syntax table with explanations of each -character's syntax (*note Syntax::.). +character's syntax (*note Syntax::). The other `C-h' options display various files of useful information. `C-h C-w' (`describe-no-warranty') displays details on the complete @@ -751,23 +751,23 @@ Operating on the Region Once you have created an active region, you can do many things to the text in it: - * Kill it with `C-w' (*note Killing::.). + * Kill it with `C-w' (*note Killing::). - * Save it in a register with `C-x r s' (*note Registers::.). + * Save it in a register with `C-x r s' (*note Registers::). - * Save it in a buffer or a file (*note Accumulating Text::.). + * Save it in a buffer or a file (*note Accumulating Text::). * Convert case with `C-x C-l' or `C-x C-u' - (*note Case::.). + (*note Case::). * Evaluate it as Lisp code with `M-x eval-region' (*note Lisp - Eval::.). + Eval::). - * Fill it as text with `M-q' (*note Filling::.). + * Fill it as text with `M-q' (*note Filling::). - * Print hardcopy with `M-x print-region' (*note Hardcopy::.). + * Print hardcopy with `M-x print-region' (*note Hardcopy::). - * Indent it with `C-x ' or `C-M-\' (*note Indentation::.). + * Indent it with `C-x ' or `C-M-\' (*note Indentation::).  File: xemacs.info, Node: Marking Objects, Next: Mark Ring, Prev: Using Region, Up: Mark @@ -805,12 +805,12 @@ These characters sometimes save you some typing. thus delimit an object in the buffer. `M-h' (`mark-paragraph') moves point to the beginning of the paragraph that surrounds or follows point, and puts the mark at the end of that paragraph (*note -Paragraphs::.). You can then indent, case-convert, or kill the whole +Paragraphs::). You can then indent, case-convert, or kill the whole paragraph. In the same fashion, `C-M-h' (`mark-defun') puts point before and the mark after the current or following defun (*note -Defuns::.). `C-x C-p' (`mark-page') puts point before the current page +Defuns::). `C-x C-p' (`mark-page') puts point before the current page (or the next or previous, depending on the argument), and mark at the -end (*note Pages::.). The mark goes after the terminating page +end (*note Pages::). The mark goes after the terminating page delimiter (to include it), while point goes after the preceding page delimiter (to exclude it). Finally, `C-x h' (`mark-whole-buffer') sets up the entire buffer as the region by putting point at the beginning @@ -895,7 +895,7 @@ whole lines. The selected region of text is highlighted. Once a region of text is selected, it becomes the primary X selection -(*note Using X Selections::.) as well as the Emacs selected region. You +(*note Using X Selections::) as well as the Emacs selected region. You can paste it into other X applications and use the options from the Edit pull-down menu on it. Since it is also the Emacs region, you can use Emacs region commands on it. @@ -1028,7 +1028,7 @@ distinction is made only for erasing text in the buffer.) The commands' names and individual descriptions use the words `kill' and `delete' to indicate what they do. If you perform a kill or delete command by mistake, use the `C-x u' (`undo') command to undo it (*note -Undo::.). The delete commands include `C-d' (`delete-char') and +Undo::). The delete commands include `C-d' (`delete-char') and (`delete-backward-char'), which delete only one character at a time, and those commands that delete only spaces or newlines. Commands that can destroy significant amounts of nontrivial data usually kill. @@ -1149,8 +1149,8 @@ numeric argument acts as a repeat count. A negative argument means to search backward and kill text before point. Other syntactic units can be killed: words, with `M-' and `M-d' -(*note Words::.); sexps, with `C-M-k' (*note Lists::.); and sentences, -with `C-x ' and `M-k' (*note Sentences::.). +(*note Words::); sexps, with `C-M-k' (*note Lists::); and sentences, +with `C-x ' and `M-k' (*note Sentences::).  File: xemacs.info, Node: Yanking, Next: Using X Selections, Prev: Killing, Up: Top diff --git a/lib-src/ChangeLog b/lib-src/ChangeLog index a969b0c..83ebc43 100644 --- a/lib-src/ChangeLog +++ b/lib-src/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,42 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + +1999-11-20 Martin Buchholz + + * process-gnu-depends.sh: Deleted. Obsolete. + * process-depends.sh: Deleted. Obsolete. + +1999-11-20 Jan Vroonhof + + * Makefile.in.in (instvardir): Added. From + Jeff Miller + +1999-11-19 Martin Buchholz + + * etags.c: Upgrade to pot etags version 13.33. + Make `etags --version' print out `XEmacs', not `GNU Emacs' + +1999-11-17 Martin Buchholz + + * etags.c (canonicalize_filename): Typo fix + +1999-11-05 Martin Buchholz + + * etags.c: + * ../etc/etags.1: + * ../etc/NEWS: + Upgrade to etags version 13.32. + etags.c has warnings removed, in addition. + +1999-11-15 Martin Buchholz + + * gnuserv.c (ipc_spawn_watchdog): Use pid_t instead of int. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released @@ -88,14 +127,14 @@ * Makefile.in.in (cppflags): Add -I$(top_srcdir)/src. 1999-04-29 Andy Piper - - * make-docfile.c: build fixes for mingw32. + + * make-docfile.c: build fixes for mingw32. * movemail.c: ditto. * run.c: ditto. * yow.c: ditto. * profile.c: ditto. (gettimeofday): new function copied from nt.c. - + * fakemail.c (make_file_preface): make buildable under windows. * Makefile.in.in: fix some build targets for when we are building @@ -194,7 +233,7 @@ * pop.c: mess with includes so that it builds under native NT. From Fabrice Popineau - + 1998-12-16 Andy Piper * XEmacs 21.2.6 is released @@ -380,7 +419,7 @@ Wed Apr 22 12:59:35 1998 Andy Piper 1998-04-19 Jan Vroonhof * gnuclient.c (main): Read eval from from stdin if just "-batch" - is given. + is given. * gnudoit: Support this. * gnuserv.1: Document this behavior. @@ -452,13 +491,13 @@ Tue Feb 17 12:50:37 1998 Andy Piper 1998-01-13 Martin Buchholz - * lib-src/add-little-package.sh: - * lib-src/add-big-package.sh: + * lib-src/add-little-package.sh: + * lib-src/add-big-package.sh: Use proper paranoid quoting for sh variables. -batch implies -q. Thu Jan 08 09:42:36 1998 - + * gnuserv.h: only set UNIX_DOMAIN_SOCKETS if HAVE_SYS_UN_H is set. @@ -602,7 +641,7 @@ Thu Jan 08 09:42:36 1998 missing a variable called "configuration. This messed up archilibdir. * Added highlighting to text suggesting to do "make gzip-el" in top - level Makefile.in. Added code to do make maybe-blessmail after a + level Makefile.in. Added code to do make maybe-blessmail after a make install is done. 1997-08-07 Jan Vroonhof @@ -670,7 +709,7 @@ Thu Jan 08 09:42:36 1998 * Makefile.in.in (INSTALLABLE_SCRIPTS): Readd Gnuattach. From Hrvoje Niksic - + 1997-06-13 Steven L Baur * update-elc.sh (mule_p): Ignore lisp/language when building diff --git a/lib-src/Makefile.in.in b/lib-src/Makefile.in.in index 9fa565b..9c1b864 100644 --- a/lib-src/Makefile.in.in +++ b/lib-src/Makefile.in.in @@ -54,6 +54,7 @@ bindir=@bindir@ libdir=@libdir@ srcdir=@srcdir@ datadir=@datadir@ +instvardir=@instvardir@ top_srcdir=@top_srcdir@ archlibdir=@archlibdir@ configuration=@configuration@ diff --git a/lib-src/add-big-package.sh b/lib-src/add-big-package.sh index 7c8e3e0..da186ab 100755 --- a/lib-src/add-big-package.sh +++ b/lib-src/add-big-package.sh @@ -2,8 +2,8 @@ # add-big-package.sh --- Add multiple file package to Package Lisp Hierarchy # Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -# Author: SL Baur -# Maintainer: SL Baur +# Author: SL Baur +# Maintainer: SL Baur # Keywords: packages internal # This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lib-src/config.values.in b/lib-src/config.values.in index 3a1cdc1..c3e3de9 100644 --- a/lib-src/config.values.in +++ b/lib-src/config.values.in @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ ;;; Do not edit this file! ;;; This file was automatically generated, by the config.values.sh script, -;;; from configure, which was itself automatically generated from configure.in +;;; from configure, which was itself automatically generated from configure.in. ;;; ;;; See lisp/util/config.el for details on how this file is used. ;;; @@ -93,6 +93,7 @@ dynodump_arch "@dynodump_arch@" etcdir "@etcdir@" exec_prefix "@exec_prefix@" extra_objs "@extra_objs@" +have_esd_config "@have_esd_config@" includedir "@includedir@" infodir "@infodir@" infopath "@infopath@" diff --git a/lib-src/config.values.sh b/lib-src/config.values.sh index d755d0c..fc22128 100644 --- a/lib-src/config.values.sh +++ b/lib-src/config.values.sh @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ exec < ./configure > "lib-src/config.values.in" cat <<\EOF ;;; Do not edit this file! ;;; This file was automatically generated, by the config.values.sh script, -;;; from configure, which was itself automatically generated from configure.in +;;; from configure, which was itself automatically generated from configure.in. ;;; ;;; See lisp/util/config.el for details on how this file is used. ;;; diff --git a/lib-src/etags.c b/lib-src/etags.c index e9ce59f..5f2223a 100644 --- a/lib-src/etags.c +++ b/lib-src/etags.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* Tags file maker to go with GNU Emacs - Copyright (C) 1984, 87, 88, 89, 93, 94, 95, 98 + Copyright (C) 1984, 87, 88, 89, 93, 94, 95, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. and Ken Arnold This file is not considered part of GNU Emacs. @@ -28,18 +28,31 @@ Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ * Francesco Potorti` reorganised C and C++ based on work by Joe Wells. * Regexp tags by Tom Tromey. * - * Francesco Potorti` (F.Potorti@cnuce.cnr.it) is the current maintainer. + * Francesco Potorti` (pot@gnu.org) is the current maintainer. + * Ansified by Martin Buchholz, 19991105. */ -char pot_etags_version[] = "@(#) pot revision number is 13.7"; +char pot_etags_version[] = "@(#) pot revision number is 13.33"; #define TRUE 1 #define FALSE 0 +#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE +# define _GNU_SOURCE /* enables some compiler checks on GNU */ +#endif #ifndef DEBUG # define DEBUG FALSE #endif +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include + /* On some systems, Emacs defines static as nothing for the sake + of unexec. We don't want that here since we don't use unexec. */ +# undef static +# define ETAGS_REGEXPS /* use the regexp features */ +# define LONG_OPTIONS /* accept long options */ +#endif /* HAVE_CONFIG_H */ + #ifdef MSDOS # include # include @@ -60,19 +73,12 @@ char pot_etags_version[] = "@(#) pot revision number is 13.7"; # undef HAVE_NTGUI # else # define DOS_NT -# define HAVE_GETCWD # endif /* not HAVE_CONFIG_H */ +# ifndef HAVE_GETCWD +# define HAVE_GETCWD +# endif /* undef HAVE_GETCWD */ #endif /* WINDOWSNT */ -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include - /* On some systems, Emacs defines static as nothing for the sake - of unexec. We don't want that here since we don't use unexec. */ -# undef static -# define ETAGS_REGEXPS /* use the regexp features */ -# define LONG_OPTIONS /* accept long options */ -#endif /* HAVE_CONFIG_H */ - #if !defined (WINDOWSNT) && defined (STDC_HEADERS) #include #include @@ -176,7 +182,6 @@ typedef void Lang_function (); typedef struct { char *suffix; - int sufflen; char *command; /* Takes one arg and decompresses to stdout */ } compressor; @@ -190,83 +195,6 @@ typedef struct extern char *getenv (); -/* Many compilers barf on this: - Lang_function Asm_labels; - so let's write it this way */ -void Asm_labels (); -void C_entries (); -void default_C_entries (); -void plain_C_entries (); -void Cjava_entries (); -void Cobol_paragraphs (); -void Cplusplus_entries (); -void Cstar_entries (); -void Erlang_functions (); -void Fortran_functions (); -void Yacc_entries (); -void Lisp_functions (); -void Pascal_functions (); -void Perl_functions (); -void Postscript_functions (); -void Prolog_functions (); -void Python_functions (); -void Scheme_functions (); -void TeX_functions (); -void just_read_file (); - -compressor *get_compressor_from_suffix (); -language *get_language_from_name (); -language *get_language_from_interpreter (); -language *get_language_from_suffix (); -int total_size_of_entries (); -long readline (), readline_internal (); -#ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS -void analyse_regex (); -void add_regex (); -void free_patterns (); -#endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ -void error (); -void suggest_asking_for_help (); -void fatal (), pfatal (); -void add_node (); - -void init (); -void initbuffer (); -void find_entries (); -void free_tree (); -void pfnote (), new_pfnote (); -void process_file (); -void put_entries (); -void takeprec (); - -char *concat (); -char *skip_spaces (), *skip_non_spaces (); -char *savenstr (), *savestr (); -char *etags_strchr (), *etags_strrchr (); -char *etags_getcwd (); -char *relative_filename (), *absolute_filename (), *absolute_dirname (); -bool filename_is_absolute (); -void canonicalize_filename (); -void grow_linebuffer (); -long *xmalloc (), *xrealloc (); - - -char searchar = '/'; /* use /.../ searches */ - -char *tagfile; /* output file */ -char *progname; /* name this program was invoked with */ -char *cwd; /* current working directory */ -char *tagfiledir; /* directory of tagfile */ -FILE *tagf; /* ioptr for tags file */ - -char *curfile; /* current input file name */ -language *curlang; /* current language */ - -int lineno; /* line number of current line */ -long charno; /* current character number */ -long linecharno; /* charno of start of current line */ -char *dbp; /* pointer to start of current tag */ - typedef struct node_st { /* sorting structure */ char *name; /* function or type name */ @@ -279,8 +207,6 @@ typedef struct node_st struct node_st *left, *right; /* left and right sons */ } node; -node *head; /* the head of the binary tree of tags */ - /* * A `linebuffer' is a structure which holds a line of text. * `readline_internal' reads a line from a stream into a linebuffer @@ -295,6 +221,97 @@ typedef struct char *buffer; } linebuffer; +/* Many compilers barf on this: + Lang_function Ada_funcs; + so let's write it this way */ +void Ada_funcs (FILE *inf); +void Asm_labels (FILE *inf); +void C_entries (int c_ext, FILE *inf); +void default_C_entries (FILE *inf); +void plain_C_entries (FILE *inf); +void Cjava_entries (FILE *inf); +void Cobol_paragraphs (FILE *inf); +void Cplusplus_entries (FILE *inf); +void Cstar_entries (FILE *inf); +void Erlang_functions (FILE *inf); +void Fortran_functions (FILE *inf); +void Yacc_entries (FILE *inf); +void Lisp_functions (FILE *inf); +void Pascal_functions (FILE *inf); +void Perl_functions (FILE *inf); +void Postscript_functions (FILE *inf); +void Prolog_functions (FILE *inf); +void Python_functions (FILE *inf); +void Scheme_functions (FILE *inf); +void TeX_functions (FILE *inf); +void just_read_file (FILE *inf); + +compressor *get_compressor_from_suffix (char *file, char **extptr); +language *get_language_from_name (char *name); +language *get_language_from_interpreter (char *interpreter); +language *get_language_from_suffix (char *file); +int total_size_of_entries (register node *np); +long readline (linebuffer *lbp, FILE *stream); +long readline_internal (linebuffer *lbp, register FILE *stream); +void get_tag (register char *bp); + +#ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS +void analyse_regex (char *regex_arg, bool ignore_case); +void add_regex (char *regexp_pattern, bool ignore_case, language *lan); +void free_patterns (void); +#endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ +void error (const char *s1, const char *s2); +void suggest_asking_for_help (void); +void fatal (char *s1, char *s2); +void pfatal (char *s1); +void add_node (node *np, node **cur_node_p); + +void init (void); +void initbuffer (linebuffer *lbp); +void find_entries (char *file, FILE *inf); +void free_tree (register node *np); +void pfnote (char *name, bool is_func, char *linestart, int linelen, int lno, long int cno); +void new_pfnote (char *name, int namelen, bool is_func, char *linestart, int linelen, int lno, long int cno); +void process_file (char *file); +void put_entries (register node *np); +void takeprec (void); + +char *concat (char *s1, char *s2, char *s3); +char *skip_spaces (char *cp); +char *skip_non_spaces (char *cp); +char *savenstr (char *cp, int len); +char *savestr (char *cp); +char *etags_strchr (char *sp, char c); +char *etags_strrchr (char *sp, char c); +char *etags_getcwd (void); +char *relative_filename (char *file, char *dir); +char *absolute_filename (char *file, char *dir); +char *absolute_dirname (char *file, char *dir); +bool filename_is_absolute (char *fn); +void canonicalize_filename (register char *fn); +void grow_linebuffer (linebuffer *lbp, int toksize); +long *xmalloc (unsigned int size); +long *xrealloc (char *ptr, unsigned int size); + + +char searchar = '/'; /* use /.../ searches */ + +char *tagfile; /* output file */ +char *progname; /* name this program was invoked with */ +char *cwd; /* current working directory */ +char *tagfiledir; /* directory of tagfile */ +FILE *tagf; /* ioptr for tags file */ + +char *curfile; /* current input file name */ +language *curlang; /* current language */ + +int lineno; /* line number of current line */ +long charno; /* current character number */ +long linecharno; /* charno of start of current line */ +char *dbp; /* pointer to start of current tag */ + +node *head; /* the head of the binary tree of tags */ + linebuffer lb; /* the current line */ linebuffer token_name; /* used by C_entries as a temporary area */ struct @@ -319,13 +336,14 @@ char bool append_to_tagfile; /* -a: append to tags */ /* The following four default to TRUE for etags, but to FALSE for ctags. */ -bool typedefs; /* -t: create tags for C typedefs */ +bool typedefs; /* -t: create tags for C and Ada typedefs */ bool typedefs_and_cplusplus; /* -T: create tags for C typedefs, level */ /* 0 struct/enum/union decls, and C++ */ /* member functions. */ bool constantypedefs; /* -d: create tags for C #define, enum */ /* constants and variables. */ /* -D: opposite of -d. Default under ctags. */ +bool declarations; /* --declarations: tag them and extern in C&Co*/ bool globals; /* create tags for global variables */ bool members; /* create tags for C member variables */ bool update; /* -u: update tags */ @@ -334,37 +352,41 @@ bool no_warnings; /* -w: suppress warnings */ bool cxref_style; /* -x: create cxref style output */ bool cplusplus; /* .[hc] means C++, not C */ bool noindentypedefs; /* -I: ignore indentation in C */ +bool packages_only; /* --packages-only: in Ada, only tag packages*/ #ifdef LONG_OPTIONS struct option longopts[] = { - { "append", no_argument, NULL, 'a' }, - { "backward-search", no_argument, NULL, 'B' }, - { "c++", no_argument, NULL, 'C' }, - { "cxref", no_argument, NULL, 'x' }, - { "defines", no_argument, NULL, 'd' }, - { "no-defines", no_argument, NULL, 'D' }, - { "globals", no_argument, &globals, TRUE }, - { "no-globals", no_argument, &globals, FALSE }, - { "help", no_argument, NULL, 'h' }, - { "help", no_argument, NULL, 'H' }, - { "ignore-indentation", no_argument, NULL, 'I' }, - { "include", required_argument, NULL, 'i' }, - { "language", required_argument, NULL, 'l' }, - { "members", no_argument, &members, TRUE }, - { "no-members", no_argument, &members, FALSE }, - { "no-warn", no_argument, NULL, 'w' }, - { "output", required_argument, NULL, 'o' }, -#ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS - { "regex", required_argument, NULL, 'r' }, - { "no-regex", no_argument, NULL, 'R' }, -#endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ - { "typedefs", no_argument, NULL, 't' }, - { "typedefs-and-c++", no_argument, NULL, 'T' }, - { "update", no_argument, NULL, 'u' }, - { "version", no_argument, NULL, 'V' }, - { "vgrind", no_argument, NULL, 'v' }, - { 0 } + { "packages-only", no_argument, &packages_only, TRUE }, + { "append", no_argument, NULL, 'a' }, + { "backward-search", no_argument, NULL, 'B' }, + { "c++", no_argument, NULL, 'C' }, + { "cxref", no_argument, NULL, 'x' }, + { "defines", no_argument, NULL, 'd' }, + { "declarations", no_argument, &declarations, TRUE }, + { "no-defines", no_argument, NULL, 'D' }, + { "globals", no_argument, &globals, TRUE }, + { "no-globals", no_argument, &globals, FALSE }, + { "help", no_argument, NULL, 'h' }, + { "help", no_argument, NULL, 'H' }, + { "ignore-indentation", no_argument, NULL, 'I' }, + { "include", required_argument, NULL, 'i' }, + { "language", required_argument, NULL, 'l' }, + { "members", no_argument, &members, TRUE }, + { "no-members", no_argument, &members, FALSE }, + { "no-warn", no_argument, NULL, 'w' }, + { "output", required_argument, NULL, 'o' }, +#ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS + { "regex", required_argument, NULL, 'r' }, + { "no-regex", no_argument, NULL, 'R' }, + { "ignore-case-regex", required_argument, NULL, 'c' }, +#endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ + { "typedefs", no_argument, NULL, 't' }, + { "typedefs-and-c++", no_argument, NULL, 'T' }, + { "update", no_argument, NULL, 'u' }, + { "version", no_argument, NULL, 'V' }, + { "vgrind", no_argument, NULL, 'v' }, + { NULL } }; #endif /* LONG_OPTIONS */ @@ -382,17 +404,22 @@ typedef struct pattern bool error_signaled; } pattern; -/* Array of all regexps. */ +/* List of all regexps. */ pattern *p_head = NULL; + +/* How many characters in the character set. (From regex.c.) */ +#define CHAR_SET_SIZE 256 +/* Translation table for case-insensitive matching. */ +char lc_trans[CHAR_SET_SIZE]; #endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ compressor compressors[] = { - { "z", 1, "gzip -d -c"}, - { "Z", 1, "gzip -d -c"}, - { "gz", 2, "gzip -d -c"}, - { "GZ", 2, "gzip -d -c"}, - { "bz2", 3, "bzip2 -d -c" }, + { "z", "gzip -d -c"}, + { "Z", "gzip -d -c"}, + { "gz", "gzip -d -c"}, + { "GZ", "gzip -d -c"}, + { "bz2", "bzip2 -d -c" }, { NULL } }; @@ -403,6 +430,10 @@ compressor compressors[] = /* Non-NULL if language fixed. */ language *forced_lang = NULL; +/* Ada code */ +char *Ada_suffixes [] = + { "ads", "adb", "ada", NULL }; + /* Assembly code */ char *Asm_suffixes [] = { "a", /* Unix assembler */ "asm", /* Microcontroller assembly */ @@ -459,7 +490,7 @@ char *plain_C_suffixes [] = NULL }; char *Postscript_suffixes [] = - { "ps", NULL }; + { "ps", "psw", NULL }; /* .psw is for PSWrap */ char *Prolog_suffixes [] = { "prolog", NULL }; @@ -486,6 +517,7 @@ char *Yacc_suffixes [] = language lang_names [] = { + { "ada", Ada_funcs, Ada_suffixes, NULL }, { "asm", Asm_labels, Asm_suffixes, NULL }, { "c", default_C_entries, default_C_suffixes, NULL }, { "c++", Cplusplus_entries, Cplusplus_suffixes, NULL }, @@ -509,7 +541,7 @@ language lang_names [] = { NULL, NULL } /* end of list */ }; -void +static void print_language_names () { language *lang; @@ -534,20 +566,26 @@ Fortran is tried first; if no tags are found, C is tried next.\n\ Compressed files are supported using gzip and bzip2."); } +#ifdef XEMACS +# define EMACS_NAME "XEmacs" +#else +# define EMACS_NAME "GNU Emacs" +#endif + #ifndef VERSION # define VERSION "20" #endif -void +static void print_version () { - printf ("%s (GNU Emacs %s)\n", (CTAGS) ? "ctags" : "etags", VERSION); - puts ("Copyright (C) 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc. and Ken Arnold"); + printf ("%s (" EMACS_NAME " %s)\n", (CTAGS) ? "ctags" : "etags", VERSION); + puts ("Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. and Ken Arnold"); puts ("This program is distributed under the same terms as Emacs"); exit (GOOD); } -void +static void print_help () { printf ("Usage: %s [options] [[regex-option ...] file-name] ...\n\ @@ -568,6 +606,9 @@ Relative ones are stored relative to the output file's directory."); puts ("-a, --append\n\ Append tag entries to existing tags file."); + puts ("--packages-only\n\ + For Ada files, only generate tags for packages ."); + if (CTAGS) puts ("-B, --backward-search\n\ Write the search commands for the tag entries using '?', the\n\ @@ -576,6 +617,14 @@ Relative ones are stored relative to the output file's directory."); puts ("-C, --c++\n\ Treat files whose name suffix defaults to C language as C++ files."); + puts ("--declarations\n\ + In C and derived languages, create tags for function declarations,"); + if (CTAGS) + puts ("\tand create tags for extern variables if --globals is used."); + else + puts + ("\tand create tags for extern variables unless --no-globals is used."); + if (CTAGS) puts ("-d, --defines\n\ Create tag entries for C #define constants and enum constants, too."); @@ -607,12 +656,15 @@ Relative ones are stored relative to the output file's directory."); #ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS puts ("-r /REGEXP/, --regex=/REGEXP/ or --regex=@regexfile\n\ - Make a tag for each line matching pattern REGEXP in the\n\ - following files. regexfile is a file containing one REGEXP\n\ - per line. REGEXP is anchored (as if preceded by ^).\n\ - The form /REGEXP/NAME/ creates a named tag. For example Tcl\n\ - named tags can be created with:\n\ + Make a tag for each line matching pattern REGEXP in the following\n\ + files. {LANGUAGE}/REGEXP/ uses REGEXP for LANGUAGE files only.\n\ + regexfile is a file containing one REGEXP per line.\n\ + REGEXP is anchored (as if preceded by ^).\n\ + The form /REGEXP/NAME/ creates a named tag.\n\ + For example Tcl named tags can be created with:\n\ --regex=/proc[ \\t]+\\([^ \\t]+\\)/\\1/."); + puts ("-c /REGEXP/, --ignore-case-regex=/REGEXP/ or --ignore-case-regex=@regexfile\n\ + Like -r, --regex but ignore case when matching expressions."); puts ("-R, --no-regex\n\ Don't create tags from regexps for the following files."); #endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ @@ -627,7 +679,7 @@ Relative ones are stored relative to the output file's directory."); if (CTAGS) { puts ("-t, --typedefs\n\ - Generate tag entries for C typedefs."); + Generate tag entries for C and Ada typedefs."); puts ("-T, --typedefs-and-c++\n\ Generate tag entries for C typedefs, C struct/enum/union tags,\n\ and C++ member functions."); @@ -660,7 +712,7 @@ Relative ones are stored relative to the output file's directory."); print_language_names (); puts (""); - puts ("Report bugs to bug-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu"); + puts ("Report bugs to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org"); exit (GOOD); } @@ -670,7 +722,8 @@ enum argument_type { at_language, at_regexp, - at_filename + at_filename, + at_icregexp }; /* This structure helps us allow mixing of --lang and file names. */ @@ -839,12 +892,15 @@ main (argc, argv) #ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS /* Set syntax for regular expression routines. */ re_set_syntax (RE_SYNTAX_EMACS | RE_INTERVALS); + /* Translation table for case-insensitive search. */ + for (i = 0; i < CHAR_SET_SIZE; i++) + lc_trans[i] = lowcase (i); #endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ /* * If etags, always find typedefs and structure tags. Why not? * Also default is to find macro constants, enum constants and - * global variables. + * global variables. */ if (!CTAGS) { @@ -859,7 +915,7 @@ main (argc, argv) char *optstring; #ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS - optstring = "-aCdDf:Il:o:r:RStTi:BuvxwVhH"; + optstring = "-aCdDf:Il:o:r:c:RStTi:BuvxwVhH"; #else optstring = "-aCdDf:Il:o:StTi:BuvxwVhH"; #endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ @@ -896,7 +952,7 @@ main (argc, argv) case 'o': if (tagfile) { - error ("-%c option may only be given once.", opt); + error ("-o option may only be given once.", (char *)NULL); suggest_asking_for_help (); } tagfile = optarg; @@ -927,6 +983,11 @@ main (argc, argv) argbuffer[current_arg].what = NULL; ++current_arg; break; + case 'c': + argbuffer[current_arg].arg_type = at_icregexp; + argbuffer[current_arg].what = optarg; + ++current_arg; + break; #endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ case 'V': print_version (); @@ -969,7 +1030,7 @@ main (argc, argv) if (nincluded_files == 0 && file_count == 0) { - error ("no input files specified.", 0); + error ("no input files specified.", (char *)NULL); suggest_asking_for_help (); } @@ -1025,7 +1086,10 @@ main (argc, argv) break; #ifdef ETAGS_REGEXPS case at_regexp: - analyse_regex (argbuffer[i].what); + analyse_regex (argbuffer[i].what, FALSE); + break; + case at_icregexp: + analyse_regex (argbuffer[i].what, TRUE); break; #endif case at_filename: @@ -1117,23 +1181,43 @@ main (argc, argv) /* - * Return a compressor given the file name. + * Return a compressor given the file name. If EXTPTR is non-zero, + * return a pointer into FILE where the compressor-specific + * extension begins. If no compressor is found, NULL is returned + * and EXTPTR is not significant. * Idea by Vladimir Alexiev */ compressor * -get_compressor_from_suffix (file) +get_compressor_from_suffix (file, extptr) char *file; + char **extptr; { compressor *compr; - char *suffix; + char *slash, *suffix; + /* This relies on FN to be after canonicalize_filename, + so we don't need to consider backslashes on DOS_NT. */ + slash = etags_strrchr (file, '/'); suffix = etags_strrchr (file, '.'); - if (suffix == NULL) + if (suffix == NULL || suffix < slash) return NULL; + if (extptr != NULL) + *extptr = suffix; suffix += 1; - for (compr = compressors; compr->suffix != NULL; compr++) - if (streq (compr->suffix, suffix)) - return compr; + /* Let those poor souls who live with DOS 8+3 file name limits get + some solace by treating foo.cgz as if it were foo.c.gz, etc. + Only the first do loop is run if not MSDOS */ + do + { + for (compr = compressors; compr->suffix != NULL; compr++) + if (streq (compr->suffix, suffix)) + return compr; +#ifndef MSDOS + break; +#endif + if (extptr != NULL) + *extptr = ++suffix; + } while (*suffix != '\0'); return NULL; } @@ -1220,7 +1304,8 @@ process_file (file) FILE *inf; compressor *compr; char *compressed_name, *uncompressed_name; - char *real_name; + char *ext, *real_name; + canonicalize_filename (file); if (streq (file, tagfile) && !streq (tagfile, "-")) @@ -1228,7 +1313,7 @@ process_file (file) error ("skipping inclusion of %s in self.", file); return; } - if ((compr = get_compressor_from_suffix (file)) == NULL) + if ((compr = get_compressor_from_suffix (file, &ext)) == NULL) { compressed_name = NULL; real_name = uncompressed_name = savestr (file); @@ -1236,8 +1321,29 @@ process_file (file) else { real_name = compressed_name = savestr (file); - uncompressed_name = savenstr (file, strlen(file) - compr->sufflen - 1); + uncompressed_name = savenstr (file, ext - file); } + + /* If the canonicalised uncompressed name has already be dealt with, + skip it silently, else add it to the list. */ + { + typedef struct processed_file + { + char *filename; + struct processed_file *next; + } processed_file; + static processed_file *pf_head = NULL; + register processed_file *fnp; + + for (fnp = pf_head; fnp != NULL; fnp = fnp->next) + if (streq (uncompressed_name, fnp->filename)) + goto exit; + fnp = pf_head; + pf_head = xnew (1, struct processed_file); + pf_head->filename = savestr (uncompressed_name); + pf_head->next = fnp; + } + if (stat (real_name, &stat_buf) != 0) { /* Reset real_name and try with a different name. */ @@ -1253,7 +1359,25 @@ process_file (file) { compressed_name = concat (file, ".", compr->suffix); if (stat (compressed_name, &stat_buf) != 0) - free (compressed_name); + { +#ifdef MSDOS + char *suf = compressed_name + strlen (file); + size_t suflen = strlen (compr->suffix) + 1; + for ( ; suf[1]; suf++, suflen--) + { + memmove (suf, suf + 1, suflen); + if (stat (compressed_name, &stat_buf) == 0) + { + real_name = compressed_name; + break; + } + } + if (real_name != NULL) + break; +#endif + free (compressed_name); + compressed_name = NULL; + } else { real_name = compressed_name; @@ -1279,7 +1403,7 @@ process_file (file) inf = popen (cmd, "r"); free (cmd); } - else + else inf = fopen (real_name, "r"); if (inf == NULL) { @@ -1543,7 +1667,7 @@ new_pfnote (name, namelen, is_func, linestart, linelen, lno, cno) named = FALSE; /* use unnamed tag */ } } - + if (named) name = savenstr (name, namelen); else @@ -1705,7 +1829,7 @@ put_entries (np) } /* Length of a number's decimal representation. */ -int +static int number_len (num) long num; { @@ -1757,7 +1881,7 @@ enum sym_type st_C_ignore, st_C_javastruct, st_C_operator, - st_C_struct, st_C_enum, st_C_define, st_C_typedef, st_C_typespec + st_C_struct, st_C_extern, st_C_enum, st_C_define, st_C_typedef, st_C_typespec }; /* Feed stuff between (but not including) %[ and %] lines to: @@ -1765,6 +1889,11 @@ enum sym_type %[ struct C_stab_entry { char *name; int c_ext; enum sym_type type; } %% +if, 0, st_C_ignore +for, 0, st_C_ignore +while, 0, st_C_ignore +switch, 0, st_C_ignore +return, 0, st_C_ignore @interface, 0, st_C_objprot @protocol, 0, st_C_objprot @implementation,0, st_C_objimpl @@ -1780,6 +1909,7 @@ namespace, C_PLPL, st_C_struct domain, C_STAR, st_C_struct union, 0, st_C_struct struct, 0, st_C_struct +extern, 0, st_C_extern enum, 0, st_C_enum typedef, 0, st_C_typedef define, 0, st_C_define @@ -1795,7 +1925,6 @@ signed, 0, st_C_typespec unsigned, 0, st_C_typespec auto, 0, st_C_typespec void, 0, st_C_typespec -extern, 0, st_C_typespec static, 0, st_C_typespec const, 0, st_C_typespec volatile, 0, st_C_typespec @@ -1814,113 +1943,152 @@ PSEUDO, 0, st_C_gnumacro %] and replace lines between %< and %> with its output. */ /*%<*/ -/* C code produced by gperf version 2.5 (GNU C++ version) */ +/* C code produced by gperf version 2.7.1 (19981006 egcs) */ /* Command-line: gperf -c -k 1,3 -o -p -r -t */ struct C_stab_entry { char *name; int c_ext; enum sym_type type; }; -#define TOTAL_KEYWORDS 41 -#define MIN_WORD_LENGTH 3 +#define TOTAL_KEYWORDS 46 +#define MIN_WORD_LENGTH 2 #define MAX_WORD_LENGTH 15 -#define MIN_HASH_VALUE 20 -#define MAX_HASH_VALUE 136 -/* maximum key range = 117, duplicates = 0 */ +#define MIN_HASH_VALUE 13 +#define MAX_HASH_VALUE 123 +/* maximum key range = 111, duplicates = 0 */ +#ifdef __GNUC__ +__inline +#endif static unsigned int hash (str, len) - register char *str; - register int unsigned len; + register const char *str; + register unsigned int len; { static unsigned char asso_values[] = { - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 58, 137, 137, 137, 38, 37, - 45, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 62, 137, 137, 14, 16, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 26, 16, 51, - 18, 61, 5, 19, 137, 23, 137, 137, 32, 63, - 54, 10, 26, 137, 24, 42, 30, 18, 46, 137, - 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, 137, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 3, 124, 124, 124, 43, 6, + 11, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 11, 124, 124, 58, 7, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 57, 7, 42, + 4, 14, 52, 0, 124, 53, 124, 124, 29, 11, + 6, 35, 32, 124, 29, 34, 59, 58, 51, 24, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, + 124, 124, 124, 124, 124, 124 }; - return len + asso_values[str[2]] + asso_values[str[0]]; + register int hval = len; + + switch (hval) + { + default: + case 3: + hval += asso_values[(unsigned char)str[2]]; + case 2: + case 1: + hval += asso_values[(unsigned char)str[0]]; + break; + } + return hval; } -struct C_stab_entry * +#ifdef __GNUC__ +__inline +#endif +static struct C_stab_entry * in_word_set (str, len) - register char *str; + register const char *str; register unsigned int len; { static struct C_stab_entry wordlist[] = { - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"",}, {"",}, - {"float", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"define", 0, st_C_define}, - {"bool", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"friend", C_PLPL, st_C_ignore}, - {"SYSCALL", 0, st_C_gnumacro}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"double", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"union", 0, st_C_struct}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"import", C_JAVA, st_C_ignore}, - {"int", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"short", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"ENTRY", 0, st_C_gnumacro}, - {"implements", C_JAVA, st_C_javastruct}, - {"auto", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, - {"interface", C_JAVA, st_C_struct}, - {"typedef", 0, st_C_typedef}, - {"typename", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, - {"signed", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"unsigned", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"struct", 0, st_C_struct}, - {"void", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"static", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"operator", C_PLPL, st_C_operator}, - {"",}, - {"char", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"class", C_PLPL, st_C_struct}, - {"enum", 0, st_C_enum}, - {"package", C_JAVA, st_C_ignore}, - {"",}, - {"volatile", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"domain", C_STAR, st_C_struct}, - {"DEFUN", 0, st_C_gnumacro}, - {"",}, - {"long", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"@protocol", 0, st_C_objprot}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"explicit", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, - {"extern", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"extends", C_JAVA, st_C_javastruct}, - {"",}, - {"mutable", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"PSEUDO", 0, st_C_gnumacro}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"const", 0, st_C_typespec}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"@end", 0, st_C_objend}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"@interface", 0, st_C_objprot}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"namespace", C_PLPL, st_C_struct}, - {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, {"",}, - {"@implementation", 0, st_C_objimpl}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"@end", 0, st_C_objend}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"ENTRY", 0, st_C_gnumacro}, + {"@interface", 0, st_C_objprot}, + {""}, + {"domain", C_STAR, st_C_struct}, + {""}, + {"PSEUDO", 0, st_C_gnumacro}, + {""}, {""}, + {"namespace", C_PLPL, st_C_struct}, + {""}, {""}, + {"@implementation",0, st_C_objimpl}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"long", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"signed", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"@protocol", 0, st_C_objprot}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"bool", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"const", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"explicit", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, + {"if", 0, st_C_ignore}, + {""}, + {"operator", C_PLPL, st_C_operator}, + {""}, + {"DEFUN", 0, st_C_gnumacro}, + {""}, {""}, + {"define", 0, st_C_define}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"double", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"struct", 0, st_C_struct}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"short", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {""}, + {"enum", 0, st_C_enum}, + {"mutable", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, + {""}, + {"extern", 0, st_C_extern}, + {"extends", C_JAVA, st_C_javastruct}, + {"package", C_JAVA, st_C_ignore}, + {"while", 0, st_C_ignore}, + {""}, + {"for", 0, st_C_ignore}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"volatile", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {""}, {""}, + {"import", C_JAVA, st_C_ignore}, + {"float", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"switch", 0, st_C_ignore}, + {"return", 0, st_C_ignore}, + {"implements", C_JAVA, st_C_javastruct}, + {""}, + {"static", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"typedef", 0, st_C_typedef}, + {"typename", C_PLPL, st_C_typespec}, + {"unsigned", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {""}, {""}, + {"char", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"class", C_PLPL, st_C_struct}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"void", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {""}, {""}, + {"friend", C_PLPL, st_C_ignore}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"int", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"union", 0, st_C_struct}, + {""}, {""}, {""}, + {"auto", 0, st_C_typespec}, + {"interface", C_JAVA, st_C_struct}, + {""}, + {"SYSCALL", 0, st_C_gnumacro} }; if (len <= MAX_WORD_LENGTH && len >= MIN_WORD_LENGTH) @@ -1929,9 +2097,9 @@ in_word_set (str, len) if (key <= MAX_HASH_VALUE && key >= 0) { - register char *s = wordlist[key].name; + register const char *s = wordlist[key].name; - if (*s == *str && !strncmp (str + 1, s + 1, len - 1)) + if (*str == *s && !strncmp (str + 1, s + 1, len - 1)) return &wordlist[key]; } } @@ -1939,7 +2107,7 @@ in_word_set (str, len) } /*%>*/ -enum sym_type +static enum sym_type C_symtype (str, len, c_ext) char *str; int len; @@ -1968,6 +2136,7 @@ enum vignore /* var-like: ignore until ';' */ } fvdef; +bool fvextern; /* func or var: extern keyword seen; */ /* * typedefs are recognized using a simple finite automaton. @@ -1976,7 +2145,8 @@ enum enum { tnone, /* nothing seen */ - ttypedseen, /* typedef keyword seen */ + tkeyseen, /* typedef keyword seen */ + ttypeseen, /* defined type seen */ tinbody, /* inside typedef body */ tend, /* just before typedef tag */ tignore /* junk after typedef tag */ @@ -2093,7 +2263,7 @@ int methodlen; * next_token_is_func IN OUT */ -bool +static bool consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) register char *str; /* IN: token pointer */ register int len; /* IN: token length */ @@ -2149,20 +2319,20 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) if (toktype == st_C_typedef) { if (typedefs) - typdef = ttypedseen; + typdef = tkeyseen; + fvextern = FALSE; fvdef = fvnone; return FALSE; } break; - case ttypedseen: + case tkeyseen: switch (toktype) { case st_none: case st_C_typespec: - typdef = tend; - break; case st_C_struct: case st_C_enum: + typdef = ttypeseen; break; } /* Do not return here, so the structdef stuff has a chance. */ @@ -2196,7 +2366,7 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) return FALSE; case st_C_struct: case st_C_enum: - if (typdef == ttypedseen + if (typdef == tkeyseen || (typedefs_and_cplusplus && cblev == 0 && structdef == snone)) { structdef = skeyseen; @@ -2217,16 +2387,14 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) return TRUE; } - /* Avoid entering fvdef stuff if typdef is going on. */ if (typdef != tnone) - { - definedef = dnone; - return FALSE; - } + definedef = dnone; /* Detect GNU macros. - DEFUN note for writers of emacs C code: + Writers of emacs code are recommended to put the + first two args of a DEFUN on the same line. + The DEFUN macro, used in emacs C source code, has a first arg that is a string (the lisp function name), and a second arg that is a C function name. Since etags skips strings, the second arg @@ -2236,8 +2404,7 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) removing the initial 'F' character and substituting '-' for '_'. Anyway, this assumes that the conventions of naming lisp functions will never change. Currently, this method is not - implemented, so writers of emacs code are recommended to put the - first two args of a DEFUN on the same line. */ + implemented. */ if (definedef == dnone && toktype == st_C_gnumacro) { next_token_is_func = TRUE; @@ -2326,11 +2493,15 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) /* A function, variable or enum constant? */ switch (toktype) { + case st_C_extern: + fvextern = TRUE; + /* FALLTHRU */ case st_C_typespec: - if (fvdef != finlist && fvdef != fignore && fvdef != vignore) - fvdef = fvnone; /* should be useless */ + if (fvdef != finlist && fvdef != fignore && fvdef != vignore) + fvdef = fvnone; /* should be useless */ return FALSE; case st_C_ignore: + fvextern = FALSE; fvdef = vignore; return FALSE; case st_C_operator: @@ -2338,6 +2509,12 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) *is_func_or_var = TRUE; return TRUE; case st_none: + if ((c_ext & C_PLPL) && strneq (str+len-10, "::operator", 10)) + { + fvdef = foperator; + *is_func_or_var = TRUE; + return TRUE; + } if (constantypedefs && structdef == sinbody && structtype == st_C_enum) return TRUE; if (fvdef == fvnone) @@ -2346,6 +2523,7 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) *is_func_or_var = TRUE; return TRUE; } + break; } return FALSE; @@ -2355,7 +2533,7 @@ consider_token (str, len, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, is_func_or_var) * C_entries () * This routine finds functions, variables, typedefs, * #define's, enum constants and struct/union/enum definitions in - * #C syntax and adds them to the list. + * C syntax and adds them to the list. */ #define current_lb_is_new (newndx == curndx) #define switch_line_buffers() (curndx = 1 - curndx) @@ -2390,7 +2568,7 @@ do { \ } while (0) -void +static void make_C_tag (isfun) bool isfun; { @@ -2434,7 +2612,7 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) int cblev; /* current curly brace level */ int parlev; /* current parenthesis level */ bool incomm, inquote, inchar, quotednl, midtoken; - bool cplpl, cjava; + bool purec, cplpl, cjava; token savetok; /* token saved during preprocessor handling */ @@ -2445,13 +2623,14 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) lp = curlb.buffer; *lp = 0; - fvdef = fvnone; typdef = tnone; structdef = snone; - definedef = dnone; objdef = onone; + fvdef = fvnone; fvextern = FALSE; typdef = tnone; + structdef = snone; definedef = dnone; objdef = onone; next_token_is_func = yacc_rules = FALSE; midtoken = inquote = inchar = incomm = quotednl = FALSE; tok.valid = savetok.valid = FALSE; cblev = 0; parlev = 0; + purec = !(c_ext & ~YACC); /* no extensions (apart from possibly yacc) */ cplpl = (c_ext & C_PLPL) == C_PLPL; cjava = (c_ext & C_JAVA) == C_JAVA; if (cjava) @@ -2530,12 +2709,18 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) case '"': inquote = TRUE; if (fvdef != finlist && fvdef != fignore && fvdef !=vignore) - fvdef = fvnone; + { + fvextern = FALSE; + fvdef = fvnone; + } continue; case '\'': inchar = TRUE; if (fvdef != finlist && fvdef != fignore && fvdef !=vignore) - fvdef = fvnone; + { + fvextern = FALSE; + fvdef = fvnone; + } continue; case '/': if (*lp == '*') @@ -2556,7 +2741,7 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) { /* entering or exiting rules section in yacc file */ lp++; - definedef = dnone; fvdef = fvnone; + definedef = dnone; fvdef = fvnone; fvextern = FALSE; typdef = tnone; structdef = snone; next_token_is_func = FALSE; midtoken = inquote = inchar = incomm = quotednl = FALSE; @@ -2598,7 +2783,7 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) if ((definedef != dnone || (cblev == 0 && structdef != scolonseen) || (cblev == 1 && cplpl && structdef == sinbody) - || (structdef == sinbody && structtype == st_C_enum)) + || (structdef == sinbody && purec)) && typdef != tignore && definedef != dignorerest && fvdef != finlist) @@ -2607,42 +2792,46 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) { if (endtoken (c)) { - if (c == ':' && cplpl && *lp == ':' && begtoken(*(lp + 1))) + bool funorvar = FALSE; + + if (c == ':' && cplpl && *lp == ':' && begtoken (lp[1])) { /* * This handles :: in the middle, but not at the - * beginning of an identifier. + * beginning of an identifier. Also, space-separated + * :: is not recognised. */ lp += 2; - toklen += 3; + toklen += 2; + c = lp[-1]; + goto intok; } else { - bool funorvar = FALSE; - if (yacc_rules || consider_token (newlb.buffer + tokoff, toklen, c, c_ext, cblev, parlev, &funorvar)) { + if (fvdef == foperator) + { + char *oldlp = lp; + lp = skip_spaces (lp-1); + if (*lp != '\0') + lp += 1; + while (*lp != '\0' + && !isspace (*lp) && *lp != '(') + lp += 1; + c = *lp++; + toklen += lp - oldlp; + } tok.named = FALSE; - if (structdef == sinbody + if (!purec + && funorvar && definedef == dnone - && funorvar) + && structdef == sinbody) /* function or var defined in C++ class body */ { - int len; - if (fvdef == foperator) - { - char *oldlp = lp; - lp = skip_spaces (lp-1); - while (*lp != '\0' - && !isspace (*lp) && *lp != '(') - lp += 1; - c = *lp++; - toklen += lp - oldlp; - } - - len = strlen (structtag) + qlen + toklen; + int len = strlen (structtag) + qlen + toklen; grow_linebuffer (&token_name, len + 1); strcpy (token_name.buffer, structtag); strcat (token_name.buffer, qualifier); @@ -2677,11 +2866,15 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) newlb.buffer + tokoff, toklen); token_name.buffer[toklen] = '\0'; token_name.len = toklen; - /* Name macros. */ + /* Name macros and members. */ tok.named = (structdef == stagseen + || typdef == ttypeseen || typdef == tend || (funorvar - && definedef == dignorerest)); + && definedef == dignorerest) + || (funorvar + && definedef == dnone + && structdef == sinbody)); } tok.lineno = lineno; tok.linelen = tokoff + toklen + 1; @@ -2706,6 +2899,7 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) } } /* if (endtoken (c)) */ else if (intoken (c)) + intok: { toklen++; continue; @@ -2781,6 +2975,7 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) } break; case fstartlist: + fvextern = FALSE; fvdef = fvnone; break; } @@ -2802,10 +2997,19 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) case fignore: break; case fvnameseen: - if ((globals && cblev == 0) || (members && cblev == 1)) + if ((members && cblev == 1) + || (globals && cblev == 0 && (!fvextern || declarations))) make_C_tag (FALSE); /* a variable */ + fvextern = FALSE; + fvdef = fvnone; + tok.valid = FALSE; + break; + case flistseen: + if (declarations && (cblev == 0 || cblev == 1)) + make_C_tag (TRUE); /* a function declaration */ /* FALLTHRU */ default: + fvextern = FALSE; fvdef = fvnone; /* The following instruction invalidates the token. Probably the token should be invalidated in all @@ -2834,7 +3038,8 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) case vignore: break; case fvnameseen: - if ((globals && cblev == 0) || (members && cblev == 1)) + if ((members && cblev == 1) + || (globals && cblev == 0 && (!fvextern || declarations))) make_C_tag (FALSE); /* a variable */ break; default: @@ -2860,7 +3065,8 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) case vignore: break; case fvnameseen: - if ((globals && cblev == 0) || (members && cblev == 1)) + if ((members && cblev == 1) + || (globals && cblev == 0 && (!fvextern || declarations))) make_C_tag (FALSE); /* a variable */ /* FALLTHRU */ default: @@ -2876,23 +3082,19 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) objdef = oparenseen; switch (fvdef) { - case fvnone: - switch (typdef) - { - case ttypedseen: - case tend: - if (tok.valid && *lp != '*') - { - /* This handles constructs like: - typedef void OperatorFun (int fun); */ - make_C_tag (FALSE); - typdef = tignore; - } - break; - } /* switch (typdef) */ - break; - case foperator: /* operator() is not handled */ case fvnameseen: + if (typdef == ttypeseen + && tok.valid + && *lp != '*' + && structdef != sinbody) + { + /* This handles constructs like: + typedef void OperatorFun (int fun); */ + make_C_tag (FALSE); + typdef = tignore; + } + /* FALLTHRU */ + case foperator: fvdef = fstartlist; break; case flistseen: @@ -2918,7 +3120,7 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) fvdef = flistseen; break; } - if (cblev == 0 && typdef == tend) + if (cblev == 0 && (typdef == tend)) { typdef = tignore; make_C_tag (FALSE); /* a typedef */ @@ -2930,7 +3132,7 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) case '{': if (definedef != dnone) break; - if (typdef == ttypedseen) + if (typdef == ttypeseen) typdef = tinbody; switch (structdef) { @@ -3015,7 +3217,8 @@ C_entries (c_ext, inf) case vignore: break; case fvnameseen: - if ((globals && cblev == 0) || (members && cblev == 1)) + if ((members && cblev == 1) + || (globals && cblev == 0 && (!fvextern || declarations))) make_C_tag (FALSE); /* a variable */ /* FALLTHRU */ default: @@ -3114,7 +3317,7 @@ Yacc_entries (inf) C_entries (YACC, inf); } -/* A useful macro. */ +/* A useful macro. */ #define LOOP_ON_INPUT_LINES(file_pointer, line_buffer, char_pointer) \ for (lineno = charno = 0; /* loop initialization */ \ !feof (file_pointer) /* loop test */ \ @@ -3142,15 +3345,15 @@ just_read_file (inf) /* Fortran parsing */ -bool +static bool tail (cp) char *cp; { register int len = 0; - while (*cp && lowcase(*cp) == lowcase(dbp[len])) + while (*cp != '\0' && lowcase (*cp) == lowcase (dbp[len])) cp++, len++; - if (*cp == '\0' && !intoken(dbp[len])) + if (*cp == '\0' && !intoken (dbp[len])) { dbp += len; return TRUE; @@ -3181,7 +3384,7 @@ takeprec () while (isdigit (*dbp)); } -void +static void getit (inf) FILE *inf; { @@ -3199,11 +3402,9 @@ getit (inf) dbp += 6; dbp = skip_spaces (dbp); } - if (!isalpha (*dbp) - && *dbp != '_' - && *dbp != '$') + if (!isalpha (*dbp) && *dbp != '_' && *dbp != '$') return; - for (cp = dbp + 1; *cp && intoken (*cp); cp++) + for (cp = dbp + 1; *cp != '\0' && intoken (*cp); cp++) continue; pfnote (savenstr (dbp, cp-dbp), TRUE, lb.buffer, cp - lb.buffer + 1, lineno, linecharno); @@ -3268,10 +3469,6 @@ Fortran_functions (inf) if (tail ("entry")) getit (inf); continue; - case 'p': - if (tail ("program") || tail ("procedure")) - getit (inf); - continue; case 'b': if (tail ("blockdata") || tail ("block data")) { @@ -3288,6 +3485,171 @@ Fortran_functions (inf) } /* + * Philippe Waroquiers , 1998-04-24 + * Ada parsing + */ +/* Once we are positioned after an "interesting" keyword, let's get + the real tag value necessary. */ +static void +adagetit (inf, name_qualifier) + FILE *inf; + char *name_qualifier; +{ + register char *cp; + char *name; + char c; + + while (!feof (inf)) + { + dbp = skip_spaces (dbp); + if (*dbp == '\0' + || (dbp[0] == '-' && dbp[1] == '-')) + { + lineno++; + linecharno = charno; + charno += readline (&lb, inf); + dbp = lb.buffer; + } + switch (*dbp) + { + case 'b': + case 'B': + if (tail ("body")) + { + /* Skipping body of procedure body or package body or .... + resetting qualifier to body instead of spec. */ + name_qualifier = "/b"; + continue; + } + break; + case 't': + case 'T': + /* Skipping type of task type or protected type ... */ + if (tail ("type")) + continue; + break; + } + if (*dbp == '"') + { + dbp += 1; + for (cp = dbp; *cp != '\0' && *cp != '"'; cp++) + continue; + } + else + { + dbp = skip_spaces (dbp); + for (cp = dbp; + (*cp != '\0' + && (isalpha (*cp) || isdigit (*cp) || *cp == '_' || *cp == '.')); + cp++) + continue; + if (cp == dbp) + return; + } + c = *cp; + *cp = '\0'; + name = concat (dbp, name_qualifier, ""); + *cp = c; + pfnote (name, TRUE, lb.buffer, cp - lb.buffer + 1, lineno, linecharno); + if (c == '"') + dbp = cp + 1; + return; + } +} + +void +Ada_funcs (inf) + FILE *inf; +{ + bool inquote = FALSE; + + LOOP_ON_INPUT_LINES (inf, lb, dbp) + { + while (*dbp != '\0') + { + /* Skip a string i.e. "abcd". */ + if (inquote || (*dbp == '"')) + { + dbp = etags_strchr ((inquote) ? dbp : dbp+1, '"'); + if (dbp != NULL) + { + inquote = FALSE; + dbp += 1; + continue; /* advance char */ + } + else + { + inquote = TRUE; + break; /* advance line */ + } + } + + /* Skip comments. */ + if (dbp[0] == '-' && dbp[1] == '-') + break; /* advance line */ + + /* Skip character enclosed in single quote i.e. 'a' + and skip single quote starting an attribute i.e. 'Image. */ + if (*dbp == '\'') + { + dbp++ ; + if (*dbp != '\0') + dbp++; + continue; + } + + /* Search for beginning of a token. */ + if (!begtoken (*dbp)) + { + dbp++; + continue; /* advance char */ + } + + /* We are at the beginning of a token. */ + switch (*dbp) + { + case 'f': + case 'F': + if (!packages_only && tail ("function")) + adagetit (inf, "/f"); + else + break; /* from switch */ + continue; /* advance char */ + case 'p': + case 'P': + if (!packages_only && tail ("procedure")) + adagetit (inf, "/p"); + else if (tail ("package")) + adagetit (inf, "/s"); + else if (tail ("protected")) /* protected type */ + adagetit (inf, "/t"); + else + break; /* from switch */ + continue; /* advance char */ + case 't': + case 'T': + if (!packages_only && tail ("task")) + adagetit (inf, "/k"); + else if (typedefs && !packages_only && tail ("type")) + { + adagetit (inf, "/t"); + while (*dbp != '\0') + dbp += 1; + } + else + break; /* from switch */ + continue; /* advance char */ + } + + /* Look for the end of the token. */ + while (!endtoken (*dbp)) + dbp++; + + } /* advance char */ + } /* advance line */ +} + +/* * Bob Weiner, Motorola Inc., 4/3/94 * Unix and microcontroller assembly tag handling * look for '^[a-zA-Z_.$][a-zA_Z0-9_.$]*[: ^I^J]' @@ -3311,7 +3673,7 @@ Asm_labels (inf) if (*cp == ':' || isspace (*cp)) { /* Found end of label, so copy it and add it to the table. */ - pfnote ((CTAGS) ? savenstr(lb.buffer, cp-lb.buffer) : NULL, TRUE, + pfnote (savenstr(lb.buffer, cp-lb.buffer), TRUE, lb.buffer, cp - lb.buffer + 1, lineno, linecharno); } } @@ -3345,7 +3707,7 @@ Perl_functions (inf) cp++; pfnote (savenstr (sp, cp-sp), TRUE, lb.buffer, cp - lb.buffer + 1, lineno, linecharno); - } + } } else if (globals /* only if tagging global vars is enabled */ && ((cp = lb.buffer, @@ -3377,7 +3739,7 @@ Perl_functions (inf) while (*cp != '\0' && *cp != ';' && *cp != '=' && *cp != ')') cp++; } - + /* Perhaps I should back cp up one character, so the TAGS table doesn't mention (and so depend upon) the following char. */ pfnote ((CTAGS) ? savenstr (lb.buffer, cp-lb.buffer) : varname, @@ -3498,8 +3860,8 @@ Pascal_functions (inf) inparms = FALSE; /* found '(' after "proc" */ verify_tag = FALSE; /* check if "extern" is ahead */ - - while (!feof (inf)) /* long main loop to get next char */ + + while (!feof (inf)) /* long main loop to get next char */ { c = *dbp++; if (c == '\0') /* if end of line */ @@ -3640,7 +4002,7 @@ Pascal_functions (inf) * lisp tag functions * look for (def or (DEF, quote or QUOTE */ -int +static int L_isdef (strp) register char *strp; { @@ -3649,7 +4011,7 @@ L_isdef (strp) && (strp[3] == 'f' || strp[3] == 'F')); } -int +static int L_isquote (strp) register char *strp; { @@ -3661,7 +4023,7 @@ L_isquote (strp) && isspace (*++strp)); } -void +static void L_getit () { register char *cp; @@ -3678,7 +4040,7 @@ L_getit () } for (cp = dbp /*+1*/; - *cp != '\0' && *cp != '(' && *cp != ' ' && *cp != ')'; + *cp != '\0' && *cp != '(' && !isspace(*cp) && *cp != ')'; cp++) continue; if (cp == dbp) @@ -3731,8 +4093,10 @@ Lisp_functions (inf) * Postscript tag functions * Just look for lines where the first character is '/' * Richard Mlynarik + * Also look at "defineps" for PSWrap + * suggested by Masatake YAMATO */ -void +void Postscript_functions (inf) FILE *inf; { @@ -3746,9 +4110,15 @@ Postscript_functions (inf) *ep != '\0' && *ep != ' ' && *ep != '{'; ep++) continue; - pfnote ((CTAGS) ? savenstr (bp, ep-bp) : NULL, TRUE, + pfnote (savenstr (bp, ep-bp), TRUE, lb.buffer, ep - lb.buffer + 1, lineno, linecharno); } + else if (strneq (bp, "defineps", 8)) + { + bp = skip_non_spaces (bp); + bp = skip_spaces (bp); + get_tag (bp); + } } } @@ -3761,54 +4131,38 @@ Postscript_functions (inf) * look for (set! xyzzy */ -void get_scheme (); - void Scheme_functions (inf) FILE *inf; { - LOOP_ON_INPUT_LINES (inf, lb, dbp) + register char *bp; + + LOOP_ON_INPUT_LINES (inf, lb, bp) { - if (dbp[0] == '(' - && (dbp[1] == 'D' || dbp[1] == 'd') - && (dbp[2] == 'E' || dbp[2] == 'e') - && (dbp[3] == 'F' || dbp[3] == 'f')) + if (bp[0] == '(' + && (bp[1] == 'D' || bp[1] == 'd') + && (bp[2] == 'E' || bp[2] == 'e') + && (bp[3] == 'F' || bp[3] == 'f')) { - dbp = skip_non_spaces (dbp); + bp = skip_non_spaces (bp); /* Skip over open parens and white space */ - while (isspace (*dbp) || *dbp == '(') - dbp++; - get_scheme (); + while (isspace (*bp) || *bp == '(') + bp++; + get_tag (bp); } - if (dbp[0] == '(' - && (dbp[1] == 'S' || dbp[1] == 's') - && (dbp[2] == 'E' || dbp[2] == 'e') - && (dbp[3] == 'T' || dbp[3] == 't') - && (dbp[4] == '!' || dbp[4] == '!') - && (isspace (dbp[5]))) + if (bp[0] == '(' + && (bp[1] == 'S' || bp[1] == 's') + && (bp[2] == 'E' || bp[2] == 'e') + && (bp[3] == 'T' || bp[3] == 't') + && (bp[4] == '!' || bp[4] == '!') + && (isspace (bp[5]))) { - dbp = skip_non_spaces (dbp); - dbp = skip_spaces (dbp); - get_scheme (); + bp = skip_non_spaces (bp); + bp = skip_spaces (bp); + get_tag (bp); } } } - -void -get_scheme () -{ - register char *cp; - - if (*dbp == '\0') - return; - /* Go till you get to white space or a syntactic break */ - for (cp = dbp + 1; - *cp != '\0' && *cp != '(' && *cp != ')' && !isspace (*cp); - cp++) - continue; - pfnote (savenstr (dbp, cp-dbp), TRUE, - lb.buffer, cp - lb.buffer + 1, lineno, linecharno); -} /* Find tags in TeX and LaTeX input files. */ @@ -3830,9 +4184,9 @@ char *TEX_defenv = "\ :chapter:section:subsection:subsubsection:eqno:label:ref:cite:bibitem\ :part:appendix:entry:index"; -void TEX_mode (); -struct TEX_tabent *TEX_decode_env (); -int TEX_Token (); +void TEX_mode (FILE *inf); +struct TEX_tabent *TEX_decode_env (char *evarname, char *defenv); +int TEX_Token (char *cp); char TEX_esc = '\\'; char TEX_opgrp = '{'; @@ -3996,11 +4350,11 @@ TEX_Token (cp) * Prolog support (rewritten) by Anders Lindgren, Mar. 96 * * Assumes that the predicate starts at column 0. - * Only the first clause of a predicate is added. + * Only the first clause of a predicate is added. */ -int prolog_pred (); -void prolog_skip_comment (); -int prolog_atom (); +int prolog_pred (char *s, char *last); +void prolog_skip_comment (linebuffer *plb, FILE *inf); +int prolog_atom (char *s, int pos); void Prolog_functions (inf) @@ -4091,8 +4445,7 @@ prolog_pred (s, last) || len != (int)strlen (last) || !strneq (s, last, len)) { - pfnote ((CTAGS) ? savenstr (s, len) : NULL, TRUE, - s, pos, lineno, linecharno); + pfnote (savenstr (s, len), TRUE, s, pos, lineno, linecharno); return len; } } @@ -4131,7 +4484,7 @@ prolog_atom (s, pos) { pos++; - while (1) + while (1) { if (s[pos] == '\'') { @@ -4158,16 +4511,16 @@ prolog_atom (s, pos) return -1; } -/* +/* * Support for Erlang -- Anders Lindgren, Feb 1996. * * Generates tags for functions, defines, and records. * * Assumes that Erlang functions start at column 0. */ -int erlang_func (); -void erlang_attribute (); -int erlang_atom (); +int erlang_func (char *s, char *last); +void erlang_attribute (char *s); +int erlang_atom (char *s, int pos); void Erlang_functions (inf) @@ -4198,7 +4551,7 @@ Erlang_functions (inf) } else if ((len = erlang_func (cp, last)) > 0) { - /* + /* * Function. Store the function name so that we only * generates a tag for the first clause. */ @@ -4245,8 +4598,7 @@ erlang_func (s, last) || len != (int)strlen (last) || !strneq (s, last, len))) { - pfnote ((CTAGS) ? savenstr (s, len) : NULL, TRUE, - s, pos, lineno, linecharno); + pfnote (savenstr (s, len), TRUE, s, pos, lineno, linecharno); return len; } @@ -4255,7 +4607,7 @@ erlang_func (s, last) /* - * Handle attributes. Currently, tags are generated for defines + * Handle attributes. Currently, tags are generated for defines * and records. * * They are on the form: @@ -4273,12 +4625,12 @@ erlang_attribute (s) if (strneq (s, "-define", 7) || strneq (s, "-record", 7)) { pos = skip_spaces (s + 7) - s; - if (s[pos++] == '(') + if (s[pos++] == '(') { pos = skip_spaces (s + pos) - s; len = erlang_atom (s, pos); if (len != 0) - pfnote ((CTAGS) ? savenstr (& s[pos], len) : NULL, TRUE, + pfnote (savenstr (& s[pos], len), TRUE, s, pos + len, lineno, linecharno); } } @@ -4311,7 +4663,7 @@ erlang_atom (s, pos) { pos++; - while (1) + while (1) { if (s[pos] == '\'') { @@ -4344,7 +4696,7 @@ erlang_atom (s, pos) an unquoted separator. Also turns "\t" into a Tab character. Returns pointer to terminating separator. Works in place. Null terminates name string. */ -char * +static char * scan_separators (name) char *name; { @@ -4384,8 +4736,9 @@ scan_separators (name) /* Look at the argument of --regex or --no-regex and do the right thing. Same for each line of a regexp file. */ void -analyse_regex (regex_arg) +analyse_regex (regex_arg, ignore_case) char *regex_arg; + bool ignore_case; { if (regex_arg == NULL) free_patterns (); /* --no-regex: remove existing regexps */ @@ -4416,7 +4769,7 @@ analyse_regex (regex_arg) } initbuffer (®exbuf); while (readline_internal (®exbuf, regexfp) > 0) - analyse_regex (regexbuf.buffer); + analyse_regex (regexbuf.buffer, ignore_case); free (regexbuf.buffer); fclose (regexfp); } @@ -4439,13 +4792,13 @@ analyse_regex (regex_arg) lang = get_language_from_name (lang_name); if (lang == NULL) return; - add_regex (cp + 1, lang); + add_regex (cp + 1, ignore_case, lang); } break; /* Regexp to be used for any language. */ default: - add_regex (regex_arg, NULL); + add_regex (regex_arg, ignore_case, NULL); break; } } @@ -4453,8 +4806,9 @@ analyse_regex (regex_arg) /* Turn a name, which is an ed-style (but Emacs syntax) regular expression, into a real regular expression by compiling it. */ void -add_regex (regexp_pattern, lang) +add_regex (regexp_pattern, ignore_case, lang) char *regexp_pattern; + bool ignore_case; language *lang; { char *name; @@ -4477,7 +4831,8 @@ add_regex (regexp_pattern, lang) (void) scan_separators (name); patbuf = xnew (1, struct re_pattern_buffer); - patbuf->translate = NULL; + /* Translation table to fold case if appropriate. */ + patbuf->translate = (ignore_case) ? lc_trans : NULL; patbuf->fastmap = NULL; patbuf->buffer = NULL; patbuf->allocated = 0; @@ -4503,7 +4858,7 @@ add_regex (regexp_pattern, lang) * Do the substitutions indicated by the regular expression and * arguments. */ -char * +static char * substitute (in, out, regs) char *in, *out; struct re_registers *regs; @@ -4567,6 +4922,23 @@ free_patterns () return; } +void +get_tag (bp) + register char *bp; +{ + register char *cp; + + if (*bp == '\0') + return; + /* Go till you get to white space or a syntactic break */ + for (cp = bp + 1; + *cp != '\0' && *cp != '(' && *cp != ')' && !isspace (*cp); + cp++) + continue; + pfnote (savenstr (bp, cp-bp), TRUE, + lb.buffer, cp - lb.buffer + 1, lineno, linecharno); +} + #endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ /* Initialize a linebuffer for use */ void @@ -4704,7 +5076,7 @@ readline (lbp, stream) } } #endif /* ETAGS_REGEXPS */ - + return result; } @@ -4830,7 +5202,7 @@ suggest_asking_for_help () /* Print error message. `s1' is printf control string, `s2' is arg for it. */ void error (s1, s2) - char *s1, *s2; + const char *s1, *s2; { fprintf (stderr, "%s: ", progname); fprintf (stderr, s1, s2); @@ -4919,6 +5291,10 @@ relative_filename (file, dir) while (*fp++ == *dp++) continue; fp--, dp--; /* back to the first differing char */ +#ifdef DOS_NT + if (fp == afn && afn[0] != '/') /* cannot build a relative name */ + return afn; +#endif do /* look at the equal chars until '/' */ fp--, dp--; while (*fp != '/'); @@ -4993,7 +5369,7 @@ absolute_filename (file, dir) slashp = etags_strchr (slashp + 1, '/'); } - + if (res[0] == '\0') return savestr ("/"); else @@ -5041,6 +5417,10 @@ canonicalize_filename (fn) register char *fn; { #ifdef DOS_NT + /* Canonicalize drive letter case. */ + if (islower (fn[0])) + fn[0] = toupper (fn[0]); + /* Convert backslashes to slashes. */ for (; *fn != '\0'; fn++) if (*fn == '\\') *fn = '/'; diff --git a/lib-src/gnuserv.c b/lib-src/gnuserv.c index 8400550..6b1364e 100644 --- a/lib-src/gnuserv.c +++ b/lib-src/gnuserv.c @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ main () #ifdef SYSV_IPC int ipc_qid = 0; /* ipc message queue id */ -int ipc_wpid = 0; /* watchdog task pid */ +pid_t ipc_wpid = 0; /* watchdog task pid */ /* @@ -111,7 +111,7 @@ ipc_spawn_watchdog (void) { if ((ipc_wpid = fork ()) == 0) { /* child process */ - int ppid = getppid (); /* parent's process id */ + pid_t ppid = getppid (); /* parent's process id */ setpgrp(); /* gnu kills process group on exit */ diff --git a/lib-src/gzip-el.sh b/lib-src/gzip-el.sh index 9d1563a..c1eb776 100755 --- a/lib-src/gzip-el.sh +++ b/lib-src/gzip-el.sh @@ -2,8 +2,8 @@ ### gzip-el.sh --- compress superfluous installed source lisp # Author: Jeff Miller -# Author: Hrvoje Niksic -# Maintainer: Steve Baur +# Author: Hrvoje Niksic +# Maintainer: Steve Baur # Created: 13 Feb 1997 # Version: 1.0 # Keywords: internal diff --git a/lib-src/update-autoloads.sh b/lib-src/update-autoloads.sh index ee56e65..9eb1ffe 100644 --- a/lib-src/update-autoloads.sh +++ b/lib-src/update-autoloads.sh @@ -58,6 +58,7 @@ REAL="$EMACS_DIR/`basename $EMACS`" echo "Rebuilding autoloads in $CANON_PWD" echo " with $REAL..." +#### echon really sucks! if [ "`uname -r | sed 's/\(.\).*/\1/'`" -gt 4 ]; then echon() { diff --git a/lisp/ChangeLog b/lisp/ChangeLog index 9a3c4fc..d3b49d9 100644 --- a/lisp/ChangeLog +++ b/lisp/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,35 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + +1999-11-18 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * minibuf.el (read-coding-system): Accept symbol and + coding-system object as a default-coding-system. + +1999-11-16 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * minibuf.el (read-coding-system): Accept symbol as + a default-coding-system. + +1999-10-06 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * apropos.el (apropos-documentation): Use insert instead + of princ. + +1999-11-07 William M. Perry + + * gpm.el: New gpm-minor-mode to turn GPM mouse support on & off + for the linux console. + + * mouse.el (mouse-consolidated-yank): Allow the mouse-yanking + stuff to work when you are not on a window system, since the GPM + mouse support now allows pasting from outside of XEmacs. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released diff --git a/lisp/about.el b/lisp/about.el index 9fcddb2..d76b533 100644 --- a/lisp/about.el +++ b/lisp/about.el @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ ;; Keywords: extensions ;; Version: 2.4 -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; This file is part of XEmacs. @@ -25,8 +25,8 @@ ;;; Synched up with: Not in FSF. -;; Original code: Jamie Zawinski -;; Text: Ben Wing , Jamie Zawinski +;; Original code: Jamie Zawinski +;; Text: Ben Wing , Jamie Zawinski ;; Hard: Amiga 1000, Progressive Peripherals Frame Grabber. ;; Soft: FG 2.0, DigiPaint 3.0, pbmplus (dec 91), xv 3.0. ;; Modified for 19.11 by Eduardo Pelegri-Llopart @@ -35,7 +35,7 @@ ;; 19.13 and 19.14 updating done by Chuck Thompson. ;; 19.15 and 20.0 updating done by Steve Baur and Martin Buchholz. -;; Completely rewritten for 20.3 by Hrvoje Niksic . +;; Completely rewritten for 20.3 by Hrvoje Niksic . ;; The original had no version numbers; I numbered the rewrite as 2.0. ;; Many things in this file are to gag. Ideally, we should just use @@ -57,19 +57,19 @@ (defvar xemacs-hackers '((ajc "Andrew Cosgriff" "ajc@bing.wattle.id.au") (baw "Barry Warsaw" "bwarsaw@python.org") - (bw "Bob Weiner" "weiner@altrasoft.com") + (bw "Bob Weiner" "weiner@beopen.com") (chr "Christian Nybø" "chr@mediascience.no") (cthomp "Chuck Thompson" "cthomp@xemacs.org") (dmoore "David Moore" "dmoore@ucsd.edu") (dkindred "Darrell Kindred" "dkindred@cmu.edu") (dv "Didier Verna" "verna@inf.enst.fr") - (hniksic "Hrvoje Niksic" "hniksic@srce.hr") + (hniksic "Hrvoje Niksic" "hniksic@xemacs.org") (jareth "Jareth Hein" "jareth@camelot.co.jp") (jason "Jason Mastaler" "jason@xemacs.org") (jens "Jens Lautenbacher" "jens@lemcbed.lem.uni-karlsruhe.de") (jmiller "Jeff Miller" "jmiller@smart.net") (juhp "Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen" "petersen@kurims.kyoto-u.ac.jp") - (jwz "Jamie Zawinski" "jwz@netscape.com") + (jwz "Jamie Zawinski" "jwz@jwz.org") (kazz "IENAGA Kazuyuki" "ienaga@jsys.co.jp") (kyle "Kyle Jones" "kyle_jones@wonderworks.com") (larsi "Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen" "larsi@gnus.org") @@ -98,29 +98,29 @@ ;; It is preferred to a simple string, because it makes maintenance ;; easier. Please add new URLs to this list. (defvar about-url-alist - '((ajc . "http://www-personal.monash.edu.au/~ajc/") - (altrasoft . "http://www.altrasoft.com/") - (ben . "http://www.666.com/ben/") + '((ajc . "http://www-personal.monash.edu.au/~ajc/") + (beopen . "http://www.beopen.com/") + (ben . "http://www.666.com/ben/") (ben-xemacs . "http://www.666.com/xemacs/") - (baw . "http://www.python.org/~bwarsaw/") - (cc-mode . "http://www.python.org/ftp/emacs/") - (chr . "http://www.xemacs.org/faq/") - (dkindred . "http://www.cs.cmu.edu/People/dkindred/me.html") - (dmoore . "http://oj.egbt.org/dmoore/") - (jason . "http://www.mastaler.com/") - (juhp . "http://www.kurims.kyoto-u.ac.jp/~petersen/") - (jwz . "http://people.netscape.com/jwz/") - (kazz . "http://www.imasy.or.jp/~kazz/") - (kyle . "http://www.wonderworks.com/kyle/") - (larsi . "http://www.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/") - (marcpa . "http://www.positron911.com/products/power.htm") - (ograf . "http://www.fga.de/~ograf/") - (pez . "http://www.dwwc.com/") - (piper . "http://www.xemacs.freeserve.co.uk/") - (vin . "http://www.upa.org/") - (stigb . "http://www.tihlde.hist.no/~stigb/") - (wget . "ftp://gnjilux.cc.fer.hr/pub/unix/util/wget/") - (xemacs . "http://www.xemacs.org/")) + (baw . "http://www.python.org/~bwarsaw/") + (cc-mode . "http://www.python.org/ftp/emacs/") + (chr . "http://www.xemacs.org/faq/") + (dkindred . "http://www.cs.cmu.edu/People/dkindred/me.html") + (dmoore . "http://oj.egbt.org/dmoore/") + (jason . "http://www.mastaler.com/") + (juhp . "http://www.kurims.kyoto-u.ac.jp/~petersen/") + (jwz . "http://www.jwz.org/") + (kazz . "http://www.imasy.or.jp/~kazz/") + (kyle . "http://www.wonderworks.com/kyle/") + (larsi . "http://www.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/") + (marcpa . "http://www.positron911.com/products/power.htm") + (ograf . "http://www.fga.de/~ograf/") + (pez . "http://www.dwwc.com/") + (piper . "http://www.xemacs.freeserve.co.uk/") + (vin . "http://www.upa.org/") + (stigb . "http://www.tihlde.hist.no/~stigb/") + (wget . "ftp://gnjilux.cc.fer.hr/pub/unix/util/wget/") + (xemacs . "http://www.xemacs.org/")) "Some of the more important URLs.") (defvar about-left-margin 3) @@ -717,12 +717,12 @@ MS Windows operating systems.\n")) (widget-insert "\ Author of the Hyperbole everyday information management hypertext system and the OO-Browser multi-language code browser. He also -designed the Altrasoft InfoDock integrated development environment +designed the BeOpen InfoDock integrated development environment for software engineers. It runs atop XEmacs and is available from -his firm, Altrasoft, which offers distributions, custom development, +his firm, BeOpen, which offers distributions, custom development, support, and training packages for corporate users of XEmacs, GNU Emacs and InfoDock. See ") - (about-url-link 'altrasoft "Visit Altrasoft WWW page") + (about-url-link 'beopen "Visit BeOpen WWW page") (widget-insert ". His interests include user interfaces, information management, @@ -1063,9 +1063,9 @@ to cygwin under MS-Windows.\n") (about-show-linked-info 'bw "\ Author of the Hyperbole everyday information management hypertext system and the OO-Browser multi-language code browser. He also -designed the Altrasoft InfoDock integrated development environment +designed the BeOpen InfoDock integrated development environment for software engineers. It runs atop XEmacs and is available from -his firm, Altrasoft, which offers custom development and support packages +his firm, BeOpen, which offers custom development and support packages for corporate users of XEmacs, GNU Emacs and InfoDock. His interests include user interfaces, information management, CASE tools, communications and enterprise integration.\n") diff --git a/lisp/apropos.el b/lisp/apropos.el index 5839194..f324ab0 100644 --- a/lisp/apropos.el +++ b/lisp/apropos.el @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ ;; Author: Joe Wells ;; Rewritten: Daniel.Pfeiffer@Informatik.START.dbp.de, fax (+49 69) 7588-2389 -;; Maintainer: SL Baur +;; Maintainer: SL Baur ;; Keywords: help ;; This file is part of XEmacs. @@ -377,7 +377,7 @@ Returns list of symbols and documentation found." (defun apropos-documentation-check-doc-file () (let (type symbol (sepa 2) sepb beg end) - (princ ?\^_) + (insert ?\^_) (backward-char) (insert-file-contents (concat doc-directory internal-doc-file-name)) (forward-char) diff --git a/lisp/auto-autoloads.el b/lisp/auto-autoloads.el index 01510e5..eceb685 100644 --- a/lisp/auto-autoloads.el +++ b/lisp/auto-autoloads.el @@ -572,7 +572,9 @@ If VARIABLE has a `variable-interactive' property, that is used as if it were the arg to `interactive' (which see) to interactively read the value. If VARIABLE has a `custom-type' property, it must be a widget and the -`:prompt-value' property of that widget will be used for reading the value." t nil) +`:prompt-value' property of that widget will be used for reading the value. + +If given a prefix (or a COMMENT argument), also prompt for a comment." t nil) (autoload 'customize-set-variable "cus-edit" "\ Set the default for VARIABLE to VALUE. VALUE is a Lisp object. @@ -587,7 +589,9 @@ If VARIABLE has a `variable-interactive' property, that is used as if it were the arg to `interactive' (which see) to interactively read the value. If VARIABLE has a `custom-type' property, it must be a widget and the -`:prompt-value' property of that widget will be used for reading the value. " t nil) +`:prompt-value' property of that widget will be used for reading the value. + +If given a prefix (or a COMMENT argument), also prompt for a comment." t nil) (autoload 'customize-save-variable "cus-edit" "\ Set the default for VARIABLE to VALUE, and save it for future sessions. @@ -601,7 +605,9 @@ If VARIABLE has a `variable-interactive' property, that is used as if it were the arg to `interactive' (which see) to interactively read the value. If VARIABLE has a `custom-type' property, it must be a widget and the -`:prompt-value' property of that widget will be used for reading the value. " t nil) +`:prompt-value' property of that widget will be used for reading the value. + +If given a prefix (or a COMMENT argument), also prompt for a comment." t nil) (autoload 'customize "cus-edit" "\ Select a customization buffer which you can use to set user options. @@ -698,7 +704,7 @@ The format is suitable for use with `easy-menu-define'." nil nil) ;;;*** -;;;### (autoloads (custom-set-faces custom-set-face-update-spec custom-declare-face) "cus-face" "lisp/cus-face.el") +;;;### (autoloads (custom-reset-faces custom-theme-reset-faces custom-theme-face-value custom-theme-set-faces custom-set-faces custom-set-face-update-spec custom-declare-face) "cus-face" "lisp/cus-face.el") (autoload 'custom-declare-face "cus-face" "\ Like `defface', but FACE is evaluated as a normal argument." nil nil) @@ -709,15 +715,35 @@ Customize the FACE for display types matching DISPLAY, merging (autoload 'custom-set-faces "cus-face" "\ Initialize faces according to user preferences. +This asociates the setting with the USER theme. The arguments should be a list where each entry has the form: - (FACE SPEC [NOW]) + (FACE SPEC [NOW [COMMENT]]) SPEC will be stored as the saved value for FACE. If NOW is present and non-nil, FACE will also be created according to SPEC. +COMMENT is a string comment about FACE. See `defface' for the format of SPEC." nil nil) +(autoload 'custom-theme-set-faces "cus-face" "\ +Initialize faces according to settings specified by args. +Records the settings as belonging to THEME. + +See `custom-set-faces' for a description of the arguments ARGS." nil nil) + +(autoload 'custom-theme-face-value "cus-face" "\ +Return spec of FACE in THEME if the THEME modifies the +FACE. Nil otherwise." nil nil) + +(autoload 'custom-theme-reset-faces "cus-face" nil nil nil) + +(autoload 'custom-reset-faces "cus-face" "\ +Reset the value of the face to values previously defined. +Assosiate this setting with the 'user' theme. + +ARGS is defined as for `custom-theme-reset-faces'" nil nil) + ;;;*** ;;;### (autoloads (disassemble) "disass" "lisp/disass.el") @@ -1057,11 +1083,11 @@ This can take a while for large buffers." t nil) ;;;*** -;;;### (autoloads (mswindows-font-menu-weight-constructor font-menu-size-constructor font-menu-family-constructor reset-device-font-menus) "font-menu" "lisp/font-menu.el") +;;;### (autoloads (font-menu-weight-constructor font-menu-size-constructor font-menu-family-constructor reset-device-font-menus) "font-menu" "lisp/font-menu.el") -(defcustom font-menu-ignore-scaled-fonts nil "*If non-nil, then the font menu will try to show only bitmap fonts." :type 'boolean :group 'x) +(defcustom font-menu-ignore-scaled-fonts nil "*If non-nil, then the font menu will try to show only bitmap fonts." :type 'boolean :group 'font-menu) -(defcustom font-menu-this-frame-only-p nil "*If non-nil, then changing the default font from the font menu will only\naffect one frame instead of all frames." :type 'boolean :group 'x) +(defcustom font-menu-this-frame-only-p nil "*If non-nil, then changing the default font from the font menu will only\naffect one frame instead of all frames." :type 'boolean :group 'font-menu) (fset 'install-font-menus 'reset-device-font-menus) @@ -1077,7 +1103,7 @@ or if you change your font path, you can call this to re-initialize the menus." (autoload 'font-menu-size-constructor "font-menu" nil nil nil) -(autoload 'mswindows-font-menu-weight-constructor "font-menu" nil nil nil) +(autoload 'font-menu-weight-constructor "font-menu" nil nil nil) ;;;*** @@ -1262,7 +1288,7 @@ If you don't like the lazy invocation of this function, you can add it to when they are selected for the first time. If you add fonts to your system, or if you change your font path, you can call this to re-initialize the menus." nil nil) -(defun* mswindows-font-menu-font-data (face dcache) (let* ((case-fold-search t) (domain (if font-menu-this-frame-only-p (selected-frame) (selected-device))) (name (font-instance-name (face-font-instance face domain))) (truename (font-instance-truename (face-font-instance face domain (if (featurep 'mule) 'ascii)))) family size weight entry slant) (when (string-match mswindows-font-regexp name) (setq family (capitalize (match-string 1 name))) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (and (null entry) (string-match mswindows-font-regexp truename)) (setq family (capitalize (match-string 1 truename))) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (null entry) (return-from font-menu-font-data (make-vector 5 nil))) (when (string-match mswindows-font-regexp name) (setq weight (capitalize (match-string 2 name))) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 4 name)))) (when (string-match mswindows-font-regexp truename) (when (not (member weight (aref entry 1))) (setq weight (capitalize (match-string 2 truename)))) (when (not (member size (aref entry 2))) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 4 truename)))) (setq slant (capitalize (match-string 5 truename)))) (vector entry family size weight slant))) +(defun* mswindows-font-menu-font-data (face dcache) (let* ((case-fold-search t) (domain (if font-menu-this-frame-only-p (selected-frame) (selected-device))) (name (font-instance-name (face-font-instance face domain))) (truename (font-instance-truename (face-font-instance face domain (if (featurep 'mule) 'ascii)))) family size weight entry slant) (when (string-match mswindows-font-regexp name) (setq family (match-string 1 name)) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (and (null entry) (string-match mswindows-font-regexp truename)) (setq family (match-string 1 truename)) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (null entry) (return-from mswindows-font-menu-font-data (make-vector 5 nil))) (when (string-match mswindows-font-regexp name) (setq weight (match-string 2 name)) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 4 name)))) (when (string-match mswindows-font-regexp truename) (when (not (member weight (aref entry 1))) (setq weight (match-string 2 truename))) (when (not (member size (aref entry 2))) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 4 truename)))) (setq slant (match-string 5 truename))) (vector entry family size weight slant))) ;;;*** @@ -1335,6 +1361,8 @@ recent to least recent -- in other words, the version names don't have to be lexically ordered. It is debatable if it makes sense to have more than one version of a package available.") +(defcustom package-get-download-sites '(("xemacs.org" "ftp.xemacs.org" "pub/xemacs/packages") ("cso.uiuc.edu" "ftp.cso.uiuc.edu" "pub/packages/xemacs/packages") ("unicamp.br" "ftp.unicamp.br" "pub/xemacs/packages") ("sunsite.cnlab-switch.ch" "sunsite.cnlab-switch.ch" "mirror/xemacs/packages") ("tu-darmstadt.de" "ftp.tu-darmstadt.de" "pub/editors/xemacs/packages") ("sunsite.auc.dk" "sunsite.auc.dk" "pub/emacs/xemacs/packages") ("pasteur.fr" "ftp.pasteur.fr" "pub/computing/xemacs/packages") ("cenatls.cena.dgac.fr" "ftp.cenatls.cena.dgac.fr" "pub/Emacs/xemacs/packages") ("kfki.hu" "ftp.kfki.hu" "pub/packages/xemacs/packages") ("uniroma2.it" "ftp.uniroma2.it" "unix/misc/dist/XEMACS/packages") ("icm.edu.pl" "ftp.icm.edu.pl" "pub/unix/editors/xemacs/packages") ("sunet.se" "ftp.sunet.se" "pub/gnu/xemacs/packages") ("doc.ic.ac.uk" "sunsite.doc.ic.ac.uk" "packages/xemacs/packages") ("srcc.msu.su" "ftp1.srcc.msu.su" "mirror/ftp.xemacs.org/packages") ("usyd.edu.au" "ftp.usyd.edu.au" "pub/Xemacs/packages") ("netlab.is.tsukuba.ac.jp" "ftp.netlab.is.tsukuba.ac.jp" "pub/GNU/xemacs/packages") ("jaist.ac.jp" "ftp.jaist.ac.jp" "pub/GNU/xemacs/packages") ("ring.aist.go.jp" "ring.aist.go.jp" "pub/text/xemacs/packages") ("ring.asahi-net.or.jp" "ring.asahi-net.or.jp" "pub/text/xemacs/packages") ("SunSITE.sut.ac.jp" "SunSITE.sut.ac.jp" "pub/archives/packages/xemacs/packages") ("dti.ad.jp" "ftp.dti.ad.jp" "pub/unix/editor/xemacs/packages") ("kreonet.re.kr" "ftp.kreonet.re.kr" "pub/tools/emacs/xemacs/packages")) "*List of remote sites available for downloading packages.\nList format is '(site-description site-name directory-on-site).\nSITE-DESCRIPTION is a textual description of the site. SITE-NAME\nis the internet address of the download site. DIRECTORY-ON-SITE\nis the directory on the site in which packages may be found.\nThis variable is used to initialize `package-get-remote', the\nvariable actually used to specify package download sites." :tag "Package download sites" :type '(repeat (list hostname directory)) :group 'package-get) + (autoload 'package-get-download-menu "package-get" "\ Build the `Add Download Site' menu." nil nil) @@ -1512,29 +1540,38 @@ they are not defaultly assigned to keys." t nil) ;;;*** -;;;### (autoloads (clear-rectangle string-rectangle open-rectangle insert-rectangle yank-rectangle kill-rectangle extract-rectangle delete-extract-rectangle delete-rectangle) "rect" "lisp/rect.el") +;;;### (autoloads (clear-rectangle string-rectangle open-rectangle insert-rectangle yank-rectangle extract-rectangle delete-extract-rectangle delete-rectangle kill-rectangle) "rect" "lisp/rect.el") + +(defvar killed-rectangle nil "\ +Rectangle for `yank-rectangle' to insert.") + +(autoload 'kill-rectangle "rect" "\ +Delete the region-rectangle and save it as the last killed one. +You might prefer to use `delete-extract-rectangle' from a program. + +When called from a program, the rectangle's corners are START and END. +With a prefix (or FILL) argument, also fill lines where nothing has to be +deleted." t nil) (autoload 'delete-rectangle "rect" "\ -Delete (don't save) text in rectangle with point and mark as corners. +Delete the text in the region-rectangle without saving it. The same range of columns is deleted in each line starting with the line -where the region begins and ending with the line where the region ends." t nil) +where the region begins and ending with the line where the region ends. + +When called from a program, the rectangle's corners are START and END. +With a prefix (or FILL) argument, also fill lines where nothing has to be +deleted." t nil) (autoload 'delete-extract-rectangle "rect" "\ -Delete contents of rectangle and return it as a list of strings. -Arguments START and END are the corners of the rectangle. -The value is list of strings, one for each line of the rectangle." nil nil) +Delete the contents of the rectangle with corners at START and END, and +return it as a list of strings, one for each line of the rectangle. -(autoload 'extract-rectangle "rect" "\ -Return contents of rectangle with corners at START and END. -Value is list of strings, one for each line of the rectangle." nil nil) +With an optional FILL argument, also fill lines where nothing has to be +deleted." nil nil) -(defvar killed-rectangle nil "\ -Rectangle for yank-rectangle to insert.") - -(autoload 'kill-rectangle "rect" "\ -Delete rectangle with corners at point and mark; save as last killed one. -Calling from program, supply two args START and END, buffer positions. -But in programs you might prefer to use `delete-extract-rectangle'." t nil) +(autoload 'extract-rectangle "rect" "\ +Return the contents of the rectangle with corners at START and END, +as a list of strings, one for each line of the rectangle." nil nil) (autoload 'yank-rectangle "rect" "\ Yank the last killed rectangle with upper left corner at point." t nil) @@ -1548,21 +1585,26 @@ After this command, the mark is at the upper left corner and point is at the lower right corner." nil nil) (autoload 'open-rectangle "rect" "\ -Blank out rectangle with corners at point and mark, shifting text right. -The text previously in the region is not overwritten by the blanks, -but instead winds up to the right of the rectangle." t nil) +Blank out the region-rectangle, shifting text right. + +When called from a program, the rectangle's corners are START and END. +With a prefix (or FILL) argument, fill with blanks even if there is no text +on the right side of the rectangle." t nil) (autoload 'string-rectangle "rect" "\ Insert STRING on each line of the region-rectangle, shifting text right. -The left edge of the rectangle specifies the column for insertion. -This command does not delete or overwrite any existing text. +The left edge of the rectangle specifies the column for insertion. This +command does not delete or overwrite any existing text. -Called from a program, takes three args; START, END and STRING." t nil) +When called from a program, the rectangle's corners are START and END." t nil) (autoload 'clear-rectangle "rect" "\ -Blank out rectangle with corners at point and mark. -The text previously in the region is overwritten by the blanks. -When called from a program, requires two args which specify the corners." t nil) +Blank out the region-rectangle. +The text previously in the region is overwritten with blanks. + +When called from a program, the rectangle's corners are START and END. +With a prefix (or FILL) argument, also fill with blanks the parts of the +rectangle which were empty." t nil) ;;;*** @@ -1767,7 +1809,7 @@ If you don't like the lazy invocation of this function, you can add it to when they are selected for the first time. If you add fonts to your system, or if you change your font path, you can call this to re-initialize the menus." nil nil) -(defun* x-font-menu-font-data (face dcache) (let* ((case-fold-search t) (domain (if font-menu-this-frame-only-p (selected-frame) (selected-device))) (name (font-instance-name (face-font-instance face domain))) (truename (font-instance-truename (face-font-instance face domain (if (featurep 'mule) 'ascii)))) family size weight entry slant) (when (string-match x-font-regexp-foundry-and-family name) (setq family (capitalize (match-string 1 name))) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (and (null entry) (string-match x-font-regexp-foundry-and-family truename)) (setq family (capitalize (match-string 1 truename))) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (null entry) (return-from font-menu-font-data (make-vector 5 nil))) (when (string-match x-font-regexp name) (setq weight (capitalize (match-string 1 name))) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 6 name)))) (when (string-match x-font-regexp truename) (when (not (member weight (aref entry 1))) (setq weight (capitalize (match-string 1 truename)))) (when (not (member size (aref entry 2))) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 6 truename)))) (setq slant (capitalize (match-string 2 truename)))) (vector entry family size weight slant))) +(defun* x-font-menu-font-data (face dcache) (let* ((case-fold-search t) (domain (if font-menu-this-frame-only-p (selected-frame) (selected-device))) (name (font-instance-name (face-font-instance face domain))) (truename (font-instance-truename (face-font-instance face domain (if (featurep 'mule) 'ascii)))) family size weight entry slant) (when (string-match x-font-regexp-foundry-and-family name) (setq family (capitalize (match-string 1 name))) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (and (null entry) (string-match x-font-regexp-foundry-and-family truename)) (setq family (capitalize (match-string 1 truename))) (setq entry (vassoc family (aref dcache 0)))) (when (null entry) (return-from x-font-menu-font-data (make-vector 5 nil))) (when (string-match x-font-regexp name) (setq weight (capitalize (match-string 1 name))) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 6 name)))) (when (string-match x-font-regexp truename) (when (not (member weight (aref entry 1))) (setq weight (capitalize (match-string 1 truename)))) (when (not (member size (aref entry 2))) (setq size (string-to-int (match-string 6 truename)))) (setq slant (capitalize (match-string 2 truename)))) (vector entry family size weight slant))) ;;;*** diff --git a/lisp/auto-save.el b/lisp/auto-save.el index bbda85d..ec7fdae 100644 --- a/lisp/auto-save.el +++ b/lisp/auto-save.el @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ ;;; Acknowledgement: ;; This code is loosely derived from autosave-in-tmp.el by Jamie -;; Zawinski (the version I had was last modified 22 +;; Zawinski (the version I had was last modified 22 ;; dec 90 jwz) and code submitted to ange-ftp-lovers on Sun, 5 Apr ;; 92 23:20:47 EDT by drw@BOURBAKI.MIT.EDU (Dale R. Worley). ;; auto-save.el tries to cover the functionality of those two diff --git a/lisp/backquote.el b/lisp/backquote.el index 1232603..38def61 100644 --- a/lisp/backquote.el +++ b/lisp/backquote.el @@ -44,7 +44,7 @@ ;; (b) ",.foo" is the same as ". ,foo" ;; (c) because RMS isn't interested in using this version of backquote.el ;; -;; wing@666.com; added ,. support back in: +;; ben@xemacs.org added ,. support back in: ;; (a) yes, it is in CLtl2. Read closely on page 529. ;; (b) RMS in 19.30 adds C support for ,. even if it's not really ;; handled. diff --git a/lisp/byte-optimize.el b/lisp/byte-optimize.el index 95e7cb4..9d34537 100644 --- a/lisp/byte-optimize.el +++ b/lisp/byte-optimize.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;;; Copyright (c) 1991, 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Hallvard Furuseth ;; Keywords: internal diff --git a/lisp/bytecomp-runtime.el b/lisp/bytecomp-runtime.el index 95d8c31..f146c69 100644 --- a/lisp/bytecomp-runtime.el +++ b/lisp/bytecomp-runtime.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1992, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Author: Hallvard Furuseth ;; Maintainer: XEmacs Development Team ;; Keywords: internal, dumped diff --git a/lisp/bytecomp.el b/lisp/bytecomp.el index 1ce8d27..727ba8a 100644 --- a/lisp/bytecomp.el +++ b/lisp/bytecomp.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;;; Copyright (C) 1985-1987, 1991-1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;;; Copyright (C) 1996 Ben Wing. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Hallvard Furuseth ;; Keywords: internal diff --git a/lisp/check-features.el b/lisp/check-features.el index 9596ff7..59c1567 100644 --- a/lisp/check-features.el +++ b/lisp/check-features.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1998 by Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: SL Baur +;; Author: SL Baur ;; Keywords: internal ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/cus-dep.el b/lisp/cus-dep.el index 8a05073..cf9fa27 100644 --- a/lisp/cus-dep.el +++ b/lisp/cus-dep.el @@ -4,8 +4,8 @@ ;; ;; Author: Per Abrahamsen , then ;; Richard Stallman , then -;; Hrvoje Niksic (rewritten for XEmacs) -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Hrvoje Niksic (rewritten for XEmacs) +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Keywords: internal ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/cus-edit.el b/lisp/cus-edit.el index 4db1128..897dd49 100644 --- a/lisp/cus-edit.el +++ b/lisp/cus-edit.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; ;; Author: Per Abrahamsen -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Keywords: help, faces ;; Version: 1.9960-x ;; X-URL: http://www.dina.kvl.dk/~abraham/custom/ diff --git a/lisp/cus-face.el b/lisp/cus-face.el index 18f2d38..36e2d32 100644 --- a/lisp/cus-face.el +++ b/lisp/cus-face.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; ;; Author: Per Abrahamsen -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Keywords: help, faces ;; Version: 1.9960-x ;; X-URL: http://www.dina.kvl.dk/~abraham/custom/ diff --git a/lisp/cus-load.el b/lisp/cus-load.el index 28bef12..67796a8 100644 --- a/lisp/cus-load.el +++ b/lisp/cus-load.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1997 by Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Steven L Baur +;; Author: Steven L Baur ;; Keywords: internal, help, faces ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/custom-load.el b/lisp/custom-load.el index 54b38b3..a5b0c03 100644 --- a/lisp/custom-load.el +++ b/lisp/custom-load.el @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ (custom-add-loads 'menu '("menubar-items")) (custom-add-loads 'minibuffer '("simple" "minibuf")) (custom-add-loads 'log-message '("simple")) -(custom-add-loads 'environment '("frame" "keydefs" "minibuf" "modeline" "window-xemacs" "menubar" "x-init" "toolbar-items" "cus-edit" "gnuserv" "sound")) +(custom-add-loads 'environment '("frame" "keydefs" "minibuf" "modeline" "window-xemacs" "menubar" "gutter-items" "x-init" "toolbar-items" "cus-edit" "gnuserv" "sound")) (custom-add-loads 'sound '("sound")) (custom-add-loads 'pui '("package-ui")) (custom-add-loads 'terminals '("gnuserv")) @@ -55,20 +55,21 @@ (custom-add-loads 'widget-button '("wid-edit")) (custom-add-loads 'paren-blinking '("simple")) (custom-add-loads 'find-file '("files")) -(custom-add-loads 'font-menu '("x-font-menu")) +(custom-add-loads 'font-menu '("font-menu")) (custom-add-loads 'files '("files")) (custom-add-loads 'build '("build-report")) (custom-add-loads 'font-lock '("font-lock")) (custom-add-loads 'external '("process" "cus-edit")) (custom-add-loads 'development '("process" "lisp-mode" "cus-edit")) (custom-add-loads 'gnuserv '("gnuserv")) +(custom-add-loads 'gutter '("gutter-items")) (custom-add-loads 'fill-comments '("simple")) (custom-add-loads 'windows '("window" "window-xemacs")) (custom-add-loads 'widget-faces '("wid-edit")) (custom-add-loads 'languages '("lisp-mode" "cus-edit" "font-lock")) (custom-add-loads 'fill '("simple" "fill")) (custom-add-loads 'custom-magic-faces '("cus-edit")) -(custom-add-loads 'display '("toolbar" "scrollbar" "auto-show")) +(custom-add-loads 'display '("toolbar" "scrollbar" "gutter-items" "auto-show")) (custom-add-loads 'faces '("faces" "cus-edit" "font-lock" "font" "hyper-apropos" "info" "wid-edit")) (custom-add-loads 'emacs '("faces" "help" "files" "cus-edit" "package-get")) (custom-add-loads 'processes '("process" "gnuserv")) @@ -78,10 +79,11 @@ (custom-add-loads 'isearch '("isearch-mode")) (custom-add-loads 'font-lock-faces '("font-lock")) (custom-add-loads 'modeline '("modeline")) -(custom-add-loads 'editing '("simple" "abbrev" "fill" "mouse" "dragdrop" "cus-edit")) +(custom-add-loads 'editing '("simple" "abbrev" "fill" "mouse" "cus-edit" "dragdrop")) (custom-add-loads 'matching '("simple" "isearch-mode" "hyper-apropos")) (custom-add-loads 'i18n '("cus-edit")) (custom-add-loads 'info '("toolbar-items" "info")) -(custom-add-loads 'x '("x-faces" "x-font-menu")) +(custom-add-loads 'x '("x-faces" "font-menu")) +(custom-add-loads 'buffers-tab '("gutter-items")) ;;; custom-load.el ends here diff --git a/lisp/custom.el b/lisp/custom.el index b27b551..316e925 100644 --- a/lisp/custom.el +++ b/lisp/custom.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; Author: Per Abrahamsen -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Keywords: help, faces, dumped ;; Version: 1.9960-x ;; X-URL: http://www.dina.kvl.dk/~abraham/custom/ diff --git a/lisp/disass.el b/lisp/disass.el index 9992f07..60bef2c 100644 --- a/lisp/disass.el +++ b/lisp/disass.el @@ -3,8 +3,8 @@ ;;; Copyright (C) 1986, 1991-1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; Author: Doug Cutting -;; Jamie Zawinski -;; Maintainer: Jamie Zawinski +;; Jamie Zawinski +;; Maintainer: XEmacs Development Team ;; Keywords: internal ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/etags.el b/lisp/etags.el index 00180d6..f727c19 100644 --- a/lisp/etags.el +++ b/lisp/etags.el @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ ;; Kyle Jones ;; added "Exact match, then inexact" code ;; added support for include directive. -;; Hrvoje Niksic +;; Hrvoje Niksic ;; various changes. diff --git a/lisp/faces.el b/lisp/faces.el index 90fe697..265ce26 100644 --- a/lisp/faces.el +++ b/lisp/faces.el @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ ;; This file is dumped with XEmacs. ;; face implementation #1 (used Lisp vectors and parallel C vectors; -;; FSFmacs still uses this) authored by Jamie Zawinski +;; FSFmacs still uses this) authored by Jamie Zawinski ;; pre Lucid-Emacs 19.0. ;; face implementation #2 (used one face object per frame per face) diff --git a/lisp/fill.el b/lisp/fill.el index 748cba4..181bcc8 100644 --- a/lisp/fill.el +++ b/lisp/fill.el @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ ;; 97/3/14 Jareth Hein (jhod@po.iijnet.or.jp) added functions for kinsoku (asian text ;; line break processing) -;; 97/06/11 Steve Baur (steve@altair.xemacs.org) converted broken +;; 97/06/11 Steve Baur (steve@xemacs.org) converted broken ;; following-char/preceding-char calls to char-after/char-before. ;;; Code: diff --git a/lisp/font-lock.el b/lisp/font-lock.el index d71c4fa..aba0a22 100644 --- a/lisp/font-lock.el +++ b/lisp/font-lock.el @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1995 Amdahl Corporation. ;; Copyright (C) 1996 Ben Wing. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski , for the LISPM Preservation Society. +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski , for the LISPM Preservation Society. ;; Minimally merged with FSF 19.34 by Barry Warsaw ;; Then (partially) synched with FSF 19.30, leading to: ;; Next Author: RMS diff --git a/lisp/gnuserv.el b/lisp/gnuserv.el index ee47e85..8da403c 100644 --- a/lisp/gnuserv.el +++ b/lisp/gnuserv.el @@ -3,9 +3,9 @@ ;; Version: 3.11 ;; Author: Andy Norman (ange@hplb.hpl.hp.com), originally based on server.el -;; Hrvoje Niksic +;; Hrvoje Niksic ;; Maintainer: Jan Vroonhof , -;; Hrvoje Niksic +;; Hrvoje Niksic ;; Keywords: environment, processes, terminals ;; This file is part of XEmacs. @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ ;; Jan Vroonhof ;; Customized. ;; -;; Hrvoje Niksic May/1997 +;; Hrvoje Niksic May/1997 ;; Completely rewritten. Now uses `defstruct' and other CL stuff ;; to define clients cleanly. Many thanks to Dave Gillespie! ;; diff --git a/lisp/help.el b/lisp/help.el index abe3bfc..d482b53 100644 --- a/lisp/help.el +++ b/lisp/help.el @@ -305,8 +305,8 @@ otherwise it is killed." "Return the command invoked by KEY. Like `key-binding', but handles menu events and toolbar presses correctly. KEY is any value returned by `next-command-event'. -MENU-FLAG is a symbol that should be set to T if KEY is a menu event, - or NIL otherwise" +MENU-FLAG is a symbol that should be set to t if KEY is a menu event, + or nil otherwise" (let (defn) (and menu-flag (set menu-flag nil)) ;; If the key typed was really a menu selection, grab the form out diff --git a/lisp/hyper-apropos.el b/lisp/hyper-apropos.el index 1e34bfa..b735091 100644 --- a/lisp/hyper-apropos.el +++ b/lisp/hyper-apropos.el @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ ;; ### The maintainer is supposed to be stig, but I haven't seen him ;; around for ages. The real maintainer for the moment is Hrvoje -;; Niksic . +;; Niksic . ;;; Code: diff --git a/lisp/iso8859-1.el b/lisp/iso8859-1.el index 50bd40a..dbfe12f 100644 --- a/lisp/iso8859-1.el +++ b/lisp/iso8859-1.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1992, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Created: 19-aug-92 ;; Maintainer: XEmacs Development Team ;; Keywords: internal, dumped diff --git a/lisp/lisp-mnt.el b/lisp/lisp-mnt.el index 76feeb2..ab1aa09 100644 --- a/lisp/lisp-mnt.el +++ b/lisp/lisp-mnt.el @@ -6,7 +6,7 @@ ;; Maintainer: Eric S. Raymond ;; Created: 14 Jul 1992 ;; Keywords: docs, maint -;; X-Modified-by: Bob Weiner , 4/14/95, to support +;; X-Modified-by: Bob Weiner , 4/14/95, to support ;; InfoDock headers. ;; X-Bogus-Bureaucratic-Cruft: Gruad will get you if you don't watch out! diff --git a/lisp/make-docfile.el b/lisp/make-docfile.el index e6c0cf8..3b77495 100644 --- a/lisp/make-docfile.el +++ b/lisp/make-docfile.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1992-1995, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; Author: Unknown -;; Maintainer: Steven L Baur +;; Maintainer: Steven L Baur ;; Keywords: internal ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/menubar-items.el b/lisp/menubar-items.el index 4f4f403..0750bc8 100644 --- a/lisp/menubar-items.el +++ b/lisp/menubar-items.el @@ -1108,7 +1108,7 @@ returns a whole bunch of info about a buffer." 'sort-buffers-menu-by-mode-then-alphabetically "*If non-nil, a function to sort the list of buffers in the buffers menu. It will be passed two arguments (two buffers to compare) and should return -T if the first is \"less\" than the second. One possible value is +t if the first is \"less\" than the second. One possible value is `sort-buffers-menu-alphabetically'; another is `sort-buffers-menu-by-mode-then-alphabetically'." :type '(choice (const :tag "None" nil) diff --git a/lisp/minibuf.el b/lisp/minibuf.el index 0061576..d567f42 100644 --- a/lisp/minibuf.el +++ b/lisp/minibuf.el @@ -2116,9 +2116,15 @@ On mswindows devices, this uses `mswindows-color-list'." (defun read-coding-system (prompt &optional default-coding-system) "Read a coding-system (or nil) from the minibuffer. Prompting with string PROMPT. -If the user enters null input, return second argument DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM." +If the user enters null input, return second argument DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM. +DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM can be a string, symbol, or coding-system object." (intern (completing-read prompt obarray 'find-coding-system t nil nil - default-coding-system))) + (cond ((symbolp default-coding-system) + (symbol-name default-coding-system)) + ((coding-system-p default-coding-system) + (symbol-name (coding-system-name default-coding-system))) + (t + default-coding-system))))) (defun read-non-nil-coding-system (prompt) "Read a non-nil coding-system from the minibuffer. diff --git a/lisp/mouse.el b/lisp/mouse.el index 0afebb8..4a0a22c 100644 --- a/lisp/mouse.el +++ b/lisp/mouse.el @@ -88,7 +88,9 @@ If set to `symbol', double-click will always attempt to highlight a the X cutbuffer. A mark is pushed, so that the inserted text lies between point and mark." (interactive) - (if (not (console-on-window-system-p)) + (if (and (not (console-on-window-system-p)) + (and (featurep 'gpm) + (not gpm-minor-mode))) (yank) (push-mark) (if (region-active-p) diff --git a/lisp/mule/mule-category.el b/lisp/mule/mule-category.el index deb9efc..31bc242 100644 --- a/lisp/mule/mule-category.el +++ b/lisp/mule/mule-category.el @@ -29,7 +29,7 @@ ;; type of char table. Some function names / arguments should be ;; parallel with syntax tables. -;; Written by Ben Wing . The initialization code +;; Written by Ben Wing . The initialization code ;; at the end of this file comes from Mule. ;; Some bugfixes by Jareth Hein diff --git a/lisp/mule/mule-ccl.el b/lisp/mule/mule-ccl.el index b0c44cd..ae0a188 100644 --- a/lisp/mule/mule-ccl.el +++ b/lisp/mule/mule-ccl.el @@ -299,7 +299,7 @@ ;;;###autoload (defun ccl-program-p (obj) - "T if OBJECT is a valid CCL compiled code." + "Return t if OBJECT is a valid CCL compiled code." (and (vectorp obj) (let ((i 0) (len (length obj)) (flag t)) (if (> len 1) diff --git a/lisp/mule/mule-help.el b/lisp/mule/mule-help.el index dd51dc7..e889207 100644 --- a/lisp/mule/mule-help.el +++ b/lisp/mule/mule-help.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1997 by Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: SL Baur +;; Author: SL Baur ;; Keywords: help, internal, mule ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/mule/mule-x-init.el b/lisp/mule/mule-x-init.el index 8bb351c..b67f7e7 100644 --- a/lisp/mule/mule-x-init.el +++ b/lisp/mule/mule-x-init.el @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ ;;; mule-x-init.el --- initialization code for X Windows under MULE ;; Copyright (C) 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Copyright (C) 1996 Ben Wing +;; Copyright (C) 1996 Ben Wing ;; Author: various ;; Keywords: mule X11 diff --git a/lisp/package-admin.el b/lisp/package-admin.el index d5603ec..aff6025 100644 --- a/lisp/package-admin.el +++ b/lisp/package-admin.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1997 by Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: SL Baur +;; Author: SL Baur ;; Keywords: internal ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/package-get.el b/lisp/package-get.el index a3f3eba..0b70110 100644 --- a/lisp/package-get.el +++ b/lisp/package-get.el @@ -225,7 +225,7 @@ variable actually used to specify package download sites." :group 'package-get) (defcustom package-get-remove-copy t - "*After copying and installing a package, if this is T, then remove the + "*After copying and installing a package, if this is t, then remove the copy. Otherwise, keep it around." :type 'boolean :group 'package-get) diff --git a/lisp/package-info.el b/lisp/package-info.el index 4a9aa2c..e3be100 100644 --- a/lisp/package-info.el +++ b/lisp/package-info.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1998 by Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: SL Baur +;; Author: SL Baur ;; Keywords: internal ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/packages.el b/lisp/packages.el index de7a272..2d1eaf3 100644 --- a/lisp/packages.el +++ b/lisp/packages.el @@ -2,8 +2,8 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Steven L Baur -;; Maintainer: Steven L Baur +;; Author: Steven L Baur +;; Maintainer: Steven L Baur ;; Keywords: internal, lisp, dumped ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/simple.el b/lisp/simple.el index 34bcde7..6fa92b3 100644 --- a/lisp/simple.el +++ b/lisp/simple.el @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ ;; Mule-2.3, and could probably use some feature additions (like additional wrap ;; styles, etc) -;; 97/06/11 Steve Baur (steve@altair.xemacs.org) Convert use of +;; 97/06/11 Steve Baur (steve@xemacs.org) Convert use of ;; (preceding|following)-char to char-(after|before). ;;; Code: @@ -670,7 +670,7 @@ BUFFER defaults to the current buffer." cnt))) ;;; Modified by Bob Weiner, 8/24/95, to print narrowed line number also. -;;; Expanded by Bob Weiner, Altrasoft, on 02/12/1997 +;;; Expanded by Bob Weiner, BeOpen, on 02/12/1997 (defun what-line () "Print the following variants of the line number of point: Region line - displayed line within the active region diff --git a/lisp/site-load.el b/lisp/site-load.el index 0fa8cc4..f54ed0d 100644 --- a/lisp/site-load.el +++ b/lisp/site-load.el @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ ;;; site-load.el --- Template file for site-wide XEmacs customization ;; Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Steven L. Baur +;; Author: Steven L. Baur ;; Keywords: internal ;; This file is part of XEmacs. diff --git a/lisp/text-props.el b/lisp/text-props.el index e08bbbc..0e1baeb 100644 --- a/lisp/text-props.el +++ b/lisp/text-props.el @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1995 Amdahl Corporation. ;; Copyright (C) 1995 Ben Wing. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Maintainer: XEmacs Development Team ;; Keywords: extensions, wp, faces, dumped diff --git a/lisp/very-early-lisp.el b/lisp/very-early-lisp.el index 48deb50..24ec4e3 100644 --- a/lisp/very-early-lisp.el +++ b/lisp/very-early-lisp.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1998 by Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: SL Baur +;; Author: SL Baur ;; Michael Sperber [Mr. Preprocessor] ;; Keywords: internal, dumped diff --git a/lisp/wid-edit.el b/lisp/wid-edit.el index 270135f..b8eb856 100644 --- a/lisp/wid-edit.el +++ b/lisp/wid-edit.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; ;; Author: Per Abrahamsen -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Keywords: extensions ;; Version: 1.9960-x ;; X-URL: http://www.dina.kvl.dk/~abraham/custom/ diff --git a/lisp/widget.el b/lisp/widget.el index 0586999..6f00faa 100644 --- a/lisp/widget.el +++ b/lisp/widget.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; Author: Per Abrahamsen -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Keywords: help, extensions, faces, hypermedia, dumped ;; Version: 1.9960-x ;; X-URL: http://www.dina.kvl.dk/~abraham/custom/ diff --git a/lisp/x-compose.el b/lisp/x-compose.el index 1500277..40df8e6 100644 --- a/lisp/x-compose.el +++ b/lisp/x-compose.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Maintainer: XEmacs Development Team ;; Rewritten by Martin Buchholz far too many times. ;; @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ ;; work, depending on what system and keyboard you are using. If it ;; doesn't, you'll have to read the man page for xmodmap. You might want ;; to get the "xkeycaps" program from -;; , +;; , ;; which is a graphical front end to xmodmap ;; that hides xmodmap's arcane syntax from you. diff --git a/lisp/x-faces.el b/lisp/x-faces.el index 46677cf..491d2c8 100644 --- a/lisp/x-faces.el +++ b/lisp/x-faces.el @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1992-4, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. ;; Copyright (C) 1995, 1996 Ben Wing. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Maintainer: XEmacs Development Team ;; Keywords: extensions, internal, dumped diff --git a/lisp/x-font-menu.el b/lisp/x-font-menu.el index 8dffa39..54f4c66 100644 --- a/lisp/x-font-menu.el +++ b/lisp/x-font-menu.el @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1995 Tinker Systems and INS Engineering Corp. ;; Copyright (C) 1997 Sun Microsystems -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Restructured by: Jonathan Stigelman ;; Mule-ized by: Martin Buchholz ;; More restructuring for MS-Windows by Andy Piper diff --git a/lisp/x-iso8859-1.el b/lisp/x-iso8859-1.el index 38788ce..94457d4 100644 --- a/lisp/x-iso8859-1.el +++ b/lisp/x-iso8859-1.el @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Jamie Zawinski +;; Author: Jamie Zawinski ;; Created: 15-jun-92 ;; Maintainer: XEmacs Development Team ;; Keywords: extensions, internal, dumped diff --git a/lwlib/ChangeLog b/lwlib/ChangeLog index 807f075..fc91207 100644 --- a/lwlib/ChangeLog +++ b/lwlib/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,15 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + +1999-11-26 Martin Buchholz + + * xlwtabs.c: Remove unused variables. Fix warnings. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released diff --git a/lwlib/xlwtabs.c b/lwlib/xlwtabs.c index e58d6fa..99918c7 100644 --- a/lwlib/xlwtabs.c +++ b/lwlib/xlwtabs.c @@ -598,73 +598,75 @@ static Boolean TabsSetValues(Widget current, Widget request, Widget new, ArgList args, Cardinal *num_args) { - TabsWidget curtw = (TabsWidget) current ; - TabsWidget tw = (TabsWidget) new ; - Boolean needRedraw = False ; - Widget *childP ; - int i ; - - - if( tw->tabs.font != curtw->tabs.font || - tw->tabs.internalWidth != curtw->tabs.internalWidth || - tw->tabs.internalHeight != curtw->tabs.internalHeight ) - { - tw->tabs.tab_height = 2 * tw->tabs.internalHeight + SHADWID ; + TabsWidget curtw = (TabsWidget) current ; + TabsWidget tw = (TabsWidget) new ; + Boolean needRedraw = False ; + Widget *childP ; + int i ; - if( tw->tabs.font != NULL ) - tw->tabs.tab_height += tw->tabs.font->max_bounds.ascent + - tw->tabs.font->max_bounds.descent ; - /* Tab size has changed. Resize all tabs and request a new size */ - for(i=0, childP=tw->composite.children; - i < tw->composite.num_children; - ++i, ++childP) - if( XtIsManaged(*childP) ) - TabWidth(*childP) ; - PreferredSize(tw, &tw->core.width, &tw->core.height, NULL,NULL) ; - needRedraw = True ; - tw->tabs.needs_layout = True ; - } + if( tw->tabs.font != curtw->tabs.font || + tw->tabs.internalWidth != curtw->tabs.internalWidth || + tw->tabs.internalHeight != curtw->tabs.internalHeight ) + { + tw->tabs.tab_height = 2 * tw->tabs.internalHeight + SHADWID ; + + if( tw->tabs.font != NULL ) + tw->tabs.tab_height += tw->tabs.font->max_bounds.ascent + + tw->tabs.font->max_bounds.descent ; + + /* Tab size has changed. Resize all tabs and request a new size */ + for(i=0, childP=tw->composite.children; + i < tw->composite.num_children; + ++i, ++childP) + if( XtIsManaged(*childP) ) + TabWidth(*childP) ; + PreferredSize(tw, &tw->core.width, &tw->core.height, NULL,NULL) ; + needRedraw = True ; + tw->tabs.needs_layout = True ; + } - /* TODO: if any color changes, need to recompute GCs and redraw */ + /* TODO: if any color changes, need to recompute GCs and redraw */ - if( tw->core.background_pixel != curtw->core.background_pixel || - tw->core.background_pixmap != curtw->core.background_pixmap ) - if( XtIsRealized(new) ) - { - TabsFreeGCs(tw) ; - TabsAllocGCs(tw) ; - needRedraw = True ; - } + if( tw->core.background_pixel != curtw->core.background_pixel || + tw->core.background_pixmap != curtw->core.background_pixmap ) + if( XtIsRealized(new) ) + { + TabsFreeGCs(tw) ; + TabsAllocGCs(tw) ; + needRedraw = True ; + } - if( tw->core.sensitive != curtw->core.sensitive ) - needRedraw = True ; + if( tw->core.sensitive != curtw->core.sensitive ) + needRedraw = True ; - /* If top widget changes, need to change stacking order, redraw tabs. - * Window system will handle the redraws. - */ + /* If top widget changes, need to change stacking order, redraw tabs. + * Window system will handle the redraws. + */ - if( tw->tabs.topWidget != curtw->tabs.topWidget ) - if( XtIsRealized(tw->tabs.topWidget) ) - { - Widget w = tw->tabs.topWidget ; - TabsConstraints tab = (TabsConstraints) w->core.constraints ; + if( tw->tabs.topWidget != curtw->tabs.topWidget ) + { + if( XtIsRealized(tw->tabs.topWidget) ) + { + Widget w = tw->tabs.topWidget ; + TabsConstraints tab = (TabsConstraints) w->core.constraints ; - XRaiseWindow(XtDisplay(w), XtWindow(w)) ; + XRaiseWindow(XtDisplay(w), XtWindow(w)) ; #ifdef NEED_MOTIF - XtVaSetValues(curtw->tabs.topWidget, XmNtraversalOn, False, 0) ; - XtVaSetValues(w, XmNtraversalOn, True, 0) ; + XtVaSetValues(curtw->tabs.topWidget, XmNtraversalOn, False, 0) ; + XtVaSetValues(w, XmNtraversalOn, True, 0) ; #endif - if( tab->tabs.row != tw->tabs.numRows-1 ) - TabsShuffleRows(tw) ; + if( tab->tabs.row != tw->tabs.numRows-1 ) + TabsShuffleRows(tw) ; - needRedraw = True ; - } - else - tw->tabs.needs_layout = True ; + needRedraw = True ; + } + else + tw->tabs.needs_layout = True ; + } - return needRedraw ; + return needRedraw ; } @@ -1060,7 +1062,6 @@ TabsPage(Widget w, XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params) Widget newtop ; Widget *childP ; int idx ; - int i ; int nc = tw->composite.num_children ; if( nc <= 0 ) @@ -1124,7 +1125,6 @@ TabsHighlight(Widget w, XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params) Widget newhl ; Widget *childP ; int idx ; - int i ; int nc = tw->composite.num_children ; if( nc <= 0 ) @@ -1271,8 +1271,6 @@ void XawTabsSetHighlight(Widget t, Widget w) { TabsWidget tw = (TabsWidget)t ; - TabsConstraints tab ; - Widget oldtop = tw->tabs.topWidget ; if( !XtIsSubclass(t, tabsWidgetClass) ) return ; diff --git a/man/ChangeLog b/man/ChangeLog index 47d4e7e..7f276b8 100644 --- a/man/ChangeLog +++ b/man/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,78 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + +1999-11-26 Martin Buchholz + + * internals.texi (Lstream Functions): + * internals.texi (Lstream Methods): + Types have changed to size_t and ssize_t. Document them. + +1999-08-12 Gunnar Evermann + + * xemacs-faq.texi (Q4.4.2): added FAQ about Sun Workshop on + XEmacs 21 + +1999-11-15 Martin Buchholz + + * xemacs/programs.texi: Upgrade to etags Version 13.32 + + * Makefile: + - Make sure the default target is `info' instead of cl.info. + - Use $(INFODIR) consistently where appropriate. + - Remove makeinfo-1.68 warning. (Usually only maintainer rebuilds info). + - Comment out unused macros: EMACS EMACSFLAGS + - Replace `-rm -f' with `rm -f', XPG4 guarantees exit code == 0. + - Get dependencies up to date. + + * internals/Makefile: + * xemacs/Makefile: + * lispref/Makefile: + * new-users-guide/Makefile: + * lispref/index.perm: + * lispref/index.unperm: + * lispref/permute-index: + * internals/index.perm: + * internals/index.unperm: + Remove these Makefiles. + Include all functionality in man/Makefile. + Support only non-permuted indexes for simplicity. + + * emodules.texi: + - TeX doesn't tolerate `_' in variable names; use `-' instead. + + * lispref/commands.texi: + * lispref/display.texi: + * lispref/faces.texi: + * lispref/functions.texi: + * lispref/keymaps.texi: + * lispref/lists.texi: + * lispref/modes.texi: + * lispref/objects.texi: + * lispref/os.texi: + * lispref/sequences.texi: + * lispref/strings.texi: + * lispref/text.texi: + * new-users-guide/custom1.texi: + * xemacs/custom.texi: + * xemacs/menus.texi: + - Make sources compatible with makeinfo 4.0 *and* 3.12. + - Replace @sc{ASCII} with @sc{ascii}, etc... + - Replace @var{(foo)} with (@var{foo}), etc... + + * info-stnd.texi: Remove. Who cares about the standalone info reader? + + * texinfo.tex: + * texinfo.texi: + * info.texi: + * standards.texi: + * make-stds.texi: + Import FSF-maintained files from texinfo-4.0. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released @@ -26,7 +101,7 @@ 1999-08-23 Stephane Epardaud - * internals/internals.texi (Garbage Collection - Step by Step): + * internals/internals.texi (Garbage Collection - Step by Step): just added some dots to shut up compile warnings. 1999-08-19 Matthias Neubauer diff --git a/man/Makefile b/man/Makefile index 7ede490..a270d5a 100644 --- a/man/Makefile +++ b/man/Makefile @@ -19,15 +19,7 @@ # the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, # Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. -# Avoid trouble on systems where the "SHELL" variable might be -# inherited from the environment. -SHELL = /bin/sh - -EMACS = ../src/xemacs -EMACSFLAGS = -batch -q -no-site-file - -# NOTE: You *must* have makeinfo-1.68 or later to rebuild the -# info tree. +SHELL = /bin/sh MAKEINFO = makeinfo TEXI2DVI = texi2dvi @@ -36,6 +28,8 @@ TEXI2DVI = texi2dvi RECURSIVE_MAKE = $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) MAKEINFO='$(MAKEINFO)' TEXI2DVI='$(TEXI2DVI)' +all : info + # Ughhh! The things we do to have portable makefiles... INFODIR = ../info @@ -46,11 +40,15 @@ info_files = \ $(INFODIR)/emodules.info \ $(INFODIR)/external-widget.info \ $(INFODIR)/info.info \ + $(INFODIR)/lispref.info \ + $(INFODIR)/internals.info \ + $(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info \ $(INFODIR)/standards.info \ $(INFODIR)/term.info \ $(INFODIR)/termcap.info \ $(INFODIR)/texinfo.info \ $(INFODIR)/widget.info \ + $(INFODIR)/xemacs.info \ $(INFODIR)/xemacs-faq.info dvi_files = \ @@ -59,103 +57,244 @@ dvi_files = \ emodules.dvi \ external-widget.dvi \ info.dvi \ + lispref.dvi \ + internals.dvi \ + new-users-guide.dvi \ standards.dvi \ term.dvi \ termcap.dvi \ texinfo.dvi \ widget.dvi \ + xemacs.dvi \ xemacs-faq.dvi -../info/cl.info : cl.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) cl.texi -o ../info/cl.info - -../info/custom.info : custom.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) custom.texi -o ../info/custom.info - -../info/emodules.info : emodules.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) emodules.texi -o ../info/emodules.info - -../info/external-widget.info : external-widget.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) external-widget.texi -o ../info/external-widget.info - -../info/info.info : info.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) info.texi -o ../info/info.info - -../info/standards.info : standards.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) standards.texi -o ../info/standards.info - -../info/term.info : term.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) term.texi -o ../info/term.info - -../info/termcap.info : termcap.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) termcap.texi -o ../info/termcap.info - -../info/texinfo.info : texinfo.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) texinfo.texi -o ../info/texinfo.info - -../info/widget.info : widget.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) widget.texi -o ../info/widget.info - -../info/xemacs-faq.info : xemacs-faq.texi - -$(MAKEINFO) xemacs-faq.texi -o ../info/xemacs-faq.info - - -# ../info/w3.info : w3.texi -# -$(MAKEINFO) w3.texi -o ../info/w3.info - -# ../info/vm.info : vm.texi +xemacs-srcs = \ + xemacs/abbrevs.texi \ + xemacs/basic.texi \ + xemacs/buffers.texi \ + xemacs/building.texi \ + xemacs/calendar.texi \ + xemacs/cmdargs.texi \ + xemacs/custom.texi \ + xemacs/display.texi \ + xemacs/entering.texi \ + xemacs/files.texi \ + xemacs/fixit.texi \ + xemacs/frame.texi \ + xemacs/glossary.texi \ + xemacs/gnu.texi \ + xemacs/help.texi \ + xemacs/indent.texi \ + xemacs/keystrokes.texi \ + xemacs/killing.texi \ + xemacs/m-x.texi \ + xemacs/major.texi \ + xemacs/mark.texi \ + xemacs/menus.texi \ + xemacs/mini.texi \ + xemacs/misc.texi \ + xemacs/mouse.texi \ + xemacs/mule.texi \ + xemacs/new.texi \ + xemacs/packages.texi \ + xemacs/picture.texi \ + xemacs/programs.texi \ + xemacs/reading.texi \ + xemacs/regs.texi \ + xemacs/search.texi \ + xemacs/sending.texi \ + xemacs/startup.texi \ + xemacs/text.texi \ + xemacs/trouble.texi \ + xemacs/undo.texi \ + xemacs/windows.texi \ + xemacs/xemacs.texi + +lispref-srcs = \ + lispref/abbrevs.texi \ + lispref/annotations.texi \ + lispref/back.texi \ + lispref/backups.texi \ + lispref/buffers.texi \ + lispref/building.texi \ + lispref/commands.texi \ + lispref/compile.texi \ + lispref/consoles-devices.texi \ + lispref/control.texi \ + lispref/customize.texi \ + lispref/databases.texi \ + lispref/debugging.texi \ + lispref/dialog.texi \ + lispref/display.texi \ + lispref/dragndrop.texi \ + lispref/edebug-inc.texi \ + lispref/edebug.texi \ + lispref/errors.texi \ + lispref/eval.texi \ + lispref/extents.texi \ + lispref/faces.texi \ + lispref/files.texi \ + lispref/frames.texi \ + lispref/functions.texi \ + lispref/glyphs.texi \ + lispref/hash-tables.texi \ + lispref/help.texi \ + lispref/hooks.texi \ + lispref/index.texi \ + lispref/internationalization.texi \ + lispref/intro.texi \ + lispref/keymaps.texi \ + lispref/ldap.texi \ + lispref/lispref.texi \ + lispref/lists.texi \ + lispref/loading.texi \ + lispref/locals.texi \ + lispref/macros.texi \ + lispref/maps.texi \ + lispref/markers.texi \ + lispref/menus.texi \ + lispref/minibuf.texi \ + lispref/modes.texi \ + lispref/mouse.texi \ + lispref/mule.texi \ + lispref/numbers.texi \ + lispref/objects.texi \ + lispref/os.texi \ + lispref/positions.texi \ + lispref/processes.texi \ + lispref/range-tables.texi \ + lispref/scrollbars.texi \ + lispref/searching.texi \ + lispref/sequences.texi \ + lispref/specifiers.texi \ + lispref/streams.texi \ + lispref/strings.texi \ + lispref/symbols.texi \ + lispref/syntax.texi \ + lispref/text.texi \ + lispref/tips.texi \ + lispref/toolbar.texi \ + lispref/tooltalk.texi \ + lispref/variables.texi \ + lispref/windows.texi \ + lispref/x-windows.texi + +internals-srcs = \ + internals/internals.texi + +new-users-guide-srcs = \ + new-users-guide/custom1.texi \ + new-users-guide/custom2.texi \ + new-users-guide/edit.texi \ + new-users-guide/enter.texi \ + new-users-guide/files.texi \ + new-users-guide/help.texi \ + new-users-guide/modes.texi \ + new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi \ + new-users-guide/region.texi \ + new-users-guide/search.texi \ + new-users-guide/xmenu.texi + +$(INFODIR)/cl.info : cl.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/cl.info cl.texi + +$(INFODIR)/custom.info : custom.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/custom.info custom.texi + +$(INFODIR)/emodules.info : emodules.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/emodules.info emodules.texi + +$(INFODIR)/external-widget.info : external-widget.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/external-widget.info external-widget.texi + +$(INFODIR)/info.info : info.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/info.info info.texi + +$(INFODIR)/standards.info : standards.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/standards.info standards.texi + +$(INFODIR)/term.info : term.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/term.info term.texi + +$(INFODIR)/termcap.info : termcap.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/termcap.info termcap.texi + +$(INFODIR)/texinfo.info : texinfo.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/texinfo.info texinfo.texi + +$(INFODIR)/widget.info : widget.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/widget.info widget.texi + +$(INFODIR)/xemacs-faq.info : xemacs-faq.texi + $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/xemacs-faq.info xemacs-faq.texi + +# Manuals with their own subdirectory +$(INFODIR)/xemacs.info : $(xemacs-srcs) + $(MAKEINFO) -P xemacs -o $(INFODIR)/xemacs.info xemacs/xemacs.texi + +$(INFODIR)/lispref.info : $(lispref-srcs) + $(MAKEINFO) -P lispref -o $(INFODIR)/lispref.info lispref/lispref.texi + +$(INFODIR)/internals.info : $(internals-srcs) + $(MAKEINFO) -P internals -o $(INFODIR)/internals.info internals/internals.texi + +$(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info : $(new-users-guide-srcs) + $(MAKEINFO) -P new-users-guide -o $(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi + +# $(INFODIR)/w3.info : w3.texi +# $(MAKEINFO) -o $(INFODIR)/w3.info w3.texi + +# EMACS = ../src/xemacs +# EMACSFLAGS = -batch -q -no-site-file + +# $(INFODIR)/vm.info : vm.texi # -$(EMACS) $(EMACSFLAGS) -insert vm.texi -l texinfmt \ # -f texinfo-format-buffer -f save-buffer -# -mv vm.info* ../info +# -mv vm.info* $(INFODIR)/. -# special = # ../info/w3.info ../info/vm.info ../info/texinfo.info +# special = # $(INFODIR)/vm.info $(INFODIR)/texinfo.info -all: info +xemacs : $(INFODIR)/xemacs.info +lispref : $(INFODIR)/lispref.info +internals : $(INFODIR)/internals.info +new-users-guide.info : $(INFODIR)/new-users-guide.info -# Subdirectories to make recursively. -SUBDIR = xemacs lispref new-users-guide internals -.PHONY: $(SUBDIR) +.PHONY : xemacs lispref internals new-users-guide info dvi info : $(info_files) - -for d in $(SUBDIR) ; do (cd ./$$d && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) $@) ; done - -.PHONY: info dvi -xemacs: FRC.xemacs - -cd ./$@ && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) -lispref: FRC.lispref - -cd ./$@ && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) -new-users-guide: FRC.new-users-guide - -cd ./$@ && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) -internals: FRC.internals - -cd ./$@ && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) # tm: FRC.tm -# -cd ./$@ && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) +# cd ./tm && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) # gnats: FRC.gnats -# -cd ./$@ && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) +# cd ./gnats && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) # FRC.xemacs FRC.lispref FRC.new-users-guide FRC.internals FRC.tm FRC.gnats: -FRC.info FRC.dvi FRC.xemacs FRC.lispref FRC.new-users-guide FRC.internals: +.PHONY: info dvi .texi.dvi: - $(TEXI2DVI) $< + -$(TEXI2DVI) $< -dvi : $(dvi_files) - -for d in $(SUBDIR) ; do (cd ./$${d} && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) $@) ; done +xemacs.dvi : $(xemacs-srcs) + $(TEXI2DVI) -I xemacs xemacs/xemacs.texi + +lispref.dvi : $(lispref-srcs) + $(TEXI2DVI) -I lispref lispref/lispref.texi +internals.dvi : $(internals-srcs) + $(TEXI2DVI) -I internals internals/internals.texi + +new-users-guide.dvi : $(new-users-guide-srcs) + $(TEXI2DVI) -I new-users-guide new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi + +dvi : $(dvi_files) .PHONY: mostlyclean clean distclean realclean extraclean mostlyclean: - -for d in $(SUBDIR) ; do (cd ./$${d} && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) $@) ; done - rm -f *.toc *.aux *.log *.op \ - *.cp *.cps *.fn *.fns *.ky *.kys *.pg *.pgs *.vr *.vrs *.tp *.tps + rm -f *.toc *.aux *.log *.op *.cp *.cps *.fn *.fns + rm -f *.ky *.kys *.pg *.pgs *.tp *.tps *.vr *.vrs clean: mostlyclean - -for d in $(SUBDIR) ; do (cd ./$${d} && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) $@) ; done - rm -f *.o core *.dvi + rm -f core *.dvi distclean: clean - -for d in $(SUBDIR) ; do (cd ./$${d} && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) $@) ; done realclean: distclean - -for d in $(SUBDIR) ; do (cd ./$${d} && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) $@) ; done extraclean: distclean - -for d in $(SUBDIR) ; do (cd ./$${d} && $(RECURSIVE_MAKE) $@) ; done - -rm -f *~ \#* + rm -f *~ \#* */*~ */\#* diff --git a/man/emodules.texi b/man/emodules.texi index f6afa99..3ec9d63 100644 --- a/man/emodules.texi +++ b/man/emodules.texi @@ -13,16 +13,16 @@ @ifset XEMACS @set emacs XEmacs @clear EMACS -@set HAVE_EMACS +@set HAVE-EMACS @end ifset @ifset EMACS @set emacs Emacs @clear XEMACS -@set HAVE_EMACS +@set HAVE-EMACS @end ifset -@ifclear HAVE_EMACS +@ifclear HAVE-EMACS @set XEMACS @set emacs XEmacs @end ifclear diff --git a/man/info.texi b/man/info.texi index def560e..fea0d0d 100644 --- a/man/info.texi +++ b/man/info.texi @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- -@comment %**start of header +@comment %**start of header @setfilename ../info/info.info -@settitle Info 1.0 -@comment %**end of header -@comment $Id: info.texi,v 1.4 1998/06/30 06:35:28 steve Exp $ +@settitle Info +@comment %**end of header +@comment $Id: info.texi,v 1.11 1999/04/19 21:37:23 karl Exp $ @dircategory Texinfo documentation system @direntry @@ -11,10 +11,10 @@ @end direntry @ifinfo -This file describes how to use Info, -the on-line, menu-driven GNU documentation system. +This file describes how to use Info, the on-line, menu-driven GNU +documentation system. -Copyright (C) 1989, 92, 96, 97 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +Copyright (C) 1989, 92, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice @@ -44,10 +44,9 @@ by the Free Software Foundation. @author Brian Fox @page @vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 1992, 1993, 1996, 1997 Free Software +Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 92, 93, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. @sp 2 - Published by the Free Software Foundation @* 59 Temple Place - Suite 330 @* Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. @@ -67,31 +66,20 @@ except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved by the Free Software Foundation. @end titlepage -@ifinfo -@node Top, Getting Started, , (dir) +@ifnottex +@node Top @top Info: An Introduction Info is a program for reading documentation, which you are using now. To learn how to use Info, type the command @kbd{h}. It brings you to a programmed instruction sequence. - -@c Need to make sure that `Info-help' goes to the right node, -@c which is the first node of the first chapter. (It should.) -@c (Info-find-node "info" -@c (if (< (window-height) 23) -@c "Help-Small-Screen" -@c "Help"))) - -To learn advanced Info commands, type @kbd{n} twice. This brings you to -@cite{Info for Experts}, skipping over the `Getting Started' chapter. -@end ifinfo +@end ifnottex @menu * Getting Started:: Getting started using an Info reader. * Advanced Info:: Advanced commands within Info. -* Create an Info File:: How to make your own Info file. -* The Standalone Info Program: (info-stnd.info). +* Creating an Info File:: How to make your own Info file. @end menu @node Getting Started, Advanced Info, Top, Top @@ -101,7 +89,7 @@ To learn advanced Info commands, type @kbd{n} twice. This brings you to This first part of the Info manual describes how to get around inside of Info. The second part of the manual describes various advanced Info commands, and how to write an Info as distinct from a Texinfo -file. The third part is about how to generate Info files from +file. The third part is about how to generate Info files from Texinfo files. @iftex @@ -110,7 +98,7 @@ try Info commands while reading about them. Reading it on paper is less effective, since you must take it on faith that the commands described really do what the manual says. By all means go through this manual now that you have it; but please try going through the on-line version as -well. +well. There are two ways of looking at the online version of this manual: @@ -340,7 +328,7 @@ Info can interpret it. The beginning of a menu is always identified by a line which starts with @samp{* Menu:}. A node contains a menu if and only if it has a line in it which starts that way. The only menu you can use at any moment is the one in the node you are in. To use a -menu in any other node, you must move to that node first. +menu in any other node, you must move to that node first. After the start of the menu, each line that starts with a @samp{*} identifies one subtopic. The line usually contains a brief name @@ -427,16 +415,14 @@ what you have entered. not need to type the argument: you just type a Return, and it stands for the subtopic of the line you are on. -Here is a menu to give you a chance to practice. - -* Menu: The menu starts here. - -This menu gives you three ways of going to one place, Help-FOO. - -* Foo: Help-FOO. A node you can visit for fun.@* -* Bar: Help-FOO. Strange! two ways to get to the same place.@* -* Help-FOO:: And yet another!@* +Here is a menu to give you a chance to practice. This menu gives you +three ways of going to one place, Help-FOO: +@menu +* Foo: Help-FOO. A node you can visit for fun. +* Bar: Help-FOO. Strange! two ways to get to the same place. +* Help-FOO:: And yet another! +@end menu >> Now type just an @kbd{m} and see what happens: @@ -559,17 +545,16 @@ to cancel the @samp{f}. @c It is an accident of the menu updating command. @node Help-Cross, , , Help-Adv -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@unnumberedsubsec The node reached by the cross reference in Info +@subsection The node reached by the cross reference in Info This is the node reached by the cross reference named @samp{Cross}. While this node is specifically intended to be reached by a cross -reference, most cross references lead to nodes that ``belong'' -someplace else far away in the structure of Info. So you cannot expect -the footnote to have a @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} or @samp{Up} pointing back to -where you came from. In general, the @kbd{l} (el) command is the only -way to get back there. +reference, most cross references lead to nodes that ``belong'' someplace +else far away in the structure of Info. So you cannot expect the +footnote to have a @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} or @samp{Up} pointing +back to where you came from. In general, the @kbd{l} (el) command is +the only way to get back there. >> Type @kbd{l} to return to the node where the cross reference was. @@ -590,15 +575,15 @@ manner. @samp{mInfo} and Return, to get to the node about Info and see what other help is available. -@node Advanced Info, Create an Info File, Getting Started, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Advanced Info @chapter Info for Experts This chapter describes various advanced Info commands, and how to write an Info as distinct from a Texinfo file. (However, in most cases, writing a Texinfo file is better, since you can use it @emph{both} to generate an Info file and to make a printed manual. @xref{Top,, Overview of -Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo: The GNU Documentation Format}.) +Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo}.) @menu * Expert:: Advanced Info commands: g, s, e, and 1 - 5. @@ -639,12 +624,12 @@ type @kbd{s} followed by the string to search for, terminated by @key{RET}. To search for the same string again, just @kbd{s} followed by @key{RET} will do. The file's nodes are scanned in the order they are in in the file, which has no necessary relationship to the -order that they may be in in the tree structure of menus and @samp{next} pointers. -But normally the two orders are not very different. In any case, -you can always do a @kbd{b} to find out what node you have reached, if -the header is not visible (this can happen, because @kbd{s} puts your -cursor at the occurrence of the string, not at the beginning of the -node). +order that they may be in in the tree structure of menus and @samp{next} +pointers. But normally the two orders are not very different. In any +case, you can always do a @kbd{b} to find out what node you have +reached, if the header is not visible (this can happen, because @kbd{s} +puts your cursor at the occurrence of the string, not at the beginning +of the node). If you grudge the system each character of type-in it requires, you might like to use the commands @kbd{1}, @kbd{2}, @kbd{3}, @kbd{4}, ... @@ -652,9 +637,9 @@ might like to use the commands @kbd{1}, @kbd{2}, @kbd{3}, @kbd{4}, ... argument. @kbd{1} goes through the first item in the current node's menu; @kbd{2} goes through the second item, etc. -If you display supports multiple fonts, and you are using Emacs' Info +If your display supports multiple fonts, and you are using Emacs' Info mode to read Info files, the @samp{*} for the fifth menu item is -underlines, and so is the @samp{*} for the ninth item; these underlines +underlined, and so is the @samp{*} for the ninth item; these underlines make it easy to see at a glance which number to use for an item. On ordinary terminals, you won't have underlining. If you need to @@ -678,12 +663,12 @@ Create some nodes, in some file, to document that topic. Put that topic in the menu in the directory. @xref{Menus, Menu}. @end enumerate -Usually, the way to create the nodes is with Texinfo @pxref{Top,, Overview of -Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo: The GNU Documentation Format}); this has the -advantage that you can also make a printed manual from them. However, -if you want to edit an Info file, here is how. +Usually, the way to create the nodes is with Texinfo (@pxref{Top,, +Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo}); this has the advantage that you +can also make a printed manual from them. However, if you want to edit +an Info file, here is how. - The new node can live in an existing documentation file, or in a new +The new node can live in an existing documentation file, or in a new one. It must have a @key{^_} character before it (invisible to the user; this node has one but you cannot see it), and it ends with either a @key{^_}, a @key{^L}, or the end of file. Note: If you put in a @@ -693,12 +678,12 @@ Also, a nicer way to make a node boundary be a page boundary as well is to put a @key{^L} @emph{right after} the @key{^_}. The @key{^_} starting a node must be followed by a newline or a -@key{^L} newline, after which comes the node's header line. The -header line must give the node's name (by which Info finds it), -and state the names of the @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous}, and @samp{Up} nodes (if -there are any). As you can see, this node's @samp{Up} node is the node -@samp{Top}, which points at all the documentation for Info. The @samp{Next} -node is @samp{Menus}. +@key{^L} newline, after which comes the node's header line. The header +line must give the node's name (by which Info finds it), and state the +names of the @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous}, and @samp{Up} nodes (if there +are any). As you can see, this node's @samp{Up} node is the node +@samp{Top}, which points at all the documentation for Info. The +@samp{Next} node is @samp{Menus}. The keywords @dfn{Node}, @dfn{Previous}, @dfn{Up}, and @dfn{Next}, may appear in any order, anywhere in the header line, but the @@ -728,10 +713,10 @@ node @kbd{*} is to make it possible to make old-fashioned, unstructured files into nodes of the tree. The @samp{Node:} name, in which a node states its own name, must not -contain a filename, since Info when searching for a node does not -expect one to be there. The @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} and @samp{Up} names may -contain them. In this node, since the @samp{Up} node is in the same file, -it was not necessary to use one. +contain a filename, since Info when searching for a node does not expect +one to be there. The @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous} and @samp{Up} names +may contain them. In this node, since the @samp{Up} node is in the same +file, it was not necessary to use one. Note that the nodes in this file have a file name in the header line. The file names are ignored by Info, but they serve as comments @@ -741,7 +726,7 @@ to help identify the node for the user. @comment node-name, next, previous, up @section How to Create Menus - Any node in the Info hierarchy may have a @dfn{menu}---a list of subnodes. + Any node in the Info hierarchy may have a @dfn{menu}---a list of subnodes. The @kbd{m} command searches the current node's menu for the topic which it reads from the terminal. @@ -766,11 +751,11 @@ short abbreviations. In a long menu, it is a good idea to capitalize the beginning of each item name which is the minimum acceptable abbreviation for it (a long menu is more than 5 or so entries). - The nodes listed in a node's menu are called its ``subnodes'', and -it is their ``superior''. They should each have an @samp{Up:} pointing at -the superior. It is often useful to arrange all or most of the -subnodes in a sequence of @samp{Next} and @samp{Previous} pointers so that someone who -wants to see them all need not keep revisiting the Menu. + The nodes listed in a node's menu are called its ``subnodes'', and it +is their ``superior''. They should each have an @samp{Up:} pointing at +the superior. It is often useful to arrange all or most of the subnodes +in a sequence of @samp{Next} and @samp{Previous} pointers so that +someone who wants to see them all need not keep revisiting the Menu. The Info Directory is simply the menu of the node @samp{(dir)Top}---that is, node @samp{Top} in file @file{.../info/dir}. You can put new entries @@ -816,7 +801,7 @@ They are just examples. The places they ``lead to'' do not really exist! You can speed up the access to nodes of a large Info file by giving it a tag table. Unlike the tag table for a program, the tag table for -an Info file lives inside the file itself and is used +an Info file lives inside the file itself and is used automatically whenever Info reads in the file. To make a tag table, go to a node in the file using Emacs Info mode and type @@ -847,24 +832,24 @@ the beginning of the node's header (ending just after the node name), a Delete character, and the character position in the file of the beginning of the node. + @node Checking, Emacs Info Variables, Tags, Advanced Info -@comment node-name, next, previous, up @section Checking an Info File - When creating an Info file, it is easy to forget the name of a node -when you are making a pointer to it from another node. If you put in -the wrong name for a node, this is not detected until someone -tries to go through the pointer using Info. Verification of the Info -file is an automatic process which checks all pointers to nodes and -reports any pointers which are invalid. Every @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous}, and +When creating an Info file, it is easy to forget the name of a node when +you are making a pointer to it from another node. If you put in the +wrong name for a node, this is not detected until someone tries to go +through the pointer using Info. Verification of the Info file is an +automatic process which checks all pointers to nodes and reports any +pointers which are invalid. Every @samp{Next}, @samp{Previous}, and @samp{Up} is checked, as is every menu item and every cross reference. In -addition, any @samp{Next} which does not have a @samp{Previous} pointing back is -reported. Only pointers within the file are checked, because checking -pointers to other files would be terribly slow. But those are usually -few. +addition, any @samp{Next} which does not have a @samp{Previous} pointing +back is reported. Only pointers within the file are checked, because +checking pointers to other files would be terribly slow. But those are +usually few. - To check an Info file, do @kbd{M-x Info-validate} while looking at -any node of the file with Emacs Info mode. +To check an Info file, do @kbd{M-x Info-validate} while looking at any +node of the file with Emacs Info mode. @node Emacs Info Variables, , Checking, Advanced Info @section Emacs Info-mode Variables @@ -894,18 +879,17 @@ The standard directory for Info documentation files. Only used when the function @code{Info-directory} is called. @end vtable -@node Create an Info File, , Advanced Info, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Creating an Info File from a Makeinfo file -@code{makeinfo} is a utility that converts a Texinfo file into an Info -file; @code{texinfo-format-region} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} are -GNU Emacs functions that do the same. +@node Creating an Info File +@chapter Creating an Info File + +@xref{Top,, Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo}, to learn how to +write a Texinfo file. -@xref{Create an Info File, , Creating an Info File, texinfo, the Texinfo -Manual}, to learn how to create an Info file from a Texinfo file. +@xref{Creating an Info File,,, texinfo, Texinfo}, to learn how to create +an Info file from a Texinfo file. -@xref{Top,, Overview of Texinfo, texinfo, Texinfo: The GNU Documentation -Format}, to learn how to write a Texinfo file. +@xref{Installing an Info File,,, texinfo, Texinfo}, to learn how to +install an Info file after you have created one. @bye diff --git a/man/internals/internals.texi b/man/internals/internals.texi index f6eb892..1a85269 100644 --- a/man/internals/internals.texi +++ b/man/internals/internals.texi @@ -7506,18 +7506,18 @@ argument is evaluated more than once. Function equivalents of the above macros. @end deftypefun -@deftypefun int Lstream_read (Lstream *@var{stream}, void *@var{data}, int @var{size}) +@deftypefun ssize_t Lstream_read (Lstream *@var{stream}, void *@var{data}, size_t @var{size}) Read @var{size} bytes of @var{data} from the stream. Return the number of bytes read. 0 means EOF. -1 means an error occurred and no bytes were read. @end deftypefun -@deftypefun int Lstream_write (Lstream *@var{stream}, void *@var{data}, int @var{size}) +@deftypefun ssize_t Lstream_write (Lstream *@var{stream}, void *@var{data}, size_t @var{size}) Write @var{size} bytes of @var{data} to the stream. Return the number of bytes written. -1 means an error occurred and no bytes were written. @end deftypefun -@deftypefun void Lstream_unread (Lstream *@var{stream}, void *@var{data}, int @var{size}) +@deftypefun void Lstream_unread (Lstream *@var{stream}, void *@var{data}, size_t @var{size}) Push back @var{size} bytes of @var{data} onto the input queue. The next call to @code{Lstream_read()} with the same size will read the same bytes back. Note that this will be the case even if there is other @@ -7542,7 +7542,7 @@ Rewind the stream to the beginning. @node Lstream Methods @section Lstream Methods -@deftypefn {Lstream Method} int reader (Lstream *@var{stream}, unsigned char *@var{data}, int @var{size}) +@deftypefn {Lstream Method} ssize_t reader (Lstream *@var{stream}, unsigned char *@var{data}, size_t @var{size}) Read some data from the stream's end and store it into @var{data}, which can hold @var{size} bytes. Return the number of bytes read. A return value of 0 means no bytes can be read at this time. This may be because @@ -7559,7 +7559,7 @@ calls @code{Lstream_read()} with a very small size. This function can be @code{NULL} if the stream is output-only. @end deftypefn -@deftypefn {Lstream Method} int writer (Lstream *@var{stream}, CONST unsigned char *@var{data}, int @var{size}) +@deftypefn {Lstream Method} ssize_t writer (Lstream *@var{stream}, CONST unsigned char *@var{data}, size_t @var{size}) Send some data to the stream's end. Data to be sent is in @var{data} and is @var{size} bytes. Return the number of bytes sent. This function can send and return fewer bytes than is passed in; in that diff --git a/man/lispref/commands.texi b/man/lispref/commands.texi index 49b599c..9fc3616 100644 --- a/man/lispref/commands.texi +++ b/man/lispref/commands.texi @@ -874,7 +874,7 @@ The contents of each event are as follows: @item channel @item timestamp @item key - Which key was pressed. This is an integer (in the printing @sc{ASCII} + Which key was pressed. This is an integer (in the printing @sc{ascii} range: >32 and <127) or a symbol such as @code{left} or @code{right}. Note that many physical keys are actually treated as two separate keys, depending on whether the shift key is pressed; for example, the ``a'' @@ -1252,7 +1252,7 @@ This function returns the device that the given event occurred on. @defun event-key event This function returns the Keysym of the given key-press event. -This will be the @sc{ASCII} code of a printing character, or a symbol. +This will be the @sc{ascii} code of a printing character, or a symbol. @end defun @defun event-button event @@ -1450,10 +1450,10 @@ that is safe. XEmacs provides some auxiliary functions for converting between events and other ways of representing keys. These are useful when working with -@sc{ASCII} strings and with keymaps. +@sc{ascii} strings and with keymaps. @defun character-to-event ch &optional event device -This function converts a numeric @sc{ASCII} value to an event structure, +This function converts a numeric @sc{ascii} value to an event structure, replete with modifier bits. @var{ch} is the character to convert, and @var{event} is the event object to fill in. This function contains knowledge about what the codes ``mean'' -- for example, the number 9 is @@ -1474,19 +1474,19 @@ high bit as meta. Beware that @code{character-to-event} and @code{event-to-character} are not strictly inverse functions, since events contain much more -information than the @sc{ASCII} character set can encode. +information than the @sc{ascii} character set can encode. @end defun @defun event-to-character event &optional allow-extra-modifiers allow-meta allow-non-ascii -This function returns the closest @sc{ASCII} approximation to +This function returns the closest @sc{ascii} approximation to @var{event}. If the event isn't a keypress, this returns @code{nil}. If @var{allow-extra-modifiers} is non-@code{nil}, then this is lenient in its translation; it will ignore modifier keys other than @key{control} and @key{meta}, and will ignore the @key{shift} modifier -on those characters which have no shifted @sc{ASCII} equivalent +on those characters which have no shifted @sc{ascii} equivalent (@key{Control-Shift-A} for example, will be mapped to the same -@sc{ASCII} code as @key{Control-A}). +@sc{ascii} code as @key{Control-A}). If @var{allow-meta} is non-@code{nil}, then the @key{Meta} modifier will be represented by turning on the high bit of the byte returned; @@ -1497,7 +1497,7 @@ If @var{allow-non-ascii} is non-@code{nil}, then characters which are present in the prevailing character set (@pxref{Keymaps, variable @code{character-set-property}}) will be returned as their code in that character set, instead of the return value being restricted to -@sc{ASCII}. +@sc{ascii}. Note that specifying both @var{allow-meta} and @var{allow-non-ascii} is ambiguous, as both use the high bit; @key{M-x} and @key{oslash} will be @@ -1506,7 +1506,7 @@ indistinguishable. @defun events-to-keys events &optional no-mice Given a vector of event objects, this function returns a vector of key -descriptors, or a string (if they all fit in the @sc{ASCII} range). +descriptors, or a string (if they all fit in the @sc{ascii} range). Optional arg @var{no-mice} means that button events are not allowed. @end defun @@ -1656,7 +1656,7 @@ press the right-arrow function key: @defun read-char This function reads and returns a character of command input. If a mouse click is detected, an error is signalled. The character typed is -returned as an @sc{ASCII} value. This function is retained for +returned as an @sc{ascii} value. This function is retained for compatibility with Emacs 18, and is most likely the wrong thing for you to be using: consider using @code{next-command-event} instead. @end defun @@ -1803,8 +1803,8 @@ value of @code{last-command-event}. @defvar last-input-char If the value of @code{last-input-event} is a keyboard event, then this -is the nearest @sc{ASCII} equivalent to it. Remember that there is -@emph{not} a 1:1 mapping between keyboard events and @sc{ASCII} +is the nearest @sc{ascii} equivalent to it. Remember that there is +@emph{not} a 1:1 mapping between keyboard events and @sc{ascii} characters: the set of keyboard events is much larger, so writing code that examines this variable to determine what key has been typed is bad practice, unless you are certain that it will be one of a small set of diff --git a/man/lispref/display.texi b/man/lispref/display.texi index 3d1e992..1517f0f 100644 --- a/man/lispref/display.texi +++ b/man/lispref/display.texi @@ -874,13 +874,13 @@ Character code 10 is a newline. All other codes in the range 0 through 31, and code 127, display in one of two ways according to the value of @code{ctl-arrow}. If it is non-@code{nil}, these codes map to sequences of two glyphs, where the -first glyph is the @sc{ASCII} code for @samp{^}. (A display table can +first glyph is the @sc{ascii} code for @samp{^}. (A display table can specify a glyph to use instead of @samp{^}.) Otherwise, these codes map just like the codes in the range 128 to 255. @item Character codes 128 through 255 map to sequences of four glyphs, where -the first glyph is the @sc{ASCII} code for @samp{\}, and the others are +the first glyph is the @sc{ascii} code for @samp{\}, and the others are digit characters representing the code in octal. (A display table can specify a glyph to use instead of @samp{\}.) @end itemize @@ -921,7 +921,7 @@ stops used by the command @code{tab-to-tab-stop}. @xref{Indent Tabs}. @cindex display table You can use the @dfn{display table} feature to control how all 256 possible character codes display on the screen. This is useful for -displaying European languages that have letters not in the @sc{ASCII} +displaying European languages that have letters not in the @sc{ascii} character set. The display table maps each character code into a sequence of @@ -1040,9 +1040,9 @@ set, you can arrange to use that character set as follows: @end example If you are editing buffers written in the ISO Latin 1 character set and -your terminal doesn't handle anything but @sc{ASCII}, you can load the +your terminal doesn't handle anything but @sc{ascii}, you can load the file @file{iso-ascii} to set up a display table that displays the other -ISO characters as explanatory sequences of @sc{ASCII} characters. For +ISO characters as explanatory sequences of @sc{ascii} characters. For example, the character ``o with umlaut'' displays as @samp{@{"o@}}. Some European countries have terminals that don't support ISO Latin 1 diff --git a/man/lispref/faces.texi b/man/lispref/faces.texi index 09a0bc4..8a6b0ae 100644 --- a/man/lispref/faces.texi +++ b/man/lispref/faces.texi @@ -672,7 +672,7 @@ result. @end defun @defun color-rgb-components color &optional domain -This function returns the @sc{RGB} components of the @var{color} in the +This function returns the @sc{rgb} components of the @var{color} in the specified @var{domain}, if any. @var{color} should be a color specifier object and @var{domain} is normally a window and defaults to the selected window if omitted. This is equivalent to using diff --git a/man/lispref/functions.texi b/man/lispref/functions.texi index e1aa70b..63b964a 100644 --- a/man/lispref/functions.texi +++ b/man/lispref/functions.texi @@ -716,7 +716,7 @@ length of @var{sequence}. Return the list of results." ;; @r{If no list is exhausted,} (if (not (memq 'nil args)) - ;; @r{apply function to @sc{CAR}s.} + ;; @r{apply function to @sc{car}s.} (cons (apply f (mapcar 'car args)) (apply 'mapcar* f ;; @r{Recurse for rest of elements.} diff --git a/man/lispref/intro.texi b/man/lispref/intro.texi index 0896fce..93f6309 100644 --- a/man/lispref/intro.texi +++ b/man/lispref/intro.texi @@ -471,7 +471,7 @@ which you are criticizing. @end ifinfo This manual was originally written for FSF Emacs 19 and was updated by -Ben Wing (wing@@666.com) for Lucid Emacs 19.10 and later for XEmacs +Ben Wing (ben@@xemacs.org) for Lucid Emacs 19.10 and later for XEmacs 19.12, 19.13, 19.14, and 20.0. It was further updated by the XEmacs Development Team for 19.15 and 20.1. Please send comments and corrections relating to XEmacs-specific portions of this manual to diff --git a/man/lispref/keymaps.texi b/man/lispref/keymaps.texi index 3fd15ff..e7ea2a7 100644 --- a/man/lispref/keymaps.texi +++ b/man/lispref/keymaps.texi @@ -235,7 +235,7 @@ if it has none. @section Key Sequences @cindex key sequences - Contrary to popular belief, the world is not @sc{ASCII}. When running + Contrary to popular belief, the world is not @sc{ascii}. When running under a window manager, XEmacs can tell the difference between, for example, the keystrokes @kbd{control-h}, @kbd{control-shift-h}, and @kbd{backspace}. You can, in fact, bind different commands to each of @@ -246,8 +246,8 @@ keysym and some set of modifiers (such as @key{CONTROL} and @key{META}). A @dfn{keysym} is what is printed on the keys on your keyboard. A keysym may be represented by a symbol, or (if and only if it is -equivalent to an @sc{ASCII} character in the range 32 - 255) by a -character or its equivalent @sc{ASCII} code. The @kbd{A} key may be +equivalent to an @sc{ascii} character in the range 32 - 255) by a +character or its equivalent @sc{ascii} code. The @kbd{A} key may be represented by the symbol @code{A}, the character @code{?A}, or by the number 65. The @kbd{break} key may be represented only by the symbol @code{break}. @@ -262,12 +262,12 @@ keystroke may also be represented by an event object, as returned by the @code{next-command-event} and @code{read-key-sequence} functions. Note that in this context, the keystroke @kbd{control-b} is @emph{not} -represented by the number 2 (the @sc{ASCII} code for @samp{^B}) or the +represented by the number 2 (the @sc{ascii} code for @samp{^B}) or the character @code{?\^B}. See below. The @key{SHIFT} modifier is somewhat of a special case. You should not (and cannot) use @code{(meta shift a)} to mean @code{(meta A)}, -since for characters that have @sc{ASCII} equivalents, the state of the +since for characters that have @sc{ascii} equivalents, the state of the shift key is implicit in the keysym (@samp{a} vs. @samp{A}). You also cannot say @code{(shift =)} to mean @code{+}, as that sort of thing varies from keyboard to keyboard. The @key{SHIFT} modifier is for use @@ -311,8 +311,8 @@ so be careful. For backward compatibility, a key sequence may also be represented by a string. In this case, it represents the key sequence(s) that would -produce that sequence of @sc{ASCII} characters in a purely @sc{ASCII} -world. For example, a string containing the @sc{ASCII} backspace +produce that sequence of @sc{ascii} characters in a purely @sc{ascii} +world. For example, a string containing the @sc{ascii} backspace character, @code{"\^H"}, would represent two key sequences: @code{(control h)} and @code{backspace}. Binding a command to this will actually bind both of those key sequences. Likewise for the following @@ -342,7 +342,7 @@ it is possible to redefine only one of those sequences like so: @end example Of course, all of this applies only when running under a window -system. If you're talking to XEmacs through a @sc{TTY} connection, you +system. If you're talking to XEmacs through a @sc{tty} connection, you don't get any of these features. @defun event-matches-key-specifier-p event key-specifier @@ -973,14 +973,14 @@ This variable is the meta-prefix character code. It is used when translating a two-character sequence to a meta character so it can be looked up in a keymap. For useful results, the value should be a prefix event (@pxref{Prefix Keys}). The default value is @code{?\^[} (integer -27), which is the @sc{ASCII} character usually produced by the @key{ESC} +27), which is the @sc{ascii} character usually produced by the @key{ESC} key. As long as the value of @code{meta-prefix-char} remains @code{?\^[}, key lookup translates @kbd{@key{ESC} b} into @kbd{M-b}, which is normally defined as the @code{backward-word} command. However, if you set @code{meta-prefix-char} to @code{?\^X} (i.e. the keystroke -@kbd{C-x}) or its equivalent @sc{ASCII} code @code{24}, then XEmacs will +@kbd{C-x}) or its equivalent @sc{ascii} code @code{24}, then XEmacs will translate @kbd{C-x b} (whose standard binding is the @code{switch-to-buffer} command) into @kbd{M-b}. @@ -1503,7 +1503,7 @@ If @var{firstonly} is @code{non-ascii}, then the value is a single string representing the first key sequence found, rather than a list of all possible key sequences. If @var{firstonly} is @code{t}, then the value is the first key sequence, except that key sequences consisting -entirely of @sc{ASCII} characters (or meta variants of @sc{ASCII} +entirely of @sc{ascii} characters (or meta variants of @sc{ascii} characters) are preferred to all other key sequences. @end ignore @@ -1546,13 +1546,13 @@ displays it in a window. If @var{prefix} is non-@code{nil}, it should be a prefix key; then the listing includes only keys that start with @var{prefix}. -When several characters with consecutive @sc{ASCII} codes have the +When several characters with consecutive @sc{ascii} codes have the same definition, they are shown together, as @samp{@var{firstchar}..@var{lastchar}}. In this instance, you need to -know the @sc{ASCII} codes to understand which characters this means. +know the @sc{ascii} codes to understand which characters this means. For example, in the default global map, the characters @samp{@key{SPC} -..@: ~} are described by a single line. @key{SPC} is @sc{ASCII} 32, -@kbd{~} is @sc{ASCII} 126, and the characters between them include all +..@: ~} are described by a single line. @key{SPC} is @sc{ascii} 32, +@kbd{~} is @sc{ascii} 126, and the characters between them include all the normal printing characters, (e.g., letters, digits, punctuation, etc.@:); all these characters are bound to @code{self-insert-command}. diff --git a/man/lispref/lispref.texi b/man/lispref/lispref.texi index a24a43c..2024291 100644 --- a/man/lispref/lispref.texi +++ b/man/lispref/lispref.texi @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -\input ../texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- +\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- @c %**start of header @setfilename ../../info/lispref.info @c @smallbook diff --git a/man/lispref/lists.texi b/man/lispref/lists.texi index be8bc92..1abd504 100644 --- a/man/lispref/lists.texi +++ b/man/lispref/lists.texi @@ -1628,7 +1628,7 @@ This function returns @code{t} if @var{prop} has a value specified in In the following functions, if optional arg @var{nil-means-not-present} is non-@code{nil}, then a property with a @code{nil} value is ignored or removed. This feature is a virus that has infected old Lisp -implementations (and thus E-Lisp, due to @sc{RMS}'s enamorment with old +implementations (and thus E-Lisp, due to @sc{rms}'s enamorment with old Lisps), but should not be used except for backward compatibility. @defun plists-eq a b &optional nil-means-not-present @@ -1682,7 +1682,7 @@ This function returns @code{t} if @var{prop} has a value specified in In the following functions, if optional arg @var{nil-means-not-present} is non-@code{nil}, then a property with a @code{nil} value is ignored or removed. This feature is a virus that has infected old Lisp -implementations (and thus E-Lisp, due to @sc{RMS}'s enamorment with old +implementations (and thus E-Lisp, due to @sc{rms}'s enamorment with old Lisps), but should not be used except for backward compatibility. @defun lax-plists-eq a b &optional nil-means-not-present diff --git a/man/lispref/modes.texi b/man/lispref/modes.texi index 0a05e5f..332a960 100644 --- a/man/lispref/modes.texi +++ b/man/lispref/modes.texi @@ -330,7 +330,7 @@ correspondingly more complicated. Here are excerpts from @group ;; @r{Set syntax of chars up to 0 to class of chars that are} ;; @r{part of symbol names but not words.} - ;; @r{(The number 0 is @code{48} in the @sc{ASCII} character set.)} + ;; @r{(The number 0 is @code{48} in the @sc{ascii} character set.)} (while (< i ?0) (modify-syntax-entry i "_ " emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table) (setq i (1+ i))) diff --git a/man/lispref/objects.texi b/man/lispref/objects.texi index 8b68361..a809171 100644 --- a/man/lispref/objects.texi +++ b/man/lispref/objects.texi @@ -343,7 +343,7 @@ number whose value is 1500. They are all equivalent. @node Character Type @subsection Character Type -@cindex @sc{ASCII} character codes +@cindex @sc{ascii} character codes @cindex char-int confoundance disease In XEmacs version 19, and in all versions of FSF GNU Emacs, a @@ -352,7 +352,7 @@ This is yet another holdover from XEmacs Lisp's derivation from vintage-1980 Lisps; modern versions of Lisp consider this equivalence a bad idea, and have separate character types. In XEmacs version 20, the modern convention is followed, and characters are their own -primitive types. (This change was necessary in order for @sc{MULE}, +primitive types. (This change was necessary in order for @sc{mule}, i.e. Asian-language, support to be correctly implemented.) Even in XEmacs version 20, remnants of the equivalence between @@ -370,21 +370,21 @@ with the distinction between characters and integers in mind. Every character has an equivalent integer, called the @dfn{character code}. For example, the character @kbd{A} is represented as the -@w{integer 65}, following the standard @sc{ASCII} representation of -characters. If XEmacs was not compiled with @sc{MULE} support, the +@w{integer 65}, following the standard @sc{ascii} representation of +characters. If XEmacs was not compiled with @sc{mule} support, the range of this integer will always be 0 to 255 -- eight bits, or one byte. (Integers outside this range are accepted but silently truncated; however, you should most decidedly @emph{not} rely on this, because it -will not work under XEmacs with @sc{MULE} support.) When @sc{MULE} +will not work under XEmacs with @sc{mule} support.) When @sc{mule} support is present, the range of character codes is much larger. (Currently, 19 bits are used.) FSF GNU Emacs uses kludgy character codes above 255 to represent -keyboard input of @sc{ASCII} characters in combination with certain +keyboard input of @sc{ascii} characters in combination with certain modifiers. XEmacs does not use this (a more general mechanism is -used that does not distinguish between @sc{ASCII} keys and other +used that does not distinguish between @sc{ascii} keys and other keys), so you will never find character codes above 255 in a -non-@sc{MULE} XEmacs. +non-@sc{mule} XEmacs. Individual characters are not often used in programs. It is far more common to work with @emph{strings}, which are sequences composed of @@ -506,15 +506,15 @@ with character code 193, or 128 plus 65. You should @emph{not} use this syntax in your programs. It is a holdover of yet another confoundance disease from earlier Emacsen. (This was used to represent keyboard input with the @key{META} key set, thus the @samp{M}; however, it conflicts -with the legitimate @sc{ISO}-8859-1 interpretation of the character code. +with the legitimate @sc{iso}-8859-1 interpretation of the character code. For example, character code 193 is a lowercase @samp{a} with an acute -accent, in @sc{ISO}-8859-1.) +accent, in @sc{iso}-8859-1.) @ignore @c None of this crap applies to XEmacs. For use in strings and buffers, you are limited to the control -characters that exist in @sc{ASCII}, but for keyboard input purposes, +characters that exist in @sc{ascii}, but for keyboard input purposes, you can turn any character into a control character with @samp{C-}. The -character codes for these non-@sc{ASCII} control characters include the +character codes for these non-@sc{ascii} control characters include the @iftex $2^{26}$ @end iftex @@ -617,9 +617,9 @@ bit values are 2**22 for alt, 2**23 for super and 2**24 for hyper. followed by a backslash and the character code in octal (up to three octal digits); thus, @samp{?\101} for the character @kbd{A}, @samp{?\001} for the character @kbd{C-a}, and @code{?\002} for the -character @kbd{C-b}. Although this syntax can represent any @sc{ASCII} +character @kbd{C-b}. Although this syntax can represent any @sc{ascii} character, it is preferred only when the precise octal value is more -important than the @sc{ASCII} representation. +important than the @sc{ascii} representation. @example @group @@ -1521,7 +1521,7 @@ Normally, there is only one device object, but there may be more than one if XEmacs is being run on a multi-headed display (e.g. an X server with attached color and mono screens) or if XEmacs is simultaneously driving frames attached to different consoles, e.g. -an X display and a @sc{TTY} connection. +an X display and a @sc{tty} connection. Devices do not have a read syntax. They print in hash notation, giving the device's type, connection name, and a unique number assigned @@ -1544,13 +1544,13 @@ related to devices. (i.e. displays on which frames exist) are connected. Normally, there is only one console object, but there may be more than one if XEmacs is simultaneously driving frames attached to different X servers and/or -@sc{TTY} connections. (XEmacs is capable of driving multiple X and -@sc{TTY} connections at the same time, and provides a robust mechanism +@sc{tty} connections. (XEmacs is capable of driving multiple X and +@sc{tty} connections at the same time, and provides a robust mechanism for handling the differing display capabilities of such heterogeneous environments. A buffer with embedded glyphs and multiple fonts and colors, for example, will display reasonably if it simultaneously appears on a frame on a color X display, a frame on a mono X display, -and a frame on a @sc{TTY} connection.) +and a frame on a @sc{tty} connection.) Consoles do not have a read syntax. They print in hash notation, giving the console's type, connection name, and a unique number assigned diff --git a/man/lispref/os.texi b/man/lispref/os.texi index b79830b..afe40ac 100644 --- a/man/lispref/os.texi +++ b/man/lispref/os.texi @@ -1602,7 +1602,7 @@ entries and DEC terminal concentrators, see @file{emacs/etc/TERMS}. @code{C-s} and @kbd{C-q} for flow control. Therefore, the choice of @kbd{C-s} and @kbd{C-q} as command characters was uncontroversial. XEmacs, for economy of keystrokes and portability, used nearly all the -@sc{ASCII} control characters, with mnemonic meanings when possible; +@sc{ascii} control characters, with mnemonic meanings when possible; thus, @kbd{C-s} for search and @kbd{C-q} for quote. Later, some terminals were introduced which required these characters diff --git a/man/lispref/sequences.texi b/man/lispref/sequences.texi index 54b2d95..fd7f170 100644 --- a/man/lispref/sequences.texi +++ b/man/lispref/sequences.texi @@ -264,7 +264,7 @@ strings for such applications, for four reasons: @item They usually occupy one-fourth the space of a vector of the same elements. (This is one-eighth the space for 64-bit machines such as the -DEC Alpha, and may also be different when @sc{MULE} support is compiled +DEC Alpha, and may also be different when @sc{mule} support is compiled into XEmacs.) @item diff --git a/man/lispref/strings.texi b/man/lispref/strings.texi index 95da8ee..260509c 100644 --- a/man/lispref/strings.texi +++ b/man/lispref/strings.texi @@ -45,8 +45,8 @@ determined only by how it is used. @xref{Character Type}. The length of a string (like any array) is fixed and independent of the string contents, and cannot be altered. Strings in Lisp are @emph{not} terminated by a distinguished character code. (By contrast, -strings in C are terminated by a character with @sc{ASCII} code 0.) -This means that any character, including the null character (@sc{ASCII} +strings in C are terminated by a character with @sc{ascii} code 0.) +This means that any character, including the null character (@sc{ascii} code 0), is a valid element of a string.@refill Since strings are considered arrays, you can operate on them with the @@ -321,15 +321,15 @@ the range 0 - 255 map to characters as follows: @item 0 - 31 Control set 0 @item 32 - 127 -@sc{ASCII} +@sc{ascii} @item 128 - 159 Control set 1 @item 160 - 255 Right half of ISO-8859-1 @end table -If support for @sc{MULE} does not exist, these are the only valid -character values. When @sc{MULE} support exists, the values assigned to +If support for @sc{mule} does not exist, these are the only valid +character values. When @sc{mule} support exists, the values assigned to other characters may vary depending on the particular version of XEmacs, the order in which character sets were loaded, etc., and you should not depend on them. @@ -427,9 +427,9 @@ function returns @code{t}. If the lesser character is the one from @var{string2}, then @var{string1} is greater, and this function returns @code{nil}. If the two strings match entirely, the value is @code{nil}. -Pairs of characters are compared by their @sc{ASCII} codes. Keep in +Pairs of characters are compared by their @sc{ascii} codes. Keep in mind that lower case letters have higher numeric values in the -@sc{ASCII} character set than their upper case counterparts; numbers and +@sc{ascii} character set than their upper case counterparts; numbers and many punctuation characters have a lower numeric value than upper case letters. @@ -515,7 +515,7 @@ of 1. (@xref{Creating Strings}.) This conversion can also be done with This function returns the first character in @var{string}. If the string is empty, the function returns 0. (Under XEmacs 19, the value is also 0 when the first character of @var{string} is the null character, -@sc{ASCII} code 0.) +@sc{ascii} code 0.) @example (string-to-char "ABC") @@ -910,7 +910,7 @@ characters (the letters @samp{A} through @samp{Z} and @samp{a} through modify the strings that are passed to them as arguments. The examples below use the characters @samp{X} and @samp{x} which have -@sc{ASCII} codes 88 and 120 respectively. +@sc{ascii} codes 88 and 120 respectively. @defun downcase string-or-char This function converts a character or a string to lower case. @@ -995,7 +995,7 @@ table}. A case table specifies the mapping between upper case and lower case letters. It affects both the string and character case conversion functions (see the previous section) and those that apply to text in the buffer (@pxref{Case Changes}). You need a case table if you are using a -language which has letters other than the standard @sc{ASCII} letters. +language which has letters other than the standard @sc{ascii} letters. A case table is a list of this form: @@ -1022,7 +1022,7 @@ the same canonical equivalent character. The element @var{equivalences} is a map that cyclicly permutes each equivalence class (of characters with the same canonical equivalent). -(For ordinary @sc{ASCII}, this would map @samp{a} into @samp{A} and +(For ordinary @sc{ascii}, this would map @samp{a} into @samp{A} and @samp{A} into @samp{a}, and likewise for each set of equivalent characters.) @@ -1063,7 +1063,7 @@ This sets the current buffer's case table to @var{table}. @end defun The following three functions are convenient subroutines for packages -that define non-@sc{ASCII} character sets. They modify a string +that define non-@sc{ascii} character sets. They modify a string @var{downcase-table} provided as an argument; this should be a string to be used as the @var{downcase} part of a case table. They also modify the standard syntax table. @xref{Syntax Tables}. @@ -1109,7 +1109,7 @@ Note that char tables as a primitive type, and all of the functions in this section, exist only in XEmacs 20. In XEmacs 19, char tables are generally implemented using a vector of 256 elements. -When @sc{MULE} support exists, the types of ranges that can be assigned +When @sc{mule} support exists, the types of ranges that can be assigned values are @itemize @bullet @@ -1123,7 +1123,7 @@ a single row in a two-octet charset a single character @end itemize -When @sc{MULE} support is not present, the types of ranges that can be +When @sc{mule} support is not present, the types of ranges that can be assigned values are @itemize @bullet @@ -1154,7 +1154,7 @@ Used for category tables, which specify the regexp categories that a character is in. The valid values are @code{nil} or a bit vector of 95 elements. Higher-level Lisp functions are provided for working with category tables. Currently categories -and category tables only exist when @sc{MULE} support is present. +and category tables only exist when @sc{mule} support is present. @item char A generalized char table, for mapping from one character to another. Used for case tables, syntax matching tables, @@ -1203,10 +1203,10 @@ one of the following: @item @code{t} (all characters are affected) @item -A charset (only allowed when @sc{MULE} support is present) +A charset (only allowed when @sc{mule} support is present) @item A vector of two elements: a two-octet charset and a row number -(only allowed when @sc{MULE} support is present) +(only allowed when @sc{mule} support is present) @item A single character @end itemize diff --git a/man/lispref/text.texi b/man/lispref/text.texi index 1f743a5..1fdb63f 100644 --- a/man/lispref/text.texi +++ b/man/lispref/text.texi @@ -1478,7 +1478,7 @@ comparing the first characters of each, the second characters of each, and so on. If a mismatch is found, it means that the sort keys are unequal; the sort key whose character is less at the point of first mismatch is the lesser sort key. The individual characters are compared -according to their numerical values. Since Emacs uses the @sc{ASCII} +according to their numerical values. Since Emacs uses the @sc{ascii} character set, the ordering in that set determines alphabetical order. @c version 19 change diff --git a/man/make-stds.texi b/man/make-stds.texi index b3b88da..c7c71ad 100644 --- a/man/make-stds.texi +++ b/man/make-stds.texi @@ -21,6 +21,8 @@ chapter @end ifclear @end iftex describes conventions for writing the Makefiles for GNU programs. +Using Automake will help you write a Makefile that follows these +conventions. @menu * Makefile Basics:: General Conventions for Makefiles @@ -28,6 +30,8 @@ describes conventions for writing the Makefiles for GNU programs. * Command Variables:: Variables for Specifying Commands * Directory Variables:: Variables for Installation Directories * Standard Targets:: Standard Targets for Users +* Install Command Categories:: Three categories of commands in the `install' + rule: normal, pre-install and post-install. @end menu @node Makefile Basics @@ -65,9 +69,10 @@ part of the make or @file{$(srcdir)/} if the file is an unchanging part of the source code. Without one of these prefixes, the current search path is used. -The distinction between @file{./} and @file{$(srcdir)/} is important -when using the @samp{--srcdir} option to @file{configure}. A rule of -the form: +The distinction between @file{./} (the @dfn{build directory}) and +@file{$(srcdir)/} (the @dfn{source directory}) is important because +users can build in a separate directory using the @samp{--srcdir} option +to @file{configure}. A rule of the form: @smallexample foo.1 : foo.man sedscript @@ -75,9 +80,8 @@ foo.1 : foo.man sedscript @end smallexample @noindent -will fail when the current directory is not the source directory, -because @file{foo.man} and @file{sedscript} are not in the current -directory. +will fail when the build directory is not the source directory, because +@file{foo.man} and @file{sedscript} are in the the source directory. When using GNU @code{make}, relying on @samp{VPATH} to find the source file will work in the case where there is a single dependency file, @@ -109,6 +113,18 @@ foo.1 : foo.man sedscript sed -e $(srcdir)/sedscript $(srcdir)/foo.man > $@@ @end smallexample +GNU distributions usually contain some files which are not source +files---for example, Info files, and the output from Autoconf, Automake, +Bison or Flex. Since these files normally appear in the source +directory, they should always appear in the source directory, not in the +build directory. So Makefile rules to update them should put the +updated files in the source directory. + +However, if a file does not appear in the distribution, then the +Makefile should not put it in the source directory, because building a +program in ordinary circumstances should not modify the source directory +in any way. + Try to make the build and installation targets, at least (and all their subtargets) work correctly with a parallel @code{make}. @@ -122,11 +138,17 @@ special features of @code{ksh} or @code{bash}. The @code{configure} script and the Makefile rules for building and installation should not use any utilities directly except these: +@c dd find +@c gunzip gzip md5sum +@c mkfifo mknod tee uname + @example -cat cmp cp echo egrep expr false grep -ln mkdir mv pwd rm rmdir sed test touch true +cat cmp cp diff echo egrep expr false grep install-info +ln ls mkdir mv pwd rm rmdir sed sleep sort tar test touch true @end example +The compression program @code{gzip} can be used in the @code{dist} rule. + Stick to the generally supported options for these programs. For example, don't use @samp{mkdir -p}, convenient as it may be, because most systems don't support it. @@ -140,26 +162,33 @@ user can substitute alternatives. Here are some of the programs we mean: @example -ar bison cc flex install ld lex +ar bison cc flex install ld ldconfig lex make makeinfo ranlib texi2dvi yacc @end example -Use the following @code{make} variables: +Use the following @code{make} variables to run those programs: @example -$(AR) $(BISON) $(CC) $(FLEX) $(INSTALL) $(LD) $(LEX) +$(AR) $(BISON) $(CC) $(FLEX) $(INSTALL) $(LD) $(LDCONFIG) $(LEX) $(MAKE) $(MAKEINFO) $(RANLIB) $(TEXI2DVI) $(YACC) @end example -When you use @code{ranlib}, you should make sure nothing bad happens if -the system does not have @code{ranlib}. Arrange to ignore an error -from that command, and print a message before the command to tell the -user that failure of the @code{ranlib} command does not mean a problem. -(The Autoconf @samp{AC_PROG_RANLIB} macro can help with this.) +When you use @code{ranlib} or @code{ldconfig}, you should make sure +nothing bad happens if the system does not have the program in question. +Arrange to ignore an error from that command, and print a message before +the command to tell the user that failure of this command does not mean +a problem. (The Autoconf @samp{AC_PROG_RANLIB} macro can help with +this.) If you use symbolic links, you should implement a fallback for systems that don't have symbolic links. +Additional utilities that can be used via Make variables are: + +@example +chgrp chmod chown mknod +@end example + It is ok to use other utilities in Makefile portions (or scripts) intended only for particular systems where you know those utilities exist. @@ -182,11 +211,12 @@ don't need to replace them with other programs. Each program-name variable should come with an options variable that is used to supply options to the program. Append @samp{FLAGS} to the program-name variable name to get the options variable name---for -example, @code{BISONFLAGS}. (The name @code{CFLAGS} is an exception to -this rule, but we keep it because it is standard.) Use @code{CPPFLAGS} -in any compilation command that runs the preprocessor, and use -@code{LDFLAGS} in any compilation command that does linking as well as -in any direct use of @code{ld}. +example, @code{BISONFLAGS}. (The names @code{CFLAGS} for the C +compiler, @code{YFLAGS} for yacc, and @code{LFLAGS} for lex, are +exceptions to this rule, but we keep them because they are standard.) +Use @code{CPPFLAGS} in any compilation command that runs the +preprocessor, and use @code{LDFLAGS} in any compilation command that +does linking as well as in any direct use of @code{ld}. If there are C compiler options that @emph{must} be used for proper compilation of certain files, do not include them in @code{CFLAGS}. @@ -212,6 +242,9 @@ Put @code{CFLAGS} last in the compilation command, after other variables containing compiler options, so the user can use @code{CFLAGS} to override the others. +@code{CFLAGS} should be used in every invocation of the C compiler, +both those which do compilation and those which do linking. + Every Makefile should define the variable @code{INSTALL}, which is the basic command for installing a file into the system. @@ -226,6 +259,18 @@ $(INSTALL_PROGRAM) foo $(bindir)/foo $(INSTALL_DATA) libfoo.a $(libdir)/libfoo.a @end example +Optionally, you may prepend the value of @code{DESTDIR} to the target +filename. Doing this allows the installer to create a snapshot of the +installation to be copied onto the real target filesystem later. Do not +set the value of @code{DESTDIR} in your Makefile, and do not include it +in any installed files. With support for @code{DESTDIR}, the above +examples become: + +@example +$(INSTALL_PROGRAM) foo $(DESTDIR)$(bindir)/foo +$(INSTALL_DATA) libfoo.a $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libfoo.a +@end example + @noindent Always use a file name, not a directory name, as the second argument of the installation commands. Use a separate command for each file to be @@ -252,6 +297,10 @@ When building the complete GNU system, the prefix will be empty and @file{/usr} will be a symbolic link to @file{/}. (If you are using Autoconf, write it as @samp{@@prefix@@}.) +Running @samp{make install} with a different value of @code{prefix} +from the one used to build the program should @var{not} recompile +the program. + @item exec_prefix A prefix used in constructing the default values of some of the variables listed below. The default value of @code{exec_prefix} should @@ -261,6 +310,10 @@ be @code{$(prefix)}. Generally, @code{$(exec_prefix)} is used for directories that contain machine-specific files (such as executables and subroutine libraries), while @code{$(prefix)} is used directly for other directories. + +Running @samp{make install} with a different value of @code{exec_prefix} +from the one used to build the program should @var{not} recompile the +program. @end table Executable programs are installed in one of the following directories. @@ -328,14 +381,11 @@ files. This directory should normally be @file{/usr/local/etc}, but write it as @file{$(prefix)/etc}. (If you are using Autoconf, write it as @samp{@@sysconfdir@@}.) -@c rewritten to avoid overfull hbox --tower -Do not install executables -@c here -in this directory (they probably -belong in @file{$(libexecdir)} or @file{$(sbindir)}). Also do not -install files that are modified in the normal course of their use -(programs whose purpose is to change the configuration of the system -excluded). Those probably belong in @file{$(localstatedir)}. +Do not install executables here in this directory (they probably belong +in @file{$(libexecdir)} or @file{$(sbindir)}). Also do not install +files that are modified in the normal course of their use (programs +whose purpose is to change the configuration of the system excluded). +Those probably belong in @file{$(localstatedir)}. @item sharedstatedir The directory for installing architecture-independent data files which @@ -366,6 +416,20 @@ default, it should be @file{/usr/local/info}, but it should be written as @file{$(prefix)/info}. (If you are using Autoconf, write it as @samp{@@infodir@@}.) +@item lispdir +The directory for installing any Emacs Lisp files in this package. By +default, it should be @file{/usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp}, but it +should be written as @file{$(prefix)/share/emacs/site-lisp}. + +If you are using Autoconf, write the default as @samp{@@lispdir@@}. +In order to make @samp{@@lispdir@@} work, you need the following lines +in your @file{configure.in} file: + +@example +lispdir='$@{datadir@}/emacs/site-lisp' +AC_SUBST(lispdir) +@end example + @item includedir @c rewritten to avoid overfull hbox --roland The directory for installing header files to be included by user @@ -374,7 +438,7 @@ should normally be @file{/usr/local/include}, but write it as @file{$(prefix)/include}. (If you are using Autoconf, write it as @samp{@@includedir@@}.) -Most compilers other than GCC do not look for header files in +Most compilers other than GCC do not look for header files in directory @file{/usr/local/include}. So installing the header files this way is only useful with GCC. Sometimes this is not a problem because some libraries are only really intended to work with GCC. But some libraries @@ -526,11 +590,12 @@ Here is a sample rule to install an Info file: @comment This example has been carefully formatted for the Make manual. @comment Please do not reformat it without talking to roland@gnu.ai.mit.edu. @smallexample -$(infodir)/foo.info: foo.info +$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/foo.info: foo.info + $(POST_INSTALL) # There may be a newer info file in . than in srcdir. -if test -f foo.info; then d=.; \ else d=$(srcdir); fi; \ - $(INSTALL_DATA) $$d/foo.info $@@; \ + $(INSTALL_DATA) $$d/foo.info $(DESTDIR)$@@; \ # Run install-info only if it exists. # Use `if' instead of just prepending `-' to the # line so we notice real errors from install-info. @@ -538,22 +603,29 @@ $(infodir)/foo.info: foo.info # fail gracefully when there is an unknown command. if $(SHELL) -c 'install-info --version' \ >/dev/null 2>&1; then \ - install-info --dir-file=$(infodir)/dir \ - $(infodir)/foo.info; \ + install-info --dir-file=$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/dir \ + $(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/foo.info; \ else true; fi @end smallexample +When writing the @code{install} target, you must classify all the +commands into three categories: normal ones, @dfn{pre-installation} +commands and @dfn{post-installation} commands. @xref{Install Command +Categories}. + @item uninstall -Delete all the installed files that the @samp{install} target would -create (but not the noninstalled files such as @samp{make all} would -create). +Delete all the installed files---the copies that the @samp{install} +target creates. This rule should not modify the directories where compilation is done, only the directories where files are installed. +The uninstallation commands are divided into three categories, just like +the installation commands. @xref{Install Command Categories}. + @item install-strip Like @code{install}, but strip the executable files while installing -them. The definition of this target can be very simple: +them. In many cases, the definition of this target can be very simple: @smallexample install-strip: @@ -638,6 +710,12 @@ You must define the variable @code{MAKEINFO} in the Makefile. It should run the @code{makeinfo} program, which is part of the Texinfo distribution. +Normally a GNU distribution comes with Info files, and that means the +Info files are present in the source directory. Therefore, the Make +rule for an info file should update it in the source directory. When +users build the package, ordinarily Make will not update the Info files +because they will already be up to date. + @item dvi Generate DVI files for all Texinfo documentation. For example: @@ -669,7 +747,7 @@ The easiest way to do this is to create a subdirectory appropriately named, use @code{ln} or @code{cp} to install the proper files in it, and then @code{tar} that subdirectory. -Compress the tar file with @code{gzip}. For example, the actual +Compress the tar file file with @code{gzip}. For example, the actual distribution file for GCC version 1.40 is called @file{gcc-1.40.tar.gz}. The @code{dist} target should explicitly depend on all non-source files @@ -720,3 +798,119 @@ installdirs: mkinstalldirs This rule should not modify the directories where compilation is done. It should do nothing but create installation directories. @end table + +@node Install Command Categories +@section Install Command Categories + +@cindex pre-installation commands +@cindex post-installation commands +When writing the @code{install} target, you must classify all the +commands into three categories: normal ones, @dfn{pre-installation} +commands and @dfn{post-installation} commands. + +Normal commands move files into their proper places, and set their +modes. They may not alter any files except the ones that come entirely +from the package they belong to. + +Pre-installation and post-installation commands may alter other files; +in particular, they can edit global configuration files or data bases. + +Pre-installation commands are typically executed before the normal +commands, and post-installation commands are typically run after the +normal commands. + +The most common use for a post-installation command is to run +@code{install-info}. This cannot be done with a normal command, since +it alters a file (the Info directory) which does not come entirely and +solely from the package being installed. It is a post-installation +command because it needs to be done after the normal command which +installs the package's Info files. + +Most programs don't need any pre-installation commands, but we have the +feature just in case it is needed. + +To classify the commands in the @code{install} rule into these three +categories, insert @dfn{category lines} among them. A category line +specifies the category for the commands that follow. + +A category line consists of a tab and a reference to a special Make +variable, plus an optional comment at the end. There are three +variables you can use, one for each category; the variable name +specifies the category. Category lines are no-ops in ordinary execution +because these three Make variables are normally undefined (and you +@emph{should not} define them in the makefile). + +Here are the three possible category lines, each with a comment that +explains what it means: + +@smallexample + $(PRE_INSTALL) # @r{Pre-install commands follow.} + $(POST_INSTALL) # @r{Post-install commands follow.} + $(NORMAL_INSTALL) # @r{Normal commands follow.} +@end smallexample + +If you don't use a category line at the beginning of the @code{install} +rule, all the commands are classified as normal until the first category +line. If you don't use any category lines, all the commands are +classified as normal. + +These are the category lines for @code{uninstall}: + +@smallexample + $(PRE_UNINSTALL) # @r{Pre-uninstall commands follow.} + $(POST_UNINSTALL) # @r{Post-uninstall commands follow.} + $(NORMAL_UNINSTALL) # @r{Normal commands follow.} +@end smallexample + +Typically, a pre-uninstall command would be used for deleting entries +from the Info directory. + +If the @code{install} or @code{uninstall} target has any dependencies +which act as subroutines of installation, then you should start +@emph{each} dependency's commands with a category line, and start the +main target's commands with a category line also. This way, you can +ensure that each command is placed in the right category regardless of +which of the dependencies actually run. + +Pre-installation and post-installation commands should not run any +programs except for these: + +@example +[ basename bash cat chgrp chmod chown cmp cp dd diff echo +egrep expand expr false fgrep find getopt grep gunzip gzip +hostname install install-info kill ldconfig ln ls md5sum +mkdir mkfifo mknod mv printenv pwd rm rmdir sed sort tee +test touch true uname xargs yes +@end example + +@cindex binary packages +The reason for distinguishing the commands in this way is for the sake +of making binary packages. Typically a binary package contains all the +executables and other files that need to be installed, and has its own +method of installing them---so it does not need to run the normal +installation commands. But installing the binary package does need to +execute the pre-installation and post-installation commands. + +Programs to build binary packages work by extracting the +pre-installation and post-installation commands. Here is one way of +extracting the pre-installation commands: + +@smallexample +make -n install -o all \ + PRE_INSTALL=pre-install \ + POST_INSTALL=post-install \ + NORMAL_INSTALL=normal-install \ + | gawk -f pre-install.awk +@end smallexample + +@noindent +where the file @file{pre-install.awk} could contain this: + +@smallexample +$0 ~ /^\t[ \t]*(normal_install|post_install)[ \t]*$/ @{on = 0@} +on @{print $0@} +$0 ~ /^\t[ \t]*pre_install[ \t]*$/ @{on = 1@} +@end smallexample + +The resulting file of pre-installation commands is executed as a shell +script as part of installing the binary package. diff --git a/man/new-users-guide/custom1.texi b/man/new-users-guide/custom1.texi index a5da258..f60c940 100644 --- a/man/new-users-guide/custom1.texi +++ b/man/new-users-guide/custom1.texi @@ -168,8 +168,8 @@ Menus}. @enumerate @item -add-menu-item: @var{(menu-name item-name function enabled-p -&optional before)} +add-menu-item: (@var{menu-name} @var{item-name} @var{function} @var{enabled-p} +&optional @var{before}) This function will add a menu item to a menu, creating the menu first if necessary. If the named item already exists, the menu will remain @@ -260,7 +260,7 @@ submenus: @b{Copy File}, @b{Delete File} and @b{Rename File}. @findex delete-menu-item @cindex deleting menu items @item -delete-menu-item: @var{(menu-path)} +delete-menu-item: (@var{menu-path}) This function will remove the menu item defined by @var{menu-name} from the menu hierarchy. Look at the following examples and the comments just above them which specify what the examples do. @@ -286,7 +286,7 @@ above them which specify what the examples do. @findex disable-menu-item @cindex disabling menu items @item -disable-menu-item: @var{(menu-name)} +disable-menu-item: (@var{menu-name}) Disables the specified menu item. The following example @example @@ -301,7 +301,7 @@ be selected. @findex enable-menu-item @cindex enabling menu items @item -enable-menu-item: @var{(menu-name)} +enable-menu-item: (@var{menu-name}) Enables the specified previously disabled menu item. @example @@ -315,7 +315,7 @@ earlier command. @findex relabel-menu-items @cindex relabelling menu items @item -relabel-menu-item: @var{(menu-name new-name)} +relabel-menu-item: (@var{menu-name} @var{new-name}) Change the string of the menu item specified by @var{menu-name} to @var{new-name}. diff --git a/man/new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi b/man/new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi index 4d984b7..3bed4da 100644 --- a/man/new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi +++ b/man/new-users-guide/new-users-guide.texi @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -\input ../texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- +\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- @setfilename ../../info/new-users-guide.info @comment node-name, next, previous, up diff --git a/man/standards.texi b/man/standards.texi index 222c11f..7889e30 100644 --- a/man/standards.texi +++ b/man/standards.texi @@ -2,8 +2,8 @@ @c %**start of header @setfilename ../info/standards.info @settitle GNU Coding Standards -@c UPDATE THIS DATE WHENEVER YOU MAKE CHANGES! -@set lastupdate 17 May 1996 +@c This date is automagically updated when you save this file: +@set lastupdate June 24, 1999 @c %**end of header @ifinfo @@ -28,7 +28,7 @@ END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY @ifinfo GNU Coding Standards -Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice @@ -59,7 +59,7 @@ by the Free Software Foundation. @page @vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @copyright{} 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +Copyright @copyright{} 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice @@ -84,13 +84,14 @@ Last updated @value{lastupdate}. @end ifinfo @menu -* Preface:: About the GNU Coding Standards -* Intellectual Property:: Keeping Free Software Free -* Design Advice:: General Program Design -* Program Behavior:: Program Behavior for All Programs -* Writing C:: Making The Best Use of C -* Documentation:: Documenting Programs -* Managing Releases:: The Release Process +* Preface:: About the GNU Coding Standards +* Legal Issues:: Keeping Free Software Free +* Design Advice:: General Program Design +* Program Behavior:: Program Behavior for All Programs +* Writing C:: Making The Best Use of C +* Documentation:: Documenting Programs +* Managing Releases:: The Release Process +* References:: References to Non-Free Software or Documentation @end menu @node Preface @@ -104,8 +105,8 @@ programs written in C, but many of the rules and principles are useful even if you write in another programming language. The rules often state reasons for writing in a certain way. -Corrections or suggestions regarding this document should be sent to -@code{gnu@@prep.ai.mit.edu}. If you make a suggestion, please include a +Corrections or suggestions for this document should be sent to +@email{gnu@@gnu.org}. If you make a suggestion, please include a suggested new wording for it; our time is limited. We prefer a context diff to the @file{standards.texi} or @file{make-stds.texi} files, but if you don't have those files, please mail your suggestion anyway. @@ -113,15 +114,15 @@ you don't have those files, please mail your suggestion anyway. This release of the GNU Coding Standards was last updated @value{lastupdate}. -@node Intellectual Property +@node Legal Issues @chapter Keeping Free Software Free This @value{CHAPTER} discusses how you can make sure that GNU software remains unencumbered. @menu -* Reading Non-Free Code:: Referring to Proprietary Programs -* Contributions:: Accepting Contributions +* Reading Non-Free Code:: Referring to Proprietary Programs +* Contributions:: Accepting Contributions @end menu @node Reading Non-Free Code @@ -161,37 +162,47 @@ to free memory, or use a new GNU facility such as obstacks. @node Contributions @section Accepting Contributions -If someone else sends you a piece of code to add to the program you are -working on, we need legal papers to use it---the same sort of legal -papers we will need to get from you. @emph{Each} significant -contributor to a program must sign some sort of legal papers in order -for us to have clear title to the program. The main author alone is not +If the program you are working on is copyrighted by the Free Software +Foundation, then when someone else sends you a piece of code to add to +the program, we need legal papers to use it---just as we asked you to +sign papers initially. @emph{Each} person who makes a nontrivial +contribution to a program must sign some sort of legal papers in order +for us to have clear title to the program; the main author alone is not enough. -So, before adding in any contributions from other people, tell us -so we can arrange to get the papers. Then wait until we tell you +So, before adding in any contributions from other people, please tell +us, so we can arrange to get the papers. Then wait until we tell you that we have received the signed papers, before you actually use the contribution. This applies both before you release the program and afterward. If you receive diffs to fix a bug, and they make significant changes, we -need legal papers for it. +need legal papers for that change. + +This also applies to comments and documentation files. For copyright +law, comments and code are just text. Copyright applies to all kinds of +text, so we need legal papers for all kinds. + +We know it is frustrating to ask for legal papers; it's frustrating for +us as well. But if you don't wait, you are going out on a limb---for +example, what if the contributor's employer won't sign a disclaimer? +You might have to take that code out again! You don't need papers for changes of a few lines here or there, since they are not significant for copyright purposes. Also, you don't need papers if all you get from the suggestion is some ideas, not actual code -which you use. For example, if you write a different solution to the -problem, you don't need to get papers. - -We know this is frustrating; it's frustrating for us as well. But if -you don't wait, you are going out on a limb---for example, what if the -contributor's employer won't sign a disclaimer? You might have to take -that code out again! +which you use. For example, if someone send you one implementation, but +you write a different implementation of the same idea, you don't need to +get papers. The very worst thing is if you forget to tell us about the other contributor. We could be very embarrassed in court some day as a result. +We have more detailed advice for maintainers of programs; if you have +reached the stage of actually maintaining a program for GNU (whether +released or not), please ask us for a copy. + @node Design Advice @chapter General Program Design @@ -199,10 +210,10 @@ This @value{CHAPTER} discusses some of the issues you should take into account when designing your program. @menu -* Compatibility:: Compatibility with other implementations -* Using Extensions:: Using non-standard features +* Compatibility:: Compatibility with other implementations +* Using Extensions:: Using non-standard features * ANSI C:: Using ANSI C features -* Source Language:: Using languages other than C +* Source Language:: Using languages other than C @end menu @node Compatibility @@ -211,20 +222,20 @@ account when designing your program. With occasional exceptions, utility programs and libraries for GNU should be upward compatible with those in Berkeley Unix, and upward compatible with @sc{ansi} C if @sc{ansi} C specifies their behavior, and -upward compatible with @sc{POSIX} if @sc{POSIX} specifies their +upward compatible with @sc{posix} if @sc{posix} specifies their behavior. When these standards conflict, it is useful to offer compatibility modes for each of them. -@sc{ansi} C and @sc{POSIX} prohibit many kinds of extensions. Feel free +@sc{ansi} C and @sc{posix} prohibit many kinds of extensions. Feel free to make the extensions anyway, and include a @samp{--ansi}, @samp{--posix}, or @samp{--compatible} option to turn them off. However, if the extension has a significant chance of breaking any real programs or scripts, then it is not really upward compatible. Try to redesign its interface. -Many GNU programs suppress extensions that conflict with POSIX if the +Many GNU programs suppress extensions that conflict with @sc{posix} if the environment variable @code{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is defined (even if it is defined with a null value). Please make your program recognize this variable if appropriate. @@ -236,9 +247,6 @@ completely with something totally different and better. (For example, feature as well. (There is a free @code{vi} clone, so we offer it.) Additional useful features not in Berkeley Unix are welcome. -Additional programs with no counterpart in Unix may be useful, -but our first priority is usually to duplicate what Unix already -has. @node Using Extensions @section Using Non-standard Features @@ -282,9 +290,16 @@ non-@sc{ansi} compilers). And if a program is already written in @sc{ansi} C, there's no need to convert it to support non-@sc{ansi} compilers. +If you don't know non-@sc{ansi} C, there's no need to learn it; just +write in @sc{ansi} C. + However, it is easy to support non-@sc{ansi} compilers in most programs, -so you might still consider doing so when you write a program. Instead -of writing function definitions in @sc{ansi} prototype form, +so you might still consider doing so when you write a program. And if a +program you are maintaining has such support, you should try to keep it +working. + +To support pre-@sc{ansi} C, instead of writing function definitions in +@sc{ansi} prototype form, @example int @@ -311,11 +326,22 @@ int foo (int, int); You need such a declaration anyway, in a header file, to get the benefit of @sc{ansi} C prototypes in all the files where the function is called. -And once you have it, you lose nothing by writing the function -definition in the pre-@sc{ansi} style. - -If you don't know non-@sc{ansi} C, there's no need to learn it; just -write in @sc{ansi} C. +And once you have the declaration, you normally lose nothing by writing +the function definition in the pre-@sc{ansi} style. + +This technique does not work for integer types narrower than @code{int}. +If you think of an argument as being of a type narrower than @code{int}, +declare it as @code{int} instead. + +There are a few special cases where this technique is hard to use. For +example, if a function argument needs to hold the system type +@code{dev_t}, you run into trouble, because @code{dev_t} is shorter than +@code{int} on some machines; but you cannot use @code{int} instead, +because @code{dev_t} is wider than @code{int} on some machines. There +is no type you can safely use on all machines in a non-@sc{ansi} +definition. The only way to support non-@sc{ansi} C and pass such an +argument is to check the width of @code{dev_t} using Autoconf and choose +the argument type accordingly. This may not be worth the trouble. @node Source Language @section Using Languages Other Than C @@ -323,13 +349,16 @@ write in @sc{ansi} C. Using a language other than C is like using a non-standard feature: it will cause trouble for users. Even if GCC supports the other language, users may find it inconvenient to have to install the compiler for that -other language in order to build your program. So please write in C. +other language in order to build your program. For example, if you +write your program in C++, people will have to install the C++ compiler +in order to compile your program. Thus, it is better if you write in C. -There are three exceptions for this rule: +But there are three situations when there is no disadvantage in using +some other language: @itemize @bullet @item -It is okay to use a special language if the same program contains an +It is okay to use another language if your program contains an interpreter for that language. For example, if your program links with GUILE, it is ok to write part of @@ -343,10 +372,14 @@ This is okay because the only people who want to build the tool will be those who have installed the other language anyway. @item -If an application is not of extremely widespread interest, then perhaps +If an application is of interest to a narrow community, then perhaps it's not important if the application is inconvenient to install. @end itemize +C has one other advantage over C++ and other compiled languages: more +people know C, so more people will find it easy to read and modify the +program if it is written in C. + @node Program Behavior @chapter Program Behavior for All Programs @@ -355,10 +388,11 @@ describes general standards for error messages, the command line interface, and how libraries should behave. @menu -* Semantics:: Writing robust programs -* Libraries:: Library behavior -* Errors:: Formatting error messages -* User Interfaces:: Standards for command line interfaces +* Semantics:: Writing robust programs +* Libraries:: Library behavior +* Errors:: Formatting error messages +* User Interfaces:: Standards for command line interfaces +* Option Table:: Table of long options. * Memory Usage:: When and how to care about memory needs @end menu @@ -371,9 +405,13 @@ all data structures dynamically. In most Unix utilities, ``long lines are silently truncated''. This is not acceptable in a GNU utility. Utilities reading files should not drop NUL characters, or any other -nonprinting characters @emph{including those with codes above 0177}. The -only sensible exceptions would be utilities specifically intended for -interface to certain types of printers that can't handle those characters. +nonprinting characters @emph{including those with codes above 0177}. +The only sensible exceptions would be utilities specifically intended +for interface to certain types of terminals or printers +that can't handle those characters. +Whenever possible, try to make programs work properly with +sequences of bytes that represent multibyte characters, using encodings +such as UTF-8 and others. Check every system call for an error return, unless you know you wish to ignore errors. Include the system error text (from @code{perror} or @@ -415,11 +453,18 @@ Try to avoid low-level interfaces to obscure Unix data structures (such as file directories, utmp, or the layout of kernel memory), since these are less likely to work compatibly. If you need to find all the files in a directory, use @code{readdir} or some other high-level interface. -These will be supported compatibly by GNU. +These are supported compatibly by GNU. -By default, the GNU system will provide the signal handling functions of -@sc{BSD} and of @sc{POSIX}. So GNU software should be written to use -these. +The preferred signal handling facilities are the BSD variant of +@code{signal}, and the @sc{posix} @code{sigaction} function; the +alternative USG @code{signal} interface is an inferior design. + +Nowadays, using the @sc{posix} signal functions may be the easiest way +to make a program portable. If you use @code{signal}, then on GNU/Linux +systems running GNU libc version 1, you should include +@file{bsd/signal.h} instead of @file{signal.h}, so as to get BSD +behavior. It is up to you whether to support systems where +@code{signal} has only the USG behavior, or give up on them. In error checks that detect ``impossible'' conditions, just abort. There is usually no point in printing any message. These checks @@ -477,6 +522,20 @@ Error messages from compilers should look like this: @var{source-file-name}:@var{lineno}: @var{message} @end example +@noindent +If you want to mention the column number, use this format: + +@example +@var{source-file-name}:@var{lineno}:@var{column}: @var{message} +@end example + +@noindent +Line numbers should start from 1 at the beginning of the file, and +column numbers should start from 1 at the beginning of the line. (Both +of these conventions are chosen for compatibility.) Calculate column +numbers assuming that space and all ASCII printing characters have +equal width, and assuming tab stops every 8 columns. + Error messages from other noninteractive programs should look like this: @example @@ -493,6 +552,12 @@ when there is an appropriate source file, or like this: @noindent when there is no relevant source file. +If you want to mention the column number, use this format: + +@example +@var{program}:@var{source-file-name}:@var{lineno}:@var{column}: @var{message} +@end example + In an interactive program (one that is reading commands from a terminal), it is better not to include the program name in an error message. The place to indicate which program is running is in the @@ -520,8 +585,10 @@ to select among the alternate behaviors. Likewise, please don't make the behavior of the program depend on the type of output device it is used with. Device independence is an -important principle of the system's design; do not compromise it -merely to save someone from typing an option now and then. +important principle of the system's design; do not compromise it merely +to save someone from typing an option now and then. (Variation in error +message syntax when using a terminal is ok, because that is a side issue +that people do not depend on.) If you think one behavior is most useful when the output is to a terminal, and another is most useful when the output is a file or a @@ -537,11 +604,11 @@ output device type. For example, we provide a @code{dir} program much like @code{ls} except that its default output format is always multi-column format. -It is a good idea to follow the @sc{POSIX} guidelines for the +It is a good idea to follow the @sc{posix} guidelines for the command-line options of a program. The easiest way to do this is to use @code{getopt} to parse them. Note that the GNU version of @code{getopt} will normally permit options anywhere among the arguments unless the -special argument @samp{--} is used. This is not what @sc{POSIX} +special argument @samp{--} is used. This is not what @sc{posix} specifies; it is a GNU extension. Please define long-named options that are equivalent to the @@ -554,26 +621,119 @@ consistent from program to program. For example, users should be able to expect the ``verbose'' option of any GNU program which has one, to be spelled precisely @samp{--verbose}. To achieve this uniformity, look at the table of common long-option names when you choose the option names -for your program. The table appears below. - -If you use names not already in the table, please send -@samp{gnu@@prep.ai.mit.edu} a list of them, with their meanings, so we -can update the table. - -It is usually a good idea for file names given as ordinary arguments -to be input files only; any output files would be specified using -options (preferably @samp{-o}). Even if you allow an output file name -as an ordinary argument for compatibility, try to provide a suitable -option as well. This will lead to more consistency among GNU -utilities, so that there are fewer idiosyncracies for users to -remember. - -Programs should support an option @samp{--version} which prints the -program's version number on standard output and exits successfully, and -an option @samp{--help} which prints option usage information on -standard output and exits successfully. These options should inhibit -the normal function of the command; they should do nothing except print -the requested information. +for your program (@pxref{Option Table}). + +It is usually a good idea for file names given as ordinary arguments to +be input files only; any output files would be specified using options +(preferably @samp{-o} or @samp{--output}). Even if you allow an output +file name as an ordinary argument for compatibility, try to provide an +option as another way to specify it. This will lead to more consistency +among GNU utilities, and fewer idiosyncracies for users to remember. + +All programs should support two standard options: @samp{--version} +and @samp{--help}. + +@table @code +@item --version +This option should direct the program to print information about its name, +version, origin and legal status, all on standard output, and then exit +successfully. Other options and arguments should be ignored once this +is seen, and the program should not perform its normal function. + +The first line is meant to be easy for a program to parse; the version +number proper starts after the last space. In addition, it contains +the canonical name for this program, in this format: + +@example +GNU Emacs 19.30 +@end example + +@noindent +The program's name should be a constant string; @emph{don't} compute it +from @code{argv[0]}. The idea is to state the standard or canonical +name for the program, not its file name. There are other ways to find +out the precise file name where a command is found in @code{PATH}. + +If the program is a subsidiary part of a larger package, mention the +package name in parentheses, like this: + +@example +emacsserver (GNU Emacs) 19.30 +@end example + +@noindent +If the package has a version number which is different from this +program's version number, you can mention the package version number +just before the close-parenthesis. + +If you @strong{need} to mention the version numbers of libraries which +are distributed separately from the package which contains this program, +you can do so by printing an additional line of version info for each +library you want to mention. Use the same format for these lines as for +the first line. + +Please do not mention all of the libraries that the program uses ``just +for completeness''---that would produce a lot of unhelpful clutter. +Please mention library version numbers only if you find in practice that +they are very important to you in debugging. + +The following line, after the version number line or lines, should be a +copyright notice. If more than one copyright notice is called for, put +each on a separate line. + +Next should follow a brief statement that the program is free software, +and that users are free to copy and change it on certain conditions. If +the program is covered by the GNU GPL, say so here. Also mention that +there is no warranty, to the extent permitted by law. + +It is ok to finish the output with a list of the major authors of the +program, as a way of giving credit. + +Here's an example of output that follows these rules: + +@smallexample +GNU Emacs 19.34.5 +Copyright (C) 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +GNU Emacs comes with NO WARRANTY, +to the extent permitted by law. +You may redistribute copies of GNU Emacs +under the terms of the GNU General Public License. +For more information about these matters, +see the files named COPYING. +@end smallexample + +You should adapt this to your program, of course, filling in the proper +year, copyright holder, name of program, and the references to +distribution terms, and changing the rest of the wording as necessary. + +This copyright notice only needs to mention the most recent year in +which changes were made---there's no need to list the years for previous +versions' changes. You don't have to mention the name of the program in +these notices, if that is inconvenient, since it appeared in the first +line. + +@item --help +This option should output brief documentation for how to invoke the +program, on standard output, then exit successfully. Other options and +arguments should be ignored once this is seen, and the program should +not perform its normal function. + +Near the end of the @samp{--help} option's output there should be a line +that says where to mail bug reports. It should have this format: + +@example +Report bugs to @var{mailing-address}. +@end example +@end table + +@node Option Table +@section Table of Long Options + +Here is a table of long options used by GNU programs. It is surely +incomplete, but we aim to list all the options that a new program might +want to be compatible with. If you use names not already in the table, +please send @email{gnu@@gnu.org} a list of them, with their +meanings, so we can update the table. @c Please leave newlines between items in this table; it's much easier @c to update when it isn't completely squashed together and unreadable. @@ -581,10 +741,7 @@ the requested information. @c a semicolon between the lists of the programs that use them, not a @c period. --friedman -Here is the table of long options used by GNU programs. - @table @samp - @item after-date @samp{-N} in @code{tar}. @@ -635,6 +792,9 @@ and @code{unexpand}. @item avoid-wraps @samp{-n} in @code{wdiff}. +@item background +For server programs, run in the background. + @item backward-search @samp{-B} in @code{ctags}. @@ -759,6 +919,9 @@ Used in @code{tar} and @code{cpio}. @item dereference-args @samp{-D} in @code{du}. +@item device +Specify an I/O device (special file name). + @item diacritics @samp{-d} in @code{recode}. @@ -891,6 +1054,11 @@ Used in @code{makeinfo}. @item force-prefix @samp{-F} in @code{shar}. +@item foreground +For server programs, run in the foreground; +in other words, don't do anything special to run the server +in the background. + @item format Used in @code{ls}, @code{time}, and @code{ptx}. @@ -1070,7 +1238,7 @@ Used in @code{su}. @item machine No listing of which programs already use this; someone should check to -see if any actually do and tell @code{gnu@@prep.ai.mit.edu}. +see if any actually do, and tell @email{gnu@@gnu.org}. @item macro-name @samp{-M} in @code{ptx}. @@ -1195,6 +1363,9 @@ Used in @code{makeinfo}. @item no-validate Used in @code{makeinfo}. +@item no-wait +Used in @code{emacsclient}. + @item no-warn Used in various programs to inhibit warnings. @@ -1246,6 +1417,10 @@ Used in GDB. @item only-time @samp{-F} in @code{gprof}. +@item options +@samp{-o} in @code{getopt}, @code{fdlist}, @code{fdmount}, +@code{fdmountd}, and @code{fdumount}. + @item output In various programs, specify the output file name. @@ -1330,6 +1505,9 @@ Used in @code{tar} and @code{cp}. @item prompt @samp{-p} in @code{ed}. +@item proxy +Specify an HTTP proxy. + @item query-user @samp{-X} in @code{shar}. @@ -1337,9 +1515,9 @@ Used in @code{tar} and @code{cp}. @samp{-q} in Make. @item quiet -Used in many programs to inhibit the usual output. @strong{Please -note:} every program accepting @samp{--quiet} should accept -@samp{--silent} as a synonym. +Used in many programs to inhibit the usual output. @strong{Note:} every +program accepting @samp{--quiet} should accept @samp{--silent} as a +synonym. @item quiet-unshar @samp{-Q} in @code{shar} @@ -1452,12 +1630,18 @@ Used by @code{recode} to chose files or pipes for sequencing passes. @item silent Used in many programs to inhibit the usual output. -@strong{Please note:} every program accepting +@strong{Note:} every program accepting @samp{--silent} should accept @samp{--quiet} as a synonym. @item size @samp{-s} in @code{ls}. +@item socket +Specify a file descriptor for a network server to use for its socket, +instead of opening and binding a new socket. This provides a way to +run, in a nonpriveledged process, a server that normally needs a +reserved port number. + @item sort Used in @code{ls}. @@ -1556,6 +1740,9 @@ Used in GDB and @code{objdump}. @item time Used in @code{ls} and @code{touch}. +@item timeout +Specify how long to wait before giving up on some operation. + @item to-stdout @samp{-O} in @code{tar}. @@ -1672,14 +1859,15 @@ This @value{CHAPTER} provides advice on how best to use the C language when writing GNU software. @menu -* Formatting:: Formatting Your Source Code -* Comments:: Commenting Your Work -* Syntactic Conventions:: Clean Use of C Constructs -* Names:: Naming Variables and Functions -* System Portability:: Portability between different operating systems +* Formatting:: Formatting Your Source Code +* Comments:: Commenting Your Work +* Syntactic Conventions:: Clean Use of C Constructs +* Names:: Naming Variables and Functions +* System Portability:: Portability between different operating systems * CPU Portability:: Supporting the range of CPU types * System Functions:: Portability and ``standard'' library functions * Internationalization:: Techniques for internationalization +* Mmap:: How you can safely use @code{mmap}. @end menu @node Formatting @@ -1808,6 +1996,13 @@ page. The formfeeds should appear alone on lines by themselves. Every program should start with a comment saying briefly what it is for. Example: @samp{fmt - filter for simple filling of text}. +Please write the comments in a GNU program in English, because English +is the one language that nearly all programmers in all countries can +read. If you do not write English well, please write comments in +English as well as you can, then ask other people to help rewrite them. +If you can't write comments in English, please find someone to work with +you and translate your comments into English. + Please put a comment on each function saying what the function does, what sorts of arguments it gets, and what the possible values of arguments mean and are used for. It is not necessary to duplicate in @@ -1862,6 +2057,11 @@ its sense}. @samp{#else} should have a comment describing the condition @dots{} #endif /* not foo */ @end group +@group +#ifdef foo + @dots{} +#endif /* foo */ +@end group @end example @noindent @@ -1875,9 +2075,13 @@ but, by contrast, write the comments this way for a @samp{#ifndef}: @dots{} #endif /* foo */ @end group +@group +#ifndef foo + @dots{} +#endif /* not foo */ +@end group @end example - @node Syntactic Conventions @section Clean Use of C Constructs @@ -2005,9 +2209,22 @@ Don't make the program ugly to placate @code{lint}. Please don't insert any casts to @code{void}. Zero without a cast is perfectly fine as a null pointer constant, except when calling a varargs function. -@node Names +@node Names @section Naming Variables and Functions +The names of global variables and functions in a program serve as +comments of a sort. So don't choose terse names---instead, look for +names that give useful information about the meaning of the variable or +function. In a GNU program, names should be English, like other +comments. + +Local variable names can be shorter, because they are used only within +one context, where (presumably) comments explain their purpose. + +Try to limit your use of abbreviations in symbol names. It is ok to +make a few abbreviations, explain what they mean, and then use them +frequently, but don't use lots of obscure abbreviations. + Please use underscores to separate words in a name, so that the Emacs word commands can be useful within them. Stick to lower case; reserve upper case for macros and @code{enum} constants, and for name-prefixes @@ -2033,10 +2250,10 @@ When you want to define names with constant integer values, use constants. Use file names of 14 characters or less, to avoid creating gratuitous -problems on older System V systems. You can use the program @code{doschk} to test for -this. @code{doschk} also tests for potential name conflicts if the -files were loaded onto an MS-DOS file system---something you may or may -not care about. +problems on older System V systems. You can use the program +@code{doschk} to test for this. @code{doschk} also tests for potential +name conflicts if the files were loaded onto an MS-DOS file +system---something you may or may not care about. @node System Portability @section Portability between System Types @@ -2066,14 +2283,10 @@ Avoid using the format of semi-internal data bases (e.g., directories) when there is a higher-level alternative (@code{readdir}). As for systems that are not like Unix, such as MSDOS, Windows, the -Macintosh, VMS, and MVS, supporting them is usually so much work that it -is better if you don't. - -The planned GNU kernel is not finished yet, but you can tell which -facilities it will provide by looking at the GNU C Library Manual. The -GNU kernel is based on Mach, so the features of Mach will also be -available. However, if you use Mach features, you'll probably have -trouble debugging your program today. +Macintosh, VMS, and MVS, supporting them is often a lot of work. When +that is the case, it is better to spend your time adding features that +will be useful on GNU and GNU/Linux, rather than on supporting other +incompatible systems. @node CPU Portability @section Portability between @sc{cpu}s @@ -2111,7 +2324,7 @@ that pass their arguments along to @code{printf} and friends: @example error (s, a1, a2, a3) char *s; - int a1, a2, a3; + char *a1, *a2, *a3; @{ fprintf (stderr, "error: "); fprintf (stderr, s, a1, a2, a3); @@ -2119,16 +2332,18 @@ error (s, a1, a2, a3) @end example @noindent -In practice, this works on all machines, and it is much simpler than any -``correct'' alternative. Be sure @emph{not} to use a prototype -for such functions. +In practice, this works on all machines, since a pointer is generally +the widest possible kind of argument, and it is much simpler than any +``correct'' alternative. Be sure @emph{not} to use a prototype for such +functions. However, avoid casting pointers to integers unless you really need to. -These assumptions really reduce portability, and in most programs they -are easy to avoid. In the cases where casting pointers to integers is -essential---such as, a Lisp interpreter which stores type information as -well as an address in one word---it is ok to do so, but you'll have to -make explicit provisions to handle different word sizes. +Outside of special situations, such casts greatly reduce portability, +and in most programs they are easy to avoid. In the cases where casting +pointers to integers is essential---such as, a Lisp interpreter which +stores type information as well as an address in one word---it is ok to +do it, but you'll have to make explicit provisions to handle different +word sizes. @node System Functions @section Calling System Functions @@ -2145,6 +2360,11 @@ Don't use the value of @code{sprintf}. It returns the number of characters written on some systems, but not on all systems. @item +@code{main} should be declared to return type @code{int}. It should +terminate either by calling @code{exit} or by returning the integer +status code; make sure it cannot ever return an undefined value. + +@item Don't declare system functions explicitly. Almost any declaration for a system function is wrong on some system. @@ -2275,13 +2495,18 @@ translations for this package from the translations for other packages. Normally, the text domain name should be the same as the name of the package---for example, @samp{fileutils} for the GNU file utilities. -To enable gettext to work, avoid writing code that makes assumptions -about the structure of words. Don't construct words from parts. Here -is an example of what not to do: +To enable gettext to work well, avoid writing code that makes +assumptions about the structure of words or sentences. When you want +the precise text of a sentence to vary depending on the data, use two or +more alternative string constants each containing a complete sentences, +rather than inserting conditionalized words or phrases into a single +sentence framework. + +Here is an example of what not to do: @example -prinf ("%d file%s processed", nfiles, - nfiles > 1 ? "s" : ""); +printf ("%d file%s processed", nfiles, + nfiles != 1 ? "s" : ""); @end example @noindent @@ -2289,8 +2514,8 @@ The problem with that example is that it assumes that plurals are made by adding `s'. If you apply gettext to the format string, like this, @example -prinf (gettext ("%d file%s processed"), nfiles, - nfiles > 1 ? "s" : ""); +printf (gettext ("%d file%s processed"), nfiles, + nfiles != 1 ? "s" : ""); @end example @noindent @@ -2298,9 +2523,9 @@ the message can use different words, but it will still be forced to use `s' for the plural. Here is a better way: @example -prinf ((nfiles > 1 ? "%d files processed" - : "%d file processed"), - nfiles); +printf ((nfiles != 1 ? "%d files processed" + : "%d file processed"), + nfiles); @end example @noindent @@ -2308,14 +2533,52 @@ This way, you can apply gettext to each of the two strings independently: @example -prinf ((nfiles > 1 ? gettext ("%d files processed") - : gettext ("%d file processed")), - nfiles); +printf ((nfiles != 1 ? gettext ("%d files processed") + : gettext ("%d file processed")), + nfiles); +@end example + +@noindent +This can be any method of forming the plural of the word for ``file'', and +also handles languages that require agreement in the word for +``processed''. + +A similar problem appears at the level of sentence structure with this +code: + +@example +printf ("# Implicit rule search has%s been done.\n", + f->tried_implicit ? "" : " not"); @end example @noindent -This can handle any language, no matter how it forms the plural of the -word for ``file.'' +Adding @code{gettext} calls to this code cannot give correct results for +all languages, because negation in some languages requires adding words +at more than one place in the sentence. By contrast, adding +@code{gettext} calls does the job straightfowardly if the code starts +out like this: + +@example +printf (f->tried_implicit + ? "# Implicit rule search has been done.\n", + : "# Implicit rule search has not been done.\n"); +@end example + +@node Mmap +@section Mmap + +Don't assume that @code{mmap} either works on all files or fails +for all files. It may work on some files and fail on others. + +The proper way to use @code{mmap} is to try it on the specific file for +which you want to use it---and if @code{mmap} doesn't work, fall back on +doing the job in another way using @code{read} and @code{write}. + +The reason this precaution is needed is that the GNU kernel (the HURD) +provides a user-extensible file system, in which there can be many +different kinds of ``ordinary files.'' Many of them support +@code{mmap}, but some do not. It is important to make programs handle +all these kinds of files. @node Documentation @chapter Documenting Programs @@ -2323,8 +2586,9 @@ word for ``file.'' @menu * GNU Manuals:: Writing proper manuals. * Manual Structure Details:: Specific structure conventions. +* License for Manuals:: Writing the distribution terms for a manual. * NEWS File:: NEWS files supplement manuals. -* Change Logs:: Recording Changes +* Change Logs:: Recording Changes * Man Pages:: Man pages are secondary. * Reading other Manuals:: How far you can go in learning from other manuals. @@ -2334,21 +2598,54 @@ word for ``file.'' @section GNU Manuals The preferred way to document part of the GNU system is to write a -manual in the Texinfo formatting language. See the Texinfo manual, -either the hardcopy, or the on-line version available through -@code{info} or the Emacs Info subsystem (@kbd{C-h i}). - -The manual should document all of the program's command-line options and -all of its commands. It should give examples of their use. But don't -organize the manual as a list of features. Instead, organize it -logically, by subtopics. Address the goals that a user will have in -mind, and explain how to accomplish them. +manual in the Texinfo formatting language. This makes it possible to +produce a good quality formatted book, using @TeX{}, and to generate an +Info file. It is also possible to generate HTML output from Texinfo +source. See the Texinfo manual, either the hardcopy, or the on-line +version available through @code{info} or the Emacs Info subsystem +(@kbd{C-h i}). + +Programmers often find it most natural to structure the documentation +following the structure of the implementation, which they know. But +this structure is not necessarily good for explaining how to use the +program; it may be irrelevant and confusing for a user. + +At every level, from the sentences in a paragraph to the grouping of +topics into separate manuals, the right way to structure documentation +is according to the concepts and questions that a user will have in mind +when reading it. Sometimes this structure of ideas matches the +structure of the implementation of the software being documented---but +often they are different. Often the most important part of learning to +write good documentation is learning to notice when you are structuring +the documentation like the implementation, and think about better +alternatives. + +For example, each program in the GNU system probably ought to be +documented in one manual; but this does not mean each program should +have its own manual. That would be following the structure of the +implementation, rather than the structure that helps the user +understand. + +Instead, each manual should cover a coherent @emph{topic}. For example, +instead of a manual for @code{diff} and a manual for @code{diff3}, we +have one manual for ``comparison of files'' which covers both of those +programs, as well as @code{cmp}. By documenting these programs +together, we can make the whole subject clearer. + +The manual which discusses a program should document all of the +program's command-line options and all of its commands. It should give +examples of their use. But don't organize the manual as a list of +features. Instead, organize it logically, by subtopics. Address the +questions that a user will ask when thinking about the job that the +program does. In general, a GNU manual should serve both as tutorial and reference. It should be set up for convenient access to each topic through Info, and for reading straight through (appendixes aside). A GNU manual should give a good introduction to a beginner reading through from the start, and should also provide all the details that hackers want. +The Bison manual is a good example of this---please take a look at it +to see what we mean. That is not as hard as it first sounds. Arrange each chapter as a logical breakdown of its topic, but order the sections, and write their @@ -2363,29 +2660,38 @@ the framework for a beginner to understand the rest of the manual. The Bison manual provides a good example of how to do this. Don't use Unix man pages as a model for how to write GNU documentation; -they are a bad example to follow. +most of them are terse, badly structured, and give inadequate +explanation of the underlying concepts. (There are, of course +exceptions.) Also Unix man pages use a particular format which is +different from what we use in GNU manuals. + +Please include an email address in the manual for where to report +bugs @emph{in the manual}. Please do not use the term ``pathname'' that is used in Unix documentation; use ``file name'' (two words) instead. We use the term -``path'' only for search paths, which are lists of file names. +``path'' only for search paths, which are lists of directory names. + +Please do not use the term ``illegal'' to refer to erroneous input to a +computer program. Please use ``invalid'' for this, and reserve the term +``illegal'' for violations of law. @node Manual Structure Details @section Manual Structure Details -The title page of the manual should state the version of the program -to which the manual applies. The Top node of the manual should also -contain this information. If the manual is changing more frequently -than or independent of the program, also state a version number for -the manual in both of these places. - -The manual should have a node named @samp{@var{program} Invocation} or -@samp{Invoking @var{program}}, where @var{program} stands for the name -of the program being described, as you would type it in the shell to run -the program. This node (together with its subnodes, if any) should -describe the program's command line arguments and how to run it (the -sort of information people would look in a man page for). Start with an -@samp{@@example} containing a template for all the options and arguments -that the program uses. +The title page of the manual should state the version of the programs or +packages documented in the manual. The Top node of the manual should +also contain this information. If the manual is changing more +frequently than or independent of the program, also state a version +number for the manual in both of these places. + +Each program documented in the manual should have a node named +@samp{@var{program} Invocation} or @samp{Invoking @var{program}}. This +node (together with its subnodes, if any) should describe the program's +command line arguments and how to run it (the sort of information people +would look in a man page for). Start with an @samp{@@example} +containing a template for all the options and arguments that the program +uses. Alternatively, put a menu item in some menu whose item name fits one of the above patterns. This identifies the node which that item points to @@ -2397,6 +2703,18 @@ quickly reading just this part of its manual. If one manual describes several programs, it should have such a node for each program described. +@node License for Manuals +@section License for Manuals + +If the manual contains a copy of the GNU GPL or GNU LGPL, or if it +contains chapters that make political or personal statements, please +copy the distribution terms of the GNU Emacs Manual, and adapt it by +modifying appropriately the list of special chapters that may not be +modified or deleted. + +If the manual does not contain any such chapters, then imitate the +simpler distribution terms of the Texinfo manual. + @node NEWS File @section The NEWS File @@ -2418,18 +2736,46 @@ Keep a change log to describe all the changes made to program source files. The purpose of this is so that people investigating bugs in the future will know about the changes that might have introduced the bug. Often a new bug can be found by looking at what was recently changed. -More importantly, change logs can help eliminate conceptual -inconsistencies between different parts of a program; they can give you -a history of how the conflicting concepts arose. +More importantly, change logs can help you eliminate conceptual +inconsistencies between different parts of a program, by giving you a +history of how the conflicting concepts arose and who they came from. + +@menu +* Change Log Concepts:: +* Style of Change Logs:: +* Simple Changes:: +* Conditional Changes:: +@end menu + +@node Change Log Concepts +@subsection Change Log Concepts -A change log file is normally called @file{ChangeLog} and covers an +You can think of the change log as a conceptual ``undo list'' which +explains how earlier versions were different from the current version. +People can see the current version; they don't need the change log +to tell them what is in it. What they want from a change log is a +clear explanation of how the earlier version differed. + +The change log file is normally called @file{ChangeLog} and covers an entire directory. Each directory can have its own change log, or a directory can use the change log of its parent directory--it's up to you. Another alternative is to record change log information with a version control system such as RCS or CVS. This can be converted automatically -to a @file{ChangeLog} file. +to a @file{ChangeLog} file using @code{rcs2log}; in Emacs, the command +@kbd{C-x v a} (@code{vc-update-change-log}) does the job. + +There's no need to describe the full purpose of the changes or how they +work together. If you think that a change calls for explanation, you're +probably right. Please do explain it---but please put the explanation +in comments in the code, where people will see it whenever they see the +code. For example, ``New function'' is enough for the change log when +you add a function, because there should be a comment before the +function definition to explain what it does. + +However, sometimes it is useful to write one line to describe the +overall purpose of a batch of changes. The easiest way to add an entry to @file{ChangeLog} is with the Emacs command @kbd{M-x add-change-log-entry}. An entry should have an @@ -2437,12 +2783,10 @@ asterisk, the name of the changed file, and then in parentheses the name of the changed functions, variables or whatever, followed by a colon. Then describe the changes you made to that function or variable. -Separate unrelated entries with blank lines. When two entries -represent parts of the same change, so that they work together, then -don't put blank lines between them. Then you can omit the file name -and the asterisk when successive entries are in the same file. +@node Style of Change Logs +@subsection Style of Change Logs -Here are some examples: +Here are some examples of change log entries: @example * register.el (insert-register): Return nil. @@ -2461,44 +2805,87 @@ Restart the tex shell if process is gone or stopped. It's important to name the changed function or variable in full. Don't abbreviate function or variable names, and don't combine them. -Subsequent maintainers will often -search for a function name to find all the change log entries that -pertain to it; if you abbreviate the name, they won't find it when they -search. For example, some people are tempted to abbreviate groups of -function names by writing @samp{* register.el -(@{insert,jump-to@}-register)}; this is not a good idea, since searching -for @code{jump-to-register} or @code{insert-register} would not find the -entry. +Subsequent maintainers will often search for a function name to find all +the change log entries that pertain to it; if you abbreviate the name, +they won't find it when they search. -There's no need to describe the full purpose of the changes or how they -work together. It is better to put such explanations in comments in the -code. That's why just ``New function'' is enough; there is a comment -with the function in the source to explain what it does. +For example, some people are tempted to abbreviate groups of function +names by writing @samp{* register.el (@{insert,jump-to@}-register)}; +this is not a good idea, since searching for @code{jump-to-register} or +@code{insert-register} would not find that entry. -However, sometimes it is useful to write one line to describe the -overall purpose of a large batch of changes. +Separate unrelated change log entries with blank lines. When two +entries represent parts of the same change, so that they work together, +then don't put blank lines between them. Then you can omit the file +name and the asterisk when successive entries are in the same file. -You can think of the change log as a conceptual ``undo list'' which -explains how earlier versions were different from the current version. -People can see the current version; they don't need the change log -to tell them what is in it. What they want from a change log is a -clear explanation of how the earlier version differed. +@node Simple Changes +@subsection Simple Changes + +Certain simple kinds of changes don't need much detail in the change +log. -When you change the calling sequence of a function in a simple -fashion, and you change all the callers of the function, there is no -need to make individual entries for all the callers. Just write in +When you change the calling sequence of a function in a simple fashion, +and you change all the callers of the function, there is no need to make +individual entries for all the callers that you changed. Just write in the entry for the function being called, ``All callers changed.'' +@example +* keyboard.c (Fcommand_execute): New arg SPECIAL. +All callers changed. +@end example + When you change just comments or doc strings, it is enough to write an -entry for the file, without mentioning the functions. Write just, -``Doc fix.'' +entry for the file, without mentioning the functions. Just ``Doc +fixes'' is enough for the change log. There's no need to make change log entries for documentation files. This is because documentation is not susceptible to bugs that are hard to fix. Documentation does not consist of parts that must interact in a precisely engineered fashion. To correct an error, you need not know -the history of the erroneous passage; it is enough to compare the -passage with the way the program actually works. +the history of the erroneous passage; it is enough to compare what the +documentation says with the way the program actually works. + +@node Conditional Changes +@subsection Conditional Changes + +C programs often contain compile-time @code{#if} conditionals. Many +changes are conditional; sometimes you add a new definition which is +entirely contained in a conditional. It is very useful to indicate in +the change log the conditions for which the change applies. + +Our convention for indicating conditional changes is to use square +brackets around the name of the condition. + +Here is a simple example, describing a change which is conditional but +does not have a function or entity name associated with it: + +@example +* xterm.c [SOLARIS2]: Include string.h. +@end example + +Here is an entry describing a new definition which is entirely +conditional. This new definition for the macro @code{FRAME_WINDOW_P} is +used only when @code{HAVE_X_WINDOWS} is defined: + +@example +* frame.h [HAVE_X_WINDOWS] (FRAME_WINDOW_P): Macro defined. +@end example + +Here is an entry for a change within the function @code{init_display}, +whose definition as a whole is unconditional, but the changes themselves +are contained in a @samp{#ifdef HAVE_LIBNCURSES} conditional: + +@example +* dispnew.c (init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent. +@end example + +Here is an entry for a change that takes affect only when +a certain macro is @emph{not} defined: + +@example +(gethostname) [!HAVE_SOCKETS]: Replace with winsock version. +@end example @node Man Pages @section Man Pages @@ -2558,9 +2945,9 @@ makes it easy to include your package into the larger framework of all GNU software. @menu -* Configuration:: How Configuration Should Work +* Configuration:: How Configuration Should Work * Makefile Conventions:: Makefile Conventions -* Releases:: Making Releases +* Releases:: Making Releases @end menu @node Configuration @@ -2633,7 +3020,7 @@ The @code{configure} script needs to be able to decode all plausible alternatives for how to describe a machine. Thus, @samp{sun3-sunos4.1} would be a valid alias. For many programs, @samp{vax-dec-ultrix} would be an alias for @samp{vax-dec-bsd}, simply because the differences -between Ultrix and @sc{BSD} are rarely noticeable, but a few programs +between Ultrix and BSD are rarely noticeable, but a few programs might need to distinguish them. @c Real 4.4BSD now runs on some Suns. @@ -2665,9 +3052,12 @@ to work with @var{package}. @c Giving an optional @var{parameter} of @c @samp{no} should omit @var{package}, if it is used by default. -Possible values of @var{package} include @samp{x}, @samp{x-toolkit}, -@samp{gnu-as} (or @samp{gas}), @samp{gnu-ld}, @samp{gnu-libc}, and -@samp{gdb}. +Possible values of @var{package} include +@samp{gnu-as} (or @samp{gas}), @samp{gnu-ld}, @samp{gnu-libc}, +@samp{gdb}, +@samp{x}, +and +@samp{x-toolkit}. Do not use a @samp{--with} option to specify the file name to use to find certain files. That is outside the scope of what @samp{--with} @@ -2734,9 +3124,9 @@ ignore most of its arguments. @node Releases @section Making Releases -Package the distribution of Foo version 69.96 in a gzipped tar file -named @file{foo-69.96.tar.gz}. It should unpack into a subdirectory -named @file{foo-69.96}. +Package the distribution of @code{Foo version 69.96} up in a gzipped tar +file with the name @file{foo-69.96.tar.gz}. It should unpack into a +subdirectory named @file{foo-69.96}. Building and installing the program should never modify any of the files contained in the distribution. This means that all the files that form @@ -2745,6 +3135,21 @@ files} and @dfn{non-source files}. Source files are written by humans and never changed automatically; non-source files are produced from source files by programs under the control of the Makefile. +The distribution should contain a file named @file{README} which gives +the name of the package, and a general description of what it does. It +is also good to explain the purpose of each of the first-level +subdirectories in the package, if there are any. The @file{README} file +should either state the version number of the package, or refer to where +in the package it can be found. + +The @file{README} file should refer to the file @file{INSTALL}, which +should contain an explanation of the installation procedure. + +The @file{README} file should also refer to the file which contains the +copying conditions. The GNU GPL, if used, should be in a file called +@file{COPYING}. If the GNU LGPL is used, it should be in a file called +@file{COPYING.LIB}. + Naturally, all the source files must be in the distribution. It is okay to include non-source files in the distribution, provided they are up-to-date and machine-independent, so that building the distribution @@ -2769,7 +3174,7 @@ Make sure that all the files in the distribution are world-readable. Make sure that no file name in the distribution is more than 14 characters long. Likewise, no file created by building the program should have a name longer than 14 characters. The reason for this is -that some systems adhere to a foolish interpretation of the POSIX +that some systems adhere to a foolish interpretation of the @sc{posix} standard, and refuse to open a longer name, rather than truncating as they did in the past. @@ -2797,6 +3202,31 @@ Leaving them out would make the distribution file a little smaller at the expense of possible inconvenience to a user who doesn't know what other files to get. +@node References +@chapter References to Non-Free Software and Documentation + +A GNU program should not recommend use of any non-free program. We +can't stop some people from writing proprietary programs, or stop other +people from using them. But we can and should avoid helping to +advertise them to new customers. + +Sometimes it is important to mention how to build your package on top of +some non-free operating system or other non-free base package. In such +cases, please mention the name of the non-free package or system in the +briefest possible way. Don't include any references for where to find +more information about the proprietary program. The goal should be that +people already using the proprietary program will get the advice they +need about how to use your free program, while people who don't already +use the proprietary program will not see anything to encourage them to +take an interest in it. + +Likewise, a GNU package should not refer the user to any non-free +documentation for free software. The need for free documentation to go +with free software is now a major focus of the GNU project; to show that +we are serious about the need for free documentation, we must not +undermine our position by recommending use of documentation that isn't +free. + @contents @bye diff --git a/man/texinfo.tex b/man/texinfo.tex index 3ce4715..c49af9f 100644 --- a/man/texinfo.tex +++ b/man/texinfo.tex @@ -1,7 +1,11 @@ % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. -% $Id: texinfo.tex,v 2.227 1998/02/25 22:54:34 karl Exp $ % -% Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 88, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98 +% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. +\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi +% +\def\texinfoversion{1999-09-25.10} +% +% Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 88, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 % Free Software Foundation, Inc. % % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or @@ -25,36 +29,44 @@ % % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug % reports; you can get the latest version from: -% ftp://ftp.cs.umb.edu/pub/tex/texinfo.tex -% /home/gd/gnu/doc/texinfo.tex on the GNU machines. -% -% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. -% Please include a precise test case in each bug report, -% including a complete document with which we can reproduce the problem. -% -% Texinfo macros (with @macro) are *not* supported by texinfo.tex. You -% have to run makeinfo -E to expand macros first; the texi2dvi script -% does this. - - -% Make it possible to create a .fmt file just by loading this file: -% if the underlying format is not loaded, start by loading it now. -% Added by gildea November 1993. -\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi +% ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo.tex +% (and all GNU mirrors, see http://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html) +% ftp://texinfo.org/tex/texinfo.tex +% ftp://us.ctan.org/macros/texinfo/texinfo.tex +% (and all CTAN mirrors, finger ctan@us.ctan.org for a list). +% /home/gd/gnu/doc/texinfo.tex on the GNU machines. +% The texinfo.tex in any given Texinfo distribution could well be out +% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. +% Texinfo has a small home page at http://texinfo.org/. +% +% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a +% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the +% problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. +% +% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the +% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple +% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: +% tex foo.texi +% texindex foo.?? +% tex foo.texi +% tex foo.texi +% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever, to process the dvi file; this makes foo.ps. +% The extra runs of TeX get the cross-reference information correct. +% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more +% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. +% +% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages. You can get +% the existing language-specific files from ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/. -% This automatically updates the version number based on RCS. -\def\deftexinfoversion$#1: #2 ${\def\texinfoversion{#2}} -\deftexinfoversion$Revision: 2.227 $ -\message{Loading texinfo package [Version \texinfoversion]:} +\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} % If in a .fmt file, print the version number % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because % they might have appeared in the input file name. -\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}\message{} +\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} % Save some parts of plain tex whose names we will redefine. - \let\ptexb=\b \let\ptexbullet=\bullet \let\ptexc=\c @@ -70,18 +82,9 @@ \let\ptexstar=\* \let\ptext=\t -% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space -% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space -% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and -% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the -% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. -{\catcode`@ = 11 - % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble - % if the definition is written into an index file. - \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M - \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } -} - +% We never want plain's outer \+ definition in Texinfo. +% For @tex, we can use \tabalign. +\let\+ = \relax \message{Basics,} \chardef\other=12 @@ -90,18 +93,47 @@ % starts a new line in the output. \newlinechar = `^^J -% Set up fixed words for English. -\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined{\gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}}\fi% -\def\putwordInfo{Info}% -\ifx\putwordSee\undefined{\gdef\putwordSee{See}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordsee\undefined{\gdef\putwordsee{see}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordfile\undefined{\gdef\putwordfile{file}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordpage\undefined{\gdef\putwordpage{page}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordsection\undefined{\gdef\putwordsection{section}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordSection\undefined{\gdef\putwordSection{Section}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordTableofContents\undefined{\gdef\putwordTableofContents{Table of Contents}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordShortContents\undefined{\gdef\putwordShortContents{Short Contents}}\fi% -\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined{\gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}}\fi% +% Set up fixed words for English if not already set. +\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi +\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi +\ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi +\ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi +\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi +\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi +\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi +\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi +\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi +\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi +\ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi +\ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi +\ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi +\ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi +\ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi +\ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi +\ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi +\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi +\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi +% +\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi +\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi +\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi +\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi +\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi +\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi +\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi +\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi +\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi +\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi +\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi +\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi +% +\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi +\ifx\putwordDeftypevar\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypevar{Variable}\fi +\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi +\ifx\putwordDeftypefun\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypefun{Function}\fi % Ignore a token. % @@ -122,30 +154,35 @@ % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. % \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% +\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined \def\loggingall{\tracingcommands2 \tracingstats2 \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1 \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen }% +\else +\def\loggingall{\tracingcommands3 \tracingstats2 + \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1 + \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1 + \tracingscantokens1 \tracingassigns1 \tracingifs1 + \tracinggroups1 \tracingnesting2 + \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen +}% +\fi % For @cropmarks command. % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. -% +% \newif\ifcropmarks \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue % % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 % -\newdimen\cornerlong \newdimen\cornerthick -\newdimen\topandbottommargin -\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize -\cornerlong=1pc\cornerthick=.3pt % These set size of cropmarks -\outerhsize=7in -%\outervsize=9.5in -% Alternative @smallbook page size is 9.25in -\outervsize=9.25in -\topandbottommargin=.75in +\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines +\newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc +\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt +\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in % Main output routine. \chardef\PAGE = 255 @@ -179,13 +216,16 @@ \shipout\vbox{% \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup \hsize = \outerhsize - \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% - \nointerlineskip - \line{% - \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% - \hfill - \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% - }% + \vskip-\topandbottommargin + \vtop to0pt{% + \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% + \nointerlineskip + \line{% + \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% + \hfill + \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% + }% + \vss}% \vskip\topandbottommargin \line\bgroup \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. @@ -203,18 +243,22 @@ \unvbox\footlinebox \fi % + \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfmkdest{\the\pageno} \fi + % \ifcropmarks \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick - \line{% - \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% - \hfill - \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% + \vbox to0pt{\vss + \line{% + \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% + \hfill + \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% + }% + \nointerlineskip + \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% }% - \nointerlineskip - \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause \fi }% end of \shipout\vbox @@ -330,11 +374,11 @@ %% Call \inENV within environments (after a \begingroup) \newif\ifENV \ENVfalse \def\inENV{\ifENV\relax\else\ENVtrue\fi} \def\ENVcheck{% -\ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment. Type Return to continue.} +\ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment; press RETURN to continue} \endgroup\fi} % This is not perfect, but it should reduce lossage % @begin foo is the same as @foo, for now. -\newhelp\EMsimple{Type to continue.} +\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} \outer\def\begin{\parsearg\beginxxx} @@ -393,7 +437,7 @@ % @@ prints an @ % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr). -\def\@{{\tt \char '100}} +\def\@{{\tt\char64}} % This is turned off because it was never documented % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures. @@ -403,8 +447,8 @@ %\def\'{{'}} % Used to generate quoted braces. -\def\mylbrace {{\tt \char '173}} -\def\myrbrace {{\tt \char '175}} +\def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}} +\def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}} \let\{=\mylbrace \let\}=\myrbrace \begingroup @@ -441,6 +485,18 @@ \fi\fi } +% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space +% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space +% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and +% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the +% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. +{\catcode`@ = 11 + % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble + % if the definition is written into an index file. + \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M + \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } +} + % @: forces normal size whitespace following. \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } @@ -538,41 +594,47 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally %% if the depth of the box does not fit. %{\baselineskip=0pt% -%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\penalty 10000 +%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak %\prevdepth=-1000pt %}} \def\needx#1{% - % Go into vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a + % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a % paragraph. \par % - % Don't add any leading before our big empty box, but allow a page - % break, since the best break might be right here. - \allowbreak - \nointerlineskip - \vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}% - % - % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the - % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the - % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider - % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the - % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. - % - % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the - % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in - % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which - % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing - % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an - % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real - % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. - \penalty9999 - % - % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. - \kern -#1\mil - % - % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. - \nobreak + % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. + \dimen0 = #1\mil + \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox + \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox + \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 + % + % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the + % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. + % And a page break here is fine. + \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% + % + % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the + % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the + % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider + % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the + % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. + % + % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the + % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in + % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which + % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing + % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an + % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real + % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. + \penalty9999 + % + % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. + \kern -#1\mil + % + % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. + \nobreak + \fi } % @br forces paragraph break @@ -583,15 +645,19 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter % font as three actual period characters. % -\def\dots{\hbox to 1.5em{% - \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil - .\hss.\hss.% - \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil -}} +\def\dots{% + \leavevmode + \hbox to 1.5em{% + \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil + .\hss.\hss.% + \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil + }% +} % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. -% +% \def\enddots{% + \leavevmode \hbox to 2em{% \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil .\hss.\hss.\hss.% @@ -602,7 +668,7 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % @page forces the start of a new page - +% \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} % @exdent text.... @@ -669,420 +735,295 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % @c is the same as @comment % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment -\def\comment{\catcode 64=\other \catcode 123=\other \catcode 125=\other% -\parsearg \commentxxx} - -\def\commentxxx #1{\catcode 64=0 \catcode 123=1 \catcode 125=2 } +\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% +\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% +\commentxxx} +{\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} \let\c=\comment -% @paragraphindent is defined for the Info formatting commands only. -\let\paragraphindent=\comment - -% Prevent errors for section commands. -% Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals. -\def\ignoresections{% -\let\chapter=\relax -\let\unnumbered=\relax -\let\top=\relax -\let\unnumberedsec=\relax -\let\unnumberedsection=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax -\let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax -\let\section=\relax -\let\subsec=\relax -\let\subsubsec=\relax -\let\subsection=\relax -\let\subsubsection=\relax -\let\appendix=\relax -\let\appendixsec=\relax -\let\appendixsection=\relax -\let\appendixsubsec=\relax -\let\appendixsubsection=\relax -\let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax -\let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax -\let\contents=\relax -\let\smallbook=\relax -\let\titlepage=\relax +% @paragraphindent NCHARS +% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. +% We cannot implement @paragraphindent asis, though. +% +\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords +\def\noneword{none} +% +\def\paragraphindent{\parsearg\doparagraphindent} +\def\doparagraphindent#1{% + \def\temp{#1}% + \ifx\temp\asisword + \else + \ifx\temp\noneword + \defaultparindent = 0pt + \else + \defaultparindent = #1em + \fi + \fi + \parindent = \defaultparindent } -% Used in nested conditionals, where we have to parse the Texinfo source -% and so want to turn off most commands, in case they are used -% incorrectly. -% -\def\ignoremorecommands{% - \let\defcodeindex = \relax - \let\defcv = \relax - \let\deffn = \relax - \let\deffnx = \relax - \let\defindex = \relax - \let\defivar = \relax - \let\defmac = \relax - \let\defmethod = \relax - \let\defop = \relax - \let\defopt = \relax - \let\defspec = \relax - \let\deftp = \relax - \let\deftypefn = \relax - \let\deftypefun = \relax - \let\deftypevar = \relax - \let\deftypevr = \relax - \let\defun = \relax - \let\defvar = \relax - \let\defvr = \relax - \let\ref = \relax - \let\xref = \relax - \let\printindex = \relax - \let\pxref = \relax - \let\settitle = \relax - \let\setchapternewpage = \relax - \let\setchapterstyle = \relax - \let\everyheading = \relax - \let\evenheading = \relax - \let\oddheading = \relax - \let\everyfooting = \relax - \let\evenfooting = \relax - \let\oddfooting = \relax - \let\headings = \relax - \let\include = \relax - \let\lowersections = \relax - \let\down = \relax - \let\raisesections = \relax - \let\up = \relax - \let\set = \relax - \let\clear = \relax - \let\item = \relax +% @exampleindent NCHARS +% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. +% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but +% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. +\def\exampleindent{\parsearg\doexampleindent} +\def\doexampleindent#1{% + \def\temp{#1}% + \ifx\temp\asisword + \else + \ifx\temp\noneword + \lispnarrowing = 0pt + \else + \lispnarrowing = #1em + \fi + \fi } -% Ignore @ignore ... @end ignore. +% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. % -\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} +\def\asis#1{#1} -% Ignore @ifinfo, @ifhtml, @ifnottex, @html, @menu, and @direntry text. +% @math means output in math mode. +% We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because control +% sequences like \math are expanded when the toc file is written. Then, +% we read the toc file back, the $'s will be normal characters (as they +% should be, according to the definition of Texinfo). So we must use a +% control sequence to switch into and out of math mode. % -\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} -\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} -\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} -\def\html{\doignore{html}} -\def\menu{\doignore{menu}} -\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} - -% Also ignore @macro ... @end macro. The user must run texi2dvi, -% which runs makeinfo to do macro expansion. Ignore @unmacro, too. -\def\macro{\doignore{macro}} -\let\unmacro = \comment +% This isn't quite enough for @math to work properly in indices, but it +% seems unlikely it will ever be needed there. +% +\let\implicitmath = $ +\def\math#1{\implicitmath #1\implicitmath} +% @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. +\def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath} +\def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath} -% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file -% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. -\let\dircategory = \comment +% @refill is a no-op. +\let\refill=\relax -% Ignore text until a line `@end #1'. +% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to +% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. +% This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). % -\def\doignore#1{\begingroup - % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. - \ignoresections - % - % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end #1'. - \long\def\doignoretext##1\end #1{\enddoignore}% - % - % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. - \catcode32 = 10 - % - % Ignore braces, too, so mismatched braces don't cause trouble. - \catcode`\{ = 9 - \catcode`\} = 9 - % - % And now expand that command. - \doignoretext +\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. +\let\novalidate = \linksfalse + +% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. +% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. +% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. +\def\setfilename{% + \iflinks + \readauxfile + \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. + \openindices + \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. + \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. + % + % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. + % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. + % Just to be on the safe side, close the input stream before the \input. + \openin 1 texinfo.cnf + \ifeof1 \let\temp=\relax \else \def\temp{\input texinfo.cnf }\fi + \closein1 + \temp + % + \comment % Ignore the actual filename. } -% What we do to finish off ignored text. +% Called from \setfilename. % -\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% +\def\openindices{% + \newindex{cp}% + \newcodeindex{fn}% + \newcodeindex{vr}% + \newcodeindex{tp}% + \newcodeindex{ky}% + \newcodeindex{pg}% +} -\newif\ifwarnedobs\warnedobsfalse -\def\obstexwarn{% - \ifwarnedobs\relax\else - % We need to warn folks that they may have trouble with TeX 3.0. - % This uses \immediate\write16 rather than \message to get newlines. - \immediate\write16{} - \immediate\write16{***WARNING*** for users of Unix TeX 3.0!} - \immediate\write16{This manual trips a bug in TeX version 3.0 (tex hangs).} - \immediate\write16{If you are running another version of TeX, relax.} - \immediate\write16{If you are running Unix TeX 3.0, kill this TeX process.} - \immediate\write16{ Then upgrade your TeX installation if you can.} - \immediate\write16{ (See ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu/TeX.README.)} - \immediate\write16{If you are stuck with version 3.0, run the} - \immediate\write16{ script ``tex3patch'' from the Texinfo distribution} - \immediate\write16{ to use a workaround.} - \immediate\write16{} - \global\warnedobstrue +% @bye. +\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} + + +\message{pdf,} +% adobe `portable' document format +\newcount\tempnum +\newcount\lnkcount +\newtoks\filename +\newcount\filenamelength +\newcount\pgn +\newtoks\toksA +\newtoks\toksB +\newtoks\toksC +\newtoks\toksD +\newbox\boxA +\newcount\countA +\newif\ifpdf +\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest + +\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined + \pdffalse + \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble + \let\pdfurl = \gobble + \let\endlink = \relax + \let\linkcolor = \relax + \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax +\else + \pdftrue + \pdfoutput = 1 + \input pdfcolor + \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% + \def\imagewidth{#2}% + \def\imageheight{#3}% + \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 + \pdfimage + \else + \pdfximage \fi -} - -% **In TeX 3.0, setting text in \nullfont hangs tex. For a -% workaround (which requires the file ``dummy.tfm'' to be installed), -% uncomment the following line: -%%%%%\font\nullfont=dummy\let\obstexwarn=\relax - -% Ignore text, except that we keep track of conditional commands for -% purposes of nesting, up to an `@end #1' command. -% -\def\nestedignore#1{% - \obstexwarn - % We must actually expand the ignored text to look for the @end - % command, so that nested ignore constructs work. Thus, we put the - % text into a \vbox and then do nothing with the result. To minimize - % the change of memory overflow, we follow the approach outlined on - % page 401 of the TeXbook: make the current font be a dummy font. - % - \setbox0 = \vbox\bgroup - % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. - \ignoresections - % - % Define `@end #1' to end the box, which will in turn undefine the - % @end command again. - \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\egroup\ignorespaces}% - % - % We are going to be parsing Texinfo commands. Most cause no - % trouble when they are used incorrectly, but some commands do - % complicated argument parsing or otherwise get confused, so we - % undefine them. - % - % We can't do anything about stray @-signs, unfortunately; - % they'll produce `undefined control sequence' errors. - \ignoremorecommands - % - % Set the current font to be \nullfont, a TeX primitive, and define - % all the font commands to also use \nullfont. We don't use - % dummy.tfm, as suggested in the TeXbook, because not all sites - % might have that installed. Therefore, math mode will still - % produce output, but that should be an extremely small amount of - % stuff compared to the main input. - % - \nullfont - \let\tenrm = \nullfont \let\tenit = \nullfont \let\tensl = \nullfont - \let\tenbf = \nullfont \let\tentt = \nullfont \let\smallcaps = \nullfont - \let\tensf = \nullfont - % Similarly for index fonts (mostly for their use in - % smallexample) - \let\indrm = \nullfont \let\indit = \nullfont \let\indsl = \nullfont - \let\indbf = \nullfont \let\indtt = \nullfont \let\indsc = \nullfont - \let\indsf = \nullfont - % - % Don't complain when characters are missing from the fonts. - \tracinglostchars = 0 - % - % Don't bother to do space factor calculations. - \frenchspacing - % - % Don't report underfull hboxes. - \hbadness = 10000 - % - % Do minimal line-breaking. - \pretolerance = 10000 - % - % Do not execute instructions in @tex - \def\tex{\doignore{tex}}% -} - -% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. -% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. -% -% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be -% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our -% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we -% didn't need it. Make sure the catcode of space is correct to avoid -% losing inside @example, for instance. -% -\def\set{\begingroup\catcode` =10 - \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR. - \parsearg\setxxx} -\def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} -\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% - \def\temp{#2}% - \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty - \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. - \fi - \endgroup -} -% Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or -% \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into -% an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'. -\def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}} - -% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. -% -\def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx} -\def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax} - -% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. -% -\def\value{\begingroup - \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR. - \valuexxx} -\def\valuexxx#1{% - \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax - {\{No value for ``#1''\}}% - \else - \csname SET#1\endcsname - \fi -\endgroup} - -% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined -% with @set. -% -\def\ifset{\parsearg\ifsetxxx} -\def\ifsetxxx #1{% - \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax - \expandafter\ifsetfail - \else - \expandafter\ifsetsucceed - \fi -} -\def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}} -\def\ifsetfail{\nestedignore{ifset}} -\defineunmatchedend{ifset} - -% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been -% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. -% -\def\ifclear{\parsearg\ifclearxxx} -\def\ifclearxxx #1{% - \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax - \expandafter\ifclearsucceed - \else - \expandafter\ifclearfail - \fi -} -\def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}} -\def\ifclearfail{\nestedignore{ifclear}} -\defineunmatchedend{ifclear} - -% @iftex, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo always succeed; we read the text -% following, through the first @end iftex (etc.). Make `@end iftex' -% (etc.) valid only after an @iftex. -% -\def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}} -\def\ifnothtml{\conditionalsucceed{ifnothtml}} -\def\ifnotinfo{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotinfo}} -\defineunmatchedend{iftex} -\defineunmatchedend{ifnothtml} -\defineunmatchedend{ifnotinfo} - -% We can't just want to start a group at @iftex (for example) and end it -% at @end iftex, since then @set commands inside the conditional have no -% effect (they'd get reverted at the end of the group). So we must -% define \Eiftex to redefine itself to be its previous value. (We can't -% just define it to fail again with an ``unmatched end'' error, since -% the @ifset might be nested.) -% -\def\conditionalsucceed#1{% - \edef\temp{% - % Remember the current value of \E#1. - \let\nece{prevE#1} = \nece{E#1}% - % - % At the `@end #1', redefine \E#1 to be its previous value. - \def\nece{E#1}{\let\nece{E#1} = \nece{prevE#1}}% - }% - \temp -} - -% We need to expand lots of \csname's, but we don't want to expand the -% control sequences after we've constructed them. -% -\def\nece#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} - -% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. -% -\def\asis#1{#1} - -% @math means output in math mode. -% We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because control -% sequences like \math are expanded when the toc file is written. Then, -% we read the toc file back, the $'s will be normal characters (as they -% should be, according to the definition of Texinfo). So we must use a -% control sequence to switch into and out of math mode. -% -% This isn't quite enough for @math to work properly in indices, but it -% seems unlikely it will ever be needed there. -% -\let\implicitmath = $ -\def\math#1{\implicitmath #1\implicitmath} - -% @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. -\def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath} -\def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath} - -\def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz} -\def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx [#1,]} -\def\nodexxx[#1,#2]{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} -\let\nwnode=\node -\let\lastnode=\relax - -\def\donoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else -\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}\fi -\global\let\lastnode=\relax} - -\def\unnumbnoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else -\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\unnumbsetref{\lastnode}\fi -\global\let\lastnode=\relax} - -\def\appendixnoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else -\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\appendixsetref{\lastnode}\fi -\global\let\lastnode=\relax} - -% @refill is a no-op. -\let\refill=\relax - -% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. -% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. -% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. -\def\setfilename{% - \readauxfile - \opencontents - \openindices - \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. - \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. - % - % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. - % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. - % Just to be on the safe side, close the input stream before the \input. - \openin 1 texinfo.cnf - \ifeof1 \let\temp=\relax \else \def\temp{\input texinfo.cnf }\fi - \closein1 - \temp - % - \comment % Ignore the actual filename. -} - -% @bye. -\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} - -% \def\macro#1{\begingroup\ignoresections\catcode`\#=6\def\macrotemp{#1}\parsearg\macroxxx} -% \def\macroxxx#1#2 \end macro{% -% \expandafter\gdef\macrotemp#1{#2}% -% \endgroup} - -%\def\linemacro#1{\begingroup\ignoresections\catcode`\#=6\def\macrotemp{#1}\parsearg\linemacroxxx} -%\def\linemacroxxx#1#2 \end linemacro{% -%\let\parsearg=\relax -%\edef\macrotempx{\csname M\butfirst\expandafter\string\macrotemp\endcsname}% -%\expandafter\xdef\macrotemp{\parsearg\macrotempx}% -%\expandafter\gdef\macrotempx#1{#2}% -%\endgroup} - -%\def\butfirst#1{} + \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi + \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi + {#1.pdf}% + \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else + \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage + \fi} + \def\pdfmkdest#1{\pdfdest name{#1@} xyz} + \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1@} + \let\linkcolor = \Cyan + \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink} + % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines + % come from Petr Olsak + \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% + \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} + \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax + \advance\tempnum by1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} + \def\pdfmakeoutlines{{% + \openin 1 \jobname.toc + \ifeof 1\else\bgroup + \closein 1 + \indexnofonts + \def\tt{} + % thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks + \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace + \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace + % + \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{} + \def\unnumbchapentry ##1##2{} + \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{\advancenumber{chap##2}} + \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2{} + \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{\advancenumber{sec##2.##3}} + \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{} + \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{\advancenumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}} + \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{} + \input \jobname.toc + \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##3}}count-\expnumber{chap##2}{##1}} + \def\unnumbchapentry ##1##2{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}} + \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##4}}count-\expnumber{sec##2.##3}{##1}} + \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}} + \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##5}}count-\expnumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}{##1}} + \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}} + \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##6}}{##1}} + \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{% + \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##2}}{##1}} + \input \jobname.toc + \egroup\fi + }} + \def\makelinks #1,{% + \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}% + \ifx\params\E + \let\nextmakelinks=\relax + \else + \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks + \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi + \picknum{#1}% + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} + goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}% + \linkcolor #1% + \advance\lnkcount by 1% + \endlink + \fi + \nextmakelinks + } + \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1} + \def\pn#1{% + \def\p{#1}% + \ifx\p\lbrace + \let\nextpn=\ppn + \else + \let\nextpn=\ppnn + \def\first{#1} + \fi + \nextpn + } + \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble} + \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first} + \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,} + \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} + \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% + \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax + \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces + \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% + \advance\filenamelength by 1 + \fi + \fi + \nextsp} + \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax} + \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 + \let \startlink \pdfannotlink + \else + \let \startlink \pdfstartlink + \fi + \def\pdfurl#1{% + \begingroup + \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}% + \leavevmode\Red + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% + user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% + % #1 + \endgroup} + \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} + \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} + \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} + \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} + \def\maketoks{% + \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS| + \ifx\first0\adn0 + \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 + \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 + \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 + \else + \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi + \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else + \let\next=\maketoks + \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} + \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi + \fi + \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi + \next} + \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% + {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} + \def\pdflink#1{% + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\mkpgn{#1}} + \linkcolor #1\endlink} + \def\mkpgn#1{#1@} + \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} +\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput \message{fonts,} - % Font-change commands. -% Texinfo supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. +% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. % So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc. \newfam\sffam \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \tensf} @@ -1148,22 +1089,17 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1} \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \bf} -% Fonts for indices and small examples (9pt). -% We actually use the slanted font rather than the italic, -% because texinfo normally uses the slanted fonts for that. -% Do not make many font distinctions in general in the index, since they -% aren't very useful. -\setfont\ninett\ttshape{9}{1000} -\setfont\indrm\rmshape{9}{1000} -\setfont\indit\slshape{9}{1000} -\let\indsl=\indit -\let\indtt=\ninett -\let\indttsl=\ninett -\let\indsf=\indrm -\let\indbf=\indrm -\setfont\indsc\scshape{10}{900} -\font\indi=cmmi9 -\font\indsy=cmsy9 +% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). +\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900} +\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000} +\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900} +\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900} +\font\smalli=cmmi9 +\font\smallsy=cmsy9 % Fonts for title page: \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3} @@ -1277,11 +1213,12 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts % Maybe make sssec fonts scaled magstephalf? -\def\indexfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\indrm \let\tenit=\indit \let\tensl=\indsl - \let\tenbf=\indbf \let\tentt=\indtt \let\smallcaps=\indsc - \let\tensf=\indsf \let\teni=\indi \let\tensy=\indsy \let\tenttsl=\indttsl - \resetmathfonts \setleading{12pt}} +\def\smallfonts{% + \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl + \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc + \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy + \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl + \resetmathfonts \setleading{11pt}} % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. % @@ -1305,13 +1242,14 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction % unless the following character is such as not to need one. \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else\/\fi\fi\fi} -\def\smartitalic#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} +\def\smartslanted#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} +\def\smartitalic#1{{\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} \let\i=\smartitalic -\let\var=\smartitalic -\let\dfn=\smartitalic +\let\var=\smartslanted +\let\dfn=\smartslanted \let\emph=\smartitalic -\let\cite=\smartitalic +\let\cite=\smartslanted \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} \let\strong=\b @@ -1329,9 +1267,9 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} } \let\ttfont=\t \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} -\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{8}{1000} -\font\smallsy=cmsy9 -\def\key#1{{\smallrm\textfont2=\smallsy \leavevmode\hbox{% +\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000} +\font\keysy=cmsy9 +\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% @@ -1341,7 +1279,9 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} +% @file, @option are the same as @samp. \let\file=\samp +\let\option=\samp % @code is a modification of @t, % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. @@ -1376,20 +1316,18 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. % -- rms. { -\catcode`\-=\active -\catcode`\_=\active -\catcode`\|=\active -\global\def\code{\begingroup \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder \codex} -% The following is used by \doprintindex to insure that long function names -% wrap around. It is necessary for - and _ to be active before the index is -% read from the file, as \entry parses the arguments long before \code is -% ever called. -- mycroft -% _ is always active; and it shouldn't be \let = to an _ that is a -% subscript character anyway. Then, @cindex @samp{_} (for example) -% fails. --karl -\global\def\indexbreaks{% - \catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash -} + \catcode`\-=\active + \catcode`\_=\active + % + \global\def\code{\begingroup + \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash + \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder + \codex + } + % + % If we end up with any active - characters when handling the index, + % just treat them as a normal -. + \global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash} } \def\realdash{-} @@ -1430,27 +1368,55 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi} -% @url. Quotes do not seem necessary, so use \code. +% For @url, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. \let\url=\code - -% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional second argument -% specifying the text to display. First (mandatory) arg is the url. -% Perhaps eventually put in a hypertex \special here. -% -\def\uref#1{\urefxxx #1,,\finish} -\def\urefxxx#1,#2,#3\finish{% - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% +\let\env=\code +\let\command=\code + +% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) +% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third +% arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url +% itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in +% a hypertex \special here. +% +\def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish} +\def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup + \unsepspaces + \pdfurl{#1}% + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt - \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% + \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that \else - \code{#1}% + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% + \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt + \ifpdf + \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it + \else + \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url + \fi + \else + \code{#1}% only url given, so show it + \fi \fi -} + \endlink +\endgroup} -% rms does not like the angle brackets --karl, 17may97. -% So now @email is just like @uref. +% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. +% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. +% %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} -\let\email=\uref +\ifpdf + \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} + \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup + \unsepspaces + \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% + \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi + \endlink + \endgroup} +\else + \let\email=\uref +\fi % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and @@ -1460,8 +1426,7 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the -% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of -% @dmn{}pt. +% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. % \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} @@ -1472,11 +1437,14 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} +% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font -% Use of \lowercase was suggested. \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font +% @acronym downcases the argument and prints in smallcaps. +\def\acronym#1{{\smallcaps \lowercase{#1}}} + % @pounds{} is a sterling sign. \def\pounds{{\it\$}} @@ -1490,15 +1458,20 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \newif\ifseenauthor \newif\iffinishedtitlepage +% Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the +% user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. +% +\newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage + \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue +\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage + \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue + \def\shorttitlepage{\parsearg\shorttitlepagezzz} \def\shorttitlepagezzz #1{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} \def\titlepage{\begingroup \parindent=0pt \textfonts \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm -% I deinstalled the following change because \cmr12 is undefined. -% This change was not in the ChangeLog anyway. --rms. -% \let\subtitlerm=\cmr12 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}% % \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines}% @@ -1547,6 +1520,23 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. \oldpage \endgroup + % + % If they want short, they certainly want long too. + \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage + \shortcontents + \contents + \global\let\shortcontents = \relax + \global\let\contents = \relax + \fi + % + \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage + \contents + \global\let\contents = \relax + \global\let\shortcontents = \relax + \fi + % + \ifpdf \pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi + % \HEADINGSon } @@ -1560,10 +1550,10 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} \let\thispage=\folio -\newtoks \evenheadline % Token sequence for heading line of even pages -\newtoks \oddheadline % Token sequence for heading line of odd pages -\newtoks \evenfootline % Token sequence for footing line of even pages -\newtoks \oddfootline % Token sequence for footing line of odd pages +\newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages +\newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages +\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages +\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages % Now make Tex use those variables \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline @@ -1681,39 +1671,23 @@ where each line of input produces a line of output.} % Subroutines used in generating headings % Produces Day Month Year style of output. -\def\today{\number\day\space -\ifcase\month\or -January\or February\or March\or April\or May\or June\or -July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi -\space\number\year} - -% Use this if you want the Month Day, Year style of output. -%\def\today{\ifcase\month\or -%January\or February\or March\or April\or May\or June\or -%July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi -%\space\number\day, \number\year} - -% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings -% It generates no output of its own - -\def\thistitle{No Title} +\def\today{% + \number\day\space + \ifcase\month + \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr + \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug + \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec + \fi + \space\number\year} + +% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. +% It generates no output of its own. +\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} \def\settitle{\parsearg\settitlezzz} \def\settitlezzz #1{\gdef\thistitle{#1}} \message{tables,} - -% @tabs -- simple alignment - -% These don't work. For one thing, \+ is defined as outer. -% So these macros cannot even be defined. - -%\def\tabs{\parsearg\tabszzz} -%\def\tabszzz #1{\settabs\+#1\cr} -%\def\tabline{\parsearg\tablinezzz} -%\def\tablinezzz #1{\+#1\cr} -%\def\&{&} - % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x), @kitem(x), @xitem(x). % default indentation of table text @@ -1757,11 +1731,6 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \itemindex{#1}% \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. % - % Be sure we are not still in the middle of a paragraph. - %{\parskip = 0in - %\par - %}% - % % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next @@ -1790,13 +1759,17 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse \else % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the - % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. Since that - % text will be indented by \tableindent, we make the item text be in - % a zero-width box. + % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. \noindent - \rlap{\hskip -\tableindent\box0}\ignorespaces% - \endgroup% - \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue% + % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in + % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and + % eventually be printed. + \nobreak\kern-\tableindent + \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 + \unhbox0 + \nobreak\kern\dimen0 + \endgroup + \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue \fi } @@ -1807,9 +1780,10 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\xitem{\errmessage{@xitem while not in a table}} \def\xitemx{\errmessage{@xitemx while not in a table}} -%% Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work +% Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work. \def\description{\tablez{\dontindex}{1}{}{}{}{}} +% @table, @ftable, @vtable. \def\table{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\tablex} {\obeylines\obeyspaces% \gdef\tablex #1^^M{% @@ -1869,7 +1843,7 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \def\itemize{\parsearg\itemizezzz} \def\itemizezzz #1{% - \begingroup % ended by the @end itemsize + \begingroup % ended by the @end itemize \itemizey {#1}{\Eitemize} } @@ -2082,46 +2056,60 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi \multitablelinespace=0pt % Macros used to set up halign preamble: -% +% \let\endsetuptable\relax \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} \let\columnfractions\relax \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} \newif\ifsetpercent -% 2/1/96, to allow fractions to be given with more than one digit. -\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {\global\advance\colcount by1 % -\expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#1\hsize}% -\setuptable} +% #1 is the part of the @columnfraction before the decimal point, which +% is presumably either 0 or the empty string (but we don't check, we +% just throw it away). #2 is the decimal part, which we use as the +% percent of \hsize for this column. +\def\pickupwholefraction#1.#2 {% + \global\advance\colcount by 1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#2\hsize}% + \setuptable +} \newcount\colcount -\def\setuptable#1{\def\firstarg{#1}% -\ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable\let\go\relax% -\else - \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions\global\setpercenttrue% +\def\setuptable#1{% + \def\firstarg{#1}% + \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable + \let\go = \relax \else - \ifsetpercent - \let\go\pickupwholefraction % In this case arg of setuptable - % is the decimal point before the - % number given in percent of hsize. - % We don't need this so we don't use it. + \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions + \global\setpercenttrue + \else + \ifsetpercent + \let\go\pickupwholefraction + \else + \global\advance\colcount by 1 + \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip }% Add a normal word space as a separator; + % typically that is always in the input, anyway. + \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% + \fi + \fi + \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction + % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so + % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. + \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% \else - \global\advance\colcount by1 - \setbox0=\hbox{#1 }% Add a normal word space as a separator; - % typically that is always in the input, anyway. - \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% + \let\go = \setuptable \fi% - \fi% -\ifx\go\pickupwholefraction\else\let\go\setuptable\fi% -\fi\go} + \fi + \go +} -% multitable syntax -\def\tab{&\hskip1sp\relax} % 2/2/96 - % tiny skip here makes sure this column space is - % maintained, even if it is never used. +% This used to have \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template line is +% not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just & until we +% encounter the problem it was intended to solve again. +% --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. +\def\tab{&} % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: - +% \def\multitable{\parsearg\dotable} \def\dotable#1{\bgroup \vskip\parskip @@ -2160,15 +2148,15 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after % the first one. - % + % % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace % to the width of each template entry. - % + % % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. - % + % % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. \rightskip=0pt \ifnum\colcount=1 @@ -2199,15 +2187,18 @@ July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi % If so, do nothing. If not, give it an appropriate dimension based on % current baselineskip. \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt +\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip +\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 %% strut to put in table in case some entry doesn't have descenders, %% to keep lines equally spaced \let\multistrut = \strut -%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of -%% table. If not, do nothing. -%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. \else +%% FIXME: what is \box0 supposed to be? \gdef\multistrut{\vrule height\multitablelinespace depth\dp0 width0pt\relax} \fi +%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of +%% table. If not, do nothing. +%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller @@ -2220,6 +2211,356 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \fi} +\message{conditionals,} +% Prevent errors for section commands. +% Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals. +\def\ignoresections{% + \let\chapter=\relax + \let\unnumbered=\relax + \let\top=\relax + \let\unnumberedsec=\relax + \let\unnumberedsection=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax + \let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax + \let\section=\relax + \let\subsec=\relax + \let\subsubsec=\relax + \let\subsection=\relax + \let\subsubsection=\relax + \let\appendix=\relax + \let\appendixsec=\relax + \let\appendixsection=\relax + \let\appendixsubsec=\relax + \let\appendixsubsection=\relax + \let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax + \let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax + \let\contents=\relax + \let\smallbook=\relax + \let\titlepage=\relax +} + +% Used in nested conditionals, where we have to parse the Texinfo source +% and so want to turn off most commands, in case they are used +% incorrectly. +% +\def\ignoremorecommands{% + \let\defcodeindex = \relax + \let\defcv = \relax + \let\deffn = \relax + \let\deffnx = \relax + \let\defindex = \relax + \let\defivar = \relax + \let\defmac = \relax + \let\defmethod = \relax + \let\defop = \relax + \let\defopt = \relax + \let\defspec = \relax + \let\deftp = \relax + \let\deftypefn = \relax + \let\deftypefun = \relax + \let\deftypeivar = \relax + \let\deftypeop = \relax + \let\deftypevar = \relax + \let\deftypevr = \relax + \let\defun = \relax + \let\defvar = \relax + \let\defvr = \relax + \let\ref = \relax + \let\xref = \relax + \let\printindex = \relax + \let\pxref = \relax + \let\settitle = \relax + \let\setchapternewpage = \relax + \let\setchapterstyle = \relax + \let\everyheading = \relax + \let\evenheading = \relax + \let\oddheading = \relax + \let\everyfooting = \relax + \let\evenfooting = \relax + \let\oddfooting = \relax + \let\headings = \relax + \let\include = \relax + \let\lowersections = \relax + \let\down = \relax + \let\raisesections = \relax + \let\up = \relax + \let\set = \relax + \let\clear = \relax + \let\item = \relax +} + +% Ignore @ignore ... @end ignore. +% +\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} + +% Ignore @ifinfo, @ifhtml, @ifnottex, @html, @menu, and @direntry text. +% +\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} +\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} +\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} +\def\html{\doignore{html}} +\def\menu{\doignore{menu}} +\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} + +% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file +% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. +\let\dircategory = \comment + +% Ignore text until a line `@end #1'. +% +\def\doignore#1{\begingroup + % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. + \ignoresections + % + % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end #1'. + % This @ is a catcode 12 token (that is the normal catcode of @ in + % this texinfo.tex file). We change the catcode of @ below to match. + \long\def\doignoretext##1@end #1{\enddoignore}% + % + % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. + \catcode32 = 10 + % + % Ignore braces, too, so mismatched braces don't cause trouble. + \catcode`\{ = 9 + \catcode`\} = 9 + % + % We must not have @c interpreted as a control sequence. + \catcode`\@ = 12 + % + % Make the letter c a comment character so that the rest of the line + % will be ignored. This way, the document can have (for example) + % @c @end ifinfo + % and the @end ifinfo will be properly ignored. + % (We've just changed @ to catcode 12.) + \catcode`\c = 14 + % + % And now expand that command. + \doignoretext +} + +% What we do to finish off ignored text. +% +\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% + +\newif\ifwarnedobs\warnedobsfalse +\def\obstexwarn{% + \ifwarnedobs\relax\else + % We need to warn folks that they may have trouble with TeX 3.0. + % This uses \immediate\write16 rather than \message to get newlines. + \immediate\write16{} + \immediate\write16{WARNING: for users of Unix TeX 3.0!} + \immediate\write16{This manual trips a bug in TeX version 3.0 (tex hangs).} + \immediate\write16{If you are running another version of TeX, relax.} + \immediate\write16{If you are running Unix TeX 3.0, kill this TeX process.} + \immediate\write16{ Then upgrade your TeX installation if you can.} + \immediate\write16{ (See ftp://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/TeX.README.)} + \immediate\write16{If you are stuck with version 3.0, run the} + \immediate\write16{ script ``tex3patch'' from the Texinfo distribution} + \immediate\write16{ to use a workaround.} + \immediate\write16{} + \global\warnedobstrue + \fi +} + +% **In TeX 3.0, setting text in \nullfont hangs tex. For a +% workaround (which requires the file ``dummy.tfm'' to be installed), +% uncomment the following line: +%%%%%\font\nullfont=dummy\let\obstexwarn=\relax + +% Ignore text, except that we keep track of conditional commands for +% purposes of nesting, up to an `@end #1' command. +% +\def\nestedignore#1{% + \obstexwarn + % We must actually expand the ignored text to look for the @end + % command, so that nested ignore constructs work. Thus, we put the + % text into a \vbox and then do nothing with the result. To minimize + % the change of memory overflow, we follow the approach outlined on + % page 401 of the TeXbook: make the current font be a dummy font. + % + \setbox0 = \vbox\bgroup + % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. + \ignoresections + % + % Define `@end #1' to end the box, which will in turn undefine the + % @end command again. + \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\egroup\ignorespaces}% + % + % We are going to be parsing Texinfo commands. Most cause no + % trouble when they are used incorrectly, but some commands do + % complicated argument parsing or otherwise get confused, so we + % undefine them. + % + % We can't do anything about stray @-signs, unfortunately; + % they'll produce `undefined control sequence' errors. + \ignoremorecommands + % + % Set the current font to be \nullfont, a TeX primitive, and define + % all the font commands to also use \nullfont. We don't use + % dummy.tfm, as suggested in the TeXbook, because not all sites + % might have that installed. Therefore, math mode will still + % produce output, but that should be an extremely small amount of + % stuff compared to the main input. + % + \nullfont + \let\tenrm=\nullfont \let\tenit=\nullfont \let\tensl=\nullfont + \let\tenbf=\nullfont \let\tentt=\nullfont \let\smallcaps=\nullfont + \let\tensf=\nullfont + % Similarly for index fonts (mostly for their use in smallexample). + \let\smallrm=\nullfont \let\smallit=\nullfont \let\smallsl=\nullfont + \let\smallbf=\nullfont \let\smalltt=\nullfont \let\smallsc=\nullfont + \let\smallsf=\nullfont + % + % Don't complain when characters are missing from the fonts. + \tracinglostchars = 0 + % + % Don't bother to do space factor calculations. + \frenchspacing + % + % Don't report underfull hboxes. + \hbadness = 10000 + % + % Do minimal line-breaking. + \pretolerance = 10000 + % + % Do not execute instructions in @tex + \def\tex{\doignore{tex}}% + % Do not execute macro definitions. + % `c' is a comment character, so the word `macro' will get cut off. + \def\macro{\doignore{ma}}% +} + +% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. +% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. +% +% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be +% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our +% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we +% didn't need it. Make sure the catcode of space is correct to avoid +% losing inside @example, for instance. +% +\def\set{\begingroup\catcode` =10 + \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR. + \parsearg\setxxx} +\def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} +\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% + \def\temp{#2}% + \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty + \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. + \fi + \endgroup +} +% Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or +% \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into +% an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'. +\def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}} + +% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. +% +\def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx} +\def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax} + +% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. +{ + \catcode`\_ = \active + % + % We might end up with active _ or - characters in the argument if + % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}. So \let any + % such active characters to their normal equivalents. + \gdef\value{\begingroup + \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 + \indexbreaks \let_\normalunderscore + \valuexxx} +} +\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} + +% We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's +% properly in indexes (we \let\value to this in \indexdummies). Ones +% whose names contain - or _ still won't work, but we can't do anything +% about that. The command has to be fully expandable, since the result +% winds up in the index file. This means that if the variable's value +% contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain it will fail +% (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work to do a +% one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). +% +\def\expandablevalue#1{% + \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax + {[No value for ``#1'']}% + \else + \csname SET#1\endcsname + \fi +} + +% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined +% with @set. +% +\def\ifset{\parsearg\ifsetxxx} +\def\ifsetxxx #1{% + \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax + \expandafter\ifsetfail + \else + \expandafter\ifsetsucceed + \fi +} +\def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}} +\def\ifsetfail{\nestedignore{ifset}} +\defineunmatchedend{ifset} + +% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been +% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. +% +\def\ifclear{\parsearg\ifclearxxx} +\def\ifclearxxx #1{% + \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax + \expandafter\ifclearsucceed + \else + \expandafter\ifclearfail + \fi +} +\def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}} +\def\ifclearfail{\nestedignore{ifclear}} +\defineunmatchedend{ifclear} + +% @iftex, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo always succeed; we read the text +% following, through the first @end iftex (etc.). Make `@end iftex' +% (etc.) valid only after an @iftex. +% +\def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}} +\def\ifnothtml{\conditionalsucceed{ifnothtml}} +\def\ifnotinfo{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotinfo}} +\defineunmatchedend{iftex} +\defineunmatchedend{ifnothtml} +\defineunmatchedend{ifnotinfo} + +% We can't just want to start a group at @iftex (for example) and end it +% at @end iftex, since then @set commands inside the conditional have no +% effect (they'd get reverted at the end of the group). So we must +% define \Eiftex to redefine itself to be its previous value. (We can't +% just define it to fail again with an ``unmatched end'' error, since +% the @ifset might be nested.) +% +\def\conditionalsucceed#1{% + \edef\temp{% + % Remember the current value of \E#1. + \let\nece{prevE#1} = \nece{E#1}% + % + % At the `@end #1', redefine \E#1 to be its previous value. + \def\nece{E#1}{\let\nece{E#1} = \nece{prevE#1}}% + }% + \temp +} + +% We need to expand lots of \csname's, but we don't want to expand the +% control sequences after we've constructed them. +% +\def\nece#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} + +% @defininfoenclose. +\let\definfoenclose=\comment + + \message{indexing,} % Index generation facilities @@ -2235,12 +2576,14 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long % for the sake of vms. - -\def\newindex #1{ -\expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname% Define number for output file -\openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\doindex {#1}} +% +\def\newindex#1{% + \iflinks + \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname + \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file + \fi + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index + \noexpand\doindex{#1}} } % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} @@ -2249,31 +2592,37 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. -\def\newcodeindex #1{ -\expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname% Define number for output file -\openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\docodeindex {#1}} +\def\newcodeindex#1{% + \iflinks + \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname + \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 + \fi + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% + \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}} } \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. -\def\synindex #1 #2 {% -\expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname -\expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\doindex {#2}}% +% The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the +% Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. +\def\synindex#1 #2 {% + \expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname + \expandafter\closeout\csname#1indfile\endcsname + \expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% define \xxxindex + \noexpand\doindex{#2}}% } % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo % inside @code. -\def\syncodeindex #1 #2 {% -\expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname -\expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo -\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex -\noexpand\docodeindex {#2}}% +\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {% + \expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname + \expandafter\closeout\csname#1indfile\endcsname + \expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo + \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% define \xxxindex + \noexpand\docodeindex{#2}}% } % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. @@ -2294,6 +2643,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} \def\indexdummies{% +\def\ { }% % Take care of the plain tex accent commands. \def\"{\realbackslash "}% \def\`{\realbackslash `}% @@ -2323,8 +2673,11 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % (Must be a way to avoid doing expansion at all, and thus not have to % laboriously list every single command here.) \def\@{@}% will be @@ when we switch to @ as escape char. -%\let\{ = \lbracecmd -%\let\} = \rbracecmd +% Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. +% But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes +% braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. +\let\{ = \mylbrace +\let\} = \myrbrace \def\_{{\realbackslash _}}% \def\w{\realbackslash w }% \def\bf{\realbackslash bf }% @@ -2335,7 +2688,6 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr}% \def\less{\realbackslash less}% \def\hat{\realbackslash hat}% -%\def\char{\realbackslash char}% \def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX}% \def\dots{\realbackslash dots }% \def\result{\realbackslash result}% @@ -2347,6 +2699,11 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright}% \def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose {##1}}% \def\code##1{\realbackslash code {##1}}% +\def\uref##1{\realbackslash uref {##1}}% +\def\url##1{\realbackslash url {##1}}% +\def\env##1{\realbackslash env {##1}}% +\def\command##1{\realbackslash command {##1}}% +\def\option##1{\realbackslash option {##1}}% \def\dotless##1{\realbackslash dotless {##1}}% \def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp {##1}}% \def\,##1{\realbackslash ,{##1}}% @@ -2362,8 +2719,16 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd {##1}}% \def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn {##1}}% \def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph {##1}}% -\def\value##1{\realbackslash value {##1}}% +\def\acronym##1{\realbackslash acronym {##1}}% +% +% Handle some cases of @value -- where the variable name does not +% contain - or _, and the value does not contain any +% (non-fully-expandable) commands. +\let\value = \expandablevalue +% \unsepspaces +% Turn off macro expansion +\turnoffmacros } % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces @@ -2420,6 +2785,12 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi %\let\tt=\indexdummyfont \let\tclose=\indexdummyfont \let\code=\indexdummyfont +\let\url=\indexdummyfont +\let\uref=\indexdummyfont +\let\env=\indexdummyfont +\let\acronym=\indexdummyfont +\let\command=\indexdummyfont +\let\option=\indexdummyfont \let\file=\indexdummyfont \let\samp=\indexdummyfont \let\kbd=\indexdummyfont @@ -2435,14 +2806,24 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % so we do not become unable to do a definition. {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other -@gdef@realbackslash{\}} + @gdef@realbackslash{\}} \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. +\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? -\let\SETmarginindex=\relax %initialize! -% workhorse for all \fooindexes -% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there -\def\doind #1#2{% +% For \ifx comparisons. +\def\emptymacro{\empty} + +% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. +% +\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}\empty} + +% Workhorse for all \fooindexes. +% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- +% \empty if called from \doind, as we usually are. The main exception +% is with defuns, which call us directly. +% +\def\dosubind#1#2#3{% % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt #2}}% @@ -2453,48 +2834,75 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage \escapechar=`\\ {% - \let\folio=0% We will expand all macros now EXCEPT \folio. + \let\folio = 0% We will expand all macros now EXCEPT \folio. \def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. % - % First process the index-string with all font commands turned off - % to get the string to sort by. - {\indexnofonts \xdef\indexsorttmp{#2}}% + \def\thirdarg{#3}% + % + % If third arg is present, precede it with space in sort key. + \ifx\thirdarg\emptymacro + \let\subentry = \empty + \else + \def\subentry{ #3}% + \fi + % + % First process the index entry with all font commands turned + % off to get the string to sort by. + {\indexnofonts \xdef\indexsorttmp{#2\subentry}}% % - % Now produce the complete index entry, with both the sort key and the - % original text, including any font commands. + % Now the real index entry with the fonts. \toks0 = {#2}% + % + % If third (subentry) arg is present, add it to the index + % string. And include a space. + \ifx\thirdarg\emptymacro \else + \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% + \fi + % + % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key + % and the original text, including any font commands. We write + % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file, texindex reduces to + % two when writing the .??s sorted result. \edef\temp{% \write\csname#1indfile\endcsname{% \realbackslash entry{\indexsorttmp}{\folio}{\the\toks0}}% }% - \temp + % + % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it + % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting + % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the + % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences + % like this: + % @end defun + % @tindex whatever + % @defun ... + % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the + % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of + % the previous defun. + % + % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We + % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. + % + % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. + % + \iflinks + \ifvmode + \skip0 = \lastskip + \ifdim\lastskip = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip-\lastskip \fi + \fi + % + \temp % do the write + % + % + \ifvmode \ifdim\skip0 = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip\skip0 \fi \fi + \fi }% }% \penalty\count255 }% } -\def\dosubind #1#2#3{% -{\count10=\lastpenalty % -{\indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage -\escapechar=`\\% -{\let\folio=0% -\def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% -% -% Now process the index-string once, with all font commands turned off, -% to get the string to sort the index by. -{\indexnofonts -\xdef\temp1{#2 #3}% -}% -% Now produce the complete index entry. We process the index-string again, -% this time with font commands expanded, to get what to print in the index. -\edef\temp{% -\write \csname#1indfile\endcsname{% -\realbackslash entry {\temp1}{\folio}{#2}{#3}}}% -\temp }% -}\penalty\count10}} - % The index entry written in the file actually looks like % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} % or @@ -2534,7 +2942,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\doprintindex#1{\begingroup \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% % - \indexfonts \rm + \smallfonts \rm \tolerance = 9500 \indexbreaks % @@ -2550,7 +2958,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure % there is some text. - (Index is nonexistent) + \putwordIndexNonexistent \else % % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof @@ -2558,7 +2966,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % it can discover if there is anything in it. \read 1 to \temp \ifeof 1 - (Index is empty) + \putwordIndexIsEmpty \else % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change @@ -2577,21 +2985,35 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. % Change them to control the appearance of the index. -% Same as \bigskipamount except no shrink. -% \balancecolumns gets confused if there is any shrink. -\newskip\initialskipamount \initialskipamount 12pt plus4pt - -\def\initial #1{% -{\let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt -\ifdim\lastskip<\initialskipamount -\removelastskip \penalty-200 \vskip \initialskipamount\fi -\line{\secbf#1\hfill}\kern 2pt\penalty10000}} +\def\initial#1{{% + % Some minor font changes for the special characters. + \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt + % + % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. + \removelastskip + % + % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. + \penalty -300 + % + % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of + % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column + % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch + % we need before each entry, but it's better. + % + % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. + \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip + \leftline{\secbf #1}% + \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip + % + % Do our best not to break after the initial. + \nobreak +}} % This typesets a paragraph consisting of #1, dot leaders, and then #2 % flush to the right margin. It is used for index and table of contents % entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. % -\def\entry #1#2{\begingroup +\def\entry#1#2{\begingroup % % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't % affect previous text. @@ -2614,12 +3036,15 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. - \hangindent=2em + \hangindent = 2em % % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line % with blank space. \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil % + % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing columns. + \vskip 0pt plus1pt + % % Start a ``paragraph'' for the index entry so the line breaking % parameters we've set above will have an effect. \noindent @@ -2644,7 +3069,11 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull % \hbox ensues. - \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph. + \ifpdf + \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. + \else + \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph. + \fi \fi% \par \endgroup} @@ -2673,24 +3102,26 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns % Grab any single-column material above us. - \output = {\global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% - % + \output = {% + % % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In - % that case, we must prevent the second \partialpage from - % simply overwriting the first, causing us to lose the page. - % This will preserve it until a real output routine can ship it - % out. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this runs and - % this will be a no-op. - \unvbox\partialpage + % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal + % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this + % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. + \ifvoid\partialpage \else + \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% + \fi % - % Unvbox the main output page. - \unvbox255 - \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip - }}% - \eject + \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% + % Unvbox the main output page. + \unvbox\PAGE + \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip + }% + }% + \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage % % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. \output = {\doublecolumnout}% @@ -2718,14 +3149,21 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) + \advance\vsize by -\ht\partialpage \vsize = 2\vsize } + +% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except +% the last. +% \def\doublecolumnout{% \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the % previous page. - \dimen@=\pageheight \advance\dimen@ by-\ht\partialpage + \dimen@ = \vsize + \divide\dimen@ by 2 + % % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \onepageout\pagesofar @@ -2734,42 +3172,67 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi } \def\pagesofar{% % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, - % followed by the two boxes we just split. + % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. \unvbox\partialpage + % \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize - \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% + \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize + \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% } \def\enddoublecolumns{% - \output = {\balancecolumns}\eject % split what we have + \output = {% + % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the + % current page, no automatic page break. + \balancecolumns + % + % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, + % though, there will be another page break right after this \output + % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not + % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal + % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be + % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes + % the output somewhat more palatable.) + \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% + }% + \eject \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns % - % Back to normal single-column typesetting, but take account of the - % fact that we just accumulated some stuff on the output page. + % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted + % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column + % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the + % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). \pagegoal = \vsize } \def\balancecolumns{% % Called at the end of the double column material. - \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% + \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. \dimen@ = \ht0 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip - \divide\dimen@ by 2 + \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to + %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% \splittopskip = \topskip % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. - {\vbadness=10000 \loop - \global\setbox3=\copy0 - \global\setbox1=\vsplit3 to\dimen@ - \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ \global\advance\dimen@ by1pt - \repeat}% + {% + \vbadness = 10000 + \loop + \global\setbox3 = \copy0 + \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ + \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ + \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt + \repeat + }% + %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% + % \pagesofar } \catcode`\@ = \other \message{sectioning,} -% Define chapters, sections, etc. +% Chapters, sections, etc. \newcount\chapno \newcount\secno \secno=0 @@ -2778,58 +3241,48 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ -\def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} - -\newwrite\contentsfile -% This is called from \setfilename. -\def\opencontents{\openout\contentsfile = \jobname.toc } +% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} +% We do the following for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual +% letter in the expansion, not just typeset. +\def\appendixletter{% + \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% + \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% + % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is + % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not + % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out + % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. + \else\char\the\appendixno + \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi + \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter. -% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise - -\def\thischapter{} \def\thissection{} -\def\seccheck#1{\ifnum \pageno<0 - \errmessage{@#1 not allowed after generating table of contents}% -\fi} - -\def\chapternofonts{% - \let\rawbackslash=\relax - \let\frenchspacing=\relax - \def\result{\realbackslash result}% - \def\equiv{\realbackslash equiv}% - \def\expansion{\realbackslash expansion}% - \def\print{\realbackslash print}% - \def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX}% - \def\dots{\realbackslash dots}% - \def\result{\realbackslash result}% - \def\equiv{\realbackslash equiv}% - \def\expansion{\realbackslash expansion}% - \def\print{\realbackslash print}% - \def\error{\realbackslash error}% - \def\point{\realbackslash point}% - \def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright}% - \def\tt{\realbackslash tt}% - \def\bf{\realbackslash bf}% - \def\w{\realbackslash w}% - \def\less{\realbackslash less}% - \def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr}% - \def\hat{\realbackslash hat}% - \def\char{\realbackslash char}% - \def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose{##1}}% - \def\code##1{\realbackslash code{##1}}% - \def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp{##1}}% - \def\r##1{\realbackslash r{##1}}% - \def\b##1{\realbackslash b{##1}}% - \def\key##1{\realbackslash key{##1}}% - \def\file##1{\realbackslash file{##1}}% - \def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd{##1}}% - % These are redefined because @smartitalic wouldn't work inside xdef. - \def\i##1{\realbackslash i{##1}}% - \def\cite##1{\realbackslash cite{##1}}% - \def\var##1{\realbackslash var{##1}}% - \def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph{##1}}% - \def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn{##1}}% -} +% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise. +\def\thischapter{} +\def\thissection{} \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raise/lowersections modify this count @@ -2901,59 +3354,59 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \fi } - +% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. \def\thischaptername{No Chapter Title} \outer\def\chapter{\parsearg\chapteryyy} \def\chapteryyy #1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz -\def\chapterzzz #1{\seccheck{chapter}% +\def\chapterzzz #1{% \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 -\global\advance \chapno by 1 \message{\putwordChapter \the\chapno}% +\global\advance \chapno by 1 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}% \chapmacro {#1}{\the\chapno}% \gdef\thissection{#1}% \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: \noexpand\thischaptername}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash chapentry{\the\toks0}{\the\chapno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash chapentry{\the\toks0}% + {\the\chapno}}}% +\temp +\donoderef \global\let\section = \numberedsec \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec -}} +} \outer\def\appendix{\parsearg\appendixyyy} \def\appendixyyy #1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz -\def\appendixzzz #1{\seccheck{appendix}% +\def\appendixzzz #1{% \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 -\global\advance \appendixno by 1 \message{Appendix \appendixletter}% +\global\advance \appendixno by 1 +\message{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}% \chapmacro {#1}{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}% \gdef\thissection{#1}% \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: \noexpand\thischaptername}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash chapentry{\the\toks0}% - {\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash chapentry{\the\toks0}% + {\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}}}% +\temp +\appendixnoderef \global\let\section = \appendixsec \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec -}} +} % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. \outer\def\centerchap{\parsearg\centerchapyyy} \def\centerchapyyy #1{{\let\unnumbchapmacro=\centerchapmacro \unnumberedyyy{#1}}} +% @top is like @unnumbered. \outer\def\top{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} + \outer\def\unnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} \def\unnumberedyyy #1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz -\def\unnumberedzzz #1{\seccheck{unnumbered}% +\def\unnumberedzzz #1{% \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 % % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the @@ -2965,155 +3418,139 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use % \the to achieve this: TeX expands \the only once, -% simply yielding the contents of the . +% simply yielding the contents of . (We also do this for +% the toc entries.) \toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}% % \unnumbchapmacro {#1}% \gdef\thischapter{#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbchapentry{\the\toks0}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbchapentry{\the\toks0}}}% +\temp +\unnumbnoderef \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec -}} +} +% Sections. \outer\def\numberedsec{\parsearg\secyyy} \def\secyyy #1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz -\def\seczzz #1{\seccheck{section}% +\def\seczzz #1{% \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % \gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash secentry % -{\the\toks0}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash secentry{\the\toks0}% + {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}}}% +\temp +\donoderef +\nobreak +} \outer\def\appendixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} \outer\def\appendixsec{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} \def\appendixsecyyy #1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz -\def\appendixsectionzzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsection}% +\def\appendixsectionzzz #1{% \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % \gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash secentry % -{\the\toks0}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash secentry{\the\toks0}% + {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}}}% +\temp +\appendixnoderef +\nobreak +} \outer\def\unnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsecyyy} \def\unnumberedsecyyy #1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz -\def\unnumberedseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsec}% +\def\unnumberedseczzz #1{% \plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsecentry{\the\toks0}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsecentry{\the\toks0}}}% +\temp +\unnumbnoderef +\nobreak +} +% Subsections. \outer\def\numberedsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsecyyy} \def\numberedsubsecyyy #1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz -\def\numberedsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{subsection}% +\def\numberedsubseczzz #1{% \gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % \subsecheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsecentry % -{\the\toks0}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsecentry{\the\toks0}% + {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}}}% +\temp +\donoderef +\nobreak +} \outer\def\appendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsecyyy} \def\appendixsubsecyyy #1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz -\def\appendixsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsubsec}% +\def\appendixsubseczzz #1{% \gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % \subsecheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsecentry % -{\the\toks0}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsecentry{\the\toks0}% + {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}}}% +\temp +\appendixnoderef +\nobreak +} \outer\def\unnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsecyyy} \def\unnumberedsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz -\def\unnumberedsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsubsec}% +\def\unnumberedsubseczzz #1{% \plainsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsubsecentry{\the\toks0}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsubsecentry% + {\the\toks0}}}% +\temp +\unnumbnoderef +\nobreak +} +% Subsubsections. \outer\def\numberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsubsecyyy} \def\numberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz -\def\numberedsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{subsubsection}% +\def\numberedsubsubseczzz #1{% \gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % \subsubsecheading {#1} {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0} - {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno} - {\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\donoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0}% + {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}}}% +\temp +\donoderef +\nobreak +} \outer\def\appendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubsecyyy} \def\appendixsubsubsecyyy #1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz -\def\appendixsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsubsubsec}% +\def\appendixsubsubseczzz #1{% \gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % \subsubsecheading {#1} {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0}% - {\appendixletter} - {\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\appendixnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{\the\toks0}% + {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}}}% +\temp +\appendixnoderef +\nobreak +} \outer\def\unnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy} \def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz -\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsubsubsec}% +\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz #1{% \plainsubsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% -{\chapternofonts% \toks0 = {#1}% -\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsubsubsecentry{\the\toks0}{\noexpand\folio}}}% -\escapechar=`\\% -\write \contentsfile \temp % -\unnumbnoderef % -\penalty 10000 % -}} +\edef\temp{\noexpand\writetocentry{\realbackslash unnumbsubsubsecentry% + {\the\toks0}}}% +\temp +\unnumbnoderef +\nobreak +} % These are variants which are not "outer", so they can appear in @ifinfo. % Actually, they should now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work. @@ -3142,8 +3579,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading -% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and -% such: +% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit % overlong headings to fold. % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a @@ -3190,12 +3626,12 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} -\def\CHAPPAGoff{ +\def\CHAPPAGoff{% \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} -\def\CHAPPAGon{ +\def\CHAPPAGon{% \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager @@ -3249,7 +3685,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\unnchfopen #1{% \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 10000 % + \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak } \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts @@ -3260,7 +3696,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\centerchfopen #1{% \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt - \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 10000 % + \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak } \def\CHAPFopen{ @@ -3313,24 +3749,45 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi } -\message{toc printing,} -% Finish up the main text and prepare to read what we've written -% to \contentsfile. +\message{toc,} +% Table of contents. +\newwrite\tocfile + +% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. +% Called from @chapter, etc. We supply {\folio} at the end of the +% argument, which will end up as the last argument to the \...entry macro. +% +% We open the .toc file here instead of at @setfilename or any other +% given time so that @contents can be put in the document anywhere. +% +\newif\iftocfileopened +\def\writetocentry#1{% + \iftocfileopened\else + \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc + \global\tocfileopenedtrue + \fi + \iflinks \write\tocfile{#1{\folio}}\fi +} \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in +\newcount\savepageno +\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 + +% Finish up the main text and prepare to read what we've written +% to \tocfile. +% \def\startcontents#1{% % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. % From: Torbjorn Granlund \contentsalignmacro - \immediate\closeout \contentsfile - \ifnum \pageno>0 - \pageno = -1 % Request roman numbered pages. - \fi + \immediate\closeout\tocfile + % % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. % It is abundantly clear what they are. \unnumbchapmacro{#1}\def\thischapter{}% + \savepageno = \pageno \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11 % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section @@ -3338,20 +3795,31 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. + % + % Roman numerals for page numbers. + \ifnum \pageno>0 \pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi } % Normal (long) toc. -\outer\def\contents{% - \startcontents{\putwordTableofContents}% - \input \jobname.toc +\def\contents{% + \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% + \openin 1 \jobname.toc + \ifeof 1 \else + \closein 1 + \input \jobname.toc + \fi + \vfill \eject + \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect + \pdfmakeoutlines \endgroup - \vfill \eject + \lastnegativepageno = \pageno + \pageno = \savepageno } % And just the chapters. -\outer\def\summarycontents{% - \startcontents{\putwordShortContents}% +\def\summarycontents{% + \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% % \let\chapentry = \shortchapentry \let\unnumbchapentry = \shortunnumberedentry @@ -3367,12 +3835,23 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{} \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{} \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{} - \input \jobname.toc + \openin 1 \jobname.toc + \ifeof 1 \else + \closein 1 + \input \jobname.toc + \fi + \vfill \eject + \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect \endgroup - \vfill \eject + \lastnegativepageno = \pageno + \pageno = \savepageno } \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents +\ifpdf + \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}% +\fi + % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. % The first argument is the chapter or section name. % The last argument is the page number. @@ -3383,7 +3862,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3{% - \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno{#3}}% + \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#3\egroup}% } % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. @@ -3391,10 +3870,14 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % We could simplify the code here by writing out an \appendixentry % command in the toc file for appendices, instead of using \chapentry % for both, but it doesn't seem worth it. -\setbox0 = \hbox{\shortcontrm \putwordAppendix } -\newdimen\shortappendixwidth \shortappendixwidth = \wd0 - +% +\newdimen\shortappendixwidth +% \def\shortchaplabel#1{% + % Compute width of word "Appendix", may change with language. + \setbox0 = \hbox{\shortcontrm \putwordAppendix}% + \shortappendixwidth = \wd0 + % % We typeset #1 in a box of constant width, regardless of the text of % #1, so the chapter titles will come out aligned. \setbox0 = \hbox{#1}% @@ -3409,7 +3892,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi } \def\unnumbchapentry#1#2{\dochapentry{#1}{#2}} -\def\shortunnumberedentry#1#2{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno{#2}}} +\def\shortunnumberedentry#1#2{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#2\egroup}} % Sections. \def\secentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2.#3\labelspace#1}{#4}} @@ -3436,24 +3919,24 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip \begingroup \chapentryfonts - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip } \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup} \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup} \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}% + \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% \endgroup} % Final typesetting of a toc entry; we use the same \entry macro as for @@ -3481,6 +3964,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \message{environments,} +% @foo ... @end foo. % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. @@ -3553,6 +4037,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \let\!=\ptexexclam \let\i=\ptexi \let\{=\ptexlbrace + \let\+=\tabalign \let\}=\ptexrbrace \let\*=\ptexstar \let\t=\ptext @@ -3604,8 +4089,8 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins. \let\nonarrowing=\relax -%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% -% \cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around argument +% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around +% environment contents. \font\circle=lcircle10 \newdimen\circthick \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner @@ -3632,9 +4117,9 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip \advance\cartinner by-\rskip \cartouter=\hsize - \advance\cartouter by 18pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either + \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either % side, and for 6pt waste from -% each corner char +% each corner char, and rule thickness \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. \let\nonarrowing=\comment @@ -3688,49 +4173,52 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \fi } -% To ending an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph -% (via \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we -% keep the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue -% will be inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the -% document, after the environment. +% Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the particular +% environment, so the error checking in \end will work. % -\def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% +% To end an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph (via +% \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we keep +% the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue will be +% inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the document, after +% the environment. +% +\def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup} +% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font. \def\lisp{\begingroup \nonfillstart \let\Elisp = \nonfillfinish \tt - % Make @kbd do something special, if requested. - \let\kbdfont\kbdexamplefont - \rawbackslash % have \ input char produce \ char from current font - \gobble + \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. + \gobble % eat return } -% Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the -% environment, so the error checking in \end will work. -% -% We must call \lisp last in the definition, since it reads the -% return following the @example (or whatever) command. -% +% @example: Same as @lisp. \def\example{\begingroup \def\Eexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} -\def\smallexample{\begingroup \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} -\def\smalllisp{\begingroup \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} -% @smallexample and @smalllisp. This is not used unless the @smallbook -% command is given. Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. +% @small... is usually equivalent to the non-small (@smallbook +% redefines). We must call \example (or whatever) last in the +% definition, since it reads the return following the @example (or +% whatever) command. +% +% This actually allows (for example) @end display inside an +% @smalldisplay. Too bad, but makeinfo will catch the error anyway. % +\def\smalldisplay{\begingroup\def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\display} +\def\smallexample{\begingroup\def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} +\def\smallformat{\begingroup\def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format} +\def\smalllisp{\begingroup\def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} + +% Real @smallexample and @smalllisp (when @smallbook): use smaller fonts. +% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. \def\smalllispx{\begingroup - \nonfillstart - \let\Esmalllisp = \nonfillfinish - \let\Esmallexample = \nonfillfinish - % - % Smaller fonts for small examples. - \indexfonts \tt - \rawbackslash % make \ output the \ character from the current font (tt) - \gobble + \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \smallfonts + \lisp } -% This is @display; same as @lisp except use roman font. +% @display: same as @lisp except keep current font. % \def\display{\begingroup \nonfillstart @@ -3738,7 +4226,15 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \gobble } -% This is @format; same as @display except don't narrow margins. +% @smalldisplay (when @smallbook): @display plus smaller fonts. +% +\def\smalldisplayx{\begingroup + \def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \smallfonts \rm + \display +} + +% @format: same as @display except don't narrow margins. % \def\format{\begingroup \let\nonarrowing = t @@ -3747,20 +4243,27 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \gobble } -% @flushleft (same as @format) and @flushright. +% @smallformat (when @smallbook): @format plus smaller fonts. % -\def\flushleft{\begingroup - \let\nonarrowing = t - \nonfillstart - \let\Eflushleft = \nonfillfinish - \gobble +\def\smallformatx{\begingroup + \def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% + \smallfonts \rm + \format } + +% @flushleft (same as @format). +% +\def\flushleft{\begingroup \def\Eflushleft{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format} + +% @flushright. +% \def\flushright{\begingroup \let\nonarrowing = t \nonfillstart \let\Eflushright = \nonfillfinish \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill - \gobble} + \gobble +} % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) % and narrows the margins. @@ -3783,9 +4286,11 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \fi } + \message{defuns,} -% Define formatter for defuns -% First, allow user to change definition object font (\df) internally +% @defun etc. + +% Allow user to change definition object font (\df) internally \def\setdeffont #1 {\csname DEF#1\endcsname} \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in @@ -3839,10 +4344,16 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi %% contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] \def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}\global\advance\parencount by 1 } \def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}\global\advance\parencount by -1 } -\def\ampnr{\&} +\let\ampnr = \& \def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}} \def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}} +% Active &'s sneak into the index arguments, so make sure it's defined. +{ + \catcode`& = 13 + \global\let& = \ampnr +} + % First, defname, which formats the header line itself. % #1 should be the function name. % #2 should be the type of definition, such as "Function". @@ -3852,20 +4363,18 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % outside the @def... \dimen2=\leftskip \advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent -\dimen3=\rightskip -\advance\dimen3 by -\defbodyindent -\noindent % +\noindent \setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}% \dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0 % compute size for first line \dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent %size for continuations -\parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1 % +\parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1 % Now output arg 2 ("Function" or some such) % ending at \deftypemargin from the right margin, % but stuck inside a box of width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking {% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins, % so that \rightline will obey them. -\advance \hsize by -\dimen2 \advance \hsize by -\dimen3 -\rlap{\rightline{{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}}}% +\advance \hsize by -\dimen2 +\rlap{\rightline{{\rm #2}\hskip -1.25pc }}}% % Make all lines underfull and no complaints: \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent @@ -3886,23 +4395,62 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% \def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3}% \parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent +\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \exdentamount=\defbodyindent \begingroup % \catcode 61=\active % 61 is `=' \obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3} -\def\defmethparsebody #1#2#3#4 {\begingroup\inENV % +% #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define). +% #2 is the \...x control sequence for consecutive fns (which we define). +% #3 is the control sequence to call to resume processing. +% #4, delimited by the space, is the class name. +% +\def\defmethparsebody#1#2#3#4 {\begingroup\inENV % \medbreak % % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies % so that it will exit this group. \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% \def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% \parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent +\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \exdentamount=\defbodyindent \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}}} +% Used for @deftypemethod and @deftypeivar. +% #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define). +% #2 is the \...x control sequence for consecutive fns (which we define). +% #3 is the control sequence to call to resume processing. +% #4, delimited by a space, is the class name. +% #5 is the method's return type. +% +\def\deftypemethparsebody#1#2#3#4 #5 {\begingroup\inENV + \medbreak + \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% + \def#2##1 ##2 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}{##2}}}% + \parindent=0in + \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent + \exdentamount=\defbodyindent + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}{#5}}} + +% Used for @deftypeop. The change from \deftypemethparsebody is an +% extra argument at the beginning which is the `category', instead of it +% being the hardwired string `Method' or `Instance Variable'. We have +% to account for this both in the \...x definition and in parsing the +% input at hand. Thus also need a control sequence (passed as #5) for +% the \E... definition to assign the category name to. +% +\def\deftypeopparsebody#1#2#3#4#5 #6 {\begingroup\inENV + \medbreak + \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% + \def#2##1 ##2 ##3 {% + \def#4{##1}% + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}{##3}}}% + \parindent=0in + \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent + \exdentamount=\defbodyindent + \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}{#6}}} + \def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV % \medbreak % % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies @@ -3911,7 +4459,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% \parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent +\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \exdentamount=\defbodyindent \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}}} @@ -3926,7 +4474,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% \def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit#3}% \parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent +\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \exdentamount=\defbodyindent \begingroup % \catcode 61=\active % @@ -3943,7 +4491,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% \def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% \parindent=0in - \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent + \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \exdentamount=\defbodyindent \begingroup\obeylines } @@ -3988,7 +4536,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% \begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% \parindent=0in -\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent +\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \exdentamount=\defbodyindent \begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{#5}}} @@ -4012,16 +4560,17 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of \defun % Use this to expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up -\def\defunargs #1{\functionparens \sl +\def\defunargs#1{\functionparens \sl % Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars. % Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar. -\hyphenchar\tensl=0 +% Set the font temporarily and use \font in case \setfont made \tensl a macro. +{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=0}% #1% -\hyphenchar\tensl=45 +{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=45}% \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}\fi% \interlinepenalty=10000 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000% +\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak } \def\deftypefunargs #1{% @@ -4032,7 +4581,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \tclose{#1}% avoid \code because of side effects on active chars \interlinepenalty=10000 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000% +\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak } % Do complete processing of one @defun or @defunx line already parsed. @@ -4051,7 +4600,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\defun{\defparsebody\Edefun\defunx\defunheader} \def\defunheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Function}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDeffunc}% \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } @@ -4065,7 +4614,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % #1 is the data type, #2 the name, #3 the args. \def\deftypefunheaderx #1#2 #3\relax{% \doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{Function}% +\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{\putwordDeftypefun}% \deftypefunargs {#3}\endgroup % \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } @@ -4096,7 +4645,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\defmac{\defparsebody\Edefmac\defmacx\defmacheader} \def\defmacheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Macro}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefmac}% \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } @@ -4106,53 +4655,77 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\defspec{\defparsebody\Edefspec\defspecx\defspecheader} \def\defspecheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Special Form}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefspec}% \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % \catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody } -% This definition is run if you use @defunx -% anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx. - -\def\deffnx #1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}} -\def\defunx #1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}} -\def\defmacx #1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}} -\def\defspecx #1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypefnx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypemethodx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypemethodx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypeunx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypeunx in invalid context}} - -% @defmethod, and so on - -% @defop {Funny Method} foo-class frobnicate argument - +% @defop CATEGORY CLASS OPERATION ARG... +% \def\defop #1 {\def\defoptype{#1}% \defopparsebody\Edefop\defopx\defopheader\defoptype} - -\def\defopheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{on #1}% Make entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defoptype{} on #1}% +% +\def\defopheader#1#2#3{% +\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ #1}% Make entry in function index +\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defoptype\ \putwordon\ #1}% \defunargs {#3}\endgroup % } -% @deftypemethod foo-class return-type foo-method args +% @deftypeop CATEGORY CLASS TYPE OPERATION ARG... +% +\def\deftypeop #1 {\def\deftypeopcategory{#1}% + \deftypeopparsebody\Edeftypeop\deftypeopx\deftypeopheader + \deftypeopcategory} +% +% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the operation name, #4 the args. +\def\deftypeopheader#1#2#3#4{% + \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index + \begingroup + \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3} + {\deftypeopcategory\ \putwordon\ \code{#1}}% + \deftypefunargs{#4}% + \endgroup +} + +% @deftypemethod CLASS TYPE METHOD ARG... % \def\deftypemethod{% - \defmethparsebody\Edeftypemethod\deftypemethodx\deftypemethodheader} + \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypemethod\deftypemethodx\deftypemethodheader} % % #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the method name, #4 the args. \def\deftypemethodheader#1#2#3#4{% - \deftypefnheaderx{Method on #1}{#2}#3 #4\relax + \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index + \begingroup + \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% + \deftypefunargs{#4}% + \endgroup } -% @defmethod == @defop Method +% @deftypeivar CLASS TYPE VARNAME +% +\def\deftypeivar{% + \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypeivar\deftypeivarx\deftypeivarheader} +% +% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the variable name. +\def\deftypeivarheader#1#2#3{% + \dosubind{vr}{\code{#3}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in variable index + \begingroup + \defname{#3}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ \code{#1}}% + \defvarargs{#3}% + \endgroup +} +% @defmethod == @defop Method +% \def\defmethod{\defmethparsebody\Edefmethod\defmethodx\defmethodheader} - -\def\defmethodheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{on #1}% entry in function index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{Method on #1}% -\defunargs {#3}\endgroup % +% +% #1 is the class name, #2 the method name, #3 the args. +\def\defmethodheader#1#2#3{% + \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index + \begingroup + \defname{#2}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% + \defunargs{#3}% + \endgroup } % @defcv {Class Option} foo-class foo-flag @@ -4161,37 +4734,30 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \defopvarparsebody\Edefcv\defcvx\defcvarheader\defcvtype} \def\defcvarheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{of #1}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defcvtype{} of #1}% +\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ #1}% Make entry in var index +\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defcvtype\ \putwordof\ #1}% \defvarargs {#3}\endgroup % } -% @defivar == @defcv {Instance Variable} - +% @defivar CLASS VARNAME == @defcv {Instance Variable} CLASS VARNAME +% \def\defivar{\defvrparsebody\Edefivar\defivarx\defivarheader} - -\def\defivarheader #1#2#3{% -\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{of #1}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#2}{Instance Variable of #1}% -\defvarargs {#3}\endgroup % +% +\def\defivarheader#1#2#3{% + \dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ #1}% entry in var index + \begingroup + \defname{#2}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ #1}% + \defvarargs{#3}% + \endgroup } -% These definitions are run if you use @defmethodx, etc., -% anywhere other than immediately after a @defmethod, etc. - -\def\defopx #1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}} -\def\defmethodx #1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}} -\def\defcvx #1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}} -\def\defivarx #1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}} - -% Now @defvar - +% @defvar % First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of @defvar. % This is actually simple: just print them in roman. % This must expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up \def\defvarargs #1{\normalparens #1% \interlinepenalty=10000 -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000} +\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak} % @defvr Counter foo-count @@ -4205,7 +4771,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\defvar{\defvarparsebody\Edefvar\defvarx\defvarheader} \def\defvarheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{Variable}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefvar}% \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % } @@ -4214,7 +4780,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\defopt{\defvarparsebody\Edefopt\defoptx\defoptheader} \def\defoptheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index -\begingroup\defname {#1}{User Option}% +\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefopt}% \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % } @@ -4226,9 +4792,9 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % is actually part of the data type, which should not be put into the index. \def\deftypevarheader #1#2{% \dovarind#2 \relax% Make entry in variables index -\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{Variable}% +\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{\putwordDeftypevar}% \interlinepenalty=10000 -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000 +\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak \endgroup} \def\dovarind#1 #2\relax{\doind{vr}{\code{#1}}} @@ -4239,18 +4805,9 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\dovarind#3 \relax% \begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{#1} \interlinepenalty=10000 -\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000 +\endgraf\nobreak\vskip -\parskip\nobreak \endgroup} -% This definition is run if you use @defvarx -% anywhere other than immediately after a @defvar or @defvarx. - -\def\defvrx #1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}} -\def\defvarx #1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}} -\def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypevarx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}} -\def\deftypevrx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}} - % Now define @deftp % Args are printed in bold, a slight difference from @defvar. @@ -4263,51 +4820,394 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\deftpheader #1#2#3{\doind {tp}{\code{#2}}% \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\deftpargs{#3}\endgroup} -% This definition is run if you use @deftpx, etc -% anywhere other than immediately after a @deftp, etc. +% These definitions are used if you use @defunx (etc.) +% anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx. +% +\def\defcvx#1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}} +\def\deffnx#1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}} +\def\defivarx#1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}} +\def\defmacx#1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}} +\def\defmethodx#1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}} +\def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}} +\def\defopx#1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}} +\def\defspecx#1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}} +\def\deftpx#1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypefnx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypefunx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefunx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypeivarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeivarx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypemethodx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypemethodx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypeopx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeopx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypevarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}} +\def\deftypevrx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}} +\def\defunx#1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}} +\def\defvarx#1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}} +\def\defvrx#1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}} + + +\message{macros,} +% @macro. + +% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, +% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. +\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined + \newwrite\macscribble + \def\scanmacro#1{% + \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M + % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex + \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=12 \escapechar=`\@ + % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline. + \toks0={#1\endinput}% + \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp + \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% + \immediate\closeout\macscribble + \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces + \input \jobname.tmp + \endgroup +} +\else +\def\scanmacro#1{% +\begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M +% Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex +\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=12 \escapechar=`\@ +\let\xeatspaces\eatspaces\scantokens{#1\endinput}\endgroup} +\fi + +\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters +\newtoks\macname % Macro name +\newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? +\def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form + % \do\macro1\do\macro2... + +% Utility routines. +% Thisdoes \let #1 = #2, except with \csnames. +\def\cslet#1#2{% +\expandafter\expandafter +\expandafter\let +\expandafter\expandafter +\csname#1\endcsname +\csname#2\endcsname} + +% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. +% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). +{\catcode`\@=11 +\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} +\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} +\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} +\def\unbrace#1{#1} +\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} +} + +% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. +{\catcode`\^^M=12\catcode`\Q=3% +\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% +\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% +\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% +} + +% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where +% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active +% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \. + +% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is +% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro +% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. + +\def\macrobodyctxt{% + \catcode`\~=12 + \catcode`\^=12 + \catcode`\_=12 + \catcode`\|=12 + \catcode`\<=12 + \catcode`\>=12 + \catcode`\+=12 + \catcode`\{=12 + \catcode`\}=12 + \catcode`\@=12 + \catcode`\^^M=12 + \usembodybackslash} + +\def\macroargctxt{% + \catcode`\~=12 + \catcode`\^=12 + \catcode`\_=12 + \catcode`\|=12 + \catcode`\<=12 + \catcode`\>=12 + \catcode`\+=12 + \catcode`\@=12 + \catcode`\\=12} + +% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. +% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N +% where N is the macro parameter number. +% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so +% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. + +{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active + @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} + @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} +} +\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} + +\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} +\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} + +\def\macroxxx#1{% + \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist + \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments + \paramno=0% + \else + \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% + \fi + \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname + \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% + \else + \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax + \else \errmessage{The name \the\macname\space is reserved}\fi + \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% + \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% + % Add the macroname to \macrolist + \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}% + \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0 + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}% + \fi + \begingroup \macrobodyctxt + \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody + \else \expandafter\parsemacbody + \fi} + +\def\unmacro{\parsearg\unmacroxxx} +\def\unmacroxxx#1{% + \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname + \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% + \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% + % Remove the macro name from \macrolist + \begingroup + \edef\tempa{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}% + \def\do##1{% + \def\tempb{##1}% + \ifx\tempa\tempb + % remove this + \else + \toks0 = \expandafter{\newmacrolist\do}% + \edef\newmacrolist{\the\toks0\expandafter\noexpand\tempa}% + \fi}% + \def\newmacrolist{}% + % Execute macro list to define \newmacrolist + \macrolist + \global\let\macrolist\newmacrolist + \endgroup + \else + \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% + \fi +} + +% This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a +% is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by +% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. +\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} +\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} +\def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} +\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} + +% Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist +% so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah +% in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list. +% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). + +% We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. +% The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something +% unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine +% it to # just before using the token list produced. +% +% The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before +% the macro is used. + +\def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% + \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,} +\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% + \if#1;\let\next=\relax + \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx + \advance\paramno by 1% + \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname + {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% + \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% + \fi\next} + +% These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. +% (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) + +\long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% +{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% +\long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% +{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% + +% This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and +% nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments. +% Much magic with \expandafter here. +% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file +% they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. +\def\defmacro{% + \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars + \ifrecursive + \ifcase\paramno + % 0 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% + \or % 1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \noexpand\braceorline + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% + \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% + \else % many + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% + \expandafter\expandafter + \expandafter\xdef + \expandafter\expandafter + \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname + \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% + \fi + \else + \ifcase\paramno + % 0 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% + \or % 1 + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \noexpand\braceorline + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% + \egroup + \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% + \else % many + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% + \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% + \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% + \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% + \expandafter\expandafter + \expandafter\xdef + \expandafter\expandafter + \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname + \paramlist{% + \egroup + \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% + \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% + \fi + \fi} + +\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} + +% \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a +% {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole +% line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence +% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg) +\def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} +\def\braceorlinexxx{% + \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else + \expandafter\parsearg + \fi \next} + +% We mant to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not +% expanded by \write. +\def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}% + \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next} + + +% @alias. +% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal +% sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing. +\def\alias{\begingroup\obeyspaces\parsearg\aliasxxx} +\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} +\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{\ignoreactivespaces +\edef\next{\global\let\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname=% + \expandafter\noexpand\csname#2\endcsname}% +\expandafter\endgroup\next} -\def\deftpx #1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}} +\message{cross references,} +% @xref etc. -\message{cross reference,} -% Define cross-reference macros -\newwrite \auxfile +\newwrite\auxfile -\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. +\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. -% @inforef is simple. +% @inforef is relatively simple. \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} -% \setref{foo} defines a cross-reference point named foo. +% @node's job is to define \lastnode. +\def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz} +\def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx [#1,]} +\def\nodexxx[#1,#2]{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} +\let\nwnode=\node +\let\lastnode=\relax -\def\setref#1{% -\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% -\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% -\dosetq{#1-snt}{Ysectionnumberandtype}} +% The sectioning commands (@chapter, etc.) call these. +\def\donoderef{% + \ifx\lastnode\relax\else + \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}% + {Ysectionnumberandtype}% + \global\let\lastnode=\relax + \fi +} +\def\unnumbnoderef{% + \ifx\lastnode\relax\else + \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}{Ynothing}% + \global\let\lastnode=\relax + \fi +} +\def\appendixnoderef{% + \ifx\lastnode\relax\else + \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}% + {Yappendixletterandtype}% + \global\let\lastnode=\relax + \fi +} -\def\unnumbsetref#1{% -\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% -\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% -\dosetq{#1-snt}{Ynothing}} -\def\appendixsetref#1{% -\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% -\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% -\dosetq{#1-snt}{Yappendixletterandtype}} +% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. +% +\newcount\savesfregister +\gdef\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} +\gdef\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} +\gdef\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} + +% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME, namely +% NAME-title, NAME-pg, and NAME-SNT. Called from \foonoderef. We have +% to set \indexdummies so commands such as @code in a section title +% aren't expanded. It would be nicer not to expand the titles in the +% first place, but there's so many layers that that is hard to do. +% +\def\setref#1#2{{% + \indexdummies + \pdfmkdest{#1}% + \dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% + \dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% + \dosetq{#1-snt}{#2}% +}} -% \xref, \pxref, and \ref generate cross-references to specified points. -% For \xrefX, #1 is the node name, #2 the name of the Info -% cross-reference, #3 the printed node name, #4 the name of the Info -% file, #5 the name of the printed manual. All but the node name can be -% omitted. +% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is +% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed +% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed +% manual. All but the node name can be omitted. % \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup + \unsepspaces \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #3}% \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual}% @@ -4320,7 +5220,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \else % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it. - \ifdim \wd1>0pt% + \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt % It is in another manual, so we don't have it. \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% \else @@ -4341,27 +5241,54 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. + \ifpdf + \leavevmode + \getfilename{#4}% + \ifnum\filenamelength>0 + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% + goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1@}% + \else + \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% + goto name{#1@}% + \fi + \linkcolor + \fi + % \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt - \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' in \cite{\printedmanual}% + \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% \else % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. - {\turnoffactive \refx{#1-snt}{}}% - \space [\printednodename],\space + {\normalturnoffactive + % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for + % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. + \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% + \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi + }% + % [mynode], + [\printednodename],\space + % page 3 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% \fi + \endlink \endgroup} % \dosetq is the interface for calls from other macros -% Use \turnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore -% work in node names. -\def\dosetq #1#2{{\let\folio=0 \turnoffactive -\edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq {#1}{#2}}}% -\next}} +% Use \normalturnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore +% and backslash work in node names. (\turnoffactive doesn't do \.) +\def\dosetq#1#2{% + {\let\folio=0% + \normalturnoffactive + \edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq{#1}{#2}}}% + \iflinks + \next + \fi + }% +} % \internalsetq {foo}{page} expands into % CHARACTERS 'xrdef {foo}{...expansion of \Ypage...} @@ -4413,12 +5340,14 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \expandafter\ifx\csname X#1\endcsname\relax % If not defined, say something at least. \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright - \ifhavexrefs - \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% - \else - \ifwarnedxrefs\else - \global\warnedxrefstrue - \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% + \iflinks + \ifhavexrefs + \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% + \else + \ifwarnedxrefs\else + \global\warnedxrefstrue + \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% + \fi \fi \fi \else @@ -4429,7 +5358,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi } % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. -% +% \def\xrdef#1{\begingroup % Reenable \ as an escape while reading the second argument. \catcode`\\ = 0 @@ -4492,8 +5421,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \catcode`\$=\other \catcode`\#=\other \catcode`\&=\other - % `\+ does not work, so use 43. - \catcode43=\other + \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters {% \count 1=128 @@ -4582,6 +5510,8 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \xspaceskip\z@skip \parindent\defaultparindent % + \smallfonts \rm + % % Hang the footnote text off the number. \hang \textindent{\thisfootno}% @@ -4596,7 +5526,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \else\let\next\f@t\fi \next} \def\f@@t{\bgroup\aftergroup\@foot\let\next} \def\f@t#1{#1\@foot} -\def\@foot{\strut\egroup} +\def\@foot{\strut\par\egroup} }%end \catcode `\@=11 @@ -4655,23 +5585,25 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. -% +% % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get % undone and the next image would fail. \openin 1 = epsf.tex \ifeof 1 \else \closein 1 - \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% do not bother showing banner + % Do not bother showing banner with post-v2.7 epsf.tex (available in + % doc/epsf.tex until it shows up on ctan). + \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% \input epsf.tex \fi % +% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. \newif\ifwarnednoepsf \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get - it from ftp://ftp.tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} + it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} % -% Only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. \def\image#1{% \ifx\epsfbox\undefined \ifwarnednoepsf \else @@ -4689,42 +5621,79 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. % #4 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff. \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% - % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi - \epsfbox{#1.eps}% + \ifpdf + \centerline{\dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}}% + \else + % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi + \begingroup + \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example + % If the image is by itself, center it. + \ifvmode + \nobreak\bigskip + % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert + % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space + % above and below. + \nobreak\vskip\parskip + \nobreak + \centerline{\epsfbox{#1.eps}}% + \bigbreak + \else + % In the middle of a paragraph, no extra space. + \epsfbox{#1.eps}% + \fi + \endgroup + \fi } -% End of control word definitions. - -\message{and turning on texinfo input format.} +\message{localization,} +% and i18n. -\def\openindices{% - \newindex{cp}% - \newcodeindex{fn}% - \newcodeindex{vr}% - \newcodeindex{tp}% - \newcodeindex{ky}% - \newcodeindex{pg}% +% @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after +% @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything +% properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation. +% It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here. +% +\def\documentlanguage{\parsearg\dodocumentlanguage} +\def\dodocumentlanguage#1{% + \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. + % Read the file if it exists. + \openin 1 txi-#1.tex + \ifeof1 + \errhelp = \nolanghelp + \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% + \let\temp = \relax + \else + \def\temp{\input txi-#1.tex }% + \fi + \temp + \endgroup } +\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or +is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory +should work if nowhere else does.} + -% Set some numeric style parameters, for 8.5 x 11 format. +% @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most +% likely, but for now just recognize it. +\let\documentencoding = \comment -\hsize = 6in -\hoffset = .25in + +% Page size parameters. +% \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt -\parindent = \defaultparindent -\parskip 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt -\setleading{13.2pt} -\advance\topskip by 1.2cm \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. -\vbadness=10000 +\vbadness = 10000 + +% Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either. +\hbadness = 2000 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans. \widowpenalty=10000 @@ -4733,101 +5702,125 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on -% \hsize. This makes it come to about 9pt for the 8.5x11 format. +% \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. % -\ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined - % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. - \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% -\else - \emergencystretch = \hsize - \divide\emergencystretch by 45 -\fi +\def\setemergencystretch{% + \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined + % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. + \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% + \else + \emergencystretch = .15\hsize + \fi +} -% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 format (or else 7x9.25) -\def\smallbook{ - \global\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt - \global\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt - \global\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt +% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset; +% 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip. Then whoever calls us can +% set \parskip and call \setleading for \baselineskip. +% +\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6{% + \voffset = #3\relax + \topskip = #6\relax + \splittopskip = \topskip % - \global\lispnarrowing = 0.3in - \setleading{12pt} - \advance\topskip by -1cm - \global\parskip 2pt plus 1pt - \global\hsize = 5in - \global\vsize=7.5in - \global\tolerance=700 - \global\hfuzz=1pt - \global\contentsrightmargin=0pt - \global\deftypemargin=0pt - \global\defbodyindent=.5cm + \vsize = #1\relax + \advance\vsize by \topskip + \outervsize = \vsize + \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin + \pageheight = \vsize % - \global\pagewidth=\hsize - \global\pageheight=\vsize + \hsize = #2\relax + \outerhsize = \hsize + \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in + \pagewidth = \hsize % - \global\let\smalllisp=\smalllispx - \global\let\smallexample=\smalllispx - \global\def\Esmallexample{\Esmalllisp} + \normaloffset = #4\relax + \bindingoffset = #5\relax + % + \parindent = \defaultparindent + \setemergencystretch } +% @letterpaper (the default). +\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 + \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt + \setleading{13.2pt}% + % + % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. + \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}{\voffset}{.25in}{\bindingoffset}{36pt}% +}} + +% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format. +\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 + \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt + \setleading{12pt}% + % + \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5.in}{\voffset}{.25in}{\bindingoffset}{16pt}% + % + \lispnarrowing = 0.3in + \tolerance = 700 + \hfuzz = 1pt + \contentsrightmargin = 0pt + \deftypemargin = 0pt + \defbodyindent = .5cm + % + \let\smalldisplay = \smalldisplayx + \let\smallexample = \smalllispx + \let\smallformat = \smallformatx + \let\smalllisp = \smalllispx +}} + % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. -\def\afourpaper{ -\global\tolerance=700 -\global\hfuzz=1pt -\setleading{12pt} -\global\parskip 15pt plus 1pt - -\global\vsize= 53\baselineskip -\advance\vsize by \topskip -%\global\hsize= 5.85in % A4 wide 10pt -\global\hsize= 6.5in -\global\outerhsize=\hsize -\global\advance\outerhsize by 0.5in -\global\outervsize=\vsize -\global\advance\outervsize by 0.6in - -\global\pagewidth=\hsize -\global\pageheight=\vsize -} - -\bindingoffset=0pt -\normaloffset=\hoffset -\pagewidth=\hsize -\pageheight=\vsize - -% Allow control of the text dimensions. Parameters in order: textheight; -% textwidth; voffset; hoffset; binding offset; topskip. -% All require a dimension; -% header is additional; added length extends the bottom of the page. - -\def\changepagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6{ - \global\vsize= #1 - \global\topskip= #6 - \advance\vsize by \topskip - \global\voffset= #3 - \global\hsize= #2 - \global\outerhsize=\hsize - \global\advance\outerhsize by 0.5in - \global\outervsize=\vsize - \global\advance\outervsize by 0.6in - \global\pagewidth=\hsize - \global\pageheight=\vsize - \global\normaloffset= #4 - \global\bindingoffset= #5} +\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 + \setleading{12pt}% + \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt + % + \internalpagesizes{53\baselineskip}{160mm}{\voffset}{4mm}{\bindingoffset}{44pt}% + % + \tolerance = 700 + \hfuzz = 1pt +}} % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. Top margin % 29mm, hence bottom margin 28mm, nominal side margin 3cm. -\def\afourlatex - {\global\tolerance=700 - \global\hfuzz=1pt - \setleading{12pt} - \global\parskip 15pt plus 1pt - \advance\baselineskip by 1.6pt - \changepagesizes{237mm}{150mm}{3.6mm}{3.6mm}{3mm}{7mm} - } +\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 + \setleading{13.6pt}% + % + \afourpaper + \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}{3.6mm}{3.6mm}{3mm}{7mm}% + % + \globaldefs = 0 +}} % Use @afourwide to print on European A4 paper in wide format. -\def\afourwide{\afourpaper -\changepagesizes{9.5in}{6.5in}{\hoffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}{7mm}} +\def\afourwide{% + \afourpaper + \internalpagesizes{9.5in}{6.5in}{\hoffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}{7mm}% + % + \globaldefs = 0 +} + +% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] +% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, +% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. +% +\def\pagesizes{\parsearg\pagesizesxxx} +\def\pagesizesxxx#1{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} +\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% + \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi + \globaldefs = 1 + % + \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt + \setleading{13.2pt}% + % + \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}{\voffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}{44pt}% +}} + +% Set default to letter. +% +\letterpaper + + +\message{and turning on texinfo input format.} % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. \catcode`\"=\other @@ -4838,6 +5831,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \catcode`\<=\other \catcode`\>=\other \catcode`\+=\other +\catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"} \def\normaltilde{~} \def\normalcaret{^} @@ -4846,6 +5840,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\normalless{<} \def\normalgreater{>} \def\normalplus{+} +\def\normaldollar{$} % This macro is used to make a character print one way in ttfont % where it can probably just be output, and another way in other fonts, @@ -4856,7 +5851,13 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. % -\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\the\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} +\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} + +% Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches +% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from +% italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway +% this is not a problem. +\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} % Turn off all special characters except @ % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). @@ -4864,10 +5865,10 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. \catcode`\"=\active -\def\activedoublequote{{\tt \char '042}} +\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} \let"=\activedoublequote \catcode`\~=\active -\def~{{\tt \char '176}} +\def~{{\tt\char126}} \chardef\hat=`\^ \catcode`\^=\active \def^{{\tt \hat}} @@ -4878,7 +5879,7 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.06em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}} \catcode`\|=\active -\def|{{\tt \char '174}} +\def|{{\tt\char124}} \chardef \less=`\< \catcode`\<=\active \def<{{\tt \less}} @@ -4887,6 +5888,8 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi \def>{{\tt \gtr}} \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}} +\catcode`\$=\active +\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar} %\catcode 27=\active %\def^^[{$\diamondsuit$} @@ -4917,9 +5920,6 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font. \def\normalbackslash{{\tt\rawbackslashxx}} -% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. -\escapechar=`\@ - % \catcode 17=0 % Define control-q \catcode`\\=\active @@ -4933,7 +5933,8 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi @let|=@normalverticalbar @let<=@normalless @let>=@normalgreater -@let+=@normalplus} +@let+=@normalplus +@let$=@normaldollar} @def@normalturnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote @let\=@normalbackslash @@ -4943,7 +5944,8 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi @let|=@normalverticalbar @let<=@normalless @let>=@normalgreater -@let+=@normalplus} +@let+=@normalplus +@let$=@normaldollar} % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. @@ -4962,16 +5964,29 @@ width0pt\relax} \fi % Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. % -@gdef@fixbackslash{@ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi - @catcode`+=@active @catcode`@_=@active} +@gdef@fixbackslash{% + @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi + @catcode`+=@active + @catcode`@_=@active +} + +% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. +@escapechar = `@@ -%% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. The @rm below -%% makes sure that the current font starts out as the newly loaded cmr10 -@catcode`@$=@other @catcode`@%=@other @catcode`@&=@other @catcode`@#=@other +% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. +@catcode`@& = @other +@catcode`@# = @other +@catcode`@% = @other +@c Set initial fonts. @textfonts @rm + @c Local variables: +@c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" +@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" +@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" +@c time-stamp-end: "}" @c End: diff --git a/man/texinfo.texi b/man/texinfo.texi index 4690a34..2afcb58 100644 --- a/man/texinfo.texi +++ b/man/texinfo.texi @@ -1,15 +1,14 @@ \input texinfo.tex @c -*-texinfo-*- -@c $Id: texinfo.txi,v 1.50 1998/02/27 21:21:34 karl Exp $ +@c $Id: texinfo.txi,v 1.162 1999/09/28 19:38:01 karl Exp $ @c %**start of header @c All text is ignored before the setfilename. @setfilename ../info/texinfo.info -@settitle Texinfo @value{edition} -@c Edition number is now the same as the Texinfo distribution version number. -@set edition 3.12 -@set update-month February 1998 -@set update-date 27 @value{update-month} +@set UPDATED 28 September 1999 +@set EDITION 4.0 +@set VERSION 4.0 +@settitle Texinfo @value{VERSION} @c Define a new index for options. @defcodeindex op @@ -22,20 +21,21 @@ @footnotestyle separate @paragraphindent 2 @finalout -@comment %**end of header -@c Before release, run C-u C-c C-u C-a (texinfo-all-menus-update with a -@c prefix arg). This updates the node pointers, which texinfmt.el needs. +@comment %**end of header @dircategory Texinfo documentation system @direntry * Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format. -* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Updating info/dir entries. -* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Printing Texinfo documentation. -* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sorting Texinfo index files. +* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Update info/dir entries. +* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Print Texinfo documents. +* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sort Texinfo index files. * makeinfo: (texinfo)makeinfo Preferred. Translate Texinfo source. @end direntry +@c Before release, run C-u C-c C-u C-a (texinfo-all-menus-update with a +@c prefix arg). This updates the node pointers, which texinfmt.el needs. + @c Set smallbook if printing in smallbook format so the example of the @c smallbook font is actually written using smallbook; in bigbook, a kludge @c is used for TeX output. Do this through the -t option to texi2dvi, @@ -44,17 +44,20 @@ @c set smallbook @c @@clear smallbook +@c If you like blank pages. Can add through texi2dvi -t. +@c setchapternewpage odd + @c Currently undocumented command, 5 December 1993: @c nwnode (Same as node, but no warnings; for `makeinfo'.) @ifinfo This file documents Texinfo, a documentation system that can produce -both on-line information and a printed manual from a single source file. +both online information and a printed manual from a single source file. -Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98 +Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -This edition is for Texinfo version @value{edition}. +This edition is for Texinfo version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice @@ -78,7 +81,6 @@ except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved by the Free Software Foundation. @end ifinfo -@setchapternewpage odd @shorttitlepage Texinfo @@ -86,25 +88,27 @@ by the Free Software Foundation. @c use the new format for titles @title Texinfo @subtitle The GNU Documentation Format -@subtitle for Texinfo version @value{edition} -@subtitle @value{update-month} +@subtitle for Texinfo version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED} -@author Robert J.@: Chassell -@author Richard M.@: Stallman +@author Robert J. Chassell +@author Richard M. Stallman @c Include the Distribution inside the titlepage so @c that headings are turned off. @page @vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98 +Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +This manual is for Texinfo version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}. + Published by the Free Software Foundation @* 59 Temple Place Suite 330 @* Boston, MA 02111-1307 @* USA @* -ISBN 1-882114-65-5 +ISBN 1-882114-67-1 @c for version 4.0, September 1999. +@c ISBN 1-882114-65-5 @c for version 3.12, March 1998. @c ISBN 1-882114-63-9 is for edition 2.20 of 28 February 1995 @c ISBN 1-882114-64-7 is for edition 2.24 of November 1996. @@ -125,65 +129,22 @@ by the Free Software Foundation. Cover art by Etienne Suvasa. @end titlepage -@ifinfo -@node Top, Copying, (dir), (dir) +@summarycontents +@contents + +@ifnottex +@node Top @top Texinfo Texinfo is a documentation system that uses a single source file to -produce both on-line information and printed output.@refill +produce both online information and printed output. The first part of this master menu lists the major nodes in this Info document, including the @@-command and concept indices. The rest of -the menu lists all the lower level nodes in the document.@refill - -This is Edition @value{edition} of the Texinfo documentation, -@w{@value{update-date}}. -@end ifinfo +the menu lists all the lower level nodes in the document. -@c Here is a spare copy of the chapter menu entry descriptions, -@c in case they are accidently deleted -@ignore -Your rights. -Texinfo in brief. -How to use Texinfo mode. -What is at the beginning of a Texinfo file? -What is at the end of a Texinfo file? -How to create chapters, sections, subsections, - appendices, and other parts. -How to provide structure for a document. -How to write nodes. -How to write menus. -How to write cross references. -How to mark words and phrases as code, - keyboard input, meta-syntactic - variables, and the like. -How to write quotations, examples, etc. -How to write lists and tables. -How to create indices. -How to insert @@-signs, braces, etc. -How to indicate results of evaluation, - expansion of macros, errors, etc. -How to force and prevent line and page breaks. -How to describe functions and the like in a uniform manner. -How to write footnotes. -How to specify text for either @TeX{} or Info. -How to print hardcopy. -How to create an Info file. -How to install an Info file -A list of all the Texinfo @@-commands. -Hints on how to write a Texinfo document. -A sample Texinfo file to look at. -Tell readers they have the right to copy - and distribute. -How to incorporate other Texinfo files. -How to write page headings and footings. -How to find formatting mistakes. -All about paragraph refilling. -A description of @@-Command syntax. -Texinfo second edition features. -A menu containing commands and variables. -A menu covering many topics. -@end ignore +This is Edition @value{VERSION} of the Texinfo manual, updated @value{UPDATED}. +@end ifnottex @menu * Copying:: Your rights. @@ -206,13 +167,12 @@ A menu covering many topics. * Breaks:: How to force and prevent line and page breaks. * Definition Commands:: How to describe functions and the like in a uniform manner. -* Footnotes:: How to write footnotes. * Conditionals:: How to specify text for either @TeX{} or Info. -* Macros:: Defining new Texinfo commands. -* Format/Print Hardcopy:: How to convert a Texinfo file to a file +* Internationalization:: +* Defining New Texinfo Commands:: +* Hardcopy:: How to convert a Texinfo file to a file for printing and how to print that file. -* Create an Info File:: Convert a Texinfo file into an Info file. -* Install an Info File:: Make an Info file accessible to users. +* Creating and Installing Info Files:: * Command List:: All the Texinfo @@-commands. * Tips:: Hints on how to write a Texinfo document. * Sample Texinfo File:: A sample Texinfo file to look at. @@ -233,18 +193,17 @@ A menu covering many topics. Overview of Texinfo -* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book - or an Info file. +* Reporting Bugs:: Submitting effective bug reports. +* Using Texinfo:: Create printed or online output. * Info Files:: What is an Info file? * Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual. * Formatting Commands:: @@-commands are used for formatting. * Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file. -* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that - the formatting commands will ignore. +* Comments:: Writing comments and ignored text in general. * Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have. * Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts. * Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file. -* Acknowledgements:: +* Acknowledgements and History:: Contributors and genesis. Using Texinfo Mode @@ -285,7 +244,8 @@ The Texinfo File Header * setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file. * settitle:: Create a title for the printed work. * setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages. -* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation. +* paragraphindent:: Specify paragraph indentation. +* exampleindent:: Specify environment indentation. * End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this. The Title and Copyright Pages @@ -334,8 +294,9 @@ Nodes * Two Paths:: Different commands to structure Info output and printed output. * Node Menu Illustration:: A diagram, and sample nodes and menus. -* node:: How to write a node, in detail. -* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: How to create node pointers with @code{makeinfo}. +* node:: Creating nodes, in detail. +* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: Letting makeinfo determine node pointers. +* anchor:: Defining arbitrary cross-reference targets. The @code{@@node} Command @@ -384,23 +345,26 @@ Marking Words and Phrases Indicating Definitions, Commands, etc. * Useful Highlighting:: Highlighting provides useful information. -* code:: How to indicate code. -* kbd:: How to show keyboard input. -* key:: How to specify keys. -* samp:: How to show a literal sequence of characters. -* var:: How to indicate a metasyntactic variable. -* file:: How to indicate the name of a file. -* dfn:: How to specify a definition. -* cite:: How to refer to a book that is not in Info. -* url:: How to indicate a world wide web reference. -* email:: How to indicate an electronic mail address. +* code:: Indicating program code. +* kbd:: Showing keyboard input. +* key:: Specifying keys. +* samp:: Showing a literal sequence of characters. +* var:: Indicating metasyntactic variables. +* env:: Indicating environment variables. +* file:: Indicating file names. +* command:: Indicating command names. +* option:: Indicating option names. +* dfn:: Specifying definitions. +* cite:: Referring to books not in the Info system. +* acronym:: Indicating acronyms. +* url:: Indicating a World Wide Web reference. +* email:: Indicating an electronic mail address. Emphasizing Text * emph & strong:: How to emphasize text in Texinfo. * Smallcaps:: How to use the small caps font. * Fonts:: Various font commands for printed output. -* Customized Highlighting:: How to define highlighting commands. Quotations and Examples @@ -409,8 +373,8 @@ Quotations and Examples * quotation:: How to write a quotation. * example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font. * noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation. -* Lisp Example:: How to illustrate Lisp code. -* smallexample & smalllisp:: Forms for the @code{@@smallbook} option. +* lisp:: How to illustrate Lisp code. +* small:: Forms for @code{@@smallbook}. * display:: How to write an example in the current font. * format:: How to write an example that does not narrow the margins. @@ -437,7 +401,7 @@ Multi-column Tables * Multitable Column Widths:: Defining multitable column widths. * Multitable Rows:: Defining multitable rows, with examples. -Creating Indices +Indices * Index Entries:: Choose different words for index entries. * Predefined Indices:: Use different indices for different kinds @@ -467,6 +431,7 @@ Special Insertions * math:: How to format a mathematical expression. * Glyphs:: How to indicate results of evaluation, expansion of macros, errors, etc. +* Footnotes:: How to include footnotes. * Images:: How to include graphics. Inserting @@ and Braces @@ -503,12 +468,17 @@ Glyphs for Examples Glyphs Summary -* result:: -* expansion:: -* Print Glyph:: -* Error Glyph:: -* Equivalence:: -* Point Glyph:: +* result:: +* expansion:: +* Print Glyph:: +* Error Glyph:: +* Equivalence:: +* Point Glyph:: + +Footnotes + +* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. +* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. Making and Preventing Breaks @@ -540,11 +510,6 @@ The Definition Commands * Abstract Objects:: Commands for object-oriented programming. * Data Types:: The definition command for data types. -Footnotes - -* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. -* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. - Conditionally Visible Text * Conditional Commands:: Specifying text for HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. @@ -557,30 +522,45 @@ Conditionally Visible Text @code{@@set}, @code{@@clear}, and @code{@@value} * ifset ifclear:: Format a region if a flag is set. -* value:: Replace a flag with a string. +* set value:: Expand a flag variable to a string. * value Example:: An easy way to update edition information. -Macros: Defining New Texinfo Commands +Internationalization + +* documentlanguage:: Declaring the current language. +* documentencoding:: Declaring the input encoding. -* Defining Macros:: Both defining and undefining new commands. +Defining New Texinfo Commands + +* Defining Macros:: Defining and undefining new commands. * Invoking Macros:: Using a macro, once you've defined it. +* Macro Details:: Beyond basic macro usage. +* alias:: Command aliases. +* definfoenclose:: Customized highlighting. -Format and Print Hardcopy +Formatting and Printing Hardcopy * Use TeX:: Use @TeX{} to format for hardcopy. -* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format in a shell. -* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to use the shell. +* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format with explicit shell commands. +* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to format. * Print with lpr:: How to print. * Within Emacs:: How to format and print from an Emacs shell. * Texinfo Mode Printing:: How to format and print in Texinfo mode. * Compile-Command:: How to print using Emacs's compile command. * Requirements Summary:: @TeX{} formatting requirements summary. -* Preparing for TeX:: What you need to do to use @TeX{}. +* Preparing for TeX:: What to do before you use @TeX{}. * Overfull hboxes:: What are and what to do with overfull hboxes. * smallbook:: How to print small format books and manuals. * A4 Paper:: How to print on European A4 paper. +* pagesizes:: How to print with customized page sizes. * Cropmarks and Magnification:: How to print marks to indicate the size of pages and how to print scaled up output. +* PDF Output:: Portable Document Format output. + +Creating and Installing Info Files + +* Creating an Info File:: +* Install an Info File:: Creating an Info File @@ -595,10 +575,11 @@ Creating an Info File * Batch Formatting:: How to format for Info in Emacs Batch mode. * Tag and Split Files:: How tagged and split files help Info to run better. +* makeinfo html:: Generating HTML output. Installing an Info File -* Directory file:: The top level menu for all Info files. +* Directory File:: The top level menu for all Info files. * New Info File:: Listing a new info file. * Other Info Directories:: How to specify Info files that are located in other directories. @@ -645,16 +626,19 @@ Finding Badly Referenced Nodes * Unsplit:: How to create an unsplit file. * Tagifying:: How to tagify a file. * Splitting:: How to split a file manually. - -How to Obtain @TeX{} - -@c * New Texinfo Mode Commands:: The updating commands are especially useful. -@c * New Commands:: Many newly described @@-commands. @end detailmenu @end menu -@node Copying, Overview, Top, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@c Reward readers for getting to the end of the menu :). +@c Contributed by Arnold Robbins. +@quotation +Documentation is like sex: when it is good, it is very, very good; and +when it is bad, it is better than nothing. +---Dick Brandon +@end quotation + + +@node Copying @unnumbered Texinfo Copying Conditions @cindex Copying conditions @cindex Conditions for copying Texinfo @@ -690,100 +674,171 @@ their recipients to know that what they have is not what we distributed, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on our reputation.@refill - The precise conditions of the licenses for the programs currently +The precise conditions of the licenses for the programs currently being distributed that relate to Texinfo are found in the General Public -Licenses that accompany them.@refill +Licenses that accompany them. -@node Overview, Texinfo Mode, Copying, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Overview @chapter Overview of Texinfo @cindex Overview of Texinfo @cindex Texinfo overview -@dfn{Texinfo}@footnote{Note that the first syllable of ``Texinfo'' is -pronounced like ``speck'', not ``hex''. This odd pronunciation is -derived from, but is not the same as, the pronunciation of @TeX{}. In -the word @TeX{}, the @samp{X} is actually the Greek letter ``chi'' -rather than the English letter ``ex''. Pronounce @TeX{} as if the -@samp{X} were the last sound in the name `Bach'; but pronounce Texinfo -as if the @samp{x} were a `k'. Spell ``Texinfo'' with a capital ``T'' -and write the other letters in lower case.} -is a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both -on-line information and printed output. This means that instead of -writing two different documents, one for the on-line help or other on-line -information and the other for a typeset manual or other printed work, you -need write only one document. When the work is revised, you need revise -only one document. (You can read the on-line information, known as an -@dfn{Info file}, with an Info documentation-reading program.)@refill +@dfn{Texinfo}@footnote{The first syllable of ``Texinfo'' is pronounced +like ``speck'', not ``hex''. This odd pronunciation is derived from, +but is not the same as, the pronunciation of @TeX{}. In the word +@TeX{}, the @samp{X} is actually the Greek letter ``chi'' rather than +the English letter ``ex''. Pronounce @TeX{} as if the @samp{X} were the +last sound in the name `Bach'; but pronounce Texinfo as if the @samp{x} +were a `k'. Spell ``Texinfo'' with a capital ``T'' and the other +letters in lower case.} is a documentation system that uses a single +source file to produce both online information and printed output. This +means that instead of writing two different documents, one for the +online information and the other for a printed work, you need write only +one document. Therefore, when the work is revised, you need revise only +that one document. @menu -* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book - or an Info file. +* Reporting Bugs:: Submitting effective bug reports. +* Using Texinfo:: Create printed or online output. * Info Files:: What is an Info file? * Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual. * Formatting Commands:: @@-commands are used for formatting. * Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file. -* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that - the formatting commands will ignore. +* Comments:: Writing comments and ignored text in general. * Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have. * Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts. * Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file. -* Acknowledgements:: +* Acknowledgements and History:: Contributors and genesis. @end menu -@node Using Texinfo, Info Files, Overview, Overview -@ifinfo -@heading Using Texinfo -@end ifinfo + +@node Reporting Bugs +@section Reporting Bugs + +@cindex Bugs, reporting +@cindex Suggestions for Texinfo, making +@cindex Reporting bugs +We welcome bug reports or suggestions for the Texinfo system, both +programs and documentation. Please email them to +@email{bug-texinfo@@gnu.org}. You can get the latest version of Texinfo +from @uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/} and its mirrors worldwide. + +@cindex Checklist for bug reports +For bug reports, please include enough information for the maintainers +to reproduce the problem. Generally speaking, that means: + +@itemize @bullet +@item the version number of Texinfo and the program(s) or manual(s) involved. +@item hardware, operating system, and compiler versions. +@item any unusual options you gave to @command{configure}. +@item the contents of any input files necessary to reproduce the bug. +@item a description of the problem and samples of any erroneous output. +@item anything else that you think would be helpful. +@end itemize + +When in doubt whether something is needed or not, include it. It's +better to include too much than to leave out something important. + +Patches are most welcome; if possible, please make them with +@samp{@w{diff -c}} (@pxref{Top,, Overview, diffutils, Comparing and +Merging Files}) and include @file{ChangeLog} entries (@pxref{Change +Log,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}). + +When sending email, please do not encode or split the messages in any +way if possible; it's much easier to deal with one plain text message, +however large, than many small ones. +@uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/sharutils/, GNU shar} is a convenient way of +packaging multiple and/or binary files for email. + + +@node Using Texinfo +@section Using Texinfo + +@cindex Using Texinfo in general +@cindex Texinfo, introduction to +@cindex Introduction to Texinfo Using Texinfo, you can create a printed document with the normal -features of a book, including chapters, sections, cross references, -and indices. From the same Texinfo source file, you can create a -menu-driven, on-line Info file with nodes, menus, cross references, -and indices. You can, if you wish, make the chapters and sections of -the printed document correspond to the nodes of the on-line -information; and you use the same cross references and indices for -both the Info file and the printed work. @cite{The GNU -Emacs Manual} is a good example of a Texinfo file, as is this manual.@refill +features of a book, including chapters, sections, cross references, and +indices. From the same Texinfo source file, you can create a +menu-driven, online Info file with nodes, menus, cross references, and +indices. You can also create from that same source file an HTML output +file suitable for use with a web browser. @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual} +is a good example of a Texinfo file, as is this manual. To make a printed document, you process a Texinfo source file with the -@TeX{} typesetting program. This creates a DVI file that you can -typeset and print as a book or report. (Note that the Texinfo language -is completely different from @TeX{}'s usual language, plain @TeX{}.) If -you do not have @TeX{}, but do have @code{troff} or @code{nroff}, you -can use the @code{texi2roff} program instead.@refill - -To make an Info file, you process a Texinfo source file with the -@code{makeinfo} utility or Emacs's @code{texinfo-format-buffer} command; -this creates an Info file that you can install on-line.@refill - -@TeX{} and @code{texi2roff} work with many types of printers; similarly, -Info works with almost every type of computer terminal. This power -makes Texinfo a general purpose system, but brings with it a constraint, -which is that a Texinfo file may contain only the customary -``typewriter'' characters (letters, numbers, spaces, and punctuation -marks) but no special graphics.@refill - -A Texinfo file is a plain @sc{ascii} file containing text and +@TeX{} typesetting program (but the Texinfo language is very different +from @TeX{}'s usual language, plain @TeX{}). This creates a DVI file +that you can typeset and print as a book or report (@pxref{Hardcopy}). + +@pindex makeinfo +To output an Info file, process your Texinfo source with the +@code{makeinfo} utility or Emacs's @code{texinfo-format-buffer} command. +You can install the result in your Info tree (@pxref{Install an Info +File}). + +To output an HTML file, process your Texinfo source with @code{makeinfo} +using the @samp{--html} option. You can (for example) install the +result on your web site. + +@cindex Output formats, supporting more +@cindex Docbook output format +@cindex SGML-tools output format +If you are a programmer and would like to contribute to the GNU project +by implementing additional output formats for Texinfo, that would be +excellent. But please do not write a separate translator texi2foo for +your favorite format foo! That is the hard way to do the job, and makes +extra work in subsequent maintenance, since the Texinfo language is +continually being enhanced and updated. Instead, the best approach is +modify @code{makeinfo} to generate the new format, as it does now for +Info and HTML. + +@TeX{} works with virtually all printers; Info works with virtually all +computer terminals; the HTML output works with virtually all web +browsers. Thus Texinfo can be used by almost any computer user. + +@cindex Source file +A Texinfo source file is a plain @sc{ascii} file containing text and @dfn{@@-commands} (words preceded by an @samp{@@}) that tell the -typesetting and formatting programs what to do. You may edit a -Texinfo file with any text editor; but it is especially convenient to -use GNU Emacs since that editor has a special mode, called Texinfo -mode, that provides various Texinfo-related features. (@xref{Texinfo -Mode}.)@refill - -Before writing a Texinfo source file, you should become familiar with -the Info documentation reading program and learn about nodes, -menus, cross references, and the rest. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, -for more information.)@refill +typesetting and formatting programs what to do. You may edit a Texinfo +file with any text editor; but it is especially convenient to use GNU +Emacs since that editor has a special mode, called Texinfo mode, that +provides various Texinfo-related features. (@xref{Texinfo Mode}.) -You can use Texinfo to create both on-line help and printed manuals; -moreover, Texinfo is freely redistributable. For these reasons, Texinfo -is the format in which documentation for GNU utilities and libraries is -written.@refill +Before writing a Texinfo source file, you should learn about nodes, +menus, cross references, and the rest, for example by reading this +manual. -@node Info Files, Printed Books, Using Texinfo, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +You can use Texinfo to create both online help and printed manuals; +moreover, Texinfo is freely redistributable. For these reasons, Texinfo +is the official documentation format of the GNU project. More +information is available at the @uref{http://www.gnu.org/doc/, GNU +documentation web page}. + +@cindex Man page output, not supported +From time to time, proposals are made to generate traditional Unix man +pages from Texinfo source. This is not likely to ever be supported, +because man pages have a very strict conventional format. Merely +enhancing @command{makeinfo} to output troff format would be +insufficient. Generating a good man page therefore requires a +completely different source than the typical Texinfo applications of +generating a good user manual or a good reference manual. This makes +generating man pages incompatible with the Texinfo design goal of not +having to document the same information in different ways for different +output formats. You might as well just write the man page directly. + +@pindex help2man +@cindex O'Dea, Brendan +If you wish to support man pages, the program @command{help2man} may be +useful; it generates a traditional man page from the @samp{--help} +output of a program. In fact, this is currently used to generate man +pages for the Texinfo programs themselves. It is free software written +by Brendan O'Dea, available from +@uref{http://www.ozemail.com.au/~bod/help2man.tar.gz}. + + +@node Info Files @section Info files @cindex Info files @@ -870,8 +925,20 @@ The @file{dir} file in the @file{info} directory serves as the departure point for the whole Info system. From it, you can reach the `Top' nodes of each of the documents in a complete Info system.@refill -@node Printed Books, Formatting Commands, Info Files, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@cindex URI syntax for Info +If you wish to refer to an Info file in a URI, you can use the +(unofficial) syntax exemplified in the following. This works with +Emacs/W3, for example: +@example +info:///usr/info/emacs#Dissociated%20Press +info:emacs#Dissociated%20Press +info://localhost/usr/info/emacs#Dissociated%20Press +@end example + +The @command{info} program itself does not follow URI's of any kind. + + +@node Printed Books @section Printed Books @cindex Printed book and manual characteristics @cindex Manual characteristics, printed @@ -883,9 +950,12 @@ departure point for the whole Info system. From it, you can reach the A Texinfo file can be formatted and typeset as a printed book or manual. To do this, you need @TeX{}, a powerful, sophisticated typesetting program written by Donald Knuth.@footnote{You can also use the -@code{texi2roff} program if you do not have @TeX{}; since Texinfo is -designed for use with @TeX{}, @code{texi2roff} is not described here. -@code{texi2roff} is not part of the standard GNU distribution.} +@pindex texi2roff@r{, unsupported software} +@uref{ftp://tug.org/texi2roff.tar.gz, @code{texi2roff}} program if you +do not have @TeX{}; since Texinfo is designed for use with @TeX{}, +@code{texi2roff} is not described here. @code{texi2roff} is not part of +the standard GNU distribution and is not maintained or up-to-date with +all the Texinfo features described in this manual.} A Texinfo-based book is similar to any other typeset, printed work: it can have a title page, copyright page, table of contents, and preface, @@ -893,18 +963,19 @@ as well as chapters, numbered or unnumbered sections and subsections, page headers, cross references, footnotes, and indices.@refill You can use Texinfo to write a book without ever having the intention -of converting it into on-line information. You can use Texinfo for +of converting it into online information. You can use Texinfo for writing a printed novel, and even to write a printed memo, although this latter application is not recommended since electronic mail is so much easier.@refill @TeX{} is a general purpose typesetting program. Texinfo provides a -file called @file{texinfo.tex} that contains information (definitions or +file @file{texinfo.tex} that contains information (definitions or @dfn{macros}) that @TeX{} uses when it typesets a Texinfo file. (@file{texinfo.tex} tells @TeX{} how to convert the Texinfo @@-commands to @TeX{} commands, which @TeX{} can then process to create the typeset document.) @file{texinfo.tex} contains the specifications for printing -a document.@refill +a document. You can get the latest version of @file{texinfo.tex} from +@uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo.tex}. Most often, documents are printed on 8.5 inch by 11 inch pages (216@dmn{mm} by 280@dmn{mm}; this is the default size), but you @@ -924,7 +995,7 @@ light-hearted, young and cheery.@refill @TeX{} is freely distributable. It is written in a superset of Pascal called WEB and can be compiled either in Pascal or (by using a conversion program that comes with the @TeX{} distribution) in C. -(@xref{TeX Mode, ,@TeX{} Mode, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for information +(@xref{TeX Mode, ,@TeX{} Mode, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for information about @TeX{}.)@refill @TeX{} is very powerful and has a great many features. Because a @@ -933,7 +1004,8 @@ character-only terminal in Info form and in a typeset book, the formatting commands that Texinfo supports are necessarily limited.@refill -@xref{Obtaining TeX, , How to Obtain @TeX{}}. +To get a copy of @TeX{}, see +@ref{Obtaining TeX, , How to Obtain @TeX{}}. @node Formatting Commands, Conventions, Printed Books, Overview @@ -963,17 +1035,17 @@ numeric characters. Similarly, you can print the output generated by @TeX{} on a wide variety of printers.@refill Depending on what they do or what arguments@footnote{The word -@dfn{argument} comes from the way it is used in mathematics and does -not refer to a disputation between two people; it refers to the -information presented to the command. According to the @cite{Oxford -English Dictionary}, the word derives from the Latin for @dfn{to make -clear, prove}; thus it came to mean `the evidence offered as proof', -which is to say, `the information offered', which led to its -mathematical meaning. In its other thread of derivation, the word -came to mean `to assert in a manner against which others may make -counter assertions', which led to the meaning of `argument' as a -disputation.} they take, you need to write @@-commands on lines of -their own or as part of sentences:@refill +@dfn{argument} comes from the way it is used in mathematics and does not +refer to a dispute between two people; it refers to the information +presented to the command. According to the @cite{Oxford English +Dictionary}, the word derives from the Latin for @dfn{to make clear, +prove}; thus it came to mean `the evidence offered as proof', which is +to say, `the information offered', which led to its mathematical +meaning. In its other thread of derivation, the word came to mean `to +assert in a manner against which others may make counter assertions', +which led to the meaning of `argument' as a dispute.} they take, you +need to write @@-commands on lines of their own or as part of +sentences: @itemize @bullet @item @@ -998,12 +1070,14 @@ wish (but usually within a sentence) with its argument, marks text as being code.)@refill @item -Write a command such as @code{@@example} at the beginning of a line of -its own; write the body-text on following lines; and write the matching -@code{@@end} command, @code{@@end example} in this case, at the -beginning of a line of its own after the body-text. (@code{@@example} -@dots{} @code{@@end example} indents and typesets body-text as an -example.)@refill +Write a command such as @code{@@example} on a line of its own; write the +body-text on following lines; and write the matching @code{@@end} +command, @code{@@end example} in this case, at the on a line of its own +after the body-text. (@code{@@example} @dots{} @code{@@end example} +indents and typesets body-text as an example.) It's usually ok to +indent environment commands like this, but in complicated and +hard-to-define circumstances the extra spaces cause extra space to +appear in the output, so beware. @end itemize @noindent @@ -1026,6 +1100,10 @@ syntax, see @ref{Command Syntax, , @@-Command Syntax}.)@refill @cindex Syntactic conventions @cindex Conventions, syntactic +This section describes the general conventions used in all Texinfo documents. + +@itemize @bullet +@item All printable @sc{ascii} characters except @samp{@@}, @samp{@{} and @samp{@}} can appear in a Texinfo file and stand for themselves. @samp{@@} is the escape character which introduces commands. @@ -1034,6 +1112,7 @@ certain commands. To put one of these special characters into the document, put an @samp{@@} character in front of it, like this: @samp{@@@@}, @samp{@@@{}, and @samp{@@@}}.@refill +@item @ifinfo It is customary in @TeX{} to use doubled single-quote characters to begin and end quotations: ` ` and ' ' (but without a space between the @@ -1044,23 +1123,26 @@ single-quote characters to @sc{ascii} double-quotes: ` ` and ' ' to " .@refill @end ifinfo @iftex It is customary in @TeX{} to use doubled single-quote characters to -begin and end quotations: @w{@tt{ `` }} and @w{@tt{ '' }}. This +begin and end quotations: @w{@t{ `` }} and @w{@t{ '' }}. This convention should be followed in Texinfo files. @TeX{} converts doubled single-quote characters to left- and right-hand doubled quotation marks, ``like this'', and Info converts doubled single-quote -characters to @sc{ascii} double-quotes: @w{@tt{ `` }} and -@w{@tt{ '' }} to @w{@tt{ " }}.@refill +characters to @sc{ascii} double-quotes: @w{@t{ `` }} and +@w{@t{ '' }} to @w{@t{ " }}.@refill @end iftex +@item Use three hyphens in a row, @samp{---}, for a dash---like this. In @TeX{}, a single or double hyphen produces a printed dash that is shorter than the usual typeset dash. Info reduces three hyphens to two for display on the screen. +@item To prevent a paragraph from being indented in the printed manual, put the command @code{@@noindent} on a line by itself before the paragraph.@refill +@item If you mark off a region of the Texinfo file with the @code{@@iftex} and @w{@code{@@end iftex}} commands, that region will appear only in the printed copy; in that region, you can use certain commands @@ -1071,8 +1153,9 @@ region, you can use Info commands that you cannot use in @TeX{}. Similarly for @code{@@ifhtml @dots{} @@end ifhtml}, @code{@@ifnothtml @dots{} @@end ifnothtml}, @code{@@ifnotinfo @dots{} @@end ifnotinfo}, -@code{@@ifnottex @dots{} @@end ifnottex}, +@code{@@ifnottex @dots{} @@end ifnottex}. @xref{Conditionals}. +@end itemize @cindex Tabs; don't use! @quotation @@ -1090,9 +1173,6 @@ spaces when you press the @key{TAB} key.@refill @noindent Also, you can run @code{untabify} in Emacs to convert tabs in a region to multiple spaces.@refill - -@noindent -Don't use tabs. @end quotation @node Comments, Minimum, Conventions, Overview @@ -1102,7 +1182,7 @@ Don't use tabs. You can write comments in a Texinfo file that will not appear in either the Info file or the printed manual by using the @code{@@comment} command (which may be abbreviated to @code{@@c}). -Such comments are for the person who reads the Texinfo file. All the +Such comments are for the person who revises the Texinfo file. All the text on a line that follows either @code{@@comment} or @code{@@c} is a comment; the rest of the line does not appear in either the Info file or the printed manual. (Often, you can write the @code{@@comment} or @@ -1148,9 +1228,9 @@ within ignored text. @cindex Texinfo file minimum By convention, the names of Texinfo files end with one of the -extensions @file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, or @file{.tex}. The longer -extension is preferred since it describes more clearly to a human -reader the nature of the file. The shorter extensions are for +extensions @file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, @file{.txi}, or @file{.tex}. +The longer extension is preferred since it describes more clearly to a +human reader the nature of the file. The shorter extensions are for operating systems that cannot handle long file names.@refill In order to be made into a printed manual and an Info file, a Texinfo @@ -1252,8 +1332,7 @@ the table of contents, and the @code{@@bye} command on a line of its own.@refill @end table -@node Short Sample, Acknowledgements, Six Parts, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node Short Sample @section A Short Sample Texinfo File @cindex Sample Texinfo file @@ -1264,7 +1343,6 @@ the material is standard boilerplate; when you write a manual, simply insert the names for your own manual in this segment. (@xref{Beginning a File}.)@refill -@noindent In the following, the sample text is @emph{indented}; comments on it are not. The complete file, without any comments, is shown in @ref{Sample Texinfo File}. @@ -1282,9 +1360,8 @@ name of the Info file and the title used in the header. @@c %**start of header @@setfilename sample.info @@settitle Sample Document -@@c %**end of header - @@setchapternewpage odd +@@c %**end of header @end group @end example @@ -1393,15 +1470,14 @@ manual. @subheading Part 6: The End of the Document @noindent -The end segment contains commands both for generating an index in a node -and unnumbered chapter of its own and for generating the table of -contents; and it contains the @code{@@bye} command that marks the end of -the document.@refill +The end segment contains commands for generating an index in a node and +unnumbered chapter of its own, (usually) for generating the table of +contents, and the @code{@@bye} command that marks the end of the +document.@refill @example @group @@node Concept Index, , First Chapter, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up @@unnumbered Concept Index @end group @@ -1438,41 +1514,61 @@ an Info file; and @TeX{} typesets it for a printed manual. @end quotation -@node Acknowledgements, , Short Sample, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Acknowledgements + +@node Acknowledgements and History +@section Acknowledgements and History @cindex Stallman, Richard M. @cindex Chassell, Robert J. @cindex Berry, Karl -Richard M.@: Stallman wrote Edition 1.0 of this manual. @w{Robert J.@: -Chassell} revised and extended it, starting with Edition 1.1. Karl -Berry made updates for the Texinfo 3.8 and subsequent releases, starting -with Edition 2.22. +Richard M.@: Stallman invented the Texinfo format, wrote the initial +processors, and created Edition 1.0 of this manual. @w{Robert J.@: +Chassell} greatly revised and extended the manual, starting with Edition +1.1. Brian Fox was responsible for the standalone Texinfo distribution +until version 3.8, and wrote the standalone @command{makeinfo} and +@command{info}. Karl Berry has made the updates since Texinfo 3.8 and +subsequent releases, starting with Edition 2.22 of the manual. @cindex Pinard, Fran@,{c}ois @cindex Zuhn, David D. @cindex Weisshaus, Melissa +@cindex Zaretskii, Eli +@cindex Schwab, Andreas +@cindex Weinberg, Zack Our thanks go out to all who helped improve this work, particularly to Fran@,{c}ois Pinard and @w{David D.@: Zuhn}, who tirelessly recorded and reported mistakes and obscurities; our special thanks go to Melissa Weisshaus for her frequent and often tedious reviews of nearly similar -editions. Our mistakes are our own. - -Please send suggestions and corrections to: - -@example -@group -@r{Internet address:} - bug-texinfo@@gnu.org -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -Please include the manual's edition number and update date in your messages. - -@node Texinfo Mode, Beginning a File, Overview, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +editions. The indefatigable Eli Zaretskii and Andreas Schwab have +provided patches beyond counting. Zack Weinberg did the impossible by +implementing the macro syntax in @file{texinfo.tex}. Dozens of others +have contributed patches and suggestions, they are gratefully +acknowledged in the @file{ChangeLog} file. Our mistakes are our own. + +@cindex Scribe +@cindex Reid, Brian +@cindex History of Texinfo +A bit of history: in the 1970's at CMU, Brian Reid developed a program +and format named Scribe to mark up documents for printing. It used the +@code{@@} character to introduce commands as Texinfo does and strived to +describe document contents rather than formatting. + +@cindex Bolio +@cindex Bo@TeX{} +Meanwhile, people at MIT developed another, not too dissimilar format +called Bolio. This then was converted to using @TeX{} as its typesetting +language: Bo@TeX{}. + +Bo@TeX{} could only be used as a markup language for documents to be +printed, not for online documents. Richard Stallman (RMS) worked on +both Bolio and Bo@TeX{}. He also developed a nifty on-line help format +called Info, and then combined Bo@TeX{} and Info to create Texinfo, a +mark up language for text that is intended to be read both on line and +as printed hard copy. + + + +@node Texinfo Mode @chapter Using Texinfo Mode @cindex Texinfo mode @cindex Mode, using Texinfo @@ -1509,7 +1605,8 @@ detail.@refill @end ifinfo Texinfo mode provides special features for working with Texinfo -files:@refill +files. +You can:@refill @itemize @bullet @item @@ -1561,16 +1658,16 @@ equivalents, such as appendices. With this value for the page delimiter, you can jump from chapter title to chapter title with the @kbd{C-x ]} (@code{forward-page}) and @kbd{C-x [} (@code{backward-page}) commands and narrow to a chapter with the -@kbd{C-x p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) command. (@xref{Pages, , , xemacs, -XEmacs User's Manual}, for details about the page commands.)@refill +@kbd{C-x p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) command. (@xref{Pages, , ,emacs, +The GNU Emacs Manual}, for details about the page commands.)@refill You may name a Texinfo file however you wish, but the convention is to -end a Texinfo file name with one of the three extensions -@file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, or @file{.tex}. A longer extension is -preferred, since it is explicit, but a shorter extension may be -necessary for operating systems that limit the length of file names. -GNU Emacs automatically enters Texinfo mode when you visit a file with -a @file{.texinfo} or @file{.texi} +end a Texinfo file name with one of the extensions +@file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, @file{.txi}, or @file{.tex}. A longer +extension is preferred, since it is explicit, but a shorter extension +may be necessary for operating systems that limit the length of file +names. GNU Emacs automatically enters Texinfo mode when you visit a +file with a @file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi} or @file{.txi} extension. Also, Emacs switches to Texinfo mode when you visit a file that has @samp{-*-texinfo-*-} in its first line. If ever you are @@ -1762,14 +1859,10 @@ cursor in the @file{*Occur*} buffer.@refill If you call @code{texinfo-show-structure} with a prefix argument by typing @w{@kbd{C-u C-c C-s}}, it will list not only those lines with the -@@-commands for @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and the like, -but also the @code{@@node} lines. (This is how the -@code{texinfo-show-structure} command worked without an argument in -the first version of Texinfo. It was changed because @code{@@node} -lines clutter up the @samp{*Occur*} buffer and are usually not -needed.) You can use @code{texinfo-show-structure} with a prefix -argument to check whether the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of -an @code{@@node} line are correct.@refill +@@-commands for @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and the like, but +also the @code{@@node} lines. You can use @code{texinfo-show-structure} +with a prefix argument to check whether the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' +pointers of an @code{@@node} line are correct. Often, when you are working on a manual, you will be interested only in the structure of the current chapter. In this case, you can mark @@ -1777,7 +1870,7 @@ off the region of the buffer that you are interested in by using the @kbd{C-x n n} (@code{narrow-to-region}) command and @code{texinfo-show-structure} will work on only that region. To see the whole buffer again, use @w{@kbd{C-x n w}} (@code{widen}). -(@xref{Narrowing, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for more +(@xref{Narrowing, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information about the narrowing commands.)@refill @vindex page-delimiter @@ -1788,7 +1881,7 @@ the chapter-level @@-commands. This enables you to use the @kbd{C-x ]} (@code{forward-page}) and @kbd{C-x [} (@code{backward-page}) commands to move forward and backward by chapter, and to use the @kbd{C-x p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) command to narrow to a chapter. -@xref{Pages, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for more information +@xref{Pages, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information about the page commands.@refill @node Updating Nodes and Menus, Info Formatting, Showing the Structure, Texinfo Mode @@ -1823,18 +1916,18 @@ node pointers by hand, which is a tedious task.@refill @subheading The Updating Commands @end ifinfo -You can use the updating commands@refill +You can use the updating commands to:@refill @itemize @bullet @item -to insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of a +insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of a node,@refill @item -to insert or update the menu for a section, and@refill +insert or update the menu for a section, and@refill @item -to create a master menu for a Texinfo source file.@refill +create a master menu for a Texinfo source file.@refill @end itemize You can also use the commands to update all the nodes and menus in a @@ -1856,11 +1949,11 @@ interpose only an @code{@@comment} line or an @code{@@ifinfo} line. Commands which work on a whole buffer require that the `Top' node be followed by a node with an @code{@@chapter} or equivalent-level command. -Note that the menu updating commands will not create a main or master -menu for a Texinfo file that has only @code{@@chapter}-level nodes! The -menu updating commands only create menus @emph{within} nodes for lower level +The menu updating commands will not create a main or master menu for a +Texinfo file that has only @code{@@chapter}-level nodes! The menu +updating commands only create menus @emph{within} nodes for lower level nodes. To create a menu of chapters, you must provide a `Top' -node.@refill +node. The menu updating commands remove menu entries that refer to other Info files since they do not refer to nodes within the current buffer. This @@ -1906,7 +1999,7 @@ This updates all the nodes and menus completely and all at once.@refill @end table The other major updating commands do smaller jobs and are designed for -the person who updates nodes and menus as he or she writes a Texinfo +the person who updates nodes and menus as he or she writes a Texinfo file.@refill @need 1000 @@ -1975,9 +2068,10 @@ The @code{texinfo-column-for-description} variable specifies the column to which menu descriptions are indented. By default, the value is 32 although it is often useful to reduce it to as low as 24. You can set the variable with the @kbd{M-x edit-options} command -(@pxref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, xemacs, XEmacs User's -Manual}) or with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command (@pxref{Examining, , -Examining and Setting Variables, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}).@refill +(@pxref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, emacs, The GNU Emacs +Manual}) or with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command (@pxref{Examining, +, Examining and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU Emacs +Manual}).@refill Also, the @code{texinfo-indent-menu-description} command may be used to indent existing menu descriptions to a specified column. Finally, if @@ -2030,7 +2124,7 @@ In this example, `Comments' is the name of both the node and the section. The next node is called `Minimum' and the previous node is called `Conventions'. The `Comments' section is within the `Overview' node, which is specified by the `Up' pointer. (Instead of an -@code{@@comment} line, you can write an @code{@@ifinfo} line.)@refill +@code{@@comment} line, you may also write an @code{@@ifinfo} line.)@refill If a file has a `Top' node, it must be called @samp{top} or @samp{Top} and be the first node in the file.@refill @@ -2039,14 +2133,14 @@ The menu updating commands create a menu of sections within a chapter, a menu of subsections within a section, and so on. This means that you must have a `Top' node if you want a menu of chapters.@refill -Incidentally, the @code{makeinfo} command will create an Info file for -a hierarchically organized Texinfo file that lacks `Next', `Previous' -and `Up' pointers. Thus, if you can be sure that your Texinfo file -will be formatted with @code{makeinfo}, you have no need for the -`update node' commands. (@xref{Create an Info File, , Creating an -Info File}, for more information about @code{makeinfo}.) However, -both @code{makeinfo} and the @code{texinfo-format-@dots{}} commands -require that you insert menus in the file.@refill +Incidentally, the @code{makeinfo} command will create an Info file for a +hierarchically organized Texinfo file that lacks `Next', `Previous' and +`Up' pointers. Thus, if you can be sure that your Texinfo file will be +formatted with @code{makeinfo}, you have no need for the update node +commands. (@xref{Creating an Info File}, for more information about +@code{makeinfo}.) However, both @code{makeinfo} and the +@code{texinfo-format-@dots{}} commands require that you insert menus in +the file. @node Other Updating Commands, , Updating Requirements, Updating Nodes and Menus @comment node-name, next, previous, up @@ -2077,11 +2171,11 @@ For example, the following marks a whole buffer as a region and inserts C-x h C-u M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines @end example -(Note that this command inserts titles as node names in @code{@@node} -lines; the @code{texinfo-start-menu-description} command -(@pxref{Inserting, Inserting Frequently Used Commands}) inserts titles -as descriptions in menu entries, a different action. However, in both -cases, you need to edit the inserted text.)@refill +This command inserts titles as node names in @code{@@node} lines; the +@code{texinfo-start-menu-description} command (@pxref{Inserting, +Inserting Frequently Used Commands}) inserts titles as descriptions in +menu entries, a different action. However, in both cases, you need to +edit the inserted text. @item M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update @findex texinfo-multiple-files-update @r{(in brief)} @@ -2181,7 +2275,7 @@ M-x makeinfo-buffer For @TeX{} or the Info formatting commands to work, the file @emph{must} include a line that has @code{@@setfilename} in its header.@refill -@xref{Create an Info File}, for details about Info formatting.@refill +@xref{Creating an Info File}, for details about Info formatting.@refill @node Printing, Texinfo Mode Summary, Info Formatting, Texinfo Mode @comment node-name, next, previous, up @@ -2244,7 +2338,7 @@ on a line by itself. (When you use @code{texinfo-tex-region}, you must surround the @code{@@settitle} line with start-of-header and end-of-header lines.)@refill -@xref{Format/Print Hardcopy}, for a description of the other @TeX{} related +@xref{Hardcopy}, for a description of the other @TeX{} related commands, such as @code{tex-show-print-queue}.@refill @node Texinfo Mode Summary, , Printing, Texinfo Mode @@ -2296,6 +2390,7 @@ C-c C-s @r{List all the headings.} The @code{texinfo-master-menu} command creates a master menu; and can be used to update every node and menu in a file as well.@refill +@c Probably should use @tables in this section. @example @group C-c C-u m @@ -2397,7 +2492,7 @@ C-c C-t C-l @r{Recenter the output buffer.} @subheading Other Updating Commands -The `other updating commands' do not have standard keybindings because +The remaining updating commands do not have standard keybindings because they are rarely used. @example @@ -2608,12 +2703,13 @@ or else like this: * setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file. * settitle:: Create a title for the printed work. * setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages. -* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation. +* paragraphindent:: Specify paragraph indentation. +* exampleindent:: Specify environment indentation. * End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this. @end menu -@node First Line, Start of Header, Header, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node First Line @subsection The First Line of a Texinfo File @cindex First line of a Texinfo file @cindex Beginning line of a Texinfo file @@ -2668,8 +2764,7 @@ A start-of-header line looks like this:@refill The odd string of characters, @samp{%**}, is to ensure that no other comment is accidentally taken for a start-of-header line.@refill -@node setfilename, settitle, Start of Header, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node setfilename @subsection @code{@@setfilename} @cindex Info file requires @code{@@setfilename} @findex setfilename @@ -2687,11 +2782,13 @@ else on the line; anything on the line after the command is considered part of the file name, including what would otherwise be a comment. -The @code{@@setfilename} line specifies the name of the Info file to be -generated. This name should be different from the name of the Texinfo -file. There are two conventions for choosing the name: you can either -remove the @samp{.texi} extension from the input file name, or replace -it with the @samp{.info} extension. +The @code{@@setfilename} line specifies the name of the output file to +be generated. This name should be different from the name of the +Texinfo file. There are two conventions for choosing the name: you can +either remove the extension (such as @samp{.texi}) from the input file +name, or replace it with the @samp{.info} extension. When producing +HTML output, @code{makeinfo} will replace any extension with +@samp{html}, or add @samp{.html} if the given name has no extension. Some operating systems cannot handle long file names. You can run into a problem even when the file name you specify is itself short enough. @@ -2701,19 +2798,24 @@ short indirect subfiles, and name them by appending @samp{-1}, file name. (@xref{Tag and Split Files, , Tag Files and Split Files}.) The subfile name @file{texinfo.info-10}, for example, is too long for some systems; so the Info file name for this document is @file{texinfo} -rather than @file{texinfo.info}. +rather than @file{texinfo.info}. When @code{makeinfo} is running on +operating systems such as MS-DOS which impose grave limits on file +names, it will sometimes remove some characters from the original file +name to leave enough space for the subfile suffix, thus producing files +named @file{texin-10}, @file{gcc.i12}, etc. @cindex Ignored before @code{@@setfilename} +@cindex @samp{\input} source line ignored The Info formatting commands ignore everything written before the @code{@@setfilename} line, which is why the very first line of the file (the @code{\input} line) does not show up in the output. @pindex texinfo.cnf The @code{@@setfilename} line produces no output when you typeset a -manual with @TeX{}, but it nevertheless is essential: it opens the +manual with @TeX{}, but it is nevertheless essential: it opens the index, cross-reference, and other auxiliary files used by Texinfo, and also reads @file{texinfo.cnf} if that file is present on your system -(@pxref{Preparing for TeX,, Preparing to Use @TeX{}}). +(@pxref{Preparing for TeX,, Preparing for @TeX{}}). @node settitle, setchapternewpage, setfilename, Header @@ -2765,15 +2867,15 @@ You may, if you wish, create your own, customized headings and footings. @xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for a detailed discussion of this process.@refill -@node setchapternewpage, paragraphindent, settitle, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node setchapternewpage @subsection @code{@@setchapternewpage} @cindex Starting chapters @cindex Pages, starting odd @findex setchapternewpage -In a book or a manual, text is usually printed on both sides of the -paper, chapters start on right-hand pages, and right-hand pages have +In an officially bound book, text is usually printed on both sides of +the paper, chapters start on right-hand pages, and right-hand pages have odd numbers. But in short reports, text often is printed only on one side of the paper. Also in short reports, chapters sometimes do not start on new pages, but are printed on the same page as the end of the @@ -2781,7 +2883,7 @@ preceding chapter, after a small amount of vertical whitespace.@refill You can use the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command with various arguments to specify how @TeX{} should start chapters and whether it -should typeset pages for printing on one or both sides of the paper +should format headers for printing on one or both sides of the paper (single-sided or double-sided printing).@refill Write the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command at the beginning of a @@ -2798,17 +2900,7 @@ You can specify one of three alternatives with the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command:@refill @table @asis -@ignore -@item No @code{@@setchapternewpage} command -If the Texinfo file does not contain an @code{@@setchapternewpage} -command before the @code{@@titlepage} command, @TeX{} automatically -begins chapters on new pages and prints headings in the standard -format for single-sided printing. This is the conventional format for -single-sided printing.@refill -The result is exactly the same as when you write -@code{@@setchapternewpage on}.@refill -@end ignore @item @code{@@setchapternewpage off} Cause @TeX{} to typeset a new chapter on the same page as the last chapter, after skipping some vertical whitespace. Also, cause @TeX{} to @@ -2817,9 +2909,9 @@ headers format with the @code{@@headings double} command; see @ref{headings on off, , The @code{@@headings} Command}.)@refill @item @code{@@setchapternewpage on} -Cause @TeX{} to start new chapters on new pages and to typeset page +Cause @TeX{} to start new chapters on new pages and to format page headers for single-sided printing. This is the form most often -used for short reports.@refill +used for short reports or personal printing. This alternative is the default.@refill @@ -2829,13 +2921,11 @@ Cause @TeX{} to start new chapters on new, odd-numbered pages the form most often used for books and manuals.@refill @end table -@noindent Texinfo does not have an @code{@@setchapternewpage even} command.@refill -@noindent -(You can countermand or modify an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command -with an @code{@@headings} command. @xref{headings on off, , The -@code{@@headings} Command}.)@refill +You can countermand or modify the effect on headers of an +@code{@@setchapternewpage} command with an @code{@@headings} command. +@xref{headings on off, , The @code{@@headings} Command}.@refill At the beginning of a manual or book, pages are not numbered---for example, the title and copyright pages of a book are not numbered. @@ -2845,62 +2935,100 @@ numerals and not in sequence with the rest of the document.@refill Since an Info file does not have pages, the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command has no effect on it.@refill -Usually, you do not write an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command for -single-sided printing, but accept the default which is to typeset for -single-sided printing and to start new chapters on new pages. Usually, -you write an @code{@@setchapternewpage odd} command for double-sided -printing.@refill +We recommend not including any @code{@@setchapternewpage} command in +your manual sources at all, since the desired output is not intrinsic to +the document. Instead, if you don't want the default option (no blank +pages, same headers on all pages) use the @option{--texinfo} option to +@command{texi2dvi} to specify the output you want. -@node paragraphindent, End of Header, setchapternewpage, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + + +@node paragraphindent @subsection Paragraph Indenting @cindex Indenting paragraphs @cindex Paragraph indentation @findex paragraphindent -The Info formatting commands may insert spaces at the beginning of the -first line of each paragraph, thereby indenting that paragraph. You -can use the @code{@@paragraphindent} command to specify the -indentation. Write an @code{@@paragraphindent} command at the -beginning of a line followed by either @samp{asis} or a number. The -template is:@refill +The Texinfo processors may insert whitespace at the beginning of the +first line of each paragraph, thereby indenting that paragraph. You can +use the @code{@@paragraphindent} command to specify this indentation. +Write an @code{@@paragraphindent} command at the beginning of a line +followed by either @samp{asis} or a number: @example @@paragraphindent @var{indent} @end example -The Info formatting commands indent according to the value of -@var{indent}:@refill +The indentation is according to the value of @var{indent}: -@itemize @bullet -@item -If the value of @var{indent} is @samp{asis}, the Info formatting -commands do not change the existing indentation.@refill +@table @asis +@item @code{asis} +Do not change the existing indentation (not implemented in @TeX{}). -@item -If the value of @var{indent} is zero, the Info formatting commands delete -existing indentation.@refill +@item 0 +Omit all indentation. -@item -If the value of @var{indent} is greater than zero, the Info formatting -commands indent the paragraph by that number of spaces.@refill -@end itemize +@item @var{n} +Indent by @var{n} space characters in Info output, by @var{n} ems in +@TeX{}. + +@end table -The default value of @var{indent} is @samp{asis}.@refill +The default value of @var{indent} is @samp{asis}. +@code{@@paragraphindent} is ignored for HTML output. Write the @code{@@paragraphindent} command before or shortly after the end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. (If you write the command between the start-of-header and end-of-header lines, the -region formatting commands indent paragraphs as specified.)@refill +region formatting commands indent paragraphs as specified.) A peculiarity of the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and @code{texinfo-format-region} commands is that they do not indent (nor fill) paragraphs that contain @code{@@w} or @code{@@*} commands. -@xref{Refilling Paragraphs}, for a detailed description of what goes -on.@refill +@xref{Refilling Paragraphs}, for further information. -@node End of Header, , paragraphindent, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node exampleindent +@subsection @code{@@exampleindent}: Environment Indenting +@cindex Indenting environments +@cindex Environment indentation +@cindex Example indentation +@findex exampleindent + +The Texinfo processors indent each line of @code{@@example} and similar +environments. You can use the @code{@@exampleindent} command to specify +this indentation. Write an @code{@@exampleindent} command at the +beginning of a line followed by either @samp{asis} or a number: + +@example +@@exampleindent @var{indent} +@end example + +The indentation is according to the value of @var{indent}: + +@table @asis +@item @code{asis} +Do not change the existing indentation (not implemented in @TeX{}). + +@item 0 +Omit all indentation. + +@item @var{n} +Indent environments by @var{n} space characters in Info output, by +@var{n} ems in @TeX{}. + +@end table + +The default value of @var{indent} is 5. @code{@@exampleindent} is +ignored for HTML output. + +Write the @code{@@exampleindent} command before or shortly after the +end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. (If you write +the command between the start-of-header and end-of-header lines, the +region formatting commands indent examples as specified.) + + +@node End of Header @subsection End of Header @cindex End of header line @@ -2930,8 +3058,8 @@ variables that you can change.@refill @xref{Start of Header}. @end iftex -@node Info Summary and Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Header, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Info Summary and Permissions @section Summary and Copying Permissions for Info The title page and the copyright page appear only in the printed copy of @@ -2958,8 +3086,8 @@ node. This mean that a reader does @emph{not} see this text when reading the file using Info, except when using the advanced Info command @kbd{g *}. -@node Titlepage & Copyright Page, The Top Node, Info Summary and Permissions, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Titlepage & Copyright Page @section The Title and Copyright Pages A manual's name and author are usually printed on a title page. @@ -2973,6 +3101,12 @@ obscure @TeX{} typesetting commands that cannot be used in an Info file. In addition, this part of the beginning of a Texinfo file contains the text of the copying permissions that will appear in the printed manual.@refill +@cindex Titlepage, for plain text +You may wish to include titlepage-like information for plain text +output. Simply place any such leading material between @code{@@ifinfo} +and @code{@@end ifinfo}; @command{makeinfo} includes this in its plain +text output. It will not show up in the Info readers. + @xref{Titlepage Permissions, , Titlepage Copying Permissions}, for the standard text for the copyright permissions.@refill @@ -2990,6 +3124,7 @@ standard text for the copyright permissions.@refill and double or single sided printing. @end menu + @node titlepage, titlefont center sp, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Titlepage & Copyright Page @comment node-name, next, previous, up @subsection @code{@@titlepage} @@ -3002,53 +3137,57 @@ with @code{@@titlepage} on a line by itself and end it with The @code{@@end titlepage} command starts a new page and turns on page numbering. (@xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for details about how to -generate page headings.) All the material that you want to -appear on unnumbered pages should be put between the -@code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} commands. By using the -@code{@@page} command you can force a page break within the region -delineated by the @code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} -commands and thereby create more than one unnumbered page. This is -how the copyright page is produced. (The @code{@@titlepage} command -might perhaps have been better named the -@code{@@titleandadditionalpages} command, but that would have been -rather long!)@refill - -@c !!! append refill to footnote when makeinfo can handle it. +generate page headings.) All the material that you want to appear on +unnumbered pages should be put between the @code{@@titlepage} and +@code{@@end titlepage} commands. You can force the table of contents to +appear there with the @code{@@setcontentsaftertitlepage} command +(@pxref{Contents}). + +@findex page@r{, within @code{@@titlepage}} +By using the @code{@@page} command you can force a page break within the +region delineated by the @code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} +commands and thereby create more than one unnumbered page. This is how +the copyright page is produced. (The @code{@@titlepage} command might +perhaps have been better named the @code{@@titleandadditionalpages} +command, but that would have been rather long!) + When you write a manual about a computer program, you should write the -version of the program to which the manual applies on the title -page. If the manual changes more frequently than the program or is -independent of it, you should also include an edition -number@footnote{We have found that it is helpful to refer to versions -of manuals as `editions' and versions of programs as `versions'; -otherwise, we find we are liable to confuse each other in conversation -by referring to both the documentation and the software with the same -words.} for the manual. This helps readers keep track of which manual -is for which version of the program. (The `Top' node -should also contain this information; see @ref{makeinfo top, , -@code{@@top}}.)@refill +version of the program to which the manual applies on the title page. +If the manual changes more frequently than the program or is independent +of it, you should also include an edition number@footnote{We have found +that it is helpful to refer to versions of manuals as `editions' and +versions of programs as `versions'; otherwise, we find we are liable to +confuse each other in conversation by referring to both the +documentation and the software with the same words.} for the manual. +This helps readers keep track of which manual is for which version of +the program. (The `Top' node should also contain this information; see +@ref{makeinfo top, , @code{@@top}}.) Texinfo provides two main methods for creating a title page. One method uses the @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@sp}, and @code{@@center} commands to generate a title page in which the words on the page are -centered.@refill +centered. The second method uses the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and @code{@@author} commands to create a title page with black rules under the title and author lines and the subtitle text set flush to the right hand side of the page. With this method, you do not specify any of the actual formatting of the title page. You specify the text -you want, and Texinfo does the formatting. You may use either -method.@refill +you want, and Texinfo does the formatting. + +You may use either method, or you may combine them; see the examples in +the sections below. @findex shorttitlepage -For extremely simple applications, Texinfo also provides a command -@code{@@shorttitlepage} which takes a single argument as the title. -The argument is typeset on a page by itself and followed by a blank -page. +@cindex Bastard title page +@cindex Title page, bastard +For extremely simple applications, and for the bastard title page in +traditional book front matter, Texinfo also provides a command +@code{@@shorttitlepage} which takes a single argument as the title. The +argument is typeset on a page by itself and followed by a blank page. -@node titlefont center sp, title subtitle author, titlepage, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node titlefont center sp @subsection @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@center}, and @code{@@sp} @findex titlefont @findex center @@ -3059,7 +3198,8 @@ commands to create a title page for a printed document. (This is the first of the two methods for creating a title page in Texinfo.)@refill Use the @code{@@titlefont} command to select a large font suitable for -the title itself.@refill +the title itself. You can use @code{@@titlefont} more than once if you +have an especially long title. @need 700 For example: @@ -3106,10 +3246,10 @@ A template for this method looks like this:@refill @end group @end example -The spacing of the example fits an 8 1/2 by 11 inch manual.@refill +The spacing of the example fits an 8.5 by 11 inch manual.@refill -@node title subtitle author, Copyright & Permissions, titlefont center sp, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node title subtitle author @subsection @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and @code{@@author} @findex title @findex subtitle @@ -3118,9 +3258,8 @@ The spacing of the example fits an 8 1/2 by 11 inch manual.@refill You can use the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and @code{@@author} commands to create a title page in which the vertical and horizontal spacing is done for you automatically. This contrasts with the method -described in -the previous section, in which the @code{@@sp} command is needed to -adjust vertical spacing.@refill +described in the previous section, in which the @code{@@sp} command is +needed to adjust vertical spacing. Write the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, or @code{@@author} commands at the beginning of a line followed by the title, subtitle, @@ -3128,7 +3267,11 @@ or author.@refill The @code{@@title} command produces a line in which the title is set flush to the left-hand side of the page in a larger than normal font. -The title is underlined with a black rule.@refill +The title is underlined with a black rule. Only a single line is +allowed; the @code{@@*} command may not be used to break the title into +two lines. To handle very long titles, you may find it profitable to +use both @code{@@title} and @code{@@titlefont}; see the final example in +this section. The @code{@@subtitle} command sets subtitles in a normal-sized font flush to the right-hand side of the page.@refill @@ -3178,29 +3321,28 @@ A template for this method looks like this:@refill @end group @end example -@ifinfo -@noindent -Contrast this form with the form of a title page written using the -@code{@@sp}, @code{@@center}, and @code{@@titlefont} commands:@refill +You may also combine the @code{@@titlefont} method described in the +previous section and @code{@@title} method described in this one. This +may be useful if you have a very long title. Here is a real-life example: @example +@group @@titlepage -@@sp 10 -@@center @@titlefont@{Name of Manual When Printed@} -@@sp 2 -@@center Subtitle, If Any +@@titlefont@{GNU Software@} @@sp 1 -@@center Second subtitle -@@sp 2 -@@center Author -@@page -@dots{} -@@end titlepage +@@title for MS-Windows and MS-DOS +@@subtitle Edition @@value@{edition@} for Release @@value@{cd-edition@} +@@author by Daniel Hagerty, Melissa Weisshaus +@@author and Eli Zaretskii +@end group @end example -@end ifinfo -@node Copyright & Permissions, end titlepage, title subtitle author, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@noindent +(The use of @code{@@value} here is explained in @ref{value +Example,,@code{@@value} Example}.) + + +@node Copyright & Permissions @subsection Copyright Page and Permissions @cindex Copyright page @cindex Printed permissions @@ -3247,19 +3389,17 @@ Copyright @copyright{} @var{year} @var{copyright-owner} @end example It is customary to put information on how to get a manual after the -copyright notice, followed by the copying permissions for the -manual.@refill +copyright notice, followed by the copying permissions for the manual. -Note that permissions must be given here as well as in the summary -segment within @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} that -immediately follows the header since this text appears only in the -printed manual and the @samp{ifinfo} text appears only in the Info -file.@refill +Permissions must be given here as well as in the summary segment within +@code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} that immediately follows the +header since this text appears only in the printed manual and the +@samp{ifinfo} text appears only in the Info file. @xref{Sample Permissions}, for the standard text.@refill -@node end titlepage, headings on off, Copyright & Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node end titlepage @subsection Heading Generation @findex end titlepage @cindex Headings, page, begin to appear @@ -3326,6 +3466,7 @@ Turn on page headings appropriate for single-sided printing. @refill @item @@headings double +@itemx @@headings on Turn on page headings appropriate for double-sided printing. The two commands, @code{@@headings on} and @code{@@headings double}, are synonymous.@refill @@ -3364,8 +3505,8 @@ headings.@refill You can also specify your own style of page heading and footing. @xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for more information.@refill -@node The Top Node, Software Copying Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node The Top Node @section The `Top' Node and Master Menu @cindex @samp{@r{Top}} node @cindex Master menu @@ -3392,10 +3533,9 @@ strictly speaking, you are not required to enclose these parts between * Master Menu Parts:: A master menu has three or more parts. @end menu -@node Title of Top Node, Master Menu Parts, The Top Node, The Top Node -@ifinfo -@subheading `Top' Node Title -@end ifinfo + +@node Title of Top Node +@subsection `Top' Node Title Sometimes, you will want to place an @code{@@top} sectioning command line containing the title of the document immediately after the @@ -3411,7 +3551,7 @@ version information. It looks like this:@refill @dots{} @@end titlepage -@@ifinfo +@@ifnottex @@node Top, Copying, , (dir) @@top Texinfo @@ -3421,7 +3561,7 @@ Texinfo is a documentation system@dots{} @group This is edition@dots{} @dots{} -@@end ifinfo +@@end ifnottex @end group @group @@ -3558,10 +3698,10 @@ Usually, an introduction is put in an @code{@@unnumbered} section. @cindex File ending @findex bye -The end of a Texinfo file should include the commands that create -indices and generate detailed and summary tables of contents. -And it must include the @code{@@bye} command that marks the last line -processed by @TeX{}.@refill +The end of a Texinfo file should include commands to create indices and +(usually) to generate detailed and summary tables of contents. And it +must include the @code{@@bye} command that marks the last line processed +by @TeX{}.@refill @need 700 For example: @@ -3601,7 +3741,7 @@ accumulated. To generate an index, you must include the @code{@@printindex} command at the place in the document where you want the index to appear. Also, as part of the process of creating a printed manual, you must run a program called @code{texindex} -(@pxref{Format/Print Hardcopy}) to sort the raw data to produce a sorted +(@pxref{Hardcopy}) to sort the raw data to produce a sorted index file. The sorted index file is what is actually used to print the index.@refill @@ -3661,52 +3801,35 @@ For example: @@printindex cp @end group - -@group -@@summarycontents -@@contents -@@bye -@end group @end smallexample @noindent -(Readers often prefer that the concept index come last in a book, -since that makes it easiest to find.)@refill +Readers often prefer that the concept index come last in a book, +since that makes it easiest to find. Having just one index helps +readers also, since then they have only one place to look +(@pxref{synindex}). -@ignore -@c TeX can do sorting, just not conveniently enough to handle sorting -@c Texinfo indexes. --karl, 5may97. -In @TeX{}, the @code{@@printindex} command needs a sorted index file -to work from. @TeX{} does not know how to do sorting; this is a -deficiency. @TeX{} writes output files of raw index data; use the -@code{texindex} program to convert these files to sorted index files. -(@xref{Format/Print Hardcopy}, for more information.)@refill -@end ignore - -@node Contents, File End, Printing Indices & Menus, Ending a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node Contents @section Generating a Table of Contents @cindex Table of contents @cindex Contents, Table of +@cindex Short table of contents @findex contents @findex summarycontents @findex shortcontents The @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and other structuring commands supply the information to make up a table of contents, but they do not -cause an actual table to appear in the manual. To do this, you must -use the @code{@@contents} and @code{@@summarycontents} -commands:@refill +cause an actual table to appear in the manual. To do this, you must use +the @code{@@contents} and/or @code{@@summarycontents} command(s). @table @code @item @@contents Generate a table of contents in a printed manual, including all chapters, sections, subsections, etc., as well as appendices and unnumbered chapters. (Headings generated by the @code{@@heading} -series of commands do not appear in the table of contents.) The -@code{@@contents} command should be written on a line by -itself.@refill +series of commands do not appear in the table of contents.) @item @@shortcontents @itemx @@summarycontents @@ -3718,42 +3841,55 @@ chapters (and appendices and unnumbered chapters). Omit sections, subsections and subsubsections. Only a long manual needs a short table of contents in addition to the full table of contents.@refill -Write the @code{@@shortcontents} command on a line by itself right -@emph{before} the @code{@@contents} command.@refill @end table -The table of contents commands automatically generate a chapter-like -heading at the top of the first table of contents page. Write the table -of contents commands at the very end of a Texinfo file, just before the -@code{@@bye} command, following any index sections---anything in the -Texinfo file after the table of contents commands will be omitted from -the table of contents.@refill - -When you print a manual with a table of contents, the table of -contents are printed last and numbered with roman numerals. You need -to place those pages in their proper place, after the title page, -yourself. (This is the only collating you need to do for a printed -manual. The table of contents is printed last because it is generated -after the rest of the manual is typeset.)@refill - -@need 700 -Here is an example of where to write table of contents commands:@refill - -@example -@group -@var{indices}@dots{} -@@shortcontents -@@contents -@@bye -@end group -@end example +Both contents commands should be written on a line by themselves. +The contents commands automatically generate a chapter-like heading at +the top of the first table of contents page, so don't include any +sectioning command such as @code{@@unnumbered} before them. Since an Info file uses menus instead of tables of contents, the Info -formatting commands ignore the @code{@@contents} and -@code{@@shortcontents} commands.@refill - -@node File End, , Contents, Ending a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +formatting commands ignore the contents commands. But the contents are +included in plain text output (generated by @code{makeinfo --no-headers}). + +The contents commands can be placed either at the very end of the file, +after any indices (see the previous section) and just before the +@code{@@bye} (see the next section), or near the beginning of the file, +after the @code{@@end titlepage} (@pxref{titlepage}). The advantage to +the former is that then the contents output is always up to date, +because it reflects the processing just done. The advantage to the +latter is that the contents are printed in the proper place, thus you do +not need to rearrange the DVI file with @command{dviselect} or shuffle +paper. However, contents commands at the beginning of the document are +ignored when outputting to standard output. + +@findex setcontentsaftertitlepage +@findex setshortcontentsaftertitlepage +@cindex Contents, after title page +@cindex Table of contents, after title page +As an author, you can put the contents commands wherever you prefer. +But if you are a user simply printing a manual, you may wish to print +the contents after the title page even if the author put the contents +commands at the end of the document (as is the case in most existing +Texinfo documents). You can do this by specifying +@code{@@setcontentsaftertitlepage} and/or +@code{@@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage}. The first prints only the main +contents after the @code{@@end titlepage}; the second prints both the +short contents and the main contents. In either case, any subsequent +@code{@@contents} or @code{@@shortcontents} is ignored (unless no +@code{@@end titlepage} is ever encountered). + +You need to include the @code{@@set@dots{}contentsaftertitlepage} +commands early in the document (just after @code{@@setfilename}, for +example). Or, if you're using @command{texi2dvi} (@pxref{Format with +texi2dvi}), you can use its @option{--texinfo} option to specify this +without altering the source file at all. For example: +@example +texi2dvi --texinfo=@@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage foo.texi +@end example + + +@node File End @section @code{@@bye} File Ending @findex bye @@ -3768,8 +3904,8 @@ manual; it is as if text after @code{@@bye} were within @code{@@ignore} with a local variables list. @xref{Compile-Command, , Using Local Variables and the Compile Command}, for more information.@refill -@node Structuring, Nodes, Ending a File, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Structuring @chapter Chapter Structuring @cindex Chapter structuring @cindex Structuring of chapters @@ -3808,8 +3944,8 @@ heading at the top of each node---but you don't need to.@refill * Raise/lower sections:: How to change commands' hierarchical level. @end menu -@node Tree Structuring, Structuring Command Types, Structuring, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Tree Structuring @section Tree Structure of Sections @cindex Tree structuring @@ -3852,9 +3988,9 @@ The chapter structuring commands are described in the sections that follow; the @code{@@node} and @code{@@menu} commands are described in following chapters. (@xref{Nodes}, and see @ref{Menus}.)@refill -@node Structuring Command Types, makeinfo top, Tree Structuring, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Types of Structuring Commands + +@node Structuring Command Types +@section Structuring Command Types The chapter structuring commands fall into four groups or series, each of which contains structuring commands corresponding to the @@ -3899,119 +4035,43 @@ start new pages in the printed manual; the @code{@@heading} commands do not.@refill @end itemize -@need 1000 Here are the four groups of chapter structuring commands:@refill -@c Slightly different formatting for regular sized books and smallbooks. -@ifset smallbook -@sp 1 -@tex -{\let\rm=\indrm \let\tt=\indtt -\halign{\hskip\itemindent#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil& -\hskip.5em#\hfil\cr - -& & & \rm No new pages\cr -\rm Numbered& \rm Unnumbered& \rm Lettered and numbered& \rm Unnumbered\cr -\rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm Not in contents\cr - -& & & \cr - & \tt @@top& & \tt @@majorheading\cr -\tt @@chapter& \tt @@unnumbered& \tt @@appendix& \tt @@chapheading\cr -\tt @@section& \tt @@unnumberedsec& \tt @@appendixsec& \tt @@heading\cr -\tt @@subsection&\tt @@unnumberedsubsec&\tt @@appendixsubsec& -\tt @@subheading\cr -\tt @@subsubsection& \tt @@unnumberedsubsubsec& \tt @@appendixsubsubsec& -\tt @@subsubheading\cr}} -@end tex -@end ifset -@ifclear smallbook -@sp 1 -@tex -\vbox{ -\halign{\hskip\itemindent\hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil& -\hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em #\hfil\cr - -& & & \cr -& & & \rm No new pages\cr -\rm Numbered& \rm Unnumbered& \rm Lettered and numbered& \rm Unnumbered\cr -\rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm Not in contents\cr - -& & & \cr - & \tt @@top& & \tt @@majorheading\cr -\tt @@chapter& \tt @@unnumbered& \tt @@appendix& \tt @@chapheading\cr -\tt @@section& \tt @@unnumberedsec& \tt @@appendixsec& \tt @@heading\cr -\tt @@subsection&\tt @@unnumberedsubsec&\tt @@appendixsubsec& -\tt @@subheading\cr -\tt @@subsubsection& \tt @@unnumberedsubsubsec& \tt @@appendixsubsubsec& -\tt @@subsubheading\cr}} -@end tex -@end ifclear -@ifinfo -@example -@group - @r{No new pages} -@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered} -@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in contents} - - @@top @@majorheading -@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading -@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading -@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading -@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading -@end group -@end example -@end ifinfo +@multitable @columnfractions .19 .30 .29 .22 + +@item @tab @tab @tab No new page +@item Numbered @tab Unnumbered @tab Lettered and numbered + @tab Unnumbered +@item In contents @tab In contents @tab In contents @tab Not in contents +@item @tab @code{@@top} @tab + @tab @code{@@majorheading} +@item @code{@@chapter} @tab @code{@@unnumbered} @tab @code{@@appendix} + @tab @code{@@chapheading} +@item @code{@@section} @tab @code{@@unnumberedsec} @tab @code{@@appendixsec} + @tab @code{@@heading} +@item @code{@@subsection} @tab @code{@@unnumberedsubsec} @tab @code{@@appendixsubsec} + @tab @code{@@subheading} +@item @code{@@subsubsection} @tab @code{@@unnumberedsubsubsec} @tab @code{@@appendixsubsubsec} + @tab @code{@@subsubheading} +@end multitable -@c Cannot line up columns properly inside of an example because of roman -@c proportional fonts. -@ignore -@ifset smallbook -@iftex -@smallexample -@group - @r{No new pages} -@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered} -@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in contents} - - @@top @@majorheading -@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading -@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading -@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading -@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading -@end group -@end smallexample -@end iftex -@end ifset -@ifclear smallbook -@iftex -@smallexample -@group - @r{No new pages} -@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered} -@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in contents} - - @@top @@majorheading -@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading -@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading -@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading -@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading -@end group -@end smallexample -@end iftex -@end ignore -@node makeinfo top, chapter, Structuring Command Types, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node makeinfo top @section @code{@@top} The @code{@@top} command is a special sectioning command that you use only after an @samp{@@node Top} line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. -The @code{@@top} command tells the @code{makeinfo} formatter -which node is the `Top' -node. It has the same typesetting effect as @code{@@unnumbered} -(@pxref{unnumbered & appendix, , @code{@@unnumbered}, @code{@@appendix}}). -For detailed information, see -@ref{makeinfo top command, , The @code{@@top} Command}.@refill +The @code{@@top} command tells the @code{makeinfo} formatter which node +is the `Top' node, so it can use it as the root of the node tree if your +manual uses implicit pointers. It has the same typesetting effect as +@code{@@unnumbered} (@pxref{unnumbered & appendix, , @code{@@unnumbered} +and @code{@@appendix}}). For detailed information, see @ref{makeinfo +top command, , The @code{@@top} Command}. + +The @code{@@top} node and its menu (if any) is conventionally wrapped in +an @code{@@ifnottex} conditional so that it will appear only in Info and +HTML output, not @TeX{}. + @node chapter, unnumbered & appendix, makeinfo top, Structuring @comment node-name, next, previous, up @@ -4049,9 +4109,8 @@ This kind of stylistic choice is not usually offered by Texinfo. @c but the Hacker's Dictionary wanted it ... -@node unnumbered & appendix, majorheading & chapheading, chapter, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@unnumbered}, @code{@@appendix} +@node unnumbered & appendix +@section @code{@@unnumbered} and @code{@@appendix} @findex unnumbered @findex appendix @@ -4346,12 +4405,11 @@ An attempt to raise above `chapters' reproduces chapter commands; an attempt to lower below `subsubsections' reproduces subsubsection commands. -@node Nodes, Menus, Structuring, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node Nodes @chapter Nodes @dfn{Nodes} are the primary segments of a Texinfo file. They do not -themselves impose a hierarchic or any other kind of structure on a file. +themselves impose a hierarchical or any other kind of structure on a file. Nodes contain @dfn{node pointers} that name other nodes, and can contain @dfn{menus} which are lists of nodes. In Info, the movement commands can carry you to a pointed-to node or to a node listed in a menu. Node @@ -4363,17 +4421,17 @@ books.@refill * Two Paths:: Different commands to structure Info output and printed output. * Node Menu Illustration:: A diagram, and sample nodes and menus. -* node:: How to write a node, in detail. -* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: How to create node pointers with @code{makeinfo}. +* node:: Creating nodes, in detail. +* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: Letting makeinfo determine node pointers. +* anchor:: Defining arbitrary cross-reference targets. @end menu -@node Two Paths, Node Menu Illustration, Nodes, Nodes -@ifinfo -@heading Two Paths -@end ifinfo + +@node Two Paths +@section Two Paths The node and menu commands and the chapter structuring commands are -independent of each other: +technically independent of each other: @itemize @bullet @item @@ -4390,26 +4448,26 @@ information for cross references; they do nothing else.@refill You can use node pointers and menus to structure an Info file any way you want; and you can write a Texinfo file so that its Info output has a -different structure than its printed output. However, most Texinfo -files are written such that the structure for the Info output -corresponds to the structure for the printed output. It is not -convenient to do otherwise.@refill +different structure than its printed output. However, virtually all +Texinfo files are written such that the structure for the Info output +corresponds to the structure for the printed output. It is neither +convenient nor understandable to the reader to do otherwise.@refill Generally, printed output is structured in a tree-like hierarchy in which the chapters are the major limbs from which the sections branch out. Similarly, node pointers and menus are organized to create a matching structure in the Info output.@refill -@node Node Menu Illustration, node, Two Paths, Nodes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Node Menu Illustration @section Node and Menu Illustration Here is a copy of the diagram shown earlier that illustrates a Texinfo file with three chapters, each of which contains two sections.@refill -Note that the ``root'' is at the top of the diagram and the ``leaves'' -are at the bottom. This is how such a diagram is drawn conventionally; -it illustrates an upside-down tree. For this reason, the root node is +The ``root'' is at the top of the diagram and the ``leaves'' are at the +bottom. This is how such a diagram is drawn conventionally; it +illustrates an upside-down tree. For this reason, the root node is called the `Top' node, and `Up' node pointers carry you closer to the root.@refill @@ -4425,35 +4483,36 @@ root.@refill | | | | | | Section Section Section Section Section Section 1.1 1.2 2.1 2.2 3.1 3.2 - @end group @end example -Write the beginning of the node for Chapter 2 like this:@refill +The fully-written command to start Chapter 2 would be this: @example @group -@@node Chapter 2, Chapter 3, Chapter 1, top +@@node Chapter 2, Chapter 3, Chapter 1, Top @@comment node-name, next, previous, up @end group @end example @noindent -This @code{@@node} line says that the name of this node is ``Chapter 2'', the -name of the `Next' node is ``Chapter 3'', the name of the `Previous' -node is ``Chapter 1'', and the name of the `Up' node is ``Top''. +This @code{@@node} line says that the name of this node is ``Chapter +2'', the name of the `Next' node is ``Chapter 3'', the name of the +`Previous' node is ``Chapter 1'', and the name of the `Up' node is +``Top''. You can omit writing out these node names if your document is +hierarchically organized (@pxref{makeinfo Pointer Creation}), but the +pointer relationships still obtain. @quotation @strong{Please Note:} `Next' refers to the next node at the same hierarchical level in the manual, not necessarily to the next node within the Texinfo file. In the Texinfo file, the subsequent node may -be at a lower level---a section-level node may follow a chapter-level -node, and a subsection-level node may follow a section-level node. -`Next' and `Previous' refer to nodes at the @emph{same} hierarchical -level. (The `Top' node contains the exception to this rule. Since the -`Top' node is the only node at that level, `Next' refers to the first -following node, which is almost always a chapter or chapter-level -node.)@refill +be at a lower level---a section-level node most often follows a +chapter-level node, for example. `Next' and `Previous' refer to nodes +at the @emph{same} hierarchical level. (The `Top' node contains the +exception to this rule. Since the `Top' node is the only node at that +level, `Next' refers to the first following node, which is almost always +a chapter or chapter-level node.)@refill @end quotation To go to Sections 2.1 and 2.2 using Info, you need a menu inside Chapter @@ -4506,11 +4565,13 @@ line, an @code{@@chapter} line, and then by indexing lines.@refill @end group @end example -@node node, makeinfo Pointer Creation, Node Menu Illustration, Nodes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node node @section The @code{@@node} Command @cindex Node, defined +@findex node + A @dfn{node} is a segment of text that begins at an @code{@@node} command and continues until the next @code{@@node} command. The definition of node is different from that for chapter or section. A @@ -4525,19 +4586,23 @@ several nodes, one for each section, subsection, and subsubsection.@refill To create a node, write an @code{@@node} command at the beginning of a -line, and follow it with four arguments, separated by commas, on the -rest of the same line. These arguments are the name of the node, and -the names of the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, in that order. -You may insert spaces before each pointer if you wish; the spaces are -ignored. You must write the name of the node, and the names of the -`Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, all on the same line. Otherwise, +line, and follow it with up to four arguments, separated by commas, on +the rest of the same line. The first argument is required; it is the +name of this node. The subsequent arguments are the names of the +`Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, in that order, and may be omitted +if your Texinfo document is hierarchically organized (@pxref{makeinfo +Pointer Creation}). + +You may insert spaces before each name if you wish; the spaces are +ignored. You must write the name of the node and the names of the +`Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers all on the same line. Otherwise, the formatters fail. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, for more information -about nodes in Info.)@refill +about nodes in Info.) Usually, you write one of the chapter-structuring command lines immediately after an @code{@@node} line---for example, an @code{@@section} or @code{@@subsection} line. (@xref{Structuring -Command Types, , Types of Structuring Commands}.)@refill +Command Types}.) @quotation @strong{Please note:} The GNU Emacs Texinfo mode updating commands work @@ -4549,8 +4614,8 @@ structuring lines. @xref{Updating Requirements}.@refill references. For this reason, you must write @code{@@node} lines in a Texinfo file that you intend to format for printing, even if you do not intend to format it for Info. (Cross references, such as the one at the -end of this sentence, are made with @code{@@xref} and its related -commands; see @ref{Cross References}.)@refill +end of this sentence, are made with @code{@@xref} and related commands; +see @ref{Cross References}.)@refill @menu * Node Names:: How to choose node and pointer names. @@ -4562,11 +4627,11 @@ commands; see @ref{Cross References}.)@refill * Top Node Summary:: Write a brief description for readers. @end menu -@node Node Names, Writing a Node, node, node -@ifinfo -@subheading Choosing Node and Pointer Names -@end ifinfo +@node Node Names +@subsection Choosing Node and Pointer Names + +@cindex Node names, choosing The name of a node identifies the node. The pointers enable you to reach other nodes and consist of the names of those nodes.@refill @@ -4586,8 +4651,14 @@ Also, it is helpful to include a brief description of the manual in the `Top' node. @xref{First Node}, for information on how to write the first node of a Texinfo file.@refill -@node Writing a Node, Node Line Tips, Node Names, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +Even when you explicitly specify all pointers, that does not mean you +can write the nodes in the Texinfo source file in an arbitrary order! +Because @TeX{} processes the file sequentially, irrespective of node +pointers, you must write the nodes in the order you wish them to appear +in the printed output. + + +@node Writing a Node @subsection How to Write an @code{@@node} Line @cindex Writing an @code{@@node} line @cindex @code{@@node} line writing @@ -4615,8 +4686,8 @@ their proper order. The comment line helps you keep track of which arguments are for which pointers. This comment line is especially useful if you are not familiar with Texinfo.@refill -The template for a node line with `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers -looks like this:@refill +The template for a fully-written-out node line with `Next', `Previous', +and `Up' pointers looks like this:@refill @example @@node @var{node-name}, @var{next}, @var{previous}, @var{up} @@ -4624,22 +4695,21 @@ looks like this:@refill If you wish, you can ignore @code{@@node} lines altogether in your first draft and then use the @code{texinfo-insert-node-lines} command to -create @code{@@node} lines for you. However, we do not -recommend this practice. It is better to name the node itself -at the same time that you -write a segment so you can easily make cross references. A large number -of cross references are an especially important feature of a good Info -file.@refill +create @code{@@node} lines for you. However, we do not recommend this +practice. It is better to name the node itself at the same time that +you write a segment so you can easily make cross references. A large +number of cross references are an especially important feature of a good +Info file. After you have inserted an @code{@@node} line, you should immediately write an @@-command for the chapter or section and insert its name. Next (and this is important!), put in several index entries. Usually, you will find at least two and often as many as four or five ways of referring to the node in the index. Use them all. This will make it -much easier for people to find the node.@refill +much easier for people to find the node. -@node Node Line Tips, Node Line Requirements, Writing a Node, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Node Line Tips @subsection @code{@@node} Line Tips Here are three suggestions: @@ -4663,8 +4733,8 @@ section or chapter titles---initial and significant words are capitalized; others are not.@refill @end itemize + @node Node Line Requirements, First Node, Node Line Tips, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up @subsection @code{@@node} Line Requirements @cindex Node line requirements @@ -4672,7 +4742,7 @@ Here are several requirements for @code{@@node} lines: @itemize @bullet @cindex Unique nodename requirement -@cindex Nodename must be unique +@cindex Node name must be unique @item All the node names for a single Info file must be unique.@refill @@ -4688,13 +4758,15 @@ different.@refill A pointer name must be the name of a node.@refill The node to which a pointer points may come before or after the -node containing the pointer.@refill +node containing the pointer. -@cindex @@-command in nodename -@cindex Nodename, cannot contain +@cindex @@-commands in nodename +@cindex Node name, should not contain @@-commands @item -You cannot use any of the Texinfo @@-commands in a node name; -@w{@@-commands} confuse Info.@refill +@w{@@-commands} used in node names generally confuse Info, so you should +avoid them. For a few rare cases when this is useful, Texinfo has +limited support for using @w{@@-commands} in node names; see +@ref{Pointer Validation}. @need 750 Thus, the beginning of the section called @code{@@chapter} looks like @@ -4709,11 +4781,15 @@ this:@refill @end group @end smallexample -@cindex Comma in nodename -@cindex Apostrophe in nodename @item -You cannot use commas or apostrophes within a node name; these -confuse @TeX{} or the Info formatters.@refill +@cindex Apostrophe in nodename +@cindex Colon in nodename +@cindex Comma in nodename +@cindex Period in nodename +@cindex Characters, invalid in node name +@cindex Invalid characters in node names +Unfortunately, you cannot use periods, commas, colons or apostrophes +within a node name; these confuse @TeX{} or the Info formatters.@refill @need 700 For example, the following is a section title: @@ -4832,69 +4908,100 @@ include an edition number for the manual. (The title page should also contain this information: see @ref{titlepage, , @code{@@titlepage}}.)@refill -@node makeinfo Pointer Creation, , node, Nodes +@node makeinfo Pointer Creation @section Creating Pointers with @code{makeinfo} @cindex Creating pointers with @code{makeinfo} @cindex Pointer creation with @code{makeinfo} @cindex Automatic pointer creation with @code{makeinfo} -The @code{makeinfo} program has a feature for automatically creating -node pointers for a hierarchically organized file that lacks -them.@refill +The @code{makeinfo} program has a feature for automatically defining +node pointers for a hierarchically organized file. When you take advantage of this feature, you do not need to write the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers after the name of a node. However, you must write a sectioning command, such as @code{@@chapter} or @code{@@section}, on the line immediately following each truncated -@code{@@node} line. You cannot write a comment line after a node -line; the section line must follow it immediately.@refill +@code{@@node} line (except that comment lines may intervene). -In addition, you must follow the `Top' @code{@@node} line with a line beginning -with @code{@@top} to mark the `Top' node in the file. @xref{makeinfo -top, , @code{@@top}}. +In addition, you must follow the `Top' @code{@@node} line with a line +beginning with @code{@@top} to mark the `Top' node in the +file. @xref{makeinfo top, , @code{@@top}}. Finally, you must write the name of each node (except for the `Top' node) in a menu that is one or more hierarchical levels above the -node's hierarchical level.@refill +node's hierarchical level. + +This node pointer insertion feature in @code{makeinfo} relieves you from +the need to update menus and pointers manually or with Texinfo mode +commands. (@xref{Updating Nodes and Menus}.) + + +@node anchor +@section @code{@@anchor}: Defining Arbitrary Cross-reference Targets + +@findex anchor +@cindex Anchors +@cindex Cross-reference targets, arbitrary +@cindex Targets for cross-references, arbitrary + +An @dfn{anchor} is a position in your document, labeled so that +cross-references can refer to it, just as they can to nodes. You create +an anchor with the @code{@@anchor} command, and give the label as a +normal brace-delimited argument. For example: + +@example +This marks the @@anchor@{x-spot@}spot. +@dots{} +@@xref@{x-spot,,the spot@}. +@end example + +@noindent produces: + +@example +This marks the spot. +@dots{} +See [the spot], page 1. +@end example + +As you can see, the @code{@@anchor} command itself produces no output. +This example defines an anchor `x-spot' just before the word `spot'. +You can refer to it later with an @code{@@xref} or other cross-reference +command, as shown. @xref{Cross References}, for details on the +cross-reference commands. + +It is best to put @code{@@anchor} commands just before the position you +wish to refer to; that way, the reader's eye is led on to the correct +text when they jump to the anchor. You can put the @code{@@anchor} +command on a line by itself if that helps readability of the source. +Spaces are always ignored after @code{@@anchor}. + +Anchor names and node names may not conflict. Anchors and nodes are +given similar treatment in some ways; for example, the @code{goto-node} +command in standalone Info takes either an anchor name or a node name as +an argument. (@xref{goto-node,,,info-stnd,GNU Info}.) -This node pointer insertion feature in @code{makeinfo} is an -alternative to the menu and pointer creation and update commands in -Texinfo mode. (@xref{Updating Nodes and Menus}.) It is especially -helpful to people who do not use GNU Emacs for writing Texinfo -documents.@refill -@node Menus, Cross References, Nodes, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node Menus @chapter Menus @cindex Menus @findex menu -@dfn{Menus} contain pointers to subordinate -nodes.@footnote{Menus can carry you to any node, regardless -of the hierarchical structure; even to nodes in a different -Info file. However, the GNU Emacs Texinfo mode updating -commands work only to create menus of subordinate nodes. -Conventionally, cross references are used to refer to other -nodes.} In Info, you use menus to go to such nodes. Menus -have no effect in printed manuals and do not appear in -them.@refill +@dfn{Menus} contain pointers to subordinate nodes.@footnote{Menus can +carry you to any node, regardless of the hierarchical structure; even to +nodes in a different Info file. However, the GNU Emacs Texinfo mode +updating commands work only to create menus of subordinate nodes. +Conventionally, cross references are used to refer to other nodes.} In +Info, you use menus to go to such nodes. Menus have no effect in +printed manuals and do not appear in them. By convention, a menu is put at the end of a node since a reader who -uses the menu may not see text that follows it.@refill - -@ifinfo -A node that has a menu should @emph{not} contain much text. If you -have a lot of text and a menu, move most of the text into a new -subnode---all but a few lines.@refill -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@emph{A node that has a menu should not contain much text.} If you -have a lot of text and a menu, move most of the text into a new -subnode---all but a few lines. Otherwise, a reader with a terminal -that displays only a few lines may miss the menu and its associated -text. As a practical matter, you should locate a menu within 20 lines -of the beginning of the node.@refill -@end iftex +uses the menu may not see text that follows it. Furthermore, a node +that has a menu should not contain much text. If you have a lot of text +and a menu, move most of the text into a new subnode---all but a few +lines. Otherwise, a reader with a terminal that displays only a few +lines may miss the menu and its associated text. As a practical matter, +you should locate a menu within 20 lines of the beginning of the +node. @menu * Menu Location:: Put a menu in a short node. @@ -4905,6 +5012,7 @@ of the beginning of the node.@refill * Other Info Files:: How to refer to a different Info file. @end menu + @node Menu Location, Writing a Menu, Menus, Menus @ifinfo @heading Menus Need Short Nodes @@ -4914,14 +5022,6 @@ of the beginning of the node.@refill @cindex Nodes for menus are short @cindex Short nodes for menus -@ifinfo -A reader can easily see a menu that is close to the beginning of the -node. The node should be short. As a practical matter, you should -locate a menu within 20 lines of the beginning of the node. -Otherwise, a reader with a terminal that displays only a few lines may -miss the menu and its associated text.@refill -@end ifinfo - The short text before a menu may look awkward in a printed manual. To avoid this, you can write a menu near the beginning of its node and follow the menu by an @code{@@node} line, and then an @code{@@heading} @@ -4953,7 +5053,8 @@ For example, the preceding two paragraphs follow an Info-only menu, The Texinfo file for this document contains more than a dozen examples of this procedure. One is at the beginning of this chapter; -another is at the beginning of the ``Cross References'' chapter.@refill +another is at the beginning of @ref{Cross References}. @refill + @node Writing a Menu, Menu Parts, Menu Location, Menus @section Writing a Menu @@ -4979,14 +5080,16 @@ Larger Units of Text @end group @end example -In a menu, every line that begins with an @w{@samp{* }} is a -@dfn{menu entry}. (Note the space after the asterisk.) A -line that does not start with an @w{@samp{* }} may also -appear in a menu. Such a line is not a menu entry but is a -menu comment line that appears in the Info file. In -the example above, the line @samp{Larger Units of Text} is a -menu comment line; the two lines starting with @w{@samp{* }} -are menu entries. +In a menu, every line that begins with an @w{@samp{* }} is a @dfn{menu +entry}. (Note the space after the asterisk.) A line that does not +start with an @w{@samp{* }} may also appear in a menu. Such a line is +not a menu entry but is a menu comment line that appears in the Info +file. In the example above, the line @samp{Larger Units of Text} is a +menu comment line; the two lines starting with @w{@samp{* }} are menu +@cindex Spaces, in menus +entries. Space characters in a menu are preserved as-is; this allows +you to format the menu as you wish. + @node Menu Parts, Less Cluttered Menu Entry, Writing a Menu, Menus @section The Parts of a Menu @@ -5195,20 +5298,20 @@ For example: not a Texinfo file, but a menu entry looks the same in both types of file.)@refill -Note that the GNU Emacs Texinfo mode menu updating commands only work -with nodes within the current buffer, so you cannot use them to create -menus that refer to other files. You must write such menus by hand.@refill +The GNU Emacs Texinfo mode menu updating commands only work with nodes +within the current buffer, so you cannot use them to create menus that +refer to other files. You must write such menus by hand. -@node Cross References, Marking Text, Menus, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Cross References @chapter Cross References @cindex Making cross references @cindex Cross references @cindex References @dfn{Cross references} are used to refer the reader to other parts of the -same or different Texinfo files. In Texinfo, nodes are the -places to which cross references can refer.@refill +same or different Texinfo files. In Texinfo, nodes and anchors are the +places to which cross references can refer. @menu * References:: What cross references are for. @@ -5234,7 +5337,7 @@ it.@refill However, in any document, some information will be too detailed for the current context, or incidental to it; use cross references to -provide access to such information. Also, an on-line help system or a +provide access to such information. Also, an online help system or a reference manual is not like a novel; few read such documents in sequence from beginning to end. Instead, people look up what they need. For this reason, such creations should contain many cross @@ -5249,15 +5352,16 @@ In Info, a cross reference results in an entry that you can follow using the Info @samp{f} command. (@inforef{Help-Adv, Some advanced Info commands, info}.)@refill -The various cross reference commands use nodes to define cross -reference locations. This is evident in Info, in which a cross -reference takes you to the specified node. @TeX{} also uses nodes to -define cross reference locations, but the action is less obvious. When -@TeX{} generates a DVI file, it records nodes' page numbers and -uses the page numbers in making references. Thus, if you are writing -a manual that will only be printed, and will not be used on-line, you -must nonetheless write @code{@@node} lines to name the places to which -you make cross references.@refill +The various cross reference commands use nodes (or anchors, +@pxref{anchor,,@code{@@anchor}}) to define cross reference locations. +This is evident in Info, in which a cross reference takes you to the +specified location. @TeX{} also uses nodes to define cross reference +locations, but the action is less obvious. When @TeX{} generates a DVI +file, it records each node's page number and uses the page numbers in making +references. Thus, if you are writing a manual that will only be +printed, and will not be used online, you must nonetheless write +@code{@@node} lines to name the places to which you make cross +references.@refill @need 800 @node Cross Reference Commands, Cross Reference Parts, References, Cross References @@ -5358,7 +5462,7 @@ The five possible arguments for a cross reference are:@refill @enumerate @item -The node name (required). This is the node to which the +The node or anchor name (required). This is the location to which the cross reference takes you. In a printed document, the location of the node provides the page reference only for references within the same document.@refill @@ -5448,16 +5552,16 @@ or like this @noindent In @TeX{}, a cross reference looks like this: -@example +@quotation See Section @var{section-number} [@var{node-name}], page @var{page}. -@end example +@end quotation @noindent or like this -@example +@quotation See Section @var{section-number} [@var{title-or-topic}], page @var{page}. -@end example +@end quotation The @code{@@xref} command does not generate a period or comma to end the cross reference in either the Info file or the printed output. @@ -5535,6 +5639,9 @@ which produces *Note Tropical Storms::, for more info. @end example +@noindent +and + @quotation See Section 3.1 [Tropical Storms], page 24, for more info. @end quotation @@ -5582,7 +5689,7 @@ See Section 5.2 [Electrical Effects], page 57. @noindent (Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a -period; and that the node name is printed, not the cross reference name.)@refill +period; and that the node name is printed, not the cross reference name.) You can write a clause after the cross reference, like this:@refill @@ -5624,7 +5731,7 @@ within a title or other section will divide it into two arguments. In a reference, you need to write a title such as ``Clouds, Mist, and Fog'' without the commas.@refill -Also, remember to write a comma or period after the closing brace of a +Also, remember to write a comma or period after the closing brace of an @code{@@xref} to terminate the cross reference. In the following examples, a clause follows a terminating comma.@refill @@ -5874,6 +5981,7 @@ This makes it useful as the last part of a sentence.@refill @noindent For example, +@cindex Hurricanes @example For more information, see @@ref@{Hurricanes@}. @end example @@ -5882,7 +5990,7 @@ For more information, see @@ref@{Hurricanes@}. produces @example -For more information, see *Note Hurricanes. +For more information, see *Note Hurricanes::. @end example @noindent @@ -5901,6 +6009,7 @@ both the printed and the Info format.@refill @noindent For example, +@cindex Sea surges @example @group Sea surges are described in @@ref@{Hurricanes@}. @@ -5924,12 +6033,13 @@ Sea surges are described in *Note Hurricanes::. @end example @quotation -@strong{Caution:} You @emph{must} write a period or comma immediately -after an @code{@@ref} command with two or more arguments. Otherwise, -Info will not find the end of the cross reference entry and its -attempt to follow the cross reference will fail. As a general rule, -you should write a period or comma after every @code{@@ref} command. -This looks best in both the printed and the Info output.@refill +@strong{Caution:} You @emph{must} write a period, comma, or right +parenthesis immediately after an @code{@@ref} command with two or more +arguments. Otherwise, Info will not find the end of the cross reference +entry and its attempt to follow the cross reference will fail. As a +general rule, you should write a period or comma after every +@code{@@ref} command. This looks best in both the printed and the Info +output.@refill @end quotation @node pxref, inforef, ref, Cross References @@ -5974,6 +6084,7 @@ of the output and not the other.@refill With one argument, a parenthetical cross reference looks like this:@refill +@cindex Flooding @example @dots{} storms cause flooding (@@pxref@{Hurricanes@}) @dots{} @end example @@ -6129,68 +6240,113 @@ refer to printed works for which no Info form exists. @xref{cite, , @code{@@cite}}.@refill -@node uref, , inforef, Cross References -@section @code{@@uref@{@var{url}[, @var{displayed-text}]@}} +@node uref +@section @code{@@uref@{@var{url}[, @var{text}][, @var{replacement}]@}} @findex uref @cindex Uniform resource locator, referring to @cindex URL, referring to -@code{@@uref} produces a reference to a uniform resource locator (URL). -It takes one mandatory argument, the URL, and one optional argument, the -text to display (the default is the URL itself). In HTML output, -@code{@@uref} produces a link you can follow. For example: +@cindex @code{href}, producing HTML +@code{@@uref} produces a reference to a uniform resource locator (url). +It takes one mandatory argument, the url, and two optional arguments +which control the text that is displayed. In HTML output, @code{@@uref} +produces a link you can follow. + +The second argument, if specified, is the text to display (the default +is the url itself); in Info and DVI output, but not in HTML output, the +url is also output. + +@cindex Man page, reference to +The third argument, on the other hand, if specified is also the text to +display, but the url is @emph{not} output in any format. This is useful +when the text is already sufficiently referential, as in a man page. If +the third argument is given, the second argument is ignored. + +The simple one argument form, where the url is both the target and the +text of the link: @example -The official GNU ftp site is -@@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu@} +The official GNU ftp site is @@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu@}. @end example -@noindent -produces (in text): +@noindent produces: @display -The official GNU ftp site is -@uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu} +The official GNU ftp site is @uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu}. @end display -@noindent -whereas + +An example of the two-argument form: @example -The official -@@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu, - GNU ftp site@} holds programs and texts. +The official @@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu, GNU ftp site@} holds +programs and texts. @end example -@noindent -produces (in text): +@noindent produces: @display -The official @uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu, GNU ftp site} holds +The official @uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu, GNU ftp site} holds programs and texts. @end display -@noindent -and (in HTML): +@noindent that is, the Info output is this: @example -The official GNU ftp -site holds programs and texts. +The official GNU ftp site (ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu) holds +programs and texts. @end example -To merely indicate a URL, use @code{@@url} (@pxref{url, @code{@@url}}). +@noindent and the HTML output is this: +@example +The official GNU ftp site holds +programs and texts. +@end example -@node Marking Text, Quotations and Examples, Cross References, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +An example of the three-argument form: +@example +The @@uref@{http://example.org/man.cgi/1/ls,,ls(1)@} program @dots{} +@end example + +@noindent produces: +@display +The @uref{http://example.org/man.cgi/1/ls,,ls(1)} program @dots{} +@end display + +@noindent but with HTML: +@example +The ls(1) program @dots{} +@end example + +To merely indicate a url without creating a link people can follow, use +@code{@@url} (@pxref{url, @code{@@url}}). + + +Some people prefer to display url's in the unambiguous format: + +@display + +@end display + +@noindent +@cindex }, since any software that tries to detect url's in text already +has to detect them without the @samp{} format if you wish.)@refill -@node file, dfn, var, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node env +@subsection @code{@@env}@{@var{environment-variable}@} +@findex env + +Use the @code{@@env} command to indicate environment variables, as used +by many operating systems, including GNU. Do not use it for +metasyntactic variables; use @code{@@var} instead (see the previous +section). + +@code{@@env} is equivalent to @code{@@code} in its effects. +For example: + +@example +The @@env@{PATH@} environment variable sets the search path for commands. +@end example +@noindent produces +@quotation +The @env{PATH} environment variable sets the search path for commands. +@end quotation + + +@node file @subsection @code{@@file}@{@var{file-name}@} @findex file @@ -6679,7 +6894,58 @@ The @file{.el} files are in the @file{/usr/local/emacs/lisp} directory. @end quotation -@node dfn, cite, file, Indicating + +@node command +@subsection @code{@@command}@{@var{command-name}@} +@findex command +@cindex Command names, indicating +@cindex Program names, indicating + +Use the @code{@@command} command to indicate command names, such as +@command{ls} or @command{cc}. + +@code{@@command} is equivalent to @code{@@code} in its effects. +For example: + +@example +The command @@command@{ls@} lists directory contents. +@end example +@noindent produces +@quotation +The command @command{ls} lists directory contents. +@end quotation + +You should write the name of a program in the ordinary text font, rather +than using @code{@@command}, if you regard it as a new English word, +such as `Emacs' or `Bison'. + +When writing an entire shell command invocation, as in @samp{ls -l}, +you should use either @code{@@samp} or @code{@@code} at your discretion. + + +@node option +@subsection @code{@@option}@{@var{option-name}@} +@findex option + +Use the @code{@@option} command to indicate a command-line option; for +example, @option{-l} or @option{--version} or +@option{--output=@var{filename}}. + +@code{@@option} is equivalent to @code{@@samp} in its effects. +For example: + +@example +The option @@option@{-l@} produces a long listing. +@end example +@noindent produces +@quotation +The option @option{-l} produces a long listing. +@end quotation + +In tables, putting options inside @code{@@code} produces a +more pleasing effect. + +@node dfn @comment node-name, next, previous, up @subsection @code{@@dfn}@{@var{term}@} @findex dfn @@ -6708,18 +6974,18 @@ term should be a definition of the term. The sentence does not need to say explicitly that it is a definition, but it should contain the information of a definition---it should make the meaning clear. -@node cite, url, dfn, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node cite @subsection @code{@@cite}@{@var{reference}@} @findex cite Use the @code{@@cite} command for the name of a book that lacks a -companion Info file. The command produces italics in the printed -manual, and quotation marks in the Info file.@refill +companion Info file. The command produces italics in the printed +manual, and quotation marks in the Info file. -(If a book is written in Texinfo, it is better to use a cross reference +If a book is written in Texinfo, it is better to use a cross reference command since a reader can easily follow such a reference in Info. -@xref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}.)@refill +@xref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}. + @ignore @c node ctrl, , cite, Indicating @@ -6771,27 +7037,50 @@ identify that control character: an uparrow followed by the character @end ignore -@node url, email, cite, Indicating +@node acronym +@subsection @code{@@acronym}@{@var{acronym}@} +@findex acronym + +@cindex NASA, as acronym +@cindex F.B.I., as acronym +@cindex Abbreviations, tagging +@cindex Acronyms, tagging +Use the @code{@@acronym} command for abbreviations written in all +capital letters, such as `@acronym{NASA}'. The abbreviation is given as +the single argument in braces, as in @samp{@@acronym@{NASA@}}. As +a matter of style, or for particular abbreviations, you may prefer to +use periods, as in @samp{@@acronym@{F.B.I.@}}. + +In @TeX{} and HTML, the argument is printed in a slightly smaller font +size. In Info or plain text output, this command changes nothing. + + +@node url @subsection @code{@@url}@{@var{uniform-resource-locator}@} @findex url @cindex Uniform resource locator, indicating @cindex URL, indicating -Use the @code{@@url} to indicate a uniform resource locator on the World -Wide Web. This is analogous to @code{@@file}, @code{@@var}, etc., and -is purely for markup purposes. It does not produce a link you can -follow in HTML output (the @code{@@uref} command does, @pxref{uref,, -@code{@@uref}}). It is useful for example URL's which do not actually -exist. For example: +Use the @code{@@url} command to indicate a uniform resource locator on +the World Wide Web. This is analogous to @code{@@file}, @code{@@var}, +etc., and is purely for markup purposes. It does not produce a link you +can follow in HTML output (use the @code{@@uref} command for that, +@pxref{uref,, @code{@@uref}}). It is useful for url's which do +not actually exist. For example: @c Two lines because one is too long for smallbook format. @example -For example, the url might be -@@url@{http://host.domain.org/path@}. +For example, the url might be @@url@{http://example.org/path@}. @end example +@noindent which produces: + +@display +For example, the url might be @url{http://example.org/path}. +@end display -@node email, , url, Indicating + +@node email @subsection @code{@@email}@{@var{email-address}[, @var{displayed-text}]@} @findex email @@ -6809,12 +7098,11 @@ For example: Send bug reports to @@email@{bug-texinfo@@@@gnu.org@}. Send suggestions to the @@email@{bug-texinfo@@@@gnu.org, same place@}. @end example -@noindent -produces -@example +@noindent produces +@display Send bug reports to @email{bug-texinfo@@gnu.org}. Send suggestions to the @email{bug-texinfo@@gnu.org, same place}. -@end example +@end display @node Emphasis, , Indicating, Marking Text @@ -6828,27 +7116,24 @@ Most often, this is the best way to mark words. However, sometimes you will want to emphasize text without indicating a category. Texinfo has two commands to do this. Also, Texinfo has several commands that specify the font in which @TeX{} will typeset -text. These commands have no affect on Info and only one of them, +text. These commands have no effect on Info and only one of them, the @code{@@r} command, has any regular use.@refill @menu * emph & strong:: How to emphasize text in Texinfo. * Smallcaps:: How to use the small caps font. * Fonts:: Various font commands for printed output. -* Customized Highlighting:: How to define highlighting commands. @end menu -@node emph & strong, Smallcaps, Emphasis, Emphasis -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node emph & strong @subsection @code{@@emph}@{@var{text}@} and @code{@@strong}@{@var{text}@} @cindex Emphasizing text, font for @findex emph @findex strong The @code{@@emph} and @code{@@strong} commands are for emphasis; -@code{@@strong} is stronger. In printed output, @code{@@emph} -produces @emph{italics} and @code{@@strong} produces -@strong{bold}.@refill +@code{@@strong} is stronger. In printed output, @code{@@emph} produces +@emph{italics} and @code{@@strong} produces @strong{bold}. @need 800 For example, @@ -6867,7 +7152,7 @@ files in the directory. produces the following in printed output: @quotation -@strong{Caution}: @code{rm * .[^.]*} removes @emph{all} +@strong{Caution}: @samp{rm * .[^.]*} removes @emph{all} files in the directory. @end quotation @@ -6880,7 +7165,7 @@ produces: @end ifinfo @example - *Caution*: `rm * .[^.]*' removes *all* + *Caution*: `rm * .[^.]*' removes _all_ files in the directory. @end example @@ -6888,31 +7173,25 @@ The @code{@@strong} command is seldom used except to mark what is, in effect, a typographical element, such as the word `Caution' in the preceding example. -In the Info file, both @code{@@emph} and @code{@@strong} put asterisks -around the text.@refill +In the Info output, @code{@@emph} surrounds the text with underscores +(@samp{_}), and @code{@@strong} puts asterisks around the text. @quotation -@strong{Caution:} Do not use @code{@@emph} or @code{@@strong} with the -word @samp{Note}; Info will mistake the combination for a cross -reference. Use a phrase such as @strong{Please note} or -@strong{Caution} instead.@refill +@strong{Caution:} Do not use @code{@@strong} with the word @samp{Note}; +Info will mistake the combination for a cross reference. Use a phrase +such as @strong{Please note} or @strong{Caution} instead. @end quotation -@node Smallcaps, Fonts, emph & strong, Emphasis + +@node Smallcaps @subsection @code{@@sc}@{@var{text}@}: The Small Caps Font @cindex Small caps font @findex sc @r{(small caps font)} -@iftex -Use the @samp{@@sc} command to set text in the printed output in @sc{a -small caps font} and set text in the Info file in upper case letters.@refill -@end iftex -@ifinfo -Use the @samp{@@sc} command to set text in the printed output in a -small caps font and set text in the Info file in upper case letters.@refill -@end ifinfo - -Write the text between braces in lower case, like this:@refill +Use the @samp{@@sc} command to set text in the printed and the HTML +output in @sc{a small caps font} and set text in the Info file in upper +case letters. Write the text you want to be in small caps (where +possible) between braces in lower case, like this: @example The @@sc@{acm@} and @@sc@{ieee@} are technical societies. @@ -6927,32 +7206,28 @@ The @sc{acm} and @sc{ieee} are technical societies. @TeX{} typesets the small caps font in a manner that prevents the letters from `jumping out at you on the page'. This makes small caps -text easier to read than text in all upper case. The Info formatting -commands set all small caps text in upper case.@refill +text easier to read than text in all upper case---but it's usually +better to use regular mixed case anyway. The Info formatting commands +set all small caps text in upper case. In HTML, the text is upper-cased +and a smaller font is used to render it. -@ifinfo -If the text between the braces of an @code{@@sc} command is upper case, -@TeX{} typesets in full-size capitals. Use full-size capitals -sparingly.@refill -@end ifinfo -@iftex -If the text between the braces of an @code{@@sc} command is upper case, -@TeX{} typesets in @sc{FULL-SIZE CAPITALS}. Use full-size capitals -sparingly.@refill -@end iftex +If the text between the braces of an @code{@@sc} command is uppercase, +@TeX{} typesets in FULL-SIZE CAPITALS. Use full-size capitals +sparingly, if ever, and since it's redundant to mark all-uppercase text +with @code{@@sc}, @command{makeinfo} warns about such usage. You may also use the small caps font for a jargon word such as -@sc{ato} (a @sc{nasa} word meaning `abort to orbit').@refill +@sc{ato} (a @sc{nasa} word meaning `abort to orbit'). There are subtleties to using the small caps font with a jargon word such as @sc{cdr}, a word used in Lisp programming. In this case, you should use the small caps font when the word refers to the second and subsequent elements of a list (the @sc{cdr} of the list), but you should use @samp{@@code} when the word refers to the Lisp function of -the same spelling.@refill +the same spelling. -@node Fonts, Customized Highlighting, Smallcaps, Emphasis -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Fonts @subsection Fonts for Printing, Not Info @cindex Fonts for printing, not for Info @findex i @r{(italic font)} @@ -6996,191 +7271,78 @@ If possible, you should avoid using the other three font commands. If you need to use one, it probably indicates a gap in the Texinfo language.@refill -@node Customized Highlighting, , Fonts, Emphasis -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Customized Highlighting -@cindex Highlighting, customized -@cindex Customized highlighting - -@c I think this whole section is obsolete with the advent of macros -@c --karl, 15sep96. -You can use regular @TeX{} commands inside of @code{@@iftex} @dots{} -@code{@@end iftex} to create your own customized highlighting commands -for Texinfo. The easiest way to do this is to equate your customized -commands with pre-existing commands, such as those for italics. Such -new commands work only with @TeX{}.@refill +@node Quotations and Examples +@chapter Quotations and Examples -@findex definfoenclose -@cindex Enclosure command for Info -You can use the @code{@@definfoenclose} command inside of -@code{@@ifinfo} @dots{} @code{@@end ifinfo} to define commands for Info -with the same names as new commands for @TeX{}. -@code{@@definfoenclose} creates new commands for Info that mark text by -enclosing it in strings that precede and follow the text. -@footnote{Currently, @code{@@definfoenclose} works only with -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} and @code{texinfo-format-region}, not with -@code{makeinfo}.}@refill +Quotations and examples are blocks of text consisting of one or more +whole paragraphs that are set off from the bulk of the text and +treated differently. They are usually indented.@refill -Here is how to create a new @@-command called @code{@@phoo} that causes -@TeX{} to typeset its argument in italics and causes Info to display the -argument between @samp{//} and @samp{\\}.@refill +In Texinfo, you always begin a quotation or example by writing an +@@-command at the beginning of a line by itself, and end it by writing +an @code{@@end} command that is also at the beginning of a line by +itself. For instance, you begin an example by writing @code{@@example} +by itself at the beginning of a line and end the example by writing +@code{@@end example} on a line by itself, at the beginning of that +line.@refill +@findex end -@need 1300 -For @TeX{}, write the following to equate the @code{@@phoo} command with -the existing @code{@@i} italics command:@refill +@menu +* Block Enclosing Commands:: Use different constructs for + different purposes. +* quotation:: How to write a quotation. +* example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font. +* noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation. +* lisp:: How to illustrate Lisp code. +* small:: Forms for @code{@@smallbook}. +* display:: How to write an example in the current font. +* format:: How to write an example that does not narrow + the margins. +* exdent:: How to undo the indentation of a line. +* flushleft & flushright:: How to push text flushleft or flushright. +* cartouche:: How to draw cartouches around examples. +@end menu -@example -@group -@@iftex -@@global@@let@@phoo=@@i -@@end iftex -@end group -@end example +@node Block Enclosing Commands +@section Block Enclosing Commands -@noindent -This defines @code{@@phoo} as a command that causes @TeX{} to typeset -the argument to @code{@@phoo} in italics. @code{@@global@@let} tells -@TeX{} to equate the next argument with the argument that follows the -equals sign. +Here are commands for quotations and examples, explained further in the +following sections: -@need 1300 -For Info, write the following to tell the Info formatters to enclose the -argument between @samp{//} and @samp{\\}: +@table @code +@item @@quotation +Indicate text that is quoted. The text is filled, indented, and +printed in a roman font by default.@refill -@example -@group -@@ifinfo -@@definfoenclose phoo, //, \\ -@@end ifinfo -@end group -@end example +@item @@example +Illustrate code, commands, and the like. The text is printed +in a fixed-width font, and indented but not filled.@refill -@noindent -Write the @code{@@definfoenclose} command on a line and follow it with -three arguments separated by commas (commas are used as separators in an -@code{@@node} line in the same way).@refill +@item @@smallexample +Same as @code{@@example}, except that in @TeX{} this command typesets +text in a smaller font for the @code{@@smallbook} format than for the +default 8.5 by 11 inch format. -@itemize @bullet -@item -The first argument to @code{@@definfoenclose} is the @@-command name -@strong{without} the @samp{@@}; +@item @@lisp +Like @code{@@example}, but specifically for illustrating Lisp code. The +text is printed in a fixed-width font, and indented but not filled. -@item -the second argument is the Info start delimiter string; and, - -@item -the third argument is the Info end delimiter string. -@end itemize - -@noindent -The latter two arguments enclose the highlighted text in the Info file. -A delimiter string may contain spaces. Neither the start nor end -delimiter is required. However, if you do not provide a start -delimiter, you must follow the command name with two commas in a row; -otherwise, the Info formatting commands will misinterpret the end -delimiter string as a start delimiter string.@refill - -After you have defined @code{@@phoo} both for @TeX{} and for Info, you -can then write @code{@@phoo@{bar@}} to see @samp{//bar\\} -in Info and see -@ifinfo -@samp{bar} in italics in printed output. -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@i{bar} in italics in printed output. -@end iftex - -Note that each definition applies to its own formatter: one for @TeX{}, -the other for Info. - -@need 1200 -Here is another example: - -@example -@group -@@ifinfo -@@definfoenclose headword, , : -@@end ifinfo -@@iftex -@@global@@let@@headword=@@b -@@end iftex -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This defines @code{@@headword} as an Info formatting command that -inserts nothing before and a colon after the argument and as a @TeX{} -formatting command to typeset its argument in bold. - -@node Quotations and Examples, Lists and Tables, Marking Text, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Quotations and Examples - -Quotations and examples are blocks of text consisting of one or more -whole paragraphs that are set off from the bulk of the text and -treated differently. They are usually indented.@refill - -In Texinfo, you always begin a quotation or example by writing an -@@-command at the beginning of a line by itself, and end it by writing -an @code{@@end} command that is also at the beginning of a line by -itself. For instance, you begin an example by writing @code{@@example} -by itself at the beginning of a line and end the example by writing -@code{@@end example} on a line by itself, at the beginning of that -line.@refill -@findex end - -@menu -* Block Enclosing Commands:: Use different constructs for - different purposes. -* quotation:: How to write a quotation. -* example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font. -* noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation. -* Lisp Example:: How to illustrate Lisp code. -* smallexample & smalllisp:: Forms for the @code{@@smallbook} option. -* display:: How to write an example in the current font. -* format:: How to write an example that does not narrow - the margins. -* exdent:: How to undo the indentation of a line. -* flushleft & flushright:: How to push text flushleft or flushright. -* cartouche:: How to draw cartouches around examples. -@end menu - -@node Block Enclosing Commands, quotation, Quotations and Examples, Quotations and Examples -@section The Block Enclosing Commands - -Here are commands for quotations and examples:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@quotation -Indicate text that is quoted. The text is filled, indented, and -printed in a roman font by default.@refill - -@item @@example -Illustrate code, commands, and the like. The text is printed -in a fixed-width font, and indented but not filled.@refill - -@item @@lisp -Illustrate Lisp code. The text is printed in a fixed-width font, -and indented but not filled.@refill - -@item @@smallexample -Illustrate code, commands, and the like. Similar to -@code{@@example}, except that in @TeX{} this command typesets text in -a smaller font for the smaller @code{@@smallbook} format than for the -8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill - -@item @@smalllisp -Illustrate Lisp code. Similar to @code{@@lisp}, except that -in @TeX{} this command typesets text in a smaller font for the smaller -@code{@@smallbook} format than for the 8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill +@item @@smalllisp +Is to @code{@@lisp} as @code{@@smallexample} is to @code{@@example}. @item @@display Display illustrative text. The text is indented but not filled, and -no font is specified (so, by default, the font is roman).@refill +no font is selected (so, by default, the font is roman).@refill + +@item @@smalldisplay +Is to @code{@@display} as @code{@@smallexample} is to @code{@@example}. @item @@format -Print illustrative text. The text is not indented and not filled -and no font is specified (so, by default, the font is roman).@refill +Like @code{@@display} (the text is not filled and no font is selected), +but the text is not indented. + +@item @@smallformat +Is to @code{@@format} as @code{@@smallexample} is to @code{@@example}. @end table The @code{@@exdent} command is used within the above constructs to @@ -7195,18 +7357,16 @@ paragraph.@refill You can use the @code{@@cartouche} command within one of the above constructs to highlight the example or quotation by drawing a box with -rounded corners around it. (The @code{@@cartouche} command affects -only the printed manual; it has no effect in the Info file; see -@ref{cartouche, , Drawing Cartouches Around Examples}.)@refill +rounded corners around it. @xref{cartouche, , Drawing Cartouches Around +Examples}. -@node quotation, example, Block Enclosing Commands, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node quotation @section @code{@@quotation} @cindex Quotations @findex quotation -The text of a quotation is -processed normally except that:@refill +The text of a quotation is processed normally except that: @itemize @bullet @item @@ -7248,8 +7408,8 @@ produces This is a foo. @end quotation -@node example, noindent, quotation, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node example @section @code{@@example} @cindex Examples, formatting them @cindex Formatting examples @@ -7275,10 +7435,9 @@ obtained by indenting each line with five spaces. @end example Write an @code{@@example} command at the beginning of a line by itself. -This line will disappear from the output. Mark the end of the example +Mark the end of the example with an @code{@@end example} command, also written at the beginning of a -line by itself. The @code{@@end example} will disappear from the -output.@refill +line by itself.@refill @need 700 For example, @@ -7296,12 +7455,14 @@ produces mv foo bar @end example -Since the lines containing @code{@@example} and @code{@@end example} -will disappear, you should put a blank line before the -@code{@@example} and another blank line after the @code{@@end -example}. (Remember that blank lines between the beginning +The lines containing @code{@@example} and @code{@@end example} +will disappear from the output. +To make the output look good, +you should put a blank line before the +@code{@@example} and another blank line after the @code{@@end example}. +Note that blank lines inside the beginning @code{@@example} and the ending @code{@@end example} will appear in -the output.)@refill +the output.@refill @quotation @strong{Caution:} Do not use tabs in the lines of an example (or anywhere @@ -7312,7 +7473,7 @@ convert tabs in a region to multiple spaces.)@refill @end quotation Examples are often, logically speaking, ``in the middle'' of a -paragraph, and the text continues after an example should not be +paragraph, and the text that continues after an example should not be indented. The @code{@@noindent} command prevents a piece of text from being indented as if it were a new paragraph. @ifinfo @@ -7323,8 +7484,8 @@ being indented as if it were a new paragraph. embedded within sentences, not set off from preceding and following text. @xref{code, , @code{@@code}}.) -@node noindent, Lisp Example, example, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node noindent @section @code{@@noindent} @findex noindent @@ -7381,11 +7542,11 @@ Do not put braces after an @code{@@noindent} command; they are not necessary, since @code{@@noindent} is a command used outside of paragraphs (@pxref{Command Syntax}).@refill -@node Lisp Example, smallexample & smalllisp, noindent, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node lisp @section @code{@@lisp} -@cindex Lisp example @findex lisp +@cindex Lisp example The @code{@@lisp} command is used for Lisp code. It is synonymous with the @code{@@example} command. @@ -7400,44 +7561,43 @@ regarding the nature of the example. This is useful, for example, if you write a function that evaluates only and all the Lisp code in a Texinfo file. Then you can use the Texinfo file as a Lisp library.@footnote{It would be straightforward to extend Texinfo to work -in a similar fashion for C, Fortran, or other languages.}@refill +in a similar fashion for C, Fortran, or other languages.} Mark the end of @code{@@lisp} with @code{@@end lisp} on a line by itself.@refill -@node smallexample & smalllisp, display, Lisp Example, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} + +@node small +@section @code{@@small@dots{}} Block Commands @cindex Small book example @cindex Example for a small book @cindex Lisp example for a small book +@findex smalldisplay @findex smallexample +@findex smallformat @findex smalllisp In addition to the regular @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} commands, -Texinfo has two other ``example-style'' commands. These are the -@code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands. Both these -commands are designed for use with the @code{@@smallbook} command that -causes @TeX{} to produce a printed manual in a 7 by 9.25 inch format -rather than the regular 8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill - -In @TeX{}, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands -typeset text in a smaller font for the smaller @code{@@smallbook} -format than for the 8.5 by 11 inch format. Consequently, many examples -containing long lines fit in a narrower, @code{@@smallbook} page -without needing to be shortened. Both commands typeset in the normal -font size when you format for the 8.5 by 11 inch size; indeed, -in this situation, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} -commands are defined to be the @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} -commands.@refill - -In Info, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands are -equivalent to the @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} commands, and work -exactly the same.@refill - -Mark the end of @code{@@smallexample} or @code{@@smalllisp} with -@code{@@end smallexample} or @code{@@end smalllisp}, -respectively.@refill +Texinfo has ``small'' example-style commands. These are +@code{@@smalldisplay}, @code{@@smallexample}, @code{@@smallformat}, and +@code{@@smalllisp}. All of these commands are designed for use with the +@code{@@smallbook} command (which causes @TeX{} to format a printed book for +a 7 by 9.25 inch trim size rather than the default 8.5 by 11 inch size). + +In @TeX{}, the @code{@@small@dots{}} commands typeset text in a smaller +font for the smaller @code{@@smallbook} format than for the 8.5 by 11 +inch format. Consequently, many examples containing long lines fit in a +narrower, @code{@@smallbook} page without needing to be shortened. Both +commands typeset in the normal font size when you format for the 8.5 by +11 inch size. Indeed, in this situation, the @code{@@small@dots{}} +commands are equivalent to their non-small versions. + +In Info, the @code{@@small@dots{}} commands are also equivalent to their +non-small companion commands. + +Mark the end of an @code{@@small@dots{}} block with a corresponding +@code{@@end small@dots{}}. For example, pair @code{@@smallexample} with +@code{@@end smallexample}. @iftex Here is an example written in the small font used by the @@ -7448,7 +7608,7 @@ Here is an example written in the small font used by the @tex % Remove extra vskip; this is a kludge to counter the effect of display \vskip-3\baselineskip -{\ninett +{\smalltt \dots{} to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source @@ -7478,21 +7638,21 @@ this text appears in a smaller font. @end smallexample @end ifinfo -The @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands make it -easier to prepare smaller format manuals without forcing you to edit -examples by hand to fit them onto narrower pages.@refill +The @code{@@small@dots{}} commands make it easier to prepare smaller +format manuals without forcing you to edit examples by hand to fit them +onto narrower pages.@refill -As a general rule, a printed document looks better if you write all the -examples in a chapter consistently in @code{@@example} or in -@code{@@smallexample}. Only occasionally should you mix the two -formats.@refill +As a general rule, a printed document looks better if you use only one +of (for example) @code{@@example} or in @code{@@smallexample} +consistently within a chapter. Only occasionally should you mix the two +formats. @xref{smallbook, , Printing ``Small'' Books}, for more information about the @code{@@smallbook} command.@refill -@node display, format, smallexample & smalllisp, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@display} + +@node display +@section @code{@@display} and @code{@@smalldisplay} @cindex Display formatting @findex display @@ -7510,9 +7670,14 @@ and an @code{@@end display} command. The @code{@@display} command indents the text, but does not fill it. @end display -@node format, exdent, display, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@format} +@findex smalldisplay +Texinfo also provides a command @code{@@smalldisplay}, which is like +@code{@@display} but uses a smaller font in @code{@@smallbook} format. +@xref{small}. + + +@node format +@section @code{@@format} and @code{@@smallformat} @findex format The @code{@@format} command is similar to @code{@@example} except @@ -7526,7 +7691,14 @@ from this example, the @code{@@format} command does not fill the text. @end format -@node exdent, flushleft & flushright, format, Quotations and Examples +@findex smallformat +Texinfo also provides a command @code{@@smallformat}, which is like +@code{@@format} but uses a smaller font in @code{@@smallbook} format. +@xref{small}. + + + +@node exdent @section @code{@@exdent}: Undoing a Line's Indentation @cindex Indentation undoing @findex exdent @@ -7636,8 +7808,8 @@ further highlight an example or quotation. For instance, you could write a manual in which one type of example is surrounded by a cartouche for emphasis.@refill -The @code{@@cartouche} command affects only the printed manual; it has -no effect in the Info file.@refill +@code{@@cartouche} affects only the printed manual; it has no effect in +other output files. @need 1500 For example, @@ -7689,8 +7861,8 @@ the first column; multi-column tables are also supported. * Multi-column Tables:: How to construct generalized tables. @end menu -@ifinfo @node Introducing Lists, itemize, Lists and Tables, Lists and Tables +@ifinfo @heading Introducing Lists @end ifinfo @@ -7759,12 +7931,12 @@ Enumerated lists, using numbers or letters. @item @@table @itemx @@ftable @itemx @@vtable -Two-column tables with indexing. +Two-column tables, optionally with indexing. @end table -@node itemize, enumerate, Introducing Lists, Lists and Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Making an Itemized List + +@node itemize +@section @code{@@itemize}: Making an Itemized List @cindex Itemization @findex itemize @@ -7772,23 +7944,26 @@ The @code{@@itemize} command produces sequences of indented paragraphs, with a bullet or other mark inside the left margin at the beginning of each paragraph for which such a mark is desired.@refill +@cindex @code{@@w}, for blank items Begin an itemized list by writing @code{@@itemize} at the beginning of a line. Follow the command, on the same line, with a character or a Texinfo command that generates a mark. Usually, you will write @code{@@bullet} after @code{@@itemize}, but you can use -@code{@@minus}, or any character or any special symbol that results in -a single character in the Info file. (When you write @code{@@bullet} -or @code{@@minus} after an @code{@@itemize} command, you may omit the -@samp{@{@}}.)@refill +@code{@@minus}, or any command or character that results in a single +character in the Info file. If you don't want any mark at all, use +@code{@@w}. (When you write the mark command such as +@code{@@bullet} after an @code{@@itemize} command, you may omit the +@samp{@{@}}.) If you don't specify a mark command, the default is +@code{@@bullet}. Write the text of the indented paragraphs themselves after the @code{@@itemize}, up to another line that says @code{@@end itemize}.@refill -Before each paragraph for which a mark in the margin is desired, write -a line that says just @code{@@item}. Do not write any other text on this -line.@refill @findex item +Before each paragraph for which a mark in the margin is desired, write a +line that says just @code{@@item}. It is ok to have text following the +@code{@@item}. Usually, you should put a blank line before an @code{@@item}. This puts a blank line in the Info file. (@TeX{} inserts the proper @@ -7796,8 +7971,8 @@ interline whitespace in either case.) Except when the entries are very brief, these blank lines make the list look better.@refill Here is an example of the use of @code{@@itemize}, followed by the -output it produces. Note that @code{@@bullet} produces an @samp{*} in -Info and a round dot in @TeX{}.@refill +output it produces. @code{@@bullet} produces an @samp{*} in Info and a +round dot in @TeX{}. @example @group @@ -7870,9 +8045,9 @@ Second outer item. @end itemize @end quotation -@node enumerate, Two-column Tables, itemize, Lists and Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Making a Numbered or Lettered List + +@node enumerate +@section @code{@@enumerate}: Making a Numbered or Lettered List @cindex Enumeration @findex enumerate @@ -7886,18 +8061,18 @@ letter as an option. Without an argument, @code{@@enumerate} starts the list with the number @samp{1}. With a numeric argument, such as @samp{3}, the command starts the list with that number. With an upper or lower case letter, such as @samp{a} or @samp{A}, the command starts -the list with that letter.@refill +the list with that letter. Write the text of the enumerated list in the same way you write an itemized list: put @code{@@item} on a line of its own before the start of each paragraph that you want enumerated. Do not write any other text -on the line beginning with @code{@@item}.@refill +on the line beginning with @code{@@item}. You should put a blank line between entries in the list. -This generally makes it easier to read the Info file.@refill +This generally makes it easier to read the Info file. @need 1500 -Here is an example of @code{@@enumerate} without an argument:@refill +Here is an example of @code{@@enumerate} without an argument: @example @group @@ -8004,8 +8179,8 @@ exhibits, and command-line option summaries. * itemx:: How to put more entries in the first column. @end menu -@ifinfo @node table, ftable vtable, Two-column Tables, Two-column Tables +@ifinfo @subheading Using the @code{@@table} Command Use the @code{@@table} command to produce two-column tables.@refill @@ -8034,6 +8209,7 @@ commands output the first column entries without added highlighting listed here. However, you can only use commands that normally take arguments in braces.)@refill +@findex item Begin each table entry with an @code{@@item} command at the beginning of a line. Write the first column text on the same line as the @code{@@item} command. Write the second column text on the line @@ -8041,8 +8217,7 @@ following the @code{@@item} line and on subsequent lines. (You do not need to type anything for an empty second column entry.) You may write as many lines of supporting text as you wish, even several paragraphs. But only text on the same line as the @code{@@item} will -be placed in the first column.@refill -@findex item +be placed in the first column, including any footnote. Normally, you should put a blank line before an @code{@@item} line. This puts a blank like in the Info file. Except when the entries are @@ -8080,8 +8255,8 @@ If you want to list two or more named items with a single block of text, use the @code{@@itemx} command. (@xref{itemx, , @code{@@itemx}}.)@refill -@node ftable vtable, itemx, table, Two-column Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node ftable vtable @subsection @code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable} @cindex Tables with indexes @cindex Indexing table entries automatically @@ -8095,8 +8270,8 @@ functions and @code{@@vtable} automatically enters each of the items in the first column of the table into the index of variables. This simplifies the task of creating indices. Only the items on the same line as the @code{@@item} commands are indexed, and they are indexed in -exactly the form that they appear on that line. @xref{Indices, , -Creating Indices}, for more information about indices.@refill +exactly the form that they appear on that line. @xref{Indices}, +for more information about indices.@refill Begin a two-column table using @code{@@ftable} or @code{@@vtable} by writing the @@-command at the beginning of a line, followed on the same @@ -8107,8 +8282,7 @@ itself. See the example for @code{@@table} in the previous section. -@node itemx, , ftable vtable, Two-column Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node itemx @subsection @code{@@itemx} @cindex Two named items for @code{@@table} @findex itemx @@ -8120,7 +8294,6 @@ line of its own. Use @code{@@itemx} for all but the first entry; @code{@@itemx} command works exactly like @code{@@item} except that it does not generate extra vertical space above the first column text. -@need 1000 For example, @example @@ -8169,7 +8342,7 @@ multitable} completes the table. Details in the sections below. * Multitable Rows:: Defining multitable rows, with examples. @end menu -@node Multitable Column Widths, Multitable Rows, Multi-column Tables, Multi-column Tables +@node Multitable Column Widths @subsection Multitable Column Widths @cindex Multitable column widths @cindex Column widths, defining for multitables @@ -8192,10 +8365,9 @@ To specify column widths as fractions of the line length, write @@multitable @@columnfractions .33 .33 .33 @end example -@noindent -The fractions need not add up exactly to 1.0, as these do +@noindent The fractions need not add up exactly to 1.0, as these do not. This allows you to produce tables that do not need the full line -length. +length. You can use a leading zero if you wish. @item @cindex Prototype row, column widths defined by @@ -8225,7 +8397,7 @@ particularly likely to be useful. @cindex Rows, of a multitable @findex item -@cindex tab +@findex tab After the @code{@@multitable} command defining the column widths (see the previous section), you begin each row in the body of a multitable with @code{@@item}, and separate the column entries with @code{@@tab}. @@ -8234,7 +8406,7 @@ input lines in your source file as necessary. Here is a complete example of a multi-column table (the text is from @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}, @pxref{Split Window,, Splitting Windows, -xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}): +emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}): @example @@multitable @@columnfractions .15 .45 .4 @@ -8254,8 +8426,7 @@ split that window. @@end multitable @end example -@noindent -produces: +@noindent produces: @multitable @columnfractions .15 .45 .4 @item Key @tab Command @tab Description @@ -8276,9 +8447,8 @@ split that window. @node Indices, Insertions, Lists and Tables, Top @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Creating Indices +@chapter Indices @cindex Indices -@cindex Creating indices Using Texinfo, you can generate indices without having to sort and collate entries manually. In an index, the entries are listed in @@ -8414,17 +8584,6 @@ command; that would be a spelling error. Whichever case convention you use, please use it consistently! -@ignore -Concept index entries consist of English text. The usual convention -is to capitalize the first word of each such index entry, unless that -word is the name of a function, variable, or other such entity that -should not be capitalized. However, if your concept index entries are -consistently short (one or two words each) it may look better for each -regular entry to start with a lower case letter, aside from proper -names and acronyms that always call for upper case letters. Whichever -convention you adapt, please be consistent! -@end ignore - Entries in indices other than the concept index are symbol names in programming languages, or program names; these names are usually case-sensitive, so use upper and lower case as required for them. @@ -8469,24 +8628,11 @@ Make an entry in the data type index for @var{data type}.@refill @quotation @strong{Caution:} Do not use a colon in an index entry. In Info, a -colon separates the menu entry name from the node name. An extra -colon confuses Info. -@xref{Menu Parts, , The Parts of a Menu}, -for more information about the structure of a menu entry.@refill +colon separates the menu entry name from the node name, so a colon in +the entry itself confuses Info. @xref{Menu Parts, , The Parts of a +Menu}, for more information about the structure of a menu entry. @end quotation -If you write several identical index entries in different places in a -Texinfo file, the index in the printed manual will list all the pages to -which those entries refer. However, the index in the Info file will -list @strong{only} the node that references the @strong{first} of those -index entries. Therefore, it is best to write indices in which each -entry refers to only one place in the Texinfo file. Fortunately, this -constraint is a feature rather than a loss since it means that the index -will be easy to use. Otherwise, you could create an index that lists -several pages for one entry and your reader would not know to which page -to turn. If you have two identical entries for one topic, change the -topics slightly, or qualify them to indicate the difference.@refill - You are not actually required to use the predefined indices for their canonical purposes. For example, suppose you wish to index some C preprocessor macros. You could put them in the function index along @@ -8678,8 +8824,7 @@ You should define new indices within or right after the end-of-header line of a Texinfo file, before any @code{@@synindex} or @code{@@syncodeindex} commands (@pxref{Header}).@refill -@node Insertions, Breaks, Indices, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node Insertions @chapter Special Insertions @cindex Inserting special characters and symbols @cindex Special insertions @@ -8692,12 +8837,17 @@ elements that do not correspond to simple characters you can type. These are: @itemize @bullet -@item Braces, @samp{@@} and periods. +@item Braces and @samp{@@}. @item Whitespace within and around a sentence. @item Accents. @item Dots and bullets. @item The @TeX{} logo and the copyright symbol. +@item The pounds currency symbol. +@item The minus sign. @item Mathematical expressions. +@item Glyphs for evaluation, macros, errors, etc. +@item Footnotes. +@item Images. @end itemize @end iftex @@ -8714,6 +8864,7 @@ These are: * math:: How to format a mathematical expression. * Glyphs:: How to indicate results of evaluation, expansion of macros, errors, etc. +* Footnotes:: How to include footnotes. * Images:: How to include graphics. @end menu @@ -8747,7 +8898,8 @@ output. Do not put braces after an @code{@@@@} command. -@node Inserting Braces, , Inserting An Atsign, Braces Atsigns + +@node Inserting Braces @subsection Inserting @samp{@{} and @samp{@}}with @@@{ and @@@} @findex @{ @r{(single @samp{@{})} @findex @} @r{(single @samp{@}})} @@ -8762,12 +8914,11 @@ Do not put braces after either an @code{@@@{} or an @code{@@@}} command. -@node Inserting Space, Inserting Accents, Braces Atsigns, Insertions +@node Inserting Space @section Inserting Space @cindex Inserting space @cindex Spacing, inserting -@cindex Whitespace, inserting The following sections describe commands that control spacing of various kinds within and after sentences. @@ -8778,7 +8929,8 @@ kinds within and after sentences. * dmn:: How to format a dimension. @end menu -@node Not Ending a Sentence, Ending a Sentence, Inserting Space, Inserting Space + +@node Not Ending a Sentence @subsection Not Ending a Sentence @cindex Not ending a sentence @@ -8786,13 +8938,13 @@ kinds within and after sentences. @cindex Periods, inserting Depending on whether a period or exclamation point or question mark is inside or at the end of a sentence, less or more space is inserted after -a period in a typeset manual. Since it is not always possible for -Texinfo to determine when a period ends a sentence and when it is used +a period in a typeset manual. Since it is not always possible +to determine when a period ends a sentence and when it is used in an abbreviation, special commands are needed in some circumstances. -(Usually, Texinfo can guess how to handle periods, so you do not need to +Usually, Texinfo can guess how to handle periods, so you do not need to use the special commands; you just enter a period as you would if you were using a typewriter, which means you put two spaces after the -period, question mark, or exclamation mark that ends a sentence.) +period, question mark, or exclamation mark that ends a sentence. @findex : @r{(suppress widening)} Use the @code{@@:}@: command after a period, question mark, @@ -8800,7 +8952,6 @@ exclamation mark, or colon that should not be followed by extra space. For example, use @code{@@:}@: after periods that end abbreviations which are not at the ends of sentences. -@need 700 For example, @example @@ -8871,8 +9022,7 @@ In the Info file output, @code{@@.}@: is equivalent to a simple The meanings of @code{@@:} and @code{@@.}@: in Texinfo are designed to work well with the Emacs sentence motion commands (@pxref{Sentences,,, -xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}). This made it necessary for them to be -incompatible with some other formatting systems that use @@-commands. +emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}). Do not put braces after any of these commands. @@ -8882,6 +9032,7 @@ Do not put braces after any of these commands. @cindex Multiple spaces @cindex Whitespace, inserting +@cindex Space, inserting horizontal @findex (space) @findex (tab) @findex (newline) @@ -8909,8 +9060,7 @@ Spacey@@ @@ @@ @@ example. @end example -@noindent -produces +@noindent produces @example Spacey@ @ @ @ @@ -8923,7 +9073,7 @@ Other possible uses of @code{@@@kbd{SPACE}} have been subsumed by Do not follow any of these commands with braces. -@node dmn, , Multiple Spaces, Inserting Space +@node dmn @subsection @code{@@dmn}@{@var{dimension}@}: Format a Dimension @cindex Thin space between number, dimension @cindex Dimension formatting @@ -8935,7 +9085,7 @@ At times, you may want to write @samp{12@dmn{pt}} or abbreviation for the dimension. You can use the @code{@@dmn} command to do this. On seeing the command, @TeX{} inserts just enough space for proper typesetting; the Info formatting commands insert no space -at all, since the Info file does not require it.@refill +at all, since the Info file does not require it. To use the @code{@@dmn} command, write the number and then follow it immediately, with no intervening space, by @code{@@dmn}, and then by @@ -8958,10 +9108,10 @@ In these cases, however, the formatters may insert a line break between the number and the dimension, so use @code{@@w} (@pxref{w}). Also, if you write a period after an abbreviation within a sentence, you should write @samp{@@:} after the period to prevent @TeX{} from inserting extra -whitespace, as shown here. @xref{Inserting Space}. +whitespace, as shown here. @xref{Not Ending a Sentence}. -@node Inserting Accents, Dots Bullets, Inserting Space, Insertions +@node Inserting Accents @section Inserting Accents @cindex Inserting accents @@ -8992,7 +9142,7 @@ possible, since accented characters are very common in some languages. @findex dotaccent @cindex Dot accent @findex H -@cindex Hungariam umlaut accent +@cindex Hungarian umlaut accent @findex ringaccent @cindex Ring accent @findex tieaccent @@ -9060,22 +9210,22 @@ commonly used in languages other than English. @cindex Es-zet @cindex Sharp S @cindex German S -@multitable {@@questiondown@{@}} {oe,OE} {es-zet or sharp S} +@multitable {x@@questiondown@{@} } {oe,OE} {es-zet or sharp S} @item @t{@@exclamdown@{@}} @tab @exclamdown{} @tab upside-down ! @item @t{@@questiondown@{@}} @tab @questiondown{} @tab upside-down ? -@item @t{@@aa@{@},@@AA@{@}} @tab @aa{},@AA{} @tab A,a with circle +@item @t{@@aa@{@},@@AA@{@}} @tab @aa{},@AA{} @tab a,A with circle @item @t{@@ae@{@},@@AE@{@}} @tab @ae{},@AE{} @tab ae,AE ligatures @item @t{@@dotless@{i@}} @tab @dotless{i} @tab dotless i @item @t{@@dotless@{j@}} @tab @dotless{j} @tab dotless j @item @t{@@l@{@},@@L@{@}} @tab @l{},@L{} @tab suppressed-L,l @item @t{@@o@{@},@@O@{@}} @tab @o{},@O{} @tab O,o with slash -@item @t{@@oe@{@},@@OE@{@}} @tab @oe{},@OE{} @tab OE,oe ligatures +@item @t{@@oe@{@},@@OE@{@}} @tab @oe{},@OE{} @tab oe,OE ligatures @item @t{@@ss@{@}} @tab @ss{} @tab es-zet or sharp S @end multitable -@node Dots Bullets, TeX and copyright, Inserting Accents, Insertions -@section Inserting Ellipsis, Dots, and Bullets +@node Dots Bullets +@section Inserting Ellipsis and Bullets @cindex Dots, inserting @cindex Bullets, inserting @cindex Ellipsis, inserting @@ -9099,9 +9249,10 @@ the braces, the formatters would be confused. @xref{Command Syntax, , @end menu -@node dots, bullet, Dots Bullets, Dots Bullets -@subsection @code{@@dots}@{@} (@dots{}) +@node dots +@subsection @code{@@dots}@{@} (@dots{}) and @code{@@enddots}@{@} (@enddots{}) @findex dots +@findex enddots @cindex Inserting dots @cindex Dots, inserting @@ -9123,7 +9274,7 @@ the dots in the ellipsis. @end iftex -@node bullet, , dots, Dots Bullets +@node bullet @subsection @code{@@bullet}@{@} (@bullet{}) @findex bullet @@ -9152,7 +9303,7 @@ braces.@refill @end menu -@node tex, copyright symbol, TeX and copyright, TeX and copyright +@node tex @subsection @code{@@TeX}@{@} (@TeX{}) @findex tex (command) @@ -9160,10 +9311,10 @@ Use the @code{@@TeX@{@}} command to generate `@TeX{}'. In a printed manual, this is a special logo that is different from three ordinary letters. In Info, it just looks like @samp{TeX}. The @code{@@TeX@{@}} command is unique among Texinfo commands in that the -@kbd{T} and the @kbd{X} are in upper case.@refill +@samp{T} and the @samp{X} are in upper case.@refill -@node copyright symbol, , tex, TeX and copyright +@node copyright symbol @subsection @code{@@copyright}@{@} (@copyright{}) @findex copyright @@ -9173,7 +9324,7 @@ this is @samp{(C)}.@refill @node pounds, minus, TeX and copyright, Insertions -@section @code{@@pounds@{@}} (@pounds{}): Pounds Sterling +@section @code{@@pounds}@{@} (@pounds{}): Pounds Sterling @findex pounds Use the @code{@@pounds@{@}} command to generate `@pounds{}'. In a @@ -9213,7 +9364,7 @@ an itemized list, you do not need to type the braces @node math, Glyphs, minus, Insertions -@section @code{@@math} - Inserting Mathematical Expressions +@section @code{@@math}: Inserting Mathematical Expressions @findex math @cindex Mathematical expressions @@ -9253,7 +9404,7 @@ remember to write the mathematical expression between one or two @samp{$} (dollar-signs) as appropriate. -@node Glyphs, Images, math, Insertions +@node Glyphs @section Glyphs for Examples @cindex Glyphs @@ -9310,12 +9461,12 @@ message.@refill @menu -* result:: -* expansion:: -* Print Glyph:: -* Error Glyph:: -* Equivalence:: -* Point Glyph:: +* result:: +* expansion:: +* Print Glyph:: +* Error Glyph:: +* Equivalence:: +* Point Glyph:: @end menu @node result, expansion, Glyphs Summary, Glyphs @@ -9324,6 +9475,7 @@ message.@refill @cindex Indicating evaluation @cindex Evaluation glyph @cindex Value of an expression, indicating +@findex result Use the @code{@@result@{@}} command to indicate the result of evaluating an expression.@refill @@ -9351,6 +9503,7 @@ may be read as ``@code{(cdr '(1 2 3))} evaluates to @code{(2 3)}''. @node expansion, Print Glyph, result, Glyphs @subsection @code{@@expansion@{@}} (@expansion{}): Indicating an Expansion @cindex Expansion, indicating it +@findex expansion When an expression is a macro call, it expands into a new expression. You can indicate the result of the expansion with the @@ -9406,6 +9559,7 @@ five spaces.@refill @node Print Glyph, Error Glyph, expansion, Glyphs @subsection @code{@@print@{@}} (@print{}): Indicating Printed Output @cindex Printed output, indicating it +@findex print Sometimes an expression will print output during its execution. You can indicate the printed output with the @code{@@print@{@}} command.@refill @@ -9451,6 +9605,7 @@ In a Texinfo source file, this example is written as follows: @node Error Glyph, Equivalence, Print Glyph, Glyphs @subsection @code{@@error@{@}} (@error{}): Indicating an Error Message @cindex Error message, indicating it +@findex error A piece of code may cause an error when you evaluate it. You can designate the error message with the @code{@@error@{@}} command.@refill @@ -9496,6 +9651,7 @@ Wrong type argument: integer-or-marker-p, x @node Equivalence, Point Glyph, Error Glyph, Glyphs @subsection @code{@@equiv@{@}} (@equiv{}): Indicating Equivalence @cindex Equivalence, indicating it +@findex equiv Sometimes two expressions produce identical results. You can indicate the exact equivalence of two forms with the @code{@@equiv@{@}} command.@refill @@ -9529,9 +9685,10 @@ This indicates that evaluating @code{(make-sparse-keymap)} produces identical results to evaluating @code{(list 'keymap)}. -@node Point Glyph, , Equivalence, Glyphs +@node Point Glyph @subsection @code{@@point@{@}} (@point{}): Indicating Point in a Buffer -@cindex Point, indicating it in a buffer +@cindex Point, indicating in a buffer +@findex point Sometimes you need to show an example of text in an Emacs buffer. In such examples, the convention is to include the entire contents of the @@ -9592,134 +9749,343 @@ This is the changed @@point@{@}contents of foo. @end example -@c this should be described with figures when we have them -@c perhaps in the quotation/example chapter. -@node Images, , Glyphs, Insertions -@section Inserting Images - -@cindex Images, inserting -@cindex Pictures, inserting -@findex image +@node Footnotes +@section Footnotes +@cindex Footnotes +@findex footnote -You can insert an image in an external file with the @code{@@image} -command: +A @dfn{footnote} is for a reference that documents or elucidates the +primary text.@footnote{A footnote should complement or expand upon +the primary text, but a reader should not need to read a footnote to +understand the primary text. For a thorough discussion of footnotes, +see @cite{The Chicago Manual of Style}, which is published by the +University of Chicago Press.}@refill -@example -@@image@{@var{filename}, @r{[}@var{width}@r{]}, @r{[}@var{height}@r{]}@} -@end example +@menu +* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. +* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. +@end menu -@cindex Formats for images -@cindex Image formats -The @var{filename} argument is mandatory, and must not have an -extension, because the different processors support different formats: -@TeX{} reads the file @file{@var{filename}.eps} (Encapsulated PostScript -format); @code{makeinfo} uses @file{@var{filename}.txt} verbatim for -Info output (more or less as if it was an @code{@@example}). HTML -output requires @file{@var{filename}.jpg}. +@node Footnote Commands +@subsection Footnote Commands -@cindex Width of images -@cindex Height of images -@cindex Aspect ratio of images -@cindex Distorting images -The optional @var{width} and @var{height} arguments specify the size to -scale the image to (they are ignored for Info output). If they are both -specified, the image is presented in its natural size (given in the -file); if only one is specified, the other is scaled proportionately; -and if both are specified, both are respected, thus possibly distorting -the original image by changing its aspect ratio. +In Texinfo, footnotes are created with the @code{@@footnote} command. +This command is followed immediately by a left brace, then by the text +of the footnote, and then by a terminating right brace. Footnotes may +be of any length (they will be broken across pages if necessary), but +are usually short. The template is: -@cindex Dimensions and image sizes -The @var{width} and @var{height} may be specified using any valid @TeX{} -dimension, namely: +@example +ordinary text@@footnote@{@var{text of footnote}@} +@end example -@table @asis -@item pt -@cindex Points (dimension) -point (72.27pt = 1in) -@item pc -@cindex Picas -pica (1pc = 12pt) -@item bp -@cindex Big points -big point (72bp = 1in) -@item in -@cindex Inches -inch -@item cm -@cindex Centimeters -centimeter (2.54cm = 1in) -@item mm -@cindex Millimeters -millimeter (10mm = 1cm) -@item dd -@cindex Did@^ot points -did@^ot point (1157dd = 1238pt) -@item cc -@cindex Ciceros -cicero (1cc = 12dd) -@item sp -@cindex Scaled points -scaled point (65536sp = 1pt) -@end table +As shown here, the @code{@@footnote} command should come right after the +text being footnoted, with no intervening space; otherwise, the footnote +marker might end up starting a line. -@pindex ridt.eps -For example, the following will scale a file @file{ridt.eps} to one -inch vertically, with the width scaled proportionately: +For example, this clause is followed by a sample footnote@footnote{Here +is the sample footnote.}; in the Texinfo source, it looks like +this:@refill @example -@@image@{ridt,,1in@} +@dots{}a sample footnote@@footnote@{Here is the sample +footnote.@}; in the Texinfo source@dots{} @end example -@pindex epsf.tex -For @code{@@image} to work with @TeX{}, the file @file{epsf.tex} must be -installed somewhere that @TeX{} can find it. This file is included in -the Texinfo distribution and is available from -@uref{ftp://ftp.tug.org/tex/epsf.tex}. - - -@node Breaks, Definition Commands, Insertions, Top -@chapter Making and Preventing Breaks -@cindex Making line and page breaks -@cindex Preventing line and page breaks +In a printed manual or book, the reference mark for a footnote is a +small, superscripted number; the text of the footnote appears at the +bottom of the page, below a horizontal line.@refill -Usually, a Texinfo file is processed both by @TeX{} and by one of the -Info formatting commands. Line, paragraph, or page breaks sometimes -occur in the `wrong' place in one or other form of output. You must -ensure that text looks right both in the printed manual and in the -Info file.@refill +In Info, the reference mark for a footnote is a pair of parentheses +with the footnote number between them, like this: @samp{(1)}. The +reference mark is followed by a cross-reference link to the footnote's +text. -For example, in a printed manual, page breaks may occur awkwardly in -the middle of an example; to prevent this, you can hold text together -using a grouping command that keeps the text from being split across -two pages. Conversely, you may want to force a page break where none -would occur normally. Fortunately, problems like these do not often -arise. When they do, use the break, break prevention, or pagination -commands.@refill +In the HTML output, footnote references are marked with a small, +superscripted number which is rendered as a hypertext link to the +footnote text. -@menu -* Break Commands:: Cause and prevent splits. -* Line Breaks:: How to force a single line to use two lines. -* - and hyphenation:: How to tell TeX about hyphenation points. -* w:: How to prevent unwanted line breaks. -* sp:: How to insert blank lines. -* page:: How to force the start of a new page. -* group:: How to prevent unwanted page breaks. -* need:: Another way to prevent unwanted page breaks. -@end menu +By the way, footnotes in the argument of an @code{@@item} command for a +@code{@@table} must be on the same line as the @code{@@item} +(as usual). @xref{Two-column Tables}. -@ifinfo -@node Break Commands, Line Breaks, Breaks, Breaks -@heading The Break Commands -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@sp 1 -@end iftex -The break commands create or allow line and paragraph breaks:@refill +@node Footnote Styles +@subsection Footnote Styles -@table @code -@item @@* -Force a line break. +Info has two footnote styles, which determine where the text of the +footnote is located:@refill + +@itemize @bullet +@cindex @samp{@r{End}} node footnote style +@item +In the `End' node style, all the footnotes for a single node +are placed at the end of that node. The footnotes are separated from +the rest of the node by a line of dashes with the word +@samp{Footnotes} within it. Each footnote begins with an +@samp{(@var{n})} reference mark.@refill + +@need 700 +@noindent +Here is an example of a single footnote in the end of node style:@refill + +@example +@group + --------- Footnotes --------- + +(1) Here is a sample footnote. +@end group +@end example + +@cindex @samp{@r{Separate}} footnote style +@item +In the `Separate' node style, all the footnotes for a single +node are placed in an automatically constructed node of +their own. In this style, a ``footnote reference'' follows +each @samp{(@var{n})} reference mark in the body of the +node. The footnote reference is actually a cross reference +which you use to reach the footnote node.@refill + +The name of the node with the footnotes is constructed +by appending @w{@samp{-Footnotes}} to the name of the node +that contains the footnotes. (Consequently, the footnotes' +node for the @file{Footnotes} node is +@w{@file{Footnotes-Footnotes}}!) The footnotes' node has an +`Up' node pointer that leads back to its parent node.@refill + +@noindent +Here is how the first footnote in this manual looks after being +formatted for Info in the separate node style:@refill + +@smallexample +@group +File: texinfo.info Node: Overview-Footnotes, Up: Overview + +(1) The first syllable of "Texinfo" is pronounced like "speck", not +"hex". @dots{} +@end group +@end smallexample +@end itemize + +A Texinfo file may be formatted into an Info file with either footnote +style.@refill + +@findex footnotestyle +Use the @code{@@footnotestyle} command to specify an Info file's +footnote style. Write this command at the beginning of a line followed +by an argument, either @samp{end} for the end node style or +@samp{separate} for the separate node style. + +@need 700 +For example, + +@example +@@footnotestyle end +@end example +@noindent +or +@example +@@footnotestyle separate +@end example + +Write an @code{@@footnotestyle} command before or shortly after the +end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. (If you +include the @code{@@footnotestyle} command between the start-of-header +and end-of-header lines, the region formatting commands will format +footnotes as specified.)@refill + +If you do not specify a footnote style, the formatting commands use +their default style. Currently, @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and +@code{texinfo-format-region} use the `separate' style and +@code{makeinfo} uses the `end' style.@refill + +@c !!! note: makeinfo's --footnote-style option overrides footnotestyle +@ignore +If you use @code{makeinfo} to create the Info file, the +@samp{--footnote-style} option determines which style is used, +@samp{end} for the end of node style or @samp{separate} for the +separate node style. Thus, to format the Texinfo manual in the +separate node style, you would use the following shell command:@refill + +@example +makeinfo --footnote-style=separate texinfo.texi +@end example + +@noindent +To format the Texinfo manual in the end of node style, you would +type:@refill + +@example +makeinfo --footnote-style=end texinfo.texi +@end example +@end ignore +@ignore +If you use @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or +@code{texinfo-format-region} to create the Info file, the value of the +@code{texinfo-footnote-style} variable controls the footnote style. +It can be either @samp{"separate"} for the separate node style or +@samp{"end"} for the end of node style. (You can change the value of +this variable with the @kbd{M-x edit-options} command (@pxref{Edit +Options, , Editing Variable Values, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}), or +with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command (@pxref{Examining, , Examining +and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).@refill + +The @code{texinfo-footnote-style} variable also controls the style if +you use the @kbd{M-x makeinfo-region} or @kbd{M-x makeinfo-buffer} +command in Emacs.@refill +@end ignore +@ifinfo +This chapter contains two footnotes.@refill +@end ifinfo + + +@c this should be described with figures when we have them +@c perhaps in the quotation/example chapter. +@node Images +@section Inserting Images + +@cindex Images, inserting +@cindex Pictures, inserting +@findex image + +You can insert an image given in an external file with the +@code{@@image} command: + +@example +@@image@{@var{filename}, @r{[}@var{width}@r{]}, @r{[}@var{height}@r{]}@} +@end example + +@cindex Formats for images +@cindex Image formats +The @var{filename} argument is mandatory, and must not have an +extension, because the different processors support different formats: +@itemize @bullet +@item +@TeX{} reads the file @file{@var{filename}.eps} (Encapsulated PostScript +format). +@item +@pindex pdftex@r{, and images} +PDF@TeX{} reads @file{@var{filename}.pdf} (Adobe's Portable Document Format). +@item +@code{makeinfo} uses @file{@var{filename}.txt} verbatim for +Info output (more or less as if it was an @code{@@example}). +@item +@cindex GIF, unsupported due to patents +@cindex PNG image format +@cindex JPEG image format +@code{makeinfo} producing HTML output tries @file{@var{filename}.png}; +if that does not exist, it tries @file{@var{filename}.jpg}. If that +does not exist either, it complains. (We cannot support GIF format due +to patents.) +@end itemize + +@cindex Width of images +@cindex Height of images +@cindex Aspect ratio of images +@cindex Distorting images +The optional @var{width} and @var{height} arguments specify the size to +scale the image to (they are ignored for Info output). If neither is +specified, the image is presented in its natural size (given in the +file); if only one is specified, the other is scaled proportionately; +and if both are specified, both are respected, thus possibly distorting +the original image by changing its aspect ratio. + +@cindex Dimensions and image sizes +The @var{width} and @var{height} may be specified using any valid @TeX{} +dimension, namely: + +@table @asis +@item pt +@cindex Points (dimension) +point (72.27pt = 1in) +@item pc +@cindex Picas +pica (1pc = 12pt) +@item bp +@cindex Big points +big point (72bp = 1in) +@item in +@cindex Inches +inch +@item cm +@cindex Centimeters +centimeter (2.54cm = 1in) +@item mm +@cindex Millimeters +millimeter (10mm = 1cm) +@item dd +@cindex Did@^ot points +did@^ot point (1157dd = 1238pt) +@item cc +@cindex Ciceros +cicero (1cc = 12dd) +@item sp +@cindex Scaled points +scaled point (65536sp = 1pt) +@end table + +@pindex ridt.eps +For example, the following will scale a file @file{ridt.eps} to one +inch vertically, with the width scaled proportionately: + +@example +@@image@{ridt,,1in@} +@end example + +@pindex epsf.tex +For @code{@@image} to work with @TeX{}, the file @file{epsf.tex} must be +installed somewhere that @TeX{} can find it. (The standard location is +@file{@var{texmf}/tex/generic/dvips/epsf.tex}, where @var{texmf} is a +root of your @TeX{} directory tree.) This file is included in the +Texinfo distribution and is available from +@uref{ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex}. + +@code{@@image} can be used within a line as well as for displayed +figures. Therefore, if you intend it to be displayed, be sure to leave +a blank line before the command, or the output will run into the +preceding text. + + +@node Breaks +@chapter Making and Preventing Breaks +@cindex Making line and page breaks +@cindex Preventing line and page breaks + +Usually, a Texinfo file is processed both by @TeX{} and by one of the +Info formatting commands. Line, paragraph, or page breaks sometimes +occur in the `wrong' place in one or other form of output. You must +ensure that text looks right both in the printed manual and in the +Info file.@refill + +For example, in a printed manual, page breaks may occur awkwardly in +the middle of an example; to prevent this, you can hold text together +using a grouping command that keeps the text from being split across +two pages. Conversely, you may want to force a page break where none +would occur normally. Fortunately, problems like these do not often +arise. When they do, use the break, break prevention, or pagination +commands.@refill + +@menu +* Break Commands:: Cause and prevent splits. +* Line Breaks:: How to force a single line to use two lines. +* - and hyphenation:: How to tell TeX about hyphenation points. +* w:: How to prevent unwanted line breaks. +* sp:: How to insert blank lines. +* page:: How to force the start of a new page. +* group:: How to prevent unwanted page breaks. +* need:: Another way to prevent unwanted page breaks. +@end menu + +@node Break Commands, Line Breaks, Breaks, Breaks +@ifinfo +@heading Break Commands +@end ifinfo + +The break commands create or allow line and paragraph breaks:@refill + +@table @code +@item @@* +Force a line break. @item @@sp @var{n} Skip @var{n} blank lines.@refill @@ -9840,15 +10206,13 @@ put a @samp{-} at each hyphenation point. For example: @example @@hyphenation@{man-u-script man-u-scripts@} @end example -@noindent -@TeX{} only uses the specified hyphenation points when the +@noindent @TeX{} only uses the specified hyphenation points when the words match exactly, so give all necessary variants. @end table Info output is not hyphenated, so these commands have no effect there. -@node w, sp, - and hyphenation, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node w @section @code{@@w}@{@var{text}@}: Prevent Line Breaks @findex w @r{(prevent line break)} @cindex Line breaks, preventing @@ -9859,38 +10223,40 @@ within @var{text}.@refill You can use the @code{@@w} command to prevent @TeX{} from automatically hyphenating a long name or phrase that happens to fall near the end of a -line.@refill +line. For example: @example -You can copy GNU software from @@w@{@@samp@{ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu@}@}. +You can copy GNU software from @@w@{@@samp@{ftp.gnu.org@}@}. @end example @noindent produces @quotation -You can copy GNU software from @w{@samp{ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu}}. +You can copy GNU software from @w{@samp{ftp.gnu.org}}. @end quotation -@quotation -@strong{Caution:} Do not write an @code{@@refill} command at the end -of a paragraph containing an @code{@@w} command; it will cause the -paragraph to be refilled and may thereby negate the effect of the -@code{@@w} command.@refill -@end quotation +@cindex Non-breakable space +@cindex Unbreakable space +@cindex Tied space +You can also use @code{@@w} to produce a non-breakable space: -@node sp, page, w, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@example +None of the formatters will break at this@@w@{ @}space. +@end example + + +@node sp @section @code{@@sp} @var{n}: Insert Blank Lines @findex sp @r{(line spacing)} -@cindex Spaces (blank lines) +@cindex Space, inserting vertical @cindex Blank lines @cindex Line spacing A line beginning with and containing only @code{@@sp @var{n}} generates @var{n} blank lines of space in both the printed manual and the Info file. @code{@@sp} also forces a paragraph break. For -example,@refill +example, @example @@sp 2 @@ -10036,7 +10402,8 @@ This paragraph is preceded by @dots{} The @code{@@need} command is useful for preventing orphans (single lines at the bottoms of printed pages).@refill -@node Definition Commands, Footnotes, Breaks, Top + +@node Definition Commands @chapter Definition Commands @cindex Definition commands @@ -10295,7 +10662,7 @@ produces These two search commands are similar except @dots{} @end deffn -Each of the other definition commands has an `x' form: @code{@@defunx}, +Each definition command has an `x' form: @code{@@defunx}, @code{@@defvrx}, @code{@@deftypefunx}, etc. The `x' forms work just like @code{@@itemx}; see @ref{itemx, , @code{@@itemx}}. @@ -10423,7 +10790,7 @@ works like @code{@@defun}.@refill @item @@defspec @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} The @code{@@defspec} command is the definition command for special forms. (In Lisp, a special form is an entity much like a function, -@pxref{Special Forms,,, lispref, XEmacs Lisp Reference Manual}.) +@pxref{Special Forms,,, elisp, GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.) @code{@@defspec} is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn @{Special Form@} @dots{}} and works like @code{@@defun}.@refill @end table @@ -10442,8 +10809,8 @@ something like a variable---an entity that records a value. You must choose a term to describe the category of entity being defined; for example, ``Variable'' could be used if the entity is a variable. Write the @code{@@defvr} command at the beginning of a line and -followed it on the same line by the category of the entity and the -name of the entity.@refill +follow it on the same line by the category of the entity and the +name of the entity. Capitalize the category name like a title. If the name of the category contains spaces, as in the name ``User Option'', enclose it in braces. @@ -10510,7 +10877,7 @@ The template is: @cindex User options, marking The @code{@@defopt} command is the definition command for @dfn{user options}, i.e., variables intended for users to change according to -taste; Emacs has many such (@pxref{Variables,,, xemacs, XEmacs User's +taste; Emacs has many such (@pxref{Variables,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}). @code{@@defopt} is equivalent to @samp{@@defvr @{User Option@} @dots{}} and works like @code{@@defvar}.@refill @end table @@ -10806,7 +11173,7 @@ The template is: @var{name}.@refill @end table -@node Abstract Objects, Data Types, Typed Variables, Def Cmds in Detail +@node Abstract Objects @subsection Object-Oriented Programming Here are the commands for formatting descriptions about abstract @@ -10841,8 +11208,7 @@ name. Thus,@refill illustrates how you would write the first line of a definition of the @code{border-pattern} class option of the class @code{Window}.@refill -The template is - +The template is: @example @group @@defcv @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @@ -10860,7 +11226,6 @@ variables in object-oriented programming. @code{@@defivar} is equivalent to @samp{@@defcv @{Instance Variable@} @dots{}}@refill The template is: - @example @group @@defivar @var{class} @var{instance-variable-name} @@ -10871,12 +11236,20 @@ The template is: @code{@@defivar} creates an entry in the index of variables. +@findex deftypeivar +@item @@deftypeivar @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{name} +The @code{@@deftypeivar} command is the definition command for typed +instance variables in object-oriented programming. It is similar to +@code{@@defivar} with the addition of the @var{data-type} parameter to +specify the type of the instance variable. @code{@@deftypeivar} creates an +entry in the index of variables. + @findex defop @item @@defop @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} The @code{@@defop} command is the general definition command for entities that may resemble methods in object-oriented programming. -These entities take arguments, as functions do, but are associated -with particular classes of objects.@refill +These entities take arguments, as functions do, but are associated with +particular classes of objects.@refill For example, some systems have constructs called @dfn{wrappers} that are associated with classes as methods are, but that act more like @@ -10908,10 +11281,7 @@ is followed on the same line by the overall name of the category of operation, the name of the class of the operation, the name of the operation, and its arguments, if any.@refill -@need 800 -@noindent The template is: - @example @group @@defop @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} @@ -10923,23 +11293,34 @@ The template is: @code{@@defop} creates an entry, such as `@code{expose} on @code{windows}', in the index of functions.@refill +@findex deftypeop +@item @@deftypeop @var{category} @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} +The @code{@@deftypeop} command is the definition command for typed +operations in object-oriented programming. It is similar to +@code{@@defop} with the addition of the @var{data-type} parameter to +specify the return type of the method. @code{@@deftypeop} creates an +entry in the index of functions. + @item @@defmethod @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} @findex defmethod The @code{@@defmethod} command is the definition command for methods in object-oriented programming. A method is a kind of function that implements an operation for a particular class of objects and its -subclasses. In the Lisp Machine, methods actually were functions, but +subclasses. +@ignore +@c ADR: Who cares?!? +@c KB: Oh, I don't know, I think this info is crucial! +In the Lisp Machine, methods actually were functions, but they were usually defined with @code{defmethod}. +@end ignore @code{@@defmethod} is equivalent to @samp{@@defop Method @dots{}}. The command is written at the beginning of a line and is followed by the name of the class of the method, the name of the method, and its arguments, if any.@refill -@need 800 @noindent -For example, - +For example: @example @group @@defmethod @code{bar-class} bar-method argument @@ -10965,6 +11346,7 @@ The template is: @code{@@defmethod} creates an entry, such as `@code{bar-method} on @code{bar-class}', in the index of functions.@refill + @item @@deftypemethod @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} @findex defmethod The @code{@@deftypemethod} command is the definition command for methods @@ -10975,7 +11357,7 @@ to the @code{@@defmethod} command with the addition of the @end table -@node Data Types, , Abstract Objects, Def Cmds in Detail +@node Data Types @subsection Data Types Here is the command for data types:@refill @@ -11044,8 +11426,8 @@ commands. The name of the function follows immediately after the @code{@@defun} command and it is followed, on the same line, by the parameter list.@refill -Here is a definition from @ref{Calling Functions,,, lispref, XEmacs Lisp -Reference Manual}. +Here is a definition from @ref{Calling Functions,,, elisp, The GNU Emacs +Lisp Reference Manual}. @quotation @defun apply function &rest arguments @@ -11085,7 +11467,6 @@ In the Texinfo source file, this example looks like this: @example @group @@defun apply function &rest arguments - @@code@{apply@} calls @@var@{function@} with @@var@{arguments@}, just like @@code@{funcall@} but with one difference: the last of @@var@{arguments@} is a list of @@ -11120,7 +11501,7 @@ sense in @@code@{apply@}. @group An interesting example of using @@code@{apply@} is found -in the description of @@code@{mapcar@}.@@refill +in the description of @@code@{mapcar@}. @@end defun @end group @end example @@ -11133,202 +11514,29 @@ Ordinary variables and user options are described using a format like that for functions except that variables do not take arguments. -@node Footnotes, Conditionals, Definition Commands, Top -@chapter Footnotes -@cindex Footnotes -@findex footnote - -A @dfn{footnote} is for a reference that documents or elucidates the -primary text.@footnote{A footnote should complement or expand upon -the primary text, but a reader should not need to read a footnote to -understand the primary text. For a thorough discussion of footnotes, -see @cite{The Chicago Manual of Style}, which is published by the -University of Chicago Press.}@refill - -@menu -* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. -* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. -@end menu - -@node Footnote Commands, Footnote Styles, Footnotes, Footnotes -@section Footnote Commands - -In Texinfo, footnotes are created with the @code{@@footnote} command. -This command is followed immediately by a left brace, then by the text -of the footnote, and then by a terminating right brace. Footnotes may -be of any length (they will be broken across pages if necessary), but -are usually short. The template is: - -@example -ordinary text@@footnote@{@var{text of footnote}@} -@end example - -As shown here, the @code{@@footnote} command should come right after the -text being footnoted, with no intervening space; otherwise, the -formatters the footnote mark might end up starting up a line. - -For example, this clause is followed by a sample -footnote@footnote{Here is the sample footnote.}; in the Texinfo -source, it looks like this:@refill - -@example -@dots{}a sample footnote@@footnote@{Here is the sample -footnote.@}; in the Texinfo source@dots{} -@end example - -@strong{Warning:} Don't use footnotes in the argument of the -@code{@@item} command for a @code{@@table} table. This doesn't work, and -because of limitations of @TeX{}, there is no way to fix it. You must -put the footnote into the body text of the table. - -In a printed manual or book, the reference mark for a footnote is a -small, superscripted number; the text of the footnote appears at the -bottom of the page, below a horizontal line.@refill - -In Info, the reference mark for a footnote is a pair of parentheses -with the footnote number between them, like this: @samp{(1)}.@refill +@node Conditionals +@chapter Conditionally Visible Text +@cindex Conditionally visible text +@cindex Text, conditionally visible +@cindex Visibility of conditional text +@cindex If text conditionally visible +Sometimes it is good to use different text for different output formats. +For example, you can use the @dfn{conditional commands} to specify +different text for the printed manual and the Info output. -@node Footnote Styles, , Footnote Commands, Footnotes -@section Footnote Styles +Conditional commands may not be nested. -Info has two footnote styles, which determine where the text of the -footnote is located:@refill +The conditional commands comprise the following categories. @itemize @bullet -@cindex @samp{@r{End}} node footnote style +@item Commands for HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. +@item Commands for not HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. +@item Raw @TeX{} or HTML commands. @item -In the `End' node style, all the footnotes for a single node -are placed at the end of that node. The footnotes are separated from -the rest of the node by a line of dashes with the word -@samp{Footnotes} within it. Each footnote begins with an -@samp{(@var{n})} reference mark.@refill - -@need 700 -@noindent -Here is an example of a single footnote in the end of node style:@refill - -@example -@group - --------- Footnotes --------- - -(1) Here is a sample footnote. -@end group -@end example - -@cindex @samp{@r{Separate}} footnote style -@item -In the `Separate' node style, all the footnotes for a single -node are placed in an automatically constructed node of -their own. In this style, a ``footnote reference'' follows -each @samp{(@var{n})} reference mark in the body of the -node. The footnote reference is actually a cross reference -which you use to reach the footnote node.@refill - -The name of the node containing the footnotes is constructed -by appending @w{@samp{-Footnotes}} to the name of the node -that contains the footnotes. (Consequently, the footnotes' -node for the @file{Footnotes} node is -@w{@file{Footnotes-Footnotes}}!) The footnotes' node has an -`Up' node pointer that leads back to its parent node.@refill - -@noindent -Here is how the first footnote in this manual looks after being -formatted for Info in the separate node style:@refill - -@smallexample -@group -File: texinfo.info Node: Overview-Footnotes, Up: Overview - -(1) Note that the first syllable of "Texinfo" is -pronounced like "speck", not "hex". @dots{} -@end group -@end smallexample +Substituting text for all formats, and testing if a flag is set or clear. @end itemize -A Texinfo file may be formatted into an Info file with either footnote -style.@refill - -@findex footnotestyle -Use the @code{@@footnotestyle} command to specify an Info file's -footnote style. Write this command at the beginning of a line followed -by an argument, either @samp{end} for the end node style or -@samp{separate} for the separate node style. - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -@@footnotestyle end -@end example -@noindent -or -@example -@@footnotestyle separate -@end example - -Write an @code{@@footnotestyle} command before or shortly after the -end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. (If you -include the @code{@@footnotestyle} command between the start-of-header -and end-of-header lines, the region formatting commands will format -footnotes as specified.)@refill - -If you do not specify a footnote style, the formatting commands use -their default style. Currently, @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and -@code{texinfo-format-region} use the `separate' style and -@code{makeinfo} uses the `end' style.@refill - -@c !!! note: makeinfo's --footnote-style option overrides footnotestyle -@ignore -If you use @code{makeinfo} to create the Info file, the -@samp{--footnote-style} option determines which style is used, -@samp{end} for the end of node style or @samp{separate} for the -separate node style. Thus, to format the Texinfo manual in the -separate node style, you would use the following shell command:@refill - -@example -makeinfo --footnote-style=separate texinfo.texi -@end example - -@noindent -To format the Texinfo manual in the end of node style, you would -type:@refill - -@example -makeinfo --footnote-style=end texinfo.texi -@end example -@end ignore -@ignore -If you use @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or -@code{texinfo-format-region} to create the Info file, the value of the -@code{texinfo-footnote-style} variable controls the footnote style. -It can be either @samp{"separate"} for the separate node style or -@samp{"end"} for the end of node style. (You can change the value of -this variable with the @kbd{M-x edit-options} command (@pxref{Edit -Options, , Editing Variable Values, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}), or -with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command (@pxref{Examining, , Examining -and Setting Variables, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}).@refill - -The @code{texinfo-footnote-style} variable also controls the style if -you use the @kbd{M-x makeinfo-region} or @kbd{M-x makeinfo-buffer} -command in Emacs.@refill -@end ignore -This chapter contains two footnotes.@refill - - -@node Conditionals, Macros, Footnotes, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Conditionally Visible Text -@cindex Conditionally visible text -@cindex Text, conditionally visible -@cindex Visibility of conditional text -@cindex If text conditionally visible - -Sometimes it is good to use different text for a printed manual and -its corresponding Info file. In this case, you can use the -@dfn{conditional commands} to specify which text is for the printed manual -and which is for the Info file.@refill - @menu * Conditional Commands:: Specifying text for HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. * Conditional Not Commands:: Specifying text for not HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. @@ -11338,21 +11546,18 @@ and which is for the Info file.@refill flag to a string that you can insert. @end menu -@node Conditional Commands, Conditional Not Commands, Conditionals, Conditionals -@ifinfo -@heading Conditional Commands -@end ifinfo + +@node Conditional Commands +@section Conditional Commands @findex ifinfo -@code{@@ifinfo} begins segments of text that should be ignored -by @TeX{} when it -typesets the printed manual. The segment of text appears only -in the Info file. -The @code{@@ifinfo} command should appear on a line by itself; end -the Info-only text with a line containing @code{@@end ifinfo} by -itself. At the beginning of a Texinfo file, the Info permissions are -contained within a region marked by @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end -ifinfo}. (@xref{Info Summary and Permissions}.)@refill +@code{@@ifinfo} begins segments of text that should be ignored by @TeX{} +when it typesets the printed manual. The segment of text appears only +in the Info file. The @code{@@ifinfo} command should appear on a line +by itself; end the Info-only text with a line containing @code{@@end +ifinfo} by itself. At the beginning of a Texinfo file, the Info +permissions are contained within a region marked by @code{@@ifinfo} and +@code{@@end ifinfo}. (@xref{Info Summary and Permissions}.) @findex iftex @findex ifhtml @@ -11371,6 +11576,9 @@ This text will appear only in the printed manual. @@ifinfo However, this text will appear only in Info. @@end ifinfo +@@ifhtml +And this text will only appear in HTML. +@@end ifhtml @end example @noindent @@ -11381,18 +11589,16 @@ This text will appear only in the printed manual. @ifinfo However, this text will appear only in Info. @end ifinfo +@ifhtml +And this text will only appear in HTML. +@end ifhtml @noindent -Note how you only see one of the two lines, depending on whether you -are reading the Info version or the printed version of this -manual.@refill +Notice that you only see one of the input lines, depending on which +version of the manual you are reading. -The @code{@@titlepage} command is a special variant of @code{@@iftex} that -is used for making the title and copyright pages of the printed -manual. (@xref{titlepage, , @code{@@titlepage}}.) @refill - -@node Conditional Not Commands, Raw Formatter Commands, Conditional Commands, Conditionals +@node Conditional Not Commands @section Conditional Not Commands @findex ifnothtml @findex ifnotinfo @@ -11413,7 +11619,8 @@ If the output file is not being made for the given format, the region is included. Otherwise, it is ignored. The regions delimited by these commands are ordinary Texinfo source as -with @code{@@iftex}, not raw formatter source as with @code{@@tex}. +with @code{@@iftex}, not raw formatter source as with @code{@@tex} +(@pxref{Raw Formatter Commands}). @node Raw Formatter Commands, set clear value, Conditional Not Commands, Conditionals @@ -11445,8 +11652,8 @@ overridden by Texinfo features. You can enter plain @TeX{} completely, and use @samp{\} in the @TeX{} commands, by delineating a region with the @code{@@tex} and @code{@@end tex} commands. (The @code{@@tex} command also causes Info to ignore the -region, like the @code{@@iftex} command.) The sole exception is that -@code{@@} chracter still introduces a command, so that @code{@@end tex} +region, like the @code{@@iftex} command.) The sole exception is that the +@code{@@} character still introduces a command, so that @code{@@end tex} can be recognized properly. @cindex Mathematical expressions @@ -11480,13 +11687,12 @@ $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N @findex html Analogously, you can use @code{@@ifhtml @dots{} @@end ifhtml} to delimit a region to be included in HTML output only, and @code{@@html @dots{} -@@end ifhtml} for a region of raw HTML (again, except that @code{@@} is +@@end html} for a region of raw HTML (again, except that @code{@@} is still the escape character, so the @code{@@end} command can be recognized.) -@node set clear value, , Raw Formatter Commands, Conditionals -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node set clear value @section @code{@@set}, @code{@@clear}, and @code{@@value} You can direct the Texinfo formatting commands to format or ignore parts @@ -11501,12 +11707,12 @@ insert the date in several places in the Texinfo file.@refill @menu * ifset ifclear:: Format a region if a flag is set. -* value:: Replace a flag with a string. +* set value:: Expand a flag variable to a string. * value Example:: An easy way to update edition information. @end menu -@node ifset ifclear, value, set clear value, set clear value +@node ifset ifclear @subsection @code{@@ifset} and @code{@@ifclear} @findex ifset @@ -11516,8 +11722,10 @@ ifset} commands. When the @var{flag} is cleared, the Texinfo formatting commands do @emph{not} format the text. Use the @code{@@set @var{flag}} command to turn on, or @dfn{set}, a -@var{flag}; a @dfn{flag} can be any single word. The format for the -command looks like this:@refill +@var{flag}; a @dfn{flag} name can be any single word, containing +letters, numerals, hyphens, or underscores. + +The format for the command looks like this:@refill @findex set @example @@ -11621,13 +11829,17 @@ format the text up to the following @code{@@end ifclear} command.@refill @end table -@node value, value Example, ifset ifclear, set clear value -@subsection @code{@@value} + +@node set value +@subsection @code{@@set} and @code{@@value} @findex value You can use the @code{@@set} command to specify a value for a flag, -which is expanded by the @code{@@value} command. The value is a string -a characters. +which is expanded by the @code{@@value} command. A flag is an +identifier; for best results, use only letters and numerals in a flag +name, not @samp{-} or @samp{_}---they will work in some contexts, but +not all, due to limitations in @TeX{}. The value is just a string of +characters, the remainder of the input line. Write the @code{@@set} command like this: @@ -11636,12 +11848,11 @@ Write the @code{@@set} command like this: @end example @noindent -This sets the value of @code{foo} to ``This is a string.'' +This sets the value of the flag @code{foo} to ``This is a string.''. -The Texinfo formatters replace an @code{@@value@{@var{flag}@}} command with -the string to which @var{flag} is set.@refill - -Thus, when @code{foo} is set as shown above, the Texinfo formatters convert +The Texinfo formatters then replace an @code{@@value@{@var{flag}@}} +command with the string to which @var{flag} is set. Thus, when +@code{foo} is set as shown above, the Texinfo formatters convert @example @group @@ -11663,9 +11874,9 @@ If you write the @code{@@set} command like this: @noindent without specifying a string, the value of @code{foo} is an empty string. -If you clear a previously set flag with an @code{@@clear @var{flag}} -command, a subsequent @code{@@value@{flag@}} command is invalid and the -string is replaced with an error message that says @samp{@{No value for +If you clear a previously set flag with @code{@@clear @var{flag}}, a +subsequent @code{@@value@{flag@}} command is invalid and the string is +replaced with an error message that says @samp{@{No value for "@var{flag}"@}}. For example, if you set @code{foo} as follows:@refill @@ -11702,15 +11913,16 @@ It is a @{No value for "how-much"@} wet day. @end group @end example -@node value Example, , value, set clear value + +@node value Example @subsection @code{@@value} Example You can use the @code{@@value} command to limit the number of places you -need to change when you record an update to a manual. -Here is how it is done in @cite{The GNU Make Manual}: +need to change when you record an update to a manual. Here is how it is +done in @cite{The GNU Make Manual}: -@need 1000 -@noindent +@enumerate +@item Set the flags: @example @@ -11722,8 +11934,7 @@ Set the flags: @end group @end example -@need 750 -@noindent +@item Write text for the first @code{@@ifinfo} section, for people reading the Texinfo file: @@ -11732,12 +11943,11 @@ Texinfo file: This is Edition @@value@{EDITION@}, last updated @@value@{UPDATED@}, of @@cite@{The GNU Make Manual@}, -for @@code@{make@}, Version @@value@{VERSION@}. +for @@code@{make@}, version @@value@{VERSION@}. @end group @end example -@need 1000 -@noindent +@item Write text for the title page, for people reading the printed manual: @c List only the month and the year since that looks less fussy on a @c printed cover than a date that lists the day as well. @@ -11755,8 +11965,7 @@ Write text for the title page, for people reading the printed manual: (On a printed cover, a date listing the month and the year looks less fussy than a date listing the day as well as the month and year.) -@need 750 -@noindent +@item Write text for the Top node, for people reading the Info file: @example @@ -11768,7 +11977,6 @@ for @@code@{make@} Version @@value@{VERSION@}. @end group @end example -@need 950 After you format the manual, the text in the first @code{@@ifinfo} section looks like this: @@ -11778,49 +11986,336 @@ This is Edition 0.35 Beta, last updated 14 August 1992, of `The GNU Make Manual', for `make', Version 3.63 Beta. @end group @end example +@end enumerate When you update the manual, change only the values of the flags; you do -not need to rewrite the three sections. +not need to edit the three sections. + + +@node Internationalization +@chapter Internationalization + +@cindex Internationalization +Texinfo has some support for writing in languages other than English, +although this area still needs considerable work. +For a list of the various accented and special characters Texinfo +supports, see @ref{Inserting Accents}. -@node Macros, Format/Print Hardcopy, Conditionals, Top -@chapter Macros: Defining New Texinfo Commands +@menu +* documentlanguage:: Declaring the current language. +* documentencoding:: Declaring the input encoding. +@end menu + + +@node documentlanguage +@section @code{@@documentlanguage @var{cc}}: Set the Document Language + +@findex documentlanguage +@cindex Language, declaring +@cindex Document language, declaring + +The @code{@@documentlanguage} command declares the current document +language. Write it on a line by itself, with a two-letter ISO-639 +language code following (list is included below). If you have a +multilingual document, the intent is to be able to use this command +multiple times, to declare each language change. If the command is not +used at all, the default is @code{en} for English. + +@cindex @file{txi-@var{cc}.tex} +At present, this command is ignored in Info and HTML output. For +@TeX{}, it causes the file @file{txi-@var{cc}.tex} to be read (if it +exists). Such a file appropriately redefines the various English words +used in @TeX{} output, such as `Chapter', `See', and so on. + +@cindex Hyphenation patterns, language-dependent +It would be good if this command also changed @TeX{}'s ideas of the +current hyphenation patterns (via the @TeX{} primitive +@code{\language}), but this is unfortunately not currently implemented. + +@cindex ISO 639 codes +@cindex Language codes +@cindex African languages +Here is the list of valid language codes. This list comes from +@uref{http://www.iro.umontreal.ca/contrib/po/iso-639, the free +translation project}. In the future we may wish to allow the 3-letter +POV codes described at @uref{http://www.sil.org/ethnologue/#contents}. +This will be necessary to support African languages. + +@multitable @columnfractions .06 .27 .06 .27 .06 .27 +@item +@code{aa} @tab Afar @tab +@code{ab} @tab Abkhazian @tab +@code{af} @tab Afrikaans +@item +@code{am} @tab Amharic @tab +@code{ar} @tab Arabic @tab +@code{as} @tab Assamese +@item +@code{ay} @tab Aymara @tab +@code{az} @tab Azerbaijani @tab +@code{ba} @tab Bashkir +@item +@code{be} @tab Byelorussian @tab +@code{bg} @tab Bulgarian @tab +@code{bh} @tab Bihari +@item +@code{bi} @tab Bislama @tab +@code{bn} @tab Bengali; Bangla @tab +@code{bo} @tab Tibetan +@item +@code{br} @tab Breton @tab +@code{ca} @tab Catalan @tab +@code{co} @tab Corsican +@item +@code{cs} @tab Czech @tab +@code{cy} @tab Welsh @tab +@code{da} @tab Danish +@item +@code{de} @tab German @tab +@code{dz} @tab Bhutani @tab +@code{el} @tab Greek +@item +@code{en} @tab English @tab +@code{eo} @tab Esperanto @tab +@code{es} @tab Spanish +@item +@code{et} @tab Estonian @tab +@code{eu} @tab Basque @tab +@code{fa} @tab Persian +@item +@code{fi} @tab Finnish @tab +@code{fj} @tab Fiji @tab +@code{fo} @tab Faroese +@item +@code{fr} @tab French @tab +@code{fy} @tab Frisian @tab +@code{ga} @tab Irish +@item +@code{gd} @tab Scots Gaelic @tab +@code{gl} @tab Galician @tab +@code{gn} @tab Guarani +@item +@code{gu} @tab Gujarati @tab +@code{ha} @tab Hausa @tab +@code{he} @tab Hebrew +@item +@code{hi} @tab Hindi @tab +@code{hr} @tab Croatian @tab +@code{hu} @tab Hungarian +@item +@code{hy} @tab Armenian @tab +@code{ia} @tab Interlingua @tab +@code{id} @tab Indonesian +@item +@code{ie} @tab Interlingue @tab +@code{ik} @tab Inupiak @tab +@code{is} @tab Icelandic +@item +@code{it} @tab Italian @tab +@code{iu} @tab Inuktitut @tab +@code{ja} @tab Japanese +@item +@code{jw} @tab Javanese @tab +@code{ka} @tab Georgian @tab +@code{kk} @tab Kazakh +@item +@code{kl} @tab Greenlandic @tab +@code{km} @tab Cambodian @tab +@code{kn} @tab Kannada +@item +@code{ks} @tab Kashmiri @tab +@code{ko} @tab Korean @tab +@code{ku} @tab Kurdish +@item +@code{ky} @tab Kirghiz @tab +@code{la} @tab Latin @tab +@code{ln} @tab Lingala +@item +@code{lt} @tab Lithuanian @tab +@code{lo} @tab Laothian @tab +@code{lv} @tab Latvian, Lettish +@item +@code{mg} @tab Malagasy @tab +@code{mi} @tab Maori @tab +@code{mk} @tab Macedonian +@item +@code{ml} @tab Malayalam @tab +@code{mn} @tab Mongolian @tab +@code{mo} @tab Moldavian +@item +@code{mr} @tab Marathi @tab +@code{ms} @tab Malay @tab +@code{mt} @tab Maltese +@item +@code{my} @tab Burmese @tab +@code{na} @tab Nauru @tab +@code{ne} @tab Nepali +@item +@code{nl} @tab Dutch @tab +@code{no} @tab Norwegian @tab +@code{oc} @tab Occitan +@item +@code{om} @tab (Afan) Oromo @tab +@code{or} @tab Oriya @tab +@code{pa} @tab Punjabi +@item +@code{pl} @tab Polish @tab +@code{ps} @tab Pashto, Pushto @tab +@code{pt} @tab Portuguese +@item +@code{qu} @tab Quechua @tab +@code{rm} @tab Rhaeto-Romance @tab +@code{rn} @tab Kirundi +@item +@code{ro} @tab Romanian @tab +@code{ru} @tab Russian @tab +@code{rw} @tab Kinyarwanda +@item +@code{sa} @tab Sanskrit @tab +@code{sd} @tab Sindhi @tab +@code{sg} @tab Sangro +@item +@code{sh} @tab Serbo-Croatian @tab +@code{si} @tab Sinhalese @tab +@code{sk} @tab Slovak +@item +@code{sl} @tab Slovenian @tab +@code{sm} @tab Samoan @tab +@code{sn} @tab Shona +@item +@code{so} @tab Somali @tab +@code{sq} @tab Albanian @tab +@code{sr} @tab Serbian +@item +@code{ss} @tab Siswati @tab +@code{st} @tab Sesotho @tab +@code{su} @tab Sundanese +@item +@code{sv} @tab Swedish @tab +@code{sw} @tab Swahili @tab +@code{ta} @tab Tamil +@item +@code{te} @tab Telugu @tab +@code{tg} @tab Tajik @tab +@code{th} @tab Thai +@item +@code{ti} @tab Tigrinya @tab +@code{tk} @tab Turkmen @tab +@code{tl} @tab Tagalog +@item +@code{tn} @tab Setswana @tab +@code{to} @tab Tonga @tab +@code{tr} @tab Turkish +@item +@code{ts} @tab Tsonga @tab +@code{tt} @tab Tatar @tab +@code{tw} @tab Twi +@item +@code{ug} @tab Uighur @tab +@code{uk} @tab Ukrainian @tab +@code{ur} @tab Urdu +@item +@code{uz} @tab Uzbek @tab +@code{vi} @tab Vietnamese @tab +@code{vo} @tab Volapuk +@item +@code{wo} @tab Wolof @tab +@code{xh} @tab Xhosa @tab +@code{yi} @tab Yiddish +@item +@code{yo} @tab Yoruba @tab +@code{za} @tab Zhuang @tab +@code{zh} @tab Chinese +@item +@code{zu} @tab Zulu +@end multitable + + +@node documentencoding +@section @code{@@documentencoding @var{enc}}: Set Input Encoding + +@findex documentencoding +@cindex Encoding, declaring +@cindex Input encoding, declaring +@cindex Document input encoding + +The @code{@@documentencoding} command declares the input document +encoding. Write it on a line by itself, with a valid encoding +specification following, such as @samp{ISO-8859-1}. + +@cindex http-equiv, and charset +@cindex meta HTML tag, and charset +At present, this is used only in HTML output from @code{makeinfo}. If a +document encoding @var{enc} is specified, it is used in the +@samp{} tag is included in the @samp{} of the output: + +@example + +@end example + + +@node Defining New Texinfo Commands +@chapter Defining New Texinfo Commands @cindex Macros @cindex Defining new Texinfo commands @cindex New Texinfo commands, defining @cindex Texinfo commands, defining new @cindex User-defined Texinfo commands +Texinfo provides several ways to define new commands: + +@itemize @bullet +@item A Texinfo @dfn{macro} allows you to define a new Texinfo command as any sequence of text and/or existing commands (including other macros). The macro can have any number of @dfn{parameters}---text you supply each -time you use the macro. (This has nothing to do with the -@code{@@defmac} command, which is for documenting macros in the subject -of the manual; @pxref{Def Cmd Template}.) +time you use the macro. + +Incidentally, these macros have nothing to do with the @code{@@defmac} +command, which is for documenting macros in the subject of the manual +(@pxref{Def Cmd Template}). + +@item +@samp{@@alias} is a convenient way to define a new name for an existing +command. + +@item +@samp{@@definfoenclose} allows you to define new commands with +customized output in the Info file. + +@end itemize @menu -* Defining Macros:: Both defining and undefining new commands. +* Defining Macros:: Defining and undefining new commands. * Invoking Macros:: Using a macro, once you've defined it. +* Macro Details:: Beyond basic macro usage. +* alias:: Command aliases. +* definfoenclose:: Customized highlighting. @end menu -@node Defining Macros, Invoking Macros, Macros, Macros +@node Defining Macros @section Defining Macros @cindex Defining macros @cindex Macro definitions +@cindex Definitions, a.k.a.@: macros @findex macro -You use the Texinfo @code{@@macro} command to define a macro. For example: +You use the Texinfo @code{@@macro} command to define a macro, like this: @example -@@macro @var{macro-name}@{@var{param1}, @var{param2}, @dots{}@} +@@macro @var{macroname}@{@var{param1}, @var{param2}, @dots{}@} @var{text} @dots{} \@var{param1}\ @dots{} @@end macro @end example The @dfn{parameters} @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @dots{} correspond to arguments supplied when the macro is subsequently used in the document -(see the next section). +(described in the next section). + +For a macro to work with @TeX{}, @var{macroname} must consist entirely +of letters: no digits, hyphens, underscores, or other special characters. If a macro needs no parameters, you can define it either with an empty list (@samp{@@macro foo @{@}}) or with no braces at all (@samp{@@macro @@ -11829,12 +12324,44 @@ foo}). @cindex Body of a macro @cindex Mutually recursive macros @cindex Recursion, mutual -The definition or @dfn{body} of the macro can contain any Texinfo -commands, including previously-defined macros. (It is not possible to -have mutually recursive Texinfo macros.) In the body, instances of a -parameter name surrounded by backslashes, as in @samp{\@var{param1}\} in -the example above, are replaced by the corresponding argument from the -macro invocation. +The definition or @dfn{body} of the macro can contain most Texinfo +commands, including previously-defined macros. Not-yet-defined macro +invocations are not allowed; thus, it is not possible to have mutually +recursive Texinfo macros. Also, a macro definition that defines another +macro does not work in @TeX{} due to limitations in the design of +@code{@@macro}. + +@cindex Parameters to macros +In the macro body, instances of a parameter name surrounded by +backslashes, as in @samp{\@var{param1}\} in the example above, are +replaced by the corresponding argument from the macro invocation. You +can use parameter names any number of times in the body, including zero. + +@cindex Backslash in macros +To get a single @samp{\} in the macro expansion, use @samp{\\}. Any +other use of @samp{\} in the body yields a warning. + +@cindex Spaces in macros +@cindex Whitespace in macros +The newlines after the @code{@@macro} line and before the @code{@@end +macro} line are ignored, that is, not included in the macro body. All +other whitespace is treated according to the usual Texinfo rules. + +@cindex Recursive macro invocations +@findex rmacro +To allow a macro to be used recursively, that is, in an argument to a +call to itself, you must define it with @samp{@@rmacro}, like this: + +@example +@@rmacro rmac +a\arg\b +@@end rmacro +@dots{} +@@rmac@{1@@rmac@{text@}2@} +@end example + +This produces the output `a1atextb2b'. With @samp{@@macro} instead of +@samp{@@rmacro}, an error message is given. @findex unmacro @cindex Macros, undefining @@ -11848,21 +12375,22 @@ For example: @end example -@node Invoking Macros, , Defining Macros, Macros +@node Invoking Macros @section Invoking Macros @cindex Invoking macros +@cindex Expanding macros +@cindex Running macros @cindex Macro invocation After a macro is defined (see the previous section), you can use (@dfn{invoke}) it in your document like this: @example -@@@var{macro-name} @{@var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}@} +@@@var{macroname} @{@var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}@} @end example -@noindent -and the result will be just as if you typed the body of -@var{macro-name} at that spot. For example: +@noindent and the result will be just as if you typed the body of +@var{macroname} at that spot. For example: @example @@macro foo @{p, q@} @@ -11871,50 +12399,242 @@ Together: \p\ & \q\. @@foo@{a, b@} @end example -@noindent -produces: +@noindent produces: @display Together: a & b. @end display -@cindex Backslash, and macros -Thus, the arguments and parameters are separated by commas and delimited -by braces; any whitespace after (but not before) a comma is ignored. To -insert a comma, brace, or backslash in an argument, prepend a backslash, -as in +@cindex Backslash, and macros +Thus, the arguments and parameters are separated by commas and delimited +by braces; any whitespace after (but not before) a comma is ignored. +The braces are required in the invocation (but not the definition), even +when the macro takes no arguments, consistent with all other Texinfo +commands. For example: + +@example +@@macro argless @{@} +No arguments here. +@@end macro +@@argless@{@} +@end example + +@noindent produces: + +@display +No arguments here. +@end display + +To insert a comma, brace, or backslash in an argument, prepend a +backslash, as in + +@example +@@@var{macname} @{\\\@{\@}\,@} +@end example + +@noindent +which will pass the (almost certainly error-producing) argument +@samp{\@{@},} to @var{macname}. + +If the macro is defined to take a single argument, and is invoked +without any braces, the entire rest of the line after the macro name is +supplied as the argument. For example: + +@example +@@macro bar @{p@} +Twice: \p\ & \p\. +@@end macro +@@bar aah +@end example + +@noindent produces: + +@c Sorry for cheating, but let's not require macros to process the manual. +@display +Twice: aah & aah. +@end display + +If the macro is defined to take a single argument, and is invoked with +braces, the braced text is passed as the argument, regardless of +commas. For example: + +@example +@@macro bar @{p@} +Twice: \p\ & \p\. +@@end macro +@@bar@{a,b@} +@end example + +@noindent produces: + +@display +Twice: a,b & a,b. +@end display + + +@node Macro Details +@section Macro Details +@cindex Macro details +@cindex Details of macro usage + +Due to unavoidable disparities in the @TeX{} and @command{makeinfo} +implementations, Texinfo macros have the following limitations. + +@itemize @bullet +@item +All macros are expanded inside at least one @TeX{} group. This means +that @set and other such commands will have no effect inside a macro. + +@item +Macros containing a command which must be on a line by itself, such as a +conditional, cannot be invoked in the middle of a line. + +@item +The @TeX{} implementation cannot construct macros that define macros in +the natural way. To do this, you must use conditionals and raw @TeX{}. +For example: + +@example +@@ifinfo +@@macro ctor @{name, arg@} +@@macro \name\ +something involving \arg\ somehow +@@end macro +@@end macro +@@end ifinfo +@@tex +\gdef\ctor#1@{\ctorx#1,@} +\gdef\ctorx#1,#2,@{\def#1@{something involving #2 somehow@}@} +@@end tex +@end example + +@item +It is best to avoid comments inside macro definitions. + +@end itemize + + +@node alias +@section @samp{@@alias @var{new}=@var{existing}} +@cindex Aliases, command +@cindex Command aliases +@findex alias + +The @samp{@@alias} command defines a new command to be just like an +existing one. This is useful for defining additional markup names, thus +preserving semantic information in the input even though the output +result may be the same. + +Write the @samp{@@alias} command on a line by itself, followed by the +new command name, an equals sign, and the existing command name. +Whitespace around the equals sign is ignored. Thus: +@example +@@alias @var{new} = @var{existing} +@end example + +For example, if your document contains citations for both books and +some other media (movies, for example), you might like to define a +macro @code{@@moviecite@{@}} that does the same thing as an ordinary +@code{@@cite@{@}} but conveys the extra semantic information as well. +You'd do this as follows: + +@example +@@alias moviecite = cite +@end example + +Macros do not always have the same effect due to vagaries of argument +parsing. Also, aliases are much simpler to define than macros. So the +command is not redundant. (It was also heavily used in the Jargon File!) + +Aliases must not be recursive, directly or indirectly. + +@node definfoenclose +@section @samp{definfoenclose}: Customized Highlighting +@cindex Highlighting, customized +@cindex Customized highlighting +@findex definfoenclose + +A @code{@@definfoenclose} command may be used to define a highlighting +command for Info, but not for TeX. A command defined using +@code{@@definfoenclose} marks text by enclosing it in strings that +precede and follow the text. You can use this to get closer control of +your Info output. + +Presumably, if you define a command with @code{@@definfoenclose} for Info, +you will create a corresponding command for @TeX{}, either in +@file{texinfo.tex}, @file{texinfo.cnf}, or within an @samp{@@iftex} in +your document. + +Write a @code{@@definfoenclose} command on a line and follow it with +three arguments separated by commas. The first argument to +@code{@@definfoenclose} is the @@-command name (without the @code{@@}); +the second argument is the Info start delimiter string; and the third +argument is the Info end delimiter string. The latter two arguments +enclose the highlighted text in the Info file. A delimiter string may +contain spaces. Neither the start nor end delimiter is required. If +you do not want a start delimiter but do want an end delimiter, you must +follow the command name with two commas in a row; otherwise, the Info +formatting commands will naturally misinterpret the end delimiter string +you intended as the start delimiter string. + +If you do a @code{@@definfoenclose} on the name of a pre-defined macro +(such as @code{@@emph}, @code{@@strong}, @code{@@t}, or @code{@@i}), the +enclosure definition will override the built-in definition. + +An enclosure command defined this way takes one argument in braces; this +is intended for new markup commands (@pxref{Marking Text}). + +@findex phoo +For example, you can write: + +@example +@@definfoenclose phoo,//,\\ +@end example + +@noindent +near the beginning of a Texinfo file to define @code{@@phoo} as an Info +formatting command that inserts `//' before and `\\' after the argument +to @code{@@phoo}. You can then write @code{@@phoo@{bar@}} wherever you +want `//bar\\' highlighted in Info. + +Also, for TeX formatting, you could write @example -@@@var{macro-name} @{\\\@{\@}\,@} +@@iftex +@@global@@let@@phoo=@@i +@@end iftex @end example @noindent -which will pass the (almost certainly error-producing) argument -@samp{\@{@},} to @var{macro-name}. +to define @code{@@phoo} as a command that causes TeX to typeset the +argument to @code{@@phoo} in italics. -If the macro is defined to take a single argument, and is invoked -without any braces, the entire rest of the line after the macro name is -supplied as the argument. For example: +Note that each definition applies to its own formatter: one for TeX, +the other for @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or +@code{texinfo-format-region}. The @code{@@definfoenclose} command need +not be within @samp{@@ifinfo}, but the raw @TeX{} commands do need to be +in @samp{@@iftex}. + +@findex headword +Here is another example: write @example -@@macro bar @{p@} -Twice: \p\, \p\. -@@end macro -@@bar aah +@@definfoenclose headword, , : @end example @noindent -produces: +near the beginning of the file, to define @code{@@headword} as an Info +formatting command that inserts nothing before and a colon after the +argument to @code{@@headword}. -@display -Twice: aah, aah. -@end display +@samp{@@definfoenclose} definitions must not be recursive, directly or +indirectly. -@node Format/Print Hardcopy, Create an Info File, Macros, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Format and Print Hardcopy +@node Hardcopy +@chapter Formatting and Printing Hardcopy @cindex Format and print hardcopy +@cindex Printing hardcopy @cindex Hardcopy, printing it @cindex Making a printed manual @cindex Sorting indices @@ -11927,49 +12647,49 @@ Texinfo file: one for converting the Texinfo file into a file that will be printed, a second for sorting indices, and a third for printing the formatted document. When you use the shell commands, you can either work directly in the operating system shell or work within a shell -inside GNU Emacs.@refill +inside GNU Emacs. If you are using GNU Emacs, you can use commands provided by Texinfo mode instead of shell commands. In addition to the three commands to format a file, sort the indices, and print the result, Texinfo mode offers key bindings for commands to recenter the output buffer, show the -print queue, and delete a job from the print queue.@refill +print queue, and delete a job from the print queue. @menu * Use TeX:: Use @TeX{} to format for hardcopy. -* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format in a shell. -* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to use the shell. +* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format with explicit shell commands. +* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to format. * Print with lpr:: How to print. * Within Emacs:: How to format and print from an Emacs shell. * Texinfo Mode Printing:: How to format and print in Texinfo mode. * Compile-Command:: How to print using Emacs's compile command. * Requirements Summary:: @TeX{} formatting requirements summary. -* Preparing for TeX:: What you need to do to use @TeX{}. +* Preparing for TeX:: What to do before you use @TeX{}. * Overfull hboxes:: What are and what to do with overfull hboxes. * smallbook:: How to print small format books and manuals. * A4 Paper:: How to print on European A4 paper. +* pagesizes:: How to print with customized page sizes. * Cropmarks and Magnification:: How to print marks to indicate the size of pages and how to print scaled up output. +* PDF Output:: Portable Document Format output. @end menu -@node Use TeX, Format with tex/texindex, Format/Print Hardcopy, Format/Print Hardcopy -@ifinfo -@heading Use @TeX{} -@end ifinfo +@node Use TeX +@section Use @TeX{} The typesetting program called @TeX{} is used for formatting a Texinfo -file. @TeX{} is a very powerful typesetting program and, if used right, +file. @TeX{} is a very powerful typesetting program and, if used correctly, does an exceptionally good job. (@xref{Obtaining TeX, , How to Obtain @TeX{}}, for information on how to obtain @TeX{}.) The @code{makeinfo}, @code{texinfo-format-region}, and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} commands read the very same @@-commands in the Texinfo file as does @TeX{}, but process them differently to -make an Info file; see @ref{Create an Info File}.@refill +make an Info file (@pxref{Creating an Info File}). -@node Format with tex/texindex, Format with texi2dvi, Use TeX, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Format using @code{tex} and @code{texindex} + +@node Format with tex/texindex +@section Format with @code{tex} and @code{texindex} @cindex Shell formatting with @code{tex} and @code{texindex} @cindex Formatting with @code{tex} and @code{texindex} @cindex DVI file @@ -11981,23 +12701,23 @@ the name of the Texinfo file. For example: tex foo.texi @end example -@noindent -@TeX{} will produce a @dfn{DVI file} as well as several auxiliary +@noindent @TeX{} will produce a @dfn{DVI file} as well as several auxiliary files containing information for indices, cross references, etc. The DVI file (for @dfn{DeVice Independent} file) can be printed on virtually -any printe (see the following sections). +any device (see the following sections). @pindex texindex The @code{tex} formatting command itself does not sort the indices; it writes an output file of unsorted index data. (The @code{texi2dvi} -command automatically generates indices; see @ref{Format with texi2dvi,, -Format using @code{texi2dvi}}.) To generate a printed index after +command automatically generates indices; @pxref{Format with texi2dvi,, +Format with @code{texi2dvi}}.) To generate a printed index after running the @code{tex} command, you first need a sorted index to work from. The @code{texindex} command sorts indices. (The source file @file{texindex.c} comes as part of the standard Texinfo distribution, among other places.)@refill @cindex Names of index files +@cindex Index file names The @code{tex} formatting command outputs unsorted index files under names that obey a standard convention: the name of your main input file with any @samp{.tex} (or similar, @pxref{tex invocation,,, web2c, @@ -12005,14 +12725,14 @@ Web2c}) extension removed, followed by the two letter names of indices. For example, the raw index output files for the input file @file{foo.texinfo} would be @file{foo.cp}, @file{foo.vr}, @file{foo.fn}, @file{foo.tp}, @file{foo.pg} and @file{foo.ky}. Those are exactly the -arguments to give to @code{texindex}.@refill +arguments to give to @code{texindex}. @need 1000 @cindex Wildcards @cindex Globbing Instead of specifying all the unsorted index file names explicitly, you can use @samp{??} as shell wildcards and give the command in this -form:@refill +form: @example texindex foo.?? @@ -12024,13 +12744,13 @@ including any that you have defined yourself using @code{@@defindex} or @code{@@defcodeindex}. (You may execute @samp{texindex foo.??} even if there are similarly named files with two letter extensions that are not index files, such as @samp{foo.el}. The @code{texindex} -command reports but otherwise ignores such files.)@refill +command reports but otherwise ignores such files.) For each file specified, @code{texindex} generates a sorted index file whose name is made by appending @samp{s} to the input file name. The -@code{@@printindex} command knows to look for a file of that name +@code{@@printindex} command looks for a file with that name (@pxref{Printing Indices & Menus}). @code{texindex} does not alter the -raw index output file.@refill +raw index output file. After you have sorted the indices, you need to rerun the @code{tex} formatting command on the Texinfo file. This regenerates the DVI file, @@ -12039,7 +12759,7 @@ this time with up-to-date index entries. Finally, you may need to run @code{tex} one more time, to get the page numbers in the cross-references correct. -To summarize, this is a four step process: +To summarize, this is a five step process: @enumerate @item @@ -12057,43 +12777,84 @@ file, this time with indices and defined cross-references, but with page numbers for the cross-references from last time, generally incorrect. @item +Sort the indices again, with @code{texindex}. + +@item Run @code{tex} one last time. This time the correct page numbers are written for the cross-references. @end enumerate @pindex texi2dvi -Alternatively, it's a one-step process: run @code{texi2dvi}. +Alternatively, it's a one-step process: run @code{texi2dvi} +(@pxref{Format with texi2dvi}). You need not run @code{texindex} each time after you run @code{tex}. If you do not, on the next run, the @code{tex} formatting command will use whatever sorted index files happen to exist from the previous use of -@code{texindex}. This is usually ok while you are -debugging.@refill +@code{texindex}. This is usually ok while you are debugging. + +@cindex Auxiliary files, avoiding +@findex novalidate +@cindex Pointer validation, suppressing +@cindex Chapters, formatting one at a time +Sometimes you may wish to print a document while you know it is +incomplete, or to print just one chapter of a document. In that case, +the usual auxiliary files that @TeX{} creates and warnings @TeX{} gives +when cross-references are not satisfied are just nuisances. You can +avoid them with the @code{@@novalidate} command, which you must give +@emph{before} the @code{@@setfilename} command +(@pxref{setfilename,,@code{@@setfilename}}). Thus, the beginning of +your file would look approximately like this: + +@example +\input texinfo +@@novalidate +@@setfilename myfile.info +@dots{} +@end example +@noindent @code{@@novalidate} also turns off validation in +@code{makeinfo}, just like its @code{--no-validate} option +(@pxref{Pointer Validation}). -@node Format with texi2dvi, Print with lpr, Format with tex/texindex, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Format using @code{texi2dvi} + +@node Format with texi2dvi +@section Format with @code{texi2dvi} @pindex texi2dvi @r{(shell script)} The @code{texi2dvi} command automatically runs both @code{tex} and @code{texindex} as many times as necessary to produce a DVI file with -up-to-date, sorted indices. It simplifies the -@code{tex}---@code{texindex}---@code{tex} sequence described in the -previous section. +sorted indices and all cross-references resolved. It simplifies the +@code{tex}---@code{texindex}---@code{tex}---@code{tex} sequence +described in the previous section. -The syntax for @code{texi2dvi} is like this (where @samp{prompt$} is your -shell prompt):@refill +To run @code{texi2dvi} on an input file @file{foo.texi}, do this (where +@samp{prompt$ } is your shell prompt): @example -prompt$ @kbd{texi2dvi @var{filename}@dots{}} +prompt$ @kbd{texi2dvi foo.texi} @end example -For a list of options, run @samp{texi2dvi --help}. +As shown in this example, the input filenames to @code{texi2dvi} must +include any extension (@samp{.texi}, @samp{.texinfo}, etc.). Under +MS-DOS and perhaps in other circumstances, you may need to run @samp{sh +texi2dvi foo.texi} instead of relying on the operating system to invoke +the shell on the @samp{texi2dvi} script. +Perhaps the most useful option to @code{texi2dvi} is +@samp{--texinfo=@var{cmd}}. This inserts @var{cmd} on a line by itself +after the @code{@@setfilename} in a temporary copy of the input file +before running @TeX{}. With this, you can specify different printing +formats, such as @code{@@smallbook} (@pxref{smallbook}), +@code{@@afourpaper} (@pxref{A4 Paper}), or @code{@@pageparams} +(@pxref{pagesizes}), without actually changing the document source. +(You can also do this on a site-wide basis with @file{texinfo.cnf}; +@pxref{Preparing for TeX,,Preparing for @TeX{}}). -@node Print with lpr, Within Emacs, Format with texi2dvi, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +For a list of other options, run @samp{texi2dvi --help}. + + +@node Print with lpr, Within Emacs, Format with texi2dvi, Hardcopy @section Shell Print Using @code{lpr -d} @pindex lpr @r{(DVI print command)} @@ -12102,7 +12863,7 @@ installation, but @samp{lpr -d} is common. The command may require the DVI file name without any extension or with a @samp{.dvi} extension. (If it is @samp{lpr}, you must include the @samp{.dvi}.) -The following commands, for example, will (probably) suffice to sort the +For example, the following commands, will (perhaps) suffice to sort the indices, format, and print the @cite{Bison Manual}: @example @@ -12128,8 +12889,41 @@ lpr -d bison.dvi @end group @end example -@node Within Emacs, Texinfo Mode Printing, Print with lpr, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@cindex Shell printing, on MS-DOS/MS-Windows +@cindex Printing DVI files, on MS-DOS/MS-Windows +@pindex lpr@r{-d, replacements on MS-DOS/MS-Windows} +@code{lpr} is a standard program on Unix systems, but it is usually +absent on MS-DOS/MS-Windows. Some network packages come with a +program named @code{lpr}, but these are usually limited to sending files +to a print server over the network, and generally don't support the +@samp{-d} option. If you are unfortunate enough to work on one of these +systems, you have several alternative ways of printing DVI files: + +@itemize @bullet{} +@item Find and install a Unix-like @code{lpr} program, or its clone. +If you can do that, you will be able to print DVI files just like +described above. + +@item Send the DVI files to a network printer queue for DVI files. +Some network printers have special queues for printing DVI files. You +should be able to set up your network software to send files to that +queue. In some cases, the version of @code{lpr} which comes with your +network software will have a special option to send a file to specific +queues, like this: + +@example +lpr -Qdvi -hprint.server.domain bison.dvi +@end example + +@item Convert the DVI file to a Postscript or PCL file and send it to your +local printer. @xref{dvips invocation,,, dvips, Dvips}, and the man +pages for @code{dvilj}, for detailed description of these tools. Once +the DVI file is converted to the format your local printer understands +directly, just send it to the appropriate port, usually @samp{PRN}. +@end itemize + + +@node Within Emacs @section From an Emacs Shell @cindex Print, format from Emacs shell @cindex Format, print from Emacs shell @@ -12139,8 +12933,8 @@ lpr -d bison.dvi You can give formatting and printing commands from a shell within GNU Emacs. To create a shell within Emacs, type @kbd{M-x shell}. In this -shell, you can format and print the document. @xref{Format/Print -Hardcopy, , Format and Print Hardcopy}, for details.@refill +shell, you can format and print the document. @xref{Hardcopy, , Format +and Print Hardcopy}, for details. You can switch to and from the shell buffer while @code{tex} is running and do other editing. If you are formatting a long document @@ -12162,7 +12956,8 @@ lpr -d gcc.dvi and printing in Texinfo mode.@refill @end ifinfo -@node Texinfo Mode Printing, Compile-Command, Within Emacs, Format/Print Hardcopy + +@node Texinfo Mode Printing, Compile-Command, Within Emacs, Hardcopy @section Formatting and Printing in Texinfo Mode @cindex Region printing in Texinfo mode @cindex Format and print in Texinfo mode @@ -12205,7 +13000,7 @@ number shown by a preceding @kbd{C-c C-t C-q} command @item C-c C-t C-k @itemx M-x tex-kill-job -Kill the currently running @TeX{} job started by +Kill the currently running @TeX{} job started by either @code{texinfo-tex-region} or @code{texinfo-tex-buffer}, or any other process running in the Texinfo shell buffer.@refill @@ -12264,13 +13059,22 @@ tex-show-queue-command "lpq" You can change the values of these variables with the @kbd{M-x edit-options} command (@pxref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, -xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}), with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command -(@pxref{Examining, , Examining and Setting Variables, xemacs, XEmacs -User's Manual}), or with your @file{.emacs} initialization file -(@pxref{Init File, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}).@refill - -@node Compile-Command, Requirements Summary, Texinfo Mode Printing, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}), with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command +(@pxref{Examining, , Examining and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU +Emacs Manual}), or with your @file{.emacs} initialization file +(@pxref{Init File, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).@refill + +@cindex Customize Emacs package +@findex Development/Docs/Texinfo Customize group +Beginning with version 20, GNU Emacs offers a user-friendly interface, +called @dfn{Customize}, for changing values of user-definable variables. +@xref{Easy Customization, , Easy Customization Interface, emacs, The GNU +Emacs Manual}, for more details about this. The Texinfo variables can +be found in the @samp{Development/Docs/Texinfo} group, once you invoke +the @kbd{M-x customize} command. + + +@node Compile-Command, Requirements Summary, Texinfo Mode Printing, Hardcopy @section Using the Local Variables List @cindex Local variables @cindex Compile command for formatting @@ -12295,11 +13099,10 @@ End: @noindent This technique is most often used by programmers who also compile programs -this way; see @ref{Compilation, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}.@refill +this way; see @ref{Compilation, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.@refill -@node Requirements Summary, Preparing for TeX, Compile-Command, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node Requirements Summary @section @TeX{} Formatting Requirements Summary @cindex Requirements for formatting @cindex Minimal requirements for formatting @@ -12310,7 +13113,7 @@ Every Texinfo file that is to be input to @TeX{} must begin with a @example \input texinfo -@@setfilename @var{arg-not-used-by-@@TeX@{@}} +@@setfilename @var{arg-not-used-by-@TeX{}} @end example @noindent @@ -12325,7 +13128,7 @@ processing and forces out unfinished pages: @end example Strictly speaking, these lines are all a Texinfo file needs to be -processed successfully by @TeX{}. +processed successfully by @TeX{}. Usually, however, the beginning includes an @code{@@settitle} command to define the title of the printed manual, an @code{@@setchapternewpage} @@ -12333,31 +13136,20 @@ command, a title page, a copyright page, and permissions. Besides an @code{@@bye}, the end of a file usually includes indices and a table of contents. (And of course most manuals contain a body of text as well.) -@iftex -For more information, see -@ref{settitle, , @code{@@settitle}}, -@ref{setchapternewpage, , @code{@@setchapternewpage}}, -@ref{Headings, ,Page Headings}, -@ref{Titlepage & Copyright Page}, -@ref{Printing Indices & Menus}, and -@ref{Contents}. -@end iftex -@noindent -@ifinfo -For more information, see@* -@ref{settitle, , @code{@@settitle}},@* -@ref{setchapternewpage, , @code{@@setchapternewpage}},@* -@ref{Headings, ,Page Headings},@* -@ref{Titlepage & Copyright Page},@* -@ref{Printing Indices & Menus}, and@* -@ref{Contents}. -@end ifinfo +For more information, see: +@itemize @bullet +@item @ref{settitle, , @code{@@settitle}} +@item @ref{setchapternewpage, , @code{@@setchapternewpage}} +@item @ref{Headings, ,Page Headings} +@item @ref{Titlepage & Copyright Page} +@item @ref{Printing Indices & Menus} +@item @ref{Contents} +@end itemize -@node Preparing for TeX, Overfull hboxes, Requirements Summary, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Preparing to Use @TeX{} -@cindex Preparing to use @TeX{} +@node Preparing for TeX +@section Preparing for @TeX{} +@cindex Preparing for @TeX{} @cindex @TeX{} input initialization @cindex @code{TEXINPUTS} environment variable @vindex TEXINPUTS @@ -12390,14 +13182,14 @@ distribution. This file is needed to support the @code{@@image} command @cindex Customizing of @TeX{} for Texinfo @cindex Site-wide Texinfo configuration file Optionally, you may create an additional @file{texinfo.cnf}, and install -it as well. This file is read by @TeX{} at the @code{@@setfilename} -command (@pxref{setfilename,, @code{@@setfilename}}). You can put any -commands you like there according to local site-wide conventions, and -they will be read by @TeX{} when processing any Texinfo document. For -example, if @file{texinfo.cnf} contains the a single line -@samp{@@afourpaper} (@pxref{A4 Paper}), then all Texinfo documents will -be processed with that page size in effect. If you have nothing to put -in @file{texinfo.cnf}, you do not need to create it. +it as well. This file is read by @TeX{} when the @code{@@setfilename} +command is executed (@pxref{setfilename,, @code{@@setfilename}}). You can put any +commands you like there, according to local site-wide conventions. They +will be read by @TeX{} when processing any Texinfo document. For +example, if @file{texinfo.cnf} contains the line @samp{@@afourpaper} +(@pxref{A4 Paper}), then all Texinfo documents will be processed with +that page size in effect. If you have nothing to put in +@file{texinfo.cnf}, you do not need to create it. @vindex TEXINPUTS If neither of the above locations for these system files suffice for @@ -12432,14 +13224,45 @@ export TEXINPUTS @end group @end example +On MS-DOS/MS-Windows, you would say it like this@footnote{Note the use +of the @samp{;} character, instead of @samp{:}, as directory separator +on these systems.}: + +@example +@group +set TEXINPUTS=.;d:/home/me/mylib;c:/usr/lib/tex/macros +@end group +@end example + @noindent -This would cause @TeX{} to look for @file{\input} file first in the current -directory, indicated by the @samp{.}, then in a hypothetical user's -@file{me/mylib} directory, and finally in a system directory. +It is customary for DOS/Windows users to put such commands in the +@file{autoexec.bat} file, or in the Windows Registry.@refill +@noindent +These settings would cause @TeX{} to look for @file{\input} file first +in the current directory, indicated by the @samp{.}, then in a +hypothetical user's @file{me/mylib} directory, and finally in a system +directory @file{/usr/lib/tex/macros}. -@node Overfull hboxes, smallbook, Preparing for TeX, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@cindex Dumping a .fmt file +@cindex Format file, dumping +Finally, you may wish to dump a @file{.fmt} file (@pxref{Memory dumps,,, +web2c, Web2c}) so that @TeX{} can load Texinfo faster. (The +disadvantage is that then updating @file{texinfo.tex} requires +redumping.) You can do this by running this command, assuming +@file{epsf.tex} is findable by @TeX{}: + +@example +initex texinfo @@dump +@end example + +(@code{@@dump} is a @TeX{} primitive.) You'll then need to move +@file{texinfo.fmt} to wherever your @code{.fmt} files are found; +typically this will be in the subdirectory @file{web2c} of your @TeX{} +installation, for example, @file{/usr/local/share/tex/web2c}. + + +@node Overfull hboxes @section Overfull ``hboxes'' @cindex Overfull @samp{hboxes} @cindex @samp{hboxes}, overfull @@ -12449,46 +13272,67 @@ directory, indicated by the @samp{.}, then in a hypothetical user's the right margin. This can occur when @TeX{} comes upon what it interprets as a long word that it cannot hyphenate, such as an electronic mail network address or a very long title. When this -happens, @TeX{} prints an error message like this:@refill +happens, @TeX{} prints an error message like this: @example -Overfull \hbox (20.76302pt too wide) +Overfull @@hbox (20.76302pt too wide) @end example +@findex hbox @noindent (In @TeX{}, lines are in ``horizontal boxes'', hence the term, ``hbox''. -The backslash, @samp{\}, is the @TeX{} equivalent of @samp{@@}.)@refill +@samp{@@hbox} is a @TeX{} primitive not needed in the Texinfo language.) @TeX{} also provides the line number in the Texinfo source file and the text of the offending line, which is marked at all the places that -@TeX{} knows how to hyphenate words. +@TeX{} considered hyphenation. @xref{Debugging with TeX, , Catching Errors with @TeX{} Formatting}, -for more information about typesetting errors.@refill +for more information about typesetting errors. If the Texinfo file has an overfull hbox, you can rewrite the sentence so the overfull hbox does not occur, or you can decide to leave it. A small excursion into the right margin often does not matter and may not -even be noticeable.@refill +even be noticeable. + +If you have many overfull boxes and/or an antipathy to rewriting, you +can coerce @TeX{} into greatly increasing the allowable interword +spacing, thus (if you're lucky) avoiding many of the bad line breaks, +like this: + +@findex \emergencystretch +@example +@@tex +\global\emergencystretch = .9\hsize +@@end tex +@end example + +@noindent +(You can adjust the fraction as needed.) This huge value for +@code{\emergencystretch} cannot be the default, since then the typeset +output would generally be of noticeably lower quality. The default +value is @samp{.15\hsize}. @code{\hsize} is the @TeX{} dimension +containing the current line width. @cindex Black rectangle in hardcopy -@cindex Rectangle, ugly, black in hardcopy -However, unless told otherwise, @TeX{} will print a large, ugly, black -rectangle beside the line that contains the overfull hbox. This is so -you will notice the location of the problem if you are correcting a -draft.@refill +@cindex Rectangle, black in hardcopy +@cindex Box, ugly black in hardcopy +@cindex Ugly black rectangles in hardcopy +For what overfull boxes you have, however, @TeX{} will print a large, +ugly, black rectangle beside the line that contains the overfull hbox +unless told otherwise. This is so you will notice the location of the +problem if you are correcting a draft. -@need 1000 @findex finalout To prevent such a monstrosity from marring your final printout, write the following in the beginning of the Texinfo file on a line of its own, -before the @code{@@titlepage} command:@refill +before the @code{@@titlepage} command: @example @@finalout @end example -@node smallbook, A4 Paper, Overfull hboxes, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node smallbook @section Printing ``Small'' Books @findex smallbook @cindex Small book size @@ -12507,43 +13351,35 @@ file, before the title page:@refill @end example @noindent -(Since regular sized books are often about 7 by 9.25 inches, this -command might better have been called the @code{@@regularbooksize} -command, but it came to be called the @code{@@smallbook} command by -comparison to the 8.5 by 11 inch format.)@refill +(Since many books are about 7 by 9.25 inches, this command might better +have been called the @code{@@regularbooksize} command, but it came to be +called the @code{@@smallbook} command by comparison to the 8.5 by 11 inch format.) If you write the @code{@@smallbook} command between the start-of-header and end-of-header lines, the Texinfo mode @TeX{} region formatting command, @code{texinfo-tex-region}, will format the region in ``small'' book size (@pxref{Start of Header}).@refill -The Free Software Foundation distributes printed copies of @cite{The GNU -Emacs Manual} and other manuals in the ``small'' book size. -@xref{smallexample & smalllisp, , @code{@@smallexample} and -@code{@@smalllisp}}, for information about commands that make it easier -to produce examples for a smaller manual.@refill +@xref{small}, for information about +commands that make it easier to produce examples for a smaller manual. -Alternatively, to avoid embedding this physical paper size in your -document, use @code{texi2dvi} to format your document (@pxref{Format -with texi2dvi}), and supply @samp{-t @@smallbook} as an argument. Then -other people do not have to change the document source file to format it -differently. +@xref{Format with texi2dvi}, and @ref{Preparing for TeX,,Preparing for +@TeX{}}, for other ways to format with @code{@@smallbook} that do not +require changing the source file. -@node A4 Paper, Cropmarks and Magnification, smallbook, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node A4 Paper @section Printing on A4 Paper @cindex A4 paper, printing on @cindex Paper size, European A4 @cindex European A4 paper @findex afourpaper -You can tell @TeX{} to typeset a document for printing on European size +You can tell @TeX{} to format a document for printing on European size A4 paper with the @code{@@afourpaper} command. Write the command on a -line by itself between @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end iftex} lines near -the beginning of the Texinfo file, before the title page:@refill - -For example, this is how you would write the header for this manual:@refill +line by itself near the beginning of the Texinfo file, before the title +page. For example, this is how you would write the header for this +manual: @example @group @@ -12551,35 +13387,70 @@ For example, this is how you would write the header for this manual:@refill @@c %**start of header @@setfilename texinfo @@settitle Texinfo -@@syncodeindex vr fn -@@iftex @@afourpaper -@@end iftex @@c %**end of header @end group @end example -Alternatively, to avoid embedding this physical paper size in your -document, use @code{texi2dvi} to format your document (@pxref{Format -with texi2dvi}), and supply @samp{-t @@afourpaper} as an argument. Then -other people do not have to change the document source file to format it -differently. +@xref{Format with texi2dvi}, and @ref{Preparing for TeX,,Preparing for +@TeX{}}, for other ways to format with @code{@@afourpaper} that do not +require changing the source file. -@pindex texinfo.cnf -Another alternative: put the @code{@@afourpaper} command in the file -@file{texinfo.cnf} that @TeX{} will read. (No need for @code{@@iftex} -there.) This will automatically typeset all the Texinfo documents at -your site with that paper size in effect. +@findex afourlatex +You may or may not prefer the formatting that results from the command +@code{@@afourlatex}. There's also @code{@@afourwide} for A4 paper in +wide format. -@node Cropmarks and Magnification, , A4 Paper, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Cropmarks and Magnification +@node pagesizes +@section @code{@@pagesizes} [@var{width}][, @var{height}]: Custom page sizes +@findex pagesizes +@cindex Custom page sizes +@cindex Page sizes, customized +@cindex Text width and height +@cindex Width of text area +@cindex Height of text area +@cindex Depth of text area + +You can explicitly specify the height and (optionally) width of the main +text area on the page with the @code{@@pagesizes} command. Write this +on a line by itself near the beginning of the Texinfo file, before the +title page. The height comes first, then the width if desired, +separated by a comma. Examples: + +@example +@@pagesizes 200mm,150mm @c for b5 paper +@end example +@noindent and +@example +@@pagesizes 11.5in @c for legal paper +@end example + +@cindex B5 paper, printing on +@cindex Legal paper, printing on +This would be reasonable for printing on B5-size paper. To emphasize, +this command specifies the size of the @emph{text area}, not the size of +the paper (which is 250@dmn{mm} by 177@dmn{mm} for B5, 14@dmn{in} by +8.5@dmn{in} for legal). + +@cindex Margins on page, not controllable +To make more elaborate changes, such as changing any of the page +margins, you must define a new command in @file{texinfo.tex} (or +@file{texinfo.cnf}, @pxref{Preparing for TeX,,Preparing for @TeX{}}). + +@xref{Format with texi2dvi}, and @ref{Preparing for TeX,,Preparing for +@TeX{}}, for other ways to specify @code{@@pagesizes} that do not +require changing the source file. +@code{@@pagesizes} is ignored by @code{makeinfo}. + + +@node Cropmarks and Magnification +@section Cropmarks and Magnification @findex cropmarks @cindex Cropmarks for printing @cindex Printing cropmarks -You can attempt to direct @TeX{} to print cropmarks at the corners of +You can (attempt to) direct @TeX{} to print cropmarks at the corners of pages with the @code{@@cropmarks} command. Write the @code{@@cropmarks} command on a line by itself between @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end iftex} lines near the beginning of the Texinfo file, before the title @@ -12599,8 +13470,8 @@ book set to 7 by 9.25 inches with the @code{@@smallbook} command. (Printers will not produce cropmarks for regular sized output that is printed on regular sized paper.) Since different printing machines work in different ways, you should explore the use of this command with a -spirit of adventure. You may have to redefine the command in the -@file{texinfo.tex} definitions file.@refill +spirit of adventure. You may have to redefine the command in +@file{texinfo.tex}. @findex mag @r{(@TeX{} command)} @cindex Magnified printing @@ -12616,7 +13487,7 @@ write this command between @code{@@tex} and @code{@@end tex} Follow the @code{\mag} command with an @samp{=} and then a number that is 1000 times the magnification you desire. For example, to print pages at 1.2 normal size, write the following near the beginning of the -Texinfo file, before the title page:@refill +Texinfo file, before the title page: @example @group @@ -12627,27 +13498,69 @@ Texinfo file, before the title page:@refill @end example With some printing technologies, you can print normal-sized copies that -look better than usual by using a larger-than-normal master.@refill +look better than usual by giving a larger-than-normal master to your +print shop. They do the reduction, thus effectively increasing the +resolution. -Depending on your system, @code{\mag} may not work or may work only at -certain magnifications. Be prepared to experiment.@refill +Depending on your system, DVI files prepared with a +nonstandard-@code{\mag} may not print or may print only with certain +magnifications. Be prepared to experiment. -@node Create an Info File, Install an Info File, Format/Print Hardcopy, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Creating an Info File + +@node PDF Output +@section PDF Output +@cindex PDF output + +@pindex pdftex +You can generate a PDF output file from Texinfo source by using the +@command{pdftex} program to process your file instead of plain +@command{tex}. Just run @samp{pdftex foo.texi} instead of @samp{tex +foo.texi}, or give the @samp{--pdf} option to @command{texi2dvi}. + +PDF stands for Portable Document Format, and was invented by Adobe +Systems. The +@uref{http://www.adobe.com/prodindex/acrobat/adobepdf.html, file format +definition} is freely available, as is a +@uref{http://www.foolabs.com/xpdf/, free viewer} for the X window +system. Since PDF is a binary format, there is no @samp{@@ifpdf} or +@samp{@@pdf} command by analogy with the other output formats. + +Despite the `portable' in the name, PDF files are nowhere near as +portable in practice as the plain ASCII formats (Info, HTML) Texinfo +also supports (portability relative to DVI is arguable). They also tend +to be much larger and do not support the bitmap fonts used by @TeX{} (by +default) very well. Nevertheless, a PDF file does preserve an actual +printed document on a screen as faithfully as possible, unlike HTML, +say, so have their place. + +PDF support in Texinfo is fairly rudimentary. + + +@node Creating and Installing Info Files +@chapter Creating and Installing Info Files + +This chapter describes how to create and install info files. @xref{Info +Files}, for general information about the file format itself. + + +@menu +* Creating an Info File:: +* Install an Info File:: +@end menu + +@node Creating an Info File +@section Creating an Info File @cindex Creating an Info file -@cindex Info, creating an on-line file +@cindex Info, creating an online file @cindex Formatting a file for Info -@code{makeinfo} is a utility that converts a Texinfo file into an Info -file; @code{texinfo-format-region} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} are -GNU Emacs functions that do the same.@refill - -A Texinfo file must contain an @code{@@setfilename} line near its -beginning, otherwise the Info formatting commands will fail. +@code{makeinfo} is a program that converts a Texinfo file into an Info +file, HTML file, or plain text. @code{texinfo-format-region} and +@code{texinfo-format-buffer} are GNU Emacs functions that convert +Texinfo to Info. -For information on installing the Info file in the Info system, see -@ref{Install an Info File}.@refill +For information on installing the Info file in the Info system, +@pxref{Install an Info File}. @menu * makeinfo advantages:: @code{makeinfo} provides better error checking. @@ -12661,21 +13574,22 @@ For information on installing the Info file in the Info system, see * Batch Formatting:: How to format for Info in Emacs Batch mode. * Tag and Split Files:: How tagged and split files help Info to run better. +* makeinfo html:: Generating HTML output. @end menu -@node makeinfo advantages, Invoking makeinfo, Create an Info File, Create an Info File -@ifinfo -@heading @code{makeinfo} Preferred -@end ifinfo + +@node makeinfo advantages +@subsection @code{makeinfo} Preferred The @code{makeinfo} utility creates an Info file from a Texinfo source file more quickly than either of the Emacs formatting commands and provides better error messages. We recommend it. @code{makeinfo} is a C program that is independent of Emacs. You do not need to run Emacs to use @code{makeinfo}, which means you can use @code{makeinfo} on machines -that are too small to run Emacs. You can run @code{makeinfo} in -any one of three ways: from an operating system shell, from a shell -inside Emacs, or by typing a key command in Texinfo mode in Emacs. +that are too small to run Emacs. You can run @code{makeinfo} in any one +of three ways: from an operating system shell, from a shell inside +Emacs, or by typing the @kbd{C-c C-m C-r} or the @kbd{C-c C-m C-b} +command in Texinfo mode in Emacs. @refill The @code{texinfo-format-region} and the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} @@ -12683,13 +13597,12 @@ commands are useful if you cannot run @code{makeinfo}. Also, in some circumstances, they format short regions or buffers more quickly than @code{makeinfo}.@refill -@node Invoking makeinfo, makeinfo options, makeinfo advantages, Create an Info File -@section Running @code{makeinfo} from a Shell +@node Invoking makeinfo +@subsection Running @code{makeinfo} from a Shell To create an Info file from a Texinfo file, type @code{makeinfo} followed by the name of the Texinfo file. Thus, to create the Info file for Bison, type the following to the shell: -is the prompt):@refill @example makeinfo bison.texinfo @@ -12710,9 +13623,9 @@ makeinfo --version @end ifinfo -@node makeinfo options, Pointer Validation, Invoking makeinfo, Create an Info File +@node makeinfo options @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Options for @code{makeinfo} +@subsection Options for @code{makeinfo} @cindex @code{makeinfo} options @cindex Options for @code{makeinfo} @@ -12749,24 +13662,37 @@ The options are: Cause the variable @var{var} to be defined. This is equivalent to @code{@@set @var{var}} in the Texinfo file (@pxref{set clear value}). +@item --commands-in-node-names +@opindex --commands-in-node-names +Allow @code{@@}-commands in node names. This is not recommended, as it +can probably never be implemented in @TeX{}. It also makes +@code{makeinfo} much slower. Also, this option is ignored when +@samp{--no-validate} is used. @xref{Pointer Validation}, for more +details. + @item --error-limit=@var{limit} +@itemx -e @var{limit} @opindex --error-limit=@var{limit} +@opindex -e @var{limit} Set the maximum number of errors that @code{makeinfo} will report before exiting (on the assumption that continuing would be useless); default 100. -@need 150 @item --fill-column=@var{width} +@itemx -f @var{width} @opindex --fill-column=@var{width} +@opindex -f @var{width} Specify the maximum number of columns in a line; this is the right-hand edge of a line. Paragraphs that are filled will be filled to this width. (Filling is the process of breaking up and connecting lines so that lines are the same length as or shorter than the number specified as the fill column. Lines are broken between words.) The default value -is 72. +is 72. Ignored with @samp{--html}. @item --footnote-style=@var{style} +@itemx -s @var{style} @opindex --footnote-style=@var{style} +@opindex -s @var{style} Set the footnote style to @var{style}, either @samp{end} for the end node style (the default) or @samp{separate} for the separate node style. The value set by this option overrides the value set in a Texinfo file @@ -12774,45 +13700,78 @@ by an @code{@@footnotestyle} command (@pxref{Footnotes}). When the footnote style is @samp{separate}, @code{makeinfo} makes a new node containing the footnotes found in the current node. When the footnote style is @samp{end}, @code{makeinfo} places the footnote references at -the end of the current node. +the end of the current node. Ignored with @samp{--html}. @item --force +@itemx -F @opindex --force +@opindex -F Ordinarily, if the input file has errors, the output files are not created. With this option, they are preserved. @item --help +@itemx -h @opindex --help +@opindex -h Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully. +@item --html +Generate HTML output rather than Info. @xref{makeinfo html}. + @item -I @var{dir} @opindex -I @var{dir} -Add @code{dir} to the directory search list for finding files that are -included using the @code{@@include} command. By default, -@code{makeinfo} searches only the current directory. +Append @var{dir} to the directory search list for finding files that +are included using the @code{@@include} command. By default, +@code{makeinfo} searches only the current directory. If @var{dir} is +not given, the current directory @file{.} is appended. Note that +@var{dir} can actually be a list of several directories separated by the +usual path separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on +MS-DOS/MS-Windows). + +@item --macro-expand=@var{file} +@itemx -E @var{file} +Output the Texinfo source with all the macros expanded to the named +file. Normally, the results of macro expansion are used internally by +@code{makeinfo} and then discarded. This option is used by +@command{texi2dvi} if you are using an old version of @file{texinfo.tex} +that does not support @code{@@macro}. @item --no-headers @opindex --no-headers -Do not include menus or node lines in the output. This results in an -@sc{ascii} file that you cannot read in Info since it does not contain -the requisite nodes or menus. It is primarily useful to extract certain -pieces of a manual into separate files to be included in a distribution, -such as @file{INSTALL} files. +@cindex Plain text output +@cindex ASCII text output +@cindex Generating plain text files +@cindex @file{INSTALL} file, generating +For Info output, do not include menus or node lines in the output and +write to standard output (unless @option{--output} is specified). This +results in an @sc{ascii} file that you cannot read in Info since it does +not contain the requisite nodes or menus. It is primarily useful to +extract certain pieces of a manual into separate files to be included in +a distribution, such as @file{INSTALL} files. + +@cindex Navigation links, omitting +For HTML output, if @samp{--no-split} is also specified, do not include a +navigation links at the top of each node. @xref{makeinfo html}. @item --no-split @opindex --no-split +@cindex Splitting of output files +@cindex Output file splitting Suppress the splitting stage of @code{makeinfo}. By default, large output files (where the size is greater than 70k bytes) are split into -smaller subfiles, each one approximately 50k bytes. +smaller subfiles. For Info output, each one is approximately 50k bytes. +For HTML output, each file contains one node (@pxref{makeinfo html}). @item --no-pointer-validate @itemx --no-validate @opindex --no-pointer-validate @opindex --no-validate -Suppress the pointer-validation phase of @code{makeinfo}. Normally, -after a Texinfo file is processed, some consistency checks are made to -ensure that cross references can be resolved, etc. -@xref{Pointer Validation}.@refill +@cindex Pointer validation, suppressing +Suppress the pointer-validation phase of @code{makeinfo}. This can also +be done with the @code{@@novalidate} command (@pxref{Use TeX,,Use +@TeX{}}). Normally, after a Texinfo file is processed, some consistency +checks are made to ensure that cross references can be resolved, etc. +@xref{Pointer Validation}. @item --no-warn @opindex --no-warn @@ -12821,6 +13780,10 @@ want this if the file you are creating has examples of Texinfo cross references within it, and the nodes that are referenced do not actually exist. +@item --number-sections +@opindex --number-sections +Output chapter, section, and appendix numbers as in printed manuals. + @item --no-number-footnotes @opindex --no-number-footnotes Suppress automatic footnote numbering. By default, @code{makeinfo} @@ -12834,15 +13797,20 @@ current footnote number to 1 at the start of each node. Specify that the output should be directed to @var{file} and not to the file name specified in the @code{@@setfilename} command found in the Texinfo source (@pxref{setfilename}). If @var{file} is @samp{-}, output -goes to standard output and @samp{--no-split} is implied. +goes to standard output and @samp{--no-split} is implied. For split +HTML output, @var{file} is the name of the output file for the top node +(@pxref{makeinfo html}). @item -P @var{dir} @opindex -P @var{dir} -Prepend @code{dir} to the directory search list for @code{@@include}. +Prepend @var{dir} to the directory search list for @code{@@include}. +If @var{dir} is not given, the current directory @file{.} is prepended. See @samp{-I} for more details. @item --paragraph-indent=@var{indent} +@itemx -p @var{indent} @opindex --paragraph-indent=@var{indent} +@opindex -p @var{indent} Set the paragraph indentation style to @var{indent}. The value set by this option overrides the value set in a Texinfo file by an @code{@@paragraphindent} command (@pxref{paragraphindent}). The value @@ -12856,11 +13824,13 @@ Preserve any existing indentation at the starts of paragraphs. Delete any existing indentation. @item @var{num} -Indent each paragraph by that number of spaces. +Indent each paragraph by @var{num} spaces. @end table @item --reference-limit=@var{limit} +@itemx -r @var{limit} @opindex --reference-limit=@var{limit} +@opindex -r @var{limit} Set the value of the number of references to a node that @code{makeinfo} will make without reporting a warning. If a node has more than this number of references in it, @code{makeinfo} will make the @@ -12877,21 +13847,24 @@ Normally, @code{makeinfo} only outputs messages if there are errors or warnings. @item --version +@itemx -V @opindex --version +@opindex -V Print the version number, then exit successfully. @end table -@node Pointer Validation, makeinfo in Emacs, makeinfo options, Create an Info File -@section Pointer Validation +@node Pointer Validation +@subsection Pointer Validation @cindex Pointer validation with @code{makeinfo} @cindex Validation of pointers -If you do not suppress pointer-validation, @code{makeinfo} will check -the validity of the final Info file. Mostly, this means ensuring that -nodes you have referenced really exist. Here is a complete list of what -is checked:@refill +If you do not suppress pointer validation with the @samp{--no-validate} +option or the @code{@@novalidate} command in the source file (@pxref{Use +TeX,,Use @TeX{}}), @code{makeinfo} will check the validity of the final +Info file. Mostly, this means ensuring that nodes you have referenced +really exist. Here is a complete list of what is checked: @enumerate @item @@ -12901,15 +13874,16 @@ node in the current file and is not an external reference such as to @item In every node, if the `Previous' node is different from the `Up' node, -then the `Previous' node must also be pointed to by a `Next' node.@refill +then the node pointed to by the `Previous' field must have a `Next' +field which points back to this node.@refill @item Every node except the `Top' node must have an `Up' pointer.@refill @item -The node referenced by an `Up' pointer must contain a reference to the -current node in some manner other than through a `Next' reference. -This includes menu entries and cross references.@refill +The node referenced by an `Up' pointer must itself reference the current +node through a menu item, unless the node referenced by `Up' +has the form `(@var{file})'. @item If the `Next' reference of a node is not the same as the `Next' reference @@ -12917,10 +13891,62 @@ of the `Up' reference, then the node referenced by the `Next' pointer must have a `Previous' pointer that points back to the current node. This rule allows the last node in a section to point to the first node of the next chapter.@refill + +@item +Every node except `Top' should be referenced by at least one other node, +either via the `Previous' or `Next' links, or via a menu or a +cross-reference.@refill @end enumerate -@node makeinfo in Emacs, texinfo-format commands, Pointer Validation, Create an Info File -@section Running @code{makeinfo} inside Emacs +@cindex @@-commands in @@node, limited support +Some Texinfo documents might fail during the validation phase because +they use commands like @code{@@value} and @code{@@definfoenclose} in +node definitions and cross-references inconsistently. Consider the +following example: + +@example +@group +@@set nodename Node 1 + +@@node @@value@{nodename@}, Node 2, Top, Top + +This is node 1. + +@@node Node 2, , Node 1, Top + +This is node 2. +@end group +@end example + +@noindent +Here, the node ``Node 1'' was referenced both verbatim and through +@code{@@value}. + +By default, @code{makeinfo} fails such cases, because node names are not +fully expanded until they are written to the output file. You should +always try to reference nodes consistently; e.g., in the above example, +the second @code{@@node} line should have also used @code{@@value}. +However, if, for some reason, you @emph{must} reference node names +inconsistently, and @code{makeinfo} fails to validate the file, you can +use the @samp{--commands-in-node-names} option to force @code{makeinfo} +to perform the expensive expansion of all node names it finds in the +document. This might considerably slow down the program, though; +twofold increase in conversion time was measured for large documents +such as the Jargon file. + +@cindex @@value in @@node lines +The support for @code{@@}-commands in @code{@@node} directives is not +general enough to be freely used. For example, if the example above +redefined @code{nodename} somewhere in the document, @code{makeinfo} +will fail to convert it, even if invoked with the +@samp{--commands-in-node-names} option. + +@samp{--commands-in-node-names} has no effect if the @samp{--no-validate} +option is given. + + +@node makeinfo in Emacs +@subsection Running @code{makeinfo} inside Emacs @cindex Running @code{makeinfo} in Emacs @cindex @code{makeinfo} inside Emacs @cindex Shell, running @code{makeinfo} in @@ -12960,7 +13986,7 @@ You can parse the error messages by typing @kbd{C-x `} (@code{next-error}). This causes Emacs to go to and position the cursor on the line in the Texinfo source that @code{makeinfo} thinks caused the error. @xref{Compilation, , Running @code{make} or -Compilers Generally, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for more +Compilers Generally, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information about using the @code{next-error} command.@refill In addition, you can kill the shell in which the @code{makeinfo} @@ -12971,8 +13997,8 @@ output.@refill @item C-c C-m C-k @itemx M-x makeinfo-kill-job @findex makeinfo-kill-job -Kill the current running @code{makeinfo} job created by -@code{makeinfo-region} or @code{makeinfo-buffer}.@refill +Kill the current running @code{makeinfo} job +(from @code{makeinfo-region} or @code{makeinfo-buffer}).@refill @item C-c C-m C-l @itemx M-x makeinfo-recenter-output-buffer @@ -13005,22 +14031,22 @@ For example, you could write the following in your @file{.emacs} file:@refill @c three references to the same named manual, which looks strange. @iftex For more information, see @ref{makeinfo options, , Options for -@code{makeinfo}}, as well as ``Editing Variable Values,''``Examining and -Setting Variables,'' and ``Init File'' in the @cite{The GNU Emacs +@code{makeinfo}}, as well as ``Editing Variable Values,'' ``Examining +and Setting Variables,'' and ``Init File'' in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}. @end iftex @noindent @ifinfo For more information, see@* -@ref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual},@* -@ref{Examining, , Examining and Setting Variables, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual},@* -@ref{Init File, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, and@* +@ref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual},@* +@ref{Examining, , Examining and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual},@* +@ref{Init File, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, and@* @ref{makeinfo options, , Options for @code{makeinfo}}. @end ifinfo -@node texinfo-format commands, Batch Formatting, makeinfo in Emacs, Create an Info File +@node texinfo-format commands @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The @code{texinfo-format@dots{}} Commands +@subsection The @code{texinfo-format@dots{}} Commands @findex texinfo-format-region @findex texinfo-format-buffer @@ -13055,16 +14081,16 @@ procedures are described in an appendix; see @ref{Catching Mistakes}. However, the @code{makeinfo} program is often faster and provides better error checking (@pxref{makeinfo in Emacs}).@refill -@node Batch Formatting, Tag and Split Files, texinfo-format commands, Create an Info File +@node Batch Formatting @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Batch Formatting +@subsection Batch Formatting @cindex Batch formatting for Info @cindex Info batch formatting You can format Texinfo files for Info using @code{batch-texinfo-format} and Emacs Batch mode. You can run Emacs in Batch mode from any shell, including a shell inside of Emacs. (@xref{Command Switches, , Command -Line Switches and Arguments, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}.)@refill +Line Switches and Arguments, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)@refill Here is a shell command to format all the files that end in @file{.texinfo} in the current directory: @@ -13087,9 +14113,9 @@ you can continue working in it. (When you run @code{texinfo-format-region} or @code{texinfo-format-buffer}, you cannot use that Emacs for anything else until the command finishes.)@refill -@node Tag and Split Files, , Batch Formatting, Create an Info File +@node Tag and Split Files @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Tag Files and Split Files +@subsection Tag Files and Split Files @cindex Making a tag table automatically @cindex Tag table, making automatically @@ -13105,27 +14131,27 @@ bytes, @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and @code{makeinfo} split the large Info file into shorter @dfn{indirect} subfiles of about 50,000 bytes each. Big files are split into smaller files so that Emacs does not need to make a large buffer to hold the whole of a large Info -file; instead, Emacs allocates just enough memory for the small, split -off file that is needed at the time. This way, Emacs avoids wasting +file; instead, Emacs allocates just enough memory for the small, split-off +file that is needed at the time. This way, Emacs avoids wasting memory when you run Info. (Before splitting was implemented, Info files were always kept short and @dfn{include files} were designed as a way to create a single, large printed manual out of the smaller Info files. @xref{Include Files}, for more information. Include files are -still used for very large documents, such as @cite{The XEmacs Lisp +still used for very large documents, such as @cite{The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, in which each chapter is a separate file.)@refill When a file is split, Info itself makes use of a shortened version of the original file that contains just the tag table and references to -the files that were split off. The split off files are called +the files that were split off. The split-off files are called @dfn{indirect} files.@refill -The split off files have names that are created by appending @w{@samp{-1}}, +The split-off files have names that are created by appending @w{@samp{-1}}, @w{@samp{-2}}, @w{@samp{-3}} and so on to the file name specified by the @code{@@setfilename} command. The shortened version of the original file continues to have the name specified by @code{@@setfilename}.@refill At one stage in writing this document, for example, the Info file was saved -as @file{test-texinfo} and that file looked like this:@refill +as the file @file{test-texinfo} and that file looked like this:@refill @example @group @@ -13155,7 +14181,7 @@ Node: conventions^?6855 @noindent (But @file{test-texinfo} had far more nodes than are shown here.) Each of -the split off, indirect files, @file{test-texinfo-1}, +the split-off, indirect files, @file{test-texinfo-1}, @file{test-texinfo-2}, and @file{test-texinfo-3}, is listed in this file after the line that says @samp{Indirect:}. The tag table is listed after the line that says @samp{Tag table:}. @refill @@ -13165,7 +14191,7 @@ records the cumulative number of bytes in the preceding indirect files, not counting the file list itself, the tag table, or the permissions text in each file. In the tag table, the number following the node name records the location of the beginning of the node, in bytes from the -beginning.@refill +beginning of the (unsplit) output. If you are using @code{texinfo-format-buffer} to create Info files, you may want to run the @code{Info-validate} command. (The @@ -13177,9 +14203,50 @@ validate the structure of the nodes, see @ref{Using Info-validate}.@refill -@node Install an Info File, Command List, Create an Info File, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Installing an Info File +@node makeinfo html +@subsection Generating HTML +@cindex HTML + +As an alternative to the normal Info format output you can use the +@samp{--html} option to generate output in HTML format, for installation +on a web site (for example). In this release, HTML output from +@code{makeinfo} is monolithic, splitting the output by chapter or node +is not supported. We hope to implement this feature soon. + +The HTML output file is named according to @code{@@setfilename}, but +with any @samp{.info} extension replaced with @samp{.html}. + +Texinfo input marked up with the @code{@@ifhtml} command will produce +output only with the @samp{--html} option supplied. Input marked up +with the @code{@@html} is passed literally to the output (suppressing +the normal escaping of input @samp{<}, @samp{>} and @samp{&} characters +which have special significance in HTML). + +The @samp{--footnote-style} option is currently ignored for HTML output; +footnotes are hyperlinked at the end of the output file. + +The HTML generated is mostly standard (i.e., HTML 2.0, RFC1866). The +exception is that HTML 3.2 tables are generated from the +@code{@@multitable} command, but tagged to degrade as well as possible +in browsers without table support. Please report output from an +error-free run of @code{makeinfo} which violates the HTML 3.2 DTD as a +bug. + +Navigation bars are inserted at the start of nodes, similarly to Info +output. The @samp{--no-headers} option will suppress this if used with +@samp{--no-split}. Header @code{} elements in split output can +support info-like navigation with browsers like Lynx and @w{Emacs W3} +which implement this @w{HTML 1.0} feature. You still won't normally get +the multi-file regexp and index search facilities provided by Info +readers. Otherwise, hyperlinks are generated from Texinfo commands +where appropriate. @samp{@@xref} commands to other documents are +generated assuming the other document is available in HTML form too, and +@samp{.html} is appended to the @samp{@@xref} Info file name. This +presumably will often not work. + + +@node Install an Info File +@section Installing an Info File @cindex Installing an Info file @cindex Info file installation @cindex @file{dir} directory for Info installation @@ -13189,7 +14256,7 @@ Info files using the standalone Info program or the Info reader built into Emacs. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, for an introduction to Info.) @menu -* Directory file:: The top level menu for all Info files. +* Directory File:: The top level menu for all Info files. * New Info File:: Listing a new info file. * Other Info Directories:: How to specify Info files that are located in other directories. @@ -13198,10 +14265,9 @@ into Emacs. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, for an introduction to Info.) * Invoking install-info:: @code{install-info} options. @end menu -@node Directory file, New Info File, Install an Info File, Install an Info File -@ifinfo -@heading The @file{dir} File -@end ifinfo + +@node Directory File +@subsection The Directory File @file{dir} For Info to work, the @file{info} directory must contain a file that serves as a top level directory for the Info system. By convention, @@ -13216,7 +14282,6 @@ this:@refill @example @group * Menu: - * Info: (info). Documentation browsing system. * Emacs: (emacs). The extensible, self-documenting text editor. @@ -13246,21 +14311,17 @@ File: emacs Node: Top, Up: (DIR), Next: Distrib @end example @noindent -(Note that in this case, the @file{dir} file name is written in upper -case letters---it can be written in either upper or lower case. Info -has a feature that it will change the case of the file name to lower -case if it cannot find the name as written.)@refill -@c !!! Can any file name be written in upper or lower case, -@c or is dir a special case? -@c Yes, apparently so, at least with Gillespie's Info. --rjc 24mar92 +In this case, the @file{dir} file name is written in upper case +letters---it can be written in either upper or lower case. This is not +true in general, it is a special case for @file{dir}. -@node New Info File, Other Info Directories, Directory file, Install an Info File -@section Listing a New Info File +@node New Info File +@subsection Listing a New Info File @cindex Adding a new info file @cindex Listing a new info file @cindex New info file, listing it in @file{dir} file -@cindex Info file, listing new one +@cindex Info file, listing a new @cindex @file{dir} file listing To add a new Info file to your system, you must write a menu entry to @@ -13280,25 +14341,26 @@ followed by a period. The third part is the description. The name of an Info file often has a @file{.info} extension. Thus, the Info file for GDB might be called either @file{gdb} or @file{gdb.info}. The Info reader programs automatically try the file name both with and -without @file{.info}; so it is better to avoid clutter and not to write -@samp{.info} explicitly in the menu entry. For example, the GDB menu -entry should use just @samp{gdb} for the file name, not @samp{gdb.info}. +without @file{.info}@footnote{On MS-DOS/MS-Windows systems, Info will +try the @file{.inf} extension as well.}; so it is better to avoid +clutter and not to write @samp{.info} explicitly in the menu entry. For +example, the GDB menu entry should use just @samp{gdb} for the file +name, not @samp{gdb.info}. -@node Other Info Directories, Installing Dir Entries, New Info File, Install an Info File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Info Files in Other Directories +@node Other Info Directories +@subsection Info Files in Other Directories @cindex Installing Info in another directory @cindex Info installed in another directory @cindex Another Info directory +@cindex @file{dir} files and Info directories If an Info file is not in the @file{info} directory, there are three ways to specify its location:@refill -@itemize @bullet +@enumerate @item -Write the pathname in the @file{dir} file as the second part of the -menu.@refill +Write the pathname in the @file{dir} file as the second part of the menu. @item If you are using Emacs, list the name of the file in a second @file{dir} @@ -13306,58 +14368,63 @@ file, in its directory; and then add the name of that directory to the @code{Info-directory-list} variable in your personal or site initialization file. -This tells Emacs where to look for @file{dir} files. Emacs merges the -files named @file{dir} from each of the listed directories. (In Emacs -version 18, you can set the @code{Info-directory} variable to the name -of only one directory.)@refill +This variable tells Emacs where to look for @file{dir} files (the files +must be named @file{dir}). Emacs merges the files named @file{dir} from +each of the listed directories. (In Emacs version 18, you can set the +@code{Info-directory} variable to the name of only one +directory.)@refill @item Specify the Info directory name in the @code{INFOPATH} environment variable in your @file{.profile} or @file{.cshrc} initialization file. (Only you and others who set this environment variable will be able to -find Info files whose location is specified this way.)@refill -@end itemize +find Info files whose location is specified this way.) +@end enumerate -For example, to reach a test file in the @file{/home/bob/manuals} +For example, to reach a test file in the @file{/home/bob/info} directory, you could add an entry like this to the menu in the -@file{dir} file:@refill +standard @file{dir} file:@refill @example -* Test: (/home/bob/manuals/info-test). Bob's own test file. +* Test: (/home/bob/info/info-test). Bob's own test file. @end example @noindent In this case, the absolute file name of the @file{info-test} file is written as the second part of the menu entry.@refill -@vindex Info-directory-list Alternatively, you could write the following in your @file{.emacs} file:@refill +@vindex Info-directory-list @example @group +(require 'info) (setq Info-directory-list - '("/home/bob/manuals" - "/usr/local/info")) + (cons (expand-file-name "/home/bob/info") Info-directory-list)) @end group @end example -@c reworded to avoid overfill hbox This tells Emacs to merge the @file{dir} file from the -@file{/home/bob/manuals} directory with the @file{dir} file from the -@file{/usr/local/info} directory. Info will list the -@file{/home/bob/manuals/info-test} file as a menu entry in the -@file{/home/bob/manuals/dir} file.@refill +@file{/home/bob/info} directory with the system @file{dir} file. Info +will list the @file{/home/bob/info/info-test} file as a menu entry in +the @file{/home/bob/info/dir} file. Emacs does the merging only +when @kbd{M-x info} is first run, so if you want to set +@code{Info-directory-list} in an Emacs session where you've already run +@code{info}, you must @code{(setq Info-dir-contents nil)} to force Emacs +to recompose the @file{dir} file. @vindex INFOPATH Finally, you can tell Info where to look by setting the @code{INFOPATH} -environment variable in your @file{.cshrc} or @file{.profile} file. If -you use a Bourne-compatible shell such as @code{sh} or @code{bash} for -your shell command interpreter, you set the @code{INFOPATH} environment -variable in the @file{.profile} initialization file; but if you use -@code{csh} or @code{tcsh}, you must set the variable in the -@file{.cshrc} initialization file. The two types of shells use -different syntax. +environment variable in your shell startup file, such as @file{.cshrc}, +@file{.profile} or @file{autoexec.bat}. If you use a Bourne-compatible +shell such as @code{sh} or @code{bash} for your shell command +interpreter, you set the @code{INFOPATH} environment variable in the +@file{.profile} initialization file; but if you use @code{csh} or +@code{tcsh}, you set the variable in the @file{.cshrc} initialization +file. On MS-DOS/MS-Windows systems, you must set @code{INFOPATH} in +your @file{autoexec.bat} file or in the Registry. Each type of shell +uses a different syntax. @itemize @bullet @item @@ -13365,7 +14432,7 @@ In a @file{.cshrc} file, you could set the @code{INFOPATH} variable as follows:@refill @smallexample -setenv INFOPATH .:~/manuals:/usr/local/emacs/info +setenv INFOPATH .:~/info:/usr/local/emacs/info @end smallexample @item @@ -13373,21 +14440,35 @@ In a @file{.profile} file, you would achieve the same effect by writing:@refill @smallexample -INFOPATH=.:$HOME/manuals:/usr/local/emacs/info +INFOPATH=.:$HOME/info:/usr/local/emacs/info export INFOPATH @end smallexample + +@item +@pindex autoexec.bat +In a @file{autoexec.bat} file, you write this command@footnote{Note the +use of @samp{;} as the directory separator, and a different syntax for +using values of other environment variables.}: + +@smallexample +set INFOPATH=.;%HOME%/info;c:/usr/local/emacs/info +@end smallexample @end itemize @noindent The @samp{.} indicates the current directory as usual. Emacs uses the @code{INFOPATH} environment variable to initialize the value of Emacs's -own @code{Info-directory-list} variable. - -@cindex colon @r{last in @code{INFOPATH}} -However you set @code{INFOPATH}, if its last character is a colon, this +own @code{Info-directory-list} variable. The stand-alone Info reader +merges any files named @file{dir} in any directory listed in the +@env{INFOPATH} variable into a single menu presented to you in the node +called @samp{(dir)Top}. + +@cindex @samp{:} @r{last in @env{INFOPATH}} +However you set @env{INFOPATH}, if its last character is a +colon@footnote{On MS-DOS/MS-Windows systems, use semi-colon instead.}, this is replaced by the default (compiled-in) path. This gives you a way to augment the default path with new directories without having to list all -the standard places. For example (using @code{sh} syntax: +the standard places. For example (using @code{sh} syntax): @example INFOPATH=/local/info: @@ -13398,9 +14479,16 @@ export INFOPATH will search @file{/local/info} first, then the standard directories. Leading or doubled colons are not treated specially. +@cindex @file{dir} file, creating your own +When you create your own @file{dir} file for use with +@code{Info-directory-list} or @env{INFOPATH}, it's easiest to start by +copying an existing @file{dir} file and replace all the text after the +@samp{* Menu:} with your desired entries. That way, the punctuation and +special CTRL-_ characters that Info needs will be present. + @node Installing Dir Entries, Invoking install-info, Other Info Directories, Install an Info File -@section Installing Info Directory Files +@subsection Installing Info Directory Files When you install an Info file onto your system, you can use the program @code{install-info} to update the Info directory file @file{dir}. @@ -13410,11 +14498,12 @@ after copying the Info file into its proper installed location. @findex dircategory @findex direntry In order for the Info file to work with @code{install-info}, you should -use the commands @code{@@dircategory} and @code{@@direntry} in the -Texinfo source file. Use @code{@@direntry} to specify the menu entry to -add to the Info directory file, and use @code{@@dircategory} to specify -which part of the Info directory to put it in. Here is how these -commands are used in this manual: +use the commands @code{@@dircategory} and +@code{@@direntry}@dots{}@code{@@end direntry} in the Texinfo source +file. Use @code{@@direntry} to specify the menu entries to add to the +Info directory file, and use @code{@@dircategory} to specify which part +of the Info directory to put it in. Here is how these commands are used +in this manual: @smallexample @@dircategory Texinfo documentation system @@ -13446,38 +14535,50 @@ command. If you use them later on in the input, @code{install-info} will not notice them. If you use @code{@@dircategory} more than once in the Texinfo source, -each usage specifies one category; the new menu entry is added to the -Info directory file in each of the categories you specify. If you use -@code{@@direntry} more than once, each usage specifies one menu entry; -each of these menu entries is added to the directory in each of the -specified categories. +each usage specifies the `current' category; any subsequent +@code{@@direntry} commands will add to that category. + +Here are some recommended @code{@@dircategory} categories: `GNU +packages', `GNU programming tools', `GNU programming documentation', +`GNU Emacs Lisp', `GNU libraries', `Linux', `TeX', `Individual +utilities'. The idea is to include the `invoking' node for every +program installed by a package under `Individual utilities', and an +entry for the manual as a whole in the appropriate other category. -@node Invoking install-info, , Installing Dir Entries, Install an Info File -@section Invoking install-info +@node Invoking install-info +@subsection Invoking install-info @pindex install-info @code{install-info} inserts menu entries from an Info file into the top-level @file{dir} file in the Info system (see the previous sections for an explanation of how the @file{dir} file works). It's most often -run as part of software installation, or when constructing a dir file +run as part of software installation, or when constructing a @file{dir} file for all manuals on a system. Synopsis: @example install-info [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{info-file} [@var{dir-file}]] @end example -If @var{info-file} or @var{dir-file} are not specified, the various -options (described below) that define them must be. There are no -compile-time defaults, and standard input is never used. -@code{install-info} can read only one info file and write only one dir -file per invocation. +If @var{info-file} or @var{dir-file} are not specified, the options +(described below) that define them must be. There are no compile-time +defaults, and standard input is never used. @code{install-info} can +read only one Info file and write only one @file{dir} file per invocation. @cindex @file{dir}, created by @code{install-info} If @var{dir-file} (however specified) does not exist, @code{install-info} creates it if possible (with no entries). +@cindex Compressed files, reading +@cindex Dir files, compressed +If any input file is compressed with @code{gzip} (@pxref{Invoking +gzip,,,gzip, Gzip}), @code{install-info} automatically uncompresses it +for reading. And if @var{dir-file} is compressed, @code{install-info} +also automatically leaves it compressed after writing any changes. +If @var{dir-file} itself does not exist, @code{install-info} tries to +open @file{@var{dir-file}.gz}. + Options: @table @code @@ -13488,12 +14589,16 @@ name in the entry in @var{dir-file} must be @var{info-file} (except for an optional @samp{.info} in either one). Don't insert any new entries. @item --dir-file=@var{name} +@itemx -d @var{name} @opindex --dir-file=@var{name} +@opindex -d @var{name} Specify file name of the Info directory file. This is equivalent to using the @var{dir-file} argument. @item --entry=@var{text} +@itemx -e @var{text} @opindex --entry=@var{text} +@opindex -e @var{text} Insert @var{text} as an Info directory entry; @var{text} should have the form of an Info menu item line plus zero or more extra lines starting with whitespace. If you specify more than one entry, they are all @@ -13501,17 +14606,24 @@ added. If you don't specify any entries, they are determined from information in the Info file itself. @item --help +@itemx -h @opindex --help +@opindex -h Display a usage message listing basic usage and all available options, then exit successfully. @item --info-file=@var{file} +@itemx -i @var{file} @opindex --info-file=@var{file} +@opindex -i @var{file} Specify Info file to install in the directory. -This is equivalent to using the @var{info-file} argument. +Equivalent to using the @var{info-file} argument. @item --info-dir=@var{dir} +@itemx -D @var{dir} @opindex --info-dir=@var{dir} +@opindex -D @var{dir} +Specify the directory where @file{dir} resides. Equivalent to @samp{--dir-file=@var{dir}/dir}. @item --item=@var{text} @@ -13524,33 +14636,40 @@ a menu item. Suppress warnings. @item --remove +@itemx -r @opindex --remove +@opindex -r Same as @samp{--delete}. @item --section=@var{sec} +@itemx -s @var{sec} @opindex --section=@var{sec} +@opindex -s @var{sec} Put this file's entries in section @var{sec} of the directory. If you specify more than one section, all the entries are added in each of the sections. If you don't specify any sections, they are determined from information in the Info file itself. @item --version +@itemx -V @opindex --version +@opindex -V @cindex version number, finding Display version information and exit successfully. @end table -@node Command List, Tips, Install an Info File, Top +@node Command List @appendix @@-Command List @cindex Alphabetical @@-command list @cindex List of @@-commands @cindex @@-command list +@cindex Reference to @@-commands Here is an alphabetical list of the @@-commands in Texinfo. Square brackets, @t{[}@w{ }@t{]}, indicate optional arguments; an ellipsis, -@samp{@dots{}}, indicates repeated text.@refill +@samp{@dots{}}, indicates repeated text. @sp 1 @table @code @@ -13587,10 +14706,10 @@ Indicate to @TeX{} that an immediately preceding period, question mark, exclamation mark, or colon does not end a sentence. Prevent @TeX{} from inserting extra whitespace as it does at the end of a sentence. The command has no effect on the Info file output. -@xref{Not Ending a Sentence}.@refill +@xref{Not Ending a Sentence}. @item @@= -Generate a macro (bar) accent over the next character, as in @=o. +Generate a macron (bar) accent over the next character, as in @=o. @xref{Inserting Accents}. @item @@? @@ -13615,7 +14734,7 @@ Stands for a left brace, @samp{@{}. Stands for a right-hand brace, @samp{@}}.@* @xref{Braces Atsigns, , Inserting @@ and braces}. -@item @@= +@item @@~ Generate a tilde accent over the next character, as in @~N. @xref{Inserting Accents}. @@ -13624,15 +14743,27 @@ Generate a tilde accent over the next character, as in @~N. Generate the uppercase and lowercase Scandinavian A-ring letters, respectively: @AA{}, @aa{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. +@item @@acronym@{@var{abbrev}@} +Tag @var{abbrev} as an acronym, that is, an abbreviation written in all +capital letters, such as `NASA'. @xref{acronym,, @code{acronym}}. + @item @@AE@{@} @itemx @@ae@{@} Generate the uppercase and lowercase AE ligatures, respectively: @AE{}, @ae{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. -@item @@afourpaper -Change page dimensions for the A4 paper size. -Only allowed inside @code{@@iftex} @dots{} @code{@@end iftex}. -@xref{A4 Paper}. +@item @@afourlatex +@itemx @@afourpaper +@itemx @@afourwide +Change page dimensions for the A4 paper size. @xref{A4 Paper}. + +@item @@alias @var{new}=@var{existing} +Make the command @samp{@@@var{new}} an alias for the existing command +@samp{@@@var{existing}}. @xref{alias}. + +@item @@anchor@{@var{name}@} +Define @var{name} as the current location for use as a cross-reference +target. @xref{anchor,, @code{@@anchor}}. @item @@appendix @var{title} Begin an appendix. The title appears in the table @@ -13736,10 +14867,14 @@ and @code{@@end ifset} commands, and preventing Highlight text that is an expression, a syntactically complete token of a program, or a program name. @xref{code, , @code{@@code}}.@refill +@item @@command@{@var{command-name}@} +Indicate a command name, such as @command{ls}. +@xref{command,, @code{@@command}}. + @item @@comment @var{comment} Begin a comment in Texinfo. The rest of the line does not appear in either the Info file or the printed manual. A synonym for @code{@@c}. -@xref{Comments, , Comments}.@refill +@xref{Comments}. @item @@contents Print a complete table of contents. Has no effect in Info, which uses @@ -13779,12 +14914,9 @@ entity, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition Commands}.@refill Define a new index and its indexing command. Print entries in a roman font. @xref{New Indices, , Defining New Indices}.@refill -@c Unused so far as I can see and unsupported by makeinfo -- karl, 15sep96. -@item @@definfoenclose @var{new-command}, @var{before}, @var{after}, -Create new @@-command for Info that marks text by enclosing it in -strings that precede and follow the text. Write definition inside of -@code{@@ifinfo} @dots{} @code{@@end ifinfo}. @xref{Customized -Highlighting}.@refill +@item @@definfoenclose @var{newcmd}, @var{before}, @var{after}, +Create new @@-command @var{newcmd} for Info that marks text by enclosing +it in strings that precede and follow the text. @xref{definfoenclose}. @item @@defivar @var{class} @var{instance-variable-name} @itemx @@defivarx @var{class} @var{instance-variable-name} @@ -13793,8 +14925,8 @@ object-oriented programming. The command is equivalent to @samp{@@defcv @{Instance Variable@} @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. -@item @@defmac @var{macro-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@defmacx @var{macro-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} +@item @@defmac @var{macroname} @var{arguments}@dots{} +@itemx @@defmacx @var{macroname} @var{arguments}@dots{} Format a description for a macro. The command is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn Macro @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. @@ -13813,7 +14945,7 @@ Format a description for an operation in object-oriented programming. @code{@@defop} takes as arguments the overall name of the category of operation, the name of the class of the operation, the name of the operation, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition -Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. +Commands}, and @ref{Abstract Objects}. @item @@defopt @var{option-name} @itemx @@defoptx @var{option-name} @@ -13832,7 +14964,7 @@ and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. Format a description for a data type. @code{@@deftp} takes as arguments the category, the name of the type (which is a word like @samp{int} or @samp{float}), and then the names of attributes of objects of that type. -@xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. +@xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{Data Types}. @item @@deftypefn @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} @itemx @@deftypefnx @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} @@ -13846,16 +14978,29 @@ entity, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @itemx @@deftypefunx @var{data-type} @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} Format a description for a function in a typed language. The command is equivalent to @samp{@@deftypefn Function @dots{}}. -@xref{Definition Commands}, -and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. +@xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. + +@item @@deftypeivar @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} +@itemx @@deftypeivarx @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} +Format a description for a typed instance variable in object-oriented +programming. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{Abstract Objects}. @item @@deftypemethod @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} @itemx @@deftypemethodx @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} Format a description for a typed method in object-oriented programming. -Takes as arguments the name of the class of the method, the return type -of the method, the name of the method, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. +@item @@deftypeop @var{category} @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} +@itemx @@deftypeopx @var{category} @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} +Format a description for a typed operation in object-oriented programming. +@xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{Abstract Objects}. + +@item @@deftypevar @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} +@itemx @@deftypevarx @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} +Format a description for a variable in a typed language. The command is +equivalent to @samp{@@deftypevr Variable @dots{}}. @xref{Definition +Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. + @item @@deftypevr @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} @itemx @@deftypevrx @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} Format a description for something like a variable in a typed @@ -13864,12 +15009,6 @@ classification of entity being described, the type, and the name of the entity. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. -@item @@deftypevar @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} -@itemx @@deftypevarx @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} -Format a description for a variable in a typed language. The command is -equivalent to @samp{@@deftypevr Variable @dots{}}. @xref{Definition -Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - @item @@defun @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} @itemx @@defunx @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} Format a description for functions. The command is equivalent to @@ -13889,7 +15028,7 @@ as arguments the category of the entity and the name of the entity. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. -@item @@detailmenu@{@} +@item @@detailmenu Avoid @code{makeinfo} confusion stemming from the detailed node listing in a master menu. @xref{Master Menu Parts}. @@ -13902,33 +15041,39 @@ Specify a part of the Info directory menu where this file's entry should go. @xref{Installing Dir Entries}. @item @@direntry -Begin the Info directory menu entry for this file. -@xref{Installing Dir Entries}. +Begin the Info directory menu entry for this file. Pair with +@code{@@end direntry}. @xref{Installing Dir Entries}. -@need 100 @item @@display -Begin a kind of example. Indent text, do not fill, do not select a -new font. Pair with @code{@@end display}. @xref{display, , -@code{@@display}}.@refill +Begin a kind of example. Like @code{@@example} (indent text, do not +fill), but do not select a new font. Pair with @code{@@end display}. +@xref{display, , @code{@@display}}. @item @@dmn@{@var{dimension}@} Format a unit of measure, as in 12@dmn{pt}. Causes @TeX{} to insert a thin space before @var{dimension}. No effect in Info. -@xref{dmn, , @code{@@dmn}}.@refill +@xref{dmn, , @code{@@dmn}}. + +@item @@documentencoding @var{enc} +Declare the input encoding as @var{enc}. +@xref{documentencoding,, @code{@@documentencoding}}. + +@item @@documentlanguage @var{CC} +Declare the document language as the two-character ISO-639 abbreviation +@var{CC}. @xref{documentlanguage,, @code{@@documentlanguage}}. @item @@dotaccent@{@var{c}@} -Generate a dot accent over the character @var{c}, as in @dotaccent{oo}. +Generate a dot accent over the character @var{c}, as in @dotaccent{o}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. @item @@dots@{@} Insert an ellipsis: @samp{@dots{}}. -@xref{dots, , @code{@@dots@{@}}}.@refill +@xref{dots, , @code{@@dots}}.@refill @item @@email@{@var{address}[, @var{displayed-text}]@} Indicate an electronic mail address. -@xref{email, , @code{@@email}}.@refill +@xref{email, , @code{@@email}}. -@need 100 @item @@emph@{@var{text}@} Highlight @var{text}; text is displayed in @emph{italics} in printed output, and surrounded by asterisks in Info. @xref{Emphasis, , @@ -13938,18 +15083,20 @@ Emphasizing Text}. Ends @var{environment}, as in @samp{@@end example}. @xref{Formatting Commands,,@@-commands}. +@item @@env@{@var{environment-variable}@} +Indicate an environment variable name, such as @env{PATH}. +@xref{env,, @code{@@env}}. + @item @@enddots@{@} Generate an end-of-sentence of ellipsis, like this @enddots{} @xref{dots,,@code{@@dots@{@}}}. -@need 100 @item @@enumerate [@var{number-or-letter}] Begin a numbered list, using @code{@@item} for each entry. Optionally, start list with @var{number-or-letter}. Pair with @code{@@end enumerate}. @xref{enumerate, , @code{@@enumerate}}.@refill -@need 100 @item @@equiv@{@} Indicate to the reader the exact equivalence of two forms with a glyph: @samp{@equiv{}}. @xref{Equivalence}.@refill @@ -13974,6 +15121,10 @@ Begin an example. Indent text, do not fill, and select fixed-width font. Pair with @code{@@end example}. @xref{example, , @code{@@example}}.@refill +@item @@exampleindent @var{indent} +Indent example-like environments by @var{indent} number of spaces +(perhaps 0). @xref{exampleindent,, Paragraph Indenting}. + @item @@exclamdown@{@} Produce an upside-down exclamation point. @xref{Inserting Accents}. @@ -13994,12 +15145,10 @@ Highlight the name of a file, buffer, node, or directory. @xref{file, , Prevent @TeX{} from printing large black warning rectangles beside over-wide lines. @xref{Overfull hboxes}.@refill -@need 100 @item @@findex @var{entry} Add @var{entry} to the index of functions. @xref{Index Entries, , Defining the Entries of an Index}.@refill -@need 200 @item @@flushleft @itemx @@flushright Left justify every line but leave the right end ragged. @@ -14008,7 +15157,6 @@ Leave font as is. Pair with @code{@@end flushleft}. @xref{flushleft & flushright, , @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright}}.@refill -@need 200 @item @@footnote@{@var{text-of-footnote}@} Enter a footnote. Footnote text is printed at the bottom of the page by @TeX{}; Info may format in either `End' node or `Separate' node style. @@ -14020,10 +15168,9 @@ node style or @samp{separate} for the separate node style. @xref{Footnotes}.@refill @item @@format -Begin a kind of example. Like @code{@@example} or @code{@@display}, -but do not narrow the margins and do not select the fixed-width font. -Pair with @code{@@end format}. @xref{example, , -@code{@@example}}.@refill +Begin a kind of example. Like @code{@@display}, but do not narrow the +margins. Pair with @code{@@end format}. @xref{example,, +@code{@@example}}. @item @@ftable @var{formatting-command} Begin a two-column table, using @code{@@item} for each entry. @@ -14166,16 +15313,15 @@ respectively: @L{}, @l{}. @item @@lisp Begin an example of Lisp code. Indent text, do not fill, and select -fixed-width font. Pair with @code{@@end lisp}. @xref{Lisp Example, , -@code{@@lisp}}.@refill +fixed-width font. Pair with @code{@@end lisp}. @xref{lisp, , @code{@@lisp}}. @item @@lowersections Change subsequent chapters to sections, sections to subsections, and so on. @xref{Raise/lower sections, , @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections}}.@refill -@item @@macro @var{macro-name} @{@var{params}@} -Define a new Texinfo command @code{@@@var{macro-name}@{@var{params}@}}. +@item @@macro @var{macroname} @{@var{params}@} +Define a new Texinfo command @code{@@@var{macroname}@{@var{params}@}}. Only supported by @code{makeinfo} and @code{texi2dvi}. @xref{Defining Macros}. @@ -14188,7 +15334,7 @@ chapheading, , @code{@@majorheading} and @code{@@chapheading}}.@refill @item @@math@{@var{mathematical-expression}@} Format a mathematical expression. -@xref{math, , @code{@@math} - Inserting Mathematical Expressions}. +@xref{math, , @code{@@math}: Inserting Mathematical Expressions}. @item @@menu Mark the beginning of a menu of nodes in Info. No effect in a printed @@ -14206,7 +15352,7 @@ Start a new page in a printed manual if fewer than @var{n} mils (thousandths of an inch) remain on the current page. @xref{need, , @code{@@need}}.@refill -@item @@node @var{name, next, previous, up} +@item @@node @var{name}, @var{next}, @var{previous}, @var{up} Define the beginning of a new node in Info, and serve as a locator for references for @TeX{}. @xref{node, , @code{@@node}}.@refill @@ -14214,6 +15360,10 @@ references for @TeX{}. @xref{node, , @code{@@node}}.@refill Prevent text from being indented as if it were a new paragraph. @xref{noindent, , @code{@@noindent}}.@refill +@item @@novalidate +Suppress validation of node references, omit creation of auxiliary files +with @TeX{}. Use before @code{@@setfilename}. @xref{Pointer Validation}. + @item @@O@{@} @itemx @@o@{@} Generate the uppercase and lowercase O-with-slash letters, respectively: @@ -14230,15 +15380,21 @@ How to Make Your Own Headings}.@refill Generate the uppercase and lowercase OE ligatures, respectively: @OE{}, @oe{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. +@item @@option@{@var{option-name}@} +Indicate a command-line option, such as @option{-l} or @option{--help}. +@xref{option,, @code{@@option}}. + @item @@page Start a new page in a printed manual. No effect in Info. @xref{page, , @code{@@page}}.@refill +@item @@pagesizes [@var{width}][, @var{height}] +Change page dimensions. @xref{pagesizes}. + @item @@paragraphindent @var{indent} -Indent paragraphs by @var{indent} number of spaces; delete indentation -if the value of @var{indent} is 0; and do not change indentation if -@var{indent} is @code{asis}. @xref{paragraphindent, , Paragraph -Indenting}.@refill +Indent paragraphs by @var{indent} number of spaces (perhaps 0); preserve +source file indentation if @var{indent} is @code{asis}. +@xref{paragraphindent,, Paragraph Indenting}. @item @@pindex @var{entry} Add @var{entry} to the index of programs. @xref{Index Entries, , Defining @@ -14278,7 +15434,6 @@ or imaginary work. Write command on a line of its own. Pair with @code{@@end quotation}. @xref{quotation, , @code{@@quotation}}.@refill -@need 100 @item @@r@{@var{text}@} Print @var{text} in @r{roman} font. No effect in Info. @xref{Fonts}.@refill @@ -14288,20 +15443,17 @@ Change subsequent sections to chapters, subsections to sections, and so on. @xref{Raise/lower sections, , @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections}}.@refill -@need 300 @item @@ref@{@var{node-name}, [@var{entry}], [@var{topic-or-title}], [@var{info-file}], [@var{manual}]@} Make a reference. In a printed manual, the reference does not start with a `See'. Follow command with a punctuation mark. Only the first argument is mandatory. @xref{ref, , @code{@@ref}}.@refill -@need 300 @item @@refill In Info, refill and indent the paragraph after all the other processing has been done. No effect on @TeX{}, which always refills. This command is no longer needed, since all formatters now automatically refill. @xref{Refilling Paragraphs}.@refill -@need 300 @item @@result@{@} Indicate the result of an expression to the reader with a special glyph: @samp{@result{}}. @xref{result, , @code{@@result}}.@refill @@ -14331,17 +15483,26 @@ Make @var{flag} active, causing the Texinfo formatting commands to format text between subsequent pairs of @code{@@ifset @var{flag}} and @code{@@end ifset} commands. Optionally, set value of @var{flag} to @var{string}. -@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}.@refill +@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}. @item @@setchapternewpage @var{on-off-odd} Specify whether chapters start on new pages, and if so, whether on odd-numbered (right-hand) new pages. @xref{setchapternewpage, , -@code{@@setchapternewpage}}.@refill +@code{@@setchapternewpage}}. + +@item @@setcontentsaftertitlepage +Put the table of contents after the @samp{@@end titlepage} even if the +@code{@@contents} command is not there. @xref{Contents}. @item @@setfilename @var{info-file-name} Provide a name to be used by the Info file. This command is essential for @TeX{} formatting as well, even though it produces no output. -@xref{setfilename, , @code{@@setfilename}}.@refill +@xref{setfilename, , @code{@@setfilename}}. + +@item @@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage +Place the short table of contents after the @samp{@@end titlepage} +command even if the @code{@@shortcontents} command is not there. +@xref{Contents}. @item @@settitle @var{title} Provide a title for page headers in a printed manual. @@ -14353,40 +15514,45 @@ menus rather than tables of contents. A synonym for @code{@@summarycontents}. @xref{Contents, , Generating a Table of Contents}.@refill -@item @@shorttitlepage@{@var{title}@} +@item @@shorttitlepage @var{title} Generate a minimal title page. @xref{titlepage,,@code{@@titlepage}}. -@need 400 @item @@smallbook Cause @TeX{} to produce a printed manual in a 7 by 9.25 inch format rather than the regular 8.5 by 11 inch format. @xref{smallbook, , -Printing Small Books}. Also, see @ref{smallexample & smalllisp, , -@code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp}}.@refill +Printing Small Books}. Also, see @ref{small}. + +@item @@smalldisplay +Begin a kind of example. Like @code{@@smallexample} (indent text, no +filling), but do not select the fixed-width font. In @code{@@smallbook} +format, print text in a smaller font than with @code{@@display}. Pair +with @code{@@end smalldisplay}. @xref{small}. -@need 400 @item @@smallexample Indent text to indicate an example. Do not fill, select fixed-width font. In @code{@@smallbook} format, print text in a smaller font than with @code{@@example}. Pair with @code{@@end smallexample}. -@xref{smallexample & smalllisp, , @code{@@smallexample} and -@code{@@smalllisp}}.@refill +@xref{small}. + +@item @@smallformat +Begin a kind of example. Like @code{@@smalldisplay}, but do not narrow +the margins and do not select the fixed-width font. +In @code{@@smallbook} format, print text in a smaller font than +with @code{@@format}. Pair with @code{@@end smallformat}. +@xref{small}. -@need 400 @item @@smalllisp Begin an example of Lisp code. Indent text, do not fill, select fixed-width font. In @code{@@smallbook} format, print text in a -smaller font. Pair with @code{@@end smalllisp}. @xref{smallexample & -smalllisp, , @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp}}.@refill +smaller font. Pair with @code{@@end smalllisp}. @xref{small}. -@need 700 @item @@sp @var{n} Skip @var{n} blank lines. @xref{sp, , @code{@@sp}}.@refill @item @@ss@{@} Generate the German sharp-S es-zet letter, @ss{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. -@need 700 -@item @@strong @var{text} +@item @@strong @{@var{text}@} Emphasize @var{text} by typesetting it in a @strong{bold} font for the printed manual and by surrounding it with asterisks for Info. @xref{emph & strong, , Emphasizing Text}.@refill @@ -14428,19 +15594,16 @@ menus rather than tables of contents. A synonym for @code{@@shortcontents}. @xref{Contents, , Generating a Table of Contents}.@refill -@need 300 @item @@syncodeindex @var{from-index} @var{into-index} Merge the index named in the first argument into the index named in the second argument, printing the entries from the first index in @code{@@code} font. @xref{Combining Indices}.@refill -@need 300 @item @@synindex @var{from-index} @var{into-index} Merge the index named in the first argument into the index named in the second argument. Do not change the font of @var{from-index} entries. @xref{Combining Indices}.@refill -@need 100 @item @@t@{@var{text}@} Print @var{text} in a @t{fixed-width}, typewriter-like font. No effect in Info. @xref{Fonts}.@refill @@ -14448,7 +15611,6 @@ No effect in Info. @xref{Fonts}.@refill @item @@tab Separate columns in a multitable. @xref{Multitable Rows}. -@need 400 @item @@table @var{formatting-command} Begin a two-column table, using @code{@@item} for each entry. Write each first column entry on the same line as @code{@@item}. First @@ -14492,21 +15654,18 @@ Not relevant to Info, which does not have title pages. @xref{title subtitle author, , The @code{@@title} @code{@@subtitle} and @code{@@author} Commands}.@refill -@need 400 @item @@titlefont@{@var{text}@} In a printed manual, print @var{text} in a larger than normal font. Not relevant to Info, which does not have title pages. @xref{titlefont center sp, , The @code{@@titlefont} @code{@@center} and @code{@@sp} Commands}.@refill -@need 300 @item @@titlepage Indicate to Texinfo the beginning of the title page. Write command on a line of its own. Pair with @code{@@end titlepage}. Nothing between @code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} appears in Info. @xref{titlepage, , @code{@@titlepage}}.@refill -@need 150 @item @@today@{@} Insert the current date, in `1 Jan 1900' style. @xref{Custom Headings, , How to Make Your Own Headings}.@refill @@ -14556,9 +15715,9 @@ chapter. The title appears in the table of contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is underlined with periods. @xref{subsubsection, , The `subsub' Commands}.@refill -@item @@uref@{@var{url}[, @var{displayed-text}@} +@item @@uref@{@var{url}[, @var{displayed-text}][, @var{replacement}@} Define a cross reference to an external uniform resource locator for the -World Wide Web. @xref{url, , @code{@@url}}.@refill +World Wide Web. @xref{uref, , @code{@@uref}}.@refill @item @@url@{@var{url}@} Indicate text that is a uniform resource locator for the World Wide @@ -14578,12 +15737,10 @@ Highlight a metasyntactic variable, which is something that stands for another piece of text. @xref{var, , Indicating Metasyntactic Variables}.@refill -@need 400 @item @@vindex @var{entry} Add @var{entry} to the index of variables. @xref{Index Entries, , Defining the Entries of an Index}.@refill -@need 400 @item @@vskip @var{amount} In a printed manual, insert whitespace so as to push text on the remainder of the page towards the bottom of the page. Used in @@ -14592,7 +15749,6 @@ formatting the copyright page with the argument @samp{0pt plus only in contexts ignored for Info. @xref{Copyright & Permissions, , The Copyright Page and Printed Permissions}.@refill -@need 400 @item @@vtable @var{formatting-command} Begin a two-column table, using @code{@@item} for each entry. Automatically enter each of the items in the first column into the @@ -14600,13 +15756,11 @@ index of variables. Pair with @code{@@end vtable}. The same as @code{@@table}, except for indexing. @xref{ftable vtable, , @code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable}}.@refill -@need 400 @item @@w@{@var{text}@} Prevent @var{text} from being split across two lines. Do not end a paragraph that uses @code{@@w} with an @code{@@refill} command. @xref{w, , @code{@@w}}.@refill -@need 400 @item @@xref@{@var{node-name}, [@var{entry}], [@var{topic-or-title}], [@var{info-file}], [@var{manual}]@} Make a reference that starts with `See' in a printed manual. Follow command with a punctuation mark. Only the first argument is @@ -14614,7 +15768,7 @@ mandatory. @xref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}.@refill @end table -@node Tips, Sample Texinfo File, Command List, Top +@node Tips @appendix Tips and Hints Here are some tips for writing Texinfo documentation:@refill @@ -14677,9 +15831,8 @@ Lisp. @item Write the indexing commands that refer to a whole section immediately after the section command, and write the indexing commands that refer to -the paragraph before the paragraph. +a paragraph before that paragraph. -@need 1000 In the example that follows, a blank line comes after the index entry for ``Leaping'': @@ -15057,7 +16210,7 @@ Write notes for yourself at the very end of a Texinfo file after the @end itemize -@node Sample Texinfo File, Sample Permissions, Tips, Top +@node Sample Texinfo File @appendix A Sample Texinfo File @cindex Sample Texinfo file, no comments @@ -15135,9 +16288,10 @@ manual. @end example -@node Sample Permissions, Include Files, Sample Texinfo File, Top +@node Sample Permissions @appendix Sample Permissions @cindex Permissions +@cindex Sample permissions @cindex Copying permissions Texinfo files should contain sections that tell the readers that they @@ -15147,7 +16301,7 @@ and the printed manual.@refill Also, if you are writing a manual about software, you should explain that the software is free and either include the GNU General Public License (GPL) or provide a reference to it. @xref{Distrib, , -Distribution, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for an example of the text +Distribution, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for an example of the text that could be used in the software ``Distribution'', ``General Public License'', and ``NO WARRANTY'' sections of a document. @xref{Copying, , Texinfo Copying Conditions}, for an example of a brief explanation @@ -15161,7 +16315,7 @@ of how the copying conditions provide you with rights. @refill @node Inserting Permissions, ifinfo Permissions, Sample Permissions, Sample Permissions @ifinfo -@appendixsec Inserting Permissions +@section Inserting Permissions @end ifinfo In a Texinfo file, the first @code{@@ifinfo} section usually begins @@ -15195,18 +16349,18 @@ To make it simple to insert a permission notice into each section of the Texinfo file, sample permission notices for each section are reproduced in full below.@refill -Note that you may need to specify the correct name of a section -mentioned in the permission notice. For example, in @cite{The GDB -Manual}, the name of the section referring to the General Public -License is called the ``GDB General Public License'', but in the -sample shown below, that section is referred to generically as the -``GNU General Public License''. If the Texinfo file does not carry a -copy of the General Public License, leave out the reference to it, but -be sure to include the rest of the sentence.@refill +You may need to specify the correct name of a section mentioned in the +permission notice. For example, in @cite{The GDB Manual}, the name of +the section referring to the General Public License is called the ``GDB +General Public License'', but in the sample shown below, that section is +referred to generically as the ``GNU General Public License''. If the +Texinfo file does not carry a copy of the General Public License, leave +out the reference to it, but be sure to include the rest of the +sentence. @node ifinfo Permissions, Titlepage Permissions, Inserting Permissions, Sample Permissions @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec @samp{ifinfo} Copying Permissions +@section @samp{ifinfo} Copying Permissions @cindex @samp{ifinfo} permissions In the @code{@@ifinfo} section of a Texinfo file, the standard Free @@ -15215,7 +16369,7 @@ Software Foundation permission notice reads as follows:@refill @example This file documents @dots{} -Copyright 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and @@ -15247,7 +16401,7 @@ translation approved by the Free Software Foundation. @node Titlepage Permissions, , ifinfo Permissions, Sample Permissions @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Titlepage Copying Permissions +@section Titlepage Copying Permissions @cindex Titlepage permissions In the @code{@@titlepage} section of a Texinfo file, the standard Free @@ -15277,7 +16431,7 @@ translation approved by the Free Software Foundation. @end example -@node Include Files, Headings, Sample Permissions, Top +@node Include Files @appendix Include Files @cindex Include files @@ -15302,7 +16456,7 @@ conveniently small parts.@refill @end menu @node Using Include Files, texinfo-multiple-files-update, Include Files, Include Files -@appendixsec How to Use Include Files +@section How to Use Include Files @findex include To include another file within a Texinfo file, write the @@ -15343,7 +16497,7 @@ Texinfo mode command, @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update}, that is designed for @code{@@include} files.@refill @node texinfo-multiple-files-update, Include File Requirements, Using Include Files, Include Files -@appendixsec @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} +@section @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} @findex texinfo-multiple-files-update GNU Emacs Texinfo mode provides the @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} @@ -15419,7 +16573,7 @@ updates @strong{every} pointer and menu in @strong{all} the files and then inser master menu.@refill @node Include File Requirements, Sample Include File, texinfo-multiple-files-update, Include Files -@appendixsec Include File Requirements +@section Include File Requirements @cindex Include file requirements @cindex Requirements for include files @@ -15445,7 +16599,7 @@ should @emph{not} contain any nodes besides the single `Top' node. The them.@refill @node Sample Include File, Include Files Evolution, Include File Requirements, Include Files -@appendixsec Sample File with @code{@@include} +@section Sample File with @code{@@include} @cindex Sample @code{@@include} file @cindex Include file sample @cindex @code{@@include} file sample @@ -15475,7 +16629,7 @@ would insert a main or master menu:@refill @group @@page @@vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. @@end titlepage @end group @@ -15516,21 +16670,21 @@ The full contents of @file{concept-index.texinfo} might be as simple as this: @example @group -@@node Concept Index, , Second, Top +@@node Concept Index @@unnumbered Concept Index @@printindex cp @end group @end example -The outer Texinfo source file for @cite{The XEmacs Lisp Reference +The outer Texinfo source file for @cite{The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual} is named @file{elisp.texi}. This outer file contains a master menu with 417 entries and a list of 41 @code{@@include} files.@refill @node Include Files Evolution, , Sample Include File, Include Files @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Evolution of Include Files +@section Evolution of Include Files When Info was first created, it was customary to create many small Info files on one subject. Each Info file was formatted from its own @@ -15558,7 +16712,7 @@ However, because large Info files are now split automatically, it is no longer necessary to keep them small.@refill Nowadays, multiple Texinfo files are used mostly for large documents, -such as @cite{The XEmacs Lisp Reference Manual}, and for projects +such as @cite{The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, and for projects in which several different people write different sections of a document simultaneously.@refill @@ -15569,7 +16723,7 @@ you can write menus and cross references without naming the different Texinfo files.@refill -@node Headings, Catching Mistakes, Include Files, Top +@node Headings @appendix Page Headings @cindex Headings @cindex Footings @@ -15628,7 +16782,7 @@ right part is set flushright.@refill @node Heading Format, Heading Choice, Headings Introduced, Headings @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Standard Heading Formats +@section Standard Heading Formats Texinfo provides two standard heading formats, one for manuals printed on one side of each sheet of paper, and the other for manuals printed @@ -15697,7 +16851,7 @@ manual.@refill @node Heading Choice, Custom Headings, Heading Format, Headings @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Specifying the Type of Heading +@section Specifying the Type of Heading @TeX{} does not begin to generate page headings for a standard Texinfo file until it reaches the @code{@@end titlepage} command. Thus, the @@ -15734,22 +16888,25 @@ Texinfo lacks an @code{@@setchapternewpage even} command.@refill @node Custom Headings, , Heading Choice, Headings @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec How to Make Your Own Headings +@section How to Make Your Own Headings You can use the standard headings provided with Texinfo or specify your own. By default, Texinfo has no footers, so if you specify them, the available page size for the main text will be slightly reduced. -@c Following paragraph is verbose to prevent overfull hboxes. Texinfo provides six commands for specifying headings and -footings. The @code{@@everyheading} command and -@code{@@everyfooting} command generate page headers and footers -that are the same for both even- and odd-numbered pages. -The @code{@@evenheading} command and @code{@@evenfooting} -command generate headers and footers for even-numbered -(left-hand) pages; and the @code{@@oddheading} command and -@code{@@oddfooting} command generate headers and footers for -odd-numbered (right-hand) pages.@refill +footings: +@itemize @bullet +@item +@code{@@everyheading} @code{@@everyfooting} generate page headers and +footers that are the same for both even- and odd-numbered pages. +@item +@code{@@evenheading} and @code{@@evenfooting} command generate headers +and footers for even-numbered (left-hand) pages. +@item +@code{@@oddheading} and @code{@@oddfooting} generate headers and footers +for odd-numbered (right-hand) pages. +@end itemize Write custom heading specifications in the Texinfo file immediately after the @code{@@end titlepage} command. Enclose your specifications @@ -15881,7 +17038,7 @@ Beware of overlong titles: they may overlap another part of the header or footer and blot it out.@refill -@node Catching Mistakes, Refilling Paragraphs, Headings, Top +@node Catching Mistakes @appendix Formatting Mistakes @cindex Structure, catching mistakes in @cindex Nodes, catching mistakes @@ -15937,7 +17094,7 @@ may want to use the tools described in this appendix.@refill @node Debugging with Info, Debugging with TeX, makeinfo Preferred, Catching Mistakes @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Catching Errors with Info Formatting +@section Catching Errors with Info Formatting @cindex Catching errors with Info formatting @cindex Debugging with Info formatting @@ -16118,13 +17275,13 @@ Inside the function @code{texinfo-format-parse-args}, the function @code{re-search-forward} was called; it was this function that could not find the missing right-hand brace.@refill -@xref{Lisp Debug, , Debugging Emacs Lisp, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, -for more information.@refill +@xref{Lisp Debug, , Debugging Emacs Lisp, emacs, The GNU Emacs +Manual}, for more information.@refill @end ignore @node Debugging with TeX, Using texinfo-show-structure, Debugging with Info, Catching Mistakes @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Catching Errors with @TeX{} Formatting +@section Catching Errors with @TeX{} Formatting @cindex Catching errors with @TeX{} formatting @cindex Debugging with @TeX{} formatting @@ -16206,9 +17363,8 @@ You can tell @TeX{} to stop this run by typing @kbd{x @key{RET}} at the @samp{?} prompt.@refill @end enumerate -Please note that if you are running @TeX{} inside Emacs, you need to -switch to the shell buffer and line at which @TeX{} offers the @samp{?} -prompt.@refill +If you are running @TeX{} inside Emacs, you need to switch to the shell +buffer and line at which @TeX{} offers the @samp{?} prompt. Sometimes @TeX{} will format a file without producing error messages even though there is a problem. This usually occurs if a command is not ended @@ -16254,7 +17410,7 @@ directly with @TeX{}, not with Texinfo.)@refill @node Using texinfo-show-structure, Using occur, Debugging with TeX, Catching Mistakes @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Using @code{texinfo-show-structure} +@section Using @code{texinfo-show-structure} @cindex Showing the structure of a file @findex texinfo-show-structure @@ -16298,20 +17454,20 @@ commands respectively. If you move your cursor into the @samp{*Occur*} window, you can position the cursor over one of the lines and use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command (@code{occur-mode-goto-occurrence}), to jump to the corresponding spot in the Texinfo file. @xref{Other Repeating -Search, , Using Occur, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, for more +Search, , Using Occur, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information about @code{occur-mode-goto-occurrence}.@refill The first line in the @samp{*Occur*} window describes the @dfn{regular expression} specified by @var{texinfo-heading-pattern}. This regular expression is the pattern that @code{texinfo-show-structure} looks for. -@xref{Regexps, , Using Regular Expressions, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, +@xref{Regexps, , Using Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information.@refill When you invoke the @code{texinfo-show-structure} command, Emacs will display the structure of the whole buffer. If you want to see the structure of just a part of the buffer, of one chapter, for example, use the @kbd{C-x n n} (@code{narrow-to-region}) command to mark the -region. (@xref{Narrowing, , , xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}.) This is +region. (@xref{Narrowing, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.) This is how the example used above was generated. (To see the whole buffer again, use @kbd{C-x n w} (@code{widen}).)@refill @@ -16326,7 +17482,7 @@ or left out a section, you can correct the mistake.@refill @node Using occur, Running Info-Validate, Using texinfo-show-structure, Catching Mistakes @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Using @code{occur} +@section Using @code{occur} @cindex Occurrences, listing with @code{@@occur} @findex occur @@ -16343,10 +17499,10 @@ command directly. To do this, type@refill @noindent and then, when prompted, type a @dfn{regexp}, a regular expression for the pattern you want to match. (@xref{Regexps, , Regular Expressions, -xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}.) The @code{occur} command works from the -current location of the cursor in the buffer to the end of the buffer. -If you want to run @code{occur} on the whole buffer, place the cursor at -the beginning of the buffer.@refill +emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.) The @code{occur} command works from +the current location of the cursor in the buffer to the end of the +buffer. If you want to run @code{occur} on the whole buffer, place +the cursor at the beginning of the buffer.@refill For example, to see all the lines that contain the word @samp{@@chapter} in them, just type @samp{@@chapter}. This will @@ -16361,12 +17517,12 @@ or phrase, end the last word with a @samp{$}; for example, all the nodes that are part of the same chapter or section and therefore have the same `Up' pointer.@refill -@xref{Other Repeating Search, , Using Occur, xemacs, XEmacs User's Manual}, +@xref{Other Repeating Search, , Using Occur, emacs , The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information.@refill @node Running Info-Validate, , Using occur, Catching Mistakes @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Finding Badly Referenced Nodes +@section Finding Badly Referenced Nodes @findex Info-validate @cindex Nodes, checking for badly referenced @cindex Checking for badly referenced nodes @@ -16395,7 +17551,7 @@ if you write an Info file from scratch.@refill @end menu @node Using Info-validate, Unsplit, Running Info-Validate, Running Info-Validate -@appendixsubsec Running @code{Info-validate} +@subsection Running @code{Info-validate} @cindex Running @code{Info-validate} @cindex Info validating a large file @cindex Validating a large file @@ -16408,9 +17564,9 @@ M-x Info-validate @end example @noindent -(Note that the @code{Info-validate} command requires an upper case +Note that the @code{Info-validate} command requires an upper case `I'. You may also need to create a tag table before running -@code{Info-validate}. @xref{Tagifying}.)@refill +@code{Info-validate}. @xref{Tagifying}. If your file is valid, you will receive a message that says ``File appears valid''. However, if you have a pointer that does not point to a node, @@ -16444,17 +17600,16 @@ This is because every `Next' pointer should be matched by a @code{Info-validate} also checks that all menu entries and cross references point to actual nodes.@refill -Note that @code{Info-validate} requires a tag table and does not work -with files that have been split. (The @code{texinfo-format-buffer} -command automatically splits large files.) In order to use -@code{Info-validate} on a large file, you must run -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} with an argument so that it does not split -the Info file; and you must create a tag table for the unsplit -file.@refill +@code{Info-validate} requires a tag table and does not work with files +that have been split. (The @code{texinfo-format-buffer} command +automatically splits large files.) In order to use @code{Info-validate} +on a large file, you must run @code{texinfo-format-buffer} with an +argument so that it does not split the Info file; and you must create a +tag table for the unsplit file. @node Unsplit, Tagifying, Using Info-validate, Running Info-Validate @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsubsec Creating an Unsplit File +@subsection Creating an Unsplit File @cindex Creating an unsplit file @cindex Unsplit file creation @@ -16491,7 +17646,7 @@ a tag table for it. @refill @cindex Tag table, making manually @node Tagifying, Splitting, Unsplit, Running Info-Validate -@appendixsubsec Tagifying a File +@subsection Tagifying a File After creating an unsplit Info file, you must create a tag table for it. Visit the Info file you wish to tagify and type:@refill @@ -16529,14 +17684,14 @@ table and split the file manually.@refill @node Splitting, , Tagifying, Running Info-Validate @comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsubsec Splitting a File Manually +@subsection Splitting a File Manually @cindex Splitting an Info file manually @cindex Info file, splitting manually You should split a large file or else let the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or @code{makeinfo-buffer} command do it for you automatically. (Generally you will let one of the formatting -commands do this job for you. @xref{Create an Info File}.)@refill +commands do this job for you. @xref{Creating an Info File}.)@refill The split-off files are called the indirect subfiles.@refill @@ -16579,10 +17734,11 @@ The primary file still functions as an Info file, but it contains just the tag table and a directory of subfiles.@refill -@node Refilling Paragraphs, Command Syntax, Catching Mistakes, Top +@node Refilling Paragraphs @appendix Refilling Paragraphs @cindex Refilling paragraphs @cindex Filling paragraphs +@cindex Paragraphs, filling @findex refill The @code{@@refill} command refills and, optionally, indents the first @@ -16618,10 +17774,11 @@ the ends of paragraphs that contain @code{@@*} or @w{@code{@@w@{ @dots{}@}}} and therefore do not refill or indent them.@refill -@node Command Syntax, Obtaining TeX, Refilling Paragraphs, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up +@node Command Syntax @appendix @@-Command Syntax @cindex @@-command syntax +@cindex Syntax, of @@-commands +@cindex Command syntax The character @samp{@@} is used to start special Texinfo commands. (It has the same meaning that @samp{\} has in plain @TeX{}.) Texinfo @@ -16682,7 +17839,7 @@ Emacs paragraph commands because it cannot appear at the beginning of a line.@refill -@node Obtaining TeX, Command and Variable Index, Command Syntax, Top +@node Obtaining TeX @appendix How to Obtain @TeX{} @cindex Obtaining @TeX{} @cindex @TeX{}, how to obtain @@ -16705,16 +17862,8 @@ available distributions: @end example The Free Software Foundation provides a core distribution on its Source -Code CD-ROM suitable for printing Texinfo manuals; the University of -Washington maintains and supports a tape distribution; the @TeX{} Users -Group co-sponsors a complete CD-ROM @TeX{} distribution. - -@itemize @bullet - -@item -For the FSF Source Code CD-ROM, please contact: +Code CD-ROM suitable for printing Texinfo manuals. To order it, contact: -@iftex @display @group Free Software Foundation, Inc. @@ -16729,54 +17878,6 @@ Free Dial Fax (in Japan): Electronic mail: @code{gnu@@gnu.org} @end group @end display -@end iftex -@ifinfo -@display -@group -Free Software Foundation, Inc. -59 Temple Place Suite 330 -Boston, MA @w{ } 02111-1307 -USA - -Telephone: @w{+1-617-542-5942} -Fax: (including Japan) @w{+1-617-542-2652} -Free Dial Fax (in Japan): -@w{ } @w{ } @w{ } 0031-13-2473 (KDD) -@w{ } @w{ } @w{ } 0066-3382-0158 (IDC) -Electronic mail: @code{gnu@@gnu.org} -@end group -@end display -@end ifinfo - -@item -To order a complete distribution on CD-ROM, please see -@uref{http://tug.org/tex-live.html}. (This distribution is also -available by FTP; see the URL's above.) - -@item -To order a full distribution from the University of Washington on either -a 1/4@dmn{in} 4-track QIC-24 cartridge or a 4@dmn{mm} DAT cartridge, -send $210 to: - -@display -@group -Pierre A. MacKay -Denny Hall, Mail Stop DH-10 -University of Washington -Seattle, WA @w{ } 98195 -USA -Telephone: +1-206-543-2268 -Electronic mail: @code{mackay@@cs.washington.edu} -@end group -@end display - -@noindent -Please make checks payable to the University of Washington. -Checks must be in U.S.@: dollars, drawn on a U.S.@: bank. Overseas -sites: please add to the base cost, if desired, $20.00 for shipment via -air parcel post, or $30.00 for shipment via courier. - -@end itemize Many other @TeX{} distributions are available; see @uref{http://tug.org/}. @@ -16784,7 +17885,8 @@ Many other @TeX{} distributions are available; see @c These are no longer ``new'', and the explanations @c are all given elsewhere anyway, I think. --karl, 25apr97. -@ignore (the entire appendix) +@c So ignore the entire appendix. +@ignore @c node New Features, Command and Variable Index, Obtaining TeX, Top @c appendix Second Edition Features @@ -16802,10 +17904,10 @@ edition.@refill Here is a brief description of the new commands.@refill -@menu +@c menu * New Texinfo Mode Commands:: The updating commands are especially useful. * New Commands:: Many newly described @@-commands. -@end menu +@c end menu @c node New Texinfo Mode Commands, New Commands, Obtaining TeX, Obtaining TeX @c appendixsec New Texinfo Mode Commands @@ -16993,8 +18095,8 @@ Indent descriptions in menus. Insert node pointers in strict sequence. @end table -@c node New Commands, , New Texinfo Mode Commands, Obtaining TeX -@c appendixsec New Texinfo @@-Commands +@c no.de New Commands, , New Texinfo Mode Commands, Obtaining TeX +@c appendix.sec New Texinfo @@-Commands The second edition of the Texinfo manual describes more than 50 commands that were not described in the first edition. A third or so @@ -17209,7 +18311,7 @@ see @ref{Overfull hboxes},@* see @ref{Footnotes},@* see @ref{dmn, , Format a Dimension},@* see @ref{Raise/lower sections, , @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections}},@* -see @ref{math, , @code{@@math} - Inserting Mathematical Expressions}.@* +see @ref{math, , @code{@@math}: Inserting Mathematical Expressions}.@* see @ref{minus, , Inserting a Minus Sign},@* see @ref{paragraphindent, , Paragraph Indenting},@* see @ref{Cross Reference Commands},@* @@ -17271,8 +18373,8 @@ Insert the current date. @end tex @end ignore -@node Command and Variable Index, Concept Index, Obtaining TeX, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up + +@node Command and Variable Index @unnumbered Command and Variable Index This is an alphabetical list of all the @@-commands, assorted Emacs Lisp @@ -17282,12 +18384,10 @@ commands are listed without their preceding @samp{@@}.@refill @printindex fn -@node Concept Index, , Command and Variable Index, Top +@node Concept Index @unnumbered Concept Index @printindex cp -@summarycontents -@contents @bye diff --git a/man/xemacs-faq.texi b/man/xemacs-faq.texi index 0c2eaa7..be50d8a 100644 --- a/man/xemacs-faq.texi +++ b/man/xemacs-faq.texi @@ -7,10 +7,10 @@ @finalout @titlepage @title XEmacs FAQ -@subtitle Frequently asked questions about XEmacs @* Last Modified: $Date: 1999/09/26 19:46:47 $ +@subtitle Frequently asked questions about XEmacs @* Last Modified: $Date: 1999/11/20 20:16:50 $ @sp 1 @author Tony Rossini -@author Ben Wing +@author Ben Wing @author Chuck Thompson @author Steve Baur @author Andreas Kaempf @@ -305,6 +305,7 @@ Other Mail & News: Sparcworks, EOS, and WorkShop: * Q4.4.1:: What is SPARCworks, EOS, and WorkShop +* Q4.4.2:: How do I start the Sun Workshop support in XEmacs 21? Energize: * Q4.5.1:: What is/was Energize? @@ -398,15 +399,15 @@ available resources. The previous maintainer of the FAQ was @email{rossini@@stat.sc.edu, Anthony Rossini}, who started it, after getting tired of hearing JWZ complain about repeatedly having to answer questions. -@email{ben@@666.com, Ben Wing} and @email{cthomp@@xemacs.org, Chuck +@email{ben@@xemacs.org, Ben Wing} and @email{cthomp@@xemacs.org, Chuck Thompson}, the principal authors of XEmacs, then took over and Ben did a massive update reorganizing the whole thing. At which point Anthony took back over, but then had to give it up again. Some of the other contributors to this FAQ are listed later in this document. The previous version was converted to hypertext format, and edited by -@email{steve@@altair.xemacs.org, Steven L. Baur}. It was converted back to -texinfo by @email{hniksic@@srce.hr, Hrvoje Niksic}. +@email{steve@@xemacs.org, Steven L. Baur}. It was converted back to +texinfo by @email{hniksic@@xemacs.org, Hrvoje Niksic}. The FAQ was then maintained by @email{andreas@@sccon.com, Andreas Kaempf}, who passed it on to @email{faq@@xemacs.org, Christian @@ -742,7 +743,7 @@ identify problems as best they can. @node Q1.1.3, Q1.2.1, Q1.1.2, Introduction @unnumberedsubsec Q1.1.3: How do I contribute to XEmacs itself? -Ben Wing @email{ben@@666.com} writes: +Ben Wing @email{ben@@xemacs.org} writes: @quotation BTW if you have a wish list of things that you want added, you have to @@ -785,14 +786,14 @@ developers responsible for the 19.16/20.x releases are: @end ifhtml -@item @email{steve@@altair.xemacs.org, Steve Baur} +@item @email{steve@@xemacs.org, Steve Baur} @ifhtml
Portrait of Steve Baur
@end ifhtml -@item @email{hniksic@@srce.hr, Hrvoje Niksic} +@item @email{hniksic@@xemacs.org, Hrvoje Niksic} @ifhtml
Portrait of Hrvoje Niksic
@@ -811,7 +812,7 @@ The developers responsible for the 19.14 release are: Chuck was Mr. XEmacs from 19.11 through 19.14, and is responsible for XEmacs becoming a widely distributed program over the Internet. -@item @email{ben@@666.com, Ben Wing} +@item @email{ben@@xemacs.org, Ben Wing} @ifhtml
Portrait of Ben Wing
@end ifhtml @@ -820,7 +821,7 @@ for XEmacs becoming a widely distributed program over the Internet. @itemize @bullet -@item @email{jwz@@netscape.com, Jamie Zawinski} +@item @email{jwz@@jwz.org, Jamie Zawinski} @ifhtml
Portrait of Jamie Zawinski
@end ifhtml @@ -844,7 +845,7 @@ version of the FAQ (listed in alphabetical order): @itemize @bullet @item @email{steve@@xemacs.org, SL Baur} -@item @email{hniksic@@srce.hr, Hrvoje Niksic} +@item @email{hniksic@@xemacs.org, Hrvoje Niksic} @item @email{Aki.Vehtari@@hut.fi, Aki Vehtari} @@ -923,7 +924,7 @@ This is yet another holdover from XEmacs Lisp's derivation from vintage-1980 Lisps; modern versions of Lisp consider this equivalence a bad idea, and have separate character types. In XEmacs version 20, the modern convention is followed, and characters are their own -primitive types. (This change was necessary in order for @sc{MULE}, +primitive types. (This change was necessary in order for @sc{mule}, i.e. Asian-language, support to be correctly implemented.) Even in XEmacs version 20, remnants of the equivalence between @@ -941,21 +942,21 @@ with the distinction between characters and integers in mind. Every character has an equivalent integer, called the @dfn{character code}. For example, the character @kbd{A} is represented as the -@w{integer 65}, following the standard @sc{ASCII} representation of -characters. If XEmacs was not compiled with @sc{MULE} support, the +@w{integer 65}, following the standard @sc{ascii} representation of +characters. If XEmacs was not compiled with @sc{mule} support, the range of this integer will always be 0 to 255 -- eight bits, or one byte. (Integers outside this range are accepted but silently truncated; however, you should most decidedly @emph{not} rely on this, because it -will not work under XEmacs with @sc{MULE} support.) When @sc{MULE} +will not work under XEmacs with @sc{mule} support.) When @sc{mule} support is present, the range of character codes is much larger. (Currently, 19 bits are used.) FSF GNU Emacs uses kludgy character codes above 255 to represent -keyboard input of @sc{ASCII} characters in combination with certain +keyboard input of @sc{ascii} characters in combination with certain modifiers. XEmacs does not use this (a more general mechanism is -used that does not distinguish between @sc{ASCII} keys and other +used that does not distinguish between @sc{ascii} keys and other keys), so you will never find character codes above 255 in a -non-@sc{MULE} XEmacs. +non-@sc{mule} XEmacs. Individual characters are not often used in programs. It is far more common to work with @emph{strings}, which are sequences composed of @@ -1148,9 +1149,9 @@ directory called @file{sample.emacs}. Copy this file from there to your home directory and rename it @file{.emacs}. Then edit it to suit. Starting with 19.14, you may bring the @file{sample.emacs} into an -XEmacs buffer by selecting @samp{Help->Samples->Sample .emacs} from the -menubar. To determine the location of the @file{etc} directory type the -command @kbd{C-h v data-directory @key{RET}}. +XEmacs buffer by selecting @samp{Help->Sample .emacs} from the menubar. +To determine the location of the @file{etc} directory type the command +@kbd{C-h v data-directory @key{RET}}. @node Q1.4.2, Q1.4.3, Q1.4.1, Introduction @unnumberedsubsec Q1.4.2: Can I use the same @file{.emacs} with the other Emacs? @@ -1352,7 +1353,7 @@ This will let you run XEmacs without massive copying. Although this entry has been written for XEmacs 19.13, most of it still stands true. -@email{steve@@altair.xemacs.org, Steve Baur} writes: +@email{steve@@xemacs.org, Steve Baur} writes: @quotation The 45MB of space required by the installation directories can be @@ -1568,7 +1569,7 @@ Initialization error: Terminal type `xterm' undefined (or can't access database?) @end example -@email{ben@@666.com, Ben Wing} writes: +@email{ben@@xemacs.org, Ben Wing} writes: @quotation Your ncurses configuration is messed up. Your /usr/lib/terminfo is a @@ -1626,7 +1627,7 @@ Rebuild XEmacs yourself -- any working ELF version of libc should be O.K. @end enumerate -@email{hniksic@@srce.hr, Hrvoje Niksic} writes: +@email{hniksic@@xemacs.org, Hrvoje Niksic} writes: @quotation Why not use a Perl one-liner for No. 2? @@ -2210,7 +2211,7 @@ forcing a static link of libc (manually). @node Q2.1.14, Q2.1.15, Q2.1.13, Installation @unnumberedsubsec Q2.1.14: @kbd{C-g} doesn't work for me. Is it broken? -@email{ben@@666.com, Ben Wing} writes: +@email{ben@@xemacs.org, Ben Wing} writes: @quotation @kbd{C-g} does work for most people in most circumstances. If it @@ -2734,7 +2735,7 @@ It's almost always a mistake to test @code{emacs-version} or any similar variables. Instead, use feature-tests, such as @code{featurep}, @code{boundp}, -@code{fboundp}, or even simple behavioral tests, eg.: +@code{fboundp}, or even simple behaviroal tests, eg.: @lisp (defvar foo-old-losing-code-p @@ -2976,7 +2977,7 @@ When I start up XEmacs using @samp{-iconic} it doesn't work right. Using @samp{-unmapped} on the command line, and setting the @code{initiallyUnmapped} X Resource don't seem to help much either... -@email{ben@@666.com, Ben Wing} writes: +@email{ben@@xemacs.org, Ben Wing} writes: @quotation Ugh, this stuff is such an incredible mess that I've about given up @@ -3540,7 +3541,7 @@ effect of being able to press and release Shift and have the next character typed come out in upper case. This will affect all the other modifier keys like Control and Meta as well. -@email{ben@@666.com, Ben Wing} writes: +@email{ben@@xemacs.org, Ben Wing} writes: @quotation One thing about the sticky modifiers is that if you move the mouse out @@ -4086,6 +4087,7 @@ Other Mail & News: Sparcworks, EOS, and WorkShop: * Q4.4.1:: What is SPARCworks, EOS, and WorkShop +* Q4.4.2:: How do I start the Sun Workshop support in XEmacs 21? Energize: * Q4.5.1:: What is/was Energize? @@ -4165,7 +4167,7 @@ Set @code{vm-reply-ignored-addresses} to a list, like @lisp (setq vm-reply-ignored-addresses '("wing@@nuspl@@nvwls.cc.purdue.edu,netcom[0-9]*.netcom.com" - "wing@@netcom.com" "wing@@666.com")) + "wing@@netcom.com" "wing@@xemacs.org")) @end lisp Note that each string is a regular expression. @@ -4487,7 +4489,7 @@ trivial to use. @node Q4.3.3, Q4.3.4, Q4.3.2, Subsystems @unnumberedsubsec Q4.3.3: Why isn't this @code{movemail} program working? -Ben Wing @email{ben@@666.com} writes: +Ben Wing @email{ben@@xemacs.org} writes: @quotation It wasn't chown'ed/chmod'd correctly. @@ -4496,14 +4498,14 @@ It wasn't chown'ed/chmod'd correctly. @node Q4.3.4, Q4.3.5, Q4.3.3, Subsystems @unnumberedsubsec Q4.3.4: Movemail is also distributed by Netscape? Can that cause problems? -@email{steve@@altair.xemacs.org, Steve Baur} writes: +@email{steve@@xemacs.org, Steve Baur} writes: @quotation Yes. Always use the movemail installed with your XEmacs. Failure to do so can result in lost mail. @end quotation -Please refer to @email{jwz@@netscape.com, Jamie Zawinski's} notes at +Please refer to @email{jwz@@jwz.org, Jamie Zawinski's} notes at @iftex @* @end iftex @@ -4539,7 +4541,7 @@ There is a good mirror at ftp.cdrom.com; @end iftex @uref{ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/tex/ctan/support/latex2html/}. -@node Q4.4.1, Q4.5.1, Q4.3.5, Subsystems +@node Q4.4.1, Q4.4.2, Q4.3.5, Subsystems @unnumberedsec 4.4: Sparcworks, EOS, and WorkShop @unnumberedsubsec Q4.4.1: What is SPARCworks, EOS, and WorkShop? @@ -4583,7 +4585,45 @@ details, check out @uref{http://www.sun.com/software/Products/Developer-products/programs.html}. @end quotation -@node Q4.5.1, Q4.6.1, Q4.4.1, Subsystems +@node Q4.4.2, Q4.5.1, Q4.4.1, Subsystems +@unnumberedsubsec Q4.4.2: How do I start the Sun Workshop support in XEmacs 21? + +Add the switch ---with-workshop to the configure command when building +XEmacs and put the following in one of your startup files +(e.g. site-start.el or .emacs): + +@lisp +(when (featurep 'tooltalk) + (load "tooltalk-macros") + (load "tooltalk-util") + (load "tooltalk-init")) +(when (featurep 'sparcworks) + (load "sunpro-init") + (load "ring") + (load "comint") + (load "annotations") + (sunpro-startup)) +@end lisp + +If you are not using the latest Workshop (5.0) you have to apply the +following patch: + +@format +--- /opt/SUNWspro/lib/eserve.el.ORIG Fri May 14 15:23:26 1999 ++++ /opt/SUNWspro/lib/eserve.el Fri May 14 15:24:54 1999 +@@@@ -42,7 +42,7 @@@@ + (defvar running-xemacs nil "t if we're running XEmacs") + (defvar running-emacs nil "t if we're running GNU Emacs 19") + +-(if (string-match "^\\(19\\|20\\)\..*\\(XEmacs\\|Lucid\\)" emacs-version) ++(if (string-match "\\(XEmacs\\|Lucid\\)" emacs-version) + (setq running-xemacs t) + (setq running-emacs t)) +@end format + + + +@node Q4.5.1, Q4.6.1, Q4.4.2, Subsystems @unnumberedsec 4.5: Energize @unnumberedsubsec Q4.5.1: What is/was Energize? @@ -5708,7 +5748,7 @@ is: an easy way to find out where it spends time? @c New -z@email{hniksic@@srce.hr, Hrvoje Niksic} writes: +z@email{hniksic@@xemacs.org, Hrvoje Niksic} writes: @quotation Under XEmacs 20.4 and later you can use @kbd{M-x profile-key-sequence}, press a key (say @key{RET} in the Gnus Group buffer), and get the results using @@ -6229,7 +6269,7 @@ XEmacs 19.16 was the last 19 release, basically consisting of 19.15 plus the collected bugfixes. @item -As of December 1996, @email{steve@@altair.xemacs.org, Steve Baur} has become +As of December 1996, @email{steve@@xemacs.org, Steve Baur} has become the lead maintainer of XEmacs. @end enumerate diff --git a/man/xemacs/custom.texi b/man/xemacs/custom.texi index 3b7ccdc..d37a926 100644 --- a/man/xemacs/custom.texi +++ b/man/xemacs/custom.texi @@ -2359,8 +2359,8 @@ The font of this face. The foreground and background colors of this face. @item @code{attributeBackgroundPixmap} (class @code{AttributeBackgroundPixmap}): file-name -The name of an @sc{XBM} file (or @sc{XPM} file, if your version of Emacs -supports @sc{XPM}), to use as a background stipple. +The name of an @sc{xbm} file (or @sc{xpm} file, if your version of Emacs +supports @sc{xpm}), to use as a background stipple. @item @code{attributeUnderline} (class @code{AttributeUnderline}): boolean Whether text in this face should be underlined. diff --git a/man/xemacs/menus.texi b/man/xemacs/menus.texi index 7b735c7..92accd8 100644 --- a/man/xemacs/menus.texi +++ b/man/xemacs/menus.texi @@ -430,18 +430,18 @@ items and disabling or enabling existing menu items. The following functions are available: @table @kbd -@item add-menu: @var{(menu-path menu-name menu-items &optional before)} +@item add-menu: (@var{menu-path} @var{menu-name} @var{menu-items} &optional @var{before}) Add a menu to the menu bar or one of its submenus. -@item add-menu-item: @var{(menu-path item-name function enabled-p -&optional before)} +@item add-menu-item: (@var{menu-path} @var{item-name} @var{function} +@var{enabled-p} &optional @var{before}) Add a menu item to a menu, creating the menu first if necessary. -@item delete-menu-item: @var{(path)} +@item delete-menu-item: (@var{path}) Remove the menu item defined by @var{path} from the menu hierarchy. -@item disable-menu-item: @var{(path)} +@item disable-menu-item: (@var{path}) Disable the specified menu item. -@item enable-menu-item: @var{(path)} +@item enable-menu-item: (@var{path}) Enable the specified previously disabled menu item. -@item relabel-menu-item: @var{(path new-name)} +@item relabel-menu-item: (@var{path} @var{new-name}) Change the string of the menu item specified by @var{path} to @var{new-name}. diff --git a/man/xemacs/programs.texi b/man/xemacs/programs.texi index dd9bf07..ded2af4 100644 --- a/man/xemacs/programs.texi +++ b/man/xemacs/programs.texi @@ -508,7 +508,7 @@ indentation is computed by @kbd{C-M-q}; if the value is a number, until the end of the list. @end table -@node C Indent,, Lisp Indent, Grinding +@node C Indent, , Lisp Indent, Grinding @subsection Customizing C Indentation Two variables control which commands perform C indentation and when. @@ -1012,7 +1012,7 @@ broken up into files. It lists the names of the component files and the names and positions of the functions (or other named subunits) in each file. Grouping the related files makes it possible to search or replace through all the files with one command. Recording the function names -and positions makes possible the @kbd{M-.} command which finds the +and positions makes possible the @kbd{M-.} command which finds the definition of a function by looking up which of the files it is in. Tags tables are stored in files called @dfn{tags table files}. The @@ -1029,15 +1029,16 @@ global variables, data types, and anything else convenient. Each name recorded is called a @dfn{tag}. @menu -* Tag Syntax:: Tag syntax for various types of code and text files. +* Tag Syntax:: Tag syntax for various types of code and text files. * Create Tags Table:: Creating a tags table with @code{etags}. +* Etags Regexps:: Create arbitrary tags using regular expressions. * Select Tags Table:: How to visit a tags table. -* Find Tag:: Commands to find the definition of a specific tag. +* Find Tag:: Commands to find the definition of a specific tag. * Tags Search:: Using a tags table for searching and replacing. * List Tags:: Listing and finding tags defined in a file. @end menu -@node Tag Syntax +@node Tag Syntax, Create Tags Table, Tags, Tags @subsection Source File Tag Syntax Here is how tag syntax is defined for the most popular languages: @@ -1045,25 +1046,28 @@ recorded is called a @dfn{tag}. @itemize @bullet @item In C code, any C function or typedef is a tag, and so are definitions of -@code{struct}, @code{union} and @code{enum}. @code{#define} macro -definitions and @code{enum} constants are also tags, unless you specify -@samp{--no-defines} when making the tags table. Similarly, global -variables are tags, unless you specify @samp{--no-globals}. Use of -@samp{--no-globals} and @samp{--no-defines} can make the tags table file -much smaller. +@code{struct}, @code{union} and @code{enum}. You can tag function +declarations and external variables in addition to function definitions +by giving the @samp{--declarations} option to @code{etags}. +@code{#define} macro definitions and @code{enum} constants are also +tags, unless you specify @samp{--no-defines} when making the tags table. +Similarly, global variables are tags, unless you specify +@samp{--no-globals}. Use of @samp{--no-globals} and @samp{--no-defines} +can make the tags table file much smaller. @item In C++ code, in addition to all the tag constructs of C code, member functions are also recognized, and optionally member variables if you use the @samp{--members} option. Tags for variables and functions in classes are named @samp{@var{class}::@var{variable}} and -@samp{@var{class}::@var{function}}. +@samp{@var{class}::@var{function}}. @code{operator} functions tags are +named, for example @samp{operator+}. @item In Java code, tags include all the constructs recognized in C++, plus -the @code{extends} and @code{implements} constructs. Tags for variables -and functions in classes are named @samp{@var{class}.@var{variable}} and -@samp{@var{class}.@var{function}}. +the @code{interface}, @code{extends} and @code{implements} constructs. +Tags for variables and functions in classes are named +@samp{@var{class}.@var{variable}} and @samp{@var{class}.@var{function}}. @item In La@TeX{} text, the argument of any of the commands @code{\chapter}, @@ -1075,7 +1079,7 @@ tag.@refill Other commands can make tags as well, if you specify them in the environment variable @code{TEXTAGS} before invoking @code{etags}. The value of this environment variable should be a colon-separated list of -commands names. For example, +command names. For example, @example TEXTAGS="def:newcommand:newenvironment" @@ -1101,6 +1105,12 @@ set with @code{set!} at top level in the file. Several other languages are also supported: @itemize @bullet + +@item +In Ada code, functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and types are +tags. Use the @samp{--packages-only} option to create tags for packages +only. + @item In assembler code, labels appearing at the beginning of a line, followed by a colon, are tags. @@ -1111,39 +1121,44 @@ it constructs. The portions of the file that contain C code are parsed as C code. @item -In Cobol code, paragraphs names are the tags, i.e. any word starting in -column 8 and followed by a full stop. +In Cobol code, tags are paragraph names; that is, any word starting in +column 8 and followed by a period. @item In Erlang code, the tags are the functions, records, and macros defined in the file. @item -In Fortran code, functions and subroutines are tags. +In Fortran code, functions, subroutines and blockdata are tags. @item In Objective C code, tags include Objective C definitions for classes, -class categories, methods and protocols. +class categories, methods, and protocols. @item In Pascal code, the tags are the functions and procedures defined in the file. @item -In Perl code, the tags are the procedures defined by the @code{sub} -keyword. +In Perl code, the tags are the procedures defined by the @code{sub}, +@code{my} and @code{local} keywords. Use @samp{--globals} if you want +to tag global variables. @item In Postscript code, the tags are the functions. @item In Prolog code, a tag name appears at the left margin. + +@item +In Python code, @code{def} or @code{class} at the beginning of a line +generate a tag. @end itemize - You can also generate tags based on regexp matching (@pxref{Create -Tags Table}) to handle other formats and languages. + You can also generate tags based on regexp matching +(@pxref{Etags Regexps}) to handle other formats and languages. -@node Create Tags Table +@node Create Tags Table, Etags Regexps, Tag Syntax, Tags @subsection Creating Tags Tables @cindex @code{etags} program @@ -1162,10 +1177,18 @@ etags @var{inputfiles}@dots{} @end example @noindent -The @code{etags} program reads the specified files, and writes a tags table -named @file{TAGS} in the current working directory. @code{etags} -recognizes the language used in an input file based on its file name and -contents. You can specify the language with the +The @code{etags} program reads the specified files, and writes a tags +table named @file{TAGS} in the current working directory. You can +intermix compressed and plain text source file names. @code{etags} +knows about the most common compression formats, and does the right +thing. So you can compress all your source files and have @code{etags} +look for compressed versions of its file name arguments, if it does not +find uncompressed versions. Under MS-DOS, @code{etags} also looks for +file names like @samp{mycode.cgz} if it is given @samp{mycode.c} on the +command line and @samp{mycode.c} does not exist. + + @code{etags} recognizes the language used in an input file based on +its file name and contents. You can specify the language with the @samp{--language=@var{name}} option, described below. If the tags table data become outdated due to changes in the files @@ -1202,7 +1225,7 @@ files. the tags file will contain absolute file names. This way, the tags file will still refer to the same files even if you move it, as long as the source files remain in the same place. Absolute file names start with -@samp{/}, or with @samp{@var{device}:/} on MS-DOS and Windows. +@samp{/}, or with @samp{@var{device}:/} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows. When you want to make a tags table from a great number of files, you may have problems listing them on the command line, because some systems @@ -1210,9 +1233,9 @@ have a limit on its length. The simplest way to circumvent this limit is to tell @code{etags} to read the file names from its standard input, by typing a dash in place of the file names, like this: -@example +@smallexample find . -name "*.[chCH]" -print | etags - -@end example +@end smallexample Use the option @samp{--language=@var{name}} to specify the language explicitly. You can intermix these options with file names; each one @@ -1220,18 +1243,25 @@ applies to the file names that follow it. Specify @samp{--language=auto} to tell @code{etags} to resume guessing the language from the file names and file contents. Specify @samp{--language=none} to turn off language-specific processing -entirely; then @code{etags} recognizes tags by regexp matching alone. -@samp{etags --help} prints the list of the languages @code{etags} knows, -and the file name rules for guessing the language. +entirely; then @code{etags} recognizes tags by regexp matching alone +(@pxref{Etags Regexps}). + + @samp{etags --help} prints the list of the languages @code{etags} +knows, and the file name rules for guessing the language. It also prints +a list of all the available @code{etags} options, together with a short +explanation. + +@node Etags Regexps, Select Tags Table, Create Tags Table, Tags +@subsection Etags Regexps The @samp{--regex} option provides a general way of recognizing tags based on regexp matching. You can freely intermix it with file names. Each @samp{--regex} option adds to the preceding ones, and applies only to the following files. The syntax is: -@example +@smallexample --regex=/@var{tagregexp}[/@var{nameregexp}]/ -@end example +@end smallexample @noindent where @var{tagregexp} is used to match the lines to tag. It is always @@ -1251,18 +1281,25 @@ expression at least @var{m} times and up to @var{n} times. You should not match more characters with @var{tagregexp} than that needed to recognize what you want to tag. If the match is such that -more characters than needed are unavoidably matched by @var{tagregexp}, -you may find useful to add a @var{nameregexp}, in order to narrow the tag -scope. You can find some examples below. +more characters than needed are unavoidably matched by @var{tagregexp} +(as will usually be the case), you should add a @var{nameregexp}, to +pick out just the tag. This will enable Emacs to find tags more +accurately and to do completion on tag names more reliably. You can +find some examples below. + + The option @samp{--ignore-case-regex} (or @samp{-c}) is like +@samp{--regex}, except that the regular expression provided will be +matched without regard to case, which is appropriate for various +programming languages. The @samp{-R} option deletes all the regexps defined with @samp{--regex} options. It applies to the file names following it, as you can see from the following example: -@example +@smallexample etags --regex=/@var{reg1}/ voo.doo --regex=/@var{reg2}/ \ bar.ber -R --lang=lisp los.er -@end example +@end smallexample @noindent Here @code{etags} chooses the parsing language for @file{voo.doo} and @@ -1272,38 +1309,90 @@ Here @code{etags} chooses the parsing language for @file{voo.doo} and @file{bar.ber}. @code{etags} uses the Lisp tags rules, and no regexp matching, to recognize tags in @file{los.er}. - Here are some more examples. The regexps are quoted to protect them -from shell interpretation. + A regular expression can be bound to a given language, by prepending +it with @samp{@{lang@}}. When you do this, @code{etags} will use the +regular expression only for files of that language. @samp{etags --help} +prints the list of languages recognised by @code{etags}. The following +example tags the @code{DEFVAR} macros in the Emacs source files. +@code{etags} applies this regular expression to C files only: + +@smallexample +--regex='@{c@}/[ \t]*DEFVAR_[A-Z_ \t(]+"\([^"]+\)"/' +@end smallexample @noindent -Tag the @code{DEFVAR} macros in the emacs source files: +This feature is particularly useful when storing a list of regular +expressions in a file. The following option syntax instructs +@code{etags} to read two files of regular expressions. The regular +expressions contained in the second file are matched without regard to +case. -@example ---regex='/[ \t]*DEFVAR_[A-Z_ \t(]+"\([^"]+\)"/' -@end example +@smallexample +--regex=@@first-file --ignore-case-regex=@@second-file +@end smallexample @noindent -Tag VHDL files (this example is a single long line, broken here for -formatting reasons): +A regex file contains one regular expressions per line. Empty lines, +and lines beginning with space or tab are ignored. When the first +character in a line is @samp{@@}, @code{etags} assumes that the rest of +the line is the name of a file of regular expressions. This means that +such files can be nested. All the other lines are taken to be regular +expressions. For example, one can create a file called +@samp{emacs.tags} with the following contents (the first line in the +file is a comment): -@example ---language=none ---regex='/[ \t]*\(ARCHITECTURE\|CONFIGURATION\) +[^ ]* +OF/' ---regex='/[ \t]*\(ATTRIBUTE\|ENTITY\|FUNCTION\|PACKAGE\ -\( BODY\)?\|PROCEDURE\|PROCESS\|TYPE\)[ \t]+\([^ \t(]+\)/\3/' -@end example +@smallexample + -- This is for GNU Emacs source files +@{c@}/[ \t]*DEFVAR_[A-Z_ \t(]+"\([^"]+\)"/\1/ +@end smallexample @noindent -Tag TCL files (this last example shows the usage of a @var{nameregexp}): +and then use it like this: -@example ---lang=none --regex='/proc[ \t]+\([^ \t]+\)/\1/' -@end example +@smallexample +etags --regex=@@emacs.tags *.[ch] */*.[ch] +@end smallexample + + Here are some more examples. The regexps are quoted to protect them +from shell interpretation. + +@itemize @bullet - For a list of the other available @code{etags} options, execute -@code{etags --help}. +@item +Tag Octave files: + +@smallexample +etags --language=none \ + --regex='/[ \t]*function.*=[ \t]*\([^ \t]*\)[ \t]*(/\1/' \ + --regex='/###key \(.*\)/\1/' \ + --regex='/[ \t]*global[ \t].*/' \ + *.m +@end smallexample + +@noindent +Note that tags are not generated for scripts so that you have to add a +line by yourself of the form `###key ' if you want to jump +to it. + +@item +Tag Tcl files: + +@smallexample +etags --language=none --regex='/proc[ \t]+\([^ \t]+\)/\1/' *.tcl +@end smallexample + +@item +Tag VHDL files: + +@smallexample +--language=none \ +--regex='/[ \t]*\(ARCHITECTURE\|CONFIGURATION\) +[^ ]* +OF/' \ +--regex='/[ \t]*\(ATTRIBUTE\|ENTITY\|FUNCTION\|PACKAGE\ +\( BODY\)?\|PROCEDURE\|PROCESS\|TYPE\)[ \t]+\([^ \t(]+\)/\3/' +@end smallexample +@end itemize -@node Select Tags Table, Find Tag, Create Tags Table, Tags +@node Select Tags Table, Find Tag, Etags Regexps, Tags @subsection Selecting a Tags Table @vindex tag-table-alist @@ -1555,7 +1644,7 @@ file in the tags table and prepare to advance sequentially by files. Visit the next file in the selected tags table. @end table -@node List Tags,, Tags Search, Tags +@node List Tags, , Tags Search, Tags @subsection Tags Table Inquiries @table @kbd @@ -1740,7 +1829,7 @@ indent some lines unaesthetically. However, a correct Fortran program will retain its meaning when reindented even if the conventions are not followed. -@node ForIndent Vars,, ForIndent Conv, Fortran Indent +@node ForIndent Vars, , ForIndent Conv, Fortran Indent @subsubsection Variables for Fortran Indentation @vindex fortran-do-indent @@ -1897,7 +1986,7 @@ command which splits the current window horizontally, resulting in a window 72 columns wide. When you edit in this window, you can immediately see when a line gets too wide to be correct Fortran. -@node Fortran Abbrev,, Fortran Columns, Fortran +@node Fortran Abbrev, , Fortran Columns, Fortran @subsection Fortran Keyword Abbrevs Fortran mode provides many built-in abbrevs for common keywords and @@ -1917,7 +2006,7 @@ automatically to @samp{continue}, provided Abbrev mode is enabled.@refill Type @samp{;?} or @samp{;C-h} to display a list of all built-in Fortran abbrevs and what they stand for. -@node Asm Mode,, Fortran, Programs +@node Asm Mode, , Fortran, Programs @section Asm Mode @cindex Asm mode diff --git a/man/xemacs/xemacs.texi b/man/xemacs/xemacs.texi index 2dbdb54..0ad18f7 100644 --- a/man/xemacs/xemacs.texi +++ b/man/xemacs/xemacs.texi @@ -1,5 +1,4 @@ - -\input ../texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- +\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- @setfilename ../../info/xemacs.info @comment node-name, next, previous, up diff --git a/nt/ChangeLog b/nt/ChangeLog index f1d7e42..cd415f7 100644 --- a/nt/ChangeLog +++ b/nt/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,11 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released diff --git a/src/ChangeLog b/src/ChangeLog index e508b43..9478322 100644 --- a/src/ChangeLog +++ b/src/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,264 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + +1999-11-26 Martin Buchholz + + * callproc.c (Fcall_process_internal): + * config.h.in: + * esd.c: + * event-msw.c (ntpipe_slurp_reader): + * event-msw.c (ntpipe_shove_writer): + * event-msw.c (winsock_reader): + * event-msw.c (winsock_writer): + * event-stream.c (dribble_out_event): + * fileio.c: + * fileio.c (Fexpand_file_name): + * glyphs-x.c (write_lisp_string_to_temp_file): + * gpmevent.c (tty_get_foreign_selection): + * lisp.h: Update prototypes. + * lstream.c (Lstream_flush_out): + * lstream.c (Lstream_write_1): + * lstream.c (Lstream_was_blocked_p): + * lstream.c (Lstream_read_more): + * lstream.c (Lstream_read): + * lstream.c (Lstream_fputc): + * lstream.c (make_stdio_output_stream): + * lstream.c (stdio_flusher): + * lstream.c (stdio_closer): + * lstream.c (make_filedesc_output_stream): + * lstream.c (errno_would_block_p): + * lstream.c (filedesc_writer): + * lstream.c (make_lisp_string_input_stream): + * lstream.c (make_fixed_buffer_output_stream): + * lstream.c (fixed_buffer_reader): + * lstream.c (make_resizing_buffer_output_stream): + * lstream.c (make_dynarr_output_stream): + * lstream.c (make_lisp_buffer_output_stream): + * lstream.c (lisp_buffer_reader): + * lstream.h (lstream_implementation): + * md5.c (Fmd5): + * miscplay.h (reset_parsestate): + * process-nt.c (nt_send_process): + * process-unix.c (unix_send_process): + * sound.c: + * sysdep.c (sys_close): + * sysdep.c (sys_read_1): + * sysdep.c (sys_write_1): + * sysfile.h: + * file-coding.c (determine_real_coding_system): + * file-coding.c (Fdetect_coding_region): + * file-coding.c (struct decoding_stream): + * file-coding.c (decoding_reader): + * file-coding.c (Fdecode_coding_region): + * file-coding.c (struct encoding_stream): + * file-coding.c (encoding_reader): + * file-coding.c (Fencode_coding_region): + * file-coding.c (convert_to_external_format): + * file-coding.c (convert_from_external_format): + - Lstream functions mirror Unix98 read(),write(). Therefore use + Unix98 types size_t and ssize_t. + - Try to make Lstream* functions 64-bit clean. Someday someone + may actually want to read from a Lstream with more than 2**32 bytes. + - Add configure support for ssize_t. + - Update all callers of Lstream_read and Lstream_write to + use the new types. + - Fix esd* initiated C++ compile errors. + - Remove comments referring to `fpurge' - we don't want to call it + even if it's there. + + * lisp.h + - Remove some lingering Lucid compiler support. + + * lisp.h + - Add prototype for Fdelete_process. + + * gpmevent.c (Freceive_gpm_event): Remove unused variables. + +1999-11-27 Martin Buchholz + + * Makefile.in.in (depend): Only update `depend' if there were changes. + +1999-11-26 Martin Buchholz + + * editfns.c (get_system_name): Remove. + +1999-11-26 Martin Buchholz + + * device-x.c (x_init_device): + - Replace magic number `17' with equivalent expn using sizeof. + - Replace strcmp with marginally more efficient memcmp. + - Avoid using C++ reserved word `class'. + + * file-coding.c (determine_real_coding_system): + - Look for both initial and final -*- cookies. + - Replace EQ (foo, Qnil) with NILP (foo) + - Make searching for cookies more efficient. + - Recognize only rfc 1521 characters in charset names. + +1999-11-22 Kazuyuki IENAGA + + * input-method-xlib.c (IMDestroyCallback): #ifdef'd by + "THIS_IS_X11R6", because it shouldn't be evaluated unless X11R6. + * input-method-xlib.c (IMInstantiateCallback): Ditto. + * input-method-xlib.c (XIM_init_device): Revive XOpenIM function + call for X11R5 systems. + * input-method-xlib.c (XIM_delete_frame): Enabled XDestroyIC() + again because XIM doesn't concern with frame deletion itself. + The XIC will be cleared by XIM when XIM is closing (at XIM destroy + callback). + +1999-10-25 Kazuyuki IENAGA + + * input-method-xlib.c: Added new lisp object Qxim_xlib. + New macro xim_warn(str), xim_warn1(fmt,str) and xim_info(str). + All the valid stderr_out were changed to those macros. + (IMDestroyCallback): Don't test the XIC if the frame is not X + frame. + (IMInstantiateCallback): Treat the client_data as "device" not + "frame" because the caller changed from frame to device. + Here initializes XIM and activates XICs for each frame which + doesn't have XIC. + (XIM_init_device): Register the XIM instantiation callback which + had been performed by XIM_init_frame() before. + (XIM_delete_frame): Added a test for the XIM before clearing XIC. + (XIM_init_frame): Placed an actual code for XIC activation which + was moved from IMInstantiateCallback. + (syms_of_input_method_xlib): New function which includes a symbol + Qxim_xlib that uses in emacs.c. + + * emacs.c: Added a function entry "syms_of_input_method_xlib" for + input_method_xlib. + + * symsinit.h: Added a declaration of "syms_of_input_method_xlib". + +1999-11-05 Robert Pluim + + * emacs.c (shut_down_emacs): Point users to PROBLEMS file + +1999-11-16 Jan Vroonhof + + * redisplay-output.c (compare_runes): Add comments about + results from profiling. + + * redisplay.h (struct rune): Do not use bitfields for members. + (struct rune): Add various comments about further optimizations. + +1999-11-19 Eric Darve + + * abbrev.c (abbrev_oblookup): Check whether wordend <= wordstart + if Vabbrev_start_location is used too. + +1999-10-27 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * file-coding.c (detect_eol_type): Return CR when two + sequential CR are found. + (determine_real_coding_system): Check EOL type when coding: + cookie is found and EOL type is not specified. + Don't assume 8bit char as part of coding: cookie. + +1999-10-26 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * file-coding.c (determine_real_coding_system): Check if + '-*-' exists. End searching for coding: cookie at the end + of line. Check whether character before coding: is space, + tab or ';'. + +1999-11-07 William M. Perry + + * gpmevent.c: Completely rewrote GPM mouse support for linux + console. The TTY console and event stream are modified at run + time, so this code can now be used as a module. + (tty_get_foreign_selection): New function to allow pasting from + other virtual consoles. + (Fgpm_enable): New lisp-visible function to turn GPM on or off + at run time. + + * device-tty.c (tty_asynch_device_change): No longer need to + notify GPM code of window/console height/width changes. + + * console-tty.c (tty_init_console): Removed outdated GPM support + that was part of the console/event code. + + * event-Xt.c (emacs_Xt_select_console): Ditto + + * event-Xt.c (emacs_Xt_unselect_console): Ditto + + * event-unixoid.c (read_event_from_tty_or_stream_desc): Ditto + + * frame-tty.c (console_type_create_frame_tty): Ditto + +1999-11-17 Martin Buchholz + + * nt.c: + * sysdep.c: + * s/mingw32.h: + * s/windowsnt.h: + - Use Unix 98 types uid_t, gid_t, pid_t. + - Define them. + +1999-11-01 Olivier Galibert + + * alloc.c (reinit_alloc_once_early): Move purify_flag init... + * emacs.c (main_1): ...here, to get the correct value even with + the portable dumper. + +1999-11-17 Martin Buchholz + + * lisp.h (BIT_VECTOR_LONG_STORAGE): Add extra parens. It's a macro! + + * tooltalk.c (tt_build_string): Remove extra parens. + * process.c (print_process): Remove extra parens. + * buffer.h (BI_BUF_PTR_BYTE_POS): + (BUF_PTR_BYTE_POS): + (BI_BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS): + (BI_BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS_BEFORE): + (valid_memind_p): + (bytind_to_memind): + (memind_to_bytind): + Remove extra parens. Inline functions are not macros. + + * editfns.c (Fuser_login_name): + (user_login_name): + Use proper type uid_t. + +1999-11-15 Martin Buchholz + + * syntax.c (complex_vars_of_syntax): Make more readable. + (define_standard_syntax): New function. + + * syntax.c (forward-comment): Gradually make XEmacs 64-bit-clean. + +1999-11-14 Martin Buchholz + + * mule-ccl.c (CCL_WRITE_STRING): Fix compiler warnings. + +1999-11-12 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * mule-charset.h (LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_1, LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_2): + New enum type to make sure no gap in the leading byte definition. + +1999-11-11 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * mule-charset.h (LEADING_BYTE_CYRILLIC_ISO_8859_5, + LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_9): Moved to 0x8B and 0x8C + to remove a hole in leading byte definition. + +1999-11-10 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * mule-charset.c (non_ascii_valid_charptr_p): Check if + private charset is defined. + +1999-11-09 Yoshiki Hayashi + + * mule-ccl.c (ccl_driver): Make sure generated sequences + are valid when doing `CCL_WRITE_STRING'. + (ccl-execute-on-string): Pass CCL_MODE_DECODING to ccl_driver. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released diff --git a/src/Makefile.in.in b/src/Makefile.in.in index 8a02b11..cef8f86 100644 --- a/src/Makefile.in.in +++ b/src/Makefile.in.in @@ -739,5 +739,8 @@ install: ${PROGNAME} FRC.depend: depend: FRC.depend cd ${srcdir} && $(RM) depend.tmp && \ - perl make-src-depend > depend.tmp && \ - $(RM) depend && mv depend.tmp depend + perl ./make-src-depend > depend.tmp && \ + if cmp -s depend depend.tmp; \ + then $(RM) depend.tmp; \ + else $(RM) depend && mv depend.tmp depend; \ + fi diff --git a/src/abbrev.c b/src/abbrev.c index 2add8a9..80f08ad 100644 --- a/src/abbrev.c +++ b/src/abbrev.c @@ -222,10 +222,11 @@ abbrev_oblookup (struct buffer *buf, Lisp_Object obarray) because of consistency with abbrev_match. */ if (wordend < point) return 0; - if (wordend <= wordstart) - return 0; } + if (wordend <= wordstart) + return 0; + p = word = (Bufbyte *) alloca (MAX_EMCHAR_LEN * (wordend - wordstart)); for (idx = wordstart; idx < wordend; idx++) { diff --git a/src/alloc.c b/src/alloc.c index 8bd4b99..dd9e43b 100644 --- a/src/alloc.c +++ b/src/alloc.c @@ -3922,9 +3922,6 @@ void reinit_alloc_once_early (void) { gc_generation_number[0] = 0; - /* purify_flag 1 is correct even if CANNOT_DUMP. - * loadup.el will set to nil at end. */ - purify_flag = 1; breathing_space = 0; XSETINT (all_bit_vectors, 0); /* Qzero may not be set yet. */ XSETINT (Vgc_message, 0); diff --git a/src/buffer.h b/src/buffer.h index 2c5498d..6e3d980 100644 --- a/src/buffer.h +++ b/src/buffer.h @@ -626,9 +626,9 @@ INLINE Bytind BI_BUF_PTR_BYTE_POS (struct buffer *buf, Bufbyte *ptr); INLINE Bytind BI_BUF_PTR_BYTE_POS (struct buffer *buf, Bufbyte *ptr) { - return ((ptr) - (buf)->text->beg + 1 - - ((ptr - (buf)->text->beg + 1) > (buf)->text->gpt - ? (buf)->text->gap_size : 0)); + return (ptr - buf->text->beg + 1 + - ((ptr - buf->text->beg + 1) > buf->text->gpt + ? buf->text->gap_size : 0)); } #define BUF_PTR_BYTE_POS(buf, ptr) \ @@ -639,8 +639,8 @@ INLINE Bufbyte * BI_BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (struct buffer *buf, Bytind pos); INLINE Bufbyte * BI_BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (struct buffer *buf, Bytind pos) { - return ((buf)->text->beg + - ((pos >= (buf)->text->gpt ? (pos + (buf)->text->gap_size) : pos) + return (buf->text->beg + + ((pos >= buf->text->gpt ? (pos + buf->text->gap_size) : pos) - 1)); } @@ -652,8 +652,8 @@ INLINE Bufbyte * BI_BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS_BEFORE (struct buffer *buf, Bytind pos); INLINE Bufbyte * BI_BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS_BEFORE (struct buffer *buf, Bytind pos) { - return ((buf)->text->beg + - ((pos > (buf)->text->gpt ? (pos + (buf)->text->gap_size) : pos) + return (buf->text->beg + + ((pos > buf->text->gpt ? (pos + buf->text->gap_size) : pos) - 2)); } @@ -668,16 +668,16 @@ INLINE int valid_memind_p (struct buffer *buf, Memind x); INLINE int valid_memind_p (struct buffer *buf, Memind x) { - return ((x >= 1 && x <= (Memind) (buf)->text->gpt) || - (x > (Memind) ((buf)->text->gpt + (buf)->text->gap_size) && - x <= (Memind) ((buf)->text->z + (buf)->text->gap_size))); + return ((x >= 1 && x <= (Memind) buf->text->gpt) || + (x > (Memind) (buf->text->gpt + buf->text->gap_size) && + x <= (Memind) (buf->text->z + buf->text->gap_size))); } INLINE Memind bytind_to_memind (struct buffer *buf, Bytind x); INLINE Memind bytind_to_memind (struct buffer *buf, Bytind x) { - return (Memind) ((x > (buf)->text->gpt) ? (x + (buf)->text->gap_size) : x); + return (Memind) ((x > buf->text->gpt) ? (x + buf->text->gap_size) : x); } @@ -688,8 +688,8 @@ memind_to_bytind (struct buffer *buf, Memind x) #ifdef ERROR_CHECK_BUFPOS assert (valid_memind_p (buf, x)); #endif - return (Bytind) ((x > (Memind) (buf)->text->gpt) ? - x - (buf)->text->gap_size : + return (Bytind) ((x > (Memind) buf->text->gpt) ? + x - buf->text->gap_size : x); } diff --git a/src/bytecode.c b/src/bytecode.c index 8a685ab..e39fe3f 100644 --- a/src/bytecode.c +++ b/src/bytecode.c @@ -28,7 +28,7 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ FSF: long ago. -hacked on by jwz@netscape.com 1991-06 +hacked on by jwz@jwz.org 1991-06 o added a compile-time switch to turn on simple sanity checking; o put back the obsolete byte-codes for error-detection; o added a new instruction, unbind_all, which I will use for diff --git a/src/callproc.c b/src/callproc.c index 4b5a5dc..080a1d7 100644 --- a/src/callproc.c +++ b/src/callproc.c @@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ If you quit, the process is killed with SIGINT, or SIGKILL if you nread = 0; while (nread < bufsize - 1024) { - int this_read + ssize_t this_read = Lstream_read (XLSTREAM (instream), bufptr + nread, bufsize - nread); diff --git a/src/config.h.in b/src/config.h.in index 45bd85f..3aa4aba 100644 --- a/src/config.h.in +++ b/src/config.h.in @@ -551,6 +551,7 @@ extern "C" { #endif /* Allow the source to use standard types */ +#undef ssize_t #undef size_t #undef pid_t #undef mode_t @@ -579,6 +580,9 @@ extern "C" { #undef HAVE_NAS_SOUND #undef NAS_NO_ERROR_JUMP +/* Compile in support for ESD (Enlightened Sound Daemon)? */ +#undef HAVE_ESD_SOUND + /* Compile in support for SunPro usage-tracking code? */ #undef USAGE_TRACKING diff --git a/src/console-tty.c b/src/console-tty.c index 05089bc..c836d8c 100644 --- a/src/console-tty.c +++ b/src/console-tty.c @@ -38,9 +38,6 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ #ifdef FILE_CODING #include "file-coding.h" #endif -#ifdef HAVE_GPM -#include "gpmevent.h" -#endif DEFINE_CONSOLE_TYPE (tty); DECLARE_IMAGE_INSTANTIATOR_FORMAT (nothing); @@ -130,10 +127,6 @@ tty_init_console (struct console *con, Lisp_Object props) tty_con->terminal_type = terminal_type; tty_con->controlling_process = controlling_process; -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - connect_to_gpm (con); -#endif - if (NILP (CONSOLE_NAME (con))) CONSOLE_NAME (con) = Ffile_name_nondirectory (tty); { diff --git a/src/console-tty.h b/src/console-tty.h index bc5aacd..a7bbd2b 100644 --- a/src/console-tty.h +++ b/src/console-tty.h @@ -41,9 +41,6 @@ DECLARE_CONSOLE_TYPE (tty); struct tty_console { int infd, outfd; -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - int mouse_fd; -#endif Lisp_Object instream, outstream; Lisp_Object terminal_type; Lisp_Object controlling_process; @@ -203,9 +200,6 @@ struct tty_console unsigned int is_stdio :1; }; -#ifdef HAVE_GPM -#define CONSOLE_TTY_MOUSE_FD(c) (CONSOLE_TTY_DATA (c)->mouse_fd) -#endif #define CONSOLE_TTY_DATA(c) CONSOLE_TYPE_DATA (c, tty) #define CONSOLE_TTY_CURSOR_X(c) (CONSOLE_TTY_DATA (c)->cursor_x) #define CONSOLE_TTY_CURSOR_Y(c) (CONSOLE_TTY_DATA (c)->cursor_y) diff --git a/src/depend b/src/depend index c4b0017..c62ee1b 100644 --- a/src/depend +++ b/src/depend @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ EmacsManager.o: EmacsManager.h EmacsManagerP.h config.h xintrinsicp.h xmmanagerp EmacsShell-sub.o: EmacsShell.h EmacsShellP.h config.h xintrinsic.h xintrinsicp.h EmacsShell.o: EmacsShell.h ExternalShell.h config.h xintrinsicp.h abbrev.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h chartab.h commands.h insdel.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h symeval.h symsinit.h syntax.h window.h winslots.h -alloc.o: $(LISP_H) backtrace.h buffer.h bufslots.h bytecode.h chartab.h conslots.h console.h device.h elhash.h events.h extents.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h opaque.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h +alloc.o: $(LISP_H) backtrace.h buffer.h bufslots.h bytecode.h chartab.h conslots.h console-stream.h console.h device.h elhash.h events.h extents.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h opaque.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h alloca.o: config.h balloon_help.o: balloon_help.h config.h xintrinsic.h blocktype.o: $(LISP_H) blocktype.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h @@ -77,7 +77,7 @@ cm.o: $(LISP_H) conslots.h console-tty.h console.h device.h frame.h frameslots.h cmdloop.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h commands.h conslots.h console.h device.h events.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h cmds.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h chartab.h commands.h insdel.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h symeval.h symsinit.h syntax.h console-stream.o: $(LISP_H) conslots.h console-stream.h console-tty.h console.h device.h events.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h -console-tty.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console-stream.h console-tty.h console.h device.h faces.h file-coding.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gpmevent.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h syssignal.h systty.h toolbar.h +console-tty.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console-stream.h console-tty.h console.h device.h faces.h file-coding.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h syssignal.h systty.h toolbar.h console.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console-tty.h console.h device.h events.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h data.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h bytecode.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfloat.h syssignal.h debug.o: $(LISP_H) bytecode.h debug.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h @@ -91,16 +91,17 @@ doprnt.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h l dragdrop.o: $(LISP_H) dragdrop.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h dynarr.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h ecrt0.o: config.h -editfns.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h chartab.h commands.h conslots.h console.h device.h events.h extents.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h line-number.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h syspwd.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h +editfns.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h chartab.h commands.h conslots.h console.h device.h events.h extents.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h line-number.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h syspwd.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h eldap.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h eldap.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h opaque.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h elhash.o: $(LISP_H) bytecode.h elhash.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h emacs.o: $(LISP_H) backtrace.h buffer.h bufslots.h commands.h conslots.h console.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h paths.h process.h redisplay.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysdll.h sysfile.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h emodules.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console.h device.h emodules.h file-coding.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysdll.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h +esd.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h miscplay.h symeval.h symsinit.h eval.o: $(LISP_H) backtrace.h buffer.h bufslots.h bytecode.h commands.h conslots.h console.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h opaque.h symeval.h symsinit.h event-Xt.o: $(LISP_H) $(LWLIB_SRCDIR)/lwlib.h EmacsFrame.h blocktype.h buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console-tty.h console-x.h console.h device.h dragdrop.h elhash.h events-mod.h events.h file-coding.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h objects-x.h objects.h offix-types.h offix.h process.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysproc.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h toolbar.h xintrinsic.h xintrinsicp.h -event-stream.o: $(LISP_H) $(LWLIB_SRCDIR)/lwlib.h blocktype.h buffer.h bufslots.h commands.h conslots.h console-x.h console.h device.h elhash.h events-mod.h events.h file-coding.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui-x.h gui.h insdel.h keymap.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h macros.h mule-charset.h opaque.h process.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h syssignal.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h xintrinsic.h +event-stream.o: $(LISP_H) $(LWLIB_SRCDIR)/lwlib.h blocktype.h buffer.h bufslots.h commands.h conslots.h console-x.h console.h device.h elhash.h events-mod.h events.h file-coding.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui-x.h gui.h insdel.h keymap.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h macros.h mule-charset.h process.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h syssignal.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h xintrinsic.h event-tty.o: $(LISP_H) conslots.h console-tty.h console.h device.h events.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h process.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysproc.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h syswait.h toolbar.h -event-unixoid.o: $(LISP_H) conslots.h console-stream.h console-tty.h console.h device.h events.h gpmevent.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h process.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h sysproc.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h +event-unixoid.o: $(LISP_H) conslots.h console-stream.h console-tty.h console.h device.h events.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h process.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysfile.h sysproc.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h events.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console-tty.h console-x.h console.h device.h events-mod.h events.h extents.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h keymap.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h xintrinsic.h extents.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console.h debug.h device.h elhash.h extents.h faces.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h keymap.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h opaque.h process.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h toolbar.h faces.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console.h device.h elhash.h extents.h faces.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h objects.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h @@ -116,12 +117,12 @@ frame.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console.h device.h events.h ex free-hook.o: $(LISP_H) hash.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h general.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h getloadavg.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h -gif_io.o: gifrlib.h +gif_io.o: gifrlib.h sysfile.h glyphs-eimage.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console.h device.h faces.h file-coding.h frame.h frameslots.h gifrlib.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h objects.h opaque.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h toolbar.h glyphs-widget.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h bytecode.h conslots.h console.h device.h faces.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h objects.h opaque.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h glyphs.o: $(LISP_H) blocktype.h buffer.h bufslots.h chartab.h conslots.h console.h device.h elhash.h faces.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h objects.h opaque.h rangetab.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h gmalloc.o: config.h getpagesize.h -gpmevent.o: $(LISP_H) conslots.h console-tty.h console.h device.h events-mod.h events.h gpmevent.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h +gpmevent.o: $(LISP_H) commands.h conslots.h console-tty.h console.h device.h events-mod.h events.h gpmevent.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h process.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h sysproc.h syssignal.h systime.h systty.h gui.o: $(LISP_H) bytecode.h elhash.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h gutter.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console.h device.h faces.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h gutter.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h hash.o: $(LISP_H) hash.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h @@ -136,7 +137,7 @@ intl.o: $(LISP_H) bytecode.h conslots.h console.h device.h lisp-disunion.h lisp- keymap.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h bytecode.h conslots.h console.h device.h elhash.h events-mod.h events.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h keymap.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h libsst.o: $(LISP_H) libsst.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h line-number.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h line-number.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h symeval.h symsinit.h -linuxplay.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h syssignal.h +linuxplay.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h miscplay.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h syssignal.h lread.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h bytecode.h elhash.h file-coding.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h opaque.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h sysfloat.h lstream.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h insdel.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h macros.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h commands.h conslots.h console.h device.h events.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h keymap.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h macros.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h @@ -145,6 +146,7 @@ marker.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h m md5.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h file-coding.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h lstream.h mule-charset.h symeval.h symsinit.h menubar.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h conslots.h console.h device.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h menubar.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h minibuf.o: $(LISP_H) buffer.h bufslots.h commands.h conslots.h console-stream.h console.h device.h events.h frame.h frameslots.h glyphs.h gui.h insdel.h lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h mule-charset.h redisplay.h scrollbar.h specifier.h symeval.h symsinit.h systime.h toolbar.h window.h winslots.h +miscplay.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h miscplay.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h syssignal.h nas.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysdep.h syssignal.h nt.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h nt.h ntheap.h symeval.h symsinit.h sysfile.h sysproc.h syssignal.h systime.h ntheap.o: $(LISP_H) lisp-disunion.h lisp-union.h lrecord.h ntheap.h symeval.h symsinit.h diff --git a/src/device-tty.c b/src/device-tty.c index 754905d..4a8c0ca 100644 --- a/src/device-tty.c +++ b/src/device-tty.c @@ -38,10 +38,6 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ #include "syssignal.h" /* for SIGWINCH */ -#ifdef HAVE_GPM -#include -#endif - #include Lisp_Object Qinit_pre_tty_win, Qinit_post_tty_win; @@ -155,15 +151,6 @@ tty_asynch_device_change (void) CONSOLE_TTY_DATA (con)->width = width; CONSOLE_TTY_DATA (con)->height = height; -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - /* We need to tell GPM how big our screen is now - ** I am pretty sure the GPM library will get incredibly confused - ** if you try to connect to more than one mouse-capable device, - ** so I don't think it will cause any more damage in that case. - */ - gpm_mx = width; - gpm_my = height; -#endif for (tail = DEVICE_FRAME_LIST (d); !NILP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) diff --git a/src/device-x.c b/src/device-x.c index 80b0f45..0c1a3e5 100644 --- a/src/device-x.c +++ b/src/device-x.c @@ -387,8 +387,8 @@ x_try_best_visual_class (Screen *screen, int scrnum, int visual_class) vi_out [i].depth == 1 || vi_out [i].depth == 8) #endif - - /* SGI has 30-bit deep visuals. Ignore them. + + /* SGI has 30-bit deep visuals. Ignore them. (We only have 24-bit data anyway.) */ && (vi_out [i].depth <= 24) @@ -566,8 +566,10 @@ x_init_device (struct device *d, Lisp_Object props) XtGetApplicationNameAndClass (dpy, (char **) &app_name, (char **) &app_class); /* search for a matching visual if requested by the user, or setup the display default */ { - char *buf1 = (char *)alloca (strlen (app_name) + 17); - char *buf2 = (char *)alloca (strlen (app_class) + 17); + int resource_name_length = max (sizeof (".emacsVisual"), + sizeof (".privateColormap")); + char *buf1 = alloca_array (char, strlen (app_name) + resource_name_length); + char *buf2 = alloca_array (char, strlen (app_class) + resource_name_length); char *type; XrmValue value; @@ -575,13 +577,14 @@ x_init_device (struct device *d, Lisp_Object props) sprintf (buf2, "%s.EmacsVisual", app_class); if (XrmGetResource (XtDatabase (dpy), buf1, buf2, &type, &value) == True) { - int cnt = 0, vis_class = PseudoColor; + int cnt = 0; + int vis_class = PseudoColor; XVisualInfo vinfo; - char *res, *str = (char*)value.addr; + char *str = (char*) value.addr; -#define CHECK_VIS_CLASS(class) \ - else if (strncmp (str, #class, sizeof (#class) - 1) == 0) \ - cnt = sizeof (#class) - 1, vis_class = class +#define CHECK_VIS_CLASS(visual_class) \ + else if (memcmp (str, #visual_class, sizeof (#visual_class) - 1) == 0) \ + cnt = sizeof (#visual_class) - 1, vis_class = visual_class if (1) ; @@ -594,8 +597,7 @@ x_init_device (struct device *d, Lisp_Object props) if (cnt) { - res = str + cnt; - depth = atoi (res); + depth = atoi (str + cnt); if (depth == 0) { stderr_out ("Invalid Depth specification in %s... ignoring...\n", str); @@ -1750,7 +1752,7 @@ Grab the keyboard on the given device (defaulting to the selected one). So long as the keyboard is grabbed, all keyboard events will be delivered to emacs -- it is not possible for other X clients to eavesdrop on them. Ungrab the keyboard with `x-ungrab-keyboard' (use an unwind-protect). -Returns t if the grab was successful; nil otherwise. +Returns t if the grab is successful, nil otherwise. */ (device)) { @@ -1809,7 +1811,7 @@ See also `x-set-font-path'. signal_simple_error ("Can't get X font path", device); while (ndirs_return--) - font_path = Fcons (build_ext_string (directories[ndirs_return], + font_path = Fcons (build_ext_string (directories[ndirs_return], FORMAT_FILENAME), font_path); return font_path; @@ -1900,7 +1902,7 @@ reinit_console_type_create_device_x (void) "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789-_"; while (*valid_resource_chars) valid_resource_char_p[(unsigned int) (*valid_resource_chars++)] = 1; - + name_char_dynarr = Dynarr_new (char); class_char_dynarr = Dynarr_new (char); } diff --git a/src/editfns.c b/src/editfns.c index e3dd769..30b173d 100644 --- a/src/editfns.c +++ b/src/editfns.c @@ -66,8 +66,6 @@ Lisp_Object Vuser_login_name; /* user name from LOGNAME or USER. */ Lisp_Object Vuser_full_name; EXFUN (Fuser_full_name, 1); -char *get_system_name (void); - Lisp_Object Qformat; Lisp_Object Qpoint, Qmark, Qregion_beginning, Qregion_end; @@ -639,17 +637,17 @@ ignored and this function returns the login name for that UID, or nil. (uid)) { char *returned_name; - int local_uid; + uid_t local_uid; if (!NILP (uid)) { CHECK_INT (uid); - local_uid = XINT(uid); - returned_name = user_login_name(&local_uid); + local_uid = XINT (uid); + returned_name = user_login_name (&local_uid); } else { - returned_name = user_login_name(NULL); + returned_name = user_login_name (NULL); } /* #### - I believe this should return nil instead of "unknown" when pw==0 pw=0 is indicated by a null return from user_login_name @@ -665,14 +663,12 @@ ignored and this function returns the login name for that UID, or nil. corresponds to a nil argument to Fuser_login_name. */ char* -user_login_name (int *uid) +user_login_name (uid_t *uid) { - struct passwd *pw = NULL; - /* uid == NULL to return name of this user */ if (uid != NULL) { - pw = getpwuid (*uid); + struct passwd *pw = getpwuid (*uid); return pw ? pw->pw_name : NULL; } else @@ -693,7 +689,7 @@ user_login_name (int *uid) return (user_name); else { - pw = getpwuid (geteuid ()); + struct passwd *pw = getpwuid (geteuid ()); #ifdef __CYGWIN32__ /* Since the Cygwin environment may not have an /etc/passwd, return "unknown" instead of the null if the username @@ -913,14 +909,6 @@ Return the name of the machine you are running on, as a string. return Fcopy_sequence (Vsystem_name); } -/* For the benefit of callers who don't want to include lisp.h. - Caller must free! */ -char * -get_system_name (void) -{ - return xstrdup ((char *) XSTRING_DATA (Vsystem_name)); -} - DEFUN ("emacs-pid", Femacs_pid, 0, 0, 0, /* Return the process ID of Emacs, as an integer. */ diff --git a/src/emacs.c b/src/emacs.c index 08bfa7e..bf999a0 100644 --- a/src/emacs.c +++ b/src/emacs.c @@ -856,8 +856,20 @@ main_1 (int argc, char **argv, char **envp, int restart) We try to do things in an order that minimizes the non-obvious dependencies between functions. */ + /* purify_flag 1 is correct even if CANNOT_DUMP. + * loadup.el will set to nil at end. */ + + purify_flag = 0; #ifdef PDUMP - initialized = restart || pdump_load (); + if (restart) + initialized = 1; + else { + initialized = pdump_load (); + purify_flag = !initialized; + } +#else + if (!initialized) + purify_flag = 1; #endif if (!initialized) @@ -1018,6 +1030,11 @@ main_1 (int argc, char **argv, char **envp, int restart) #if defined (HAVE_MENUBARS) || defined (HAVE_SCROLLBARS) || defined (HAVE_DIALOGS) || defined (HAVE_TOOLBARS) syms_of_gui_x (); #endif +#ifdef HAVE_XIM +#ifdef XIM_XLIB + syms_of_input_method_xlib (); +#endif +#endif /* HAVE_XIM */ #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ #ifdef HAVE_MS_WINDOWS @@ -1088,6 +1105,10 @@ main_1 (int argc, char **argv, char **envp, int restart) syms_of_eldap (); #endif +#ifdef HAVE_GPM + syms_of_gpmevent (); +#endif + /* Now create the subtypes for the types that have them. We do this before the vars_*() because more symbols may get initialized here. */ @@ -1483,6 +1504,10 @@ main_1 (int argc, char **argv, char **envp, int restart) vars_of_eldap (); #endif +#ifdef HAVE_GPM + vars_of_gpmevent (); +#endif + /* Now initialize any specifier variables. We do this later because it has some dependence on the vars initialized above. @@ -2436,12 +2461,16 @@ shut_down_emacs (int sig, Lisp_Object stuff) ("Your files have been auto-saved.\n" "Use `M-x recover-session' to recover them.\n" "\n" + "If you have access to the PROBLEMS file that came with your\n" + "version of XEmacs, please check to see if your crash is described\n" + "there, as there may be a workaround available.\n" #ifdef INFODOCK - "Please report this bug by selecting `Report-Bug' in the InfoDock\n" - "menu.\n" + "Otherwise, please report this bug by selecting `Report-Bug'\n" + "in the InfoDock menu.\n" #else - "Please report this bug by running the send-pr script included\n" - "with XEmacs, or selecting `Send Bug Report' from the help menu.\n" + "Otherwise, please report this bug by running the send-pr\n" + "script included with XEmacs, or selecting `Send Bug Report'\n" + "from the help menu.\n" "As a last resort send ordinary email to `crashes@xemacs.org'.\n" #endif "*MAKE SURE* to include the information in the command\n" diff --git a/src/event-Xt.c b/src/event-Xt.c index 3417197..4bea4e7 100644 --- a/src/event-Xt.c +++ b/src/event-Xt.c @@ -2034,9 +2034,6 @@ emacs_Xt_select_console (struct console *con) { Lisp_Object console; int infd; -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - int mousefd; -#endif if (CONSOLE_X_P (con)) return; /* X consoles are automatically selected for when we @@ -2044,22 +2041,6 @@ emacs_Xt_select_console (struct console *con) infd = event_stream_unixoid_select_console (con); XSETCONSOLE (console, con); select_filedesc (infd, console); -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - /* On a stream device (ie: noninteractive), bad things can happen. */ - if (EQ (CONSOLE_TYPE (con), Qtty)) { - mousefd = CONSOLE_TTY_MOUSE_FD (con); - /* We check filedesc_to_what_closure[fd] here because if you run - ** XEmacs from a TTY, it will fire up GPM, select the mouse fd, then - ** if you run gnuattach to connect to another TTY, it will fire up - ** GPM again, and try to reselect the mouse fd. GPM uses the same - ** fd for every connection apparently, and select_filedesc will - ** fail its assertion if we try to select it twice. - */ - if ((mousefd >= 0) && !filedesc_to_what_closure[mousefd]) { - select_filedesc (mousefd, console); - } - } -#endif } static void @@ -2067,9 +2048,6 @@ emacs_Xt_unselect_console (struct console *con) { Lisp_Object console; int infd; -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - int mousefd; -#endif if (CONSOLE_X_P (con)) return; /* X consoles are automatically selected for when we @@ -2077,15 +2055,6 @@ emacs_Xt_unselect_console (struct console *con) infd = event_stream_unixoid_unselect_console (con); XSETCONSOLE (console, con); unselect_filedesc (infd); -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - /* On a stream device (ie: noninteractive), bad things can happen. */ - if (EQ (CONSOLE_TYPE (con), Qtty)) { - mousefd = CONSOLE_TTY_MOUSE_FD (con); - if (mousefd >= 0) { - unselect_filedesc (mousefd); - } - } -#endif } /* read an event from a tty, if one is available. Returns non-zero diff --git a/src/event-msw.c b/src/event-msw.c index 0dee130..f3e7727 100644 --- a/src/event-msw.c +++ b/src/event-msw.c @@ -89,7 +89,7 @@ typedef NMHDR *LPNMHDR; /* Timer ID used for button2 emulation */ #define BUTTON_2_TIMER_ID 1 -extern Lisp_Object +extern Lisp_Object mswindows_get_toolbar_button_text (struct frame* f, int command_id); extern Lisp_Object mswindows_handle_toolbar_wm_command (struct frame* f, HWND ctrl, WORD id); @@ -199,7 +199,7 @@ struct ntpipe_slurp_stream_shared_data }; #define MAX_SLURP_STREAMS 32 -struct ntpipe_slurp_stream_shared_data +struct ntpipe_slurp_stream_shared_data shared_data_block[MAX_SLURP_STREAMS]={{0}}; struct ntpipe_slurp_stream @@ -271,7 +271,7 @@ slurp_thread (LPVOID vparam) /* Now we got something to notify caller, either a byte or an error/eof indication. Before we do, allow internal pipe - buffer to accumulate little bit more data. + buffer to accumulate little bit more data. Reader function pulses this event before waiting for a character, to avoid pipe delay, and to get the byte immediately. */ @@ -360,11 +360,11 @@ get_ntpipe_input_stream_waitable (Lstream *stream) return s->thread_data->hev_caller; } -static int +static ssize_t ntpipe_slurp_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { /* This function must be called from the main thread only */ - struct ntpipe_slurp_stream_shared_data* s = + struct ntpipe_slurp_stream_shared_data* s = NTPIPE_SLURP_STREAM_DATA(stream)->thread_data; if (!s->die_p) @@ -373,7 +373,7 @@ ntpipe_slurp_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) /* Disallow pipe read delay for the thread: we need a character ASAP */ SetEvent (s->hev_unsleep); - + /* Check if we have a character ready. Give it a short delay, for the thread to awake from pipe delay, just ion case*/ wait_result = WaitForSingleObject (s->hev_caller, 2); @@ -424,7 +424,7 @@ ntpipe_slurp_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) ReadFile (s->hpipe, data, min (bytes_available, size), &bytes_read, NULL); } - + /* Now we can unblock thread, so it attempts to read more */ SetEvent (s->hev_thread); return bytes_read + 1; @@ -433,11 +433,11 @@ ntpipe_slurp_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) return 0; } -static int +static int ntpipe_slurp_closer (Lstream *stream) { /* This function must be called from the main thread only */ - struct ntpipe_slurp_stream_shared_data* s = + struct ntpipe_slurp_stream_shared_data* s = NTPIPE_SLURP_STREAM_DATA(stream)->thread_data; /* Force thread to stop */ @@ -469,7 +469,7 @@ init_slurp_stream (void) LSTREAM_TYPE_DATA (stream, ntpipe_shove) #define MAX_SHOVE_BUFFER_SIZE 128 - + struct ntpipe_shove_stream { LPARAM user_data; /* Any user data stored in the stream object */ @@ -496,7 +496,7 @@ shove_thread (LPVOID vparam) for (;;) { - DWORD bytes_written; + DWORD bytes_written; /* Block on event and wait for a job */ InterlockedIncrement (&s->idle_p); @@ -533,7 +533,7 @@ make_ntpipe_output_stream (HANDLE hpipe, LPARAM param) s->hpipe = hpipe; s->user_data = param; - /* Create reader thread. This could fail, so do not + /* Create reader thread. This could fail, so do not create the event until thread is created */ s->hthread = CreateThread (NULL, 0, shove_thread, (LPVOID)s, CREATE_SUSPENDED, &thread_id_unused); @@ -562,7 +562,7 @@ get_ntpipe_output_stream_param (Lstream *stream) } #endif -static int +static ssize_t ntpipe_shove_writer (Lstream *stream, const unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct ntpipe_shove_stream* s = NTPIPE_SHOVE_STREAM_DATA(stream); @@ -671,7 +671,7 @@ winsock_initiate_read (struct winsock_stream *str) str->eof_p = 1; } -static int +static ssize_t winsock_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct winsock_stream *str = WINSOCK_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -704,7 +704,7 @@ winsock_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) return 0; if (str->error_p) return -1; - + /* Return as much of buffer as we have */ size = min (size, (size_t) (str->bufsize - str->bufpos)); memcpy (data, (void*)((BYTE*)str->buffer + str->bufpos), size); @@ -717,7 +717,7 @@ winsock_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) return size; } -static int +static ssize_t winsock_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct winsock_stream *str = WINSOCK_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -745,7 +745,7 @@ winsock_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) if (size == 0) return 0; - + { ResetEvent (str->ov.hEvent); @@ -867,7 +867,7 @@ mswindows_user_event_p (struct Lisp_Event* sevt) || sevt->event_type == misc_user_event); } -/* +/* * Add an emacs event to the proper dispatch queue */ static void @@ -875,7 +875,7 @@ mswindows_enqueue_dispatch_event (Lisp_Object event) { int user_p = mswindows_user_event_p (XEVENT(event)); enqueue_event (event, - user_p ? &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue : + user_p ? &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue : &mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue, user_p ? &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue_tail : &mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue_tail); @@ -953,7 +953,7 @@ mswindows_enqueue_mouse_button_event (HWND hwnd, UINT message, POINTS where, DWO event->event.button.x = where.x; event->event.button.y = where.y; event->event.button.modifiers = mswindows_modifier_state (NULL, 0); - + if (message==WM_LBUTTONDOWN || message==WM_MBUTTONDOWN || message==WM_RBUTTONDOWN) { @@ -972,7 +972,7 @@ mswindows_enqueue_mouse_button_event (HWND hwnd, UINT message, POINTS where, DWO event->event_type = button_release_event; ReleaseCapture (); } - + mswindows_enqueue_dispatch_event (emacs_event); } @@ -1004,10 +1004,10 @@ mswindows_dequeue_dispatch_event () !NILP(mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue)); event = dequeue_event ( - NILP(mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue) ? - &mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue : + NILP(mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue) ? + &mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue : &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue, - NILP(mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue) ? + NILP(mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue) ? &mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue_tail : &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue_tail); @@ -1037,9 +1037,9 @@ mswindows_cancel_dispatch_event (struct Lisp_Event *match) Lisp_Object event; Lisp_Object previous_event = Qnil; int user_p = mswindows_user_event_p (match); - Lisp_Object* head = user_p ? &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue : + Lisp_Object* head = user_p ? &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue : &mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue; - Lisp_Object* tail = user_p ? &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue_tail : + Lisp_Object* tail = user_p ? &mswindows_u_dispatch_event_queue_tail : &mswindows_s_dispatch_event_queue_tail; assert (match->event_type == timeout_event @@ -1062,7 +1062,7 @@ mswindows_cancel_dispatch_event (struct Lisp_Event *match) if (EQ (*tail, event)) *tail = previous_event; } - + return event; } previous_event = event; @@ -1103,7 +1103,7 @@ remove_waitable_handle (HANDLE h) if (ix < 0) return; - mswindows_waitable_handles [ix] = + mswindows_waitable_handles [ix] = mswindows_waitable_handles [--mswindows_waitable_count]; } #endif /* HAVE_MSG_SELECT */ @@ -1127,7 +1127,7 @@ mswindows_protect_modal_loop (Lisp_Object (*bfun) (Lisp_Object barg), { Lisp_Object tmp; - ++mswindows_in_modal_loop; + ++mswindows_in_modal_loop; tmp = condition_case_1 (Qt, bfun, barg, mswindows_modal_loop_error_handler, Qnil); @@ -1151,7 +1151,7 @@ mswindows_unmodalize_signal_maybe (void) } /* - * This is an unsafe part of event pump, guarded by + * This is an unsafe part of event pump, guarded by * condition_case. See mswindows_pump_outstanding_events */ static Lisp_Object @@ -1175,7 +1175,7 @@ mswindows_unsafe_pump_events (Lisp_Object u_n_u_s_e_d) Fdeallocate_event (event); UNGCPRO; - + /* Qt becomes return value of mswindows_pump_outstanding_events once we get here */ return Qt; @@ -1223,14 +1223,14 @@ mswindows_pump_outstanding_events (void) Lisp_Object result = Qt; struct gcpro gcpro1; GCPRO1 (result); - + if (NILP(mswindows_error_caught_in_modal_loop)) result = mswindows_protect_modal_loop (mswindows_unsafe_pump_events, Qnil); UNGCPRO; return result; } -static void +static void mswindows_drain_windows_queue () { MSG msg; @@ -1249,7 +1249,7 @@ mswindows_drain_windows_queue () } } -/* +/* * This is a special flavor of the mswindows_need_event function, * used while in event pump. Actually, there is only kind of events * allowed while in event pump: a timer. An attempt to fetch any @@ -1282,7 +1282,7 @@ mswindows_need_event_in_modal_loop (int badly_p) /* We'll deadlock if go waiting */ if (mswindows_pending_timers_count == 0) error ("Deadlock due to an attempt to call next-event in a wrong context"); - + /* Fetch and dispatch any pending timers */ GetMessage (&msg, NULL, WM_TIMER, WM_TIMER); DispatchMessage (&msg); @@ -1319,7 +1319,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) SELECT_TYPE temp_mask = input_wait_mask; EMACS_TIME sometime; EMACS_SELECT_TIME select_time_to_block, *pointer_to_this; - + if (badly_p) pointer_to_this = 0; else @@ -1330,7 +1330,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) } active = select (MAXDESC, &temp_mask, 0, 0, pointer_to_this); - + if (active == 0) { assert (!badly_p); @@ -1342,7 +1342,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) { mswindows_drain_windows_queue (); } -#ifdef HAVE_TTY +#ifdef HAVE_TTY /* Look for a TTY event */ for (i = 0; i < MAXDESC-1; i++) { @@ -1354,7 +1354,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) struct console *c = tty_find_console_from_fd (i); Lisp_Object emacs_event = Fmake_event (Qnil, Qnil); struct Lisp_Event* event = XEVENT (emacs_event); - + assert (c); if (read_event_from_tty_or_stream_desc (event, c, i)) { @@ -1373,7 +1373,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) { struct Lisp_Process *p = get_process_from_usid (FD_TO_USID(i)); - + mswindows_enqueue_process_event (p); } else @@ -1412,7 +1412,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) assert ((!badly_p && active == WAIT_TIMEOUT) || (active >= WAIT_OBJECT_0 && active <= WAIT_OBJECT_0 + mswindows_waitable_count)); - + if (active == WAIT_TIMEOUT) { /* No luck trying - just return what we've already got */ @@ -1427,7 +1427,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) { int ix = active - WAIT_OBJECT_0; /* First, try to find which process' output has signaled */ - struct Lisp_Process *p = + struct Lisp_Process *p = get_process_from_usid (HANDLE_TO_USID (mswindows_waitable_handles[ix])); if (p != NULL) { @@ -1455,7 +1455,7 @@ mswindows_need_event (int badly_p) /* Event generators */ /************************************************************************/ -/* +/* * Callback procedure for synchronous timer messages */ static void CALLBACK @@ -1477,7 +1477,7 @@ mswindows_wm_timer_callback (HWND hwnd, UINT umsg, UINT id_timer, DWORD dwtime) mswindows_enqueue_dispatch_event (emacs_event); } -/* +/* * Callback procedure for dde messages * * We execute a dde Open("file") by simulating a file drop, so dde support @@ -1488,9 +1488,9 @@ HDDEDATA CALLBACK mswindows_dde_callback (UINT uType, UINT uFmt, HCONV hconv, HSZ hszTopic, HSZ hszItem, HDDEDATA hdata, DWORD dwData1, DWORD dwData2) -{ +{ switch (uType) - { + { case XTYP_CONNECT: if (!DdeCmpStringHandles (hszTopic, mswindows_dde_topic_system)) return (HDDEDATA)TRUE; @@ -1507,7 +1507,7 @@ mswindows_dde_callback (UINT uType, UINT uFmt, HCONV hconv, return (DdeCreateDataHandle (mswindows_dde_mlid, (LPBYTE)pairs, sizeof (pairs), 0L, 0, uFmt, 0)); } - return (HDDEDATA)NULL; + return (HDDEDATA)NULL; case XTYP_EXECUTE: if (!DdeCmpStringHandles (hszTopic, mswindows_dde_topic_system)) @@ -1588,12 +1588,12 @@ mswindows_dde_callback (UINT uType, UINT uFmt, HCONV hconv, UNGCPRO; return (HDDEDATA) DDE_FACK; } - DdeFreeDataHandle (hdata); + DdeFreeDataHandle (hdata); return (HDDEDATA) DDE_FNOTPROCESSED; - default: - return (HDDEDATA) NULL; - } + default: + return (HDDEDATA) NULL; + } } #endif @@ -1677,7 +1677,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) BYTE keymap_orig[256]; POINT pnt = { LOWORD (GetMessagePos()), HIWORD (GetMessagePos()) }; MSG msg; - + msg.hwnd = hwnd; msg.message = message; msg.wParam = wParam; @@ -1750,7 +1750,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) mswindows_enqueue_mouse_button_event (hwnd, message, MAKEPOINTS (lParam), GetMessageTime()); break; - + case WM_LBUTTONUP: msframe = FRAME_MSWINDOWS_DATA (XFRAME (mswindows_find_frame (hwnd))); msframe->last_click_time = GetMessageTime(); @@ -1872,7 +1872,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) } msframe->last_click_time = GetMessageTime(); break; - + case WM_TIMER: if (wParam == BUTTON_2_TIMER_ID) { @@ -1921,7 +1921,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) event->event.motion.x = MAKEPOINTS(lParam).x; event->event.motion.y = MAKEPOINTS(lParam).y; event->event.motion.modifiers = mswindows_modifier_state (NULL, 0); - + mswindows_enqueue_dispatch_event (emacs_event); } break; @@ -1946,9 +1946,9 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) /* find out which toolbar */ frame = XFRAME (mswindows_find_frame (hwnd)); - btext = mswindows_get_toolbar_button_text ( frame, + btext = mswindows_get_toolbar_button_text ( frame, nmhdr->idFrom ); - + tttext->lpszText = NULL; tttext->hinst = NULL; @@ -1956,7 +1956,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) { /* I think this is safe since the text will only go away when the toolbar does...*/ - GET_C_STRING_EXT_DATA_ALLOCA (btext, FORMAT_OS, + GET_C_STRING_EXT_DATA_ALLOCA (btext, FORMAT_OS, tttext->lpszText); } #endif @@ -1978,12 +1978,12 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) item.mask = TCIF_PARAM; SendMessage (nmhdr->hwndFrom, TCM_GETITEM, (WPARAM)index, (LPARAM)&item); - + mswindows_handle_gui_wm_command (frame, 0, item.lParam); } } break; - + case WM_PAINT: { /* According to the docs we need to check GetUpdateRect() before @@ -1994,7 +1994,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) int x, y, width, height; frame = XFRAME (mswindows_find_frame (hwnd)); - + BeginPaint (hwnd, &paintStruct); x = paintStruct.rcPaint.left; y = paintStruct.rcPaint.top; @@ -2057,8 +2057,8 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) if (FRAME_MSWINDOWS_TARGET_RECT (frame)) { /* Yes, we have to size again */ - mswindows_size_frame_internal ( frame, - FRAME_MSWINDOWS_TARGET_RECT + mswindows_size_frame_internal ( frame, + FRAME_MSWINDOWS_TARGET_RECT (frame)); /* Reset so we do not get here again. The SetWindowPos call in * mswindows_size_frame_internal can cause recursion here. */ @@ -2073,7 +2073,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) if (!msframe->sizing && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (frame)) mswindows_enqueue_magic_event (hwnd, XM_MAPFRAME); FRAME_VISIBLE_P (frame) = 1; - + if (!msframe->sizing || mswindows_dynamic_frame_resize) redisplay (); } @@ -2164,7 +2164,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) SendMessage (hwndScrollBar, WM_CANCELMODE, 0, 0); } UNGCPRO; - break; + break; } case WM_MOUSEWHEEL: @@ -2181,7 +2181,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) } else goto defproc; - break; + break; } #endif @@ -2255,7 +2255,7 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) Lisp_Object image_instance; VOID_TO_LISP (image_instance, ii); if (IMAGE_INSTANCEP (image_instance) - && + && IMAGE_INSTANCE_TYPE_P (image_instance, IMAGE_WIDGET) && !NILP (XIMAGE_INSTANCE_WIDGET_FACE (image_instance))) @@ -2266,27 +2266,27 @@ mswindows_wnd_proc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam) { if (widget_brush) DeleteObject (widget_brush); - widget_brush = CreateSolidBrush - (COLOR_INSTANCE_MSWINDOWS_COLOR - (XCOLOR_INSTANCE - (FACE_BACKGROUND + widget_brush = CreateSolidBrush + (COLOR_INSTANCE_MSWINDOWS_COLOR + (XCOLOR_INSTANCE + (FACE_BACKGROUND (XIMAGE_INSTANCE_WIDGET_FACE (image_instance), XIMAGE_INSTANCE_SUBWINDOW_FRAME (image_instance))))); } last_widget_brushed = ii; SetTextColor (hdc, - COLOR_INSTANCE_MSWINDOWS_COLOR - (XCOLOR_INSTANCE - (FACE_FOREGROUND + COLOR_INSTANCE_MSWINDOWS_COLOR + (XCOLOR_INSTANCE + (FACE_FOREGROUND (XIMAGE_INSTANCE_WIDGET_FACE (image_instance), XIMAGE_INSTANCE_SUBWINDOW_FRAME (image_instance))))); SetBkMode (hdc, OPAQUE); SetBkColor (hdc, - COLOR_INSTANCE_MSWINDOWS_COLOR - (XCOLOR_INSTANCE - (FACE_BACKGROUND + COLOR_INSTANCE_MSWINDOWS_COLOR + (XCOLOR_INSTANCE + (FACE_BACKGROUND (XIMAGE_INSTANCE_WIDGET_FACE (image_instance), XIMAGE_INSTANCE_SUBWINDOW_FRAME (image_instance))))); return (LRESULT)widget_brush; @@ -2667,7 +2667,7 @@ emacs_mswindows_handle_magic_event (struct Lisp_Event *emacs_event) { case XM_BUMPQUEUE: break; - + case WM_SETFOCUS: case WM_KILLFOCUS: { @@ -2695,13 +2695,13 @@ emacs_mswindows_handle_magic_event (struct Lisp_Event *emacs_event) case XM_UNMAPFRAME: { Lisp_Object frame = EVENT_CHANNEL (emacs_event); - va_run_hook_with_args (EVENT_MSWINDOWS_MAGIC_TYPE(emacs_event) + va_run_hook_with_args (EVENT_MSWINDOWS_MAGIC_TYPE(emacs_event) == XM_MAPFRAME ? - Qmap_frame_hook : Qunmap_frame_hook, + Qmap_frame_hook : Qunmap_frame_hook, 1, frame); } break; - + /* #### What about Enter & Leave */ #if 0 va_run_hook_with_args (in_p ? Qmouse_enter_frame_hook : @@ -2969,9 +2969,9 @@ reinit_vars_of_event_mswindows (void) mswindows_event_stream->select_console_cb = emacs_mswindows_select_console; mswindows_event_stream->unselect_console_cb = emacs_mswindows_unselect_console; #ifdef HAVE_MSG_SELECT - mswindows_event_stream->select_process_cb = + mswindows_event_stream->select_process_cb = (void (*)(struct Lisp_Process*))event_stream_unixoid_select_process; - mswindows_event_stream->unselect_process_cb = + mswindows_event_stream->unselect_process_cb = (void (*)(struct Lisp_Process*))event_stream_unixoid_unselect_process; mswindows_event_stream->create_stream_pair_cb = event_stream_unixoid_create_stream_pair; mswindows_event_stream->delete_stream_pair_cb = event_stream_unixoid_delete_stream_pair; diff --git a/src/event-stream.c b/src/event-stream.c index b9fefe2..81f5f02 100644 --- a/src/event-stream.c +++ b/src/event-stream.c @@ -4839,9 +4839,7 @@ dribble_out_event (Lisp_Object event) { Emchar ch = XCHAR (keysym); Bufbyte str[MAX_EMCHAR_LEN]; - Bytecount len; - - len = set_charptr_emchar (str, ch); + Bytecount len = set_charptr_emchar (str, ch); Lstream_write (XLSTREAM (Vdribble_file), str, len); } else if (string_char_length (XSYMBOL (keysym)->name) == 1) diff --git a/src/event-unixoid.c b/src/event-unixoid.c index d613f62..9033ebf 100644 --- a/src/event-unixoid.c +++ b/src/event-unixoid.c @@ -41,10 +41,6 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ #include "sysproc.h" /* select stuff */ #include "systime.h" -#ifdef HAVE_GPM -#include "gpmevent.h" -#endif - /* Mask of bits indicating the descriptors that we wait for input on. These work as follows: @@ -84,12 +80,6 @@ read_event_from_tty_or_stream_desc (struct Lisp_Event *event, XSETCONSOLE (console, con); -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - if (fd == CONSOLE_TTY_MOUSE_FD (con)) { - return handle_gpm_read (event,con,fd); - } -#endif - nread = read (fd, &ch, 1); if (nread <= 0) { diff --git a/src/file-coding.c b/src/file-coding.c index c6e9ae0..2bf225e 100644 --- a/src/file-coding.c +++ b/src/file-coding.c @@ -294,7 +294,7 @@ static const struct struct_description ccs_description = { sizeof(charset_conversion_spec), ccs_description_1 }; - + static const struct lrecord_description ccsd_description_1[] = { XD_DYNARR_DESC(charset_conversion_spec_dynarr, &ccs_description), { XD_END } @@ -1053,7 +1053,7 @@ Define symbol ALIAS as an alias for coding system CODING-SYSTEM. FROB (CR, "-mac"); #undef FROB } - /* FSF return value is a vector of [ALIAS-unix ALIAS-doc ALIAS-mac], + /* FSF return value is a vector of [ALIAS-unix ALIAS-dos ALIAS-mac], but it doesn't look intentional, so I'd rather return something meaningful or nothing at all. */ return Qnil; @@ -1491,21 +1491,19 @@ detect_eol_type (struct detection_state *st, CONST unsigned char *src, while (n--) { c = *src++; - if (c == '\r') - st->eol.just_saw_cr = 1; - else + if (c == '\n') { - if (c == '\n') - { - if (st->eol.just_saw_cr) - return EOL_CRLF; - else if (st->eol.seen_anything) - return EOL_LF; - } - else if (st->eol.just_saw_cr) - return EOL_CR; - st->eol.just_saw_cr = 0; + if (st->eol.just_saw_cr) + return EOL_CRLF; + else if (st->eol.seen_anything) + return EOL_LF; } + else if (st->eol.just_saw_cr) + return EOL_CR; + else if (c == '\r') + st->eol.just_saw_cr = 1; + else + st->eol.just_saw_cr = 0; st->eol.seen_anything = 1; } @@ -1530,7 +1528,7 @@ detect_eol_type (struct detection_state *st, CONST unsigned char *src, */ static int -detect_coding_type (struct detection_state *st, CONST unsigned char *src, +detect_coding_type (struct detection_state *st, CONST Extbyte *src, unsigned int n, int just_do_eol) { int c; @@ -1635,13 +1633,15 @@ coding_system_from_mask (int mask) /* Given a seekable read stream and potential coding system and EOL type as specified, do any autodetection that is called for. If the - coding system and/or EOL type are not autodetect, they will be left + coding system and/or EOL type are not `autodetect', they will be left alone; but this function will never return an autodetect coding system or EOL type. This function does not automatically fetch subsidiary coding systems; that should be unnecessary with the explicit eol-type argument. */ +#define LENGTH(string_constant) (sizeof (string_constant) - 1) + void determine_real_coding_system (Lstream *stream, Lisp_Object *codesys_in_out, enum eol_type *eol_type_in_out) @@ -1656,68 +1656,110 @@ determine_real_coding_system (Lstream *stream, Lisp_Object *codesys_in_out, decst.mask = ~0; /* If autodetection is called for, do it now. */ - if (XCODING_SYSTEM_TYPE (*codesys_in_out) == CODESYS_AUTODETECT || - *eol_type_in_out == EOL_AUTODETECT) + if (XCODING_SYSTEM_TYPE (*codesys_in_out) == CODESYS_AUTODETECT + || *eol_type_in_out == EOL_AUTODETECT) { - unsigned char random_buffer[4096]; - int nread; + Extbyte buf[4096]; Lisp_Object coding_system = Qnil; - - nread = Lstream_read (stream, random_buffer, sizeof (random_buffer)); - if (nread) - { - unsigned char *cp = random_buffer; - - while (cp < random_buffer + nread) - { - if ((*cp++ == 'c') && (cp < random_buffer + nread) && - (*cp++ == 'o') && (cp < random_buffer + nread) && - (*cp++ == 'd') && (cp < random_buffer + nread) && - (*cp++ == 'i') && (cp < random_buffer + nread) && - (*cp++ == 'n') && (cp < random_buffer + nread) && - (*cp++ == 'g') && (cp < random_buffer + nread) && - (*cp++ == ':') && (cp < random_buffer + nread)) + Extbyte *p; + ssize_t nread = Lstream_read (stream, buf, sizeof (buf)); + Extbyte *scan_end; + + /* Look for initial "-*-"; mode line prefix */ + for (p = buf, + scan_end = buf + nread - LENGTH ("-*-coding:?-*-"); + p <= scan_end + && *p != '\n' + && *p != '\r'; + p++) + if (*p == '-' && *(p+1) == '*' && *(p+2) == '-') + { + Extbyte *local_vars_beg = p + 3; + /* Look for final "-*-"; mode line suffix */ + for (p = local_vars_beg, + scan_end = buf + nread - LENGTH ("-*-"); + p <= scan_end + && *p != '\n' + && *p != '\r'; + p++) + if (*p == '-' && *(p+1) == '*' && *(p+2) == '-') { - unsigned char coding_system_name[4096 - 6]; - unsigned char *np = coding_system_name; - - while ( (cp < random_buffer + nread) - && ((*cp == ' ') || (*cp == '\t')) ) - { - cp++; - } - while ( (cp < random_buffer + nread) && - (*cp != ' ') && (*cp != '\t') && (*cp != ';') ) - { - *np++ = *cp++; - } - *np = 0; - coding_system - = Ffind_coding_system (intern ((char *) coding_system_name)); + Extbyte *suffix = p; + /* Look for "coding:" */ + for (p = local_vars_beg, + scan_end = suffix - LENGTH ("coding:?"); + p <= scan_end; + p++) + if (memcmp ("coding:", p, LENGTH ("coding:")) == 0 + && (p == local_vars_beg + || (*(p-1) == ' ' || + *(p-1) == '\t' || + *(p-1) == ';'))) + { + Extbyte save; + int n; + p += LENGTH ("coding:"); + while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t') p++; + + /* Get coding system name */ + save = *suffix; *suffix = '\0'; + /* Characters valid in a MIME charset name (rfc 1521), + and in a Lisp symbol name. */ + n = strspn ( (char *) p, + "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ" + "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz" + "0123456789" + "!$%&*+-.^_{|}~"); + *suffix = save; + if (n > 0) + { + save = p[n]; p[n] = '\0'; + coding_system = + Ffind_coding_system (intern ((char *) p)); + p[n] = save; + } + break; + } break; } - } - if (EQ(coding_system, Qnil)) - do{ - if (detect_coding_type (&decst, random_buffer, nread, - XCODING_SYSTEM_TYPE (*codesys_in_out) - != CODESYS_AUTODETECT)) - break; - nread = Lstream_read (stream, - random_buffer, sizeof (random_buffer)); - if (!nread) - break; - } while(1); - } + break; + } + + if (NILP (coding_system)) + do + { + if (detect_coding_type (&decst, buf, nread, + XCODING_SYSTEM_TYPE (*codesys_in_out) + != CODESYS_AUTODETECT)) + break; + nread = Lstream_read (stream, buf, sizeof (buf)); + if (nread == 0) + break; + } + while (1); + + else if (XCODING_SYSTEM_TYPE (*codesys_in_out) == CODESYS_AUTODETECT + && XCODING_SYSTEM_EOL_TYPE (coding_system) == EOL_AUTODETECT) + do + { + if (detect_coding_type (&decst, buf, nread, 1)) + break; + nread = Lstream_read (stream, buf, sizeof (buf)); + if (!nread) + break; + } + while (1); + *eol_type_in_out = decst.eol_type; if (XCODING_SYSTEM_TYPE (*codesys_in_out) == CODESYS_AUTODETECT) { - if (EQ(coding_system, Qnil)) + if (NILP (coding_system)) *codesys_in_out = coding_system_from_mask (decst.mask); else *codesys_in_out = coding_system; } } + /* If we absolutely can't determine the EOL type, just assume LF. */ if (*eol_type_in_out == EOL_AUTODETECT) *eol_type_in_out = EOL_LF; @@ -1754,7 +1796,7 @@ type. Optional arg BUFFER defaults to the current buffer. while (1) { unsigned char random_buffer[4096]; - int nread = Lstream_read (istr, random_buffer, sizeof (random_buffer)); + ssize_t nread = Lstream_read (istr, random_buffer, sizeof (random_buffer)); if (!nread) break; @@ -1921,8 +1963,10 @@ struct decoding_stream struct detection_state decst; }; -static int decoding_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size); -static int decoding_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size); +static ssize_t decoding_reader (Lstream *stream, + unsigned char *data, size_t size); +static ssize_t decoding_writer (Lstream *stream, + CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size); static int decoding_rewinder (Lstream *stream); static int decoding_seekable_p (Lstream *stream); static int decoding_flusher (Lstream *stream); @@ -1954,12 +1998,12 @@ decoding_marker (Lisp_Object stream) /* Read SIZE bytes of data and store it into DATA. We are a decoding stream so we read data from the other end, decode it, and store it into DATA. */ -static int +static ssize_t decoding_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct decoding_stream *str = DECODING_STREAM_DATA (stream); unsigned char *orig_data = data; - int read_size; + ssize_t read_size; int error_occurred = 0; /* We need to interface to mule_decode(), which expects to take some @@ -2016,11 +2060,11 @@ decoding_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) return data - orig_data; } -static int +static ssize_t decoding_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct decoding_stream *str = DECODING_STREAM_DATA (stream); - int retval; + ssize_t retval; /* Decode all our data into the runoff, and then attempt to write it all out to the other end. Remove whatever chunk we succeeded @@ -2290,7 +2334,7 @@ BUFFER defaults to the current buffer if unspecified. char tempbuf[1024]; /* some random amount */ Bufpos newpos, even_newer_pos; Bufpos oldpos = lisp_buffer_stream_startpos (istr); - int size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); + ssize_t size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); if (!size_in_bytes) break; @@ -2375,9 +2419,9 @@ struct encoding_stream #endif /* MULE */ }; -static int encoding_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size); -static int encoding_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, - size_t size); +static ssize_t encoding_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size); +static ssize_t encoding_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, + size_t size); static int encoding_rewinder (Lstream *stream); static int encoding_seekable_p (Lstream *stream); static int encoding_flusher (Lstream *stream); @@ -2409,12 +2453,12 @@ encoding_marker (Lisp_Object stream) /* Read SIZE bytes of data and store it into DATA. We are a encoding stream so we read data from the other end, encode it, and store it into DATA. */ -static int +static ssize_t encoding_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct encoding_stream *str = ENCODING_STREAM_DATA (stream); unsigned char *orig_data = data; - int read_size; + ssize_t read_size; int error_occurred = 0; /* We need to interface to mule_encode(), which expects to take some @@ -2471,11 +2515,11 @@ encoding_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) return data - orig_data; } -static int +static ssize_t encoding_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct encoding_stream *str = ENCODING_STREAM_DATA (stream); - int retval; + ssize_t retval; /* Encode all our data into the runoff, and then attempt to write it all out to the other end. Remove whatever chunk we succeeded @@ -2698,7 +2742,7 @@ text. BUFFER defaults to the current buffer if unspecified. char tempbuf[1024]; /* some random amount */ Bufpos newpos, even_newer_pos; Bufpos oldpos = lisp_buffer_stream_startpos (istr); - int size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); + ssize_t size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); if (!size_in_bytes) break; @@ -3758,7 +3802,7 @@ encode_coding_utf8 (Lstream *encoding, CONST unsigned char *src, back_to_square_n: #endif /* ENABLE_COMPOSITE_CHARS */ - + while (n--) { unsigned char c = *src++; @@ -5443,7 +5487,7 @@ convert_to_external_format (CONST Bufbyte *ptr, GCPRO3 (instream, outstream, da_outstream); while (1) { - int size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); + ssize_t size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); if (!size_in_bytes) break; Lstream_write (ostr, tempbuf, size_in_bytes); @@ -5500,7 +5544,7 @@ convert_from_external_format (CONST Extbyte *ptr, GCPRO3 (instream, outstream, da_outstream); while (1) { - int size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); + ssize_t size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); if (!size_in_bytes) break; Lstream_write (ostr, tempbuf, size_in_bytes); diff --git a/src/fileio.c b/src/fileio.c index a44dd4c..514c058 100644 --- a/src/fileio.c +++ b/src/fileio.c @@ -280,18 +280,16 @@ restore_point_unwind (Lisp_Object point_marker) signal handler) because that's way too losing. (#### Actually, longjmp()ing out of the signal handler may not be - as losing as I thought. See sys_do_signal() in sysdep.c.) + as losing as I thought. See sys_do_signal() in sysdep.c.) */ - Solaris include files declare the return value as ssize_t. - Is that standard? */ -int +ssize_t read_allowing_quit (int fildes, void *buf, size_t size) { QUIT; return sys_read_1 (fildes, buf, size, 1); } -int +ssize_t write_allowing_quit (int fildes, CONST void *buf, size_t size) { QUIT; @@ -1020,9 +1018,9 @@ See also the function `substitute-in-file-name'. if ((user = user_login_name (NULL)) != NULL) { /* Does the user login name match the ~name? */ - if (strcmp(user,((char *) o + 1)) == 0) + if (strcmp (user, (char *) o + 1) == 0) { - newdir = (Bufbyte *) get_home_directory(); + newdir = (Bufbyte *) get_home_directory(); nm = p; } } @@ -2982,7 +2980,7 @@ positions), even in Mule. (Fixing this is very difficult.) occurs inside of the filedesc stream. */ while (1) { - Bytecount this_len; + ssize_t this_len; Charcount cc_inserted; QUIT; diff --git a/src/frame-tty.c b/src/frame-tty.c index a079f8a..6815605 100644 --- a/src/frame-tty.c +++ b/src/frame-tty.c @@ -33,10 +33,6 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ #include "events.h" -#ifdef HAVE_GPM -#include -#endif - /* Default properties to use when creating frames. */ Lisp_Object Vdefault_tty_frame_plist; @@ -86,33 +82,6 @@ tty_after_init_frame (struct frame *f, int first_on_device, call1 (Qinit_post_tty_win, FRAME_CONSOLE (f)); } -#ifdef HAVE_GPM -static int -tty_get_mouse_position (struct device *d, Lisp_Object *frame, int *x, int *y) -{ - Gpm_Event ev; - int num_buttons; - - num_buttons = Gpm_GetSnapshot(&ev); - *x = ev.x; - *y = ev.y; - *frame = DEVICE_SELECTED_FRAME (d); - return (1); -} - -static void -tty_set_mouse_position (struct window *w, int x, int y) -{ - /* XXX - I couldn't find any GPM functions that set the mouse position. - Mr. Perry had left this function empty; that must be why. - karlheg - */ -} - -#endif - - /* Change from withdrawn state to mapped state. */ static void tty_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f) @@ -223,10 +192,6 @@ console_type_create_frame_tty (void) CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, init_frame_1); CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, init_frame_3); CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, after_init_frame); -#ifdef HAVE_GPM - CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, get_mouse_position); - CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, set_mouse_position); -#endif CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, make_frame_visible); CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, make_frame_invisible); CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, frame_visible_p); diff --git a/src/getloadavg.c b/src/getloadavg.c index 2bf2c3f..98de5bb 100644 --- a/src/getloadavg.c +++ b/src/getloadavg.c @@ -532,7 +532,7 @@ getloadavg (double loadavg[], int nelem) privileges to use it. Initial implementation courtesy Zlatko Calusic . - Integrated to XEmacs by Hrvoje Niksic . + Integrated to XEmacs by Hrvoje Niksic . Additional cleanup by Hrvoje Niksic, based on code published by Casper Dik . */ kstat_ctl_t *kc; diff --git a/src/glyphs-x.c b/src/glyphs-x.c index c326e75..301da9b 100644 --- a/src/glyphs-x.c +++ b/src/glyphs-x.c @@ -678,7 +678,7 @@ write_lisp_string_to_temp_file (Lisp_Object string, char *filename_out) /* Get the data while doing the conversion */ while (1) { - int size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); + ssize_t size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (istr, tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); if (!size_in_bytes) break; /* It does seem the flushes are necessary... */ diff --git a/src/gpmevent.c b/src/gpmevent.c index 77f3738..2d37ea1 100644 --- a/src/gpmevent.c +++ b/src/gpmevent.c @@ -1,4 +1,27 @@ -/* William Perry 1997 */ +/* GPM functions + Copyright (C) 1997 William M. Perry + Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + +This file is part of XEmacs. + +XEmacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it +under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the +Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any +later version. + +XEmacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT +ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or +FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License +for more details. + +You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License +along with XEmacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to +the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, +Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ + +/* Synched up with: Not in FSF. */ + +/* Authors: William Perry */ #include #include "lisp.h" @@ -8,6 +31,10 @@ #include "events.h" #include "events-mod.h" #include "sysdep.h" +#include "commands.h" +#include "lstream.h" +#include "sysproc.h" /* for MAXDESC */ +#include "process.h" #ifdef HAVE_GPM #include "gpmevent.h" @@ -21,94 +48,601 @@ #include #endif -int -handle_gpm_read (struct Lisp_Event *event, struct console *con, int fd) -{ - Gpm_Event ev; - int modifiers = 0; - int type = -1; - int button = 1; - - if (!Gpm_GetEvent(&ev)) - return 0; - - event->timestamp = 0; - event->channel = CONSOLE_SELECTED_FRAME (con); - - /* Whow, wouldn't named defines be NICE!?!?! */ - modifiers = 0; - - if (ev.modifiers & 1) modifiers |= MOD_SHIFT; - if (ev.modifiers & 2) modifiers |= MOD_META; - if (ev.modifiers & 4) modifiers |= MOD_CONTROL; - if (ev.modifiers & 8) modifiers |= MOD_META; - - if (ev.type & GPM_DOWN) - type = GPM_DOWN; - else if (ev.type & GPM_UP) - type = GPM_UP; - else if (ev.type & GPM_MOVE) { - type = GPM_MOVE; - GPM_DRAWPOINTER(&ev); - } - - if (ev.buttons & GPM_B_LEFT) - button = 1; - else if (ev.buttons & GPM_B_MIDDLE) - button = 2; - else if (ev.buttons & GPM_B_RIGHT) - button = 3; - - switch (type) { - case GPM_DOWN: - case GPM_UP: - event->event_type = - type == GPM_DOWN ? button_press_event : button_release_event; - event->event.button.x = ev.x; - event->event.button.y = ev.y; - event->event.button.button = button; - event->event.button.modifiers = modifiers; - break; - case GPM_MOVE: - event->event_type = pointer_motion_event; - event->event.motion.x = ev.x; - event->event.motion.y = ev.y; - event->event.motion.modifiers = modifiers; - default: - return 0; - } - return 1; -} - -void -connect_to_gpm (struct console *con) -{ - /* Only do this if we are running after dumping and really interactive */ - if (!noninteractive && initialized) { - /* We really only want to do this on a TTY */ - CONSOLE_TTY_MOUSE_FD (con) = -1; - if (EQ (CONSOLE_TYPE (con), Qtty)) { - Gpm_Connect conn; - int rval; - - conn.eventMask = GPM_DOWN|GPM_UP|GPM_MOVE; - conn.defaultMask = GPM_MOVE; - conn.minMod = 0; - conn.maxMod = ((1<= 0) + { + memset(&gpm_state_information[fd], '\0', sizeof(struct __gpm_state)); + } + gpm_tried = gpm_flag = 1; + gpm_fd = gpm_consolefd = -1; + gpm_stack = NULL; +} + +static int +get_process_infd (struct Lisp_Process *p) +{ + Lisp_Object instr, outstr; + get_process_streams (p, &instr, &outstr); + assert (!NILP (instr)); + return filedesc_stream_fd (XLSTREAM (instr)); +} + +DEFUN ("receive-gpm-event", Freceive_gpm_event, 0, 2, 0, /* +Run GPM_GetEvent(). +This function is the process handler for the GPM connection. +*/ + (process, string)) +{ + Gpm_Event ev; + int modifiers = 0; + int button = 1; + Lisp_Object fake_event; + struct Lisp_Event *event = NULL; + struct gcpro gcpro1; + static int num_events; + + CHECK_PROCESS (process); + + restore_gpm_state (get_process_infd (XPROCESS (process))); + + if (!Gpm_GetEvent(&ev)) + { + warn_when_safe (Qnil, Qcritical, "Gpm_GetEvent failed - %d", gpm_fd); + return(Qzero); + } + + GCPRO1(fake_event); + + num_events++; + + fake_event = Fmake_event (Qnil, Qnil); + event = XEVENT(fake_event); + + event->timestamp = 0; + event->channel = Fselected_frame (Qnil); /* CONSOLE_SELECTED_FRAME (con); */ + + /* Whow, wouldn't named defines be NICE!?!?! */ + modifiers = 0; + + if (ev.modifiers & 1) modifiers |= MOD_SHIFT; + if (ev.modifiers & 2) modifiers |= MOD_META; + if (ev.modifiers & 4) modifiers |= MOD_CONTROL; + if (ev.modifiers & 8) modifiers |= MOD_META; + + if (ev.buttons & GPM_B_LEFT) + { + button = 1; + } + else if (ev.buttons & GPM_B_MIDDLE) + { + button = 2; + } + else if (ev.buttons & GPM_B_RIGHT) + { + button = 3; + } + + switch (GPM_BARE_EVENTS(ev.type)) { + case GPM_DOWN: + case GPM_UP: + event->event_type = + (ev.type & GPM_DOWN) ? button_press_event : button_release_event; + event->event.button.x = ev.x; + event->event.button.y = ev.y; + event->event.button.button = button; + event->event.button.modifiers = modifiers; + break; + case GPM_MOVE: + case GPM_DRAG: + event->event_type = pointer_motion_event; + event->event.motion.x = ev.x; + event->event.motion.y = ev.y; + event->event.motion.modifiers = modifiers; + default: + /* This will never happen */ + break; + } + + /* Handle the event */ + enqueue_event (fake_event, &gpm_event_queue, &gpm_event_queue_tail); + + UNGCPRO; + + return (Qzero); +} + +static void turn_off_gpm (char *process_name) +{ + Lisp_Object process = Fget_process (build_string (process_name)); + int fd = -1; + + if (NILP (process)) + { + /* Something happened to our GPM process - fail silently */ + return; + } + + fd = get_process_infd (XPROCESS (process)); + + restore_gpm_state (fd); + Gpm_Close(); - break; - default: - set_descriptor_non_blocking (gpm_fd); - CONSOLE_TTY_MOUSE_FD (con) = gpm_fd; - } - } - } + + clear_gpm_state (fd); + + Fdelete_process (build_string (process_name)); +} + +#ifdef TIOCLINUX +static Lisp_Object +tty_get_foreign_selection (Lisp_Object selection_symbol, Lisp_Object target_type) +{ + /* This function can GC */ + struct device *d = decode_device (Qnil); + int fd = DEVICE_INFD (d); + char c = 3; + Lisp_Object output_stream; + Lisp_Object terminal_stream; + Lisp_Object output_string; + struct gcpro gcpro1,gcpro2,gcpro3; + + GCPRO3(output_stream,terminal_stream,output_string); + + /* The ioctl() to paste actually puts things in the input queue of + ** the virtual console, so we need to trap that data, since we are + ** supposed to return the actual string selection from this + ** function. + */ + + /* I really hate doing this, but it doesn't seem to cause any + ** problems, and it makes the Lstream_read stuff further down + ** error out correctly instead of trying to indefinitely read from + ** the console. + ** + ** There is no set_descriptor_blocking() function call, but in my + ** testing under linux, it has not proved fatal to leave the + ** descriptor in non-blocking mode. + ** + ** William Perry Nov 5, 1999 + */ + set_descriptor_non_blocking (fd); + + /* We need two streams, one for reading from the selected device, + ** and one to write the data into. There is no writable version + ** of the lisp-string lstream, so we make do with a resizing + ** buffer stream, and make a string out of it after we are + ** done. + */ + output_stream = make_resizing_buffer_output_stream (); + terminal_stream = make_filedesc_input_stream (fd, 0, -1, LSTR_BLOCKED_OK); + output_string = Qnil; + + /* #### We should arguably use a specbind() and an unwind routine here, + ** #### but I don't care that much right now. + */ + if (NILP (output_stream) || NILP (terminal_stream)) + { + /* Should we signal an error here? */ + goto out; + } + + if (ioctl (fd, TIOCLINUX, &c) < 0) + { + /* Could not get the selection - eek */ + UNGCPRO; + return (Qnil); + } + + while (1) + { + Bufbyte tempbuf[1024]; /* some random amount */ + ssize_t i; + ssize_t size_in_bytes = + Lstream_read (XLSTREAM (terminal_stream), + tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); + + if (size_in_bytes <= 0) + { + /* end of the stream */ + break; + } + + /* convert CR->LF */ + for (i = 0; i < size_in_bytes; i++) + { + if (tempbuf[i] == '\r') + { + tempbuf[i] = '\n'; + } + } + + Lstream_write (XLSTREAM (output_stream), tempbuf, size_in_bytes); + } + + Lstream_flush (XLSTREAM (output_stream)); + + output_string = make_string (resizing_buffer_stream_ptr (XLSTREAM (output_stream)), + Lstream_byte_count (XLSTREAM (output_stream))); + + Lstream_delete (XLSTREAM (output_stream)); + Lstream_delete (XLSTREAM (terminal_stream)); + + out: + UNGCPRO; + return (output_string); +} + +static Lisp_Object +tty_selection_exists_p (Lisp_Object selection) +{ + return (Qt); } +#endif /* TIOCLINUX */ + +#if 0 +static Lisp_Object +tty_own_selection (Lisp_Object selection_name, Lisp_Object selection_value) +{ + /* There is no way to do this cleanly - the GPM selection + ** 'protocol' (actually the TIOCLINUX ioctl) requires a start and + ** end position on the _screen_, not a string to stick in there. + ** Lame. + ** + ** William Perry Nov 4, 1999 + */ +} +#endif + +/* This function appears to work once in a blue moon. I'm not sure +** exactly why either. *sigh* +** +** William Perry Nov 4, 1999 +** +** Apparently, this is the way (mouse-position) is supposed to work, +** and I was just expecting something else. (mouse-pixel-position) +** works just fine. +** +** William Perry Nov 7, 1999 +*/ +static int +tty_get_mouse_position (struct device *d, Lisp_Object *frame, int *x, int *y) +{ + Gpm_Event ev; + int num_buttons; + + memset(&ev,'\0',sizeof(ev)); + + num_buttons = Gpm_GetSnapshot(&ev); + + if (!num_buttons) + { + /* This means there are events pending... */ + + /* #### In theory, we should drain the events pending, stick + ** #### them in the queue, and return the mouse position + ** #### anyway. + */ + return(-1); + } + *x = ev.x; + *y = ev.y; + *frame = DEVICE_SELECTED_FRAME (d); + return (1); +} + +static void +tty_set_mouse_position (struct window *w, int x, int y) +{ + /* + #### I couldn't find any GPM functions that set the mouse position. + #### Mr. Perry had left this function empty; that must be why. + #### karlheg + */ +} + +static int gpm_event_pending_p (int user_p) +{ + Lisp_Object event; + + EVENT_CHAIN_LOOP (event, gpm_event_queue) + { + if (!user_p || command_event_p (event)) + { + return (1); + } + } + return (orig_event_pending_p (user_p)); +} + +static void gpm_next_event_cb (struct Lisp_Event *event) +{ + /* #### It would be nice to preserve some sort of ordering of the + ** #### different types of events, but that would be quite a bit + ** #### of work, and would more than likely break the abstraction + ** #### between the other event loops and this one. + */ + + if (!NILP (gpm_event_queue)) + { + Lisp_Object queued_event = dequeue_event (&gpm_event_queue, &gpm_event_queue_tail); + *event = *(XEVENT (queued_event)); + + if (event->event_type == pointer_motion_event) + { + struct device *d = decode_device (event->channel); + int fd = DEVICE_INFD (d); + + /* Ok, now this is just freaky. Bear with me though. + ** + ** If you run gnuclient and attach to a XEmacs running in + ** X or on another TTY, the mouse cursor does not get + ** drawn correctly. This is because the ioctl() fails + ** with EPERM because the TTY specified is not our + ** controlling terminal. If you are the superuser, it + ** will work just spiffy. The appropriate source file (at + ** least in linux 2.2.x) is + ** .../linux/drivers/char/console.c in the function + ** tioclinux(). The following bit of code is brutal to + ** us: + ** + ** if (current->tty != tty && !suser()) + ** return -EPERM; + ** + ** I even tried setting us as a process leader, removing + ** our controlling terminal, and then using the TIOCSCTTY + ** to set up a new controlling terminal, all with no luck. + ** + ** What is even weirder is if you run XEmacs in a VC, and + ** attach to it from another VC with gnuclient, go back to + ** the original VC and hit a key, the mouse pointer + ** displays (in BOTH VCs), until you hit a key in the + ** second VC, after which it does not display in EITHER + ** VC. Bizarre, no? + ** + ** All I can say is thank god Linux comes with source code + ** or I would have been completely confused. Well, ok, + ** I'm still completely confused. I don't see why they + ** don't just check the permissions on the device + ** (actually, if you have enough access to it to get the + ** console's file descriptor, you should be able to do + ** with it as you wish, but maybe that is just me). + ** + ** William M. Perry - Nov 9, 1999 + */ + + Gpm_DrawPointer (event->event.motion.x,event->event.motion.y, fd); + } + + return; + } + + return (orig_next_event_cb (event)); +} + +static void hook_event_callbacks_once (void) +{ + static int hooker; + + if (!hooker) + { + orig_event_pending_p = event_stream->event_pending_p; + orig_next_event_cb = event_stream->next_event_cb; + event_stream->event_pending_p = gpm_event_pending_p; + event_stream->next_event_cb = gpm_next_event_cb; + hooker = 1; + } +} + +static void hook_console_methods_once (void) +{ + static int hooker; + if (!hooker) + { + /* Install the mouse position methods for the TTY console type */ + CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, get_mouse_position); + CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, set_mouse_position); + CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, get_foreign_selection); + CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, selection_exists_p); +#if 0 + CONSOLE_HAS_METHOD (tty, own_selection); #endif + } +} + +DEFUN ("gpm-enabled-p", Fgpm_enabled_p, 0, 1, 0, /* +Return non-nil if GPM mouse support is currently enabled on DEVICE. +*/ + (device)) +{ + char *console_name = ttyname (DEVICE_INFD (decode_device (device))); + char process_name[1024]; + Lisp_Object proc; + + if (!console_name) + { + return (Qnil); + } + + memset (process_name, '\0', sizeof(process_name)); + snprintf (process_name, sizeof(process_name) - 1, "gpm for %s", console_name); + + proc = Fget_process (build_string (process_name)); + + if (NILP (proc)) + { + return (Qnil); + } + + if (1) /* (PROCESS_LIVE_P (proc)) */ + { + return (Qt); + } + return (Qnil); +} + +DEFUN ("gpm-enable", Fgpm_enable, 0, 2, 0, /* +Toggle accepting of GPM mouse events. +*/ + (device, arg)) +{ + Gpm_Connect conn; + int rval; + Lisp_Object gpm_process; + Lisp_Object gpm_filter; + struct device *d = decode_device (device); + int fd = DEVICE_INFD (d); + char *console_name = ttyname (fd); + char process_name[1024]; + + hook_event_callbacks_once (); + hook_console_methods_once (); + + if (noninteractive) + { + error ("Can't connect to GPM in batch mode."); + } + + if (!console_name) + { + /* Something seriously wrong here... */ + return (Qnil); + } + + memset (process_name, '\0', sizeof(process_name)); + snprintf (process_name, sizeof(process_name) - 1, "gpm for %s", console_name); + + if (NILP (arg)) + { + turn_off_gpm (process_name); + return (Qnil); + } + + /* DANGER DANGER. + ** Though shalt not call (gpm-enable t) after we have already + ** started, or stuff blows up. + */ + if (!NILP (Fgpm_enabled_p (device))) + { + error ("GPM already enabled for this console."); + } + + conn.eventMask = GPM_DOWN|GPM_UP|GPM_MOVE|GPM_DRAG; + conn.defaultMask = GPM_MOVE; + conn.minMod = 0; + conn.maxMod = ((1<methods->close) does "Xfree (ic)". + + */ + #include #include "lisp.h" #include /* More portable than ? */ @@ -38,13 +79,20 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ #include "EmacsFrame.h" #include "events.h" +#ifdef THIS_IS_X11R6 #include #include +#endif #ifndef XIM_XLIB #error XIM_XLIB is not defined?? #endif +Lisp_Object Qxim_xlib; +#define xim_warn(str) warn_when_safe (Qxim_xlib, Qwarning, str); +#define xim_warn1(fmt, str) warn_when_safe (Qxim_xlib, Qwarning, fmt, str); +#define xim_info(str) warn_when_safe (Qxim_xlib, Qinfo, str); + /* Get/Set IC values for just one attribute */ #ifdef DEBUG_XEMACS #define XIC_Value(Get_Set, xic, name, attr, value) \ @@ -92,31 +140,31 @@ Initialize_Locale (void) /*XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, (XtLanguageProc) NULL, NULL);*/ if ((locale = setlocale (LC_ALL, "")) == NULL) { - stderr_out ("Can't set locale.\n"); - stderr_out ("Using C locale instead.\n"); + xim_warn ("Can't set locale.\n" + "Using C locale instead.\n"); putenv ("LANG=C"); putenv ("LC_ALL=C"); if ((locale = setlocale (LC_ALL, "C")) == NULL) { - stderr_out ("Can't even set locale to `C'!\n"); + xim_warn ("Can't even set locale to `C'!\n"); return; } } if (!XSupportsLocale ()) { - stderr_out ("X Windows does not support locale `%s'\n", locale); - stderr_out ("Using C Locale instead\n"); + xim_warn1 ("X Windows does not support locale `%s'\n" + "Using C Locale instead\n", locale); putenv ("LANG=C"); putenv ("LC_ALL=C"); if ((locale = setlocale (LC_ALL, "C")) == NULL) { - stderr_out ("Can't even set locale to `C'!\n"); + xim_warn ("Can't even set locale to `C'!\n"); return; } if (!XSupportsLocale ()) { - stderr_out ("X Windows does not even support locale `C'!\n"); + xim_warn ("X Windows does not even support locale `C'!\n"); return; } } @@ -125,55 +173,131 @@ Initialize_Locale (void) if (XSetLocaleModifiers ("") == NULL) { - stderr_out ("XSetLocaleModifiers(\"\") failed\n"); - stderr_out ("Check the value of the XMODIFIERS environment variable.\n"); + xim_warn ("XSetLocaleModifiers(\"\") failed\n" + "Check the value of the XMODIFIERS environment variable.\n"); } } -/******************************************************************/ -/* Input method using xlib */ -/******************************************************************/ - -/* - * called from when XIM is destroying - */ +#ifdef THIS_IS_X11R6 /* Callbacks for IM are supported from X11R6 or later. */ +/* Called from when XIM is destroying. + Clear all the XIC when the XIM was destroying... */ static void IMDestroyCallback (XIM im, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) { - struct frame *f = (struct frame *) client_data; - struct device *d = XDEVICE (FRAME_DEVICE (f)); + struct device *d = (struct device *)client_data; Lisp_Object tail; DEVICE_FRAME_LOOP (tail, d) { struct frame *target_frame = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)); - if (FRAME_X_XIC (target_frame)) + if (FRAME_X_P (target_frame) && FRAME_X_XIC (target_frame)) { - XDestroyIC (FRAME_X_XIC (target_frame)); + /* XDestroyIC (FRAME_X_XIC (target_frame)); */ FRAME_X_XIC (target_frame) = NULL; } } -#if 0 - if ( DEVICE_X_XIM (d) ) + DEVICE_X_XIM (d) = NULL; + xim_initted = False; + return; +} + +/* This is registered in XIM_init_device (when DEVICE is initializing). + This activates XIM when XIM becomes available. */ +static void +IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) +{ + struct device *d = (struct device *)client_data; + XIM xim; + char *name, *class; + XIMCallback ximcallback; + Lisp_Object tail; + + /* if no xim is presented, initialize xim ... */ + if ( xim_initted == False ) { - stderr_out ("NULLing d->xim...\n"); - /* DEVICE_X_XIM (d) = NULL; */ + xim_initted = True; + XtGetApplicationNameAndClass (dpy, &name, &class); + DEVICE_X_XIM (d) = xim = XOpenIM (dpy, XtDatabase (dpy), name, class); + + /* destroy callback for im */ + ximcallback.callback = IMDestroyCallback; + ximcallback.client_data = (XPointer) d; + XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &ximcallback, NULL); } -#endif - xim_initted = False; + /* activate XIC on all the X frames... */ + DEVICE_FRAME_LOOP (tail, d) + { + struct frame *target_frame = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)); + if (FRAME_X_P (target_frame) && !FRAME_X_XIC (target_frame)) + { + XIM_init_frame (target_frame); + } + } return; } +#endif /* if THIS_IS_X11R6 */ + +/* Initialize XIM for X device. + Register the use of XIM using XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback. */ +void +XIM_init_device (struct device *d) +{ +#ifdef THIS_IS_X11R6 + DEVICE_X_XIM (d) = NULL; + XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (DEVICE_X_DISPLAY (d), NULL, NULL, NULL, + IMInstantiateCallback, (XPointer) d); + return; +#else + Display *dpy = DEVICE_X_DISPLAY (d); + char *name, *class; + XIM xim; + + XtGetApplicationNameAndClass (dpy, &name, &class); + DEVICE_X_XIM (d) = xim = XOpenIM (dpy, XtDatabase (dpy), name, class); + if (xim == NULL) + { + xim_warn ("XOpenIM() failed...no input server available\n"); + return; + } + else + { + XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &DEVICE_X_XIM_STYLES (d), NULL); + return; + } +#endif +} + /* - * called from when FRAME is initializing + * For the frames */ + +/* Callback for the deleting frame. */ static void -IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) +XIM_delete_frame (Widget w, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data) { struct frame *f = (struct frame *) client_data; struct device *d = XDEVICE (FRAME_DEVICE (f)); + + if (DEVICE_X_XIM (d)) + { + if (FRAME_X_XIC (f)) + { + XDestroyIC (FRAME_X_XIC (f)); + FRAME_X_XIC (f) = NULL; + } + } + return; +} + +/* Initialize XIC for new frame. + Create an X input context (XIC) for this frame. */ +void +XIM_init_frame (struct frame *f) +{ + struct device *d = XDEVICE (FRAME_DEVICE (f)); XIM xim; Widget w = FRAME_X_TEXT_WIDGET (f); Window win = XtWindow (w); @@ -181,7 +305,6 @@ IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) XPoint spot = {0,0}; XIMStyle style; XVaNestedList p_list, s_list; - char *name, *class; typedef struct { XIMStyles styles; @@ -191,7 +314,6 @@ IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) char *inputmethod; } xic_vars_t; xic_vars_t xic_vars; - XIMCallback ximcallback; XIC xic; #define res(name, class, representation, field, default_value) \ @@ -201,32 +323,22 @@ IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) static XtResource resources[] = { /* name class represent'n field default value */ +#ifdef THIS_IS_X11R6 + res(XtNinputMethod, XtCInputMethod, XtRString, inputmethod, (XtPointer) NULL), +#endif res(XtNximStyles, XtCXimStyles, XtRXimStyles, styles, (XtPointer) DefaultXIMStyles), res(XtNfontSet, XtCFontSet, XtRFontSet, fontset, (XtPointer) XtDefaultFontSet), res(XtNximForeground, XtCForeground, XtRPixel, fg, (XtPointer) XtDefaultForeground), - res(XtNximBackground, XtCBackground, XtRPixel, bg, (XtPointer) XtDefaultBackground), - res(XtNinputMethod, XtCInputMethod, XtRString, inputmethod, (XtPointer) NULL) + res(XtNximBackground, XtCBackground, XtRPixel, bg, (XtPointer) XtDefaultBackground) }; - /* ---------- beginning of the action ---------- */ - /* - * if no xim is presented, initialize xim ... - */ - if ( xim_initted == False ) - { - xim_initted = True; - XtGetApplicationNameAndClass (dpy, &name, &class); - DEVICE_X_XIM (d) = xim = XOpenIM (dpy, XtDatabase (dpy), name, class); + xim = DEVICE_X_XIM (d); - /* destroy callback for im */ - ximcallback.callback = IMDestroyCallback; - ximcallback.client_data = (XPointer) f; - XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &ximcallback, NULL); - } - else + if (!xim) { - xim = DEVICE_X_XIM (d); + xim_info ("X Input Method open failed. Waiting for an XIM to be enabled.\n"); + return; } w = FRAME_X_TEXT_WIDGET (f); @@ -234,13 +346,13 @@ IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) /* * initialize XIC */ - if ( FRAME_X_XIC (f) ) return; + if (FRAME_X_XIC (f)) return; XtGetApplicationResources (w, &xic_vars, resources, XtNumber (resources), NULL, 0); if (!xic_vars.fontset) { - stderr_out ("Can't get fontset resource for Input Method\n"); + xim_warn ("Can't get fontset resource for Input Method\n"); FRAME_X_XIC (f) = NULL; return; } @@ -278,7 +390,7 @@ IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) if (!xic) { - stderr_out ("Warning: XCreateIC failed.\n"); + xim_warn ("Warning: XCreateIC failed.\n"); return; } @@ -292,60 +404,11 @@ IMInstantiateCallback (Display *dpy, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data) XSetICFocus (xic); - return; -} - -/* Create X input method for device */ -void -XIM_init_device (struct device *d) -{ - /* do nothing here */ - return; -} - -/* Callback for when the frame was deleted (closed) */ -static void -XIM_delete_frame (Widget w, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data) -{ - struct frame *f = (struct frame *) client_data; - struct device *d = XDEVICE (FRAME_DEVICE (f)); - Display *dpy = DEVICE_X_DISPLAY (d); - - XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpy, NULL, NULL, NULL, - IMInstantiateCallback, (XPointer) f); - - if (FRAME_X_XIC (f)) - { - XDestroyIC (FRAME_X_XIC (f)); - FRAME_X_XIC (f) = NULL; - } - return; -} - -/* Create an X input context for this frame. - - Register the IM to be initiated later using XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback - */ -void -XIM_init_frame (struct frame *f) -{ - struct device *d = XDEVICE (FRAME_DEVICE (f)); - - XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (DEVICE_X_DISPLAY (d), NULL, NULL, NULL, - IMInstantiateCallback, (XPointer) f); - -#if 0 - if ( FRAME_X_XIC (f) ) - return; -#endif - if ( ! DEVICE_X_XIM (d) ) - { - stderr_out ("X Input Method open failed. Waiting IM to be enabled.\n"); - } - +#ifdef THIS_IS_X11R6 /* when frame is going to be destroyed (closed) */ XtAddCallback (FRAME_X_TEXT_WIDGET(f), XNDestroyCallback, XIM_delete_frame, (XtPointer)f); - return; +#endif } @@ -723,6 +786,65 @@ best_style (XIMStyles *user, XIMStyles *xim) return DEFAULTStyle; /* Default Style */ } +/* These lisp-callable functions will be sealed until xim-leim is needed. + Oct 22 1999 - kazz */ +#if 0 +/* + * External callable function for XIM + */ +DEFUN ("x-open-xim", Fx_open_xim, 1, 1, 0, /* +Open the XIC on the frame if XIM is available. +Commonly, use this as \(x-open-xim \(selected-frame)). +If the frame is not on X device, return signal. +If XIC is created successfully return t. If not return nil. +*/ + (frame)) +{ + struct frame *f; + + CHECK_LIVE_FRAME (frame); + f = XFRAME (frame); + if (!FRAME_X_P (f)) + return signal_simple_error ("This frame is not on X device", frame); + + XIM_init_frame (f); + return FRAME_X_XIC (f) ? Qt : Qnil; +} + +DEFUN ("x-close-xim", Fx_close_xim, 1, 1, 0, /* +Close the XIC on the frame if it exists. +Commonly, use this as \(x-close-xim \(selected-frame)). +If the frame is not on X device, return signal. +Otherwise, it destroys the XIC if it exists, then returns t anyway. +*/ + (frame)) +{ + struct frame *f; + struct device *d; + + CHECK_LIVE_FRAME (frame); + f = XFRAME (frame); + if (!FRAME_X_P (f)) + return signal_simple_error ("This frame is not on X device", frame); + + d = XDEVICE (FRAME_DEVICE (f)); + if (DEVICE_X_XIM (d)) { + /* XDestroyIC (FRAME_X_XIC (XFRAME (f))); */ + FRAME_X_XIC (XFRAME (f)) = NULL; + } + return Qt; +} +#endif /* if 0 */ + +void +syms_of_input_method_xlib (void) +{ + defsymbol (&Qxim_xlib, "xim-xlib"); +#if 0 /* see above */ + DEFSUBR (Fx_open_xim); + DEFSUBR (Fx_close_xim); +#endif +} void vars_of_input_method_xlib (void) diff --git a/src/linuxplay.c b/src/linuxplay.c index 4847277..ab594f3 100644 --- a/src/linuxplay.c +++ b/src/linuxplay.c @@ -1,7 +1,8 @@ /* linuxplay.c - play a sound file on the speaker ** ** Copyright (C) 1995,96 by Markus Gutschke (gutschk@math.uni-muenster.de) - ** This is version 1.3 of linuxplay.c + ** This is version 1.3 of linuxplay.c, with platform-independent functions + ** moved to a different file by Robert Bihlmeyer . ** ** Parts of this code were inspired by sunplay.c, which is copyright 1989 by ** Jef Poskanzer and 1991,92 by Jamie Zawinski; c.f. sunplay.c for further @@ -45,9 +46,6 @@ /* Synched up with: Not in FSF. */ -#define HEADERSZ 256 /* has to be at least as big as the biggest header */ -#define SNDBUFSZ 2048 /* has to be at least as big as HEADERSZ */ - /* XEmacs beta testers say: undef this by default. */ #undef NOVOLUMECTRLFORMULAW /* Changing the volume for uLaw-encoded samples sounds very poor; possibly, @@ -59,6 +57,8 @@ #include #endif +#include "miscplay.h" + #include #include #include SOUNDCARD_H_PATH /* Path computed by configure */ @@ -82,58 +82,14 @@ #define warn(str) message("audio: %s ",GETTEXT(str)) #endif -#ifdef __GNUC__ -#define UNUSED(x) ((void)(x)) -#else -#define UNUSED(x) -#define __inline__ -#endif - static void (*sighup_handler)(int); static void (*sigint_handler)(int); -/* Maintain global variable for keeping parser state information; this struct - is set to zero before the first invocation of the parser. The use of a - global variable prevents multiple concurrent executions of this code, but - this does not happen anyways... */ -enum wvState -{ wvMain, - wvSubchunk, - wvOutOfBlock, - wvSkipChunk, - wvSoundChunk, - wvFatal, - wvFatalNotify -}; - -static union { - struct { - int align; - enum wvState state; - size_t left; - unsigned char leftover[HEADERSZ]; - signed long chunklength; - } wave; - struct { - int align; - int isdata; - int skipping; - size_t left; - unsigned char leftover[HEADERSZ]; - } audio; -} parsestate; - -/* Use a global buffer as scratch-pad for possible conversions of the - sampling format */ -static unsigned char linuxplay_sndbuf[SNDBUFSZ]; - static int mix_fd; static int audio_vol; static int audio_fd; static char *audio_dev = "/dev/dsp"; -typedef enum {fmtIllegal,fmtRaw,fmtVoc,fmtWave,fmtSunAudio} fmtType; - /* Intercept SIGINT and SIGHUP in order to close the audio and mixer devices before terminating sound output; this requires reliable signals as provided by "syssignal.h" */ @@ -156,649 +112,6 @@ static void sighandler(int sig) else exit(1); } -/* There is no special treatment required for parsing raw data files; we - assume that these files contain data in 8bit unsigned format that - has been sampled at 8kHz; there is no extra header */ -static size_t parseraw(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - int rc = *sz; - - *outbuf = *data; - *sz = 0; - return(rc); -} - -/* Currently we cannot cope with files in VOC format; if you really need - to play these files, they should be converted by using SOX */ -static size_t parsevoc(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - UNUSED(data); - UNUSED(sz); - UNUSED(outbuf); - return(0); -} - -/* We need to perform some look-ahead in order to parse files in WAVE format; - this might require re-partioning of the data segments if headers cross the - boundaries between two read operations. This is done in a two-step way: - first we request a certain amount of bytes... */ -static __inline__ int waverequire(void **data,size_t *sz,size_t rq) -{ - int rc = 1; - - if (rq > HEADERSZ) { - warn("Header size exceeded while parsing WAVE file"); - parsestate.wave.state = wvFatal; - *sz = 0; - return(0); } - if ((rq -= parsestate.wave.left) <= 0) - return(rc); - if (rq > *sz) {rq = *sz; rc = 0;} - memcpy(parsestate.wave.leftover+parsestate.wave.left, - *data,rq); - parsestate.wave.left += rq; - (*(unsigned char **)data) += rq; - *sz -= rq; - return(rc); -} - -/* ...and next we remove this many bytes from the buffer */ -static __inline__ void waveremove(size_t rq) -{ - if (parsestate.wave.left <= rq) - parsestate.wave.left = 0; - else { - parsestate.wave.left -= rq; - memmove(parsestate.wave.leftover, - parsestate.wave.leftover+rq, - parsestate.wave.left); } - return; -} - -/* Sound files in WAVE format can contain an arbitrary amount of tagged - chunks; this requires quite some effort for parsing the data */ -static size_t parsewave(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - for (;;) - switch (parsestate.wave.state) { - case wvMain: - if (!waverequire(data,sz,20)) - return(0); - /* Keep compatibility with Linux 68k, etc. by not relying on byte-sex */ - parsestate.wave.chunklength = parsestate.wave.leftover[16] + - 256*(parsestate.wave.leftover[17] + - 256*(parsestate.wave.leftover[18] + - 256*parsestate.wave.leftover[19])); - waveremove(20); - parsestate.wave.state = wvSubchunk; - break; - case wvSubchunk: - if (!waverequire(data,sz,parsestate.wave.chunklength)) - return(0); - parsestate.wave.align = parsestate.wave.chunklength < 14 ? 1 - : parsestate.wave.leftover[12]; - if (parsestate.wave.align != 1 && - parsestate.wave.align != 2 && - parsestate.wave.align != 4) { - warn("Illegal datawidth detected while parsing WAVE file"); - parsestate.wave.state = wvFatal; } - else - parsestate.wave.state = wvOutOfBlock; - waveremove(parsestate.wave.chunklength); - break; - case wvOutOfBlock: - if (!waverequire(data,sz,8)) - return(0); - /* Keep compatibility with Linux 68k, etc. by not relying on byte-sex */ - parsestate.wave.chunklength = parsestate.wave.leftover[4] + - 256*(parsestate.wave.leftover[5] + - 256*(parsestate.wave.leftover[6] + - 256*(parsestate.wave.leftover[7] & 0x7F))); - if (memcmp(parsestate.wave.leftover,"data",4)) - parsestate.wave.state = wvSkipChunk; - else - parsestate.wave.state = wvSoundChunk; - waveremove(8); - break; - case wvSkipChunk: - if (parsestate.wave.chunklength > 0 && *sz > 0 && - (signed long)*sz < (signed long)parsestate.wave.chunklength) { - parsestate.wave.chunklength -= *sz; - *sz = 0; } - else { - if (parsestate.wave.chunklength > 0 && *sz > 0) { - *sz -= parsestate.wave.chunklength; - (*(unsigned char **)data) += parsestate.wave.chunklength; } - parsestate.wave.state = wvOutOfBlock; } - break; - case wvSoundChunk: { - size_t count,rq; - if (parsestate.wave.left) { /* handle leftover bytes from last - alignment operation */ - count = parsestate.wave.left; - rq = HEADERSZ-count; - if (rq > (size_t) parsestate.wave.chunklength) - rq = parsestate.wave.chunklength; - if (!waverequire(data,sz,rq)) { - parsestate.wave.chunklength -= parsestate.wave.left - count; - return(0); } - parsestate.wave.chunklength -= rq; - *outbuf = parsestate.wave.leftover; - parsestate.wave.left = 0; - return(rq); } - if (*sz >= (size_t) parsestate.wave.chunklength) { - count = parsestate.wave.chunklength; - rq = 0; } - else { - count = *sz; - count -= rq = count % parsestate.wave.align; } - *outbuf = *data; - (*(unsigned char **)data) += count; - *sz -= count; - if ((parsestate.wave.chunklength -= count) < parsestate.wave.align) { - parsestate.wave.state = wvOutOfBlock; - /* Some broken software (e.g. SOX) attaches junk to the end of a sound - chunk; so, let's ignore this... */ - if (parsestate.wave.chunklength) - parsestate.wave.state = wvSkipChunk; } - else if (rq) - /* align data length to a multiple of datasize; keep additional data - in "leftover" buffer --- this is necessary to ensure proper - functioning of the sndcnv... routines */ - waverequire(data,sz,rq); - return(count); } - case wvFatalNotify: - warn("Irrecoverable error while parsing WAVE file"); - parsestate.wave.state = wvFatal; - break; - case wvFatal: - default: - *sz = 0; - return(0); } -} - -/* Strip the header from files in Sun/DEC audio format; this requires some - extra processing as the header can be an arbitrary size and it might - result in alignment errors for subsequent conversions --- thus we do - some buffering, where needed */ -static size_t parsesundecaudio(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - /* There is data left over from the last invocation of this function; join - it with the new data and return a sound chunk that is as big as a - single entry */ - if (parsestate.audio.left) { - if (parsestate.audio.left + *sz > (size_t) parsestate.audio.align) { - int count; - memmove(parsestate.audio.leftover + parsestate.audio.left, - *data, - count = parsestate.audio.align - parsestate.audio.left); - *outbuf = parsestate.audio.leftover; - *sz -= count; - *data = (*(char **)data) + count; - parsestate.audio.left = 0; - return(parsestate.audio.align); } - else { - /* We need even more data in order to get one complete single entry! */ - memmove(parsestate.audio.leftover + parsestate.audio.left, - *data, - *sz); - *data = (*(char **)data) + *sz; - parsestate.audio.left += *sz; - *sz = 0; - return(0); } } - - /* This is the main sound chunk, strip of any extra data that does not fit - the alignment requirements and move these bytes into the leftover buffer*/ - if (parsestate.audio.isdata) { - int rc = *sz; - *outbuf = *data; - if ((parsestate.audio.left = rc % parsestate.audio.align) != 0) { - memmove(parsestate.audio.leftover, - (char *)*outbuf + rc - parsestate.audio.left, - parsestate.audio.left); - rc -= parsestate.audio.left; } - *sz = 0; - return(rc); } - - /* This is the first invocation of this function; we need to parse the - header information and determine how many bytes we need to skip until - the start of the sound chunk */ - if (!parsestate.audio.skipping) { - unsigned char *header = (unsigned char *) *data; - if (*sz < 8) { - warn("Irrecoverable error while parsing Sun/DEC audio file"); - return(0); } - /* Keep compatibility with Linux 68k, etc. by not relying on byte-sex */ - if (header[3]) { /* Sun audio (big endian) */ - parsestate.audio.align = ((header[15] > 2)+1)*header[23]; - parsestate.audio.skipping = header[7]+256*(header[6]+256* - (header[5]+256*header[4])); } - else { /* DEC audio (little endian) */ - parsestate.audio.align = ((header[12] > 2)+1)*header[20]; - parsestate.audio.skipping = header[4]+256*(header[5]+256* - (header[6]+256*header[7])); }} - - /* We are skipping extra data that has been attached to header; most usually - this will be just a comment, such as the original filename and/or the - creation date. Make sure that we do not return less than one single sound - sample entry to the caller; if this happens, rather decide to move those - few bytes into the leftover buffer and deal with it later */ - if (*sz >= (size_t) parsestate.audio.skipping) { - /* Skip just the header information and return the sound chunk */ - int rc = *sz - parsestate.audio.skipping; - *outbuf = (char *)*data + parsestate.audio.skipping; - if ((parsestate.audio.left = rc % parsestate.audio.align) != 0) { - memmove(parsestate.audio.leftover, - (char *)*outbuf + rc - parsestate.audio.left, - parsestate.audio.left); - rc -= parsestate.audio.left; } - *sz = 0; - parsestate.audio.skipping = 0; - parsestate.audio.isdata++; - return(rc); } - else { - /* Skip everything */ - parsestate.audio.skipping -= *sz; - return(0); } -} - -/* If the soundcard could not be set to natively support the data format, we - try to do some limited on-the-fly conversion to a different format; if - no conversion is needed, though, we can output directly */ -static size_t sndcnvnop(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - int rc = *sz; - - *outbuf = *data; - *sz = 0; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 8 bit unsigned stereo data to 8 bit unsigned mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv8U_2mono(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(((int)*(src)++ + - (int)*(src)++) / 2); - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 8 bit signed stereo data to 8 bit signed mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv8S_2mono(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc, count; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(((int)*((signed char *)(src++)) + - (int)*((signed char *)(src++))) / 2); - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 8 bit signed stereo data to 8 bit unsigned mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv2monounsigned(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(((int)*((signed char *)(src++)) + - (int)*((signed char *)(src++))) / 2) ^ 0x80; - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 8 bit signed mono data to 8 bit unsigned mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv2unsigned(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) - *dest++ = *(src)++ ^ 0x80; - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert a number in the range -32768..32767 to an 8 bit ulaw encoded - number --- I hope, I got this conversion right :-) */ -static __inline__ signed char int2ulaw(int i) -{ - /* Lookup table for fast calculation of number of bits that need shifting*/ - static short int t_bits[128] = { - 0,1,2,2,3,3,3,3,4,4,4,4,4,4,4,4,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5,5, - 6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6,6, - 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7, - 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7}; - REGISTER int bits,logi; - - /* unrolling this condition (hopefully) improves execution speed */ - if (i < 0) { - if ((i = (132-i)) > 0x7FFF) i = 0x7FFF; - logi = (i >> ((bits = t_bits[i/256])+4)); - return((bits << 4 | logi) ^ 0x7F); } - else { - if ((i = 132+i) > 0x7FFF) i = 0x7FFF; - logi = (i >> ((bits = t_bits[i/256])+4)); - return(~(bits << 4 | logi)); } -} - -/* Convert 8 bit ulaw stereo data to 8 bit ulaw mono data */ -static size_t sndcnvULaw_2mono(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - - static short int ulaw2int[256] = { - /* Precomputed lookup table for conversion from ulaw to 15 bit signed */ - -16062,-15550,-15038,-14526,-14014,-13502,-12990,-12478, - -11966,-11454,-10942,-10430, -9918, -9406, -8894, -8382, - -7998, -7742, -7486, -7230, -6974, -6718, -6462, -6206, - -5950, -5694, -5438, -5182, -4926, -4670, -4414, -4158, - -3966, -3838, -3710, -3582, -3454, -3326, -3198, -3070, - -2942, -2814, -2686, -2558, -2430, -2302, -2174, -2046, - -1950, -1886, -1822, -1758, -1694, -1630, -1566, -1502, - -1438, -1374, -1310, -1246, -1182, -1118, -1054, -990, - -942, -910, -878, -846, -814, -782, -750, -718, - -686, -654, -622, -590, -558, -526, -494, -462, - -438, -422, -406, -390, -374, -358, -342, -326, - -310, -294, -278, -262, -246, -230, -214, -198, - -186, -178, -170, -162, -154, -146, -138, -130, - -122, -114, -106, -98, -90, -82, -74, -66, - -60, -56, -52, -48, -44, -40, -36, -32, - -28, -24, -20, -16, -12, -8, -4, +0, - +16062,+15550,+15038,+14526,+14014,+13502,+12990,+12478, - +11966,+11454,+10942,+10430, +9918, +9406, +8894, +8382, - +7998, +7742, +7486, +7230, +6974, +6718, +6462, +6206, - +5950, +5694, +5438, +5182, +4926, +4670, +4414, +4158, - +3966, +3838, +3710, +3582, +3454, +3326, +3198, +3070, - +2942, +2814, +2686, +2558, +2430, +2302, +2174, +2046, - +1950, +1886, +1822, +1758, +1694, +1630, +1566, +1502, - +1438, +1374, +1310, +1246, +1182, +1118, +1054, +990, - +942, +910, +878, +846, +814, +782, +750, +718, - +686, +654, +622, +590, +558, +526, +494, +462, - +438, +422, +406, +390, +374, +358, +342, +326, - +310, +294, +278, +262, +246, +230, +214, +198, - +186, +178, +170, +162, +154, +146, +138, +130, - +122, +114, +106, +98, +90, +82, +74, +66, - +60, +56, +52, +48, +44, +40, +36, +32, - +28, +24, +20, +16, +12, +8, +4, +0}; - - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) - /* it is not possible to directly interpolate between two ulaw encoded - data bytes, thus we need to convert to linear format first and later - we convert back to ulaw format */ - *dest++ = int2ulaw(ulaw2int[*(src)++] + - ulaw2int[*(src)++]); - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 16 bit little endian signed stereo data to 16 bit little endian - signed mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv16_2monoLE(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - signed short i; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - for (count /= 2; count--; ) { - i = ((int)(src[0]) + - 256*(int)(src[1]) + - (int)(src[2]) + - 256*(int)(src[3])) / 2; - src += 4; - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(i & 0xFF); - *dest++ = (unsigned char)((i / 256) & 0xFF); } - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 16 bit big endian signed stereo data to 16 bit big endian - signed mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv16_2monoBE(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - signed short i; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - for (count /= 2; count--; ) { - i = ((int)(src[1]) + - 256*(int)(src[0]) + - (int)(src[3]) + - 256*(int)(src[2])) / 2; - src += 4; - *dest++ = (unsigned char)((i / 256) & 0xFF); - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(i & 0xFF); } - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 16 bit little endian signed data to 8 bit unsigned data */ -static size_t sndcnv2byteLE(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) { - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(((signed char *)src)[1] ^ (signed char)0x80); - src += 2; - } - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 16 bit big endian signed data to 8 bit unsigned data */ -static size_t sndcnv2byteBE(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz / 2; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 2*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) { - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(((signed char *)src)[0] ^ (signed char)0x80); - src += 2; - } - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 16 bit little endian signed stereo data to 8 bit unsigned - mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv2monobyteLE(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz / 4; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 4*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) { - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(((int)((signed char *)src)[1] + - (int)((signed char *)src)[3]) / 2 ^ 0x80); - src += 4; - } - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Convert 16 bit big endian signed stereo data to 8 bit unsigned - mono data */ -static size_t sndcnv2monobyteBE(void **data,size_t *sz,void **outbuf) -{ - REGISTER unsigned char *src; - REGISTER unsigned char *dest; - int rc,count; - - count = *sz / 4; - if (count > SNDBUFSZ) { *sz -= 4*SNDBUFSZ; count = SNDBUFSZ; } - else *sz = 0; - rc = count; - src = (unsigned char *) *data; - *outbuf = - dest = linuxplay_sndbuf; - while (count--) { - *dest++ = (unsigned char)(((int)((signed char *)src)[0] + - (int)((signed char *)src)[2]) / 2 ^ 0x80); - src += 4; - } - *data = src; - return(rc); -} - -/* Look at the header of the sound file and try to determine the format; - we can recognize files in VOC, WAVE, and, Sun/DEC-audio format--- everything - else is assumed to be raw 8 bit unsigned data sampled at 8kHz */ -static fmtType analyze_format(unsigned char *format,int *fmt,int *speed, - int *tracks, - size_t (**parsesndfile)(void **,size_t *sz, - void **)) -{ - /* Keep compatibility with Linux 68k, etc. by not relying on byte-sex */ - if (!memcmp(format,"Creative Voice File\x1A\x1A\x00",22) && - (format[22]+256*format[23]) == - ((0x1233-format[24]-256*format[25])&0xFFFF)) { /* VOC */ - *fmt = AFMT_U8; - *speed = 8000; - *tracks = 2; - *parsesndfile = parsevoc; - return(fmtVoc); } - else if (!memcmp(format,"RIFF",4) && - !memcmp(format+8,"WAVEfmt ",8)) { /* WAVE */ - if (memcmp(format+20,"\001\000\001"/* PCM mono */,4) && - memcmp(format+20,"\001\000\002"/* PCM stereo */,4)) - return(fmtIllegal); - *fmt = (format[32]/(*tracks = format[22])) == 1 ? - AFMT_U8 : AFMT_S16_LE; - /* Keep compatibility with Linux 68k, etc. by not relying on byte-sex */ - *speed = format[24]+256*(format[25]+256* - (format[26]+256*format[27])); - *parsesndfile = parsewave; - return(fmtWave); } - else if (!memcmp(format,".snd",4)) { /* Sun Audio (big endian) */ - if (format[7]+256*(format[6]+256*(format[5]+256*format[4])) < 24) { - *fmt = AFMT_MU_LAW; - *speed = 8000; - *tracks = 1; - *parsesndfile = parsesundecaudio; - return(fmtSunAudio); } - if (!memcmp(format+12,"\000\000\000\001",4)) *fmt = AFMT_MU_LAW; - else if (!memcmp(format+12,"\000\000\000\002",4)) *fmt = AFMT_S8; - else if (!memcmp(format+12,"\000\000\000\003",4)) *fmt = AFMT_S16_BE; - else return(fmtIllegal); - /* Keep compatibility with Linux 68k, etc. by not relying on byte-sex */ - *speed = format[19]+256*(format[18]+256* - (format[17]+256*format[16])); - *tracks = format[23]; - *parsesndfile = parsesundecaudio; - return(fmtSunAudio); } - else if (!memcmp(format,".sd",4)) { /* DEC Audio (little endian) */ - if (format[4]+256*(format[5]+256*(format[6]+256*format[7])) < 24) { - *fmt = AFMT_MU_LAW; - *speed = 8000; - *tracks = 1; - *parsesndfile = parsesundecaudio; - return(fmtSunAudio); } - if (!memcmp(format+12,"\001\000\000",4)) *fmt = AFMT_MU_LAW; - else if (!memcmp(format+12,"\002\000\000",4)) *fmt = AFMT_S8; - else if (!memcmp(format+12,"\003\000\000",4)) *fmt = AFMT_S16_LE; - else return(fmtIllegal); - /* Keep compatibility with Linux 68k, etc. by not relying on byte-sex */ - *speed = format[16]+256*(format[17]+256* - (format[18]+256*format[19])); - *tracks = format[20]; - *parsesndfile = parsesundecaudio; - return(fmtSunAudio); } - else { - *fmt = AFMT_U8; - *speed = 8000; - *tracks = 1; - *parsesndfile = parseraw; - return(fmtRaw); } -} - /* Initialize the soundcard and mixer device with the parameters that we found in the header of the sound file. If the soundcard is not capable of natively supporting the required parameters, then try to set up conversion @@ -973,16 +286,17 @@ static void linux_play_data_or_file(int fd,unsigned char *data, int fmt,speed,tracks; unsigned char *pptr,*optr,*cptr,*sptr; int wrtn,rrtn,crtn,prtn; + unsigned char sndbuf[SNDBUFSZ]; /* We need to read at least the header information before we can start doing anything */ if (!data || length < HEADERSZ) { if (fd < 0) return; else { - length = read(fd,linuxplay_sndbuf,SNDBUFSZ); + length = read(fd,sndbuf,SNDBUFSZ); if (length < HEADERSZ) return; - data = linuxplay_sndbuf; + data = sndbuf; length = SNDBUFSZ; } } @@ -1010,8 +324,7 @@ static void linux_play_data_or_file(int fd,unsigned char *data, goto END_OF_PLAY; audio_vol = volume; - /* Initialize global parser state information to zero */ - memset(&parsestate,0,sizeof(parsestate)); + reset_parsestate(); /* Mainloop: read a block of data, parse its contents, perform all the necessary conversions and output it to the sound @@ -1034,17 +347,15 @@ static void linux_play_data_or_file(int fd,unsigned char *data, warn(buf); goto END_OF_PLAY; } } if (fd >= 0) { - if ((rrtn = read(fd,linuxplay_sndbuf,SNDBUFSZ)) < 0) { + if ((rrtn = read(fd,sndbuf,SNDBUFSZ)) < 0) { perror("read"); goto END_OF_PLAY; } } else break; } while (rrtn > 0); - /* Verify that we could fully parse the entire soundfile; this is needed - only for files in WAVE format */ - if (ffmt == fmtWave && parsestate.wave.state != wvOutOfBlock && - parsestate.wave.state != wvFatal) - warn("Unexpected end of WAVE file"); + if (ffmt == fmtWave) + parse_wave_complete(); + END_OF_PLAY: /* Now cleanup all used resources */ diff --git a/src/lisp.h b/src/lisp.h index 3831e32..c827371 100644 --- a/src/lisp.h +++ b/src/lisp.h @@ -40,10 +40,7 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ #include #include #include /* offsetof */ - -#ifdef __lucid -# include -#endif +#include /* ---- Dynamic arrays ---- */ @@ -1122,7 +1119,7 @@ set_bit_vector_bit (Lisp_Bit_Vector *v, size_t n, int value) /* Number of longs required to hold LEN bits */ #define BIT_VECTOR_LONG_STORAGE(len) \ - ((len + LONGBITS_POWER_OF_2 - 1) >> LONGBITS_LOG2) + (((len) + LONGBITS_POWER_OF_2 - 1) >> LONGBITS_LOG2) /*********** symbol ***********/ @@ -2135,7 +2132,7 @@ Lisp_Object emacs_doprnt_string_lisp_2 (CONST Bufbyte *, Lisp_Object, /* Defined in editfns.c */ void uncache_home_directory (void); char *get_home_directory (void); -char *user_login_name (int *); +char *user_login_name (uid_t *); Bufpos bufpos_clip_to_bounds (Bufpos, Bufpos, Bufpos); Bytind bytind_clip_to_bounds (Bytind, Bytind, Bytind); void buffer_insert1 (struct buffer *, Lisp_Object); @@ -2313,8 +2310,8 @@ void maybe_signal_double_file_error_2 (CONST char *, CONST char *, Error_behavior); Lisp_Object lisp_strerror (int); Lisp_Object expand_and_dir_to_file (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object); -int read_allowing_quit (int, void *, size_t); -int write_allowing_quit (int, CONST void *, size_t); +ssize_t read_allowing_quit (int, void *, size_t); +ssize_t write_allowing_quit (int, CONST void *, size_t); int internal_delete_file (Lisp_Object); /* Defined in filelock.c */ @@ -2622,6 +2619,7 @@ EXFUN (Fdefault_boundp, 1); EXFUN (Fdefault_value, 1); EXFUN (Fdefine_key, 3); EXFUN (Fdelete_region, 3); +EXFUN (Fdelete_process, 1); EXFUN (Fdelq, 2); EXFUN (Fdestructive_alist_to_plist, 1); EXFUN (Fdetect_coding_region, 3); diff --git a/src/lread.c b/src/lread.c index 08c6c79..a92fc18 100644 --- a/src/lread.c +++ b/src/lread.c @@ -903,17 +903,18 @@ locate_file_find_directory_hash_table (Lisp_Object directory) nil, a list, or a string (for backward compatibility), with the following semantics: - a) nil - no suffix, just search for file name intact (semantically - different from "empty suffix list") + a) nil - no suffix, just search for file name intact + (semantically different from "empty suffix list", which + would be meaningless.) b) list - list of suffixes to append to file name. Each of these must be a string. c) string - colon-separated suffixes to append to file name (backward compatibility). - All of this got hairy, so I decided to use write a mapper. Calling - a function for each suffix shouldn't slow things down, since - locate_file is rarely call with enough suffixes for it to make a - difference. */ + All of this got hairy, so I decided to use a mapper. Calling a + function for each suffix shouldn't slow things down, since + locate_file is rarely called with enough suffixes for funcalls to + make any difference. */ /* Map FUN over SUFFIXES, as described above. FUN will be called with a char * containing the current file name, and ARG. Mapping stops when diff --git a/src/lstream.c b/src/lstream.c index d7c4f70..9ecce37 100644 --- a/src/lstream.c +++ b/src/lstream.c @@ -95,12 +95,12 @@ int Lstream_fgetc (Lstream *stream) void Lstream_fungetc (Lstream *stream, int c) Function equivalents of the above macros. -int Lstream_read (Lstream *stream, void *data, size_t size) +ssize_t Lstream_read (Lstream *stream, void *data, size_t size) Read SIZE bytes of DATA from the stream. Return the number of bytes read. 0 means EOF. -1 means an error occurred and no bytes were read. -int Lstream_write (Lstream *stream, void *data, size_t size) +ssize_t Lstream_write (Lstream *stream, void *data, size_t size) Write SIZE bytes of DATA to the stream. Return the number of bytes written. -1 means an error occurred and no bytes were written. @@ -302,11 +302,11 @@ Lstream_reopen (Lstream *lstr) int Lstream_flush_out (Lstream *lstr) { - int num_written; + ssize_t num_written; while (lstr->out_buffer_ind > 0) { - int size = lstr->out_buffer_ind; + size_t size = lstr->out_buffer_ind; if (! (lstr->flags & LSTREAM_FL_IS_OPEN)) Lstream_internal_error ("lstream not open", lstr); if (! (lstr->flags & LSTREAM_FL_WRITE)) @@ -347,7 +347,7 @@ Lstream_flush_out (Lstream *lstr) the attempt to write the data might have resulted in an EWOULDBLOCK error. */ return 0; - else if (num_written >= (int) lstr->out_buffer_ind) + else if (num_written >= lstr->out_buffer_ind) lstr->out_buffer_ind = 0; else if (num_written > 0) { @@ -389,7 +389,7 @@ Lstream_flush (Lstream *lstr) if it's getting EWOULDBLOCK errors. We have to keep stocking them up until they can be written, so as to avoid losing data. */ -static int +static size_t Lstream_adding (Lstream *lstr, size_t num, int force) { /* Compute the size that the outbuffer needs to be after the @@ -409,11 +409,11 @@ Lstream_adding (Lstream *lstr, size_t num, int force) /* Like Lstream_write(), but does not handle line-buffering correctly. */ -static int +static ssize_t Lstream_write_1 (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size) { CONST unsigned char *p = (CONST unsigned char *) data; - int off = 0; + ssize_t off = 0; if (! (lstr->flags & LSTREAM_FL_IS_OPEN)) Lstream_internal_error ("lstream not open", lstr); if (! (lstr->flags & LSTREAM_FL_WRITE)) @@ -424,7 +424,7 @@ Lstream_write_1 (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size) while (1) { /* Figure out how much we can add to the buffer */ - int chunk = Lstream_adding (lstr, size, 0); + size_t chunk = Lstream_adding (lstr, size, 0); if (chunk == 0) { if (couldnt_write_last_time) @@ -469,17 +469,17 @@ Lstream_write_1 (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size) repeatedly call Lstream_putc(), which knows how to handle line buffering. */ -int +ssize_t Lstream_write (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size) { - int i; + size_t i; CONST unsigned char *p = (CONST unsigned char *) data; if (size == 0) return size; if (lstr->buffering != LSTREAM_LINE_BUFFERED) return Lstream_write_1 (lstr, data, size); - for (i = 0; i < (int) size; i++) + for (i = 0; i < size; i++) { if (Lstream_putc (lstr, p[i]) < 0) break; @@ -490,10 +490,7 @@ Lstream_write (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size) int Lstream_was_blocked_p (Lstream *lstr) { - if (lstr->imp->was_blocked_p) - return (lstr->imp->was_blocked_p) (lstr); - else - return 0; + return lstr->imp->was_blocked_p ? lstr->imp->was_blocked_p (lstr) : 0; } static int @@ -511,16 +508,16 @@ Lstream_raw_read (Lstream *lstr, unsigned char *buffer, size_t size) /* Assuming the buffer is empty, fill it up again. */ -static int +static ssize_t Lstream_read_more (Lstream *lstr) { #if 0 - int size_needed = max (1, min (MAX_READ_SIZE, lstr->buffering_size)); + ssize_t size_needed = max (1, min (MAX_READ_SIZE, lstr->buffering_size)); #else /* If someone requested a larger buffer size, so be it! */ - int size_needed = max (1, lstr->buffering_size); + ssize_t size_needed = max (1, lstr->buffering_size); #endif - int size_gotten; + ssize_t size_gotten; DO_REALLOC (lstr->in_buffer, lstr->in_buffer_size, size_needed, unsigned char); @@ -530,11 +527,11 @@ Lstream_read_more (Lstream *lstr) return size_gotten < 0 ? -1 : size_gotten; } -int +ssize_t Lstream_read (Lstream *lstr, void *data, size_t size) { unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *) data; - int off = 0; + size_t off = 0; size_t chunk; int error_occurred = 0; @@ -546,7 +543,7 @@ Lstream_read (Lstream *lstr, void *data, size_t size) if (chunk > 0) { /* The bytes come back in reverse order. */ - for (; off < (int) chunk; off++) + for (; off < chunk; off++) p[off] = lstr->unget_buffer[--lstr->unget_buffer_ind]; lstr->byte_count += chunk; size -= chunk; @@ -568,7 +565,7 @@ Lstream_read (Lstream *lstr, void *data, size_t size) /* If we need some more, try to get some more from the stream's end */ if (size > 0) { - int retval = Lstream_read_more (lstr); + ssize_t retval = Lstream_read_more (lstr); if (retval < 0) error_occurred = 1; if (retval <= 0) @@ -592,7 +589,7 @@ Lstream_read (Lstream *lstr, void *data, size_t size) VALIDATE_CHARPTR_BACKWARD (dataend); if (dataend + REP_BYTES_BY_FIRST_BYTE (*dataend) != p + off) { - int newoff = dataend - p; + size_t newoff = dataend - p; /* If not, chop the size down to ignore the last char and stash it away for next time. */ Lstream_unread (lstr, dataend, off - newoff); @@ -601,25 +598,24 @@ Lstream_read (Lstream *lstr, void *data, size_t size) } } - return ((off == 0 && error_occurred) ? -1 : off); + return off == 0 && error_occurred ? -1 : (ssize_t) off; } void Lstream_unread (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size) { - int i; - unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *) data; + CONST unsigned char *p = (CONST unsigned char *) data; /* Make sure buffer is big enough */ - DO_REALLOC (lstr->unget_buffer, lstr->unget_buffer_size, lstr->unget_buffer_ind + size, unsigned char); + lstr->byte_count -= size; + /* Bytes have to go on in reverse order -- they are reversed again when read back. */ - for (i = size - 1; i >= 0; i--) - lstr->unget_buffer[lstr->unget_buffer_ind++] = p[i]; - lstr->byte_count -= size; + while (size--) + lstr->unget_buffer[lstr->unget_buffer_ind++] = p[size]; } int @@ -646,15 +642,11 @@ Lstream_seekable_p (Lstream *lstr) static int Lstream_pseudo_close (Lstream *lstr) { - int rc; - if (!lstr->flags & LSTREAM_FL_IS_OPEN) Lstream_internal_error ("lstream is not open", lstr); /* don't check errors here -- best not to risk file descriptor loss */ - rc = Lstream_flush (lstr); - - return rc; + return Lstream_flush (lstr); } int @@ -729,7 +721,7 @@ int Lstream_fputc (Lstream *lstr, int c) { unsigned char ch = (unsigned char) c; - int retval = Lstream_write_1 (lstr, &ch, 1); + ssize_t retval = Lstream_write_1 (lstr, &ch, 1); if (retval >= 0 && lstr->buffering == LSTREAM_LINE_BUFFERED && ch == '\n') return Lstream_flush_out (lstr); return retval < 0 ? -1 : 0; @@ -792,24 +784,42 @@ make_stdio_output_stream (FILE *stream, int flags) return make_stdio_stream_1 (stream, flags, "w"); } -static int +/* #### From reading the Unix 98 specification, it appears that if we + want stdio_reader() to be completely correct, we should check for + 0 < val < size and if so, check to see if an error has occurred. + If an error has occurred, but val is non-zero, we should go ahead + and act as if the read was successful, but remember in some fashion + or other, that an error has occurred, and report that on the next + call to stdio_reader instead of calling fread() again. + + Currently, in such a case, we end up calling fread() twice and we + assume that + + 1) this is not harmful, and + 2) the error will still be reported on the second read. + + This is probably reasonable, so I don't think we should change this + code (it could even be argued that the error might have fixed + itself, so we should do the fread() again. */ + +static ssize_t stdio_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct stdio_stream *str = STDIO_STREAM_DATA (stream); - size_t val = fread (data, 1, (size_t) size, str->file); + size_t val = fread (data, 1, size, str->file); if (!val && ferror (str->file)) return -1; - return (int) val; + return val; } -static int +static ssize_t stdio_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct stdio_stream *str = STDIO_STREAM_DATA (stream); size_t val = fwrite (data, 1, size, str->file); if (!val && ferror (str->file)) return -1; - return (int) val; + return val; } static int @@ -837,9 +847,6 @@ stdio_flusher (Lstream *stream) if (stream->flags & LSTREAM_FL_WRITE) return fflush (str->file); else - /* call fpurge? Only exists on some systems. #### Why not add a - configure check for HAVE_FPURGE and utilize it on systems that - support it? --hniksic */ return 0; } @@ -853,7 +860,6 @@ stdio_closer (Lstream *stream) if (stream->flags & LSTREAM_FL_WRITE) return fflush (str->file); else - /* call fpurge? Only exists on some systems. */ return 0; } @@ -921,10 +927,10 @@ make_filedesc_output_stream (int filedesc, int offset, int count, int flags) return make_filedesc_stream_1 (filedesc, offset, count, flags, "w"); } -static int +static ssize_t filedesc_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { - int nread; + ssize_t nread; struct filedesc_stream *str = FILEDESC_STREAM_DATA (stream); if (str->end_pos >= 0) size = min (size, (size_t) (str->end_pos - str->current_pos)); @@ -948,11 +954,11 @@ errno_would_block_p (int val) return 0; } -static int +static ssize_t filedesc_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct filedesc_stream *str = FILEDESC_STREAM_DATA (stream); - int retval; + ssize_t retval; int need_newline = 0; /* This function would be simple if it were not for the blasted @@ -1005,8 +1011,8 @@ filedesc_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) out for EWOULDBLOCK. */ if (str->chars_sans_newline >= str->pty_max_bytes) { - int retval2 = ((str->allow_quit ? write_allowing_quit : write) - (str->fd, &str->eof_char, 1)); + ssize_t retval2 = ((str->allow_quit ? write_allowing_quit : write) + (str->fd, &str->eof_char, 1)); if (retval2 > 0) str->chars_sans_newline = 0; else if (retval2 < 0) @@ -1036,8 +1042,8 @@ filedesc_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) if (need_newline) { Bufbyte nl = '\n'; - int retval2 = ((str->allow_quit ? write_allowing_quit : write) - (str->fd, &nl, 1)); + ssize_t retval2 = ((str->allow_quit ? write_allowing_quit : write) + (str->fd, &nl, 1)); if (retval2 > 0) { str->chars_sans_newline = 0; @@ -1170,7 +1176,7 @@ make_lisp_string_input_stream (Lisp_Object string, Bytecount offset, return obj; } -static int +static ssize_t lisp_string_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct lisp_string_stream *str = LISP_STRING_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -1260,7 +1266,7 @@ make_fixed_buffer_output_stream (unsigned char *buf, size_t size) return obj; } -static int +static ssize_t fixed_buffer_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct fixed_buffer_stream *str = FIXED_BUFFER_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -1270,7 +1276,7 @@ fixed_buffer_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) return size; } -static int +static ssize_t fixed_buffer_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct fixed_buffer_stream *str = FIXED_BUFFER_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -1332,7 +1338,7 @@ make_resizing_buffer_output_stream (void) return obj; } -static int +static ssize_t resizing_buffer_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct resizing_buffer_stream *str = RESIZING_BUFFER_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -1394,7 +1400,7 @@ make_dynarr_output_stream (unsigned_char_dynarr *dyn) return obj; } -static int +static ssize_t dynarr_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct dynarr_stream *str = DYNARR_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -1518,7 +1524,7 @@ make_lisp_buffer_output_stream (struct buffer *buf, Bufpos pos, int flags) return lstr; } -static int +static ssize_t lisp_buffer_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct lisp_buffer_stream *str = LISP_BUFFER_STREAM_DATA (stream); @@ -1576,7 +1582,7 @@ lisp_buffer_reader (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size) return data - orig_data; } -static int +static ssize_t lisp_buffer_writer (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size) { struct lisp_buffer_stream *str = LISP_BUFFER_STREAM_DATA (stream); diff --git a/src/lstream.h b/src/lstream.h index 357c820..1108045 100644 --- a/src/lstream.h +++ b/src/lstream.h @@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ typedef struct lstream_implementation /* The omniscient mly, blinded by the irresistable thrall of Common Lisp, thinks that it is bogus that the types and implementations of input and output streams are the same. */ - int (*reader) (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size); + ssize_t (*reader) (Lstream *stream, unsigned char *data, size_t size); /* Send some data to the stream's end. Data to be sent is in DATA and is SIZE bytes. Return the number of bytes sent. This function can send and return fewer bytes than is passed in; in @@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ typedef struct lstream_implementation data. (This is useful, e.g., of you're dealing with a non-blocking file descriptor and are getting EWOULDBLOCK errors.) This function can be NULL if the stream is input-only. */ - int (*writer) (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size); + ssize_t (*writer) (Lstream *stream, CONST unsigned char *data, size_t size); /* Return non-zero if the last write operation on the stream resulted in an attempt to block (EWOULDBLOCK). If this method does not exists, the implementation returns 0 */ @@ -209,8 +209,8 @@ int Lstream_flush_out (Lstream *lstr); int Lstream_fputc (Lstream *lstr, int c); int Lstream_fgetc (Lstream *lstr); void Lstream_fungetc (Lstream *lstr, int c); -int Lstream_read (Lstream *lstr, void *data, size_t size); -int Lstream_write (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size); +ssize_t Lstream_read (Lstream *lstr, void *data, size_t size); +ssize_t Lstream_write (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size); int Lstream_was_blocked_p (Lstream *lstr); void Lstream_unread (Lstream *lstr, CONST void *data, size_t size); int Lstream_rewind (Lstream *lstr); diff --git a/src/make-src-depend b/src/make-src-depend index 4f604f4..a112b6a 100644 --- a/src/make-src-depend +++ b/src/make-src-depend @@ -29,8 +29,7 @@ my ($myName, $srcdir, %exists, %uses, %generated_header); Usage: $myName Generates Makefile dependencies for the XEmacs src directory. -The dependencies are written to stdout. -"; +The dependencies are written to stdout.\n"; die $usage if @ARGV; diff --git a/src/md5.c b/src/md5.c index acb9f0d..775942a 100644 --- a/src/md5.c +++ b/src/md5.c @@ -582,8 +582,8 @@ file-coding or Mule support. Otherwise, they are ignored. while (1) { Bufbyte tempbuf[1024]; /* some random amount */ - int size_in_bytes = Lstream_read (XLSTREAM (instream), - tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); + ssize_t size_in_bytes = + Lstream_read (XLSTREAM (instream), tempbuf, sizeof (tempbuf)); if (!size_in_bytes) break; diff --git a/src/mule-ccl.c b/src/mule-ccl.c index e84c7e1..7e92134 100644 --- a/src/mule-ccl.c +++ b/src/mule-ccl.c @@ -682,17 +682,27 @@ static tr_stack *mapping_stack_pointer; /* Write a string at ccl_prog[IC] of length LEN to the current output buffer. */ -#define CCL_WRITE_STRING(len) do { \ - if (!destination) \ - { \ - ccl->status = CCL_STAT_INVALID_CMD; \ - goto ccl_error_handler; \ - } \ - else \ - for (i = 0; i < len; i++) \ - Dynarr_add(destination, \ - (XINT (ccl_prog[ic + (i / 3)]) \ - >> ((2 - (i % 3)) * 8)) & 0xFF); \ +#define CCL_WRITE_STRING(len) do { \ + if (!destination) \ + { \ + ccl->status = CCL_STAT_INVALID_CMD; \ + goto ccl_error_handler; \ + } \ + else \ + { \ + Bufbyte work[MAX_EMCHAR_LEN]; \ + for (i = 0; i < len; i++) \ + { \ + int ch = (XINT (ccl_prog[ic + (i / 3)]) \ + >> ((2 - (i % 3)) * 8)) & 0xFF; \ + int bytes = \ + ( ch < ( conversion_mode == CCL_MODE_ENCODING ? \ + 256 : 128 ) ) ? \ + simple_set_charptr_emchar (work, ch) : \ + non_ascii_set_charptr_emchar (work, ch); \ + Dynarr_add_many (destination, work, bytes); \ + } \ + } \ } while (0) /* Read one byte from the current input buffer into Rth register. */ @@ -1838,7 +1848,7 @@ It returns the contents of write buffer as a string, outbuf = Dynarr_new (unsigned_char); ccl.last_block = NILP (contin); produced = ccl_driver (&ccl, XSTRING_DATA (str), outbuf, - XSTRING_LENGTH (str), (int *)0, CCL_MODE_ENCODING); + XSTRING_LENGTH (str), (int *)0, CCL_MODE_DECODING); for (i = 0; i < 8; i++) XVECTOR_DATA (status)[i] = make_int(ccl.reg[i]); XSETINT (XVECTOR_DATA (status)[8], ccl.ic); diff --git a/src/mule-charset.c b/src/mule-charset.c index 5d216a7..b0a60fa 100644 --- a/src/mule-charset.c +++ b/src/mule-charset.c @@ -267,7 +267,8 @@ non_ascii_valid_char_p (Emchar ch) if (f3 < 0x20) return 0; - if (f3 != 0x20 && f3 != 0x7F) + if (f3 != 0x20 && f3 != 0x7F && !(f2 >= MIN_CHAR_FIELD2_PRIVATE && + f2 <= MAX_CHAR_FIELD2_PRIVATE)) return 1; /* @@ -276,6 +277,8 @@ non_ascii_valid_char_p (Emchar ch) FIELD2_TO_PRIVATE_LEADING_BYTE are the same. */ charset = CHARSET_BY_LEADING_BYTE (f2 + FIELD2_TO_OFFICIAL_LEADING_BYTE); + if (EQ (charset, Qnil)) + return 0; return (XCHARSET_CHARS (charset) == 96); } else @@ -300,7 +303,8 @@ non_ascii_valid_char_p (Emchar ch) } #endif /* ENABLE_COMPOSITE_CHARS */ - if (f2 != 0x20 && f2 != 0x7F && f3 != 0x20 && f3 != 0x7F) + if (f2 != 0x20 && f2 != 0x7F && f3 != 0x20 && f3 != 0x7F + && !(f1 >= MIN_CHAR_FIELD1_PRIVATE && f1 <= MAX_CHAR_FIELD1_PRIVATE)) return 1; if (f1 <= MAX_CHAR_FIELD1_OFFICIAL) @@ -310,6 +314,8 @@ non_ascii_valid_char_p (Emchar ch) charset = CHARSET_BY_LEADING_BYTE (f1 + FIELD1_TO_PRIVATE_LEADING_BYTE); + if (EQ (charset, Qnil)) + return 0; return (XCHARSET_CHARS (charset) == 96); } } diff --git a/src/mule-charset.h b/src/mule-charset.h index d46ebac..07f72df 100644 --- a/src/mule-charset.h +++ b/src/mule-charset.h @@ -332,40 +332,48 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ #define LEADING_BYTE_COMPOSITE 0x80 /* for a composite character */ #define LEADING_BYTE_CONTROL_1 0x8F /* represent normal 80-9F */ -/** The following are for 1-byte characters in an official charset. **/ +/* Note the gap in each official charset can cause core dump + as first and last values are used to determine whether + charset is defined or not in non_ascii_valid_char_p */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_1 0x81 /* Right half of ISO 8859-1 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_2 0x82 /* Right half of ISO 8859-2 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_3 0x83 /* Right half of ISO 8859-3 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_4 0x84 /* Right half of ISO 8859-4 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_THAI_TIS620 0x85 /* TIS620-2533 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_GREEK_ISO8859_7 0x86 /* Right half of ISO 8859-7 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_ARABIC_ISO8859_6 0x87 /* Right half of ISO 8859-6 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_HEBREW_ISO8859_8 0x88 /* Right half of ISO 8859-8 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_KATAKANA_JISX0201 0x89 /* Right half of JIS X0201-1976 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_JISX0201 0x8A /* Left half of JIS X0201-1976 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_CYRILLIC_ISO8859_5 0x8C /* Right half of ISO 8859-5 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_9 0x8D /* Right half of ISO 8859-9 */ +/** The following are for 1-byte characters in an official charset. **/ +enum LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_1 +{ + LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_1 = 0x81, /* Right half of ISO 8859-1 */ + LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_2, /* 0x82 Right half of ISO 8859-2 */ + LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_3, /* 0x83 Right half of ISO 8859-3 */ + LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_4, /* 0x84 Right half of ISO 8859-4 */ + LEADING_BYTE_THAI_TIS620, /* 0x85 TIS620-2533 */ + LEADING_BYTE_GREEK_ISO8859_7, /* 0x86 Right half of ISO 8859-7 */ + LEADING_BYTE_ARABIC_ISO8859_6, /* 0x87 Right half of ISO 8859-6 */ + LEADING_BYTE_HEBREW_ISO8859_8, /* 0x88 Right half of ISO 8859-8 */ + LEADING_BYTE_KATAKANA_JISX0201, /* 0x89 Right half of JIS X0201-1976 */ + LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_JISX0201, /* 0x8A Left half of JIS X0201-1976 */ + LEADING_BYTE_CYRILLIC_ISO8859_5,/* 0x8B Right half of ISO 8859-5 */ + LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_9 /* 0x8C Right half of ISO 8859-9 */ + /* 0x8D unused */ +}; #define MIN_LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_1 LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_1 #define MAX_LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_1 LEADING_BYTE_LATIN_ISO8859_9 /** The following are for 2-byte characters in an official charset. **/ - -#define LEADING_BYTE_JAPANESE_JISX0208_1978 0x90/* Japanese JIS X0208-1978 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_GB2312 0x91 /* Chinese Hanzi GB2312-1980 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_JAPANESE_JISX0208 0x92 /* Japanese JIS X0208-1983 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_KOREAN_KSC5601 0x93 /* Hangul KS C5601-1987 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_JAPANESE_JISX0212 0x94 /* Japanese JIS X0212-1990 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_CNS11643_1 0x95 /* Chinese CNS11643 Set 1 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_CNS11643_2 0x96 /* Chinese CNS11643 Set 2 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_BIG5_1 0x97 /* Big5 Level 1 */ -#define LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_BIG5_2 0x98 /* Big5 Level 2 */ - /* 0x99 unused */ - /* 0x9A unused */ - /* 0x9B unused */ - /* 0x9C unused */ - /* 0x9D unused */ +enum LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_2 +{ + LEADING_BYTE_JAPANESE_JISX0208_1978 = 0x90, /* Japanese JIS X0208-1978 */ + LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_GB2312, /* 0x91 Chinese Hanzi GB2312-1980 */ + LEADING_BYTE_JAPANESE_JISX0208, /* 0x92 Japanese JIS X0208-1983 */ + LEADING_BYTE_KOREAN_KSC5601, /* 0x93 Hangul KS C5601-1987 */ + LEADING_BYTE_JAPANESE_JISX0212, /* 0x94 Japanese JIS X0212-1990 */ + LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_CNS11643_1, /* 0x95 Chinese CNS11643 Set 1 */ + LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_CNS11643_2, /* 0x96 Chinese CNS11643 Set 2 */ + LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_BIG5_1, /* 0x97 Big5 Level 1 */ + LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_BIG5_2 /* 0x98 Big5 Level 2 */ + /* 0x99 unused */ + /* 0x9A unused */ + /* 0x9B unused */ + /* 0x9C unused */ +}; #define MIN_LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_2 LEADING_BYTE_JAPANESE_JISX0208_1978 #define MAX_LEADING_BYTE_OFFICIAL_2 LEADING_BYTE_CHINESE_BIG5_2 diff --git a/src/nt.c b/src/nt.c index 54e06e1..ce16938 100644 --- a/src/nt.c +++ b/src/nt.c @@ -131,13 +131,13 @@ static struct passwd the_passwd = the_passwd_shell, }; -int +uid_t getuid () { return the_passwd.pw_uid; } -int +uid_t geteuid () { /* I could imagine arguing for checking to see whether the user is @@ -146,20 +146,20 @@ geteuid () return getuid (); } -int +gid_t getgid () { return the_passwd.pw_gid; } -int +gid_t getegid () { return getgid (); } struct passwd * -getpwuid (int uid) +getpwuid (uid_t uid) { if (uid == the_passwd.pw_uid) return &the_passwd; diff --git a/src/process-nt.c b/src/process-nt.c index 0b92984..2a61346 100644 --- a/src/process-nt.c +++ b/src/process-nt.c @@ -705,7 +705,7 @@ nt_send_process (Lisp_Object proc, struct lstream* lstream) while (1) { - int writeret; + ssize_t writeret; chunklen = Lstream_read (lstream, chunkbuf, 128); if (chunklen <= 0) diff --git a/src/process-unix.c b/src/process-unix.c index b4a612e..85539ed 100644 --- a/src/process-unix.c +++ b/src/process-unix.c @@ -1142,7 +1142,7 @@ unix_send_process (Lisp_Object proc, struct lstream* lstream) while (1) { - int writeret; + ssize_t writeret; chunklen = Lstream_read (lstream, chunkbuf, 512); if (chunklen <= 0) diff --git a/src/process.c b/src/process.c index 9b73e80..4d20fad 100644 --- a/src/process.c +++ b/src/process.c @@ -147,10 +147,10 @@ print_process (Lisp_Object obj, Lisp_Object printcharfun, int escapeflag) else { int netp = network_connection_p (obj); - write_c_string (((netp) ? GETTEXT ("#name, printcharfun, 1); - write_c_string (((netp) ? " " : " pid "), printcharfun); + write_c_string ((netp ? " " : " pid "), printcharfun); print_internal (proc->pid, printcharfun, 1); write_c_string (" state:", printcharfun); print_internal (proc->status_symbol, printcharfun, 1); diff --git a/src/redisplay-output.c b/src/redisplay-output.c index 06b78b3..5b8228c 100644 --- a/src/redisplay-output.c +++ b/src/redisplay-output.c @@ -190,6 +190,27 @@ compare_runes (struct window *w, struct rune *crb, struct rune *drb) /* Do not compare the values of bufpos and endpos. They do not affect the display characteristics. */ + /* Note: (hanoi 6) spends 95% of its time in redisplay, and about + 30% here. Not using bitfields for rune.type alone gives a redisplay + speed up of 10%. + + #### In profile arcs run of a normal Gnus session this function + is run 6.76 million times, only to return 1 in 6.73 million of + those. + + In addition a quick look GCC sparc assembly shows that GCC is not + doing a good job here. + 1. The function is not inlined (too complicated?) + 2. It seems to be reloading the crb and drb variables all the + time. + 3. It doesn't seem to notice that the second half of these if's + are really a switch statement. + + So I (JV) conjecture + + #### It would really be worth it to arrange for this function to + be (almost) a single call to memcmp. */ + if ((crb->findex != drb->findex) || (WINDOW_FACE_CACHEL_DIRTY (w, drb->findex))) return 0; diff --git a/src/redisplay.h b/src/redisplay.h index 96e2e92..f79847c 100644 --- a/src/redisplay.h +++ b/src/redisplay.h @@ -91,6 +91,13 @@ typedef struct but control characters have two -- a ^ and a letter -- and other non-printing characters (those displayed in octal) have four. */ +/* WARNING! In compare_runes (one of the most heavily used functions) + two runes are compared. So please be careful with changes to this + structure. See comments in compare_runes. + + #### This should really be made smaller. +*/ + typedef struct rune rune; struct rune { @@ -105,10 +112,6 @@ struct rune each of the face properties in this particular window. */ - short xpos; /* horizontal starting position in pixels */ - short width; /* pixel width of rune */ - - Bufpos bufpos; /* buffer position this rune is displaying; for the modeline, the value here is a Charcount, but who's looking? */ @@ -116,11 +119,26 @@ struct rune /* #### Chuck, what does it mean for a rune to cover a range of pos? I don't get this. */ - unsigned int cursor_type :3; /* is this rune covered by the cursor? */ - unsigned int type :3; /* type of rune object */ + /* #### This isn't used as an rvalue anywhere! + remove! */ + + + short xpos; /* horizontal starting position in pixels */ + short width; /* pixel width of rune */ + + + unsigned char cursor_type; /* is this rune covered by the cursor? */ + unsigned char type; /* type of rune object */ + /* We used to do bitfields here, but if I + (JV) count correctly that doesn't matter + for the size of the structure. All the bit + fiddling _does_ slow down redisplay by + about 10%. So don't do that */ union /* Information specific to the type of rune */ { + /* #### GLyps are are. Is it really necessary to waste 8 bytes on every + rune for that?! */ /* DGLYPH */ struct { diff --git a/src/s/mingw32.h b/src/s/mingw32.h index 8168d5a..32783cf 100644 --- a/src/s/mingw32.h +++ b/src/s/mingw32.h @@ -215,10 +215,15 @@ int kill (int pid, int sig); #define popen _popen #define pclose _pclose +typedef int uid_t; +typedef int gid_t; +typedef int pid_t; +typedef int ssize_t; + /* Encapsulation of system calls */ #ifndef DONT_ENCAPSULATE #define getpid sys_getpid -int getpid (void); +pid_t getpid (void); #endif #define DONT_USE_LITOUT @@ -235,12 +240,12 @@ char *getwd (char *dir); void *sbrk (unsigned long increment); struct passwd; -struct passwd *getpwuid (int uid); +struct passwd *getpwuid (uid_t uid); struct passwd *getpwnam (const char *name); -int getuid (); -int geteuid (); -int getgid (void); -int getegid (); +uid_t getuid (void); +uid_t geteuid (void); +gid_t getgid (void); +gid_t getegid (void); #define _timeb timeb /* Stuff that gets set wrongly or otherwise */ diff --git a/src/s/windowsnt.h b/src/s/windowsnt.h index 50bf0d9..023e038 100644 --- a/src/s/windowsnt.h +++ b/src/s/windowsnt.h @@ -281,10 +281,15 @@ int kill (int pid, int sig); #endif /* 0 */ +typedef int uid_t; +typedef int gid_t; +typedef int pid_t; +typedef int ssize_t; + /* Encapsulation of system calls */ #ifndef DONT_ENCAPSULATE #define getpid sys_getpid -int getpid (void); +pid_t getpid (void); #endif /* Random global functions called everywhere. Implemented in nt.c */ @@ -299,12 +304,12 @@ char *getwd (char *dir); void *sbrk (unsigned long increment); struct passwd; -struct passwd *getpwuid (int uid); +struct passwd *getpwuid (uid_t uid); struct passwd *getpwnam (const char *name); -int getuid (); -int geteuid (); -int getgid (void); -int getegid (); +uid_t getuid (void); +uid_t geteuid (void); +gid_t getgid (void); +gid_t getegid (void); /* Setitimer is emulated */ #define HAVE_SETITIMER diff --git a/src/sound.c b/src/sound.c index 0260728..4a8786f 100644 --- a/src/sound.c +++ b/src/sound.c @@ -45,6 +45,12 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ # include #endif +#ifdef HAVE_ESD_SOUND +extern int esd_play_sound_file (char *file, int vol); +extern int esd_play_sound_data (unsigned char *data, size_t length, int vol); +# define DEVICE_CONNECTED_TO_ESD_P(x) 1 /* FIXME: better check */ +#endif + int bell_volume; int bell_inhibit_time; Lisp_Object Vsound_alist; @@ -79,7 +85,8 @@ Windows the sound file must be in WAV format. { /* This function can call lisp */ int vol; -#if defined (HAVE_NATIVE_SOUND) || defined (HAVE_NAS_SOUND) +#if defined (HAVE_NATIVE_SOUND) || defined (HAVE_NAS_SOUND) \ + || defined (HAVE_ESD_SOUND) struct device *d = decode_device (device); #endif struct gcpro gcpro1; @@ -126,6 +133,17 @@ Windows the sound file must be in WAV format. } #endif /* HAVE_NAS_SOUND */ +#ifdef HAVE_ESD_SOUND + if (DEVICE_CONNECTED_TO_ESD_P (d)) + { + char *fileext; + + GET_C_STRING_FILENAME_DATA_ALLOCA (file, fileext); + if (esd_play_sound_file (fileext, vol)) + return Qnil; + } +#endif /* HAVE_ESD_SOUND */ + #ifdef HAVE_NATIVE_SOUND if (NILP (Vnative_sound_only_on_console) || DEVICE_ON_CONSOLE_P (d)) { @@ -302,6 +320,18 @@ See the variable `sound-alist'. } #endif /* HAVE_NAS_SOUND */ +#ifdef HAVE_ESD_SOUND + if (DEVICE_CONNECTED_TO_ESD_P (d) && STRINGP (sound)) + { + Extbyte *soundext; + Extcount soundextlen; + + GET_STRING_BINARY_DATA_ALLOCA (sound, soundext, soundextlen); + if (esd_play_sound_data (soundext, soundextlen, vol)) + return Qnil; + } +#endif /* HAVE_ESD_SOUND */ + #ifdef HAVE_NATIVE_SOUND if ((NILP (Vnative_sound_only_on_console) || DEVICE_ON_CONSOLE_P (d)) && STRINGP (sound)) diff --git a/src/src-headers b/src/src-headers index cb0e337..d94b992 100644 --- a/src/src-headers +++ b/src/src-headers @@ -28,8 +28,8 @@ my ($myName, $srcdir); ($myName = $0) =~ s@.*/@@; my $usage =" Usage: $myName -Generates header file fragments from the Emacs sources. -"; +Generates header file fragments from the Emacs sources +and writes them to stdout.\n"; die $usage if @ARGV; diff --git a/src/symsinit.h b/src/symsinit.h index 5fbcd26..7ae439d 100644 --- a/src/symsinit.h +++ b/src/symsinit.h @@ -101,6 +101,7 @@ void syms_of_gui_x (void); void syms_of_gui (void); void syms_of_gutter (void); void syms_of_indent (void); +void syms_of_input_method_xlib (void); void syms_of_intl (void); void syms_of_keymap (void); void syms_of_lread (void); @@ -148,6 +149,7 @@ void syms_of_widget (void); void syms_of_window (void); void syms_of_xselect (void); void syms_of_eldap (void); +void syms_of_gpmevent (void); /* Initialize the console types (dump-time but for reinit_). */ @@ -368,6 +370,7 @@ void reinit_vars_of_window (void); void vars_of_xselect (void); void reinit_vars_of_xselect (void); void vars_of_eldap (void); +void vars_of_gpmevent (void); /* Initialize specifier variables (dump-time only). */ diff --git a/src/syntax.c b/src/syntax.c index 4792c2b..2e0dde9 100644 --- a/src/syntax.c +++ b/src/syntax.c @@ -661,7 +661,7 @@ Optional argument BUFFER defaults to the current buffer. Bufpos stop; Emchar c; enum syntaxcode code; - int count; + EMACS_INT count; struct buffer *buf = decode_buffer (buffer, 0); struct Lisp_Char_Table *mirrortab = XCHAR_TABLE (buf->mirror_syntax_table); @@ -1690,9 +1690,18 @@ Non-nil means `forward-word', etc., should treat escape chars part of words. no_quit_in_re_search = 0; } +static void +define_standard_syntax (CONST char *p, enum syntaxcode syn) +{ + for (; *p; p++) + Fput_char_table (make_char (*p), make_int (syn), Vstandard_syntax_table); +} + void complex_vars_of_syntax (void) { + Emchar i; + CONST char *p; /* Set this now, so first buffer creation can refer to it. */ /* Make it nil before calling copy-syntax-table so that copy-syntax-table will know not to try to copy from garbage */ @@ -1704,68 +1713,31 @@ complex_vars_of_syntax (void) Smax); staticpro (&Vsyntax_designator_chars_string); - fill_char_table (XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_syntax_table), - make_int (Spunct)); - - { - Emchar i; + fill_char_table (XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_syntax_table), make_int (Spunct)); - for (i = 0; i <= 32; i++) - Fput_char_table (make_char (i), make_int ((int) Swhitespace), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - for (i = 127; i <= 159; i++) - Fput_char_table (make_char (i), make_int ((int) Swhitespace), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - - for (i = 'a'; i <= 'z'; i++) - Fput_char_table (make_char (i), make_int ((int) Sword), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - for (i = 'A'; i <= 'Z'; i++) - Fput_char_table (make_char (i), make_int ((int) Sword), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - for (i = '0'; i <= '9'; i++) - Fput_char_table (make_char (i), make_int ((int) Sword), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char ('$'), make_int ((int) Sword), + for (i = 0; i <= 32; i++) /* Control 0 plus SPACE */ + Fput_char_table (make_char (i), make_int (Swhitespace), Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char ('%'), make_int ((int) Sword), + for (i = 127; i <= 159; i++) /* DEL plus Control 1 */ + Fput_char_table (make_char (i), make_int (Swhitespace), Vstandard_syntax_table); + define_standard_syntax ("abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz" + "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ" + "0123456789" + "$%", Sword); + define_standard_syntax ("\"", Sstring); + define_standard_syntax ("\\", Sescape); + define_standard_syntax ("_-+*/&|<>=", Ssymbol); + define_standard_syntax (".,;:?!#@~^'`", Spunct); + + for (p = "()[]{}"; *p; p+=2) { - Fput_char_table (make_char ('('), Fcons (make_int ((int) Sopen), - make_char (')')), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char (')'), Fcons (make_int ((int) Sclose), - make_char ('(')), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char ('['), Fcons (make_int ((int) Sopen), - make_char (']')), + Fput_char_table (make_char (p[0]), + Fcons (make_int (Sopen), make_char (p[1])), Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char (']'), Fcons (make_int ((int) Sclose), - make_char ('[')), + Fput_char_table (make_char (p[1]), + Fcons (make_int (Sclose), make_char (p[0])), Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char ('{'), Fcons (make_int ((int) Sopen), - make_char ('}')), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char ('}'), Fcons (make_int ((int) Sclose), - make_char ('{')), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - } - - Fput_char_table (make_char ('"'), make_int ((int) Sstring), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - Fput_char_table (make_char ('\\'), make_int ((int) Sescape), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - - { - CONST char *p; - for (p = "_-+*/&|<>="; *p; p++) - Fput_char_table (make_char (*p), make_int ((int) Ssymbol), - Vstandard_syntax_table); - - for (p = ".,;:?!#@~^'`"; *p; p++) - Fput_char_table (make_char (*p), make_int ((int) Spunct), - Vstandard_syntax_table); } - } } diff --git a/src/sysdep.c b/src/sysdep.c index 398eaca..ea912f0 100644 --- a/src/sysdep.c +++ b/src/sysdep.c @@ -567,7 +567,7 @@ restore_signal_handlers (struct save_signal *saved_handlers) } #ifdef WINDOWSNT -int +pid_t sys_getpid (void) { return abs (getpid ()); @@ -2573,8 +2573,8 @@ mswindows_set_last_errno (void) /* Ben sez: read Dick Gabriel's essay about the Worse Is Better approach to programming and its connection to the silly - interruptible-system-call business. To find it, look at - Jamie's home page (http://www.netscape.com/people/jwz). */ + interruptible-system-call business. To find it, look on + Jamie's home page (http://www.jwz.org/worse-is-better.html). */ #ifdef ENCAPSULATE_OPEN int @@ -2638,13 +2638,13 @@ interruptible_open (CONST char *path, int oflag, int mode) #ifdef ENCAPSULATE_CLOSE int -sys_close (int fd) +sys_close (int filedes) { #ifdef INTERRUPTIBLE_CLOSE int did_retry = 0; REGISTER int rtnval; - while ((rtnval = close (fd)) == -1 + while ((rtnval = close (filedes)) == -1 && (errno == EINTR)) did_retry = 1; @@ -2656,15 +2656,15 @@ sys_close (int fd) return rtnval; #else - return close (fd); + return close (filedes); #endif } #endif /* ENCAPSULATE_CLOSE */ -int +ssize_t sys_read_1 (int fildes, void *buf, size_t nbyte, int allow_quit) { - int rtnval; + ssize_t rtnval; /* No harm in looping regardless of the INTERRUPTIBLE_IO setting. */ while ((rtnval = read (fildes, buf, nbyte)) == -1 @@ -2677,24 +2677,23 @@ sys_read_1 (int fildes, void *buf, size_t nbyte, int allow_quit) } #ifdef ENCAPSULATE_READ -int +ssize_t sys_read (int fildes, void *buf, size_t nbyte) { return sys_read_1 (fildes, buf, nbyte, 0); } #endif /* ENCAPSULATE_READ */ -int +ssize_t sys_write_1 (int fildes, CONST void *buf, size_t nbyte, int allow_quit) { - int rtnval; - int bytes_written = 0; + ssize_t bytes_written = 0; CONST char *b = (CONST char *) buf; /* No harm in looping regardless of the INTERRUPTIBLE_IO setting. */ while (nbyte > 0) { - rtnval = write (fildes, b, nbyte); + ssize_t rtnval = write (fildes, b, nbyte); if (allow_quit) REALLY_QUIT; @@ -2704,17 +2703,17 @@ sys_write_1 (int fildes, CONST void *buf, size_t nbyte, int allow_quit) if (errno == EINTR) continue; else - return (bytes_written ? bytes_written : -1); + return bytes_written ? bytes_written : -1; } b += rtnval; nbyte -= rtnval; bytes_written += rtnval; } - return (bytes_written); + return bytes_written; } #ifdef ENCAPSULATE_WRITE -int +ssize_t sys_write (int fildes, CONST void *buf, size_t nbyte) { return sys_write_1 (fildes, buf, nbyte, 0); diff --git a/src/sysfile.h b/src/sysfile.h index 3f4a694..e421d79 100644 --- a/src/sysfile.h +++ b/src/sysfile.h @@ -244,7 +244,7 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ Other encapsulations are declared in the appropriate sys*.h file. */ #ifdef ENCAPSULATE_READ -int sys_read (int, void *, size_t); +ssize_t sys_read (int, void *, size_t); #endif #if defined (ENCAPSULATE_READ) && !defined (DONT_ENCAPSULATE) # undef read @@ -255,7 +255,7 @@ int sys_read (int, void *, size_t); #endif #ifdef ENCAPSULATE_WRITE -int sys_write (int, CONST void *, size_t); +ssize_t sys_write (int, CONST void *, size_t); #endif #if defined (ENCAPSULATE_WRITE) && !defined (DONT_ENCAPSULATE) # undef write diff --git a/src/tooltalk.c b/src/tooltalk.c index b53f3f4..f9a6d5e 100644 --- a/src/tooltalk.c +++ b/src/tooltalk.c @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ /* Synched up with: Not in FSF. */ /* Written by John Rose . - Heavily modified and cleaned up by Ben Wing . */ + Heavily modified and cleaned up by Ben Wing . */ #include #include "lisp.h" @@ -502,7 +502,7 @@ tt_state_symbol (Tt_state n) static Lisp_Object tt_build_string (char *s) { - return build_string ((s) ? s : ""); + return build_string (s ? s : ""); } static Lisp_Object diff --git a/tests/ChangeLog b/tests/ChangeLog index 5c35ad8..0829572 100644 --- a/tests/ChangeLog +++ b/tests/ChangeLog @@ -1,3 +1,11 @@ +1999-11-29 XEmacs Build Bot + + * XEmacs 21.2.22 is released + +1999-11-28 Martin Buchholz + + * XEmacs 21.2.21 is released. + 1999-11-10 XEmacs Build Bot * XEmacs 21.2.20 is released diff --git a/tests/Dnd/droptest.sh b/tests/Dnd/droptest.sh index eb1b92f..602c7fd 100644 --- a/tests/Dnd/droptest.sh +++ b/tests/Dnd/droptest.sh @@ -1,8 +1,10 @@ #!/bin/sh -cat README > /tmp/DropTest.txt +TEMPDIR=/tmp -cat > /tmp/DropTest.html < $TEMPDIR/DropTest.txt + +cat > $TEMPDIR/DropTest.html < DropTest Page @@ -14,7 +16,7 @@ Just a Test! EOF -cat > /tmp/DropTest.tex < $TEMPDIR/DropTest.tex < /tmp/DropTest.xpm < $TEMPDIR/DropTest.xpm < -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Author: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Created: 1998 ;; Keywords: tests diff --git a/tests/automated/symbol-tests.el b/tests/automated/symbol-tests.el index d8c680f..0159d5b 100644 --- a/tests/automated/symbol-tests.el +++ b/tests/automated/symbol-tests.el @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ ;; Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -;; Author: Hrvoje Niksic -;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Author: Hrvoje Niksic +;; Maintainer: Hrvoje Niksic ;; Created: 1999 ;; Keywords: tests diff --git a/version.sh b/version.sh index af75a6c..b501d5e 100644 --- a/version.sh +++ b/version.sh @@ -2,8 +2,8 @@ emacs_is_beta=t emacs_major_version=21 emacs_minor_version=2 -emacs_beta_version=20 -xemacs_codename="Yoko" +emacs_beta_version=22 +xemacs_codename="Mercedes" infodock_major_version=4 infodock_minor_version=0 infodock_build_version=8